Prospekt - Hedgeconcept.de
Transcription
Prospekt - Hedgeconcept.de
Prospekt der MORGAN STANLEY B.V. vom 14. Februar 2008 für bis zu 75.000 kapitalgeschützte apano AP Garant 2 Garantiezertifikate bezogen auf Aktien der Klasse T2 (Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares) der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. garantiert von Morgan Stanley (gegründet nach dem Recht des US-Bundesstaates Delaware) WKN: MS5DHK ISIN: DE000MS5DHK0 Die Zertifikate sind und werden in Zukunft nicht unter dem U.S. Securities Act of 1933 ("Securities Act") registriert. Abgesehen von bestimmten Ausnahmen dürfen die Zertifikate weder in den Vereinigten Staaten noch an U.S. Personen angeboten, verkauft oder geliefert werden. INHALTSVERZEICHNIS DURCH VERWEIS EINBEZOGENE DOKUMENTE................................................5 ZUSAMMENFASSUNG ..............................................................................................8 Warnhinweise ................................................................................................................8 Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Risikofaktoren.....................................................8 Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Merkmale in Bezug auf die Emittentin.............12 Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Merkmale in Bezug auf die Garantin................13 Zusammenfassung des Angebots.................................................................................15 Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Merkmale in Bezug auf die ausgegebenen Zertifikate.....................................................................................................................16 RISIKOFAKTOREN DER ZERTIFIKATE ............................................................... 23 Mit der Emittentin verbundene Risiken.......................................................................23 Mit der Garantin verbundene Risiken..........................................................................24 Mit den Zertifikaten verbundene Risiken ....................................................................39 Mit der Fonds-Komponente verbundene Risiken ........................................................44 ALLGEMEINE INFORMATIONEN ÜBER DAS ANGEBOT UND DIE ZERTIFIKATE ............................................................................................................57 Gegenstand des Prospekts............................................................................................57 Wertpapierkennummer ("WKN") / ISIN der Zertifikate ............................................. 57 Billigung des Prospekts................................................................................................ 58 EWR-Pass ....................................................................................................................58 Ausgabe der Zertifikate und öffentliches Angebot......................................................58 Verkaufsbeschränkungen.............................................................................................59 Verbriefung ..................................................................................................................60 Zahlstelle......................................................................................................................61 Verwendung der Emissionserlöse................................................................................61 2 Verantwortung .............................................................................................................61 Beschluss des Board of Directors................................................................................61 Bereithaltung des Prospekts und sonstiger Unterlagen................................................62 Ausgabe von Berichten im Anschluss an die Emission...............................................62 BESCHREIBUNG DER EMITTENTIN.....................................................................63 BESCHREIBUNG DER GARANTIN ........................................................................ 69 KOSTEN, GEBÜHREN UND SONSTIGE AUSLAGEN .........................................92 Gebühren......................................................................................................................92 Sonstige Kosten, Gebühren, Provisionen und Aufwendungen im Zusammenhang mit der Fonds-Komponente............................................................... 93 BESCHREIBUNG DER FONDS-KOMPONENTE...................................................94 ZERTIFIKATSBEDINGUNGEN .............................................................................104 § 1 Zertifikatsrecht; Rückzahlungsbetrag ..................................................................104 § 2 Weitere Definitionen............................................................................................105 § 3 Status; Garantie; Form der Zertifikate; Girosammelverwahrung; Übertragbarkeit ..........................................................................................................105 § 4 Aussetzungen und Verschiebungen .....................................................................106 § 5 Berechnungen; Zahlung von Geldbeträgen .........................................................108 § 6 Zahl- und Berechnungsstelle................................................................................108 § 7 Bekanntmachungen..............................................................................................109 § 8 Aufstockung; Ankauf; Entwertung ......................................................................109 § 9 Vorzeitiger Verkauf durch die Zertifikatsinhaber................................................110 § 10 Kündigung durch die Emittentin........................................................................111 § 11 Ersetzung der Emittentin.................................................................................... 114 § 12 Verschiedenes ....................................................................................................115 § 13 Sprache...............................................................................................................116 3 BESTEUERUNG IN DER BUNDESREPUBLIK DEUTSCHLAND .....................117 ANLAGE: JAHRESBERICHT DER EMITTENTIN ZUM 30 NOVEMBER 2007 ......................................................................... F-1 – F-20 ANLAGE: JAHRESBERICHT (FORM 10-K) DER GARANTIN ZUM 30. NOVEMBER 2007 ..................................................................... G-1 – G-353 UNTERSCHRIFTENSEITE................................................................................... U-1 4 DURCH VERWEIS EINBEZOGENE DOKUMENTE Sämtliche in Hinblick auf die Morgan Stanley B.V. als Emittentin ("MSBV" oder die "Emittentin") und Morgan Stanley als Garantin ("Morgan Stanley" oder die "Garantin") folgenden Dokumente sind Bestandteile des Basisprospekts vom 22. Juni 2007, wie durch Nachträge vom 10. Oktober 2007, 19. November 2007 und 20. Dezember 2007 ergänzt (Program for the Issuance of Notes, Series A and B) von Morgan Stanley als Emittentin und Garantin, Morgan Stanley (Jersey) Limited als Emittentin und Morgan Stanley B.V. als Emittentin, der von der Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht in Großbritannien (Financial Services Authority) in Übereinstimmung mit der Richtlinie 2003/71/EG vom 4. November 2003 bzw. deren maßgeblichen Umsetzungsvorschriften in Großbritannien gebilligt worden ist, und sind durch Verweis in diesen Prospekt einbezogen bzw. bilden einen Bestandteil dieses Prospekts: Bezüglich Morgan Stanley als Garantin: Einbezogenes Dokument: Bezug genommen in: Information: Für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2006 bis zum 30. November 2007 wird verwiesen auf: Jahresbericht (Annual "Ausgewählte • "Bilanz" (Consolidated Statements of Report, Form 10-K) Finanzinformationen" auf Financial Condition) Seiten G-101 f. des der Garantin zum Seite 82 dieses Prospekts: Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 1030. November 2007 K) • "Gewinn und Verlustrechnung" (Consolidated Statements of Income) Seite G-103 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) • "Kapitalflussrechnung" (Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows ) Seite G-105 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10K) • "Rechnungslegungsstrategien und erläuternde Anmerkungen" (Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements) Seiten G-107 ff. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) "Prüfung historischer • Prüfungsbericht (Report of the Finanzdaten" auf Seite 83 Independent Registered Public Accounting dieses Prospekts: Firm), Seite G-100 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) 5 Für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2005 bis zum 30. November 2006 wird verwiesen auf: Jahresbericht (Annual "Ausgewählte • "Bilanz" (Consolidated Statements of Report, Form 10-K) Finanzinformationen" auf Financial Condition) Seiten 110 f. des der Garantin zum Seite 82 dieses Prospekts: Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 1030. November 2006 K) • "Gewinn und Verlustrechnung" (Consolidated Statements of Income) Seite 112 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) • "Kapitalflussrechnung" (Consolidated Statement of Cash Flow ) Seite -114 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10K) • "Rechnungslegungsstrategien und erläuternde Anmerkungen" (Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements) Seiten 116 ff. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) "Prüfung historischer • Prüfungsbericht (Report of the Finanzdaten" auf Seite 83 Independent Registered Public Accounting dieses Prospekts: Firm), Seite 109 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) Bezüglich Morgan Stanley B.V. als Emittentin: Einbezogenes Dokument: Bezug genommen in: Information: Für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2006 bis zum 30. November 2007 wird verwiesen auf: Jahresbericht (Annual "Finanzinformationen über die • "Bilanz" (Balance Sheet), Seite F-4 Report and Accounts) Vermögens-, Finanzund des Jahresberichts (Annual Report der Emittentin zum Ertragslage der Emittentin " auf and Accounts) 30. November 2007 Seite 66 dieses Prospekts: • "Gewinn und Verlustrechnung" (Income Statement), Seite F-3 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) • "Kapitalflussrechnung" (Cash Flow Statement), Seite F-6 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) • "Erläuternde Anmerkungen" (Notes to the Financial Statements), Seiten F-7 ff. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) "Prüfung der historischen • Prüfungsbericht (Auditor's Report), jährlichen Finanzinformationen" Seiten F-19 f des Jahresberichts auf Seite 68 dieses Prospekts: (Annual Report and Accounts) 6 Einbezogenes Dokument: Bezug genommen in: Information: Für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2005 bis zum 30. November 2006 wird verwiesen auf: Jahresbericht (Annual "Finanzinformationen über die • "Bilanz" (Balance Sheet), Seite 3 Report and Accounts) Vermögens-, Finanzund des Jahresberichts (Annual Report der Emittentin zum Ertragslage der Emittentin " auf and Accounts) 30. November 2006 Seite 66 dieses Prospekts: • "Gewinn und Verlustrechnung" (Profit and Loss Account), Seite 2 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) • "Kapitalflussrechnung" (Cash Flow Statement), Seite 4 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) • "Erläuternde Anmerkungen" (Notes to the Accounts), Seiten 5 ff. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) "Prüfung der historischen • Prüfungsbericht (Auditor's Report), jährlichen Finanzinformationen" Seiten 14 f des Jahresberichts auf Seite 68 dieses Prospekts: (Annual Report and Accounts) Die durch Verweis einbezogenen Dokumente werden bei der Emittentin bzw. der Garantin in gedruckter Form zur kostenlosen Ausgabe bereitgehalten. Die in Hinblick auf die Garantin durch Verweis einbezogenen Dokumente sind zudem auf der Internet-Seite der US-amerikanischen Wertpapier- und Börsenaufsicht (United States Securities and Exchange Commission) unter www.sec.gov veröffentlicht und dort für Anleger abrufbar. 7 ZUSAMMENFASSUNG Warnhinweise Die folgende Zusammenfassung stellt eine Einführung zu diesem Prospekt (der "Prospekt") dar. Der Zertifikatsinhaber sollte daher jede Entscheidung zur Anlage in die Zertifikate nur nach ausführlicher Prüfung des gesamten Prospekts einschließlich der Zertifikatsbedingungen (die "Zertifikatsbedingungen") treffen. Begriffe, die in den Zertifikatsbedingungen definiert sind, haben in der Zusammenfassung die gleiche Bedeutung, falls nicht anderweitig bestimmt. Für den Fall, dass vor einem Gericht Ansprüche aufgrund der in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Informationen geltend gemacht werden, hat der als Kläger auftretende Zertifikatsinhaber in Anwendung der einzelstaatlichen Rechtsvorschriften der Staaten des Europäischen Wirtschaftsraums gegebenenfalls die Kosten für eine erforderliche Übersetzung des Prospekts vor Prozessbeginn zu tragen. Potenzielle Erwerber der Zertifikate sollten beachten, dass die Emittentin für die Zusammenfassung einschließlich einer Übersetzung davon in diesem Prospekt haftbar gemacht werden kann, jedoch nur für den Fall, dass die Zusammenfassung irreführend, unrichtig oder widersprüchlich ist, wenn sie zusammen mit den anderen Teilen des Prospekts gelesen wird. Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Risikofaktoren Die im Folgenden dargestellten Risikofaktoren können sich negativ auf die Wertentwicklung der kapitalgeschützten apano AP Garant 2 Garantiezertifikate (jeweils das "Zertifikat" bzw. die "Zertifikate") auswirken. Dabei können mehrere Risikofaktoren die Wertentwicklung der Zertifikate gleichzeitig beeinflussen, ohne dass über deren Zusammenwirken eine verbindliche Aussage getroffen werden könnte. Darüber hinaus können sich weitere, zum jetzigen Zeitpunkt unbekannte oder unvorhersehbare Risiken ebenfalls negativ auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Anleger müssen Risikofaktoren in Bezug auf die Emittentin, die Garantin, die Zertifikate, die den Zertifikaten zugrundeliegenden Fonds-Komponente und sonstige Risiken beachten. Risikofaktoren in Bezug auf die Emittentin sind unter anderem, dass • es keine Ansprüche der Zertifikatsinhaber gegen Gesellschafter, Geschäftsführer oder Angestellte der Morgan Stanley B.V. ("MSBV" oder die "Emittentin") gibt; und 8 • alle wesentlichen Aktiva von MSBV Verpflichtungen von (oder Wertpapiere ausgegeben von) einer oder mehreren Gesellschaften der Morgan Stanley Gruppe darstellen. Die Verpflichtungen von MSBV gemäß solchen Transaktionen sind im Wesentlichen von Morgan Stanley garantiert. Entstehen einer dieser Gesellschaften der Morgan Stanley Gruppe Verluste im Zusammenhang mit ihren Aktivitäten (unabhängig davon, ob sich diese Aktivitäten auf MSBV beziehen oder nicht), so könnten diese nur noch eingeschränkt in der Lage sein, ihre Verpflichtungen gegenüber MSBV zu erfüllen, und die Inhaber von Wertpapieren, die MSBV ausgegeben hat, wären einem Verlustrisiko ausgesetzt. Risikofaktoren in Bezug auf die Garantin sind unter anderem, dass • das tatsächliche Ergebnis von Morgan Stanley ("Morgan Stanley" oder die "Garantin") im Einzelfall aufgrund zahlreicher Faktoren erheblich vom erwarteten Ergebnis abweichen könnte. Die in diesem Prospekt aufgeführten Risikofaktoren stellen die wesentlichen Risiken und Unsicherheiten für das Geschäft von Morgan Stanley dar; • das operative Ergebnis von Morgan Stanley in wesentlichem Maße von Marktschwankungen, wirtschaftlichen und anderen Faktoren, wie dem politischen Umfeld, der Konjunktur- und Marktsituation, der Verfügbarkeit und den Kosten von Kapital, dem Kurs- und Volatilitätsniveau an den Aktienmärkten, den Rohstoffpreisen und Zinssätzen, den Wechselkursen und anderen Marktindizes, technologischen Veränderungen und Ereignissen, der Verfügbarkeit und den Kosten von Fremdkapital, der Inflation sowie der Verbraucherstimmung und dem Vertrauen in die Finanzmärkte beeinflusst werden kann; • Morgan Stanley einem harten Wettbewerb mit anderen Finanzdienstleistern ausgesetzt ist und dies auf die Preise drücken und somit die Erträge und Profitabilität des Unternehmens erheblich beeinträchtigen könnte und • die Finanzdienstleistungsbranche erheblichen Risiken im Zusammenhang mit Rechtsstreitigkeiten und aufsichtsrechtlichen Aspekten ausgesetzt ist, und der Ruf in der Finanzdienstleistungsbranche sowie die rechtliche Haftungssituation von Morgan Stanley Schaden nehmen können, wenn die Dienstleistungen als nicht zufrieden stellend bewertet werden oder andere Gründe vorliegen. Morgan Stanley musste im vierten Quartal des Geschäftsjahres 2007 Abschreibungen in Höhe von USD 9,4 Milliarden, inklusive USD 7,8 Millarden aufgrund ihrer U.S. Subprime Handelspositionen und USD 1,6 Milliarden aufgrund anderer Hypothekengeschäfte vornehmen. Diese Geschäfte beinhalten etwa Commercial Mortgage Backed Securities, Alt-A und andere Darlehen, notleidende Kredite (Non Performing Loans) und europäische Non-Conforming Loans und eine 9 Ausgleichszahlung für Hypothekenportfolios heimischer Tochtergesellschaften. Morgan Stanley ist weiterhin in diesen Märkten und Produkten aktiv und, soweit die Marktbedingungen voranschreiten, könnte der Wert hypothekenbezogener Instrumente weiter sinken. Daneben erschwert die hohe Volatilität der aktuellen Marktbedingungen eine Bewertung einzelner Wertpapiere von Morgan Stanley. Spätere Bewertungen unter Berücksichtigung dieser Faktoren können zu einer signifikanten Änderung der Bewertung einzelner Wertpapiere in der Zukunft führen. Daneben hängt der am Verkaufstag von Morgan Stanley erzielbare Preis von Wertpapieren von der Nachfrage und der Liquidität am Markt ab, welcher durchaus erheblich niedriger als der gegenwärtige eigentliche Preis sein kann. Sämtliche dieser Faktoren können dazu führen, dass Morgan Stanley weitere Abschreibungen in Bezug auf den Wert ihres Wertpapierportfolios vornehmen muss und dies einen negativen Einfluss auf das Ergebnis in der Zukunft haben kann. Das Ergebnis des Geschäftsjahres 2007 beinhaltete weitere Verluste, die vor allem auf die Illiquidität des Marktes in der zweiten Hälfte des Geschäftsjahres 2007 zurückzuführen sind. Diese Verluste spiegelten die Marktbewertungen bezüglich Darlehen und Darlehnsengagements im Zusammenhang mit der Akquisitionsfinanzierung von Nicht-Banken wieder. Morgan Stanleys Leveraged Finance-Geschäft beinhaltet die Konsortialführerschaft und den Weitervertrieb von Darlehen und Verpflichtungen und zielt darauf ab, die gegenwärtigen Positionen weiter zu veräußern. Dennoch könnte dies wegen der Liquidität des Marktes länger als in der Vergangenheit dauern und zu weiteren Abschreibungen solcher Darlehen und Verpflichtungen führen. Die Bewertung dieser Verpflichtungen könnte sich in der Zukunft ändern, was unter anderem davon abhängt, ob neue Absprachen auch bezüglich des Preises getroffen werden und ob die zugrundeliegende Transaktion stattfindet. Andere Geschäftsbereiche von Morgan Stanley, die bis heute nicht von der Illiquidität des Hypotheken- und Kreditgeschäfts betroffen waren, können im Falle einer Ausweitung der gegenwärtigen Bedingungen auf andere Bereiche negativ beeinflusst werden. Risikofaktoren in Bezug auf die Zertifikate sind unter anderem, dass • die Zahlung eines über den Mindestbetrag von 120% des Nennwerts der Zertifikate hinausgehenden Betrags von der an einen Partizipationsfaktor geknüpften Wertentwicklung der Fonds-Komponente abhängig ist. Sollte sich der Wert der Fonds-Komponente nicht entsprechend entwickeln, erhalten die Anleger unter Umständen zum Laufzeitende lediglich den Mindestbetrag von 120% des Nennwerts der Zertifikate und keine darüber hinausgehenden Beträge. • der Kapitalschutz im Umfang von 120% des Nennwerts je Zertifikat nur zum Ende der Laufzeit der Wertpapiere greift; 10 • ein möglicher Kapitalschutz vor dem Ende der Laufzeit wie in den Zertifikatsbedingungen beschrieben nur zu den in den Zertifikatsbedingungen beschriebenen Zeiträumen greift; • trotz des Kapitalschutzes im Umfang von 120% des Nennwerts, der Investor das Risiko der Verschlechterung der finanziellen Leistungsfähigkeit der Emittentin bzw. der Garantin trägt; • sich Nebenkosten des Kaufs und Verkaufs der Zertifikate nachteilig auf die Gewinnchance auswirken; • der Wert des Zertifikats überholt sein kann, da der Wert der FondsKomponente für einen bestimmten Tag, jedoch nicht an diesem Tag veröffentlicht wird; • risikoausschließende oder -einschränkende Geschäfte nicht immer möglich sind; • die Inanspruchnahme von Kredit zur Finanzierung der Zertifikate zu weiteren Verlusten führen kann; • sich die steuerliche Behandlung der Zertifikate ändern kann; • die Emittentin und die Garantin keine Verantwortung für die Rechtmäßigkeit des Erwerbs der Zertifikate durch die Zertifikatsinhaber übernehmen; • potenzielle Interessenkonflikte der beteiligten Parteien den Wert der Zertifikate und den Rückzahlungsbetrag beeinträchtigen können. Risikofaktoren in Bezug auf die Fonds-Komponente sind unter anderem, dass • die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. eine Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten (segregated accounts company)ist; • Änderungen der Besteuerung und der anwendbaren Gesetze in Bezug auf die Gesellschaft eintreten können; • die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. - Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares einer Diversifizierung unterliegen, die nicht offen gelegt wird; • die Anlagestrategie der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares Änderungen durch Man Investments Ltd., Großbritannien, als Investment Manager (der "Investment Manager") unterliegt; 11 • der allgemeine Anlageansatz der Gesellschaft, sowie die Investitionen der Anlagestrategien und Hedgefonds bestimmten Risiken unterliegt; • der Investment Manager weder Kontrolle noch Einfluss auf die Investitionsentscheide im Zusammenhang mit der Umsetzung der Anlagestrategien und der ihnen zugrunde liegenden Hedgefondsmanagern hat; • Transaktionskosten und Gebühren der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. - Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares sich nachteilig auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken können; • der Einsatz von Leverage-Techniken durch die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. die Wertentwicklung der Fonds-Komponente nachteilig beeinflussen kann; • Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. in äußerst volatile Märkte nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert der FondsKomponente haben können; • die Konzentration von Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert der FondsKomponente haben kann; • das mit den Anlagen der durch die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. verbundene Gegenparteirisiko nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente haben kann; • die mit den Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. verbundenen Zins- und Wechselkursrisiken nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente haben können; • die Bewertung der Vermögenswerte, auf denen die Fonds-Komponente basiert, nicht unbedingt den Marktwert der Vermögenswerte wieder spiegelt; • der Wert der Fonds-Komponente überholt sein kann. Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Merkmale in Bezug auf die Emittentin Morgan Stanley B.V. wurde am 6. September 2001 nach dem Recht der Niederlande als Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung (Besloten Vennootschap) auf unbegrenzte Dauer errichtet. MSBV ist im Handelsregister der Industrie- und Handelskammer (Kamer von Koophandel) von Amsterdam, Niederlande, unter der Nummer 34161590 eingetragen. Der Unternehmenssitz ist in Amsterdam, Niederlande, und die Geschäftsräume in Locatellikade 1, 1076 AZ Amsterdam, Niederlande, Telefon +31 20 5755600. 12 Gemäß den in Artikel 3 der Satzung von MSBV beschriebenen Zielen kann das Unternehmen unter anderem Schuldverschreibungen, Optionsscheine und andere Wertpapiere emittieren. Alle wesentlichen Aktiva von MSBV sind Verpflichtungen von (oder Wertpapiere ausgegeben von) einer oder mehreren Gesellschaften der Morgan Stanley Gruppe. Die Wirtschaftsprüfer von MSBV sind Deloitte Accountants B.V. (Mitglied des niederländischen Wirtschaftsprüferverbands Nederlands Instituut van Registeraccountants). MSBV hat keine Tochtergesellschaften und oberstes beherrschendes Unternehmen ist Morgan Stanley. Die Directors von MSBV sind C.E.C Hood, J. Solan, G.C. De Boer und TMF Management B.V. MSBV beschäftigt keine Mitarbeiter. Das genehmigte Stammkapital von MSBV setzt sich aus 900 Stammanteilen in Höhe von 100 Euro zusammen. Das ausgegebene, zugeteilte und voll eingezahlte Stammkapital von MSBV setzt sich aus 180 Stammanteilen in Höhe von 100 Euro zusammen. Die Netto-Umsatzerlöse zu den jeweiligen Bilanzstichtagen am 30. November 2007 und 2006 beliefen sich auf 2.962.000 Euro bzw. 1.075.000 Euro, und setzten sich zusammen aus Provisionen für die Ausgabe von Finanzinstrumenten abzüglich der Verbindlichkeiten für Garantiegebühren. In den Geschäftsjahren mit Bilanzstichtag 30. November 2007 und 2006 wurde ein Ergebnis vor Steuern in Höhe von 2.197.000 Euro bzw. 775.000 Euro Gewinn ausgewiesen. Im Berichtszeitraum wurden keine Dividenden ausgeschüttet. Das Umlaufvermögen von MSBV stieg von 3.893.257.000 Euro in 2006 auf 10.182.479.000 Euro in 2007, und die gesamten Verbindlichkeiten von 3.893.257.000 Euro in 2006 auf 10.182.479.000 Euro in 2007. Hauptgrund für diesen Verschuldungsanstieg war eine höhere Kundennachfrage nach Finanzinstrumenten. Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Merkmale in Bezug auf die Garantin Die Abschlussprüfer von Morgan Stanley für die Geschäftsjahre vom 1. Dezember 2004 bis 30. November 2005, vom 1. Dezember 2005 bis 30. November 2006 und 1. Dezember 2006 bis 30. November 2007 waren Deloitte & Touche LLP, Two World Financial Center, New York, New York 10281, USA, eine unabhängige registrierte Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (die "Abschlussprüfer"). Die Abschlussprüfer sind beim Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (USA) registriert. Morgan Stanley wurde ursprünglich am 1. Oktober 1981 nach dem Recht des USBundesstaates Delaware auf unbegrenzte Dauer mit Registernummer 0923632 gegründet. Die Vorgängergesellschaften gehen bis auf das Jahr 1924 zurück. Am 31. Mai 1997 schloss sich die Morgan Stanley Group, Inc. in einer Fusion unter Gleichen mit Dean Witter Discover & Co. ("Dean Witter Discover") zusammen. Zu 13 diesem Zeitpunkt änderte Dean Witter Discover den Firmennamen in Morgan Stanley, Dean Witter, Discover & Co. ("MSDWD"). Am 24. März 1998 wurde MSDWD in Morgan Stanley Dean Witter & Co und am 20. Juni 2002 in Morgan Stanley umbenannt. Sitz von Morgan Stanley ist The Corporation Trust Center, 1209 Orange Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, USA, und die Hauptverwaltung befindet sich in 1585 Broadway, New York, New York 10036, USA, Telefonnummer +1 (212) 761-4000. Zum Datum dieses Prospekts ist „Morgan Stanley“ der juristische und kommerzielle Name von Morgan Stanley. Morgan Stanley ist ein weltweit operierendes Finanzdienstleistungsunternehmen, das in allen Geschäftssegmenten – Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group und Asset Management – über bedeutende Marktpositionen verfügt. Morgan Stanley ist in folgenden Geschäftssegmente tätig: Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group und Asset Management. Morgan Stanley leitet das Geschäft von seinem Hauptsitz in New York City, den regionalen Niederlassungen und Filialen in den USA und seinen Hauptniederlassungen in London, Tokio, Hongkong und anderen Finanzzentren der Welt. Morgan Stanley ist eine Holdinggesellschaft, die durch ihre Tochtergesellschaften und verbundenen Unternehmen ihre Produkte und Dienstleistungen einer großen und breit gefächerten Mandanten- und Kundengruppe anbietet, darunter Unternehmen, Regierungen, Finanzinstituten und Einzelpersonen. Ziele und Geschäftsgegenstand von Morgan Stanley sind auf Seite 1 der Gründungsurkunde dargelegt und ermöglichen dem Unternehmen, alle gesetzlich zulässigen Handlungen und Tätigkeiten auszuführen, für die eine Kapitalgesellschaft gemäß dem General Corporation Law des Staates Delaware eingerichtet und gegründet werden kann. Zum Zeitpunkt dieses Prospekts hat Morgan Stanley die folgenden Directors: John J. Mack, Roy J. Bostock, Erskine B. Bowles, Howard J. Davies, C. Roberd Kidder, Donald T. Nicolaisen, Charles H. Noski, Hutham S. Olayan, Charles E. Phillips Jr, O. Griffith Sexton, Laura D. Tyson und Klaus Zumwinkel. Zum 30. November 2007 beschäftigte Morgan Stanley weltweit 48.256 Mitarbeiter. Zum 30. November 2007 umfasste das genehmigte Grundkapital von Morgan Stanley 3.500.000.000 Stammaktien im Nennwert von USD 0,01 und 30.000.000 Vorzugsaktien im Nennwert von USD 0,01. Das ausgegebene, nicht nachschusspflichtige und voll eingezahlte Grundkapital von Morgan Stanley betrug am 30. November 2007 1.211.701.552 Stammaktien im Nennwert von USD 0,01. Im Geschäftsjahr mit Stichtag 30. November 2007 beliefen sich die Aktiva von Morgan Stanley auf 1.045.409 Millionen US-Dollar und die Gesamtverbindlichkeiten 14 und das Eigenkapital (Passiva) auf 1.045.409 Millionen US-Dollar. Im Geschäftsjahr mit Stichtag 30. November 2006 beliefen sich die Aktiva von Morgan Stanley auf 1.121.192 Millionen US-Dollar und die Gesamtverbindlichkeiten und das Eigenkapital (Passiva) auf 1.121.192 Millionen US-Dollar. Zusammenfassung des Angebots Emissionsvolumen: bis zu 75.000 Zertifikate. Dies entspricht einem Gesamtemissionserlös von bis zu 75.000.000 Euro. Im Zeitraum vom 15. Februar 2008 bis zum 8. April 2008, 16:00 Uhr Frankfurter Zeit, werden die Zertifikate im Rahmen eines öffentlichen Angebots in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland von der Emittentin zum anfänglichen Ausgabepreis von 1.000 Euro (zuzüglich eines Agios von bis zu 6%) angeboten. Die Emittentin behält sich das Recht vor, die Angebotsfrist gegebenenfalls bis zum 18. April 2008, 16:00 Uhr Frankfurter Zeit zu verlängern. Die Emittentin ist nicht verpflichtet, gezeichnete Zertifikate auch zu emittieren. Anfänglicher Ausgabepreis: Mindestzeichnungsbetrag 1.000 Euro je Zertifikat 10.000 Euro (der Mindestzeichnungsbetrag entspricht 10 Zertifikaten) Agio: Es kann ein Agio je Zertifikat von bis zu 6% des anfänglichen Ausgabepreises erhoben werden, d.h. bei einem anfänglichen Ausgabepreis von 1.000 Euro ein Agio von bis zu 60 Euro Ausgabetag: 15. Mai 2008 Lieferung: Die Lieferung der verkauften Zertifikate erfolgt gemäß den anwendbaren örtlichen Marktusancen über Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt am Main, Neue Börsenstraße 1, 60487 Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland (das "Clearingsystem"). Emissionswährung: Euro 15 Zusammenfassung der wesentlichen Merkmale in Bezug auf die ausgegebenen Zertifikate Laufzeit der Zertifikate Die Laufzeit der Zertifikate beginnt mit ihrer Ausgabe am 15. Mai 2008 und endet, vorbehaltlich der Kündigung der Zertifikate durch die Emittentin in Übereinstimmung mit den Zertifikatsbedingungen, am 15. Februar 2023. Zertifikatsrecht Die Morgan Stanley B.V. als Emittentin gewährt hiermit dem Inhaber von je einem Zertifikat bezogen auf die Fonds-Komponenten der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. das Recht, vorbehaltlich eines Vorzeitigen Verkaufs durch den Zertifikatsinhaber bzw. einer Kündigung durch die Emittentin, nach Maßgabe dieser Zertifikatsbedingungen am Fälligkeitstag den Rückzahlungsbetrag, bzw. am Vorzeitigen Rückzahlungstag den Vorzeitigen Verkaufspreis zu beziehen. Rückzahlungsbetrag Der am Fälligkeitstag durch die Emittentin zu zahlende Rückzahlungsbetrag pro Zertifikat (der "Rückzahlungsbetrag") entspricht dem höheren Betrag von: (i) Nennwert * 120% und (ii) Nennwert * (120%+Partizipation * NAV(Ende) / NAV(Anfang)) Wobei: "Barwert der Nullkuponanleihe" der in Prozent ausgedrückte Marktwert einer synthetischen Nullkuponanleihe rückzahlbar zu 120% des Nennwerts am Fälligkeitstag und zu jedem Bankgeschäftstag bewertet. Dieser Marktwert wird von der Berechnungsstelle auf der Basis der EUR-Zinskurve unter Zugrundelegung eines Zinssatzes von 1‑Monats EURIBOR plus 0,22% festgesetzt. "NAV(Ende)" dem Nettoinventarwert Bewertungstag entspricht. der 16 Fonds-Komponente am Letzten "NAV(Anfang)" 1 Euro entspricht. "Nennwert" 1.000 Euro entspricht. "Nettoinventarwert" ("NAV") der Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente ist, wie er durch Man Valuations Ltd. (die "Bewertungsstelle") ermittelt und durch Man Investments bekannt gegeben wird. "Partizipation" voraussichtlich 43%* beträgt (*indikativ, die Partizipation wird am Festlegungstag auf Basis der Differenz aus 100% und dem Barwert der Nullkuponanleihe von der Berechnungsstelle festgelegt). Weitere Definitionen "Festlegungstag" ist der 13. Mai 2008. "Bankgeschäftstag" ist jeder Tag (außer Samstag und Sonntag) an dem die Banken in Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland, Amsterdam, Niederlande und in London, Großbritannien, für den Geschäftsverkehr geöffnet sind, das Trans-European Automated Real-time Gross settlement Express Transfer System ("TARGETSystem") geöffnet ist und das Clearingsytem (§ 3) Wertpapiergeschäfte abwickelt. "Letzter Bewertungstag" ist der 31. Dezember 2022. Vorzeitiger Verkauf Jeder Zertifikatsinhaber ist, vorbehaltlich der Zertifikatsbestimmungen, berechtigt, die von ihm gehaltenen Zertifikate insgesamt oder teilweise der Emittentin durch schriftliche Mitteilung gegenüber der Zahlstelle und unter Einhaltung einer Mitteilungsfrist von mindestens fünfundzwanzig (25) Kalendertagen vor dem letzten Geschäftstag eines Kalenderquartals (jeweils ein "Vorzeitiger Verkaufstag") über die Morgan Stanley Bank AG, Frankfurt am Main, Junghofstrasse 13-15, 60311 Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland, zum Ankauf anzudienen. Der erste Vorzeitige Verkaufstag ist der 31. Dezember 2009 und der letzte Vorzeitige Verkaufstag ist der 30. September 2022. Im Fall des Vorzeitigen Verkaufs erhält der Zertifikatsinhaber am jeweiligen Vorzeitigen Rückzahlungstag den Vorzeitigen Verkaufspreis ("Vorzeitiger Verkaufspreis"). Dieser entspricht dem höheren Betrag der beiden folgenden Beträge: 17 (i) Vorzeitiger Mindestverkaufspreis und (ii) einem Betrag, der sich nach folgender Formel bestimmt: [Nennwert*(Nullkuponanleihe(i) + Part*NAV(i)/NAV(Anfang))]*(100%-Gebühr) Wobei: "Nullkuponanleihe(i)" der in Prozent ausgedrückte Marktwert einer synthetischen Nullkuponanleihe rückzahlbar zu 120% des Nennwerts am Fälligkeitstag und zu jedem Bankgeschäftstag bewertet. Dieser Marktwert wird von der Berechnungsstelle auf der Basis der EUR-Zins-kurve unter Zugrundelegung eines Zinssatzes von 1‑Monats EURIBOR plus 0,30% festgesetzt, "Part" die Partizipation bezeichnet, "NAV(i)" dem Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente am jeweiligen Vorzeitigen Verkaufstag entspricht, und "Gebühr" die Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr bezeichnet. Die Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr ("Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr") entspricht im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Zeitraum folgenden Prozentsätzen: Zeitraum Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr 31. Dezember 2009 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2010 (einschließlich) 4% 30. September 2010 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2012 (einschließlich) 3% 30. September 2012 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2014 (einschließlich) 1% Bei einem Vorzeitigen Verkauf nach dem 30. Juni 2014 wird keine Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr erhoben. 18 "Vorzeitiger Rückzahlungstag" im Fall des Vorzeitigen Verkaufs durch den Zertifikatsinhaber gemäß § 9, spätestens den sechsunddreissigsten (36.) Geschäftstag, der auf den jeweils maßgeblichen Vorzeitigen Verkaufstag folgt, bezeichnet. "Vorzeitiger Mindestverkaufspreis" im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Zeitraum folgenden Beträgen entspricht: Zeitraum Vorzeitiger Mindestverkaufspreis Ausgabetag (einschließlich) bis zum 29. Juni 2019 (einschließlich) 30. Juni 2019 (einschließlich) bis zum 29. Juni 2021 (einschließlich) 30. Juni 2021 (einschließlich) bis zum 14. Februar 2023 (einschließlich) 0 Nennwert Nennwert * 110% Kündigung Bei Vorliegen eines der in den Zertifikatsbestimmungen beispielhaft beschriebenen Kündigungsereignisse ist die Emittentin berechtigt, aber nicht verpflichtet, die Zertifikate durch Bekanntmachung unter Angabe eines Kündigungsereignisses zu kündigen. Im Fall der Kündigung zahlt die Emittentin am Rückzahlungstag bei Kündigung an jeden Zertifikatsinhaber bezüglich jedes von ihm gehaltenen Zertifikats einen Geldbetrag, der von der Emittentin gemäß § 315 BGB nach billigem Ermessen und unter Berücksichtigung der im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Kündigungstag maßgeblichen Kündigungsgebühr sowie gegebenenfalls unter Berücksichtigung des dann maßgeblichen Nettoinventarwerts der Fonds-Komponente und der durch die Kündigung bei der Emittentin angefallenen Kosten, als angemessener Marktpreis eines Zertifikats bei Kündigung festgelegt wird. Der "Rückzahlungstag bei Kündigung" ist spätestens der sechsunddreissigste (36.) Geschäftstag, der unmittelbar auf den Kündigungstag folgt. Die "Kündigungsgebühr" im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Zeitraum entspricht folgenden Prozentsätzen: 19 Zeitraum Kündigungsgebühr 31. Dezember 2009 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2010 (einschließlich) 4 % des Nennwerts 1. Juli 2010 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2012 (einschließlich) 3 % des Nennwerts 1. Juli 2012 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2014 (einschließlich) 1 % des Nennwerts Bei Kündigung nach dem 30. Juni 2014 wird keine Kündigungsgebühr erhoben. Status; Garantie Die Zertifikate begründen unbesicherte und nicht nachrangige Verbindlichkeiten der Emittentin, die untereinander und mit allen gegenwärtigen und zukünftigen unbesicherten und nicht nachrangigen Verbindlichkeiten der Emittentin, abgesehen von solchen Verbindlichkeiten, denen auf Grund zwingender gesetzlicher Bestimmungen der Vorrang zukommt, gleichrangig sind. Morgan Stanley als Garantin hat eine unbedingte und unwiderrufliche Garantie (die "Garantie") für die vertragsgemäße Zahlung auf die Zertifikate zahlbarer Beträge übernommen. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbar gegen die Garantin bestehende und durchsetzbare Ansprüche der Zertifikatsinhaber. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbare, unbedingte, nichtnachrangige und unbesicherte Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, die jederzeit zumindest gleichrangig sind mit allen sonstigen gegenwärtigen und zukünftigen unmittelbaren, unbedingten, nicht-nachrangigen und unbesicherten Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, mit Ausnahme solcher Verbindlichkeiten, die kraft zwingender gesetzlicher Bestimmungen vorrangig sind. Zahlstelle Zahlstelle ist die Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft, Große Gallusstrasse 10-14, 60272 Frankfurt am Main, Deutschland. 20 Wertpapierkennummer / ISIN der Zertifikate WKN: MS5DHK ISIN: DE000MS5DHK0 Verwendung der Emissionserlöse Die Erlöse aus der Ausgabe der Zertifikate (ohne Agio) in Höhe von bis zu 75.000.000 Euro werden ausschließlich für die Erfüllung der Zahlungsverpflichtungen der Emittentin und zu Zwecken der üblichen Geschäftstätigkeit der Emittentin verwendet. Die Fonds-Komponente Die Fonds-Komponente ist nicht zum öffentlichen Vertrieb in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland zugelassen. Die in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Angaben zur Fonds-Komponente dienen allein der Information von Anlegern, die Zertifikate erwerben wollen und stellen kein Angebot von Anteilen der Fonds-Komponente dar. Die hier enthaltenen Informationen in Bezug auf die Fonds-Komponente bestehen lediglich aus Auszügen oder Zusammenfassungen von Informationen über die FondsKomponente. Die Emittentin und die Garantin übernehmen die Verantwortung, dass die Informationen richtig wiedergegeben bzw. zusammengefasst wurden. Soweit es der Emittentin und der Garantin bekannt ist und soweit sie dies aus den veröffentlichten Informationen ableiten kann, wurden keine Tatsachen ausgelassen, die dazu führen würden, dass die wiedergegebenen Informationen falsch oder irreführend würden. Neben diesen Zusicherungen wird keine weitergehende oder sonstige Gewähr von der Emittentin bzw. von der Garantin für die Informationen übernommen. Insbesondere übernehmen die Emittentin und die Garantin keine Verantwortung für die Vollständigkeit und Richtigkeit der dieser Darstellung zugrundeliegenden Angaben oder dafür, dass kein Umstand eingetreten ist, der deren Richtigkeit und Vollständigkeit beeinträchtigen könnte. Fonds-Komponente: Die Fonds-Komponente ist jeweils eine stimmrechtslose rückzahlbare gewinnbeteiligte Aktie der Aktienklasse T2 der Gesellschaft. Die Gesellschaft ist eine steuerbefreite Gesellschaft (exempted company) mit beschränkter Haftung in Bermuda und ist amtlich eingetragen als eine Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten (segregated accounts company) gemäß dem Segregated Accounts Companies Act 2000 of Bermuda und als ein offener Publikumsfonds gemäß dem Companies Act 1981 of Bermuda. Die Gesellschaft ist als ein Bermuda standard scheme eingestuft worden. Als solcher 21 unterliegt die Gesellschaft der Aufsicht und den Vorschriften nach Maßgabe der Bermuda Monetary Authority (Collective Investment Scheme Classification) Regulations 1998. Die Gesellschaft kann Aktien ausgeben und zurückkaufen zu Preisen auf der Grundlage des Nettoinventarwerts je Aktie. Investmentziel und Investmentstrategie: Das Investmentziel der Gesellschaft in Bezug auf die Aktienklasse besteht darin, eher Kursgewinne als Zinsen zu erwirtschaften. Die Fonds-Komponenten sind so gestaltet, dass sie auf wesentliches mittelfristiges Wachstum abzielen und Diversifikationsvorteile innerhalb eines traditionellen Aktienund Anleihenportfolios bieten, indem die in Verbindung mit den Fonds-Komponenten vereinnahmten Erträge in das AHL Institutional Programme und das MGS Style Portfolio ("Anlagestrategien") investiert werden. Die Investitionen in die Anlagestrategien unterliegen vollständig dem Ermessen des Investment Managers, und dieser kann jederzeit auch andere Anlagestrategien hinzufügen. Investment Manager: Man Investments Ltd., Großbritannien Bewertungsstelle: Man Valuations Ltd., Großbritannien 22 RISIKOFAKTOREN DER ZERTIFIKATE Potenzielle Käufer der Zertifikate sollten die nachstehenden Risikoinformationen in Verbindung mit sonstigen in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Informationen sorgfältig prüfen, bevor sie sich zu einem Kauf der Zertifikate entschließen. Die im Folgenden dargestellten Risikofaktoren können sich negativ auf die Wertentwicklung der Zertifikate auswirken. Dabei können mehrere Risikofaktoren die Wertentwicklung der Zertifikate gleichzeitig beeinflussen, ohne dass über deren Zusammenwirken eine verbindliche Aussage getroffen werden könnte. Darüber hinaus können sich weitere, zum jetzigen Zeitpunkt unbekannte oder unvorhersehbare Risiken ebenfalls negativ auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Anleger müssen Risikofaktoren in Bezug auf die Emittentin, die Garantin, die Zertifikate, die den Zertifikaten zugrundeliegende Fonds-Komponente und sonstige Risiken beachten. Die in diesem Prospekt genannten Risiken der Zertifikate stellen die wesentlichen mit den Zertifikaten verbundenen Risiken dar. Jeder potenzielle Käufer von Zertifikaten sollte sorgfältig prüfen, ob vor dem Hintergrund seiner Finanzlage sowie der in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Angaben eine Anlage in die Zertifikate geeignet erscheint. Potenzielle Käufer von Zertifikaten sollten mit ihren Rechts- und Steuerberatern, Wirtschaftsprüfern und sonstigen Beratern klären, ob eine Anlage in Zertifikaten unter Berücksichtigung ihrer individuellen Verhältnisse geeignet ist. Mehrere Risikofaktoren können im Hinblick auf die Zertifikate gleichzeitig auftreten, so dass die Auswirkungen des Eintritts eines bestimmten Risikos unvorhersehbar sind. Darüber hinaus kann mehr als ein Risikofaktor einen möglicherweise unvorhersehbaren, verstärkenden Effekt ausüben. Es kann keine Garantie dahingehend abgegeben werden, wie sich der Eintritt einer Kombination von Risikofaktoren auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirkt. Mit der Emittentin verbundene Risiken Keine Ansprüche gegen Gesellschafter, Geschäftsführer oder Angestellte der Emittentin Die Zertifikate begründen keine Ansprüche der Zertifikatsinhaber gegen Gesellschafter, Geschäftsführer oder Angestellte der Morgan Stanley B.V. ("Gesellschafter, Geschäftsführer oder Angestellte der Morgan Stanley B.V." oder die "Emittentin"). 23 Verlustrisiko der Inhaber von Wertpapieren, die MSBV ausgegeben hat Alle wesentlichen Aktiva der MSBV stellen Verpflichtungen von (oder Wertpapiere ausgegeben von) einer oder mehreren Gesellschaften der Morgan Stanley Gruppe dar. Die Verpflichtungen von MSBV aus solchen Transaktionen sind von Morgan Stanley garantiert. Entstehen einer dieser Gesellschaften der Morgan Stanley Gruppe Verluste im Zusammenhang mit ihren Aktivitäten (unabhängig davon, ob sich diese Aktivitäten auf MSBV beziehen oder nicht), so könnten diese nur noch eingeschränkt in der Lage sein, ihre Verpflichtungen gegenüber MSBV zu erfüllen, und die Inhaber von Wertpapieren, die MSBV ausgegeben hat, wären einem Verlustrisiko ausgesetzt. Mit der Garantin verbundene Risiken Liquiditätsrisiko Das Liquiditäts- und Finanzierungsrisiko betrifft das Risiko, das Morgan Stanley nicht mehr in der Lage ist, seine Geschäftstätigkeit zu finanzieren, wenn der Zugang zu den Kapitalmärkten nicht mehr möglich ist oder Schwierigkeiten bei der Liquidierung der Vermögenswerte bestehen. Zum Liquiditätsund Finanzierungsrisiko gehört auch, dass Morgan Stanley in der Lage ist, seine finanziellen Verpflichtungen zu erfüllen, ohne dass hiermit eine erhebliche Störung des Geschäftsbetriebs oder eine Rufschädigung einhergeht, durch die Gefahr für die Lebensfähigkeit des Unternehmens im laufenden Betrieb droht. Für das Geschäft von Morgan Stanley ist Liquidität ein herausragendes Merkmal, und Morgan Stanley hängt bei der Finanzierung eines erheblichen Teils seiner Geschäftstätigkeit von externen Quellen ab. Liquidität ist von überragender Bedeutung für die Aktivitäten von Morgan Stanley. Die Liquidität von Morgan Stanley könnte in erheblichem Maße eingeschränkt werden, wenn das Unternehmen nicht mehr in der Lage ist, sich an den Anleihemärkten im langen oder kurzen Laufzeitenbereich zu refinanzieren, oder keinen Zugang mehr zu Kreditsicherungsmärkten hat. Hierbei könnten Faktoren, auf die Morgan Stanley keinen Einfluss hat – wie eine Störung an den Finanzmärkten oder negative Einschätzungen der Finanzdienstleistungsbranche insgesamt – die Refinanzierungsmöglichkeiten einschränken. Zudem könnten sich die Möglichkeiten für Refinanzierungen seitens Morgan Stanley verschlechtern, wenn Kreditgeber die lang- oder kurzfristigen finanziellen Aussichten des Unternehmens negativ beurteilen. Solche negativen Erwartungen könnten entstehen, wenn Morgan Stanley Handelsverluste ausweist, im Rating herabgestuft wird oder von den Ratingagenturen auf eine entsprechenden "negative Watchliste" gesetzt wird, das Niveau der Geschäftstätigkeit zurückgeht, Aufsichtsbehörden wesentliche Maßnahmen gegen das Unternehmen einleiten oder erhebliches Fehlverhalten der Mitarbeiter oder illegale Aktivitäten aufgedeckt werden, usw. Wenn sich Morgan Stanley nicht mit den oben beschriebenen Maßnahmen refinanzieren kann, muss das Unternehmen aller Wahrscheinlichkeit nach unbelastete Vermögenswerte, wie beispielsweise ihre 24 Anlage- und Handelsportfolios liquidieren, um Verbindlichkeiten bei Fälligkeit zu begleichen. Morgan Stanley ist möglicherweise nicht in der Lage, einen Teil seiner Vermögenswerte zu verkaufen, oder muss diese mit einem Abschlag vom Marktwert verkaufen. Beides könnte sich negativ auf das operative Ergebnis auswirken. Die Kreditkosten von Morgan Stanley und der Zugang zu den Anleihemärkten hängen in hohem Maße vom Rating ab. Die Kosten und Verfügbarkeit unbesicherter Finanzierungsmittel hängen grundsätzlich von den kurz- und langfristigen Ratings für Morgan Stanley ab. Bei der Festlegung der Ratings oder im Zusammenhang mit der Fähigkeit, kurz- oder langfristige Finanzmittel zu erhalten, spielen unter anderem die folgenden Faktoren eine wesentliche Rolle: Höhe und Volatilität der Erträge, relative Wettbewerbsposition von Morgan Stanley in den Märkten, in denen das Unternehmen aktiv ist, Diversifikation über Regionen und Produkte, die Fähigkeit, wichtige Mitarbeiter zu halten, das Risikoprofil des Unternehmens, die Risikomanagementpolitik, die Liquidität an Bargeld, angemessene Kapitalausstattung, das Kreditrisiko für seine Unternehmensanleihen sowie rechtliche und aufsichtsrechtliche Entwicklungen. Eine Verschlechterung bei einem einzelnen oder einer Kombination dieser Faktoren kann dazu führen, dass die Ratingagenturen die Kreditratings von Morgan Stanley herabstufen und somit die Kosten des Unternehmens für unbesicherte Finanzierungsmittel erhöhen. Die Anleihe-Ratings von Morgan Stanley können sich ferner erheblich auf bestimmte Handelserträge auswirken, dies gilt insbesondere in den Geschäftsbereichen, in denen eine längerfristige Kontrahentenperformance wichtig ist, wie beispielsweise bei OTCDerivatetransaktionen, einschließlich Kreditderviaten und Zinsswaps. Im Zusammenhang mit bestimmten OTC-Handelsvereinbarungen und bestimmten anderen Vereinbarungen, die mit dem Bereich Institutional Securities verbunden sind, müsste Morgan Stanley bestimmten Kontrahenten im Falle einer Herabstufung durch Moody's Investors Service oder Standard & Poor's zusätzliche Sicherheiten zur Verfügung stellen. Morgan Stanley ist als Holdinggesellschaft von Zahlungen der Tochtergesellschaften abhängig. Im Rahmen der Finanzierung von Dividendenzahlungen und aller Zahlungen im Rahmen von Verpflichtungen, einschließlich der Verpflichtungen aus Schuldverschreibungen, ist Morgan Stanley abhängig von Dividenden, Ausschüttungen und sonstigen Zahlungen der Tochtergesellschaften. Aufsichtsrechtliche und sonstige rechtliche Beschränkungen können das Unternehmen in seiner Fähigkeit einschränken, Mittel frei an die oder von den Tochtergesellschaften zu übertragen. Insbesondere unterliegen zahlreiche Tochtergesellschaften, einschließlich der Tochtergesellschaften, die Broker-Dealer 25 sind, Gesetzen und Vorschriften, nach denen Aufsichtsbehörden befugt sind, Mittelflüsse an die Muttergesellschaften zu blockieren oder einzuschränken oder nach denen solche Übertragungen unter bestimmten Umständen insgesamt untersagt sind. Diese Gesetze und Vorschriften können Morgan Stanley darin behindern, auf Mittel zuzugreifen, die sie für Zahlungen im Zusammenhang mit ihren Verpflichtungen benötigten könnte. Wenn Morgan Stanley keine angemessene Liquiditäts- und Finanzierungspolitik betreibt, kann das Unternehmen möglicherweise nicht auf ausreichende Finanzierungsmittel zurückgreifen. Die Liquiditäts- und Finanzierungspolitik von Morgan Stanley wurde so konzipiert, dass hierüber ausreichend liquide Finanzmittel bereitgestellt werden, so dass auch in einem angespannten Liquiditätsumfeld die Fortführung der Geschäfte für einen ausgedehnten Zeitraum gewährleistet ist. Wenn Morgan Stanley keine angemessene Liquiditäts- und Finanzierungspolitik hat oder befolgt, ist Morgan Stanley möglicherweise nicht in der Lage, auf ausreichende Finanzmittel für die Bedienung ihrer finanziellen Verpflichtungen bei Fälligkeit zuzugreifen; dies könnte sich erheblich nachteilig auf das Geschäft oder die Aktivitäten auswirken. Marktrisiko Unter dem Marktrisiko ist die Gefahr zu verstehen, dass eine Änderung eines oder mehrerer Rohstoff- oder Wertpapierpreise am Markt, der Zinssätze, Indizes, impliziten Volatilitäten (Preisschwankungen des Basisinstruments, die von den Optionskursen herrühren), Korrelationen oder anderer Marktfaktoren wie die Liquidität einer Position oder eines Portfolios Verluste mit sich bringt. Das operative Ergebnis von Morgan Stanley wird möglicherweise in wesentlichem Maße von Marktschwankungen, konjunkturellen Faktoren und anderen Ereignissen beeinflusst. Die Höhe, die Investitionsdauer und das Spektrum von Morgan Stanleys Engagements mit Marktrisiko haben sich in den vergangenen Jahren erhöht, und dieser Trend kann sich fortsetzen. Das operative Ergebnis von Morgan Stanley wird möglicherweise in wesentlichem Maße von Marktschwankungen infolge konjunktureller und anderer Faktoren beeinflusst. Das operative Ergebnis wurde in der Vergangenheit – und wird möglicherweise auch in Zukunft – in wesentlichem Maße beeinflusst von zahlreichen Faktoren globalen Charakters, wie beispielsweise dem politischen Umfeld, der Konjunktur- und Marktsituation, der Verfügbarkeit und den Kosten von Kapital, der Liquidität des globalen Marktes, dem Kurs- und Volatilitätsniveau an den Aktienmärkten, den Rohstoffpreisen und Zinssätzen, den 26 Wechselkursen und anderen Marktindizes, technologischen Veränderungen und Ereignissen, der Verfügbarkeit und den Kosten von Fremdkapital, der Inflation, Naturkatastrophen, Terroranschlägen sowie der Verbraucherstimmung und dem Vertrauen in die Finanzmärkte. Zudem können Entwicklungen in der Gesetzgebung, der Rechtsprechung und dem aufsichtsrechtlichen Umfeld im Zusammenhang mit den Aktivitäten von Morgan Stanley die Kosten erhöhen und sich damit auf das künftige operative Ergebnis auswirken. Diese Faktoren können sich auch darauf auswirken, ob Morgan Stanley seine strategischen Ziele erreichen kann. Das Ergebnis des Bereichs Institutional Securities von Morgan Stanley, und hier insbesondere das Ergebnis im Zusammenhang mit Engagements an Primär- und Sekundärmärkten in alle Arten von Finanzprodukten ist aus mehreren Gründen, einschließlich der oben genannten, starken Schwankungen ausgesetzt, die Morgan Stanley nicht mit hoher Sicherheit beeinflussen oder vorhersagen kann. Diese Fluktuationen wirken sich auf Ergebnis aus, indem sie zu Abweichungen bei der Generierung von Neugeschäft und beim Fair Value von Wertpapieren und anderen Finanzprodukten führen. Schwankungen treten auch aufgrund des Niveaus der globalen Marktaktivitäten auf, und wirken sich unter anderem aus auf die Größe, die Zahl und das zeitliche Aufkommen von Investment-Banking-Mandaten und -Transaktionen sowie auf die Realisierung von Erträgen in Morgan Stanleys Eigenhandel. In Zeiten einer ungünstigen Markt- oder Konjunkturlage beteiligen sich zudem möglicherweise einzelne Anleger weniger stark an den globalen Märkten, was sich wiederum negativ auf das Ergebnis des Bereichs Global Wealth Management Group auswirken würde. Morgan Stanley könnte weitere Abschreibungen seiner Finanzinstrumente und Verluste wegen volatiler und illiquider Marktverhältnisse vornehmen müssen. Morgan Stanley musste im vierten Quartal des Geschäftsjahres 2007 Abschreibungen in Höhe von USD 9,4 Milliarden, inklusive USD 7,8 Millarden aufgrund ihrer U.S. Subprime Handelspositionen und USD 1,6 Milliarden aufgrund anderer Hypothekengeschäfte vornehmen. Diese Geschäfte beinhalten etwa Commercial Mortgage Backed Securities, Alt-A und andere Darlehen, notleidende Kredite (Non Performing Loans) und europäische Non-Conforming Loans und eine Ausgleichszahlung für Hypothekenportfolios heimischer Tochtergesellschaften. Morgan Stanley ist weiterhin in diesen Märkten und Produkten aktiv und, soweit die Marktbedingungen voranschreiten, könnte der Wert hypothekenbezogener Instrumente weiter sinken. Daneben erschwert die hohe Volatilität der aktuellen Marktbedingungen eine Bewertung einzelner Wertpapiere von Morgan Stanley. Spätere Bewertungen unter Berücksichtigung dieser Faktoren können zu einer signifikanten Änderung der Bewertung einzelner Wertpapiere in der Zukunft führen. Daneben hängt der am Verkaufstag von Morgan Stanley erzielbare Preis von Wertpapieren von der Nachfrage und der Liquidität am Markt ab, welcher durchaus erheblich niedriger als der gegenwärtige eigentliche Preis sein kann. Sämtliche dieser Faktoren können dazu führen, dass Morgan Stanley weitere Abschreibungen in Bezug auf den Wert ihres Wertpapierportfolios vornehmen muss und dies einen negativen Einfluss auf das Ergebnis in der Zukunft haben kann. Das Ergebnis des 27 Geschäftsjahres 2007 beinhaltete weitere Verluste, die vor allem auf die Illiquidität des Marktes in der zweiten Hälfte des Geschäftsjahres 2007 zurückzuführen sind. Diese Verluste spiegelten die Marktbewertungen bezüglich Darlehen und Darlehnsengagements im Zusammenhang mit der Akquisitionsfinanzierung von Nicht-Banken wieder. Morgan Stanleys Leveraged Finance-Geschäft beinhaltet die Konsortialführerschaft und den Weitervertrieb von Darlehen und Verpflichtungen und zielt darauf ab, die gegenwärtigen Positionen weiter zu veräußern. Dennoch könnte dies wegen der Liquidität des Marktes länger als in der Vergangenheit dauern und zu weiteren Abschreibungen solcher Darlehen und Verpflichtungen führen. Die Bewertung dieser Verpflichtungen könnte sich in der Zukunft ändern, was unter anderem davon abhängt, ob neue Absprachen auch bezüglich des Preises getroffen werden und ob die zugrundeliegende Transaktion stattfindet. Andere Geschäftsbereiche von Morgan Stanley, die bis heute nicht von der Illiquidität des Hypotheken- und Kreditgeschäfts betroffen waren, können im Falle einer Ausweitung der gegenwärtigen Bedingungen auf andere Bereiche negativ beeinflusst werden. Das Halten großer und stark konzentrierter Positionen könnte Verluste für Morgan Stanley bringen. Mit einer Risikokonzentration könnten geringere Erträge oder Verluste in den Bereichen Market Making, Eigenhandel, Anlage, Block-Trading, Underwriting und Kreditvergabe verbunden sein, wenn sich der Markt unvorteilhaft entwickelt. Morgan Stanley hat in diesen Bereichen hohe Kapitalbeträge gebunden und ist dadurch häufig gezwungen, große Positionen von Wertpapieren eines bestimmten Emittenten oder bestimmter Emittenten in einer bestimmten Branche, einem bestimmten Land oder einer bestimmten Region zu übernehmen oder Kredite an diese auszureichen. Zudem geht die Tendenz in allen wichtigen Kapitalmärkten hin zu größeren und häufigeren Kapitalzusagen im Rahmen vieler solcher Aktivitäten, und Morgan Stanley rechnet mit einer Fortsetzung dieses Trends. Die Märkte können zeitweise hochvolatil sein und zusätzlich eine beschränkte Liquitität aufweisen. Die Finanzmärkte sind anfällig für schwerwiegende Ereignisse, die zu einer Abwertung von Vermögensgegenständen führen können, und von einer Abnahme der Liquidität begleitet werden, wie etwa der Preisverfall im U.S. Hypothekenmarkt für Subprime Baufinanzierungen. Unter diesen extremen Bedingungen könnten Absicherungsgeschäfte und andere Strategien zur Vermeidung von Risiken weniger wirksam sein, Verluste aus dem Handel auszugleichen, als unter normalen Bedingungen. Vielmehr sind unter diesen Bedingungen die Marktteilnehmer den Handelstrategien ausgesetzt, die viele Teilnehmer zur selben Zeit ausführen, wie etwa Massenverkäufe. Morgan Stanleys Risikomanagement und andere 28 Kontrollmechanismen versuchen das Risiko zu quantifizieren und die Verluste aufgrund extremer Martbewegungen zu verringern. Solche schwerwiegenden Ereignisse waren in der Vergangenheit schwer vorauszusehen, auch Morgan Stanley könnte erhebliche Verluste aufgrund unvorhergesehener extremer Marktbedingungen, wie auf dem aktuellen U.S. Hypothekenmarkt für Subprime Baufinanzierungen, erleiden. Die Profitabilität bestimmter Rohstoff-Marketing-Aktiväten von Morgan Stanley hängt von der Angebotslage bei Erdölprodukten ab. Ein deutlicher Rückgang des Angebots aus egal welchem Grund kann sich erheblich nachteilig auf Umsatz und operatives Ergebnis bestimmter Geschäftssparten des Rohstoffbereichs auswirken. Morgan Stanleys Erfolg bei Vermarktung und Absatz im Rohstoffgeschäft hängt von der Fähigkeit ab, positive Margen mit dem Verkauf von veredelten Erdölprodukten zu erzielen. Zudem ist das Terminal-, Schlepp- und Lastfrachtgeschäft von Morgan Stanley darauf angewiesen, dass ein aktiver Markt für veredelte Erdölprodukte eine ausreichende Nachfrage nach Terminal-Dienstleistungen gewährleistet. Ein angemessenes Angebot an veredelten Erdölprodukten ist für Morgan Stanleys Pipeline-, Transport- und Terminalgeschäft von wesentlicher Bedeutung. Eine erhebliche Störung auf der Angebotsseite bei veredelten Erdölprodukten könnte die Erlöse aus Geschäften am Kassamarkt (rack spot) und beim Handel auf Basis längerfristiger Lieferverträge (contract sales) sowie die Einnahmen aus Durchsatzund Lagergebühren beeinträchtigen. Zu solchen Risiken gehören Umstände "höherer Gewalt", die durch Naturkatastrophen, Unwetter, Terroranschläge und andere Ereignisse hervorgerufen werden, die sich dem Einfluss von Morgan Stanley entziehen. Derartige Umstände können sich ebenfalls negativ auswirken auf das Pipeline- und Schifffahrtsgeschäft sowie das Transport- und Terminalgeschäft, das von den mit Rohstoffen befassten Geschäftssparten von Morgan Stanley betrieben wird. Morgan Stanley könnten erhebliche Verluste im Immobiliensektor entstehen. Morgan Stanley finanziert und erwirbt eigene Positionen in unterschiedlichen Immobilien und immobiliennahen Produkten auf eigene Rechnung, für Investmentvehikel, die von verbundenen Unternehmen verwaltet werden, an denen Morgan Stanley ebenfalls eine erhebliche Beteiligung halten könnte sowie für separat verwaltete Konten, die von verbundenen Unternehmen für wichtige Teilnehmer der Gewerbe- und Wohnbauimmobilienmärkte verwaltet werden, und reicht Kredite aus, die durch Gewerbe- und Wohnbauimmobilien gesichert sind. Ferner ist Morgan Stanley im Verbriefungsgeschäft und Handel mit einem weiten Spektrum von Gewerbe- und Wohnbauimmobilien sowie immobilienbezogenen Finanzforderungen (so genannte Whole Loans), Hypotheken und anderen Vermögenswerten und Produkten in Form von Immobilien und gewerblichen Aktiva, einschließlich durch Wohnbau- und Gewerbeimmobilienhypotheken gesicherter Wertpapiere, aktiv. Von 29 einem Konjunkturabschwung des Immobiliensektors können diese Aktivitäten negativ beeinflusst werden. Kreditrisiko Mit Kreditrisiko wird das Verlustrisiko im Zusammenhang mit dem Ausfall eines Kreditnehmers, eines Kontrahenten oder anderen Schuldners bezeichnet, wenn dieser nicht in der Lage oder nicht Willens ist, seine Verpflichtungen gegenüber Morgan Stanley zu erfüllen. Morgan Stanley ist drei unterschiedlichen Arten von Kreditrisiken in seinem Geschäft ausgesetzt. Morgan Stanley trägt das Risiko, dass Dritte, die Schulden gegenüber Morgan Stanley haben, ihren Verpflichtungen nicht nachkommen. Morgan Stanley entsteht durch den Bereich Institutional Securities ein bedeutendes Kreditrisiko gegenüber einzelnen Adressen. Dieses Risiko kann sich beispielsweise durch Abschluss von Swap- oder anderen Derivateverträgen ergeben, nach denen sich Kontrahenten langfristig zu Zahlungen an Morgan Stanley verpflichten, oder daraus, dass Morgan Stanley über unterschiedliche Kreditarrangements Kredite an ihre Kunden ausreicht. Durch die Ausreichung von jeweils grundsätzlich mit Sicherheiten unterlegten Effekten-Krediten an einzelne Anleger und kleine Unternehmen ist Morgan Stanley im Bereich Global Wealth Managment Group Kreditrisiken "einzelner Verbraucher" ausgesetzt. Die Höhe, die Investitionsdauer und das Spektrum von Morgan Stanleys Kreditengagements haben sich in den vergangenen Jahren erhöht, und dieser Trend kann sich fortsetzen. In den letzten Jahren hat Morgan Stanley den Einsatz von Swaps und anderen Derivaten erheblich ausgeweitet und kann auch künftig weiter so verfahren. Unternehmenskunden fragen im Zusammenhang mit dem Investment Banking und anderen Mandaten verstärkt Darlehen oder Kreditzusagen von Morgan Stanley nach. Zudem ist Morgan Stanley aus Gründen des Wettbewerbs verstärkt dem Druck ausgesetzt, längerfristige Kreditrisiken zu übernehmen, Gegenparteien und Kreditnehmern mit geringerer Bonität Swaps und Kreditverpflichtungen zu gewähren, Kredite gegen weniger liquide Sicherheiten auszureichen und Derivate aggressiver auf Basis der übernommen Kreditrisiken zu bewerten. Als Clearing Member finanziert Morgan Stanley Kundenpositionen und kann für den Ausfall oder das Fehlverhalten der Kunden verantwortlich gemacht werden. Zwar prüft Morgan Stanley die Kreditrisiken regelmäßig. Das Ausfallrisiko kann jedoch auf Ereignissen oder Umständen basieren, die schwer zu ergründen oder vorherzusehen sind. 30 Der Ausfall eines anderen größeren Finanzinstituts könnte die Finanzmärkte insgesamt belasten. Die wirtschaftliche Stabilität vieler Finanzinstitute kann wegen der Kredit-, Handels-, Clearing- oder sonstiger Verhältnisse zwischen den Instituten eng verzahnt sein. Daher könnten Bedenken hinsichtlich eines Instituts, oder der Ausfall oder drohende Ausfall eines Instituts erhebliche Liquiditätsprobleme im gesamten Markt, Verlust oder Ausfälle anderer Institute nach sich ziehen. Dies wird gelegentlich als "systemisches Risiko" bezeichnet und kann Finanzintermediäre, wie ClearingAgenten, Clearing-Häuser, Banken, Wertpapierhandelsgesellschaften und Börsen, mit denen Morgan Stanley täglich zu tun hat, beeinträchtigen, und somit auch Morgan Stanley belasten. Operatives Risiko Das operative Risiko bezieht sich auf das Risiko eines finanziellen oder sonstigen Verlusts oder möglicher Schäden für den Ruf eines Unternehmens, die aus unzureichenden oder fehlerhaften internen Prozessen, menschlichen Handlungen, Ressourcen und Systemen oder aus externen Ereignissen (z.B. externe oder interne Betrugshandlungen, rechtliche und Compliance-Risiken, Schäden an physischen Vermögenswerten, usw.) resultieren können. Für Morgan Stanley können operative Risiken über das gesamte Spektrum ihrer Geschäftsaktivitäten, einschließlich der ertragsgenerierenden Bereiche (z.B. Sales und Trading) und der Support-Funktionen (z.B. Informationstechnologie und Gebäudemanagement) entstehen. Somit kann Morgan Stanley in allen Bereichen sowie auch in den Kontrollgruppen operativen Risiken ausgesetzt sein. Morgan Stanley ist operativen Risiken ausgesetzt und ein operativer Zwischenfall könnte die Aktivitäten belasten. Die Aktivitäten von Morgan Stanley sind in hohem Maße davon abhängig, dass das Unternehmen täglich eine hohe Zahl von Transaktionen über zahlreiche und unterschiedliche Märkte in vielen Währungen verarbeiten kann. Insgesamt nimmt die Komplexität der verarbeiteten Transaktionen immer mehr zu. Morgan Stanley übernimmt die für den Betrieb der unterschiedlichen Aktivitäten erforderlichen Funktionen selbst oder bewirkt die Ausführung der Funktionen über Verträge mit Dritten. Morgan Stanley ist abhängig davon, dass die Mitarbeiter, die internen Systeme und die Systeme der von Dritten betriebenen Technologiezentren in der Lage sind, ein hohes Transaktionsvolumen zu verarbeiten. Morgan Stanley sieht sich ferner dem Risiko operativer Fehler oder der Beendigung der Geschäftstätigkeit von Clearing-Agenten, Börsen, Clearing-Häusern oder anderen Finanzintermediären, die sie für die Umsetzung ihrer Wertpapiertransaktionen verwendet, ausgesetzt. Im Falle 31 eines Ausfalls oder des fehlerhaften Betriebs der eigenen Systeme oder der Systeme Dritter oder im Falle des Fehlverhaltens von Dritten oder eigenen Mitarbeitern könnte Morgan Stanley einen finanziellen Verlust, eine Verschlechterung der Liquidität, eine Störung der Aktivitäten, aufsichtsrechtliche Sanktionen oder einen Schaden des Rufs erleiden. Trotz der Notfallpläne von Morgan Stanley könnte sich eine Störung der Infrastruktur, die die Aktivitäten von Morgan Stanley und die Gemeinden, in denen Morgan Stanley seinen Sitz hat, unterstützt, negativ auswirken auf die Fähigkeit, die Geschäftstätigkeit fortzusetzen. Hierzu könnte zählen: die Nichtbegehbarkeit der Geschäftsräume, Terror-Attacken, Epidemien sowie Störungen bei den von Morgan Stanley, seinen Mitarbeitern oder Dritten, mit denen Morgan Stanley Geschäfte betreibt, eingesetzten Strom- oder Kommunikationseinrichtungen oder sonstigen Diensten. Rechtliches Risiko Das rechtliche Risiko bezieht sich auf das Risiko, das geltende gesetzliche und aufsichtsrechtliche Vorschriften und Standards nicht eingehalten werden. Das rechtliche Risiko umfasst ferner vertragliche oder gewerbliche Risiken, wie das Risiko, dass die Verpflichtungen zur Leistungserfüllung seitens des Kontrahenten nicht durchsetzbar sind. Die Finanzdienstleistungsbranche steht vor erheblichen Risiken im Zusammenhang mit Rechtsstreitigkeiten und aufsichtsrechtlichen Angelegenheiten, und Morgan Stanley könnte Schaden am Ruf nehmen und gesetzliche Haftungspflichten auf sich ziehen. Morgan Stanley wurde von Zeit zu Zeit als Beklagte in verschiedenen Rechtsverfahren benannt, darunter Schiedsgerichtsverfahren, Sammelklagen (class actions) und andere Rechtstreitigkeiten, die sich aus ihrer Tätigkeit als global diversifizierter Finanzdienstleister ergeben. Manche dieser anhängigen oder drohenden Rechtsverfahren machen erhebliche ausgleichende und/oder Strafe einschließende Schadensersatzansprüche oder Ansprüche auf der Höhe nach noch unbestimmte Schadensersatzbeträge geltend. In einigen Fällen sind Emittenten, die ansonsten bei diesen Gerichtsfällen als Hauptbeklagte genannt worden wären, insolvent oder in finanzieller Bedrängnis. Von Zeit zu Zeit ist Morgan Stanley zudem Gegenstand anderer Untersuchungen, Ermittlungen und Verfahren (formell und informell), die von staatlichen Aufsichtsbehörden und selbst regulierenden Organisationen ausgehen und sich auf das Geschäft der Gesellschaft beziehen (einschließlich, u.a. Angelegenheiten im Zusammenhang mit der Rechnungslegung oder dem operativen Geschäft). Diese können nachteilige Urteilssprüche, Vergleiche, Strafen, Geldstrafen, Verfügungen oder andere Rechtsmittel nach sich ziehen. Die Anzahl dieser Ermittlungen und 32 Verfahren nahm in den letzten paar Jahren bei vielen Firmen der Finanzdienstleistungsbranche einschließlich Morgan Stanley zu. Wie jede große Kapitalgesellschaft ist auch Morgan Stanley dem Risiko eines möglichen Fehlverhaltens von Mitarbeitern, einschließlich des Verstoßes gegen die Unternehmenspolitik und der unzulässigen Verwendung oder Offenlegung von vertraulichen Informationen, ausgesetzt. Die Aktivitäten sowie die Finanz- und Ertragslage können erheblich beeinträchtigt werden durch wesentliche rechtliche Haftungspflichten oder aufsichtsrechtliche Maßnehmen gegen Morgan Stanley, und könnten eine erhebliche Rufschädigung nach sich ziehen, die das Geschäft von Morgan Stanley ernsthaft schädigen könnte. Morgan Stanley unterliegt in den Rechtsordnungen seiner Geschäftstätigkeit der umfassenden Aufsicht. Morgan Stanley unterliegt der umfassenden Aufsicht auf globaler Ebene und trägt das Risiko, dass die Aufsichtsbehörden in den Rechtsordnungen, in denen das Unternehmen aktiv ist, erhebliche Interventionsmaßnahmen ergreifen. Unter anderem könnte Morgan Stanley mit Bußgeldern belegt werden, das Engagement in einem Teil ihrer Geschäftstätigkeit könnte untersagt werden oder es könnten im Hinblick auf die Geschäftstätigkeit Beschränkungen oder Auflagen eingeführt werden. Erhebliche aufsichtsrechtliche Maßnahmen gegen Morgan Stanley könnten wesentliche nachteilige finanzielle Folgen haben oder einen erheblichen Schaden für den Ruf oder auch die Geschäftsaussichten nach sich ziehen. Neue Gesetze oder Vorschriften oder Veränderungen in der Durchsetzung bestehender Gesetze oder Vorschriften, die für die Kunden von Morgan Stanley gelten, können sich ebenso auf das Geschäft von Morgan Stanley auswirken. Die Rohstoffaktivitäten von Morgan Stanley ziehen weit reichende aufsichtsrechtliche Konsequenzen nach sich, machen das Unternehmen angreifbar im Falle von Katastrophen und unterwerfen es Umweltrisiken, die allesamt erhebliche Kosten und Verbindlichkeiten für das Unternehmen zur Folge haben können. Im Zusammenhang mit den Rohstoff-Aktivitäten im Bereich Institutional Securities von Morgan Stanley engagiert sich das Unternehmen in der Produktion, Lagerung, dem Transport, der Vermarktung und dem Handel unterschiedlicher Rohstoffe wie Metalle (Basis- und Edelmetalle), Rohöl, Erdölprodukte, Erdgas, elektrischer Strom, Emissionsrechte, Frachtkohle, Flüssiggas und damit verbundene Produkte und Indizes. Zudem hält Morgan Stanley das Eigentum an fünf Stromerzeugungsanlagen in den USA und Europa, an TransMontagne Inc. und deren Tochtergesellschaften, einer Gruppe von Gesellschaften, die im Vertrieb und Verkauf von raffinierten Produkten tätig ist, und an der Heimar Group, einer Gruppe, die internationale Seefracht und U.S. Seelogistik Service anbietet. Als Ergebnis dieser Aktivitäten unterliegt Morgan Stanley umfassenden und in der Entwicklung befindlichen Gesetzen und Vorschriften in den Bereichen Energie, Umwelt, Gesundheit und 33 Sicherheit sowie sonstigen staatlichen Gesetzen und Vorschriften. Beispielsweise könnte daher eine Haftung nach bestimmten Umweltschutzgesetzen auch ohne Verschulden eintreten. Das Rohstoffgeschäft von Morgan Stanley birgt ebenso das Risiko unvorhergesehener Ereignisse, einschließlich Naturkatastrophen, Lecks, auslaufender Stoffe, Explosionen mit Entweichen giftiger Substanzen, Feuer, Unfälle auf dem Meer und auf dem Land, Kriege und Terrorattacken, welche zu Körperverletzungen, Tod, Sachschäden und der Aussetzung von Aktivitäten führen könnten. Auch wenn Morgan Stanley sich bemüht hat, die Risiken aus Umweltverschmutzung und sonstige Umweltrisiken, einschließlich der unten stehenden Risiken, unter anderem dadurch zu minimieren, dass angemessene Maßnahmen und Verfahren für den Betrieb von Stromanlagen eingeführt werden, die Qualität der Erdöllagereinrichtungen und Transportfahrzeuge überwacht wird und Notfallprogramme umgesetzt werden, können diese Maßnahmen möglicherweise nicht für alle Notfälle greifen. Zudem ist möglicherweise für einen Teil dieser Risiken kein Versicherungsschutz verfügbar, und die Einnahmen aus den Versicherungsleistungen sind möglicherweise nicht ausreichend, um die Verpflichtungen in Bezug auf bestimmte Vorfälle abzudecken. All diese Ereignisse können die Finanz- und Ertragslage von Morgan Stanley belasten. Morgan Stanley rechnet ferner damit, dass die anderen Gesetze und Vorschriften, die das Stromgeschäft betreffen, sowohl in Umfang als auch in Komplexität zunehmen. Während der vergangenen Jahre haben genauere Prüfungen der Energiemärkte durch Behörden in den USA auf Bundes-, Einzelstaaten- und kommunaler Ebene sowie im Ausland und die Aufmerksamkeit der Öffentlichkeit dazu geführt, dass sich die aufsichtsrechtlichen und rechtlichen Durchsetzungs-, Prozessund Rechtsmittelverfahren in Bezug auf Unternehmen, die in denselben Bereichen tätig sind, wie Morgan Stanley, zugenommen haben. So hat etwa die EU ihren Fokus auf die Energiemärkte gelegt, was zu einer Einführung einer Regulierung für an den Energiemärkten beteiligte Firmen führte. Davon umfasst werden auch Stromproduzenten und solche Firmen, die am Handel mit flüssigem Kohlenwasserstoff beteiligt sind. Mit der Einhaltung der aktuellen oder künftigen Gesetze und Vorschriften können für Morgan Stanley erhebliche Kostenbelastungen entstehen und die Geschäftstätigkeit insgesamt sowie der Ruf des Unternehmens können durch die aktuellen rechtlichen Rahmenbedingungen Schaden nehmen. Daneben kann ein Bruch dieser Gesetze und Regelungen zu ernsthaften zivilrechtlichen und strafrechtlichen Sanktionen und Strafen führen. Pipeline, Seeverkehr und Terminal-Aktiväten. Mit Pipelines, Seeverkehr und Terminal-Aktivitäten ist das Risiko erheblicher Umweltkosten und –verbindlichkeiten verbunden. Wie auch bei den anderen Rohstoffaktivitäten von Morgan Stanley gelten die US- und internationalen Umweltgesetze tatsächlich oder möglicherweise; dies gilt auch für die US- und sonstigen Umweltschutzgesetze im Zusammenhang mit Ölkatastrophen. Nach den Bundesgesetzen und –vorschriften sowie entsprechenden einzelstaatlichen Gesetzen kann sich eine verschuldensunabhängige Haftung für die Wiederherstellung der verseuchten Bereiche ergeben. 34 Interessenkonflikte nehmen zu und das Unvermögen, Interessenkonflikten angemessen zu begegnen, könnte Morgan Stanleys Aktivitäten belasten. Einer der wichtigsten Vermögenswerte von Morgan Stanley ist der Ruf. Im Rahmen der Ausweitung der Aktivitäten und Kundenbasis muss sich Morgan Stanley mit möglichen Interessenkonflikten auseinander setzen, einschließen derjenigen im Zusammenhang mit den Aktivitäten auf eigene Rechnung. So können Konflikte beispielsweise daraus entstehen, dass Morgan Stanley einerseits Finanzberater bei einer Fusion ist und andererseits eine wesentliche Beteiligung an einer der an der Transaktion beteiligten Parteien hält. Zudem zählen zur Kundenbasis von Morgan Stanley immer mehr Hedge Fonds und Private Equity Fonds, die jedoch bei vielen Aktivitäten gleichzeitig als konkurrierende Marktteilnehmer auftreten. Morgan Stanley hat Verfahren und Kontrollen zur Behandlung solcher Interessenkonflikte eingerichtet. Die angemessene Behandlung von Interessenkonflikten ist komplex und schwierig, und der Ruf von Morgan Stanley könnte Schaden nehmen, wenn die angemessene Behandlung von Interessenskonflikten tatsächlich oder anscheinend fehl schlägt. Zudem haben die SEC und andere Aufsichtsbehörden auf Ebene des Bundes und der Einzelstaaten die Prüfungen bei möglichen Interessenkonflikten verschärft. Mögliche oder mutmaßliche Interessenkonflikte können Prozesse oder Durchsetzungsmaßnahmen nach sich ziehen. Es ist möglich, dass die aufsichtsrechtlichen Prüfungen und Prozesse im Zusammenhang mit Interessenkonflikten dazu führen, dass Kunden von Morgan Stanley nicht so bereitwillig Transaktionen abschließen, die mit einem Konflikt verbunden sind, und dass hierdurch das Geschäft von Morgan Stanley negativ beeinflusst wird. Morgan Stanley unterliegt steuerlichen Eventualverpflichtungen, die das Ergebnis belasten könnten. Für Morgan Stanley gelten die Einkommensteuergesetze und Gesetze über indirekte Steuer der USA, deren Einzelstaaten und Kommunen sowie die der ausländischen Rechtsordnungen, in denen das Unternehmen wesentliche Geschäftsaktivitäten unterhält. Diese Steuergesetze sind komplex und werden vom Steuerzahler und den entsprechenden staatlichen Steuerbehörden unterschiedlich ausgelegt. Bei der Bildung der Steuerrückstellungen und der Bestimmung der Aufwendungen für indirekte Steuern muss Morgan Stanley die steuerliche Lage und Anwendung dieser inhärent komplexen Steuergesetze beurteilen und auslegen und zudem Schätzungen hinsichtlich der zeitlichen Auswirkung bestimmter Positionen auf das steuerpflichtige Einkommen in den unterschiedlichen Steuerhoheiten treffen. 35 Wettbewerbsumfeld Der harte Wettbewerb, in dem Morgan Stanley mit anderen Finanzdienstleistern steht, könnte auf die Preise drücken und somit die Erträge und Profitabilität des Unternehmens erheblich beeinträchtigen Die Finanzdienstleistungsbranche und alle Aktivitäten von Morgan Stanley sind hart umkämpft und Morgan Stanley rechnet damit, dass dies so bleibt. Morgan Stanley steht im Wettbewerb mit Handelsbanken, Versicherungsgesellschaften, Sponsoren von offenen Investmentfonds, Hedge Fonds, Energieversorgern und anderen Gesellschaften, die in den USA, in der ganzen Welt und über das Internet Finanzdienstleistungen anbieten. Im Wettbewerb spielen für Morgan Stanley unterschiedliche Faktoren eine Rolle, einschließlich der Transaktionsausführung, des Kapitals oder Zugangs zu Kapital, Produkten und Dienstleistungen, der Innovationskraft, des Rufs und des Preises. Im Zeitverlauf waren in bestimmten Bereichen der Finanzdienstleistungsbranche erhebliche Konsolidierungseffekte zu beobachten, da breit aufgestellte Finanzdienstleister von anderen Unternehmen übernommen oder mit diesen zusammengeschlossen wurden. Diese Konsolidierung könnte dazu führen, dass die Mitbewerber von Morgan Stanley mehr Kapital und sonstige Ressourcen, wie beispielsweise ein größeres Produkt- und Dienstleistungsspektrum sowie eine höhere geografische Diversifikation, auf sich vereinen können. Morgan Stanley kann infolge dieser Faktoren sowie auch im Zuge von Preissenkungen, die Mitbewerber vornehmen, um ihre Marktanteile auszuweiten, einem erhöhten Preisdruck ausgesetzt sein. Die Fähigkeit von Morgan Stanley, qualifizierte Mitarbeiter zu halten und anzuwerben ist für den Erfolg des Geschäfts von entscheidender Bedeutung, und ein entsprechendes Unvermögen könnte die Performance erheblich belasten. Die Mitarbeiter sind die wichtigste Ressource für Morgan Stanley, und qualifizierte Mitarbeiter sind hart umkämpft. Um qualifizierte Mitarbeiter anzuwerben und zu halten, muss Morgan Stanley diesen Mitarbeitern marktübliche Vergütungen zahlen. Grundsätzlich haben die Marktstandards dazu geführt, dass die Mitarbeitervergütung der größte Aufwandsposten von Morgan Stanley ist, da die Vergütungen stark variieren und sich mit der Performance ändern. Wenn Morgan Stanley nicht in der Lage ist, qualifizierte Mitarbeiter anzuwerben und zu halten, oder dies auf einem Niveau zu tun, das erforderlich ist, um die Wettbewerbsposition aufrecht zu erhalten, oder wenn die mit der Anwerbung und dem Halten von Mitarbeitern verbundenen Personalkosten steigen, könnte dies die Performance wie auch die Wettbewerbsposition von Morgan Stanley erheblich beeinträchtigen. 36 Automatisierte Handelsmärkte könnten das Geschäft von Morgan Stanley negativ beeinflussen und den Wettbewerb erhöhen. Morgan Stanley hat die Existenz eines intensiven Preiskampfs in einigen seiner Geschäftszweige in den letzten Jahren erlebt. Insbesondere haben die Möglichkeit, Wertpapierorder bei Börsen elektronisch auszuführen, und andere automatisierte Handelsmärkte den Druck auf die Handelskomissionen erhöht. Der Trend in Richtung eines direkten Zugangs zu automatisierten elektronischen Aktienmärkten wird wahrscheinlich anhalten. Es ist möglich, dass Morgan Stanley in Zukunft einen verschärften Wettbewerbsdruck in diesem oder anderen Bereichen erfährt, da einige der Wettbewerber möglicherweise Marktanteile durch eine Reduktion der Preise gewinnen wollen. Internationales Risiko Die internationale Geschäftstätigkeit unterwirft Morgan Stanley zahlreichen politischen, konjunkturellen, rechtlichen, operativen und anderen Risiken, die sich in vielerlei Hinsicht negativ auf die Aktivitäten auswirken können. Morgan Stanley unterliegt politischen, wirtschaftlichen, rechtlichen, operativen und sonstigen Risiken, die mit dem Engagement in einer Vielzahl von Ländern verbunden sind, einschließlich der Risiken einer möglichen Verstaatlichung, Enteignung, Preiskontrollen, Kapitalsteuerung, Devisenbewirtschaftung und sonstiger beschränkender staatlicher Maßnahmen, sowie des Ausbruchs von Feindseligkeiten. In vielen Ländern sind die für die Wertpapier- und Finanzdienstleistungsbranche anwendbaren Gesetze und Vorschriften unsicher und in der Entwicklung befindlich, und die Bestimmung der genauen Anforderungen der nationalen Gesetze in den einzelnen Märkten könnte sich für Morgan Stanley schwierig gestalten. Ist Morgan Stanley nicht in der Lage, die nationalen Gesetze eines bestimmten Marktes zu befolgen, so könnte sich dies nicht nur auf Morgan Stanleys Geschäft in diesem Markt sondern auch auf Morgan Stanleys Ruf insgesamt negativ auswirken. Morgan Stanley unterliegt ferner dem erhöhten Risiko, dass seine strukturierten Transaktionen nicht in allen Fällen rechtlich durchsetzbar sind. Morgan Stanley hat in den Emerging Markets expandiert und sucht nach Chancen für eine weitere Expansion. In zahlreichen Ländern der Emerging Markets waren ernsthafte wirtschaftliche und finanzielle Störungen zu beobachten, einschließlich erheblicher Entwertungen der Währungen, Kapitalsteuerungsund Devisenbewirtschaftungsmaßnahmen, Hyperinflation sowie geringe oder negative Wachstumsraten der Volkswirtschaften. Kriminalität und Korruption sowie Gefahren hinsichtlich der generellen und persönlichen Sicherheit existieren ebenfalls in manchen dieser Länder. Diese Umstände könnten sich auf die Geschäfte von Morgan Stanley negativ auswirken und die Volatilität der Finanzmärkte insgesamt steigern. Das Ausbrechen einer Epidemie oder anderer ausgedehnter Gesundheitsnotstandssituationen oder Bedenken hinsichtlich der Möglichkeit eines 37 solchen Notstands könnte zu Störungen des wirtschaftlichen und finanziellen Gleichgewichts in den Emerging Markets und anderen Regionen der Welt führen und Probleme für das operative Geschäft (einschließlich Reisebeschränkungen) nach sich ziehen, die Morgan Stanleys Fähigkeit, seine Aktivitäten in der gesamten Welt zu steuern, einschränken könnten. Übernahmerisiken Morgan Stanley ist möglicherweise nicht in der Lage, den erwarteten Wert künftiger Übernahmen, Joint Ventures oder Minderheitsbeteiligungen zu realisieren. Morgan Stanley will zum Teil durch Akquisitionen, Joint Ventures und Minderheitsbeteiligungen wachsen. Soweit Morgan Stanley Unternehmen übernimmt oder Zusammenschlüsse oder Joint Ventures umsetzt, sieht sich die Gesellschaft zahlreichen Risiken und Unsicherheiten im Zusammenhang mit der Kombination und Integration der entsprechenden Aktivitäten und Systeme ausgesetzt, einschließlich der Notwendigkeit, Rechnungslegungs- und Datenverarbeitungssysteme sowie Managementkontrollen zusammenzufassen und Beziehungen zu Kunden und Geschäftspartnern zu integrieren. Im Fall von Joint Ventures und Minderheitsbeteiligungen unterliegt Morgan Stanley insofern weiteren Risiken und Unsicherheiten, als dass das Unternehmen von Haftungspflichten, Verlusten, Rufschädigungen im Zusammenhang mit Systemen, Kontrollen und Mitarbeitern abhängig sein kann oder diesen ausgesetzt sein kann, die nicht von Morgan Stanley beeinflussbar sind. Zudem können Konflikte oder Uneinigkeiten zwischen Morgan Stanley und den Joint Venture Partnern den mit dem Joint Venture angestrebten Nutzen zunichte machen. Es kann nicht gewährleistet werden, dass die jüngsten Übernahmen oder Aktivitäten, die Morgan Stanley erwirbt, in Zukunft erfolgreich integriert werden und die beabsichtigten positiven Auswirkungen insgesamt umgesetzt werden. Wenn Morgan Stanley nicht in der Lage ist, die in der Vergangenheit oder in Zukunft übernommenen Aktivitäten zu integrieren, so besteht das Risiko, dass das operative Ergebnis von Morgan Stanley wesentlich belastet werden kann. Risikomanagement Morgan Stanleys Hedging-Strategien und andere Risikomanagement-Techniken entfalten möglicherweise nicht ihre volle Wirksamkeit bei der Minderung der Risiken in allen Marktsituationen bei allen Arten von Risiken. Morgan Stanley hat erhebliche Ressourcen in die Entwicklung seiner Risikomanagementverfahren und –methoden gesteckt und rechnet auch für die Zukunft mit einer Fortsetzung dieses Trends. Trotzdem sind Morgan Stanleys Hedging-Strategien und sonstigen Risikomanagement-Techniken möglicherweise 38 nicht voll wirksam bei der Minderung der Risiken in allen Marktsituationen bei allen Arten von Risiken, einschließlich der noch nicht identifizierten oder prognostizierten Risiken. Einige Risikomanagementmethoden von Morgan Stanley basieren auf dem Einsatz des in der Vergangenheit beobachteten Marktverhaltens. Im Ergebnis können diese Methoden keine künftigen Risiken vorhersagen, die sich erheblich von den historischen Messgrößen unterscheiden können (z.B. die aktuellen Ereignisse auf dem U.S. Subprime Baufinanzierungs-Hypothekenmarkt). Operative, rechtliche und aufsichtsrechtliche Risiken müssen unter anderem mit Methoden und Verfahren gesteuert werden, die eine große Zahl von Transaktionen und Ereignissen in angemessener Art und Weise aufzeichnen und verifizieren. Diese Methoden und Verfahren sind möglicherweise nicht vollständig wirksam. Mit den Zertifikaten verbundene Risiken Die nachfolgende Beschreibung von Risikofaktoren stellt keine abschließende Darstellung aller mit einer Anlage in die Zertifikate verbundenen Risiken dar. Die Emittentin und die Garantin lehnen jegliche Verantwortung hinsichtlich einer Beratung interessierter Anleger in Bezug auf die Risiken ab, die zum Zeitpunkt der Veröffentlichung dieses Prospekts oder auf Grund veränderter Umstände zu einem späteren Zeitpunkt jeweils bestehen. Interessierte Anleger sollten sich hinsichtlich der mit einer Anlage in die Zertifikate verbundenen Risiken von ihren eigenen Rechts-, Finanz- und/oder Steuerberatern beraten lassen und auf dieser Grundlage die Eignung einer Anlage unter Berücksichtigung ihrer individuellen Umstände prüfen. Die Zertifikate sind nicht geeignet für unerfahrene Anleger. Interessierte Anleger sollen die nachfolgenden Risikofaktoren zusammen mit den anderen in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Informationen sorgfältig lesen und bei ihrer Anlageentscheidung berücksichtigen. Allgemeine Risikofaktoren Eine Veränderung des Wertes der Fonds-Komponente oder der Zinsverhältnisse kann dazu führen, dass der Wert der Zertifikate erheblich unter den für das Zertifikat gezahlten Kaufpreis sinkt und dadurch für den Inhaber der Zertifikate bei einem vorzeitigen Verkauf der Zertifikate im Sekundärmarkt ein erheblicher Verlust entsteht. Die Auszahlung eines Mindestbetrages von 120% des Nennwerts der Zertifikate erfolgt nur bei Rückzahlung der Zertifikate am Ende ihrer Laufzeit. Dieses Risiko besteht unabhängig von der finanziellen Leistungsfähigkeit der Emittentin oder der Garantin. Die Emittentin oder die Garantin bzw. mit ihnen verbundene Unternehmen können an Transaktionen, die die Fonds-Komponente bzw. die der Fonds-Komponente zu Grunde liegende Werte und die Gesellschaft betreffen, beteiligt sein. Insofern ist es möglich, dass Aktien der Gesellschaft von einem mit der Emittentin bzw. der 39 Garantin verbundenen Unternehmen verkauft werden, während sie gleichzeitig von einem anderen mit der Emittentin bzw. der Garantin verbundenen Unternehmen – beispielsweise im Rahmen periodischer Umschichtungen – gekauft werden. Die Berechnungsstelle und mit ihr verbundene Unternehmen können oder könnten ein Eigeninteresse in den hier dargestellten Zertifikaten haben oder Market Maker für diese Produkte sein. Potenzielle Anleger sollte jede Entscheidung zur Anlage in die Zertifikate nur nach ausführlicher Prüfung des gesamten Prospekts einschließlich der Zertifikatsbedingungen treffen. Potenziellen Anlegern wird empfohlen, vor einer Anlageentscheidung den Rat der Hausbank oder eines unabhängigen Finanz- und/oder Steuerberaters einzuholen und allfällige lokale Verkaufsbeschränkungen zu beachten. Provisionen und andere Transaktionskosten können zu einer zusätzlichen Kostenbelastung führen. Potenzielle Anleger sollten sich vor Erwerb des Zertifikates über alle eventuell anfallenden Kosten informieren. Mögliche Interessenkonflikte Die Berechnungsstelle der Zertifikate ist ein mit der Emittentin bzw. der Garantin verbundenes Unternehmen. Daher kann bei der Berechnungsstelle ein potenzieller Interessenkonflikt gegenüber den Zertifikatsinhabern entstehen, einschließlich bei der Feststellung bestimmter Größen und die Vornahme bestimmter Beurteilungen, die von der Berechnungsstelle in Bezug auf Zahlungen auf die Zertifikate gemäß der Zertifikatsbedingungen vorzunehmen sind. Darüber hinaus können sich die Emittentin und die Garantin bzw. verbundene Unternehmen der Garantin im Rahmen des Eigenhandels oder auf Kundenrechnung jeweils in Transaktionen engagieren oder sog. Prime Brokerage Dienstleistungen erbringen, die die Fonds-Komponente bzw. die der Fonds-Komponente zu Grunde liegende Werte und die Gesellschaft betreffen, involvieren. Solche Transaktionen bzw. Dienstleistungen können sich negativ auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und daher auch auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Die Garantin und bestimmte verbundene Unternehmen der Garantin können ferner Gegenparteien bei Hedging-Geschäften der Emittentin im Zusammenhang mit ihren Verpflichtungen aus einer Zertifikatsemission sein. Entsprechend können sowohl bei diesen Tochtergesellschaften der Garantin als auch zwischen den Interessen dieser Tochtergesellschaften und den Interessen der Zertifikatsinhaber bestimmte Interessenkonflikte entstehen. 40 Weitere mit den Zertifikaten verbundene Risiken Abhängigkeit der Zahlungen von der Wertentwicklung der Fonds-Komponente Die Zahlung eines über den Mindestbetrag von 120% des Nennwerts der Zertifikate hinausgehenden Betrags ist abhängig von der an einen Partizipationsfaktor geknüpften Wertentwicklung der Fonds-Komponente. Sollte sich der Wert der Fonds-Komponente nicht entsprechend entwickeln, erhalten die Anleger unter Umständen zum Laufzeitende lediglich den Mindestbetrag von 120% des Nennwerts der Zertifikate und keine darüber hinausgehenden Beträge. Der Kapitalschutz greift nur zum Ende der Laufzeit der Wertpapiere Die Zertifikate sind zum Ende der Laufzeit im Umfang des Nennwerts (ohne Berücksichtigung des Ausgabeaufschlags) kapitalgeschützt, das heißt der Anleger erhält zum Ende der Laufzeit unabhängig von der Entwicklung der FondsKomponente jedenfalls 120% des Nennwert des Zertifikats. Erwirbt ein Investor die Zertifikate nach Emission zu einem Preis, der über dem Nennwert liegt, so sollte dem potenziellen Erwerber der Zertifikate bewusst sein, dass sich der Kapitalschutz nur auf den kleineren Nennwert bezieht. Dabei ist zudem zu beachten, dass der Kapitalschutz nur zum Ende der Laufzeit, das heißt soweit die Zertifikate nicht gekündig worden sind, greift. Der Geldbetrag, der bei einer Kündigung durch die Emittentin der Zertifikate geleistet wird, kann erheblich geringer sein als der Betrag, der bei Greifen des Kapitalschutzes zum Ende der Laufzeit mindestens zu zahlen wäre. Potenziellen Erwerbern der Wertpapiere sollte zudem bewusst sein, dass sie trotz des Kapitalschutzes im Umfang des Nennwerts, das Risiko der Verschlechterung der finanziellen Leistungsfähigkeit der Emittentin bzw. der Garantin tragen. Potenzielle Erwerber müssen deshalb bereit und in der Lage sein, Verluste des eingesetzten Kapitals bis hin zum Totalverlust hinzunehmen. In jedem Falle sollten Erwerber der Zertifikate ihre jeweiligen wirtschaftlichen Verhältnisse daraufhin überprüfen, ob sie in der Lage sind, die mit dem Zertifikat verbundenen Verlustrisiken zu tragen. Transaktionskosten oder Abzüge in Verbindung mit Transaktionen oder einer vorzeitigen Rückzahlung von Zertifikaten können negative Auswirkungen auf den wirtschaftlichen Erfolg einer Anlage in die Zertifikate haben Für Anleger in Zertifikate können Transaktionskosten, wie z.B. das Agio und sonstige Gebühren sowie Abzüge in Bezug auf den gegenwärtigen Zertifikats-Wert anfallen, wenn Zertifikate vor ihrem ursprünglichen Fälligkeitstag (sei es auf dem Primär- oder 41 Sekundärmarkt) gekauft, verkauft oder vor Endfälligkeit eingelöst werden. Diese und andere Transaktionskosten und Abzüge verringern die möglichen Erträge einer Anlage in die Zertifikate. Potenzielle Erwerber sollten sich über die Höhe solcher Transaktionskosten und Abzüge informieren, bevor sie Zertifikate kaufen oder verkaufen. Die Bestimmung des Werts des Zertifikats beruht auf Daten, auf deren Richtigkeit die Emittentin keinen Einfluss hat Die Bestimmung des Werts des Zertifikats beruht auf Daten und der Erbringung von Dienstleistungen, deren Richtigkeit außerhalb des Einflussbereichs der Emittentin liegt. Insbesondere unterliegt die Bewertung der Fonds-Komponente einem weiten Ermessen des Investment Managers bzw. der Bewertungsstelle. Daher kann die Emittentin nicht sicherstellen, dass die bekannt gegebenen Werte der FondsKomponente und der Wert des Zertifikats stets dem objektiven Verkehrswert der in der Fonds-Komponente enthaltenen Bestandteile widerspiegeln und dass die Inhaber der Zertifikate ordnungsgemäß informiert wurden. Risikoausschließende oder -einschränkende Geschäfte Anleger sollten nicht darauf vertrauen, dass sie während der Laufzeit der Zertifikate Geschäfte abschließen können, durch die sie Ihre anfänglichen Risiken ausschließen oder einschränken können; dies hängt von den Marktverhältnissen und den jeweils zugrundeliegenden Bedingungen ab. Unter Umständen können solche Geschäfte nur zu einem ungünstigen Marktpreis getätigt werden, so dass für sie ein entsprechender Verlust entsteht. Inanspruchnahme von Kredit Wenn Anleger den Erwerb der Zertifikate mit Kredit finanzieren, müssen sie beim Nichteintritt ihrer Erwartungen nicht nur den eingetretenen Verlust hinnehmen, sondern auch den Kredit verzinsen und zurückzahlen. Dadurch erhöht sich ihr Verlustrisiko erheblich. Zertifikatsinhaber sollten nie darauf setzen, den Kredit aus Gewinnen eines Zertifikatsgeschäfts verzinsen und zurückzahlen zu können. Vielmehr muss der Erwerber von Zertifikaten vorher seine wirtschaftlichen Verhältnisse daraufhin überprüfen, ob er zur Verzinsung und gegebenenfalls zur kurzfristigen Tilgung des Kredits auch dann in der Lage ist, wenn statt der erwarteten Gewinne Verluste eintreten. 42 Die Bedeutung von Fristen im Zusammenhang mit dem Vorzeitigen Verkauf der Zertifikate Jeder Zertifikatsinhaber ist, vorbehaltlich der nachfolgenden Bestimmungen, berechtigt, die von ihm gehaltenen Zertifikate insgesamt oder teilweise der Emittentin durch schriftliche Mitteilung gegenüber der Zahlstelle und unter Einhaltung einer Mitteilungsfrist von mindestens fünfundzwanzig (25) Kalendertagen vor dem letzten Kalendertag eines Kalenderquartals über die Morgan Stanley Bank AG, Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland, zum Ankauf anzudienen. Die Morgan Stanley Bank AG, Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland, kann hierbei eine zusätzliche Frist bestimmen, um den rechtzeitigen Eingang der Mitteilung bis mindestens fünfundzwanzig Kalendertage vor dem jeweiligen Vorzeitigen Verkauftag sicherzustellen. Wahrt der Zertifikatsinhaber die Frist nicht, ist seine Andienung unbeachtlich. Dem Zertifikatsinhaber wird daher empfohlen, sich rechtzeitig bei der Morgan Stanley Bank AG, Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland, über die Länge dieser zusätzlichen Frist zu informieren. Unabhängige Prüfung und Beratung Jeder potenzielle Käufer der Zertifikate muss durch eine eigene unabhängige Prüfung und eine sachverständige Beratung, die ihm unter den gegebenen Umständen als geeignet erscheint, sicherstellen, dass der Erwerb der Zertifikate (i) mit seinen Anlagebedürfnissen und -zielen sowie seiner finanziellen Lage (oder, falls er die Zertifikate treuhänderisch oder in anderer Weise für einen Dritten erwirbt, mit den Anlagebedürfnissen und -zielen sowie der finanziellen Lage des Begünstigten oder des maßgeblichen Dritten) vollständig vereinbar ist; (ii) allen diesbezüglich anwendbaren Anlagegrundsätzen, -richtlinien und -beschränkungen entspricht und vollständig mit diesen vereinbar ist (unabhängig davon, ob der Käufer die Zertifikate in eigenem Namen oder treuhänderisch oder auf andere Weise für einen Dritten erwirbt), und (iii) eine geeignete, angemessene und passende Anlage für ihn (oder, falls er die Zertifikate treuhänderisch oder in anderer Weise für einen Dritten erwirbt, für den Begünstigten oder den maßgeblichen Dritten) ist, ungeachtet der offensichtlichen und wesentlichen Risiken, die mit einer Anlage in den Zertifikaten bzw. mit dem Besitz der Zertifikate verbunden sind. 43 Änderung der steuerlichen Behandlung der Zertifikate Die in diesem Prospekt ausgeführten Überlegungen hinsichtlich der Besteuerung der Wertpapiere geben die Ansicht der Emittentin auf Basis der zum Datum des Prospekts geltenden Gesetzgebung wieder. Eine andere steuerliche Behandlung durch die Finanzbehörden und Finanzgerichte kann jedoch nicht ausgeschlossen werden. Darüber hinaus dürfen die in diesem Prospekt ausgeführten steuerlichen Überlegungen nicht als alleinige Grundlage für die Beurteilung einer Anlage in die Wertpapiere aus steuerlicher Sicht dienen, da die individuelle Situation eines jeden Anlegers gleichermaßen berücksichtigt werden muss. Die in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen steuerlichen Überlegungen sind daher nicht als eine Form der maßgeblichen Information oder Steuerberatung bzw. als eine Form der Zusicherung oder Garantie im Hinblick auf das Eintreffen bestimmter steuerlicher Konsequenzen zu erachten. Folglich sollten Anleger vor der Entscheidung über einen Kauf der Wertpapiere ihre persönlichen Steuerberater konsultieren. Weder die Emittentin noch die Garantin übernehmen die Verantwortung für die steuerlichen Konsequenzen einer Anlage in die Wertpapiere. Rechtmäßigkeit des Erwerbs Die Emittentin und die Garantin übernehmen keine Verantwortung für die Rechtmäßigkeit des Erwerbs der Zertifikate durch einen potenziellen Erwerber, sei es nach den Gesetzen des Sitzstaates, der Nationalität, des Wohnsitzes oder der Geschäftstätigkeit (soweit sich diese unterscheiden), oder für die Einhaltung jeglicher einschlägiger Gesetze, Regelungen oder Verordnungen durch den potenziellen Erwerber. Dieser Prospekt ersetzt nicht die in jedem individuellen Fall unerlässliche Beratung vor der Kaufentscheidung durch Ihre Bank oder Ihren Finanzberater. Insbesondere sollten Zertifikatsinhaber im Hinblick auf die individuellen steuerlichen Auswirkungen der Anlage in die Zertifikate den eigenen steuerlichen Berater konsultieren. Mit der Fonds-Komponente verbundene Risiken Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. ist eine Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten (segregated accounts company) Die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. wurde als eine Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten (segregated accounts company) gemäß dem Segregated Accounts Companies Act 2000 of Bermuda (das "SAC-Gesetz") und als ein offener Publikumsfonds gemäß dem Companies Act 1981 of Bermuda eingetragen. Als Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten (segregated accounts) kann sie die einer bestimmten Aktienklasse der Gesellschaft zurechenbaren Vermögenswerte und 44 Verbindlichkeiten separat von den jeder anderen Aktienklasse der Gesellschaft zurechenbaren Vermögenswerten und Verbindlichkeiten sowie separat von den allgemeinen Vermögenswerten und Verbindlichkeiten der Gesellschaft führen. Die Vermögenswerte eines zugriffsbeschränkten Kontos sind ausschließlich für die Erfüllung von Verbindlichkeiten gegenüber Gläubigern in Bezug auf dieses bestimmte zugriffsbeschränkte Konto vorgesehen, und es ist nicht beabsichtigt, dass auf sie zur Erfüllung von Verbindlichkeiten gegenüber Gläubigern in Bezug auf andere zugriffsbeschränkte Konten oder die Gesellschaft allgemein zurückgegriffen werden kann. Nach Wissen der Gesellschaft wurde das SAC-Gesetz noch nicht von den Gerichten in Bermuda oder einer anderen Rechtsordnung geprüft, und es ist möglich, dass das SAC-Gesetz in einigen Rechtsordnungen nicht anerkannt wird oder entgegen der Gesetzgebungsintention ausgelegt wird. Sind Vermögenswerte eines zugriffsbeschränkten Kontos der Gesellschaft in einer anderen Rechtsordnung als Bermuda gelegen, und werden diesbezüglich in dieser Rechtsordnung Verfahren angestrengt, so ist nicht bekannt, wie die Gerichte dieser Rechtsordnung die vom SAC-Gesetz geregelte Struktur, die in dieser Rechtsordnung ungewohnt sein könnte, behandeln werden. Insbesondere werden Gerichte anderer Rechtsordnungen als der von Bermuda möglicherweise nicht anerkennen, dass Gläubiger in Bezug auf ein bestimmtes zugriffsbeschränktes Konto nicht auf die Vermögenswerte der anderen zugriffsbeschränkten Konten zurückgreifen können, oder dass allgemeine Gläubiger der Gesellschaft insgesamt keinen Rückgriff auf die Vermögenswerte haben, die speziell als Vermögenswerte zugriffsbeschränkter Konten ausgewiesen sind. Dementsprechend ist nicht bekannt, wie Verbindlichkeiten, die der Gesellschaft durch eine Behörde in Bermuda oder einem anderem Land auferlegt werden (z.B. eine Strafe oder Steuer), von den Gerichten in Bermuda oder anderen Rechtsordnungen auf Gesellschaft als Ganzes und die einzelnen zugriffsbeschränkten Konten aufgeteilt werden würde. Die Nicht-Anerkennung der Struktur als Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten kann sich wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der FondsKomponente und somit den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Es können Änderungen der Besteuerung und der anwendbaren Gesetze in Bezug auf die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. eintreten Die Gesellschaft ist bestrebt, ihre Geschäfte so zu führen, dass sie nicht so behandelt wird, als engagiere sie sich in Transaktionen oder Geschäften in einem anderen Land als Bermuda, und sie dürfte daher in keinem anderen Land als Bermuda zur Steuer veranlagt werden. Sollten ihre Aktivitäten doch so angesehen werden, als stellen sie Transaktionen oder Geschäfte aus einem anderen Land als Bermuda dar, so ist möglicherweise die steuerliche Veranlagung in diesem Landes erforderlich. Solche Steuern würden die Wertentwicklung der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares belasten und sich damit nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Die Gesellschaft ist zudem dem Risiko von Änderungen der auf sie anwendbaren Gesetze oder Verordnungen bzw. der Besteuerung ausgesetzt. Diese Änderungen 45 können sich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares unterliegen einer Diversifizierung, die nicht offen gelegt wird Die Investitionen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares umfassen eine breite Palette an Anlagemöglichkeiten, darunter Investitionen in Hedgefonds (die "Hedgefonds"). Obwohl damit das Risiko einer Konzentration auf eine beschränkte Anzahl von Vermögenswerten begrenzt werden soll, kann nicht sichergestellt werden, dass diese Diversifizierung wirksamer ist als eine Konzentration auf eine geringe Anzahl von Vermögenswerten. Außerdem ist nicht beabsichtigt, die jeweilige Zusammensetzung des Portfolios der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares bekannt zu geben. Die Anlagestrategie der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares unterliegt Änderungen durch den Investment Manager Das Portfolio der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares wird durch die Man Investments Limited als Investment Manager verwaltet. Das Portfolio und die Strategie des Managements des Portfolios können vom Investment Manager geändert werden, da die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares grundsätzlich nicht auf die von ihm eingesetzten Anlagestrategien beschränkt ist und der Investment Manager jederzeit neue Strategien entwickeln kann. Zudem können Anlagestrategien von der Zusammensetzung des Mitarbeiterstabes des Investment Managers abhängig sein, der ebenfalls Fluktuationen unterliegt. Da die Anlagestrategie der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares auch Investitionen in Hedgefonds umfasst, können Änderungen in deren Strategie und Personal ebenfalls den Wert der FondsKomponente beeinflussen. Strategieänderungen und Personalwechsel sowie die Ergebnisse von Anlageentscheidungen des Investment Managers können sich wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und somit den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Der Anlageansatz der Gesellschaft, sowie die Investitionen der Anlagestrategien und Hedgefonds sind mit Risiken verbunden Mit dem Anlageansatz der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. sind insbesondere folgende Risiken verbunden, deren Realisierung sich wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und somit den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken kann: (a) Die Erträge der Aktien können während ihres Bestehens erheblich steigen und auch sinken. Dies hängt von den Handels- und Anlagegewinnen ab. Die Gesellschaft gibt keine Erklärung darüber ab, welche Erträge ein Aktionär 46 mit den Aktien erwirtschaften kann, und es ist nicht gewährleistet, dass in diesem Prospekt dargestellten Informationen über den Investment Manager oder die Anlagestile in irgendeiner Hinsicht indikativ für die künftige Entwicklung der Aktien sind (hinsichtlich der Rentabilität oder der geringen Korrelation mit anderen Anlageformen). (b) Die Aufgabe des Investment Managers oder der Anlageberater der Anlagestrategien und Hedgefonds, in welche die Gesellschaft investiert (die "Anlageberater"), die zu befolgende Anlagestrategie zu identifizieren und tatsächlich Gewinn bringend einzusetzen, ist mit einem hohen Maß an Unsicherheit verbunden,. Es kann nicht gewährleistet werden, dass der Investment Manager oder ein Anlageberater in der Lage ist, geeignete Anlagechancen auszumachen, in deren Rahmen alle zugewiesenen Vermögenswerte genutzt werden. (c) Die Gesellschaft betreibt ihr operatives Geschäft erst seit begrenzter Zeit, und die einzelnen zugriffsbeschränkten Konten verfügen möglicherweise über keine oder nur begrenzte operative Erfahrung. Zwar können der Investment Manager und die Anlageberater der Fonds und Strategien in die die Gesellschaft investiert (auf eine operative Geschichte zurückblicken, jedoch ist diese möglicherweise relativ kurz, und die verwendeten Strategien wurden möglicherweise vorher nicht von Anlagegesellschaften eingesetzt, die ihrer Art nach so aufgestellt sind wie die Gesellschaft. Erwerber der Zertifikate sollten sich bewusst sein, dass die Entwicklung des operativen Geschäfts der Gesellschaft (falls auf eine entsprechende Geschichte zurückgeblickt werden kann) nicht notwendigerweise Aufschluss über die wahrscheinliche künftige Entwicklung der Gesellschaft, der FondsKomponente und der Zertifikate gibt. (d) Anlagen der Gesellschaft und ein erheblicher Teil ihrer Vermögenswerte in Bezug auf die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares können direkt oder indirekt konzentriert sein auf Wertpapiere eines einzelnen Emittenten oder einer einzelnen Emissionsstelle oder auf Anlagestrategien eines einzelnen Anlageberaters. Soweit eine Konzentration in einer solchen Weise besteht, könnten die Gesamtauswirkungen nachteiliger Entwicklungen des Geschäfts eines solchen Emittenten oder einer solchen Emissionsstelle oder eines solchen Anlageberaters oder einer Negativentwicklung der Währung, auf die die Wertpapiere lauten, deutlich größer sein, als wenn eine Konzentration der Anlagen in diesem Ausmaß nicht bestünde. (e) Die Gesellschaft kann Anlagen in Märkten tätigen, die volatil und/oder illiquide sein können. Entsprechend ist es, auch wenn bestimmte Anlagen mit einer höheren Liquidität ausgestattet sein können als eine Aktienanlage, unter Umständen nicht möglich (im Falle der Einstellung des Handels oder auf Grund von täglichen Kursschwankungsgrenzen an den gehandelten Märkten oder aus anderen Gründen) oder sehr teuer für die Gesellschaft, Positionen zu liquidieren die sich durch Bewegungen der Märkte negativ entwickeln. Alternativ ist es unter bestimmten Umständen nicht möglich, 47 dass eine Position unmittelbar eingegangen oder liquidiert werden kann (sofern in den jeweiligen Märkten keine ausreichenden Handelsaktivitäten verzeichnet werden oder aus anderen Gründen). Entsprechend kann die Gesellschaft in ihrer Fähigkeit, auf Marktschwankungen zu reagieren, eingeschränkt sein. Diese Risikowirkung kann noch verstärkt werden, wenn die Gesellschaft gezwungen ist, Positionen auf Grund der Erfüllung von Margin- Bestimmungen, Margin-Einschüssen, Rücknahmeanträgen oder Finanzierungserfordernissen zu liquidieren. Die Anlageberater können in Bezug auf ihre Aktivitäten ähnlichen Risiken ausgesetzt sein. (f) Bei den Anlagestrategien können zum Teil Leerverkäufe eingesetzt werden, wobei vereinbart wird, Wertpapiere zu einem künftigen Termin zu verkaufen, unabhängig davon, ob der Verkäufer die zu verkaufenden Wertpapiere im Zeitpunkt des Verkaufs besitzt. Der Verkäufer kann jeweils gezwungen sein, für die Lieferung an den Käufer Wertpapiere derselben Art auszuleihen, mit der gleichzeitigen Verpflichtung des Verkäufers, solche ausgeliehenen Wertpapiere zu einem späteren Termin wieder zurückzugeben. Mit Leerverkäufen können Anleger von rückläufigen Marktpreisen profitieren, soweit solche Kursrückgänge die Transaktionskosten und Kosten für die Ausleihung der Wertpapiere übersteigen. Müssen für die Schließung der Leerverkaufspositionen die ausgeliehenen Wertpapiere jedoch durch Käufe zu Marktpreisen ersetzt werden, so würde jegliche Kurssteigerung der ausgeliehenen Wertpapiere zu einem Verlust führen. Kurssteigerungen können allein aus dem Kauf von Wertpapieren zur Glattstellung von Shortpositionen resultieren und die Verluste so weiter in die Höhe treiben. Es ist nicht garantiert, dass die zur Deckung einer Shortposition notwendigen Wertpapiere gekauft werden können. Zudem sind nach den Regelungen einiger Märkte Leerverkäufe verboten, wenn diese nur zu einem Preis unter dem letzten Verkaufspreis möglich sind, weshalb die Wertpapiere möglicherweise nicht zum am stärksten favorisierten Zeitpunkt leerverkauft werden können. Dementsprechend kann sich der Einsatz von Leerverkäufen wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und somit auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. (g) Anlagen in Derivate sind mit erheblichen Risiken verbunden und können Verluste nach sich ziehen. Die Preise von Futureskontrakten und derivativen Instrumenten sind starken Schwankungen unterworfen. Einflussfaktoren für diese Preise sind unter anderem das Zinsniveau, die implizite Volatilität, die Dividendenrendite des Wertpapiers auf das sich das Derivat bezieht, eine Änderung bei Angebot und Nachfrage, Handels- und Fiskalprogramme sowie geld- und währungspolitische Programme und politische und wirtschaftliche Ereignisse. Während der Investment Manager und die Anlageberater möglicherweise bestrebt sind, diese Einflüsse zu prognostizieren und zu überwachen, kann es keine Garantie geben, dass der Investment Manager und der Anlageberater diese Einflüsse, die zu Verlusten führen könnten, korrekt vorhersieht und überwacht. 48 (h) Forwardkontrakte werden im Gegensatz zu Futureskontrakten nicht an Börsen gehandelt und sind nicht standardisiert. Der Handel im Forward- und Kassamarkt ist im Wesentlichen nicht reguliert. Es gibt keine Begrenzungen für tägliche Kursschwankungen und spekulative Positionslimite kommen nicht zur Anwendung. Für die Marktteilnehmer, die in den Forwardmärkten handeln, besteht keine Verpflichtung, weiterhin als Market Maker für die von ihnen gehandelten Währungen oder Commodities zu fungieren, und in diesen Märkten können Phasen der Illiquidität herrschen, die im Einzelfall über einen erheblichen Zeitraum andauern können. An jedem gehandelten Markt können wegen ungewöhnlichen hoher Handelsvolumina, politischer Interventionen und sonstiger Faktoren Störungen auftreten. Illiquidität oder Störungen an den Märkten können zu Verlusten führen. (i) Die von bestimmten Anlageberatern eingesetzten komplexen Handelssysteme/-programme und das Tempo und Volumen von Transaktionen führt zwangsweise gelegentlich dazu, dass Geschäfte ausgeführt werden, die im Nachhinein betrachtet nicht für die Handelssysteme/-programme erforderlich waren. Die mit jeglichen unabsichtlichen Geschäften, die auf diese Art und Weise ausgeführt wurden, verbundenen Verluste wirken sich nachteilig auf den Wert der FondsKomponente und damit der Zertifikate aus. (j) Die Gesellschaft und die zu Grunde liegenden Anlagevehikel, über die Anlagen direkt oder indirekt getätigt werden, können bestimmte Strategien einsetzen, die jeweils von der Zuverlässigkeit und Korrektheit der analytischen Modelle des Investment Managers oder der Anlageberater abhängen. Sofern solche Modelle (oder die ihnen zu Grunde liegenden Annahmen) sich nicht als richtig erweisen, können die Anlagen der Gesellschaft möglicherweise nicht die erwartete Performance erreichen. Dies könnte zu erheblichen Verlusten der Gesellschaft und damit auch der Fonds-Komponenten und der Zertifikate führen. (k) Der Nettoninventarwert der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares basiert teilweise auf Bewertungen, die Schätzwerte enthalten, und unterliegt dem Risiko, dass solche Schätzwerte und/oder zugrunde liegenden Annahmen sich als unrichtig erweisen, sowie dem operativen Risiko, dass die Berechnungen fehlerhaft sind. (l) Der Investment Manager verwaltet das Risiko für die Gesellschaft, indem er bestrebt ist, sicherzustellen, dass sich das zugrunde liegende Risiko im Zusammenhang mit jeder Aktienklasse, einschließlich der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares, in einem vorher bestimmten Rahmen hält. Dennoch muss die Gesellschaft möglicherweise ihre Handelsaktivitäten in einigen oder allen Anlagestrategien für eine oder mehrere Aktienklassen einstellen, wenn der Nettoinventarwert eines oder mehrerer zugriffsbeschränkter Konten (segregated accounts) auf ein Niveau sinkt, das nicht mehr ausreichend ist, um den übliche diversifizierten Anlageansatz zu verfolgen. 49 (m) Der spezifische Anlageansatz des Investment Managers setzt zum Teil auf die selbst verliehene Flexibilität, in unterschiedliche Strategien anzulegen, wobei dies auch Strategien sein können, die heute noch nicht in Betracht gezogen werden. Im Ergebnis können die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares deshalb im Zuge der weiteren Entwicklung der Anlagestile, mit denen die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares verwaltet werden, Risiken ausgesetzt sein, die nicht in diesem Abschnitt beschrieben sind. Der Investment Manager hat weder Kontrolle noch Einfluss auf die Investitionsentscheide der Anlagestrategien und der ihnen zugrunde liegenden Hedgefondsmanager Der Investment Manager überwacht die Wertentwicklung der Anlagestrategien, hat jedoch weder Kontrolle noch Einfluss auf die Investitionsentscheide die von den Anlagestrategien oder den ihnen zugrunde liegenden einzelnen Hedgefondsmanagern getroffen werden. Die Hedgefonds und Anlagestrategien berücksichtigen bei ihren Anlageentscheiden nicht die Interessen der Fonds-Komponente, der Gesellschaft oder eines Hypothetischen Anteilsinhabers. Weiterhin können die Hedgefonds und Anlagestrategien in einem Land mit eingeschränkter oder keiner regulatorischen Aufsicht ansässig sein, und in illiquide, volatile Anlagen, in Emerging-Markets, sowie in Anlagen mit keinem oder geringem Credit-Rating investieren. Bezüglich der Investmentmöglichkeiten und –strategien, die von den Hedgefonds und Anlagestrategien angewendet werden können, gibt es nur wenige Beschränkungen. Die damit verbundenen Risiken können sich wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und somit den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Transaktionskosten und Gebühren der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares können sich nachteilig auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken Die Führung der Geschäfte des Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares und der einzelnen Hedgefonds bringt die Zahlung erheblicher Transaktionskosten und Gebühren für Dienstleistungen mit sich, die für die Anlageentscheidungen von wesentlicher Bedeutung sind. Die Höhe und die Zahlung derartiger Kosten und Gebühren können sich wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und somit auf den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. So muss die Gesellschaft erhebliche Gebühren, einschließlich Verwaltungsgebühren, Erfolgsvergütungen und Transaktionsgebühren der Broker, zahlen. Diese Kosten wirken sich auf den Nettinventarwert der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares und somit auch auf die Fähigkeit der Gesellschaft aus, in Bezug auf die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares eine positive Performance zu erzielen. Solche Gebühren und Transaktionskosten sind im Wesentlichen an Unternehmen der Man Group plc (die "Man Group") zahlbar. 50 Die Entwicklung der Fonds-Komponente wird insbesondere durch Belastungen beeinflusst, die sich auf die Investitionen beziehen. Üblicherweise führt ein hoher Portfolioumsatz zu entsprechend hohen Transaktionskosten und der genaue Betrag der damit verbundenen Maklerprovisionen und dazugehörigen Transaktionskosten hängt von einer Reihe von Faktoren ab, unter anderem Art und Häufigkeit der sich bietenden Marktchancen, Umfang der Transaktion und den jeweils geltenden Transaktionssätzen. Solche Gebühren und Transaktionskosten sind im Wesentlichen an die Man Group zahlbar. Diese Kosten und Gebühren sind von der jeweiligen Entwicklung der FondsKomponente unabhängig. Dementsprechend müssen sie auch gezahlt werden, wenn die entsprechende Entwicklung negativ ist. Zudem werden Erfolgsvergütungen separat für jede Anlagestrategie berechnet und belastet. Werden zwischen den Anlagestrategien Umschichtungen vorgenommen, so wird die Berechnungsgrundlage für die Erfolgsvergütung neu festgelegt, und dies kann bedeuten, dass ein Erfolgshonorar zahlbar ist, das nicht zahlbar wäre, wenn eine solche Umschichtung nicht stattgefunden hätte. Das Erfolgshonorar kann für den Investment Manager und die Anlageberater einen Anreiz darstellen, risikoreichere Anlagen zu tätigen, als sie ansonsten, ohne eine Gebühr auf Basis der Wertentwicklung, tätigen würden. Die von der Gesellschaft und/oder den zugrunde liegenden Anlageinstrumenten zahlbaren Gebühren und Transaktionskosten können während des Bestehens der Gesellschaft der Neuverhandlung unterliegen. Es wird zudem Situationen geben, in denen ein Unternehmen der Man Group an Gebühren und Aufwendungen beteiligt ist, die von oder im Zusammenhang mit Investmentfonds oder Managed Accounts erhoben werden, in die die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares direkt oder indirekt investieren, oder in denen ein solches Unternehmen an den zugrunde liegenden Anlageverwaltern selbst beteiligt ist. Die vom Investment Manager eingerichteten Verfahren sind so konzipiert, dass mit ihnen sichergestellt ist, dass die von einem einzelnen zugrunde liegenden Anlageberatern berechneten Gebühren grundsätzlich in einem marktüblichen Rahmen liegen und berücksichtigen hierbei alle relevanten einschlägigen Umstände dieses Beraters. In diesem Zusammenhang bezeichnet der Begriff "Beteiligung" insbesondere, jedoch nicht nur, eine Geschäftsbeziehung, eine finanzielle Beziehung oder eine andere gewerbliche Struktur, die dazu führt, dass eine Beteiligung an einem Geschäft, einem Gewerbe, einem Finanzkonstrukt oder eine sonstige wesentliche Beteiligung geschaffen wird. Der Einsatz von Leverage-Techniken durch die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. kann die Wertentwicklung der Fonds-Komponente nachteilig beeinflussen Die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares, und Hedgefonds, in die sie investieren, sind in der Lage, signifikant und zum Teil auch unbeschränkt Fremdkapital aufzunehmen und verschiedene Kreditlinien und andere Formen der Fremdfinanzierung, unter anderem auch Swaps und Wertpapierpensionsgeschäfte zu nutzen. Während die 51 Fremdfinanzierung eine Möglichkeit zur Steigerung des Gesamtertrages eines Hedgefonds darstellt, birgt sie zugleich die Gefahr potenziell höherer Verluste. Mit dem Einsatz von Leverage-Techniken durch die Gesellschaft sind insbesondere folgende Risiken verbunden, deren Realisierung sich wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und somit den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken kann: (a) Die Aufnahme von Fremdkapital sorgt für eine zusätzliche Hebelwirkung, die im Falle rückläufigen Handelskapitals und negativer Renditen die Wertentewicklung der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares negativ beeinflussen können. (b) Die Gesellschaft kann für die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares Darlehen aufnehmen und Swaps und andere außerbilanzielle Derivatetransaktionen sowie andere Fremdkapitalmittel einsetzen. Die zugrunde liegenden Instrumente, über die die Gesellschaft direkt oder indirekt anlegt (wie beispielsweise die Hedgefonds), können ebenfalls die Hebelwirkung von Fremdkapital nutzen. Während der Einsatz von Leverage-Methoden die Chance auf höhere Gesamterträge bietet, steigt hiermit gleichzeitig das Potenzial höherer Verluste. Wenn Erträge und Wertsteigerungen von Anlagen, die mit geliehenen Mitteln erzielt wurden, die Kosten der Fremdkapitalstrategie jedoch nicht decken, so wird der Wert des Nettovermögens der zugriffsbeschränkten Konten der Gesellschaft sowie auch der Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente sinken. Entsprechend würde jedes Ereignis, das sich negativ auf den Wert einer Anlage der Gesellschaft oder einer der zugrunde liegenden Anlagestrategien und Hedgefonds, über die sie direkt oder indirekt Anlagen tätigt, auswirkt, in Höhe der eingesetzten Hebelwirkung um ein Vielfaches verstärkt werden. Durch ein eventuell hohes Maß an Fremdfinanzierung kann die Gesellschaft dem Risiko ausgesetzt sein, dass die zugrunde liegenden Investments in einem frühen Stadium Verluste ausweisen. (c) Der kumulative Effekt von Leverage-Methoden in Märkten, die sich anders als erwartet entwickeln, könnte in erheblichen Verlusten resultieren, die größer wären, als wenn keine Leverage-Methoden eingesetzt worden wären. (d) In der Regel involvieren Leverage-Transaktionen die Hinterlegung von Sicherheitsleistungen. Höhere Margin- oder ähnliche Zahlungen könnten dazu führen, dass Geschäfte zu Zeitpunkten oder Preisen getätigt werden müssen, die für die Gesellschaft oder die zugrunde liegenden Anlagevehikel, über die direkt oder indirekt Anlagen getätigt werden, nachteilig sein könnten und in erheblichen Verlusten resultieren könnten. (e) Die Anlagestrategien können zum Teil den Einsatz von umfangreichen Leverage-Methoden vorsehen. Es gibt keine Garantie, dass diese Fremdkapitalvereinbarungen jederzeit zur Verfügung stehen, und ein Verlust oder die Einschränkung der Fremdkapitalvereinbarungen in Bezug auf eine Aktienklasse dürfte möglicherweise zur Folge haben, dass die Gesellschaft 52 ihr gesamtes Anlage-Engagement reduzieren muss. Die Bedingungen, zu denen Leverage-Möglichkeiten genutzt werden können, unterliegen Veränderungen. (f) Als Folge der Fremdfinanzierungen können die Zinsaufwendungen einen erheblichen Prozentsatz der Vermögenswerte eines zugriffsbeschränkten Kontos ausmachen. Zinsaufwendungen könnten bedingen, dass eine Aktienklasse ihr Engagement in der entsprechenden Anlagestrategie reduzieren muss. Selbst wenn relativ geringe Verluste erzielt werden oder die Gewinne nicht ausreichen, um die Aufwendungen zu decken, könnte das für die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares verfügbare Handelskapital durch den Einsatz von Leverage schnell erschöpft oder das Gewinnpotenzial einer solchen Klasse ausgelöscht werden. (g) Es ist nicht gewährleistet, dass eine Fremdkapitalvereinbarung verlängert wird. Insbesondere ist es möglich, dass keine Dritten als Fremdkapitalgeber zur Verfügung stehen und die Man Group selbst aufsichtsrechtlichen, geschäftlichen oder sonstigen Beschränkungen unterliegt, die dazu führen, dass eine Fremdkapitalvereinbarung nicht angeboten oder erneuert wird. Zudem sind Fremdkapitalvereinbarungen möglicherweise gemäß ihren Bedingungen vorzeitig kündbar und können von einem Kontrahenten gekündigt werden. Ein Verlust, eine Beendigung oder eine Herabsetzung einer Fremdkapitalvereinbarung kann zur Folge haben, dass die Gesellschaft das Investment Exposure der Fond-Komponenten herunterfahren muss, was eine entsprechende Verminderung der Renditeerwartungen der Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares zur Folge haben könnte. Bei der Erneuerung einer Fremdkapitalvereinbarung werden möglicherweise geänderte Bedingungen für diese Fremdkapitalvereinbarung ausgehandelt, insbesondere, jedoch nicht nur, eine Veränderung der geltenden Zinsspannen. Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. in äußerst volatile Märkte können nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente haben Die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares und die Hedgefonds können in eine breite Palette an Vermögenswerten investieren, unter anderem in Aktien anderer Gesellschaften, Anleihen und Derivate. Die Preise dieser Vermögenswerte und insbesondere der Derivate, darunter Futures, Forwards und Optionen auf Wertpapiere, Währungen und Rohstoffe sind insgesamt höchst volatil. So werden zum Beispiel die Preisbewegungen von Forward-Kontrakten, Futures-Kontrakten und anderen Derivate-Kontrakten, in die die Fonds-Komponente direkt oder indirekt investieren kann, unter anderem von Zinssätzen, wechselnden Angebots- und Nachfrageverhältnissen, Handels-, Steuer-, fiskalischen, geldpolitischen und Wechselkurs-Kontrollprogrammen und Politiken der Regierungen und internationalen politischen und wirtschaftlichen Ereignissen und Regelungen beeinflusst. Zudem 53 intervenieren Regierungen gelegentlich direkt oder durch Rechtssetzungsakte in bestimmte Märkte, insbesondere bei währungs- und zinssatzbezogenen Futures und Optionen. Diese Interventionen sind häufig dazu bestimmt, Preise unmittelbar zu beeinflussen und können zusammen mit anderen Faktoren zu einer raschen Bewegung solcher Märkte in ein und dieselbe Richtung unter anderem aufgrund der Schwankungen beim Zinssatz führen. Die Fonds-Komponente ist darüber hinaus dem Risiko der Schließung einer der Börsen, an denen ihre Positionen gehandelt werden, bzw. deren Clearingstellen ausgesetzt. Die Konzentration von Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. kann nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente haben Die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares und die Hedgefonds können ihre Investitionen auf wenige Wertpapiere, Branchen oder Länder konzentrieren. Obwohl eine Risikostreuung über eine Reihe von Hedgefonds-Strategien und –Arten durch eine große Anzahl von unterschiedlichen Hedgefonds-Managern beabsichtigt ist, kann die Konzentration durch einzelne Hedgefonds einen proportional höheren Verlust verursachen, als wenn die Anlage über eine große Anzahl von Investitionen verteilt worden wäre. Darüber hinaus können auf Anraten des Investment Managers Investitionen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares konzentriert werden und ein erheblicher Teil der Vermögenswerte in Wertpapieren eines einzelnen Emittenten oder eines einzelnen Landes angelegt werden. In dem Umfang, in dem eine Konzentration in dieser Weise erfolgt, können nachteilige Entwicklungen im Geschäft eines solchen Emittenten oder eines Landes oder im Verhältnis zur Währung, auf welche die Wertpapiere lauten, erheblich größere Gesamtfolgen auslösen, als wenn die Konzentration der Investitionen nicht in diesem Umfang erfolgt wäre. Jeder Verlust auf Grund einer solchen Konzentration kann sich wesentlich nachteilig auf den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und somit den Wert der Zertifikate auswirken. Das mit den Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. verbundene Gegenparteirisiko kann nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert Fonds-Komponente haben (a) Anlagen werden in Bezug auf die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares grundsätzlich zwischen der Gesellschaft und dem Broker, der auf eigene Rechnung handelt (und nicht als Vertreter), getätigt. Entsprechend ist diese Aktienklasse der Gesellschaft dem Risiko ausgesetzt, das der Broker im Falle der Insolvenz oder eines ähnlichen Ereignisses nicht in der Lage ist, seine vertraglichen Verpflichtungen in Bezug auf diese Aktienklasse gegenüber der Gesellschaft zu erfüllen. Die zugrunde liegenden Anlageinstrumente, über die die Gesellschaft direkt oder indirekt Anlagen tätigt, können hinsichtlich der eingesetzten Broker ähnliche oder größere Risiken tragen. (b) Die Gesellschaft (und jegliche sonstigen zugrunde liegenden Anlagevehikel, über die die Gesellschaft direkt oder indirekt Anlagen tätigt) trägt ein 54 Gegenparteirisiko in Bezug auf die von ihr gehaltenen Over-the-CounterInstrumente. Im Falle der Insolvenz einer Gegenpartei oder eines Brokers, über den der Investment Manager oder ein Anlageberater auf Rechnung der Gesellschaft handelt, rangiert die Gesellschaft möglicherweise als unbesicherter Gläubiger in Bezug auf die aus einem Margin-Konto oder anderweitig an den Teilfonds zahlbaren Gelder; jegliche derartige Verluste trägt das entsprechende zugriffsbeschränkte Konto (segregated account) der Gesellschaft. (c) Die Gesellschaft und die Anlageberater können auch Währungs-, Zins-, Total-Return- oder andere Swaps abschließen, die als Ersatz für andere Instrumente wie Devisen-Forwardkontrakte oder Zinsoptionen dienen können. Der Wert dieser Instrumente hängt grundsätzlich von den Preisbewegungen der zu Grunde liegenden Vermögenswerte sowie vom Gegenparteirisiko ab. Die zugrunde liegenden Anlageinstrumente, über die die Gesellschaft direkt oder indirekt Anlagen tätigt, können hinsichtlich ihrer Anlagen ähnliche oder größere Risiken tragen. Die mit den Anlagen der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. verbundenen Zins- und Wechselkursrisiken können nachteilige Auswirkungen auf den Wert des Zertifikats haben Die Gesellschaft ist bei ihren Aktivitäten Zins- und/oder Wechselkursrisiken ausgesetzt. Soweit sich die geltenden Wechselkurse oder Zinsen ändern, könnte sich dies negativ auf den Nettoinventarwert je Fonds-Komponente auswirken. Auch wenn die Gesellschaft bestrebt ist, Zins- und/oder Wechselkursrisiken auszuschalten, können solche Risiken weiter bestehen. Die komplexen Systeme und Programme, die zur Reduzierung des Zins- und/oder Wechselkursrisikos eingesetzt werden, können dazu führen, dass Geschäfte ausgeführt werden, die im Nachhinein nicht notwendig waren und/oder zu einer verzögerten Ausführung oder der Nichtausführung von Transaktionen, die im Nachhinein doch angemessen gewesen wären. Unter solchen Umständen mindern die entstehenden Verluste den Wert der Fonds-Komponente und damit den Wert der Zertifikate. Zudem können die zugrunde liegenden Anlageinstrumente, über die die Gesellschaft direkt oder indirekt Anlagen tätigt, hinsichtlich ihrer Anlagen ähnliche oder größere Risiken tragen. Die Bewertung der Vermögenswerte, auf denen die Fonds-Komponente basiert, spiegelt nicht unbedingt den Marktwert der Vermögenswerte wieder Die Bewertung von Wertpapieren, in welche die Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. – Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares oder die Hedgefonds investieren können, werden gemäß den Regelungen des jeweiligen Hedgefonds für solche Bewertungen vorgenommen. Im Allgemeinen sehen die geltenden Bestimmungen von Hedgefonds vor, dass Wertpapiere oder Investments, die illiquide sind, nicht an Börsen oder auf einem etablierten Markt gehandelt werden oder für die nicht ohne Weiteres ein Wert bestimmt werden kann, ein solcher angemessener Wert beigemessen wird, den der jeweiliger Investmentmanager nach seiner Beurteilung auf Basis verschiedener Faktoren bestimmt. Zu diesen Faktoren gehören, insbesondere Händler- Quotierungen oder unabhängige Bewertungen. 55 Solche Bewertungen geben unter Umständen nicht den tatsächlichen Verkehrswert wieder, der sich in einem aktiven, liquiden oder etablierten Markt ergeben würde. Der Wert der Fonds-Komponente kann überholt sein Der Wert der Fonds-Komponente für einen bestimmten Tag wird jeweils in Bezug auf einen bestimmten Tag berechnet, jedoch nicht an diesem Tag veröffentlicht. Daher bestehen immer erhebliche Verzögerung zwischen der entsprechenden Bewertung und Berechnung und der Veröffentlichung der entsprechenden Daten. Somit kann nicht ausgeschlossen werden, dass wesentliche Informationen einschließlich des Werts der Fonds-Komponente zum Zeitpunkt ihrer Veröffentlichung wesentlich veraltet sind. Da sich der Wert der Fonds-Komponente zudem fortlaufend ändert, kann nicht sichergestellt werden, dass die veröffentlichten Informationen den tatsächlichen Wert der Fonds-Komponente zu einem Tag nach einer solchen Veröffentlichung richtig wiedergeben. Die Bewertung der Fonds-Komponente kann zudem unter Umständen ausgesetzt werden. 56 ALLGEMEINE INFORMATIONEN ÜBER DAS ANGEBOT UND DIE ZERTIFIKATE Gegenstand des Prospekts Gegenstand dieses Prospekts sind die von Morgan Stanley B.V. als "Emittentin" begebenen bis zu 75.000 kapitalgeschützte apano AP Enhanced Garant 2 Garantiezertifikate bezogen auf eine Aktie der Klasse T2 (Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares) (die "Fonds-Komponente") der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. (die "Gesellschaft"), deren Rückzahlung werden von der Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc, 25 Cabot Square, Canary Wharf, London, E 14 4 QA, Großbritannien berechnet. Die Laufzeit der Zertifikate beginnt mit ihrer Ausgabe am 15. Mai 2008 (der "Ausgabetag") und endet, vorbehaltlich eines vorzeitigen Verkaufs oder dem Eintritt eines Kündigungsereignisses, am 15. Februar 2023 (der "Fälligkeitstag"). Die Zertifikate begründen unbesicherte und nicht nachrangige Verbindlichkeiten der Emittentin, die untereinander und mit allen gegenwärtigen und zukünftigen unbesicherten und nicht nachrangigen Verbindlichkeiten der Emittentin, abgesehen von solchen Verbindlichkeiten, denen auf Grund zwingender gesetzlicher Bestimmungen der Vorrang zukommt, gleichrangig sind. Morgan Stanley (die "Garantin") hat eine unbedingte und unwiderrufliche Garantie (die "Garantie") für die vertragsgemäße Zahlung auf die Zertifikate zahlbarer Beträge übernommen. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbar gegen die Garantin bestehende und durchsetzbare Ansprüche der Zertifikatsinhaber. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbare, unbedingte, nichtnachrangige und unbesicherte Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, die jederzeit zumindest gleichrangig sind mit allen sonstigen gegenwärtigen und zukünftigen unmittelbaren, unbedingten, nichtnachrangigen und unbesicherten Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, mit Ausnahme solcher Verbindlichkeiten, die kraft zwingender gesetzlicher Bestimmungen vorrangig sind. Wertpapierkennummer ("WKN") / ISIN der Zertifikate WKN: MS5DHK ISIN: DE000MS5DHK0 57 Billigung des Prospekts Der vorliegende Prospekt wurde von der Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht ("BaFin") als Wertpapieraufsichtsbehörde der Bundesrepublik Deutschland gemäß dem Wertpapierprospektgesetz vom 22. Juni 2005 ("WpPG"), das die Richtlinie 2003/71/EG (die "Prospektrichtlinie") in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland in geltendes Recht umsetzt, gebilligt. EWR-Pass Die Emittentin behält sich vor, für bestimmte Länder des Europäischen Wirtschaftsraums ("EWR") die Bescheinigung der Billigung des Prospekts nach dem WpPG bei der BaFin zu beantragen, um die Zertifikate auch in diesen Ländern öffentlich anbieten zu können und/oder dort ggf. auch eine Zulassung zum Handel an einem organisierten Markt (im Sinne der Richtlinie 93/22/EWG) zu erreichen (der "EWR-Pass"). Eine besondere Erlaubnis zum Angebot der Zertifikate oder zum Verteilen des Prospekts in einer Rechtsordnung außerhalb der Länder, für die ein EWR-Pass möglich und in der eine Erlaubnis erforderlich ist, wurde nicht eingeholt. Ausgabe der Zertifikate und öffentliches Angebot Im Zeitraum vom 15. Februar 2008 bis zum 8. April 2008, 16:00 Uhr Frankfurter Zeit, werden die Zertifikate im Rahmen eines öffentlichen Angebots in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland von der Emittentin zum anfänglichen Ausgabepreis von 1.000 Euro (zuzüglich eines Agios von bis zu 60 Euro) angeboten. Die Emittentin behält sich das Recht vor die Angebotsfrist gegebenenfalls bis zum 18. April 2008, 16:00 Uhr Frankfurter Zeit, zu verlängern. Eine Zeichnung der Zertifikate ist nur mit einem Mindestzeichnungsbetrag in Höhe von 10.000 Euro (dies entspricht 10 Zertifikaten) möglich. Anschließend werden sie während der gesamten Laufzeit zum freibleibenden Verkauf zu den vorherrschenden Marktpreisen weiterhin öffentlich angeboten. Die Emittentin ist nicht verpflichtet, gezeichnete Zertifikate auch zu emittieren. Die Emissionswährung ist Euro. Die Lieferung der verkauften Zertifikate erfolgt gemäß den anwendbaren örtlichen Marktusancen über Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt. 58 Verkaufsbeschränkungen Verkaufsbeschränkungen innerhalb des EWR In einem Mitgliedstaat des Europäischen Wirtschaftsraums, der die Prospektrichtlinie umgesetzt hat (jeweils ein "maßgeblicher Mitgliedstaat"), dürfen die Zertifikate ab dem Tag der Umsetzung der Prospektrichtlinie in dem maßgeblichen Mitgliedstaat (der "maßgebliche Umsetzungstag") (einschließlich) nicht mehr öffentliche angeboten werden, es sei denn, ab dem maßgeblichen Umsetzungstag (einschließlich) ist in dem maßgeblichen Mitgliedstaat ein öffentliches Angebot der Zertifikaten nach Maßgabe des Nachstehenden zulässig: (a) sofern nach den Zertifikatsbedingungen ein Angebot der Zertifikate außerhalb des Anwendungsbereichs des Art. 3 Abs. 2 der Prospektrichtlinie zulässig ist (ein sog. "Nicht–befreites Angebot"), darf ein Angebot in dem Zeitraum erfolgen der in dem Prospekt oder den Zertifikatsbedingungen genannt ist. Dieser Zeitraum beginnt frühestens am Tag nach der Veröffentlichung eines Prospekts für die Zertifikate, welcher von der zuständigen Behörde dieses maßgeblichen Mitgliedstaats gebilligt wurde bzw. in einem anderen Mitgliedstaat gebilligt wurde und von dessen Billigung die zuständige Behörde des maßgeblichen Mitgliedstaats unterrichtet wurde und vorausgesetzt, daß ein solcher Prospekt (jeweils nach Maßgabe der Prospektrichtlinie), nachfolgend durch die endgültigen Bedingungen unter Berücksichtigung des "Nicht–befreiten Angebots" vervollständigt wurde; (b) das öffentliche Angebot darf jederzeit erfolgen, wenn es gegenüber juristischen Personen erfolgt, die in Bezug auf ihre Tätigkeit auf den Finanzmärkten zugelassen sind bzw. beaufsichtigt werden oder, sofern sie weder zugelassen sind noch beaufsichtigt werden, deren einziger Geschäftszweck in der Wertpapieranlage besteht; (c) das öffentliche Angebot darf jederzeit erfolgen, wenn es gegenüber juristischen Personen erfolgt, die zwei oder mehr der folgenden Kriterien erfüllen: (1) eine durchschnittliche Beschäftigtenzahl im letzten Geschäftsjahr von mindestens 250, (2) eine Gesamtbilanzsumme von mindestens 43.000.000 Euro und (3) ein Jahresnettoumsatz, ausgewiesen im letzten Jahres- oder Konzernabschluß, von über 50.000.000 Euro; (d) das öffentliche Angebot darf jederzeit erfolgen, wenn es gegenüber weniger als 100 natürlichen oder juristischen Personen erfolgt die keine qualifizierten Investoren im Sinne der Prospektrichtlinie sind; oder (e) das öffentliche Angebot darf jederzeit unter anderen Umständen erfolgen, unter denen die Emittentin oder der für die Emittentin handelnde Platzeur nicht gemäß Art. 3 Abs. 2 der Prospektrichtlinie wie in (b) bis (e) beschrieben, verpflichtet ist, einen Prospekt entsprechend Art. 3 oder eines Nachtrags nach Art. 16 der Prospektrichtlinie zu veröffentlichen. 59 Für die Zwecke dieser Bestimmung bezeichnet der Ausdruck "öffentliches Angebot von Zertifikaten" in Bezug auf Zertifikate in einem maßgeblichen Mitgliedstaat eine Mitteilung in jedweder Form und auf jedwede Art und Weise, die ausreichende Informationen über die Angebotsbedingungen und die anzubietenden Zertifikate enthält, um einen Anleger in die Lage zu versetzen, sich für den Kauf oder die Zeichnung der Zertifikate zu entscheiden, wobei diese Bestimmungen in dem betreffenden Mitgliedstaat aufgrund einer Maßnahme zur Umsetzung der Prospektrichtlinie durch den Mitgliedstaat geändert werden können, und "Prospektrichtlinie" bezeichnet die Richtlinie 2003/71/EG und schließt jede maßgebliche Umsetzungsmaßnahme in jedem maßgeblichen Mitgliedstaat ein. Verkaufsbeschränkungen außerhalb des EWR In einem Staat außerhalb des EWR dürfen die Zertifikate innerhalb dessen Rechtsordnung oder mit Ausgangspunkt in dessen Rechtsordnung nur öffentlich angeboten, verkauft oder geliefert werden, wenn dies gemäß der anwendbaren Gesetze und sonstigen Rechtsvorschriften zulässig ist und der Emittentin keinerlei Verpflichtungen entstehen. Die Emittentin hat keine Maßnahmen ergriffen und wird keinerlei Maßnahmen ergreifen, um das öffentliche Angebot der Zertifikate oder ihren Besitz oder den Vertrieb von Angebotsunterlagen in Bezug auf die Zertifikate in dieser Rechtsordnung zulässig zu machen, falls zu diesem Zweck besondere Maßnahmen ergriffen werden müssen. Die Zertifikate (oder Rechte hieran) sind nicht unter dem United States Securities Act of 1933 in seiner jeweiligen Fassung (der "Securities Act") registriert worden und werden nicht entsprechend registriert werden; ferner ist der Handel in den Zertifikaten durch die United States Commodity Futures Trading Commission nicht nach dem United States Commodity Exchange Act in seiner jeweiligen Fassung genehmigt worden, noch wird er entsprechend genehmigt werden. Die Zertifikate (oder jedes Recht hieran) werden nur außerhalb der Vereinigten Staaten und nur Personen angeboten, die keine U.S.-Personen im Sinne der entsprechenden Definition der Regulation S des Securities Act sind. Verbriefung Die Zertfikate werden im Sinne der U.S. Treasury Regulation § 1.163-5(c) (2) (i) (D) anfänglich durch eine vorläufige Globalurkunde (die "Vorläufige Dauerglobalurkunde") verbrieft, die gegen eine die Zertifikate verbriefende Dauerglobalurkunde (die "Dauerglobalurkunde") nicht früher als 40 Tage und nicht später als 180 Tage nach dem Abschluss der Platzierung der Zertifikate gegen Nachweis des Nichtbestehens einer U.S.-Inhaberschaft (certification of non U.S. beneficial ownership) ausgetauscht wird. Die Vorläufige Dauerglobalurkunde bzw. die Dauerglobalurkunde werden jeweils bei Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt am Main, Neue Börsenstraße 1, 60487 Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland (das "Clearingsystem") hinterlegt. Ansprüche auf Lieferung effektiver Stücke werden ausgeschlossen. Die Zertifikate sind nach dem 60 jeweils anwendbaren Recht und gegebenenfalls den jeweils geltenden Vorschriften und Verfahren des Clearingsystems übertragbar. Zahlstelle Zahlstelle ist die Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft, Große Gallusstrasse 10-14, 60272 Frankfurt am Main, Deutschland. Verwendung der Emissionserlöse Die Erlöse aus der Ausgabe der Zertifikate (ohne Agio) in Höhe von bis zu Euro 75.000.000 werden ausschließlich für die Erfüllung der Zahlungsverpflichtungen der Emittentin und zu Zwecken der üblichen Geschäftstätigkeit der Emittentin verwendet. Verantwortung Die Emittentin übernimmt die Verantwortung für den Inhalt dieses Prospekts und erklärt, dass ihres Wissens die im Prospekt genannten Angaben richtig sind und keine wesentlichen Umstände ausgelassen wurden. Sofern Angaben von Seiten Dritter übernommen wurden, bestätigt die Emittentin, dass diese Angaben korrekt wiedergegeben wurden und dass — soweit es der Emittentin bekannt ist und sie aus den von dieser dritten Partei veröffentlichten Informationen ableiten konnte — keine Tatsachen unterschlagen wurden, die die wiedergegebenen Informationen unkorrekt oder irreführend gestalten würden. Im Zusammenhang mit der Ausgabe und dem Verkauf der Zertifikate ist niemand berechtigt, irgendwelche Informationen zu verbreiten oder Erklärungen abzugeben, die nicht in diesem Prospekt enthalten sind. Für Informationen, die nicht in diesem Prospekt enthalten sind, lehnt die Emittentin jegliche Haftung ab. Die hierin enthaltenen Informationen beziehen sich auf das Datum des Prospekts und können aufgrund später eingetretener Veränderungen unrichtig und/oder unvollständig geworden sein. Im Falle von wesentlichen Änderungen des Prospekts wird die Emittentin einen Nachtrag zum Prospekt erstellen. Beschluss des Board of Directors Die Emittentin wird die Begebung der bis zu 75.000 kapitalgeschützte apano AP Enhanced Garant 2 Garantiezertifikate bezogen auf eine Aktie der Klasse T2 (Man AP 61 Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares) der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. am 8. Februar 2008 beschliessen. Bereithaltung des Prospekts und sonstiger Unterlagen Dieser Prospekt wird gemäß § 14 des Wertpapierprospektgesetzes veröffentlicht und ist in dieser Form von der Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht gebilligt worden. Die Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht hat neben der formellen Vollständigkeit dieses Prospekts die Kohärenz und Verständlichkeit der vorgelegten Informationen überprüft. Die Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht hat keine Prüfung der inhaltlichen Richtigkeit vorgenommen. Die folgenden Dokumente werden in physischer und elektronischer Form während der gewöhnlichen Geschäftszeiten an jedem Werktag zur Einsicht bei Morgan Stanley in 1585 Broadway, New York, New York 10036, U.S.A. Tel: +1 (212) 761 4000 und bei Morgan Stanley B.V. in Locatellikade 1, 1076 AZ Amsterdam, The Netherlands, Tel: +31 20 57 55 600 bereitgehalten: • dieser Prospekt einschließlich möglicher Nachträge, • in Bezug auf die Emittentin: die Satzung der Emittentin, der Jahresbericht (Annual Report and Accounts) der Emittentin zum 30. November 2006 und der Jahresbericht (Annual Report and Accounts) der Emittentin zum 30. November 2006, • in Bezug auf die Garantin: die Satzung der Garantin, die Garantie (die Satzung und die Garantie sind nicht bei der obigen Adresse von Morgan Stanley B.V. erhältlich), der Jahresbericht (Annual Report, Form 10-K) der Garantin zum 30. November 2006 und der Jahresbericht (Annual Report, Form 10-K) der Garantin zum 30. November 2007 in englischer Sprache. Der Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente kann bei der Man Capital Markets AG, Distribution Germany, Huobstrasse 3, 8808 Pfäffikon SZ, Schweiz, Tel: +41 (0)55 417 6350, Fax: +41 (0)55 417 6351 erfragt werden, bei der zudem Informationen über die Wertentwicklung und Volatilität der Fonds-Komponente erhältlich sind. Ausgabe von Berichten im Anschluss an die Emission Die Emittentin beabsichtigt, mit Ausnahme der in den Zertifikatsbedingungen genannten Bekanntmachungen, keine Veröffentlichung von Informationen nach erfolgter Emission. 62 BESCHREIBUNG DER EMITTENTIN Wirtschaftsprüfer Die Wirtschaftsprüfer von Morgan Stanley B.V. ("MSBV" oder die "Emittentin") für die Berichtszeiträume 1. Dezember 2005 bis 30. November 2006 und 1. Dezember 2006 bis 30. November 2007 waren Deloitte Accountants B.V, Orlyplein 10, 1043 DP Amsterdam, Niederlande, eine eingetragene Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (die "Wirtschaftsprüfer"). Die Wirtschaftsprüfer von MSBV sind Mitglied des niederländischen Wirtschaftsprüferverbands Nederlands Instituut van Registeraccountants. Ausgewählte Finanzinformationen Die Netto-Umsatzerlöse zu den jeweiligen Bilanzstichtagen am 30. November 2007 und 2006 beliefen sich auf 2.962.000 Euro bzw. 1.075.000 Euro, und setzten sich zusammen aus Provisionen für die Ausgabe von Finanzinstrumenten abzüglich der Verbindlichkeiten für Garantiegebühren. In den Geschäftsjahren mit Bilanzstichtag 30. November 2007 und 2006 wurde ein Ergebnis vor Steuern in Höhe von 2.197.000 Euro bzw. 775.000 Euro Gewinn ausgewiesen. Im Berichtszeitraum wurden keine Dividenden ausgeschüttet. Das Umlaufvermögen von MSBV stieg von 3.893.257.000 Euro in 2006 auf 10.182.479.000 Euro in 2007, und die gesamten Verbindlichkeiten von 3.893.257.000 Euro in 2006 auf 10.182.479.000 Euro in 2007. Hauptgrund für diesen Verschuldungsanstieg war eine höhere Kundennachfrage nach Finanzinstrumenten. Geschichte und Entwicklung Morgan Stanley B.V. wurde am 6. September 2001 nach dem Recht der Niederlande als Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung auf unbegrenzte Dauer errichtet. MSBV ist beim Handelsregister der Industrie- und Handelskammer Amsterdam unter Registernummer 34161590 eintragen, mit Sitz in Locatellikade 1, 1076 AZ Amsterdam, Niederlande, Telefon: + 31 205755600. MSBV ist nach den Gesetzen der Niederlande gegründet und diese sind für sie anwendbar. 63 Investitionen Alle wesentlichen Aktiva von MSBV sind Verpflichtungen von (oder Wertpapiere ausgegeben von) einer oder mehreren Gesellschaften der Morgan Stanley Gruppe. MSBV hat seit dem Datum des zuletzt veröffentlichten Abschlusses keine wesentlichen Anlagen getätigt. Hauptaktivitäten Die wesentliche Haupttätigkeit von MSBV liegt in der Ausgabe von Anleihen, Optionsscheinen und anderen Wertpapieren. Hauptmärkte MSBV agiert aus den Niederlanden heraus und gibt Anleihen, Optionsscheinen und andere Wertpapiere im Wesentlichen für den europäischen Markt aus. Organisatorische Struktur MSBV hat keine Tochtergesellschaften. Oberstes beherrschendes Unternehmen ist Morgan Stanley. Morgan Stanley ist eine Holdinggesellschaft, die ihre Produkte und Dienstleistungen über ihre Tochtergesellschaften und verbundenen Unternehmen einer großen Gruppe verschiedener Kunden anbietet, darunter Unternehmen, Regierungen, Finanzinstitute und Privatpersonen. Zu Morgan Stanleys US-amerikanischen und internationalen Tochtergesellschaften gehören Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (früher "Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited"), Morgan Stanley Japan Securities Co., Ltd. (früher "Morgan Stanley Japan Limited") und Morgan Stanley Investment Advisors Inc. Am 1. April 2007 verschmolz Morgan Stanley Morgan Stanley DW Inc. in Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated. Nach Vollendung der Fusion, wurde die fortbestehende Gesellschaft Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated der wichtigste US-Broker-Dealer von Morgan Stanley. Trend Informationen MSBV plant weiterhin die Ausgabe von Wertpapieren und den Abschluss von HedgeTransaktionen im Hinblick auf solche Wertpapieremissionen. Seit dem 30. November 2007 hat es keine wesentlichen negativen Veränderungen in den Aussichten der Emittentin gegeben. 64 Verwaltungs-, Geschäftsführungs- und Aufsichtsorgane Die derzeitigen Directors von MSBV, ihre Ämter bei MSBV und ihre wichtigste externe Tätigkeit sind jeweils gegebenenfalls nachstehend angegeben. Die Geschäftsadresse jedes Directors ist Locatellikade 1, 1076 AZ Amsterdam, Niederlande. Name Titel Charles Edward Managing Director Crossley Hood Joe Solan Executive Director Ger De Boer Managing Director TMF Management B.V. Managing Director Wichtigste externe Tätigkeit Managing Director, Morgan Stanley Executive Director, Morgan Stanley Executive Director und Sales Director, Morgan Stanley Investment Management Directors von TMF Management B.V. Robert Willem de Managing Director Koning Franciscus Adrianus Managing Director Josephus van Oers Timo Johannes van Rijn Managing Director Maria Christina van der Managing Director Sluijs-Plantz Jan Reint de Vos van Managing Director Steenwijk Johan Versluis Managing Director Mitarbeiter B.V. Mitarbeiter B.V. Mitarbeiter B.V. Mitarbeiter B.V. Mitarbeiter B.V. Mitarbeiter B.V. von TMF Nederland von TMF Nederland von TMF Nederland von TMF Nederland von TMF Nederland von TMF Nederland Es gibt keine bestehenden oder potenziellen Interessenkonflikte zwischen den der MSBV geschuldeten Pflichten (wie oben beschrieben) und den privaten Interessen und/oder externen Pflichten der vorgenannten Personen. Board Practice Nach eigener Einschätzung erfüllt MSBV alle für sie geltenden niederländischen Corporate-Governance-Gesetze. 65 Zum Datum dieses Prospekts hat MSBV keinen Prüfungsausschuss eingesetzt. Der Abschluss von MSBV wird vom Board of Directors genehmigt. Anteilinhaber Oberstes beherrschendes Unternehmen von MSBV ist Morgan Stanley. MSBV sind keine Kontrollmaßnahmen in Bezug auf diese Beherrschung durch den Gesellschafter bekannt. Alle Entscheidungen über die Ausgabe von Wertpapieren trifft das Board of Directors, und MSBV vereinnahmt einen Spread auf alle Wertpapieremissionen. Stammkapital Das genehmigte Stammkapital von MSBV setzt sich aus 900 Stammanteilen in Höhe von 100 Euro zusammen. Das ausgegebene, zugeteilte und voll eingezahlte Stammkapital von MSBV setzt sich aus 180 Stammanteilen in Höhe von 100 Euro zusammen. Gesellschaftsurkunde und Satzung Ziel und Zweck von MSBV sind in Artikel 3 der Satzung festgelegt und versetzen das Unternehmen in die Lage, Optionsscheine, Derivate, Zertifikate, Schuldverschreibungen, Aktien und/oder ähnliche Wertpapiere oder Instrumente auszugeben, zu verkaufen, zu kaufen, zu übertragen und entgegenzunehmen, und Hedging-Vereinbarungen im Zusammenhang mit solchen Wertpapieren und Instrumenten abzuschließen. Ferner liegen die Unternehmensziele in der Finanzierung von Aktivitäten und Gesellschaften, der Kreditaufnahme und –ausreichung und Mittelbeschaffung, sowie im Abschluss von Verträgen im Zusammenhang mit dem Vorstehenden, in der Ausreichung von Garantien, dem Abschluss verbindlicher Verträge für die Gesellschaft und der Verpfändung ihrer Vermögenswerte für Verpflichtungen der Gesellschaften und Unternehmen, mit denen es im Konzernverbund steht, sowie im Namen Dritter und im Handel mit Devisen, Wertpapieren und Eigentumsanteilen allgemein. Finanzinformationen über die Vermögens-, Finanz- und Ertragslage der Emittentin Hinsichtlich der Darstellung der Vermögens-, Finanz- und Ertragslage von MSBV als Emittentin wird auf die Jahresberichte (Annual Reports and Account) der Emittentin für die Geschäftsjahre 2006 und 2007 in englischer Sprache verwiesen. In diesem 66 Zusammenhang entspricht das Wirtschaftsjahr der Garantin jeweils dem Zeitraum vom 1. Dezember bis zum 30. November eines Kalenderjahres. Sämtliche diesbezüglich darin enthaltenen, von den Wirtschaftsprüfern der Emittentin in Übereinstimmung mit United Kingdom Accounting Principles geprüften Finanzinformationen und Erläuterungen bilden einen integralen Bestandteil dieses Prospekts und sind damit inhaltlich in vollem Umfang in diesen Prospekt einbezogen. Für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2006 bis zum 30. November 2007 wird verwiesen auf: Balance Sheet, Seite 3 des Jahresberichts Bilanz: (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2007 Income Statement, Seite 2 des Gewinn und Verlustrechnung: Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2007 Cash Flow Statement, Seite 5 des Kapitalflussrechnung: Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2007 Notes to the Financial Statements, Erläuternde Anmerkungen: Seiten 6 ff. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2007 Für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2005 bis zum 30. November 2006 wird verwiesen auf: Balance Sheet, Seite 3 des Jahresberichts Bilanz: (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2006 Profit and Loss Account, Seite 2 des Gewinn und Verlustrechnung: Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2006 Cash Flow Statement, Seite 4 des Kapitalflussrechnung: Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2006 Notes to the Accounts, Seiten 5 ff. des Erläuternde Anmerkungen: Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2006 Die Emittentin veröffentlicht keine Quartalsberichte. Sämtliche in Hinblick auf die Emittentin durch Verweis einbezogenen Dokumente sind Bestandteile des Basisprospekts vom 22. Juni 2007 (Program for the Issuance of Notes, Series A and B) von Morgan Stanley als Emittentin und Garantin, Morgan Stanley (Jersey) Limited als Emittentin und Morgan Stanley B.V. als Emittentin, der von der Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht in Großbritannien (Financial Services Authority) in Übereinstimmung mit der Richtlinie 2003/71/EG vom 67 4. November 2003 bzw. deren Großbritannien gebilligt worden ist. maßgeblichen Umsetzungsvorschriften in Seit dem 30. November 2007 hat sich die Finanz- oder Handelsposition von MSBV nicht wesentlich geändert. Prüfung der historischen jährlichen Finanzinformationen Die Jahresberichte (Annual Reports and Accounts) der Emittentin für die Geschäftsjahre 2006 und 2007 wurden durch Deloitte Accountants B.V. als Wirtschaftsprüfer und in Übereinstimmung mit United Kingdom Accounting Principles geprüft: Der Prüfungsbericht (Auditor's Report) für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2005 bis zum 30. November 2006 findet sich auf den Seiten 14 f. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2006. Der Prüfungsbericht (Auditor's Report) für das Geschäftsjahr vom 1. Dezember 2006 bis zum 30. November 2007 findet sich auf der Seite 18 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report and Accounts) zum 30. November 2007. Schieds- und Gerichtsverfahren MSBV als Emittentin war während des Zwölfmonatszeitraums vor dem Datum dieses Prospekts nicht an staatlichen Interventionen, Gerichts- oder Schiedsgerichtsverfahren (einschließlich derjenigen Verfahren, die nach Kenntnis der Emittentin noch anhängig sind oder eingeleitet werden könnten) beteiligt, die sich erheblich auf die Finanzlage oder die Rentabilität der Emittentin und/oder der Gruppe auswirken bzw. in jüngster Zeit ausgewirkt haben. Wesentliche Verträge Außerhalb des normalen Geschäftsverlaufs sind keine wesentlichen Verträge abgeschlossen worden, die dazu führen könnten, dass jedwedes Mitglied der Gruppe der Emittentin einer Verpflichtung ausgesetzt ist oder ein Recht erlangt, die bzw. das für die Fähigkeit der Emittentin, ihren Verpflichtungen in Bezug auf die ausgegebenen Wertpapiere nachzukommen, von wesentlicher Bedeutung wäre. 68 BESCHREIBUNG DER GARANTIN Abschlussprüfer Die Abschlussprüfer von Morgan Stanley für die Geschäftsjahre vom 1. Dezember 2004 bis 30. November 2005, vom 1. Dezember 2005 bis 30. November 2006 und vom 1. Dezember 2006 bis 30. November 2007 waren Deloitte & Touche LLP, Two World Financial Center, New York, New York 10281, USA, eine unabhängige registrierte Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (die "Abschlussprüfer"). Am 12. Februar 2007 (in Verbindung mit der Anmerkung 1 - Eingestellte Geschäftsaktivitäten-Discover - und der Anmerkung 30 des Berichtes 8-K vom 25. Oktober 2007 – wie nachstehend erläutert) haben die Abschlußprüfer im Hinblick auf die nachstehenden Punkte (i), (ii) und (iii) einen uneingeschränkten Bestätigungsvermerk erteilt: (i) die Bilanzen (Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition) von Morgan Stanley vom 30. November 2006 und 2005 und die entsprechenden Gewinn- und Verlustrechnungen (Consolidated Statements of Income), die Kapitalflussrechnung (Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows) und die Veränderungen des Eigenkapitals für die Geschäftsjahre, die am 30. November 2004, 2005 bzw. 2006 endeten, (ii) den diesbezüglichen Bericht von Morgan Stanley und (iii) die Einschätzung des Vorstandes betreffend die Effektivität der internen Kontrollmechanismen bezüglich des Rechnungswesens. Am 28. Januar 2008 haben die Abschlussprüfer im Hinblick auf die nachstehenden Punkte (i), (ii) und (iii) einen uneingeschränkten Bestätigungsvermerk erteilt: (i) die Bilanzen (Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition) von Morgan Stanley vom 30. November 2007 und 2006 und die entsprechenden Gewinn- und Verlustrechnungen (Consolidated Statements of Income), die Kapitalflussrechnung (Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows) und die Veränderungen des Eigenkapitals für die Geschäftsjahre, die am 30. November 2005, 2006 bzw. 2007 endeten, (ii) den diesbezüglichen Bericht von Morgan Stanley und (iii) den Vorstandsbericht über die Effektivität der Kontrollmechanismen bezüglich des Rechnungswesens. internen Morgan Stanley hat den vorgenannten Bericht auf Formular 8-K vom 25. Oktober 2007 hauptsächlich deshalb eingereicht, um bestimmte Informationen in den historischen konsolidierten Bilanzen zu aktualisieren, welche auch im Hinblick auf 69 vorgenannte Anmerkungen 1 und 30 einer Aktualisierung aus folgenden Gründen bedurften: Am 30. Juni 2007 hat Morgan Stanley die Abspaltung (spin-off) der Discover Financial Services ("DFS") abgeschlossen. Morgan Stanley verteilte alle ausgegebenen Stammaktien der DFS (Nennbetrag von jeweils USD 0,01) an am 18. Juni 2007 eingetragene Aktionäre von Morgan Stanley. Dabei erhielten Morgan Stanleys Aktionäre für zwei Morgan Stanley gehaltene Stammaktien jeweils eine DFS Stammaktie. Die Aktionäre erhielten für Beträge, die geringer als eine ganze DFS Aktie waren, einen Ausgleichsbetrag in Geld. Morgan Stanley erhielt von der US-amerikanischen Finanzbehörde (Internal Revenue Service) einen Bescheid dahingehend, dass vorstehende Zuteilung an Morgan Stanleys Aktionäre für diese, unter Zugrundelegung gewöhnlicher Umstände, keine Steuerverpflichtung in Ansehung der US-Bundeseinkommenssteuer (US federal income tax) begründe. Das vollständige Formular 8-K vom 8. Oktober 2007 kann auf der Webseite der United States Securities and Exchange Commission under “www.sec.gov” eingesehen werden. Die vorgenannten Bestätigungsvermerke (einschließlich erläuternder Anmerkungen dazu) sind Teil von Morgan Stanleys Jahresabschlußberichte auf dem Formular 10-K für die Geschäftsjahre mit Ende 30. November 2007 und 30. November 2006. Die Abschlussprüfer sind beim Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (USA) registriert. Risikofaktoren Informationen über die Risikofaktoren in Verbindung mit Morgan Stanley sind dem Abschnitt "Risikofaktoren" in diesem Prospekt zu entnehmen. Angaben zu Morgan Stanley Geschichte und Entwicklung von Morgan Stanley Morgan Stanley wurde ursprünglich am 1. Oktober 1981 nach dem Recht des USBundesstaates Delaware auf unbegrenzte Dauer mit Registernummer 0923632 gegründet. Die Vorgängergesellschaften gehen bis auf das Jahr 1924 zurück. Am 31. Mai 1997 schloss sich die Morgan Stanley Group, Inc. in einer Fusion unter Gleichen mit Dean Witter Discover & Co. ("Dean Witter Discover") zusammen. Zu diesem Zeitpunkt änderte Dean Witter Discover den Firmennamen in Morgan Stanley, Dean Witter, Discover & Co. ("MSDWD"). Am 24. März 1998 wurde MSDWD in Morgan Stanley Dean Witter & Co und am 20. Juni 2002 in Morgan Stanley umbenannt. Sitz von Morgan Stanley ist The Corporation Trust Center, 1209 Orange Street, Wilmington, Delaware 19801, USA, und die Hauptverwaltung befindet sich in 1585 Broadway, New York, New York 10036, USA, Telefonnummer +1 (212) 761-4000. 70 Zum Datum dieses Prospekts ist „Morgan Stanley“ der juristische und kommerzielle Name von Morgan Stanley. Gründungsstatut / Auf Morgan Stanley anwendbares Recht Morgan Stanley unterliegt sowohl dem Recht der Vereinigten Staaten von Amerika als auch dem Gesellschaftsrecht des US-Bundesstaates Delaware (Delaware General Corporation Law, "DGCL"). Die US-Bundesgesetze haben Auswirkungen auf zahlreiche Aspekte des Innen- und Außenverhältnisses von Gesellschaften und befassen sich mit so unterschiedlichen Themen wie Kartellbildung, Insolvenzverfahren, Arbeitgeber-Arbeitnehmer-Beziehungen, Veräußerung von Wertpapieren und Besteuerung. Bestimmte Bundeswertpapiergesetze der USA werden von der Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) verwaltet und verbieten grundsätzlich den Verkauf von Wertpapieren mit betrügerischen Mitteln und verpflichten die meisten Kapitalgesellschaften, die öffentlich gehandelte Wertpapiere begeben haben, darunter auch Morgan Stanley, der SEC und den Aktionären regelmäßig Finanz- und andere Berichte vorzulegen. In den USA erfolgen Unternehmensgründungen normalerweise nach dem Recht eines der Bundesstaaten. Morgan Stanley wurde nach dem Recht des Bundesstaates Delaware gegründet. Mit Wirkung vom 1. Dezember 2005 wurde Morgan Stanley als „consolidated supervised entity“ ("CSE") laut Definition der SEC zugelassen. Als solche unterliegt Morgan Stanley einer gruppenweiten Aufsicht und Überprüfung durch die SEC und Mindestkapitalanforderungen auf konsolidierter Basis. Morgan Stanleys den europäischen Regelungen unterfallende Unternehmen haben die Eigenkapital-Standards des Baseler Ausschusses für Bankenaufsicht ("Basel II") am 1. Januar 2008 umgesetzt. Morgan Stanley arbeitet mit den zuständigen Aufsichtsbehörden weiter an der Umsetzung der CSE-Vorschriften und der Standards von Basel II. Jüngste Ereignisse China Investment Corporation Ltd. Im Dezember 2007 veräusserte Morgan Stanley aktienbezogene Rechte, welche vertragliche Ansprüche auf den Erwerb von Morgan Stanely Aktien beinhalteten, an eine Tochtergesellschaft der China Investment Corporation ("CIC") für circa USD 5.579 Millionen. Das Eigentum der CIC an Morgan Stanley Stammaktien würde, im Falle einer Ausübung der vorgenannten Ansprüche auf den Erwerb von Aktien einschließlich der höchstmöglichen Anzahl an zu lieferenden Morgan Stanley Stammaktien, 9,9 % oder weniger aller am 30. November 2007 ausstehenden Aktien betragen. Die CIC wird ein passiver Investor sein und keine besonderen Mitgliedschaftsrechte oder eine besondere Rolle im Management von Morgan Stanley wahrnehmen. Ein bedeutender Anteil der Investitionssumme wird für aufsichtsrechtliche Zwecke als Tier-1 Kapital behandelt. Morgan Stanley Wealth Management S.V., S.A.U. Am 28. Januar 2008 gab Morgan Stanley bekannt, dass es eine Einigung erzielt hätte im Hinblick auf den Verkauf von 71 Morgan Stanley Wealth Management S.V., S.A.U. ("MSWM"), seine in Spanien aktive Vermögensverwaltung. Vorbehaltlich üblicher Voraussetzungen (einschliesslich behördlicher Genehmigungen) wird ein Abschluss des Verkaufs für die erste Hälfte des Geschäftsjahres 2008 erwartet. Investitionen Soweit Morgan Stanley davon Kenntnis hat, haben seit dem 30. November 2007 keine wesentlichen Investitionen stattgefunden, und es gibt keine zukünftigen Hauptinvestitionen, zu denen die Geschäftsleitung von Morgan Stanley sich bereits fest verpflichtet hat. Geschäftsüberblick Haupttätigkeitsbereiche Morgan Stanley ist ein weltweit operierendes Finanzdienstleistungsunternehmen, das in allen Geschäftssegmenten – Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group und Asset Management – über bedeutende Marktpositionen verfügt. Durch seine Tochtergesellschaften und verbundene Unternehmen bietet Morgan Stanley eine Vielfalt von Produkten und Dienstleistungen für eine breite und diversifizierte Gruppe von Klienten und Kunden an (einschliesslich Gesellschaften, Regierungen, Finanzinstitute und Einzelpersonen). Es folgt ein Überblick über die Tätigkeiten der einzelnen Geschäftssegmente: Institutional Securities umfasst die Bereiche Kapitalaufnahme; Finanzberatung, einschließlich Beratung in Bezug auf Fusionen und Übernahmen, Restrukturierungen, Immobilien- und Projektfinanzierungen; Unternehmenskredite; Verkauf, Handel, Finanzierung und Market Making in Zusammenhang mit Aktien sowie festverzinslichen Wertpapieren und verwandten Produkten, einschließlich Devisen und Rohstoffe; Analyse der Leitindizes und Risikomanagement-Analyse; Research und Investmenttätigkeit. Global Wealth Management Group liefert Broker- und Anlageberatungsleistungen für verschiedene Investmentalternativen; Finanz- und Vermögensplanung; Renten- und andere Versicherungsprodukte; Darlehen und andere Kreditprodukte; CashManagement-Dienstleistungen; Altersvorsorge und Treuhandtätigkeit. Asset Management beinhaltet weltweite Vermögensverwaltungsprodukte und -dienstleistungen in Aktien, festverzinslichen Wertpapieren und alternativen Anlageformen, wie Hedgefonds, Dachfonds und das Remboursgeschäft, was Immobilien, Private Equity und Infrastruktur umfasst, die institutionellen Anlegern und Privatkunden über eigene und externe Einzelhandelsvertriebswege, Vermittler und Morgan Stanleys institutionellen Vertriebsweg angeboten werden. Das Segment Asset Management nimmt außerdem Investmenttätigkeiten wahr. 72 Eingestellte Geschäftsaktivitäten Discover. Am 30. Juni 2007 hat Morgan Stanley die Ausgliederung von DFS abgeschlossen. Die Ergebnisse von DFS werden als eingestellte Geschäftsaktivitäten in allen Zeiträumen dargestellt. Quilter Holding Ltd. Die Ergebnisse der Quilter Holding Ltd. ("Quilter") werden wegen ihres Verkaufs am 28. Februar 2007 für alle Zeiträume als eingestellte Geschäftsaktivität dargestellt. Die Ergebnisse von Quilter waren Teil des Global Wealth Management. Aircraft Leasing. Die Ergebnisse des Morgan Stanleys Flugzeug Leasing Geschäftsbereichs (aircraft leasing business) werden wegen des Verkaufs am 24. März 2006 für alle Zeiträume als eingestellte Geschäftsaktivität dargestellt. Die Ergebnisse des Flugzeug Leasing Geschäftsbereichs waren Teil der Institutional Securities. Wichtigste Märkte Morgan Stanley leitet das Geschäft von seinem Hauptsitz in New York City, den regionalen Niederlassungen und Filialen in den USA und seinen Hauptniederlassungen in London, Tokio, Hongkong und anderen Finanzzentren der Welt. Wettbewerb Alle Aspekte der Geschäftstätigkeit von Morgan Stanley sind äußerst wettbewerbsintensiv, und Morgan Stanley geht davon aus, dass dies so bleiben wird. In allen Aspekten seiner Geschäftssegmente steht Morgan Stanley in den USA und weltweit im Wettbewerb um Kunden, Marktanteile und qualifizierte Mitarbeiter. Die Wettbewerbsposition von Morgan Stanley ist von seiner Reputation, der Qualität seiner Produkte, Dienstleistungen und Beratung abhängig. Morgan Stanleys Fähigkeit, seine Wettbewerbsposition aufrecht zu erhalten oder zu verbessern, hängt auch maßgeblich von seiner Fähigkeit ab, weiterhin qualifizierte Mitarbeiter zu gewinnen und zu halten und gleichzeitig die Personal- und andere Kosten einzudämmen. Zu den Wettbewerbern gehören Handelsbanken, Versicherungsunternehmen, Fondsvertriebsgesellschaften, Hedgefonds, Energieunternehmen und andere Unternehmen, die in den USA und über das Internet Finanzdienstleistungen anbieten. Institutional Securities und Global Wealth Management Group: Die Wettbewerbsposition von Morgan Stanley wird von den Faktoren Innovation, Ausführungskapazität und relativer Preis bestimmt. Morgan Stanley steht in den USA und weltweit in direktem Wettbewerb mit anderen Wertpapierhäusern, Finanzdienstleistungsunternehmen und Broker-Dealern sowie regional oder produktbezogen mit anderen Anbietern. 73 Die Fähigkeit von Morgan Stanley, Kapital zu günstigen Konditionen aufzunehmen (was im Allgemeinen von den Bonitätseinstufungen abhängig ist) und auf effiziente Weise bereitzustellen – was vor allem für die kapitalintensiven Emissionsübernahme-, Verkaufs-, Handels-, Finanzierungs- und Market Making-Tätigkeiten gilt – wirkt sich ebenfalls auf die Wettbewerbsposition aus. Unternehmenskunden wünschen in Zusammenhang mit bestimmten Investmentbankgeschäften weiterhin Darlehen oder Kreditzusagen von Morgan Stanley. Im Laufe der Zeit fand in bestimmten Sektoren der Finanzdienstleistungsbranche eine Konzentration statt, da Finanzinstitute, die ein breites Spektrum von Finanzdienstleistungen angeboten haben, von anderen Unternehmen übernommen oder mit ihnen fusioniert wurden. Diese Konvergenz könnte dazu führen, dass die Wettbewerber von Morgan Stanley mehr Kapital und andere Ressourcen erlangen, wie beispielsweise eine breitere Produkt- und Dienstleistungspalette und geografische Vielfalt. Der Wettbewerb könnte sich sogar intensivieren, wenn Morgan Stanley weiter mit Finanzinstituten im Wettbewerb steht, die möglicherweise größer oder mit mehr Kapital ausgestattet sind oder in bestimmten Bereichen über eine stärkere lokale Präsenz und längere geschäftliche Erfahrungen verfügen. Viele dieser Unternehmen haben mehr Kapital als Morgan Stanley und sind in der Lage, ein breites Spektrum von Produkten anzubieten, die ihre Wettbewerbsposition stärken und einen Preisdruck auf die Geschäftsbereiche von Morgan Stanley ausüben könnten. Die sich ergänzenden Trends in der Finanzdienstleistungsbranche – Konsolidierung und Globalisierung – sind unter anderem mit technologischen, Risikomanagement-, aufsichtsrechtlichen und anderen infrastrukturellen Herausforderungen verbunden, die Morgan Stanley nur bei einer effektiven Ressourcenaufteilung konkurrenzfähig meistern kann. Einige Geschäftsbereiche von Morgan Stanley sind in den letzten Jahren durch einen intensiven Preiswettbewerb gekennzeichnet. Insbesondere die Möglichkeit, Transaktionen elektronisch bei Börsen und andere alternative Handelsmärkte abzuwickeln, hat den Druck auf die Handelsprovisionen erhöht. Der Trend zur Nutzung direkten Zugangs zu automatisierten, elektronischen Aktienmärkten wird voraussichtlich anhalten. Möglicherweise wird der Wettbewerbsdruck auf Morgan Stanley künftig in diesen und anderen Bereichen zunehmen, wenn einige Wettbewerber versuchen, Marktanteile durch niedrigere Preise zu erlangen. Asset Management: Der Wettbewerb in der Vermögensverwaltungsbranche wird durch mehrere Faktoren beeinflusst, wie der Reputation von Morgan Stanley, seinen Anlagezielen, der Kompetenz der Anlagespezialisten, der Wertentwicklung der Investmentprodukte gegenüber der Vergleichsgruppe und einem angemessenen Benchmark-Index, Werbeund Verkaufsförderungsmaßnahmen, der Gebührenstruktur, der Wirksam- und Verfügbarkeit von Vertriebswegen sowie der Art und Qualität der angebotenen Produkte. Die alternativen Anlageprodukte von Morgan Stanley wie Private Equity Fonds, Immobilien und Hedgefonds stehen im Wettbewerb zu ähnlichen Produkten, welche sowohl von alternativen wie von traditionellen Vermögensverwaltern angeboten werden. 74 Organisationsstruktur Morgan Stanley ist eine Holdinggesellschaft, die durch ihre Tochtergesellschaften und verbundenen Unternehmen ihre Produkte und Dienstleistungen einer großen und breit gefächerten Mandanten- und Kundengruppe anbietet, darunter Unternehmen, Regierungen, Finanzinstituten und Einzelpersonen. Die US-amerikanischen und internationalen Tochtergesellschaften von Morgan Stanley umfassen Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated, Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (ehemals "Morgan Stanley & Co. International Limited"), Morgan Stanley Japan Securities Co., Ltd. (ehemals "Morgan Stanley Japan Limited") und Morgan Stanley Investment Advisors Inc. Am 1. April 2007 wurde Morgan Stanley DW Inc. mit Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated zusammengeschlossen. Nach Abschluss der Fusion wurde das übernehmende Unternehmen, Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated, Morgan Stanleys wichtigster Broker-Dealer in den USA. Trendinformationen Seit dem 30. Januar 2008 hat es keine wesentlichen negativen Veränderungen in den Aussichten von Morgan Stanley und seinen konsolidierten Tochtergesellschaften gegeben. Geschäftsleitung Directors Nachfolgend sind die Directors von Morgan Stanley zum Zeitpunkt des vorliegenden Prospekts, ihre Funktion innerhalb von Morgan Stanley und ihre externe Haupttätigkeit angegeben. Ihre Geschäftsadresse lautet jeweils 1585 Broadway, New York, New York 10036, USA. Name Funktion innerhalb von Morgan Stanley John J. Mack Vorsitzender des Board of John J. Mack übt außerhalb Directors und Chief von Morgan Stanley keine Executive Officer anderen relevanten Management-Funktionen aus. 75 Externe Haupttätigkeit Roy J. Bostock Director Vorsitzender der Partnership for a Drug-Free America. Mitglied des Board of Directors der Northwest Airlines Corporation und Yahoo! Inc. Erskine B. Bowles Director Präsident der University of North Carolina und Präsident der North Carolina Mutual Life Insurance Company. Director der General Motors Corporation und Cousins Properties Incorporated Howard J. Davies Director Director der London School of Economics and Political Science, Director der Paternoster plc. C. Robert Kidder Director Vorsitzender und CEO von 3 Stone Advisors LLC. Director der Schering-Plough Corporation Donald T. Nicolaisen Director Director der MGIC Investment Corporation, von Verizon Communications Inc. und Zurich Financial Services Charles H. Noski Director Director der Microsoft Corporation und Air Products and Chemicals Inc. Hutham S. Olayan Director Präsident und Chief Executive Officer der Olayan America Corporation Charles E. Phillips, Jr. Director Präsident und Director der Oracle Corporation und Director der Viacom, Inc. 76 O. Griffith Sexton Director Advisory Director von Morgan Stanley, Adjunct Professor für Finanzwesen an der Columbia Business School; Gastlektor an der Princeton University, Director von Investor AB und Hamilton Lane Laura D. Tyson Director Professor, Walter A. Haas School of Business, University of California in Berkeley. Director der Eastman Kodak Company und AT&T Inc. und 24/7 Customer Inc. Klaus Zumwinkel Director Vorstandsvorsitzender der Deutsche Post AG, Mitglied des Aufsichtsrates der Deutsche Lufthansa AG, Vorsitzender des Aufsichtsrates der Deutsche Telekom AG, Mitglied des Aufsichtsrates der Karstadt Quelle AG und Vorsitzender des Aufsichtsrates der Deutsche Postbank AG Geschäftsvorfälle mit nahe stehenden Unternehmen und Personen Im Geschäftsjahr 2007 vergaben Morgan Stanleys Tochtergesellschaften im Rahmen ihrer gewöhnlichen Geschäftstätigkeit Kredite an bestimmte Directors, leitende Angestellte und Mitarbeiter von Morgan Stanley sowie deren unmittelbare Angehörige. Diese Kreditgewährungen erfolgten in Zusammenhang mit Effektenkrediten, Hypothekendarlehen, Kreditkartentransaktionen, revolvierenden Kreditlinien und anderen Kreditvergaben durch die Tochtergesellschaften von Morgan Stanley. Die Kredite wurden im Wesentlichen zu den selben Konditionen, einschließlich Zinssätzen und Besicherungsanforderungen, ausgereicht, wie sie zu diesem Zeitpunkt für vergleichbare Geschäftsvorfälle mit anderen Personen üblich waren. Die gewährten Kredite waren mit keinem größeren Risiko als dem normalen Einbringlichkeitsrisiko verbunden oder durch andere nachteilige Merkmale gekennzeichnet. Directors, leitende Angestellte und Mitarbeiter sowie deren unmittelbare Angehörige, die Wertpapiere, Derivate, Finanzprodukte und Finanzdienstleistungen kaufen möchten, können dies über die Tochtergesellschaften von Morgan Stanley tun. Diese Tochtergesellschaften können ihnen Ermäßigungen auf die normalen Provisionssätze oder Gebühren anbieten. Außerdem kaufen oder verkaufen sie von Zeit zu Zeit im gewöhnlichen Geschäftsverlauf als Eigenhändler 77 Wertpapiere und Derivate, an denen Directors, leitende Angestellte und Mitarbeiter von Morgan Stanley und deren unmittelbare Angehörige beteiligt sind. Diese Käufe und Verkäufe können zu einem ermäßigten Aufschlag bzw. Abschlag des Händlers getätigt werden, der sonst bei nicht verbundenen Dritten erhoben wird. Bestimmte Mitarbeiter, darunter auch die Mitglieder der Geschäftsleitung von Morgan Stanley, können zu den gleichen Konditionen wie andere Anleger in Investmentfonds anlegen, die von Morgan Stanley hauptsächlich für Kundenanlagen aufgelegt und verwaltet werden, wobei Morgan Stanley bei Mitarbeitern auf bestimmte Gebühren und Kosten verzichten oder diese ermäßigen kann. Außerdem steht es Morgan Stanley frei, in Übereinstimmung mit den jeweils gültigen Aktienrückkaufgenehmigungen Stammaktien von Morgan Stanley auf dem freien Markt oder in nicht öffentlich verhandelten Transaktionen zurückzukaufen oder zu erwerben. Dabei kann es sich auch um Geschäftsvorfälle mit Directors, leitenden Angestellten und Mitarbeitern handeln. Diese Transaktionen werden im Rahmen der gewöhnlichen Geschäftstätigkeit zu den jeweils gültigen Marktpreisen durchgeführt. Im Geschäftsjahr 2007 führte Morgan Stanley im gewöhnlichen Geschäftsverlauf Transaktionen mit State Street und Barclays und bestimmten mit ihnen verbundenen Unternehmen durch. State Street und Barclays waren am 23. Februar 2007 jeweils wirtschaftliche Eigentümer von mehr als 5 % der im Umlauf befindlichen Stammaktien von Morgan Stanley. Diese Geschäftsvorfälle fanden im Wesentlichen zu den gleichen Konditionen statt, wie sie zu diesem Zeitpunkt bei vergleichbaren Geschäftsvorfällen mit unabhängigen Dritten üblich waren. Morgan Stanley führt auch Transaktionen, einschließlich Finanzdienstleistungen (z. B. Handel mit Wertpapieren, Rohstoffen oder Derivaten) mit bzw. für Unternehmen durch, in denen seine Directors und deren unmittelbare Angehörige eine Führungsposition bekleiden, und erbringt für solche Unternehmen Dienstleistungen in den Bereichen Investmentbanking, Finanzberatung, Maklergeschäfte, Anlageverwaltung u. a. und kann diesen Unternehmen Kredite gewähren oder Kreditzusagen machen. Die Durchführung von Transaktionen, Erbringung von Dienstleistungen und Gewährung von Krediten und Kreditzusagen erfolgen im Rahmen der gewöhnlichen Geschäftstätigkeit im Wesentlichen zu den selben Konditionen, einschließlich Zinssätzen und Besicherungsanforderungen, wie sie zu diesem Zeitpunkt für vergleichbare Geschäftsvorfälle mit anderen Personen üblich sind. Die Kredite sind mit keinem größeren Risiko als dem normalen Einbringlichkeitsrisiko verbunden oder durch andere nachteilige Merkmale gekennzeichnet. Es gibt keine vorhandenen oder potenziellen Interessenkonflikte zwischen den Pflichten, die Morgan Stanleys Directors oder Mitglieder der Hauptausschüsse gegenüber dem Unternehmen haben, und den privaten Interessen und/oder anderen externen Pflichten dieser Personen. Arbeitsweise des Board of Directors Morgan Stanley erfüllt seiner Ansicht nach alle für das Unternehmen geltenden USGesetze zur Corporate Governance. 78 Das Board of Directors kommt regelmäßig zusammen; zwischen den Sitzungen erhalten die Directors Informationen über die Tätigkeit der Ausschüsse und die geschäftliche Entwicklung von Morgan Stanley. Alle Directors haben vollständigen und zeitnahen Zugang zu allen relevanten Informationen und können bei Bedarf unabhängigen fachlichen Rat einholen. Lead Director ist C. Robert Kidder. Das Board of Directors hat nachstehende ständige Ausschüsse gebildet. Sämtliche Mitglieder der Ausschüsse sind Mitglieder der Geschäftsleitung. Insofern wird hinsichtlich ihrer externen Haupttätigkeit bzw. Haupttätigkeiten auf die Angaben auf Seite 73 f. dieses Prospektes verwiesen. Ausschuss Derzeitige Mitglieder Hauptaufgaben Audit Committee Charles H. Noski (Vorsitzender) Überwachung der Integrität des Konzernabschlusses von Morgan Stanley, des internen Kontrollsystems, des Risikomanagements und der Einhaltung gesetzlicher und aufsichtsrechtlicher Vorschriften. Howard J. Davies Donald T. Nicolaisen Charles E. Phillips, Jr. Auswahl, Festlegung Beurteilung und Ersetzung des Abschlussprüfers Vorabgenehmigung und zulässigen Leistungen. der Vergütung, gegebenenfalls unabhängigen sowie der Prüfungsprüfungsfernen Überwachung der Qualifikationen und Unabhängigkeit des unabhängigen Abschlussprüfers und der Leistung der internen und unabhängigen Abschlussprüfer von Morgan Stanley. Nach Überprüfung Abgabe einer Empfehlung an das Board, den geprüften Konzernabschluss anzunehmen und in Morgan Stanleys Geschäftsbericht auf Formular 10-K aufzunehmen. 79 Compensation, Management, Development and Succession Committee C. Robert Kidder (Vorsitzender) Erskine B. Bowles Donald T. Nicolaisen Jährliche Überprüfung und Genehmigung der für die Vergütung des Vorsitzenden und CEO maßgeblichen Vorgaben und Ziele und Beurteilung seiner Leistung anhand dieser Vorgaben und Ziele. Festlegung der Vergütung der Führungskräfte von Morgan Stanley und anderer leitender Angestellte, wie dies für angemessen erachtet wird. Verwaltung der aktienbasierten Vergütungsprogramme von Morgan Stanley. Aufsicht über die Programme für Managemententwicklung und Nachfolgeplanung. Nominating and Governance Committee Laura D. Tyson (Vorsitzende) Identifizierung und Empfehlung von Kandidaten für die Wahl in das Board of Directors. Roy J. Bostock Festlegung von Verfahren für seine Aufsicht über die Beurteilung des Board. Hutham S. Olayan Klaus Zumwinkel Empfehlung der Vergütung und Leistungen für Directors. Jährliche Überprüfung der Corporate Governance-Richtlinien von Morgan Stanley. Mitarbeiter Zum 30. November 2007 beschäftigte Morgan Stanley weltweit 48.256 Mitarbeiter. Hauptaktionäre Nach den für Morgan Stanley maßgeblichen SEC-Vorschriften beträgt der Grenzwert für die Offenlegungspflicht von Beteiligungen an börsennotierten Unternehmen 5 % des Grundkapitals. Deshalb sind nur diese Angaben öffentlich verfügbar. 80 Morgan Stanley hat keine Informationen über Aktionäre mit einer Beteiligung zwischen 2 % und 5 %. Gemäß den jüngsten bei der SEC eingereichten Unterlagen vom 23. Februar 2007 hielten die folgenden Aktionäre mehr als 5 % der Stammaktien von Morgan Stanley: Im wirtschaftlichem Eigentum befindliche Stammaktien Name und Anschrift Stückzahl Prozent(1) State Street Bank and Trust Company(2) 225 Franklin Street, Boston, MA 02110, USA 127.887.564 12,01 % Barclays Global Investors, N.A., und andere berichtende Unternehmen (Barclays)(3) 45 Fremont Street, San Francisco, CA 94105, USA 64.442.639 6,05 % (1) Berechnung der Prozentsätze auf Basis der am 9. Februar 2007 im Umlauf befindlichen Stammaktien und dem in Schedule 13G Information Statements angegebenen Stammaktienbesitz, der in den Fußnoten 2-3 unten näher ausgeführt wird. Laut diesen Information Statements waren State Street und Barclays zum 31. Dezember 2006 wirtschaftliche Eigentümer von 12,1 % bzw. 6,15 % der Stammaktien von Morgan Stanley. (2) Auf Grundlage des am 12. Februar 2007 von State Street eingereichten Schedule 13G Information Statement, wobei das Unternehmen verschiedene treuhänderische Funktionen ausübte. Gemäß den Angaben in Schedule 13G hatte State Street das alleinige Stimmrecht an 47.230.411 Aktien, ein gemeinsames Stimmrecht an 80.657.153 Aktien und ein gemeinsames Verfügungsrecht an 127.887.564 Aktien; die Anteile, die State Street im Namen des Trusts und des vom Unternehmen finanzierten aktienbasierten Vergütungsprogramms hielt, beliefen sich am 31. Dezember 2006 auf 7,6 % des Grundkapitals; und State Street war nach eigenen Angaben bei allen hierin angegebenen Aktien nicht wirtschaftlicher Eigentümer. (3) Auf Grundlage des am 23. Januar 2007 von Barclays Global Investors, N.A., Barclays Global Fund Advisors, Barclays Global Investors, Ltd, Barclays Global Investors Japan Trust and Banking Company Limited und Barclays Global Investors Japan Limited eingereichten Schedule 13G Information Statement (mit Datum vom 31. Januar 2007). In Schedule 13G bestätigten die berichtenden Unternehmen nicht die Existenz eines Konzerns. Schedule 13G zufolge hatten die berichtenden Unternehmen insgesamt das alleinige Stimm- und Verfügungsrecht an 56.284.434 Aktien und das alleinige Verfügungsrecht an 64.442.639 Aktien und besaßen für keine Aktien ein gemeinsames Recht. 81 Folglich gibt es kein Unternehmen, das Morgan Stanley direkt oder indirekt besitzt oder beherrscht. Grundkapital Zum 30. November 2007 umfasste das genehmigte Grundkapital von Morgan Stanley 3.500.000.000 Stammaktien im Nennwert von USD 0,01 und 30.000.000 Vorzugsaktien im Nennwert von USD 0,01. Das ausgegebene, nicht nachschusspflichtige und voll eingezahlte Grundkapital von Morgan Stanley betrug am 30. November 2007 1.211.701.552 Stammaktien im Nennwert von USD 0,01. Gründungsurkunde Ziele und Geschäftsgegenstand von Morgan Stanley sind auf Seite 1 der Gründungsurkunde dargelegt und ermöglichen dem Unternehmen, alle gesetzlich zulässigen Handlungen und Tätigkeiten auszuführen, zu denen nach dem DGCL gegründete Gesellschaften berechtigt sind. Ausgewählte Finanzinformationen In diesen Abschnitt werden in Form eines Verweises die historischen Finanzdaten aufgenommen, die im aktuellen Bericht auf Formular 10-K vom 28. Januar 2008 für die Geschäftsjahre zum 30. November 2007 und 30. November 2006 enthalten sind, einschließlich der Konzernaufstellung über die Vermögens- und Finanzlage, der Konzern-Gewinn- und -Verlustrechnung, der Konzern-Kapitalflussrechnung und des Anhangs zum Konzernabschluss. 1. "Bilanz" (Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition): Seiten 101 f. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) 2. "Gewinn und Verlustrechnung" (Consolidated Statements of Income): Seite 103 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) 3. "Kapitalflussrechnung" (Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows): Seite 105 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) 4. "Rechnungslegungsstrategien und erläuternde Anmerkungen" (Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements): Seiten 107 ff. des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) 5. Prüfungsbericht (Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm): Seite 100 des Jahresberichts (Annual Report, Form 10-K) Der Geschäftsbericht auf Formular 10-K für das Geschäftsjahr zum 30. November 2007 wurde am 29. Januar 2008 bei der SEC eingereicht. 82 Seit dem 30. November 2007 gab es keine wesentlichen Veränderungen in der Finanzlage oder der Handelsposition von Morgan Stanley und seinen konsolidierten Tochtergesellschaften. Prüfung historischer Finanzdaten Die Abschlussprüfer von Morgan Stanley für die Geschäftsjahre vom 1. Dezember 2004 bis 30. November 2005, vom 1. Dezember 2005 bis 30. November 2006 und vom 1. Dezember 2006 bis 30. November 2007 waren Deloitte & Touche LLP, Two World Financial Center, New York, New York 10281, USA, eine unabhängige registrierte Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft (die "Abschlussprüfer"). Am 12. Februar 2007 (in Verbindung mit der Anmerkung 1 - Eingestellte Geschäftsaktivitäten-Discover - und der Anmerkung 30 des Berichtes 8-K vom 25. Oktober 2007 – wie nachstehend erläutert) haben die Abschlußprüfer im Hinblick auf die nachstehenden Punkte (i), (ii) und (iii) einen uneingeschränkten Bestätigungsvermerk erteilt: (i) die Bilanzen (Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition) von Morgan Stanley vom 30. November 2006 und 2005 und die entsprechenden Gewinn- und Verlustrechnungen (Consolidated Statements of Income), die Kapitalflussrechnung (Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows) und die Veränderungen des Eigenkapitals für die Geschäftsjahre, die am 30. November 2004, 2005 bzw. 2006 endeten, (ii) den diesbezüglichen Bericht von Morgan Stanley und (iii) die Einschätzung des Vorstandes betreffend die Effektivität der internen Kontrollmechanismen bezüglich des Rechnungswesens. Am 28. Januar 2008 haben die Abschlussprüfer im Hinblick auf die nachstehenden Punkte (i), (ii) und (iii) einen uneingeschränkten Bestätigungsvermerk erteilt: (i) die Bilanzen (Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition) von Morgan Stanley vom 30. November 2007 und 2006 und die entsprechenden Gewinn- und Verlustrechnungen (Consolidated Statements of Income), die Kapitalflussrechnung (Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows) und die Veränderungen des Eigenkapitals für die Geschäftsjahre, die am 30. November 2005, 2006 bzw. 2007 endeten, (ii) den diesbezüglichen Bericht von Morgan Stanley und (iii) den Vorstandsbericht über die Effektivität der Kontrollmechanismen bezüglich des Rechnungswesens. internen Morgan Stanley hat den vorgenannten Bericht auf Formular 8-K vom 25. Oktober 2007 hauptsächlich deshalb eingereicht, um bestimmte Informationen in den 83 historischen konsolidierten Bilanzen zu aktualisieren, welche auch im Hinblick auf vorgenannte Anmerkungen 1 und 30 einer Aktualisierung aus folgenden Gründen bedurften: Am 30. Juni 2007 hat Morgan Stanley die Abspaltung (spin-off) der Discover Financial Services ("DFS") abgeschlossen. Morgan Stanley verteilte alle ausgegebenen Stammaktien der DFS (Nennbetrag von jeweils USD 0,01) an am 18. Juni 2007 eingetragene Aktionäre von Morgan Stanley. Dabei erhielten Morgan Stanleys Aktionäre für zwei Morgan Stanley gehaltene Stammaktien jeweils eine DFS Stammaktie. Die Aktionäre erhielten für Beträge, die geringer als eine ganze DFS Aktie waren, einen Ausgleichsbetrag in Geld. Morgan Stanley erhielt von der US-amerikanischen Finanzbehörde (Internal Revenue Service) einen Bescheid dahingehend, dass vorstehende Zuteilung an Morgan Stanleys Aktionäre für diese, unter Zugrundelegung gewöhnlicher Umstände, keine Steuerverpflichtung in Ansehung der US-Bundeseinkommenssteuer (US federal income tax) begründe. Das vollständige Formular 8-K vom 8. Oktober 2007 kann auf der Webseite der United States Securities and Exchange Commission under “www.sec.gov” eingesehen werden. Die vorgenannten Bestätigungsvermerke (einschließlich erläuternder Anmerkungen dazu) sind Teil von Morgan Stanleys Jahresabschlußberichte auf dem Formular 10-K für die Geschäftsjahre mit Ende 30. November 2007 und 30. November 2006. Gerichts- und Schiedsgerichtsverfahren Neben den nachfolgend beschriebenen Sachverhalten war Morgan Stanley im Rahmen seiner gewöhnlichen Geschäftstätigkeit gelegentlich beklagte Partei in verschiedenen Rechtsstreitigkeiten, wie Schiedsverfahren, Sammelklagen und anderen Prozessen, die sich in Zusammenhang mit seiner Tätigkeit als weltweites, diversifiziertes Finanzdienstleistungsunternehmen ergeben. Einige der tatsächlichen oder angedrohten Klagen betreffen wesentliche kompensatorische und/oder Strafschadensersatzansprüche oder Schadenersatzforderungen in nicht bezifferter Höhe. In einigen Fällen sind die Emittenten, die ansonsten die Hauptbeklagte in diesen Verfahren wären, zahlungsunfähig oder befinden sich in finanziellen Schwierigkeiten. Darüber hinaus ist Morgan Stanley gelegentlich Gegenstand von weiteren Untersuchungen, Ermittlungen und Verfahren (sowohl offiziell als auch inoffiziell) durch Regierungs- und Selbstregulierungsorgane, die Morgan Stanleys Geschäftstätigkeit, darunter das Rechnungswesen und betriebliche Angelegenheiten, betreffen. Einige davon können nachteilige Urteile, Vergleiche, Strafen, Bußgelder, einstweilige Verfügungen oder sonstige Rechtsbehelfe zur Folge haben. Die Anzahl solcher Untersuchungen, Ermittlungen und Verfahren hat in den letzten Jahren bei vielen Unternehmen der Finanzdienstleistungsbranche, so auch bei Morgan Stanley, zugenommen. 84 Morgan Stanley bestreitet die Haftpflicht und/oder den Betrag des Schadenersatzes, wie im jeweils anhängigen Fall angemessen. Da es naturgemäß schwierig ist, den Ausgang solcher Verfahren vorherzusagen, insbesondere in Fällen, in denen die Kläger bedeutende oder unbestimmte Schadenersatzforderungen stellen oder die Ermittlungen und Verfahren noch in der Anfangsphase sind, kann Morgan Stanley nicht mit Gewissheit vorhersagen, wie hoch (wenn überhaupt) der Verlust oder die Verlustspanne in Verbindung mit diesen Verfahren sein wird, wie oder ob sie entschieden werden, wann dies letztendlich der Fall sein wird oder wie ein etwaiger Vergleich, eine etwaige Strafe, ein etwaiges Bußgeld oder ein anderer Rechtsbehelf schließlich aussehen könnte. Vorbehaltlich der vorstehenden Ausführungen und mit Ausnahme des nachfolgend beschriebenen Coleman-Rechtsstreits geht Morgan Stanley nach seinem derzeitigen Kenntnisstand und nach Rücksprache mit seinem Anwalt davon aus, dass der Ausgang dieser anhängigen Verfahren keine wesentlichen nachteiligen Auswirkungen auf die konsolidierte Finanz- und Vermögenslage von Morgan Stanley haben wird, wobei der Ausgang dieser Verfahren jedoch wesentlich für das betriebliche Ergebnis und den Kapitalfluss von Morgan Stanley in einer bestimmten künftigen Periode sein könnte, was u. a. vom Umsatz- und Ertragsniveau in dieser Periode abhängig sein wird. Coleman-Rechtsstreit Im Mai 2003 reichte Coleman (Parent) Holdings Inc. ("CPH") beim Circuit Court of the Fifteenth Judicial Circuit for Palm Beach County, Florida, eine Klage gegen Morgan Stanley ein. Gegenstand der Klage ist die Fusion zwischen The Coleman Company, Inc. und Sunbeam, Inc. ("Sunbeam") von 1998. In der geänderten Fassung der Klageschrift heißt es, dass CPH auf der Grundlage bestimmter finanzieller Falschdarstellungen veranlasst wurde, der Transaktion mit Sunbeam zuzustimmen, und es wurden Ansprüche gegen Morgan Stanley wegen Beihilfe zu Betrug, unrechtmäßigem kollusiven Zusammenwirken und Strafschadenersatz geltend gemacht. Kurz vor der Hauptverhandlung, die im April 2005 begann, gab das erstinstanzliche Gericht teilweise einem Antrag auf Verhängung eines Versäumnisurteils gegen Morgan Stanley statt und ordnete an, dass Teile der Klageschrift von CPH, einschließlich der Passagen, in der seine Hauptanschuldigungen gegen Morgan Stanley dargelegt werden, der Jury vorgelesen werden und für alle Zwecke des Prozesses als gültig zu betrachten sind. Im Mai 2005 fällte die Jury ein Urteil zugunsten von CPH und sprach CPH USD 604 Mio. kompensatorischen Schadenersatz und USD 850 Mio. Strafschadenersatz zu. Im Juni 2005 erließ das erstinstanzliche Gericht ein Endurteil zugunsten von CPH in Höhe von USD 1.578 Mio. In diesem Betrag waren die bis zur Urteilsverkündigung angefallenen Zinsen enthalten, nicht jedoch bestimmte Zahlungen, die CPH zur Abfindung ähnlicher Ansprüche gegen andere Parteien erhalten hat. Im März 2007 gab das District Court of Appeal for the Fourth District of Florida eine Urteilsbegründung ab, in der es das erstinstanzliche Urteil in Bezug auf die Zubilligung von kompensatorischen und Strafschadenersatz aufhob und die Angelegenheit an das untere Gericht mit der Anordnung zurückverwies, ein Urteil zugunsten von Morgan Stanley einzutragen. Im Juni 2007 wurde die Urteilsbegründung endgültig, nachdem der Court of Appeal die Anträge von CPH auf eine erneute Anhörung, eine en banc Anhörung und auf Zulassung bestimmter Fragen 85 zur Überprüfung durch den Florida Supreme Court (dem "Supreme Court") abgelehnt hat. Am 12. Dezember 2007 hat der Supreme Court das Begehren von CPH, eine Überprüfung der Entscheidung des Court of Appeal zuzulassen abgelehnt, was ein Urteil zugunsten Morgan Stanleys bedeutet. Rechtsstreitigkeiten wegen Konsortialprovisionen Ab Ende 1998 wurden beim U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York ("SDNY") angebliche Sammelklagen, die später in der Rechtssache In re Public Offering Fee Antitrust Litigation (die "Käuferklage ") und in der Rechtssache In re Issuer Plaintiff Initial Public Offering Fee Antitrust Litigation (die "Emittentenklage") zusammengefasst wurden, gegen Morgan Stanley und zahlreiche andere Konsortialmitglieder erhoben. In den konsolidierten Verfahren – das eine im Namen der Käufer und das andere im Namen der Emittenten bestimmter Aktien in öffentlichen Erstemissionen ("IPOs") – wird den Beklagten vorgeworfen, durch Festsetzung der Konsortialprovision auf 7 % in Börsengängen von US-Gesellschaften mit einem Gesamtemissionsvolumen zwischen USD 20 bis 80 Mio. gegen Section 1 des Sherman Act verstoßen zu haben. Die Klage umfasst Schadenersatzforderungen in dreifacher Höhe (treble damages) und Unterlassungsansprüche. Die Schadenersatzforderungen der Kläger der Käuferklage wurden abgewiesen, die Unterlassungsansprüche bestehen jedoch weiterhin. Die Schadenersatz- und Unterlassungsansprüche der Kläger der Emittentenklage werden weiter aufrechterhalten. Die Kläger beider Klagen haben eine Zertifizierung als Klägergruppe (class certification) in die Wege geleitet, gegen die die Beklagten im Mai 2005 Einspruch eingelegt haben. Im Oktober 2005 stellten die Kläger einen Antrag beim SDNY auf "Summary Judgment" (Urteil im abgekürzten Verfahren), gegen den die Beklagten Einspruch einlegten. Im Mai 2006 stellten die Kläger gemäß Rule 23(f) der Federal Rules of Civil Procedure einen Antrag auf Zulassung einer Revision gegen die Ablehnung der Zertifizierung als Klägergruppe. Im September 2007 hob das U.S. Court of Appeal in der Rechtssache In re Issuer Plaintiff Initial Public Offering Fee Antitrust Litigation die Ablehnung der Klassifizierung der Klägergruppe durch das U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York auf und verwies den Fall zur weiteren Erwägung der „class certification“ an das unterinstanzliche Gericht zurück. Daraufhin stellten die Kläger bei dem unterinstanzlichen Gericht am 17. Oktober 2007 einen Antrag auf Zertifizierung als Klägergruppe. Verfahren in Verbindung mit der Wertpapierzuteilung in IPOs Ab März 2001 wurde beim SDNY angeblich im Namen von Käufern, die in Börsengängen oder auf dem Sekundärmarkt Aktien erworben hatten, eine Reihe mutmaßlicher Sammelklagen gegen bestimmte Emittenten von IPO-Wertpapieren, bestimmte einzelne leitende Angestellte dieser Emittenten, Morgan Stanley und andere Konsortialmitglieder dieser Börsengänge eingereicht, die inzwischen in der Rechtssache In re Initial Public Offering Securities Litigation zusammengefasst wurden. Dabei wird behauptet, dass die Beklagten von ihren Kunden für Aktienzuteilungen bei "Hot IPOs" verlangt hätten, eine nicht angegebene, überhöhte Vergütung in Form von höheren Maklerprovisionen zu zahlen und nach Abschluss 86 der Börsengänge weitere Aktienkäufe ("tie in purchases") zu stufenweise steigenden Preisniveaus zu tätigen, die über dem Ausgabepreis lagen (eine Vorgehensweise, den die Kläger als "laddering" bezeichnen) und gegen die Bundeswertpapiergesetze, einschließlich Sections 11 und 12(a)(2) des Securities Act 1933 ("Securities Act") und Section 10(b) des Exchange Act verstoßen haben. In einigen Klageschriften wird auch vorgebracht, dass laufende Kaufempfehlungen durch die Analysten der Beklagten die Kurse, zu dem die Wertpapiere nach dem Börsengang gehandelt wurden, auf unlautere Weise in die Höhe getrieben oder auf hohem Niveau gehalten hätten. Im Februar 2003 wurde der gemeinsame Antrag der beklagten Konsortialmitglieder auf Abweisung der Klage außer in Bezug auf bestimmte Emissionen abgelehnt. Im Dezember 2006 hob der Second Circuit die vom SDNY gewährte Zertifizierung der Klägergruppe auf und entschied, dass diese Fälle nicht für eine Behandlung als Sammelklage in Betracht kommen. Im August reichten die Kläger eine zweite konsolidierte geänderte Sammelklageschrift ein, in denen die Klagepunkte angeblich in Anbetracht der vom Berufungsgericht aufgehobenen unterinstanzlichen Entscheidung, die Fälle als Sammelklagen zuzulassen, geändert wurden. Die Kläger beantragen erneut eine Zertifizierung als Klägergruppe. Im Oktober 2007 wurden zahlreiche Klagen in Prozesstandschaft vor dem U.S. District Court des Western District of Washington gegen Morgan Stanley im Auftrag bestimmter Emittenten von Wertpapieren und anderer an den Börsengängen beteiligter Personen erhoben. Mit den Klagen werden sog. "short swing" Gewinne zurückverlangt, welche angeblich durch einen Verstoß gegen Section 16(b) des Börsengesetzes (Exchange Act) ermöglicht wurden. Sog. "Late Trading" und "Market Timing" Ab Juli 2003 erhielt Morgan Stanley Ladungen und Auskunftsersuchen von verschiedenen Aufsichts- und Regierungsbehörden, darunter der SEC, der NYSE und mehreren Bundesstaaten, in Zusammenhang mit branchenweiten Untersuchungen von Broker-Händlern und Investmentfondsgesellschaften im Hinblick auf ein mögliches Late-Trading und Marketing-Timing von Fondsanteilen. Im Dezember 2007 schloss Morgan Stanley mit der SEC einen Vergleich, der alle Streitigkeiten mit der SEC hinsichtlich Late Trading und Market Timing von Mutual Funds im Endkundensystem zwischen Januar 2002 und August 2003 beendet. Nach den Bestimmungen des Vergleichs wird Morgan Stanley unter anderem verwarnt und muss ein Bußgeld zahlen. Angelegenheiten im Zusammenhang mit Subprimekrediten Morgan Stanley hat Ladungen und Auskunftsersuchen von verschiedenen Aufsichtsund Regierungsbehörden hinsichtlich der Anbahnung, des Kaufs, der Verbriefung und Abwicklung von Baufinanzierungsdarlehen an Kunden mit schlechter Bonität ("Subprime") und guter Bonität ("Prime") und damit im Zusammengang stehenden Fragen erhalten. Morgan Stanley wurde auch als mögliche Beklagte in verschiedenen zivilrechtlichen Verfahren im Zusammenhang mit dem Baufinanzierungsgeschäft im Subprime und Prime Segment bezeichnet, einschließlich einer Sammelklage, welche 87 die Rolle Morgan Stanleys als Konsortialbank bei der Emission bestimmter Vorzugsaktien der New Century Financial Corp. und der Countrywide Financial Corp. und der Emission von mit Hypotheken unterlegten Zertifikaten für eine Tochtergesellschaft der Countrywide Corp. und weiterer Streitgegenstände in diesem Zusammenhang zum Inhalt hatte. Im November 2007 wurde eine Aktionärsklage in Prozessstandschaft bei dem SDNY erhoben, worin Ansprüche hauptsächlich wegen Verlusten aus bestimmten Subprime Handelspositionen und damit in Zusammenhang stehende Fragen erhoben wurden, wobei eine Klagebegründung bisher nicht eingereicht wurde. Im Dezember 2007 wurden gegen Morgan Stanley und andere (auch bestimmte amtierende und ehemalige Direktoren und Vorstände von Morgan Stanley) weitere Sammelklagen beim SDNY eingereicht, die Ansprüche von Teilnehmer der Morgan Stanley 401(k) Pensionskasse und Teilnehmern des Mitarbeiter Aktien-Beteiligungsprogramms nach dem Employee Retirement Income Security Act von 1974 beinhalten. Die Anprüche beziehen sich hauptsächlich auf Verluste im Zusammenhang mit Subprime Darlehen und werfen Morgan Stanley unter anderem vor, dass eine Investition in Morgan Stanley Aktien keine kluge Enscheidung war und dass die Risiken im Zusammenhang mit einer solchen Investition und die finanzielle Situation von Morgan Stanley nicht ausreichend offengelegt wurden. Die folgenden Anlegegenheiten wurden mit Abschluß des Quartals zum 30. November 2007 geklärt: Personelle Angelegenheiten in der Global Wealth Management Group Gehälter und Arbeitszeiten. Im Namen bestimmter derzeitiger und ehemaliger Mitarbeiter wurden gegen Morgan Stanley in New Jersey, New York, Connecticut, Texas, Florida, Illinois, Kalifornien und Ohio Klagen wegen angeblicher unbezahlter Überstunden und gesetzeswidriger Gehaltsabzüge mit entsprechenden Schadenersatzforderungen eingereicht. Im Oktober 2006 erzielte Morgan Stanley eine Einigung in Bezug auf diese Ansprüche womit alle Ansprüche der Kläger sowie aller anderen potenziellen Mitglieder der Klägergruppe in den USA abgegolten wurden. Im November 2006 wurde zur Durchführung des Vergleichs beim U.S. Ditstrict Court des Southern District of California ("SDC") eine konsolidierte geänderte Klage mit der Bezeichnung Steinberg, et al. v. Morgan Stanley eingereicht. Im Dezember 2006 erließ das Judicial Panel für "district"-übergreifende Rechtssachen den Beschluss, die Verfahren zusammenzuführen. Geschlechterbehandlung. Im Juni 2006 wurde Morgan Stanley auch in zwei mutmaßlichen Sammelklagen wegen angeblicher Geschlechterdiskriminierung nach Bundes- und bundesstaatlichem Recht als Beklagter benannt. Am 24. Oktober 2007 hat der U.S. District Court in der Rechtssache Joanne Augst-Johnson et al. v. Morgan Stanley & Co. Inc. den Vergleich über die Sammelklage genehmigt. Der Vergleich beinhaltetet eine Zahlung an den Ausgleichsfonds und bestimmte andere programmatische Rechtsbehelfe (programmatic relief) und beendet alle Streitigkeiten der Teilnehmer der Sammeklage und individueller Antragsteller. Alle ähnlichen 88 Sammelansprüche der zweiten Sache Daisy Jaffe et al. v. Morgan Stanley wurden in den Vergleich miteinbezogen. Mit Ausnahme der in diesem Abschnitt beschriebenen ist Morgan Stanley in den zwölf letzten Monaten vor dem Datum dieses Prospekts nicht in staatlichen Verfahren, Gerichts- oder Schiedsgerichtsverfahren (einschließlich Verfahren, die eingeleitet oder nach Kenntnis von Morgan Stanley angedroht sind) involviert gewesen, die sich erheblich auf die Vermögens- und Finanzlage oder Rentabilität von Morgan Stanley auswirken oder in jüngster Vergangenheit ausgewirkt haben. Art und Anwendungsbereich der Garantie Morgan Stanley wird bis zum 15. Mai 2008 eine unbedingte und unwiderrufliche Garantie (die "Garantie") für die vertragsgemäße Zahlung auf die Zertifikate zahlbarer Beträge übernehmen. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbar gegen die Garantin bestehende und durchsetzbare Ansprüche der Zertifikatsinhaber. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbare, unbedingte, nichtnachrangige und unbesicherte Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, die jederzeit zumindest gleichrangig sind mit allen sonstigen gegenwärtigen und zukünftigen unmittelbaren, unbedingten, nicht-nachrangigen und unbesicherten Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, mit Ausnahme solcher Verbindlichkeiten, die kraft zwingender gesetzlicher Bestimmungen vorrangig sind. Die Garantie wird in physischer und elektronischer Form während der gewöhnlichen Geschäftszeiten an jedem Werktag zur Einsicht bei Morgan Stanley in 1585 Broadway, New York, New York 10036, U.S.A. Tel: +1 (212) 761 4000 und bei Morgan Stanley B.V. in Locatellikade 1, 1076 AZ Amsterdam, The Netherlands, Tel: +31 20 57 55 600 bereitgehalten. 89 Wortlaut der Garantie (in englischer Sprache): Guarantee of Morgan Stanley Morgan Stanley (the "Guarantor") hereby guarantees unconditionally and irrevocably the payment obligations of Morgan Stanley B.V. (the "Issuer") in respect of the issue of capital protected apano AP Enhanced Garant 2 Garantiezertifikate (the "Certificates") issued by the Issuer pursuant to a stand alone prospectus dated 14 February 2008 established by the Issuer to the holders of Certificates (the "Certificateholders") from time to time (together with any additional amounts payable in accordance with, and subject to, the terms and conditions of the Certificates). As long as the Certificates are held by Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt am Main ("Clearstream Frankfurt"), the Guarantor covenants to each person who is for the time being shown in the records of Clearstream Frankfurt or in the records of any other clearing system through which the Certificates may be held from time to time, as the holder of the economic value of the Certificates (the "Accountholders") that it shall make such payments under this Guarantee and acknowledges that the Accountholders may take proceedings to enforce this Guarantee directly against the Guarantor. The Certificateholders from time to time and the Accountholders are referred to herein as the Holders. References to Clearstream Frankfurt shall include its respective successors and assigns and any other clearing system designated by the Issuer and notified to holders of the Certificates in accordance with Condition 8 of the terms and conditions of the Certificates. The Guarantor hereby agrees that it shall not be necessary, as a condition to enforce this Guarantee, that suit be first instituted against the Issuer or that any rights or remedies against the Issuer be first exhausted. Rather, it is understood and agreed that the liability of the Guarantor hereunder shall be primary, direct, and in all respects, unconditional. The obligations of the Guarantor under this Guarantee constitute direct, unconditional and unsecured obligations of the guarantor and rank without preference among themselves and, subject as aforesaid, pari passu with all other outstanding unsecured and unsubordinated obligations of the Guarantor, present and future, but, in the event of insolvency, only to the extent permitted by laws relating to creditors' rights. The Guarantor shall be fully liable as if it were the principal debtor under the Certificates whether any time has been granted to the Issuer, whether the obligations of the Issuer under the Certificates have ceased to exist pursuant to bankruptcy, corporate reorganisation or other similar event, whether the Issuer has been dissolved or liquidated or consolidated or has changed or lost its corporate identity and whether or not any other circumstances have occurred which might otherwise constitute a legal or equitable discharge of or defence to a guarantor. 90 If any moneys shall become payable by the Guarantor under this Guarantee, the Guarantor shall not for so long as the same remain unpaid in respect of any amount paid by it under this Guarantee, exercise any right of subrogation in relation to the Issuer or any other right or remedy which may accrue to it in respect of or as a result of any such payment. All payments pursuant to this Guarantee will be made without withholding or deduction for any taxes, duties, assessments, or governmental charges of whatsoever nature imposed, levied, collected, withheld or assessed by the United States of America, or any political subdivision or any authority thereof having power to tax unless such withholding or deduction is required by law. The Guarantor shall not be required to make any additional payments on account of such withholding or deduction. If the Guarantor becomes subject at any time to any taxing jurisdiction other than the United States of America, references in the Guarantee to the United States shall be construed as references to such other jurisdiction. This guarantee shall be governed and construed in accordance with New York law, without regard to the conflict of law principles. This guarantee shall expire and is no longer effective once all amounts payable on or in respect of the Certificates have been paid in full. MORGAN STANLEY By: ______________________________ Authorised Signatory 91 KOSTEN, GEBÜHREN UND SONSTIGE AUSLAGEN Gebühren Bei vorzeitigem Verkauf ("Vorzeitigem Verkauf") der Zertifikate fällt eine Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr ("Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr") an, welche im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Zeitraum den folgenden Prozentsätzen entspricht: Zeitraum Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr 31. Dezember 2009 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2010 (einschließlich) 4% 30. September 2010 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2012 (einschließlich) 3% 30. September 2012 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2014 (einschließlich) 1% Bei einem Vorzeitigen Verkauf nach dem 30. Juni 2014 wird keine Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr erhoben. Die "Kündigungsgebühr" im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Zeitraum entspricht folgenden Prozentsätzen: Zeitraum Kündigungsgebühr 31. Dezember 2009 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2010 (einschließlich) 4 % des Nennwerts 1. Juli 2010 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2012 (einschließlich) 3 % des Nennwerts 1. Juli 2012 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2014 (einschließlich) 1 % des Nennwerts Bei Kündigung nach dem 30. Juni 2014 wird keine Kündigungsgebühr erhoben. 92 Sonstige Kosten, Gebühren, Provisionen und Aufwendungen im Zusammenhang mit der Fonds-Komponente Zudem fallen auf Ebene der Gesellschaft bzw. Fonds-Komponente weitere Kosten und Gebühren, die mit der Verwaltung der Fonds-Komponente verbunden sind, wie beispielsweise Kosten für die Registrierungsstelle der Gesellschaft oder Provisionen und Aufwendungen, wie im Abschnitt mit der Überschrift "Provisionen und Aufwendungen" in der Beschreibung der Fonds-Komponente in diesem Prospekt beschrieben, an. Insbesondere wird eine Zertifikatsgebühr in Höhe von 0,35 % p.a. vom Nennbetrag erhoben, welche von der Fonds-Komponente abgezogen wird und an die Emittentin gezahlt wird. Sämtliche dieser Kosten, Gebühren, Provisionen und Aufwendungen werden dem Netto-Fondsvermögen der Fonds-Komponente belastet und mindern so den jeweils ermittelten Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente bzw., vorbehaltlich der Rückzahlung des Nennwerts je Zertifikat, die Höhe des Rückzahlungsbetrags. 93 BESCHREIBUNG DER FONDS-KOMPONENTE Die Fonds-Komponente ist nicht zum öffentlichen Vertrieb in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland zugelassen. Die in diesem Prospekt enthaltenen Angaben zur Fonds-Komponente dienen allein der Information von Anlegern, die Zertifikate erwerben wollen und stellen kein Angebot von Anteilen an der Fonds-Komponente dar. Die hier enthaltenen Informationen in Bezug auf die Fonds-Komponente bestehen lediglich aus Auszügen oder Zusammenfassungen von Informationen über der FondsKomponente. Die Emittentin und die Garantin übernehmen die Verantwortung, dass die Informationen richtig wiedergegeben bzw. zusammengefasst wurden. Soweit es der Emittentin und der Garantin bekannt ist und soweit sie dies aus den veröffentlichten Informationen ableiten kann, wurden keine Tatsachen ausgelassen, die dazu führen würden, dass die wiedergegebenen Informationen falsch oder irreführend würden. Neben diesen Zusicherungen wird keine weitergehende oder sonstige Gewähr von der Emittentin bzw. von der Garantin für die Informationen übernommen. Insbesondere übernehmen die Emittentin und die Garantin keine Verantwortung für die Vollständigkeit und Richtigkeit der dieser Darstellung zugrundeliegenden Angaben oder dafür, dass kein Umstand eingetreten ist, der deren Richtigkeit und Vollständigkeit beeinträchtigen könnte. 1. Allgemeine Beschreibung der Aktienklasse Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Limited: Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares Die Aktienklasse Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares (die "Aktienklasse", eine Aktie der Aktienklasse T2 stellt die "Fonds-Komponente" dar) ist eine Aktienklasse von stimmrechtslosen rückzahlbaren gewinnbeteiligten Aktien (jede eine "Aktie" oder "Fonds-Komponente" und zusammen die "Aktien" oder die "Fonds-Komponenten") der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. (die "Gesellschaft"). Die Gesellschaft ist eine steuerbefreite Gesellschaft (exempted company) mit beschränkter Haftung in Bermuda und ist amtlich eingetragen als eine Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten (segregated accounts company) gemäß dem Segregated Accounts Companies Act 2000 of Bermuda und als ein offener Publikumsfonds gemäß dem Companies Act 1981 of Bermuda. Die Gesellschaft ist als ein Bermuda standard scheme eingestuft worden. Als solcher unterliegt die Gesellschaft der Aufsicht und den Vorschriften nach Maßgabe der Bermuda Monetary Authority (Collective Investment Scheme Classification) Regulations 1998. Die Gesellschaft kann Aktien ausgeben und zurückkaufen zu Preisen auf der Grundlage des Nettoinventarwerts je Aktie. Die Gesellschaft wird für die Aktienklasse Finanzanlagen tätigen, indem sie in das AHL Institutional Programme (das "AHL Institutional Programme") investiert, wobei die in diesem diversifizierten Portfolio gehandelten Finanzinstrumente Futures, Optionen, Terminkontrakte, Swaps und anderen Derivaten umfassen können, sowie auch in das Man Global Strategies Style Portfolio, bei dem es sich um einen Hedge Dachfonds mit einem diversifizierten Multi-Strategy-Ansatz handelt (das "MGS Style Portfolio"). 94 2. Bewertung der Aktienklasse Der Nettovermögenswert der Aktienklasse wird durch die Man Valuation Services Limited (die "Bewertungsstelle") zum letzten Kalendertag eines jeden Kalendermonats (jeweils ein "Aktienklassebewertungstag") ermittelt. Der Nettoinventarwert (net asset value) der Aktienklasse (der "NAV") pro sich im Umlauf befindender Aktie wird dem Wert des Vermögens der Aktienklasse minus der Aktienklasse zugeordneter Verbindlichkeiten, dividiert durch die Anzahl der sich im Umlauf befindenden Aktien an dem entsprechenden Bewertungstag entsprechen. Die Bewertungsstelle wird den NAV auf Grundlage der Informationen ermitteln, die ihr von den Direktoren der Gesellschaft in Bezug auf den jeweiligen Aktienklassebewertungstag zur Verfügung gestellt werden. Es wird erwartet, dass die Gesellschaft ihre Vermögenswerte und Verbindlichkeiten im Einklang mit den folgenden Prinzipien bewertet: (a) Finanzanlagen in anderen gepoolten Sondervermögen werden zu den Preisen bewertet, die von diesen Sondervermögen zur Verfügung gestellt werden; (b) alle Berechnungen, die auf der Bewertung von Finanzanlagen beruhen, die (i) an einer Futures-Börse notiert, zugelassen oder gehandelt werden, werden auf der Grundlage des Schlusskurses an der entsprechenden Futures-Börse zum Geschäftsschluss desjenigen Tages ermittelt, für den eine solche Berechnung vorzunehmen ist; (ii) an einer anderen Börse (d.h. nicht einer Futures-Börse) notiert, zugelassen oder gehandelt werden, werden auf der Grundlage der letzten Notierung (oder, sofern kein Handel stattfindet, zum letzten Geldkurs für gedeckte Positionen (long positions) oder zum letzten Briefkurs für ungedeckte Positionen (short positions)) an der Hauptbörse für die jeweilige Finanzanlage zum Geschäftsschluss desjenigen Tages ermittelt, für den eine solche Berechnung vorzunehmen ist; und (iii) auf einem ungeregelten Markt (over-the-counter-market) gehandelt werden, der für diese den Hauptmarkt darstellt, werden durch Bezugnahme auf den Mittelwert zwischen dem letzten Geld- und Briefkurs, der für sie notiert wurde, ermittelt, vorausgesetzt, dass (aa) wenn die Direktoren der Gesellschaft nach ihrem freien Ermessen begründeterweise davon ausgehen können, dass die an einer anderen Börse oder ungeregeltem Markt als der Hauptbörse geltenden Preise einen in Anbetracht aller Umstände angemesseneren Bewertungsansatz für die Finanzanlagen darstellen, so können sie diese Preise übernehmen, und (bb) die Direktoren der Gesellschaft nach ihrem freien Ermessen eine andere Bewertungsmethode verwenden können, falls sie begründeterweise eine solche Bewertung für die Finanzanlagen für geeigneter halten, einen angemessenen Wert zu bestimmen; (c) Termingeschäfte über Fremdwährungen werden unter Bezugnahme auf den Preis am Indexbewertungstag bewertet, an dem ein neues Termingeschäft gleicher Größe und Fälligkeit eingegangen werden könnte; (d) Barmittel oder Einlagen und Forderungen, Vorauszahlungen und Bardividenden, die aufgelaufen aber noch nicht ausgezahlt wurden, werden 95 mit ihrer vollen Höhe bewertet, ausser die Direktoren entscheiden, dass es unwahrscheinlich ist, dass diese in voller Höhe erhalten oder gezahlt werden, in welchem Fall die Direktoren in ihrem freien Ermessen einen angemessenen Abschlag zur Bestimmung des tatsächlichen Wertes festlegen können; (e) falls keine der oben bezeichneten Preisnotierungen verfügbar sein sollte, wird der Wert von Zeit zu Zeit nach einer von den Direktoren der Gesellschaft in begründeter Weise festgelegten Methode ermittelt; (f) sofern angemessen, werden Bewertungen (sei es für Wertpapiere oder liquide Mittel), welche auf eine andere Währung als Euro lauten, zu einem amtlichen oder einem sonstigen Kurs in Euro umgerechnet, den die Direktoren der Gesellschaft nach ihrem freien Ermessen in begründeter Weise für als den Umständen angemessen halten, unter anderem im Hinblick auf relevante Auf- oder Abschläge und Umtauschkosten; und (g) Verbindlichkeiten werden mit ihrem Zeitwert bewertet. Die Berechnung des Nettoinventarwerts der Fonds-Komponente kann von den Direktoren für den gesamten Zeitraum oder eines Teils davon ausgesetzt werden während dem: (a) eine Börse, an der ein wesentlicher Teil der Anlagen der Aktienklasse notiert, zugelassen oder gehandelt wird, geschlossen ist (ausser Wochenenden oder amtliche Feiertage), oder der Handel beschränkt ist; (b) Umstände vorliegen, durch die es nach Meinung der Direktoren für die Gesellschaft nicht in vernünftiger Weise möglich ist Anlagen der Aktienklasse zu veräussern, oder durch die eine Veräusserung einen wesentlichen Nachteil für die Inhaber der Fonds-Komponente zur Folge hätte; (c) ein Ausfall derjenigen Systeme vorliegt und diejenigen Mittel nicht zur Verfügung stehen mit denen unter normalen Umständen die Bewertung der Anlagen der Fonds-Komponente vorgenommen wird, oder ein anderer Grund vorliegt der eine faire und vernünftige Bewertung der Anlagen nicht möglich macht; (d) es der Gesellschaft unmöglich ist, die für die Auszahlung aufgrund einer teilweisen oder vollständigen Veräusserung der Fonds-Komponenten durch die Inhaber benötigten finanziellen Mittel zu repatriieren; (e) Zahlungsverpflichtungen oder Anlagen nach Meinung der Direktoren nicht zu einem sich unter normalen Umständen bildenden Wechselkurs ausgeführt werden können; (f) im Fall einer Auflösung der Gesellschaft oder zwangsweisen Rückgabe der Fonds-Komponenten die erste Meldung über eine derartige Entscheidung an die Inhaber veröffentlicht wird; 96 (g) die Anlagen der Gesellschaft von einer freiwilligen oder unfreiwilligen Liquidation, einem Konkurs, einer Zahlungsunfähigkeit oder einem sonstigen ähnlichen Vorfall betroffen sind, oder die Anlagen Gegenstand einer Enteignung sind oder anderweitig an eine staatliche Behörde oder Gesellschaft übertragen werden müssen; (h) die Direktoren der Meinung sind, dass die Änderung oder Übernahme eines Gesetzes, einer Verordnung oder Vorschrift durch eine staatliche Behörde, Zentralbank oder vergleichbare Institution oder eine Anweisung oder Verfügung einer dieser Institutionen den Kauf, Verkauf oder Übertrag der Anlagen einschränkt; oder (i) jeder andere Zeitraum den die Direktoren in ihrem freien Ermessen festlegen können falls dies ihrer Meinung nach im Interesse der gesamten Anteilsinhaber der Gesellschaft oder der Anteilsinhaber der Aktienklasse ist. Während die Bewertung der Aktienklasse ausgesetzt ist können keine FondsKomponenten zurückgegeben oder neu ausgegeben werden. Die Direktoren behalten sich das Recht vor Zahlungen in Verbindung mit einer Rückgabe von FondsKomponenten vor einer Aussetzung der Bewertung solange zurückzuhalten bis diese Aussetzung wieder aufgehoben wird. Bei der Andienung von Fonds-Komponenten wird jeder Inhaber von einer eventuell bestehenden Aussetzung der Bewertung unterrichtet. Falls der Antrag auf Rückgabe der Fonds-Komponenten daraufhin nicht zurückgenommen wird, wird die Rückgabe am ersten Tag nach Aufhebung der Aussetzung an dem dies möglich ist, oder jedem anderen Tag den die Direktoren bestimmen können, ausgeführt. Die Direktoren haben das Recht den Handel mit den Fonds-Komponenten auszusetzen an den Investment Manager delegiert. 3. Geschäftsaktivitäten von Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd, Aktienklasse Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares Das Investmentziel der Gesellschaft in Bezug auf die Aktienklasse besteht darin, eher Kursgewinne als Zinsen zu erwirtschaften. Die Fonds-Komponenten sind so gestaltet, dass sie auf wesentliches mittelfristiges Wachstum abzielen und Diversifikationsvorteile innerhalb eines traditionellen Aktien- und Anleihenportfolios bieten, indem die in Verbindung mit den Fonds-Komponenten vereinnahmten Erträge in das AHL Institutional Programme und das MGS Style Portfolio ("Anlagestrategien") investiert werden. Als Gesellschaft mit zugriffsbeschränkten Konten (segregated accounts company) wird die Gesellschaft in Bezug auf die Aktien ein gesondertes zugriffsbeschränktes Konto (segregated account) einrichten. Das Guthaben dieses zugriffbeschränkten Kontos darf nur zum Ausgleich von Verbindlichkeiten gegenüber Gläubigern dieses zugriffbeschränkten Kontos verwendet werden und darf nicht zur Begleichung von Verbindlichkeiten gegenüber Gläubigern anderer zugriffsbeschränkter Konten oder, vorbehaltlich einer abweichenden Vereinbarung, gegenüber den allgemeinen Gläubigern der Gesellschaft herangezogen werden. Die Gesellschaft wird die MGSIS Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Trading Ltd. gründen, die als handelnde Tochtergesellschaft für die Gesellschaft in Bezug auf die Aktienklasse fungieren wird ("Handelnde Tochtergesellschaft"). Die Handelnde 97 Tochtergesellschaft ist eine steuerbefreite Gesellschaft (exempted company) nach dem Recht von Bermuda und wird voraussichtlich im April 2008 mit beschränkter Haftung gegründet. Zum Zeitpunkt der Gründung beträgt das Stammkapital der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft USD 12.000,00, aufgeteilt in 12.000 Stammaktien jeweils mit einem Nennwert von USD 1,00. Nach dem Abzug der vorläufigen Kosten (wie im Abschnitt mit der Überschrift "Provisionen und Aufwendungen" beschrieben), wird der Saldo der Erlöse der Aktienemission zur Finanzierung der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft verwendet und der gesamte Handel der Gesellschaft in Bezug auf die Anlagestrategien durch die Handelnde Tochtergesellschaft abgewickelt. Die Beteiligung der Gesellschaft an der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft wird bei der Gesellschaft als ein Vermögenswert der Aktienklasse erfasst. Das Portfolio der Aktienklasse wird durch Man Investments Limited (der "Investment Manager") verwaltet. Der Investment Manager wird die Marktsituation beobachten und kann regelmäßig Vermögenswerte der Aktienklasse zwischen dem AHL Institutional Programme und dem MGS Style Portfolio umverteilen oder andere Anlagestrategien für das Portfolio der Aktienklasse einführen, um die Anlageziele zu erreichen. Neben den Aktien und anderen Aktienklassen hat die Gesellschaft 100 Manager Shares mit einem jeweiligen Nennwert von USD 1,00 ausgegeben, die zu 25 Prozent der Man Holdings Limited gehören, einer auf Bermuda errichteten Tochtergesellschaft der Man Group Holdings Limited. Die übrigen 75 Prozent der Manager Shares stehen im Eigentum der Albany Management Company Limited, einer auf Bermuda errichteten Gesellschaft. Die Manager Shares sind mit 100 Prozent der Stimmrechte in der Gesellschaft ausgestattet. Die Inhaber der Manager Shares sind insgesamt berechtigt, Dividenden bis zu einem Gegenwert von USD 5.000,00 pro Jahr zu erhalten. Die Gesellschaft ist auch berechtigt, andere Klassen stimmrechtsloser rückzahlbarer gewinnbeteiligter Aktien zu emittieren, für die jeweils ein gesondertes Konto eröffnet werden wird. 4. Investment Exposure und Fremdkapitalaufnahme Der Investment Manager wird in Bezug auf eine Fonds-Komponente ein Ziel Investment Exposure von etwa 150% des folgenden Wertes anstreben ("Referenzwert(t)"): (1 / PartRate) * (Barwert der hypothetischen Nullkuponanleihe(t) + PartRate * NAV(t) / NAV(Anfang)) Wobei: "Barwert" der in Prozent ausgedrückte Marktwert einer synthetischen Nullkuponanleihe rückzahlbar zu EUR 1.200 am Fälligkeitstag und zu jedem Bankgeschäftstag bewertet. Dieser Marktwert wird auf der Basis der EUR-Zinskurve unter Zugrundelegung eines Zinssatzes von 1-Monats EURIBOR plus 0,22% festgesetzt. 98 "Barwert der hypothetischen Nullkuponanleihe(t)" der in Prozent ausgedrückte theoretische Wert einer synthetischen Nullkuponanleihe rückzahlbar zu EUR 1,20 am Fälligkeitstag und zu jedem Bankgeschäftstag bewertet ist. Dieser theoretische Wert wird unter Zugrundelegung eines Zinssatzes von 1-Monats EURIBOR plus 0,30% festgesetzt. "Fälligkeitstag" der 15. Februar 2023 ist. "Festlegungstag" der 13. Mai 2008 ist. "NAV(t)" den Nettoinventarwert Aktienklassebewertungstag darstellt. der Fonds-Komponente am jeweiligen "NAV(Anfang)" EUR 1 beträgt. "PartRate" die Differenz zwischen 100% und dem Barwert am Festlegungstag beträgt. Zu Beginn ist dabei vorgesehen etwa je 75% Investment Exposure in das AHL Institutional Programme und in das MGS Style Portfolio zu investieren. Diese Aufteilung des Investment Exposures auf die Anlagestrategien sowie die Allokation zu einzelnen Anlagestrategien unterliegen jedoch vollständig dem Ermessen des Investment Managers und können sich – auch in der Zukunft - je nach Einschätzung der Chancen der einzelnen Anlagestrategien verändern. Weiterhin kann der Investment Manager künftig auch andere Anlagestrategien hinzufügen, vorhandene Anlagestrategien ersetzen oder je nach Marktumfeld in eigenem Ermessen das Ziel Investment Exposure anpassen. Es ist jedoch nicht vorgesehen das Ziel Investment Exposure auf mehr als 180% zu erhöhen. Die Handelnde Tochtergesellschaft kann Vereinbarungen zur Fremdkapitalaufnahme treffen. Es wird erwartet, dass der ausstehende Kreditbetrag pro Fonds-Komponente gemäß den Vereinbarungen zur Fremdkapitalaufnahme sich stets maximal auf 75% des aktuellen Referenzwerts oder einen solchen anderen Betrag belaufen wird, den die Direktoren von Zeit zu Zeit festlegen können. Neben der Befriedigung kurzfristigen Liquiditätsbedarfs können die Vereinbarungen zur Fremdkapitalaufnahme durch den Investment Manager genutzt werden, um es der Aktienklasse zu ermöglichen, das gewünschte Investment Exposure zu erreichen. Neben der Bereitstellung des Fremdkapitals durch unabhängige Dritte kann das Fremdkapital (ganz oder teilweise) von einer oder mehreren Gesellschaften der Man Group bereitgestellt werden. 5. Beschreibung der Anlagestrategien Die folgenden Anlagestrategien stellen die Investitionen dar, die die Handelnde Tochtergesellschaft voraussichtlich am 1. Juni 2008 tätigen wird. Danach kann der Investment Manager auch weitere Anlagestrategien hinzufügen. Das AHL Institutional Programme AHL verwendet quantitative Handelsstrategien die darauf ausgerichtet sind, Preistendenzen zu erkennen und auszunutzen, und sich die Marktineffizienzen in etwa 99 100 Finanzmärkten weltweit zu Nutze zu machen. AHL bietet Anlegern Zugang zu einem über verschiedene Märkte diversifizierten Portfolio, das derzeit Aktienindizes, Anleihen, Währungen, kurzfristige Zinssätze und Energie- und Metallkontrakte beinhaltet. Der Spielraum, in ein diversifiziertes Portfolio von Währungen bis zu Rohstoffen zu investieren, vergrößert die vorhandenen Möglichkeiten und hilft das Anlagerisiko zu verringern. Da sich das Programm ausschließlich auf computerbetriebenen Handel stützt, ist es zu 100% systematisch. Das AHL Institutional Programme zeichnet sich durch Stabilität und Skalierbarkeit aus. Es verwendet eine Vielzahl von Handelsfrequenzen und hat somit die Möglichkeit, von kurz- oder langfristigen Markttendenzen zu profitieren. Die Allokation der Vermögenswerte in die bestimmten Märkte berücksichtigt: − Korrelationen zwischen spezifischen Sektoren und Märkten, − Zielrenditen und Volatilitätsniveaus, − Marktzugangskosten, und − die Marktliquidität. Die Methode der Portfoliostrukturierung und Vermögensallokation konzentriert sich auf Diversifizierung und die Bedeutung des Einsatzes von Anlagekapital über die gesamte Palette von Märkten. Die Instrumente, die in dem diversifizierten Portfolio gehandelt werden, können Futures, Optionen, Terminkontrakte, Swaps und andere Derivate umfassen. Die Anzahl und die Vielfalt der Märkte und Instrumente, die direkt oder indirekt durch das AHL Institutional Programme gehandelt werden, können sich ändern. Die MGS Style Portfolios Daneben strebt die Aktienklasse die Erschließung weiteren Potenzials durch eine Anlage in die MGS Style Portfolios an, welche sich aus mittelbaren oder unmittelbaren Beteiligungen an MGS Arbitrage Strategies N Ltd., MGS Directional Strategies Ltd., MGS Equity Hedge Strategies Ltd., Man Long/Short Equities NF Style Series Class A, und/oder anderen Gesellschaften zusammensetzen können, von denen jede ein diversifizierter Hedge-Dachfonds mit einem diversifizierten MultiStrategy-Ansatz ist oder in solche investiert. Die Gesellschaften, die Teil der MGS Style Portfolios sind, verwirklichen ihre Strategien durch Verteilung der Gelder auf Investmentmanager. Die Investmentmanager verwenden verschiedene alternative Investmentstrategien und wenden eine Reihe komplementärer quantitativer und qualitativer Anlagemethoden passend zu jedem Anlagestil an. Arbitrage Der Arbitrage-Stil schließt Anlagestrategien ein, die typischerweise Preisabweichungen bei verwandten Wertpapieren innerhalb eines oder zwischen verschiedenen Märkten ausnutzen. Durch die Bildung von gedeckten Positionen in unterbewerteten Anlagewerten und ungedeckten Positionen in überbewerteten 100 Anlagewerten versuchen diese Strategien Profitmöglichkeiten zu nutzen, die aus der sich verändernden Preisbeziehung zwischen den betroffenen Anlagewerten entstehen. Die Strategien sind üblicherweise ihrer Natur nach relativwert- oder ereignisorientiert und umfassen Wandelanleihen, festverzinsliche Wertpapiere, Fusionen, besondere Situationen und Multi-Strategy Arbitrage-Ansätze. Unabhängig von der Entwicklungsrichtung der allgemeinen Marktpreise sollen sie mit einer relativ geringen Volatilität in allen Marktlagen Gewinne erwirtschaften. Direktional Der direktionale Stil beinhaltet Anlagestrategien, die die Top-Down-Analyse der makroökonomischen und finanziellen Bedingungen verwenden, um Preisineffizienzen aufzudecken, die in Ländern als Folge politischer oder wirtschaftlicher Veränderungen auf regionaler und nationaler Ebene entstehen. Sie konzentrieren sich vor allem auf globale Handelsmethoden mit Macro-, opportunistischen und frei ermessensbasierten Ansätzen, was auch Relative Value-Anlagen in Wachstumsmärkten beinhalten kann. Der Stil kann erhebliche gedeckte oder ungedeckte Netto-Positionen in Wertpapieren, Zinssätzen, Rohstoffen und Währungen innerhalb von Ländern oder Gruppen von Ländern involvieren. Die Strategien erzeugen Erträge, die im Allgemeinen unkorreliert zu traditionellen Anlageklassen und anderen Anlagestilen von Hedge-Fonds sind. Equity Hedge Der Anlagestil Equity Hedge beinhaltet Anlagestrategien, die relativwert- und marktneutral sind (entweder Dollar oder Beta) oder von Natur aus eine hohe Absicherung darstellen. Er zielt darauf ab, von der Identifizierung von Aktien zu profitieren, die in Beziehung zu anderen Aktien oder Gruppen von Aktien, oft innerhalb eines Sektors, für unter- oder überbewertet gehalten werden. Anlageentscheidungen werden häufig innerhalb systematischer Rahmenbedingungen getroffen. Die Aktienauswahl basiert üblicherweise entweder auf einer preisbasierten Analyse, was die gewöhnliche Vorgehensweise im Fall von statistischen ArbitrageModellen ist, oder auf verschiedenen Messwerten für den zugrunde liegenden Wert. Gelegentlich werden auch Mehrfaktorenmodelle verwendet, die sowohl technische als auch grundlegende Messwerte kombinieren. Im Allgemeinen wird erwartet, dass die Performance dieser Strategien relative geringe Korrelation und Beta zu den gehandelten Märkten aufweist. Equity Hedge-Strategien sind oft durch eine relative hohe Handelsfrequenz gekennzeichnet. Strategien innerhalb dieser Kategorien zielen darauf ab, beständige Erträge in allen Marktlagen mit relativ geringer Volatilität zu erreichen. Long/Short Equities Der Anlagestil Long/Short Equities beinhaltet Anlagestrategien, die ohne notwendige Beschränkungen gedeckte und ungedeckte Positionen eingehen und deshalb variable oder konstante Nettotendenzen aufweisen können. Sie zielen darauf ab, von der Identifizierung von und Anlage in solche Aktien zu profitieren, die für unter- oder überbewertet gehalten werden – ein Ansatz der häufig als „Stock-Picking“ bezeichnet wird. Im Allgemeinen wird erwartet, dass die Performance dieser Strategien eine höhere Korrelation und Beta zu den gehandelten Märkten aufweist als Equity Hedge- 101 Strategien. Auch die Volatilität ist üblicherweise höher als bei Equity HedgeStrategien. Das Ziel der Portfoliostrukturierung in diesem Gebiet liegt darin, Anlagefachwissen in komplementären Bereichen zum Tragen zu bringen, über geografische und/oder Sektorengrenzen hinweg. Diese Anlagestile sind nicht abschließend und der Investment Manager kann, im Rahmen der Bemühung um die Erreichung des Anlageziels der Aktienklasse, Mittel auch neuen Ansätzen zuweisen, die nicht in die oben beschriebenen Kategorien fallen. Der Investment Manager kann die Strukturierung und Verwaltung individueller Portfolios oder anderer Anlagestrategien auch an assoziierte oder externe Manager übertragen. Auch die Zusammensetzung und Beschreibung dieser Kategorien können sich im Laufe der Zeit ändern. 6. Provisionen und Aufwendungen Der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft wird monatlich nachträglich eine Managementprovision zu einem Satz von 0,8% pro Jahr auf das Investment Exposure der Mittelzuteilung bezogen auf jede Anlagestrategie (d.h. auf das Investment Exposure, das mit dem Betrag der Anlagemittel, der von der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft durch den Investment Manager im Laufe der Zeit mittelbar oder unmittelbar jeder Anlagestrategie zugewiesen wird, erreicht wird) berechnet. Auf der Ebene des Dachfonds wird keine Erfolgsprämie in Rechnung gestellt. Die gesamten Provisionen oder ein Teil davon können von Man Investments oder ihren verbundenen Unternehmen vereinnahmt werden. Es ist eine Risikotransfer- und Verwaltungsgebühr von einem Zwölftel von 1% pro Monat (circa 1% pro Jahr) vom Wert der Zertifikate zu berechnen und monatlich nachträglich an den Investment Manager zu zahlen, sowie eine Liquiditäts- und Finanzverwaltungsgebühr von einem Zwölftel von 0,6% pro Monat (circa 0,6% pro Jahr) auf das Investment Exposure der Mittelzuteilung bezogen auf jede Anlagestrategie, zahlbar an den Investment Manager. Beide Gebühren werden monatlich errechnet und sind nachträglich zu zahlen. Ferner ist an den Emittenten der apano AP Enhanced Garant 2 Garanertifikate eine Emittentengebühr von einem Zwölftel von 0,35% des Gesamtnennwertes der zu jedem Monatsende noch ausstehenden Zertifikate zu zahlen. Die Emittentin ist in der Verwendung dieser Gelder frei und kann diese insbesondere im Zusammenhang mit dem Angebot der Zertifikate verwenden. Im Rahmen der Umsetzung der Anlagestrategien werden die Mittelallokationen durch eine Reihe von Methoden erfolgen, wie z. B. durch die Anlage in andere Investmentfonds, Treuhandkonten oder durch beauftragte Investment-Manager. Auf dieser Ebene werden daher, bezogen auf das Investment Exposure des so zugeteilten Teils der Mittel, weitere Provisionen und Aufwendungen, einschließlich gegebenenfalls Verwaltungs- und Erfolgsprovisionen, anfallen. Beauftragte Manager werden im Allgemeinen durch eine Kombination von Verwaltungs- und Erfolgsprovisionen entschädigt. Eine typische Gebührenstruktur besteht aus einer jährlichen Verwaltungsgebühr von bis zu 2% auf das Investment Exposure der Mittelzuteilung und einer Erfolgsprovision von 20%, berechnet auf der Basis des Netto-Wertzuwachses der Anlage für jeden der beauftragten Manager. Nicht alle 102 Vergütungsvereinbarungen mit beauftragten Managern sind auf diese Weise aufgebaut oder fallen in diese Spannen. Es wird eine Beratungs- und Verwaltungsprovision von 0,5% pro Jahr auf das Investment Exposure der Mittelzuteilung an bestimmte Investment Manager berechnet werden, wobei die Provision monatlich nachträglich bezahlt wird. Die Handelnde Tochtergesellschaft hat alle Kosten und Maklerprovisionen im Zusammenhang mit den Handelsgeschäften zu zahlen, die eine Einführungsmaklerprovision für den einführenden Broker von bis zu 2% pro Jahr auf das Investment Exposure der Mittelzuteilung zu bestimmten Anlagestrategien, Zinsen für Finanzierungen und damit verbundene Gebühren beinhalten werden. Die Aktienklasse zahlt eine Bewertungsgebühr von bis zu 0,15% pro Jahr des Nettovermögenswertes der Aktien (vorbehaltlich eines Minimums von USD 50.000 pro Jahr) an die Bewertungsstelle und ersetzt die bei ihr entstandenen Ausgaben in Bezug auf die Aktien. Jede Fremdkapitalaufnahme gemäß den Vereinbarungen zur Fremdkapitalaufnahme wird voraussichtlich mit Zinsen in Höhe der LIBOR plus einer Marge verbunden sein (wobei diese Marge Änderungen unterworfen sein kann, aber voraussichtlich 2% nicht übersteigen wird), welche quartalsweise nachträglich zahlbar ist und auf den Kapitalbetrag der ausstehenden Fremdkapitalaufnahme gemäß den Vereinbarungen zur Fremdkapitalaufnahme berechnet wird. Voraussichtlich wird nach dem Ende der Erstausgabe der Aktienklasse von der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft eine Bereitstellungsgebühr in Bezug auf die Fremdkapitalaufnahme zu zahlen sein und im Fall der Verlängerung wird für die Fremdkapitalaufnahme gemäß den Vereinbarungen zur Fremdkapitalaufnahme voraussichtlich eine jährliche Verlängerungsgebühr anfallen. Im Zusammenhang mit der Vermittlung von freien Handelsvereinbarungen wird die Handelnde Tochtergesellschaft dem Investment Manager eine Provision von 0,05% pro Jahr (monatlich anfallend und monatlich nachträglich zahlbar) auf das Investment Exposure der Mittelzuteilung zu jeder Anlagestrategie zahlen. Die vorläufigen Aufwendungen, die im Zusammenhang mit der Schaffung der Aktienklasse, einschließlich der Gründung der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft, entstanden sind, die juristischen Kosten der Aktienklasse, der Handelnden Tochtergesellschaft und von Man Investments sowie der Erstausgabe der Aktien werden im Ergebnis von der Aktienklasse beglichen. Diese Aufwendungen werden während der ersten drei Jahre amortisiert, der Aktienklasse berechnet und werden voraussichtlich nicht mehr als USD 100.000 betragen. Die vorstehende Beschreibung ist allgemeiner Art und erhebt keinen Anspruch auf Vollständigkeit. Potentielle Anleger müssen sich bewusst sein, dass allen Beschreibungen von Investmentprozessen aufgrund ihrer Komplexität, Vertraulichkeit und Subjektivität naturgemäß Grenzen gesetzt sind. Darüber hinaus wird die Beschreibung praktisch jeder Handelsstrategie durch die Tatsache eingeschränkt, dass Handelsstrategien ebenso wie die Märkte, an denen die Fonds-Komponente anlegt, einem ständigen Wandel unterworfen sind. 103 ZERTIFIKATSBEDINGUNGEN §1 Zertifikatsrecht; Rückzahlungsbetrag (1) Die Morgan Stanley B.V. (die "Emittentin") gewährt hiermit dem Inhaber (der "Zertifikatsinhaber") von je einem kapitalgeschützten apano AP Garant 2 Garantiezertifikat (das "Zertifikat") bezogen auf Aktien der Klasse T2 (die "Aktienklasse", eine Aktie der Klasse Man AP Enhanced Garant 2 Class T2 EUR Shares stellt die "Fonds-Komponente" dar) der Man Global Strategies Investment Strategies Ltd. (die "Gesellschaft") das Recht, vorbehaltlich eines Vorzeitigen Verkaufs durch den Zertifikatsinhaber gemäß § 9 bzw. einer Kündigung durch die Emittentin gemäß § 10, nach Maßgabe dieser Zertifikatsbedingungen am Fälligkeitstag (§ 2) den Rückzahlungsbetrag (§ 1 (2)), bzw. am Vorzeitigen Rückzahlungstag (§ 2) den Vorzeitigen Verkaufspreis (§ 9 (2)) zu beziehen (das "Zertifikatsrecht"). (2) Der am Fälligkeitstag durch die Emittentin zu zahlende Rückzahlungsbetrag pro Zertifikat (der "Rückzahlungsbetrag") entspricht dem höheren Betrag von: (i) Nennwert * 120% und (ii) Nennwert * (120%+Partizipation * NAV(Ende) / NAV(Anfang)) Wobei: "Barwert der Nullkuponanleihe" der in Prozent ausgedrückte Marktwert einer synthetischen Nullkuponanleihe rückzahlbar zu 120% des Nennwerts am Fälligkeitstag (§ 2) und zu jedem Bankgeschäftstag (§ 2) bewertet. Dieser Marktwert wird von der Berechnungsstelle (§ 6) auf der Basis der EURZinskurve unter Zugrundelegung eines Zinssatzes von 1-Monats EURIBOR plus 0,22% festgesetzt. "NAV(Ende)" dem Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente am Letzten Bewertungstag (§ 2) entspricht. "NAV(Anfang)" Euro 1 entspricht. "Nennwert" Euro 1.000 entspricht. 104 "Nettoinventarwert" ("NAV") der Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente ist, wie er durch Man Valuations Ltd. (die "Bewertungsstelle") ermittelt und durch Man Investments bekannt gegeben wird. "Partizipation" voraussichtlich 43%* beträgt (*indikativ, die Partizipation wird am Festlegungstag auf Basis der Differenz aus 100% und dem Barwert der Nullkuponanleihe von der Berechnungsstelle festgelegt). §2 Weitere Definitionen "Allokationstag" ist der 1. Juni 2008. "Festlegungstag" ist der 13. Mai 2008. "Bankgeschäftstag" ist jeder Tag (außer Samstag und Sonntag) an dem die Banken in Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland, Amsterdam, Niederlande und in London, Großbritannien, für den Geschäftsverkehr geöffnet sind , das Trans-European Automated Real-time Gross settlement Express Transfer System ("TARGET-System") geöffnet ist und das Clearingsytem (§ 3) Wertpapiergeschäfte abwickelt. "Bewertungstag" ist der jeweils der letzte Tag eines Kalendermonats, oder jeder andere Tag, der von den Direktoren der Fonds-Komponente festgelegt werden kann. "Fälligkeitstag" ist der 15. Februar 2023. "Fonds-Geschäftstag" ist jeder Tag (außer Samstag und Sonntag), der in Bermuda, Dublin, London, Zürich, Jersey, Isle of Man und New York als Werktag gilt. "Geschäftstag" ist Bankgeschäftstag ist. jeder Fonds-Geschäftstag, der zugleich ein "Letzter Bewertungstag" ist der 31. Dezember 2022. "Vorzeitiger Rückzahlungstag" im Fall des Vorzeitigen Verkaufs durch den Zertifikatsinhaber gemäß § 9, ist spätestens der sechsunddreissigste (36.) Geschäftstag, der auf den jeweils maßgeblichen Vorzeitigen Verkaufstag folgt. §3 Status; Garantie; Form der Zertifikate; Girosammelverwahrung; Übertragbarkeit (1) Die Zertifikate begründen unbesicherte und nicht nachrangige Verbindlichkeiten der Emittentin, die untereinander und mit allen gegenwärtigen und zukünftigen unbesicherten und nicht nachrangigen Verbindlichkeiten der 105 Emittentin, abgesehen von solchen Verbindlichkeiten, denen auf Grund zwingender gesetzlicher Bestimmungen der Vorrang zukommt, gleichrangig sind. (2) Morgan Stanley (die "Garantin") hat eine unbedingte und unwiderrufliche Garantie (die "Garantie") für die vertragsgemäße Zahlung auf die Zertifikate zahlbarer Beträge übernommen. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbar gegen die Garantin bestehende und durchsetzbare Ansprüche der Zertifikatsinhaber. Die Garantie begründet unmittelbare, unbedingte, nichtnachrangige und unbesicherte Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, die jederzeit zumindest gleichrangig sind mit allen sonstigen gegenwärtigen und zukünftigen unmittelbaren, unbedingten, nicht-nachrangigen und unbesicherten Verbindlichkeiten der Garantin, mit Ausnahme solcher Verbindlichkeiten, die kraft zwingender gesetzlicher Bestimmungen vorrangig sind. (3) Die Zertfikate werden im Sinne der U.S. Treasury Regulation § 1.163-5(c) (2) (i) (D) anfänglich durch eine vorläufige Globalurkunde (die "Vorläufige Dauerglobalurkunde") verbrieft, die gegen eine die Zertifikate verbriefende Dauerglobalurkunde (die "Dauerglobalurkunde") nicht früher als 40 Tage und nicht später als 180 Tage nach dem Abschluss der Platzierung der Zertifikate gegen Nachweis des Nichtbestehens einer U.S.-Inhaberschaft (certification of non U.S. beneficial ownership) ausgetauscht wird. Die Vorläufige Dauerglobalurkunde bzw. die Dauerglobalurkunde werden jeweils bei Clearstream Banking AG, Frankfurt am Main, Neue Börsenstraße 1, 60487 Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland (das "Clearingsystem") hinterlegt. Ansprüche auf Lieferung effektiver Stücke werden ausgeschlossen. Die Zertifikate sind nach dem jeweils anwendbaren Recht und gegebenenfalls den jeweils geltenden Vorschriften und Verfahren des Clearingsystems übertragbar. (4) Im Effektengiroverkehr sind die Zertifikate einzeln oder einem ganzzahligen Vielfachen davon übertragbar. §4 Aussetzungen und Verschiebungen (1) Bei Eintritt oder dem wahrscheinlichen Eintritt eines Aussetzunggrundes (§ 4 (2)) in Bezug auf die Fonds-Komponente kann die Berechnungsstelle, wenn sie nach billigem Ermessen (gemäß § 317 BGB) der Ansicht ist, dass dieser Grund wesentlich ist und sich nachteilig auf die Fonds-Komponente oder die Berechnung des Nettoinventarwerts der Fonds-Komponente auswirkt, die Bewertung der Zertifikate, den Vorzeitigen Verkaufstag sowie den jeweiligen Vorzeitigen Rückzahlungstag für den Zeitraum des Vorliegens dieses Grundes verschieben oder aussetzen. Bei einer Verschiebung des Letzten Bewertungstags verschiebt sich der Fälligkeitstag entsprechend. 106 (2) "Aussetzungsgrund" bezeichnet einen der folgenden Umstände: (a) Die Bewertungsstelle versäumt es, den Nettoinventarwert der Fondskomponente wie vorgesehen zu ermitteln oder bekannt zu geben oder versäumt es, andere Informationen bezüglich der Gesellschaft zu veröffentlichen, die nach den Regeln oder den Fonds-Dokumenten zu veröffentlichen wären. (b) Wenn die Berechnungsstelle nach Ausübung billigen Ermessens (gemäß § 317 BGB) berechtigten Grund zu der Annahme besitzt, dass der bekannt gegebene Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente einen offenkundigen Fehler enthält oder unrichtig ist, kann sie die Berechnung und Bekanntmachung des Nettoinventarwerts der Fonds-Komponente als zum Zweck aller in Zusammenhang mit den Zertifikaten stehenden Berechnungen als "nicht bekannt gegeben" ansehen, bis der Investment Manager ihr einen überarbeiteten Nettoinventarwert der FondsKomponente vorlegt, welcher zur Zufriedenheit der Berechnungsstelle angemessen begründet werden kann (die "Bekanntmachungsaussetzungszeit"). Die Berechnungsstelle ersucht beim Investment Manager innerhalb von fünf (5) Bankgeschäftstagen nach dem maßgeblichen Geschäftstag schriftlich (das "Ersuchen") um einen überarbeiteten Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente. (c) Der Hypothetischer Aktieninhaber erhält bei einer Rückgabe der Aktien der Gesellschaft nicht den vollen Erlös (Rückkaufwert) innerhalb der üblichen, unter den in den Dokumenten dargelegten normalen Marktbedingungen anwendbaren, Zahlungsfrist für Rücknahmen. (3) Verschiebungen und Aussetzungen nach den vorstehenden Absätzen werden von der Berechnungsstelle nach billigem Ermessen (gemäß § 317 BGB), vorgenommen und von der Emittentin nach § 7 dieser Bedingungen bekannt gemacht. Verschiebungen und Aussetzungen sind (sofern nicht ein offensichtlicher Fehler vorliegt) für alle Beteiligten endgültig und bindend. (4) Die Berechnungsstelle kann den maßgeblichen Nettoinventarwert der FondsKomponente nach billigem Ermessen (gemäß § 317 BGB) und unter Berücksichtigung des Marktstandards unter Verwendung der gleichen Berechnungsformel und –methode, die in den Fonds-Dokumenten zur Bestimmung des Nettoinventarwerts vorgeschrieben ist, und unter Berücksichtigung der zur Berechnung des Nettoinventarwerts der FondsKomponente notwendigen Daten schätzen, sofern (a) es der Bewertungsstelle nicht gelingt, der Berechnungsstelle innerhalb von fünf (5) Bankgeschäftstagen nach Erhalt des Ersuchens nach § 4 (2) (b) einen überarbeiteten Nettoinventarwert der FondsKomponente vorzulegen, oder falls die Berechnungsstelle nachweist, dass der überarbeitete Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente immer noch einen offenkundigen Fehler enthält oder unrichtig ist; oder 107 (b) die Bewertungsstelle den Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente nicht wie vorgesehen ermittelt oder bekannt gegeben hat (§ 4 (2) (b)) und die Suspendierung oder das Ausbleiben der Bekanntgabe des massgeblichen Nettoinventarwerts der Fondskomponente für mehr als zwanzig (20) Fonds-Geschäftstage nach dem für die Veröffentlichung des Nettoinventarwerts massgeblichen Fonds-Geschäftstags nicht behoben ist. Im Falle nicht ausreichender Daten kann die Berechnungsstelle den Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente nach billigem Ermessen (gemäß § 317 BGB) unter Berücksichtigung der herrschenden Marktbedingungen, des zuletzt gemeldeten Nettoinventarwerts, der der Bewertungsstelle abgegebenen Schätzungen und sonstiger Konditionen bzw. Faktoren, von denen sie angemessenerweise entscheidet, dass sie von Bedeutung sind, berechnen. (5) Das Recht der Emittentin zur Kündigung gemäß § 10 dieser Bedingungen bleibt hiervon unberührt. §5 Berechnungen; Zahlung von Geldbeträgen (1) Die jeweils gemäß diesen Bedingungen zahlbaren Beträge werden durch die Berechnungsstelle berechnet. Sämtliche Beträge werden auf die 2. Dezimalstelle abgerundet. Die Berechnungen sind (sofern nicht ein offensichtlicher Fehler vorliegt) endgültig und für alle Beteiligten bindend. (2) Die Emittentin wird die Überweisung der gemäß diesen Bedingungen zahlbaren Beträge über die Zahlstelle (§ 6) an das Clearingsystem zur Gutschrift auf die Konten der Hinterleger der Zertifikate bei dem Clearingsystem veranlassen. (3) Alle im Zusammenhang mit der Zahlung von Geldbeträgen anfallenden Steuern, Gebühren oder anderen Abgaben sind von dem Zertifikatsinhaber zu tragen und zu zahlen. Die Emittentin bzw. die Zahlstelle sind berechtigt, von Geldbeträgen etwaige Steuern, Gebühren oder Abgaben einzubehalten, die von dem Zertifikatsinhaber gemäß vorstehendem Satz zu zahlen sind. (4) Die in § 801 Absatz 1 BGB bestimmte Vorlegungsfrist wird für die Zertifikate auf 10 Jahre abgekürzt. §6 Zahl- und Berechnungsstelle (1) Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft, Große Gallusstrasse 10-14, 60272 Frankfurt am Main, Deutschland, ist die Zahlstelle (die "Zahlstelle"). Die Emittentin ist berechtigt, jederzeit die Zahlstelle durch ein anderes Kreditinstitut oder Finanzdienstleistungsinstitut mit vergleichbarer Bonität (das "Institut"), das seine Hauptniederlassung oder eine Zweigniederlassung 108 in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland unterhält, zu ersetzen, eine oder mehrere zusätzliche Zahlstellen zu bestellen und deren Bestellung zu widerrufen. Ersetzung, Bestellung und Widerruf werden unverzüglich gemäß § 7 bekannt gemacht. (2) Die Zahlstelle ist berechtigt, jederzeit ihr Amt als Zahlstelle niederzulegen. Die Niederlegung wird nur wirksam mit der Bestellung eines anderen Instituts, das seine Hauptniederlassung oder eine Zweigniederlassung in der Bundesrepublik Deutschland unterhält, zur Zahlstelle durch die Emittentin. Niederlegung und Bestellung werden unverzüglich gemäß § 7 bekannt gemacht. (3) Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc ist die Berechnungsstelle (die "Berechnungsstelle"). Die Emittentin ist berechtigt, jederzeit die Berechnungsstelle durch ein verbundenes Unternehmen zu ersetzen. (4) Die Zahlstelle und die Berechnungsstelle handeln ausschließlich als Erfüllungsgehilfen der Emittentin und haben keinerlei Pflichten gegenüber den Zertifikatsinhabern. Die Zahlstelle ist von den Beschränkungen des § 181 BGB befreit. (5) Weder die Emittentin noch die Zahlstelle sind verpflichtet, die Berechtigung der Einreicher von Zertifikaten zu prüfen. §7 Bekanntmachungen (1) Alle die Zertifikate betreffenden Mitteilungen sind in einer führenden Tageszeitung mit allgemeiner Verbreitung in Deutschland zu veröffentlichen. Diese Tageszeitung wird voraussichtlich die Börsen-Zeitung sein. Jede derartige Mitteilung gilt mit dem fünften Tag nach dem Tag der Veröffentlichung (oder bei mehreren Veröffentlichungen mit dem fünften Tag nach dem Tag der ersten solchen Veröffentlichung) als wirksam erfolgt. (2) Die Emittentin ist berechtigt, eine Veröffentlichung nach Absatz 1 durch eine Mitteilung an das Clearingsystem zur Weiterleitung an die Zertifikatsinhaber zu ersetzen. Jede derartige Mitteilung gilt am fünften Tag nach dem Tag der Mitteilung an das Clearingsystem als den Zertifikatsinhabern mitgeteilt. §8 Aufstockung; Ankauf; Entwertung (1) Die Emittentin ist berechtigt, jederzeit ohne Zustimmung der Zertifikatsinhaber weitere Zertifikate mit gleicher Ausstattung in der Weise zu begeben, dass sie mit diesen Zertifikaten eine einheitliche Serie bilden, wobei in diesem Fall der Begriff "Zertifikate" entsprechend auszulegen ist. 109 (2) Die Emittentin und jedes ihrer Tochterunternehmen ist berechtigt, Zertifikate im Markt oder anderweitig zu jedem beliebigen Preis zu kaufen. Sofern diese Käufe durch öffentliches Angebot erfolgen, muss dieses Angebot allen Zertifikatsinhabern gegenüber erfolgen. Die von der Emittentin erworbenen Zertifikate können nach Wahl der Emittentin von ihr gehalten, weiterverkauft oder entwertet werden. (3) Sämtliche vollständig zurückgezahlten Zertifikate sind unverzüglich zu entwerten und können nicht wiederbegeben oder wiederverkauft werden. §9 Vorzeitiger Verkauf durch die Zertifikatsinhaber (1) Jeder Zertifikatsinhaber ist, vorbehaltlich der nachfolgenden Bestimmungen, berechtigt, die von ihm gehaltenen Zertifikate insgesamt oder teilweise der Emittentin durch schriftliche Mitteilung gegenüber der Zahlstelle und unter Einhaltung einer Mitteilungsfrist von mindestens fünfundzwanzig (25) Kalendertagen vor dem letzten Kalendertag eines Kalenderquartals (jeweils ein "Vorzeitiger Verkaufstag") über die Morgan Stanley Bank AG, Frankfurt am Main, Bundesrepublik Deutschland, zum Ankauf anzudienen ("Vorzeitiger Verkauf"). Der erste Vorzeitige Verkaufstag ist der 31. Dezember 2009 und der letzte Vorzeitige Verkaufstag ist der 30. September 2022. (2) Im Fall des Vorzeitigen Verkaufs erhält der Zertifikatsinhaber am jeweiligen Vorzeitigen Rückzahlungstag den Vorzeitigen Verkaufspreis. Dieser entspricht dem höheren Betrag der beiden folgenden Beträge: (i) Vorzeitiger Mindestverkaufspreis und (ii) einem Betrag, der sich nach folgender Formel bestimmt: [Nennwert*(Nullkuponanleihe(i) + Part*NAV(i)/NAV(Anfang))]*(100%-Gebühr) Wobei: "Nullkuponanleihe(i)" der in Prozent ausgedrückte Marktwert einer synthetischen Nullkuponanleihe rückzahlbar zu 120% des Nennwerts am Fälligkeitstag und zu jedem Bankgeschäftstag bewertet. Dieser Marktwert wird von der Berechnungsstelle auf der Basis der EUR-Zinskurve unter Zugrundelegung eines Zinssatzes von 1‑Monats EURIBOR plus 0,30% festgesetzt, "Part" die Partizipation bezeichnet, die am Festlegungstag auf Basis der Differenz aus 100% und dem Barwert der Nullkuponanleihe von der Berechnungsstelle festgelegt wird, 110 "NAV(i)" dem Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente am jeweiligen Vorzeitigen Verkaufstag entspricht, und "Gebühr" die Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr bezeichnet. Die Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr ("Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr") entspricht im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Zeitraum folgenden Prozentsätzen: Zeitraum Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr 31. Dezember 2009 (einschließlich) 30. Juni 2010 (einschließlich) bis zum 4% 30. September 2010 (einschließlich) 30. Juni 2012 (einschließlich) bis zum 3% 30. September 2012 (einschließlich) 30. Juni 2014 (einschließlich) bis zum 1% Bei einem Vorzeitigen Verkauf nach dem 30. Juni 2014 wird keine Vorzeitige Verkaufsgebühr erhoben. "Vorzeitiger Mindestverkaufspreis" im Hinblick auf den jeweilige Zeitraum folgenden Beträgen entspricht: Zeitraum Vorzeitiger Mindestverkaufspreis Ausgabetag (einschließlich) bis zum 29. Juni 2019 (einschließlich) 0 30. Juni 2019 (einschließlich) 29. Juni 2021 (einschließlich) bis zum Nennwert 30. Juni 2021 (einschließlich) 14. Februar 2023 (einschließlich) bis zum Nennwert * 110% § 10 Kündigung durch die Emittentin (1) Bei Vorliegen eines der nachstehend beispielhaft beschriebenen "Kündigungsereignisse" ist die Emittentin berechtigt, aber nicht verpflichtet, die Zertifikate durch Bekanntmachung gemäß § 7 dieser Bedingungen unter Angabe des Kündigungsereignisses zu kündigen (die "Kündigung"), sofern das Kündigungsereignis nicht innerhalb von dreissig (30) FondsGeschäftstagen (die "Heilungsfrist") (nach Aufforderung durch die Emittentin innerhalb von fünf (5) Bankgeschäftstagen nach dem Vorliegen des Kündigungsereignisses) behoben worden ist: 111 (a) Die Ermittlung und/oder Bekanntmachung des Nettoinventarwerts der Fonds-Komponente wird endgültig eingestellt, oder der Emittentin oder der Berechnungsstelle wird eine entsprechende Absicht bekannt. (b) Die Liquidität, mit welcher die Fonds-Komponente gehandelt werden kann (die "Handelsfrequenz") wird wesentlich zu Lasten der Hypothetischen Aktieninhaber geändert und weicht nun wesentlich von der Handelsfrequenz am Allokationstag oder wesentlich von der Handelsfrequenz, die in den Fonds-Dokumenten beschrieben wird, oder von den sonstigen Regeln in Bezug auf die Gesellschaft ab. Die Änderung oder Abweichung der Handelsfrequenz ist nicht wesentlich, sofern eine zumindest quarteilsweise Rückgabemöglichkeit der FondsKomponente gegeben ist. (c) Die Währung, in der der Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente veröffentlicht wird, (die "Währungseinheit") wird geändert und weicht nun von der Währung am Allokationstag bzw. an dem Tag, zu dem die Fonds-Komponente nach diesen Bestimmungen angepasst wurde, oder von der Währungseinheit, die in den Fonds-Dokumenten beschrieben wird, oder von den sonstigen Regeln in Bezug auf die Gesellschaft ab. (d) Die Frequenz der Bekanntmachung oder der Zeitraum zwischen Ermittlung und Bekanntmachung oder die Berechnungsmethode, jeweils in Bezug auf den Nettoinventarwert (oder einen vorläufigen oder geschätzten Nettoinventarwert) (die "NAV-Frequenz") wird wesentlich geändert und weicht nun wesentlich von der NAV-Frequenz am Allokationstag bzw. an dem Tag, zu dem die Fonds-Komponente nach diesen Bestimmungen angepasst wurde, oder von der NAV-Frequenz, die in den Fonds-Dokumenten beschrieben wird, von oder den sonstigen Regeln in Bezug auf die Gesellschaft ab. (e) Die Gesellschaft führt Rücknahmegebühr ein. (f) Die Anzahl von Aktien der Gesellschaft, ihrer Teilfonds oder Aktienklassen, die ein Hypothetischer Aktieninhaber halten darf, wird aufgrund Gesetzes oder behördlicher Maßnahmen beschränkt. (g) Jede Aussetzung oder Beschränkung des Handels in der FondsKomponente (wegen Liquiditätsbeschränkungen oder aus anderen Gründen), soweit diese nicht bereits zuvor an dem Allokationstag bzw. zu dem Tag, zu dem die Fonds-Komponente nach diesen Bestimmungen angepasst wurde, bestanden, wie in den Regeln in Bezug auf die Gesellschaft beschrieben. (h) Die Gesellschaft verlangt, dass ein Hypothetischer Aktieninhaber seine Aktien ganz oder teilweise zurückgibt. einen 112 Ausgabeaufschlag oder eine (i) Ein Hypothetischer Aktieninhaber erhält bei einer Rückgabe der Aktien der Gesellschaft nicht den vollen Erlös (Rückkaufwert) innerhalb der üblichen, unter den in den Dokumenten dargelegten normalen Marktbedingungen anwendbaren, Zahlungsfrist für Rücknahmen zurück. (j) Die Gesellschaft unterliegt der Liquidation, Auflösung oder Einstellung, oder der Investment Manager beabsichtigt, empfiehlt oder initiiert die Liquidation, Auflösung oder Einstellung der Gesellschaft. (k) Die Bewertungsstelle hat den Nettoinventarwert der Fonds-Komponente nicht wie vorgesehen ermittelt oder bekannt gegeben (§ 4 (2) (b)) und die Suspendierung oder das Ausbleiben der Bekanntgabe des massgeblichen Nettoinventarwerts der Fondskomponente ist für mehr als zwanzig (20) Fonds-Geschäftstage nach dem für die Veröffentlichung des Nettoinventarwerts massgeblichen FondsGeschäftstags nicht behoben worden. (2) Die Kündigung hat innerhalb von fünf (5) Bankgeschäftstagen nach Ablauf der Heilungsfrist und unter Angabe des Bankgeschäftstags, zu dem die Kündigung wirksam wird (der "Kündigungstag"), zu erfolgen. In Zweifelsfällen über das Vorliegen des Kündigungsereignisses entscheidet die Emittentin gemäß § 315 BGB nach billigem Ermessen. (3) Im Fall der Kündigung zahlt die Emittentin am Rückzahlungstag bei Kündigung (§ 10 (4)) an jeden Zertifikatsinhaber bezüglich jedes von ihm gehaltenen Zertifikats einen Geldbetrag, der von der Emittentin gemäß § 315 BGB nach billigem Ermessen und unter Berücksichtigung der im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Kündigungstag maßgeblichen Kündigungsgebühr (§ 10 (5)) sowie gegebenenfalls unter Berücksichtigung des dann maßgeblichen Nettoinventarwerts der Fonds-Komponente und der durch die Kündigung bei der Emittentin angefallenen Kosten, als angemessener Marktpreis eines Zertifikats bei Kündigung festgelegt wird (der "Kündigungsbetrag"). (4) Der "Rückzahlungstag sechsunddreissigste (36.) Kündigungstag folgt. (5) Die "Kündigungsgebühr" entspricht im Hinblick auf den jeweiligen Zeitraum folgenden Prozentsätzen: bei Kündigung" Geschäftstag, der ist spätestens unmittelbar auf der den Zeitraum Kündigungsgebühr 31. Dezember 2009 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2010 (einschließlich) 4 % des Nennwerts 113 1. Juli 2010 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2012 (einschließlich) 3 % des Nennwerts 1. Juli 2012 (einschließlich) bis zum 30. Juni 2014 (einschließlich) 1 % des Nennwerts Bei Kündigung nach dem 30. Juni 2014 wird keine Kündigungsgebühr erhoben. § 11 Ersetzung der Emittentin (1) Die Emittentin (oder jede Schuldnerin, welche die Emittentin ersetzt) ist jederzeit berechtigt, ohne weitere Zustimmung der Zertifikatsinhaber ein von ihr kontrolliertes, sie kontrollierendes oder gemeinsam mit ihr von einem dritten Unternehmen kontrolliertes Unternehmen (mit Geschäftssitz in irgendeinem Land weltweit) oder irgendeines ihrer Tochterunternehmen an ihrer Stelle als Hauptschuldnerin (die "Nachfolgeschuldnerin") für alle Verpflichtungen aus und im Zusammenhang mit den Zertifikaten einzusetzen, und die Zertifikatsinhaber stimmen dieser Einsetzung hiermit unwiderruflich zu, vorausgesetzt, dass: (a) alle für die Wirksamkeit der Ersetzung notwendigen Dokumente (die "Dokumente") von der Emittentin und der Nachfolgeschuldnerin unterzeichnet werden, entsprechend denen die Nachfolgeschuldnerin zu Gunsten jedes Zertifikatsinhabers alle Verpflichtungen aus diesen Zertifikatsbedingungen übernimmt, als sei sie von Anfang an Stelle der Emittentin Partei dieser Vereinbarungen gewesen, und entsprechend denen die Emittentin und die Garantin (falls die Garantin nicht die Nachfolgeschuldnerin ist) zu Gunsten jedes Zertifikatsinhabers unbedingt und unwiderruflich die Zahlung aller fälligen und durch die Nachfolgeschuldnerin als Hauptschuldner zahlbaren Beträge garantiert (wobei diese Garantie im Folgenden als "Ersetzungs-Garantie") bezeichnet wird), und (b) die Dokumente ein unselbstständiges Garantieversprechen der Nachfolgeschuldnerin und der Emittentin enthalten, wonach die Nachfolgeschuldnerin und die Emittentin alle für die Ersetzung und die Abgabe der Ersetzungs-Garantie durch die Emittentin notwendigen Genehmigungen und Einverständniserklärungen von Regierungsstellen und Aufsichtsbehörden erhalten haben, wonach ferner die Nachfolgeschuldnerin alle für die Erfüllung ihrer Verpflichtungen aus den Dokumenten notwendigen Genehmigungen und Einverständniserklärungen von Regierungsstellen und Aufsichtsbehörden erhalten hat und wonach weiterhin sämtliche dieser Genehmigungen und Einverständniserklärungen in vollem Umfang gültig und wirksam sind und wonach zudem die Verpflichtungen der Nachfolgeschuldnerin und 114 die Ersetzungs-Garantie jeweils gemäß ihren Bestimmungen wirksam und rechtsverbindlich und durch jeden Zertifikatsinhaber durchsetzbar sind und wonach schließlich, wenn die Nachfolgeschuldnerin ihre Verbindlichkeiten an den Zertifikaten durch eine Niederlassung erfüllt, die Nachfolgeschuldnerin selbst verpflichtet bleibt (2) Nachdem die Dokumente für die Emittentin und die Nachfolgeschuldnerin wirksam und rechtsverbindlich geworden sind und eine Mitteilung gemäß Absatz 4 dieser Bestimmung erfolgt ist, gilt die Nachfolgeschuldnerin als in den Zertifikaten an Stelle der Emittentin als Hauptschuldnerin verzeichnet und die Zertifikate gelten als dementsprechend ergänzt, um der Ersetzung zur Durchsetzung zu verhelfen. Die Unterzeichnung der Dokumente und die Mitteilung gemäß Absatz 4 dieser Bestimmung befreien, im Fall der Einsetzung einer anderen Gesellschaft als Hauptschuldnerin, die Emittentin von allen Verbindlichkeiten, die sie als Hauptschuldnerin unter den Zertifikaten hatte. (3) Die Dokumente werden so lange bei der Zahlstelle hinterlegt und von dieser verwahrt werden, als noch Forderungen bezüglich des Zertifikats von irgendeinem Zertifikatsinhaber gegen die Nachfolgeschuldnerin oder die Emittentin erhoben werden können oder Forderungen aus den Dokumenten noch nicht endgültig zugesprochen, ausgeglichen oder erfüllt worden sind. (4) Spätestens fünfzehn (15) Bankgeschäftstage nach Unterzeichnung der Dokumente wird die Nachfolgeschuldnerin dies den Zertifikatsinhabern mitteilen. (5) Für die Zwecke dieses § 11 bedeutet 'Kontrolle' direkten oder indirekten Einfluss auf die Geschäftsleitung und Geschäftspolitik einer Gesellschaft oder die Möglichkeit, deren Richtung zu bestimmen, sei es kraft Vertrages oder kraft direkten oder indirekten Besitzes einer solchen Zahl stimmberechtigter Anteile, die es deren Inhaber ermöglichen, die Mehrheit der Geschäftsführer zu bestimmen, wobei jede Gesellschaft als darin einbezogen gilt, die eine ähnliche Beziehung zur erstgenannten Gesellschaft aufweist. 'Stimmberechtigte Anteile' sind zu diesem Zweck Kapitalanteile an einer Gesellschaft, die üblicherweise zur Wahl der Geschäftsführer berechtigen. Die Begriffe 'kontrolliert', 'kontrollierend' und 'gemeinsam kontrolliert' sind entsprechend auszulegen. § 12 Verschiedenes (1) Die Zertifikate unterliegen deutschem Recht. (2) Ausschließlich zuständig für sämtliche im Zusammenhang mit den Zertifikaten entstehenden Klagen oder sonstige Verfahren ("Rechtsstreitigkeiten") ist das Landgericht Frankfurt/Main. Die Zertifikatsinhaber können ihre Ansprüche jedoch auch vor anderen 115 zuständigen Gerichten geltend machen. Die Emittentin unterwirft sich den in diesem Absatz bestimmten Gerichten. (3) Für etwaige Rechtsstreitigkeiten vor deutschen Gerichten bestellen die Emittentin und die Garantin Morgan Stanley Bank AG, Junghofstraße 13-15, 60311 Frankfurt am Main zu ihrem Zustellungsbevollmächtigten in Deutschland. (4) Die Emittentin ist berechtigt, in diesen Zertifikatsbedingungen a) offensichtliche Schreib- oder Rechenfehler oder ähnliche offenbare Unrichtigkeiten sowie b) widersprüchliche oder lückenhafte Bestimmungen ohne Zustimmung der Zertifikatsinhaber zu ändern bzw. zu ergänzen, wobei in den unter b) genannten Fällen nur solche Änderungen bzw. Ergänzungen zulässig sind, die unter Berücksichtigung der Interessen der Emittentin für die Zertifikatsinhaber zumutbar sind, d.h. die die finanzielle Situation der Zertifikatsinhaber nicht wesentlich verschlechtern. Änderungen bzw. Ergänzungen dieser Zertifikatsbedingungen werden unverzüglich gemäß § 7 bekannt gemacht. § 13 Sprache Diese Zertifikatsbedingungen sind ausschließlich in deutscher Sprache abgefasst. 116 BESTEUERUNG IN DER BUNDESREPUBLIK DEUTSCHLAND Die nachstehenden Ausführungen enthalten allgemeine Angaben zu deutschen steuerrechtlichen Vorschriften, die im Zeitpunkt der Drucklegung dieser Zertifikatsbedingungen in Kraft waren und nach Auffassung der Emittentin für die Besteuerung von Zertifikatsinhabern bedeutsam werden können. Diese Vorschriften können kurzfristig geändert werden, unter gewissen Grenzen auch mit Rückwirkung. Die Besteuerung der Zertifikate wird sich insbesondere durch die Einführung einer allgemeinen Abgeltungsteuer ändern (vgl. nachfolgend unter "Steuerrechtsänderungen"). Die nachfolgenden Informationen erheben keinen Anspruch auf Vollständigkeit und berücksichtigen insbesondere nicht individuelle Aspekte, die für die Besteuerung eines Zertifikatsinhabers bedeutsam werden können. Es wird jedem potentiellen Anleger empfohlen, sich vor dem Kauf der Zertifikate von seinem persönlichen Steuerberater über die sich in seinem Einzelfall ergebenden Steuerfolgen beraten zu lassen; nur dieser ist in der Lage, die individuellen Umstände des jeweiligen Anlegers in Betracht zu ziehen. Steuerinländer Zinszahlungen auf die Zertifikate (dazu gehört bei diesem Typ der Zertifikate der Unterschiedsbetrag zwischen dem Ausgabebetrag und dem Rückzahlungsbetrag bei Fälligkeit) an Personen, die in Deutschland steuerlich ansässig sind (d.h. Personen, deren Wohnsitz, gewöhnlicher Aufenthalt, Sitz oder Ort der Geschäftsleitung sich in Deutschland befindet), unterliegen der deutschen Einkommenbzw. Körperschaftsteuer (zuzüglich Solidaritätszuschlag). Wenn die Zertifikate Betriebsvermögen eines in Deutschland betriebenen Gewerbebetriebs sind, unterliegen die Zinsen auch der Gewerbesteuer. Werden die Zertifikate während ihrer Laufzeit veräußert oder bei Endfälligkeit zurückgezahlt, so unterliegt bei natürlichen Personen der Unterschied zwischen dem Erlös aus der Veräußerung, Abtretung oder Einlösung und dem Ausgabe- bzw. Kaufpreis für das Zertifikat im Jahr der Veräußerung, Abtretung oder Einlösung der Einkommensteuer (zuzüglich Solidaritätszuschlag). Gewinne aus der Veräußerung von Zertifikate, die von einer in Deutschland ansässigen Körperschaft erzielt werden, unterliegen der Körperschaftsteuer (zuzüglich Solidaritätszuschlag) und der Gewerbesteuer. Wenn die Zertifikate in einem Depot verwahrt werden, das der Inhaber bei einer deutschen Zweigstelle eines deutschen oder ausländischen Kredit- oder Finanzdienstleistungsinstituts (nachfolgend "auszahlende Stelle") unterhält, wird Zinsabschlag in Höhe von 30 % (zuzüglich 5,5 % Solidaritätszuschlag darauf), insgesamt also ein Steuerabzug von 31,65 %, auf die Zinszahlungen erhoben. Zinsabschlag in der genannten Höhe wird auch von dem Unterschied zwischen dem Erlös aus der Veräußerung, Abtretung oder Einlösung und dem Ausgabe- bzw. Kaufpreis der Zertifikate einbehalten, wenn die Zertifikate seit der Zeichnung bzw. dem Erwerb in einem Depot dieser auszahlenden Stelle verwahrt worden sind. Wurden sie erst später in das Depot der auszahlenden Stelle überführt, so wird Zinsabschlag in der genannten Höhe pauschal auf 30 % des Erlöses auf der Veräußerung, Abtretung oder Einlösung der Zertifikate einbehalten. 117 Im Allgemeinen wird kein Zinsabschlag erhoben, wenn der Inhaber der Zertifikate eine natürliche Person ist und (i) die Zertifikate weder im Betriebsvermögen hält, noch die Erträge daraus zu den Einkünften aus Vermietung und Verpachtung gehören und (ii) er der auszahlenden Stelle einen Freistellungsauftrag erteilt hat, soweit die auf die Zertifikate entfallenden Zinserträge zusammen mit anderen Kapitalerträgen den im Freistellungsauftrag angegebenen Höchstbetrag nicht übersteigen. Entsprechend wird kein Zinsabschlag einbehalten, wenn der Inhaber der Zertifikate der auszahlenden Stelle eine vom zuständigen Wohnsitzfinanzamt ausgestellte Nichtveranlagungsbescheinigung eingereicht hat. Der Zinsabschlag und der Solidaritätszuschlag darauf werden auf die deutsche Einkommen- oder Körperschaftsteuer und den Solidaritätszuschlag der in Deutschland steuerlich ansässigen Personen angerechnet. Übersteigen die Steuerabzugsbeträge die geschuldete Steuer, so wird die Differenz dem Inhaber der Zertifikate bei der Steuerveranlagung erstattet. Steuerausländer Zinsen und Veräußerungsgewinne unterliegen bei Steuerausländern, d.h. Personen, die nicht in Deutschland steuerlich ansässig sind, nicht der deutschen Besteuerung, es sei denn, (i) die Zertifikate gehören zum Betriebsvermögen einer Betriebsstätte (einschließlich eines ständigen Vertreters) oder festen Einrichtung, die der Inhaber der Zertifikate in Deutschland unterhält, oder (ii) die Zinseinkünfte gehören aus anderen Gründen zu den steuerpflichtigen inländischen Einkünften (z.B. als Einkünfte aus der Vermietung oder Verpachtung bestimmten in Deutschland belegenen Vermögens). Wenn der Steuerausländer mit den Erträgen aus den Zertifikaten der deutschen Besteuerung unterliegt, gelten ähnliche Regeln wie oben unter "Steuerinländer" erläutert. Steuerausländer sind im Allgemeinen von dem deutschen Zinsabschlag und dem Solidaritätszuschlag darauf befreit. Sind die Zinsen jedoch nach Maßgabe des vorstehenden Absatzes in Deutschland steuerpflichtig und werden die Zertifikate in einem Depot bei einer auszahlenden Stelle verwahrt, so wird Zinsabschlag erhoben wie oben unter "Steuerinländer" erläutert. Steuerrechtsänderungen Im Rahmen des Unternehmensteuerreformgesetzes 2008 hat der deutsche Gesetzgeber die Einführung einer allgemeinen Abgeltungsteuer mit genereller Wirkung für nach dem 31. Dezember 2008 zufließende Kapitalerträge beschlossen. Im Folgenden werden die wesentlichen Änderungen für die Besteuerung der Zertifikate dargestellt, die sich durch das Unternehmensteuerreformgesetz 2008 ergeben. Das Unternehmensteuerreformgesetz 2008 sieht unter anderem vor, dass Erträge und Gewinne aus der Veräußerung von Kapitalanlagen einem Steuerabzug an der Quelle zu einem einheitlichen Steuersatz von 26,375 % (einschließlich Solidaritätszuschlag, gegebenenfalls zuzüglich Kirchensteuer) unterliegen. Dies gilt sowohl für im Privat- als auch im Betriebsvermögen gehaltene Zertifikate. Bei privaten Anlegern ist mit dem Steuerabzug die Einkommensteuer in Bezug auf diese Kapitaleinkünfte zukünftig grundsätzlich abgegolten (Abgeltungsteuer). Betriebliche Anleger können die Quellensteuer im Rahmen der Veranlagung anrechnen oder erstatten lassen. 118 Verluste aus der Veräußerung von Zertifikaten, die dem neuen Recht unterliegen, können nur mit positiven Einkünften aus Kapitalvermögen verrechnet werden. Sind im Veranlagungszeitraum des Verlusts keine ausreichenden positiven Einkünfte vorhanden, können die Verluste in die folgenden Jahre vorgetragen werden; ein Verlustrücktrag ist nicht möglich. Bei steuerpflichtigen Kapitalerträgen, die einem privaten Anleger nach dem 31. Dezember 2008 zufließen, kann ein Sparer-Pauschbetrag in Höhe von EUR 801 (EUR 1.602 bei Zusammenveranlagung) von den Erträgen abgezogen werden. Die im Zusammenhang mit Kapitaleinkünften stehenden tatsächlichen Werbungskosten, die nach dem 31. Dezember 2008 entstehen, finden keine steuerliche Berücksichtigung. EU Zinsrichtlinie Am 3. Juni 2003 hat der Rat der Europäischen Union die Richtlinie im Bereich der Besteuerung von Zinserträgen (2003/48/EG) erlassen. Nach den Regelungen der Richtlinie ist jeder Mitgliedstaat verpflichtet, den zuständigen Behörden eines anderen Mitgliedstaates Auskünfte über Zinszahlungen und gleichgestellte Zahlungen zu erteilen, die im jeweiligen Mitgliedstaat an eine Person gezahlt werden, die in einem anderen Mitgliedstaat ansässig ist. Österreich, Belgien und Luxemburg sind anstelle der Auskunftserteilung verpflichtet, während einer Übergangszeit eine Quellensteuer zu erheben, deren Satz schrittweise auf 35% angehoben wird. Die Richtlinie wurde in Deutschland durch die am 1. Juli 2005 in Kraft getretene Zinsinformationsverordnung durch Einführung eines Meldeverfahrens für Zinszahlungen an in anderen EU-Staaten (bzw. bestimmten abhängigen und assoziierten Gebieten) ansässige natürliche Personen nach § 9 der Zinsinformationsverordnung (ZIV) eingeführt. Dieses Verfahren erfasst, abhängig von der Ausgestaltung, auch Zertifikate. Das Meldeverfahren sieht vor, dass eine inländische Zahlstelle dem Bundeszentralamt für Steuern Auskünfte zu erteilen verpflichtet ist, insbesondere im Hinblick auf Identität und Wohnsitz des wirtschaftlichen Eigentümers, Name und Anschrift der Zahlstelle, Kontonummer des wirtschaftlichen Eigentümers oder, in Ermangelung einer solchen, Kennzeichen der Forderung aus der die Zinsen herrühren sowie den Gesamtbetrag der Zinsen oder Erträge und den Gesamtbetrag des Erlöses aus der Abtretung, Rückzahlung oder Einlösung. Das Bundeszentralamt für Steuern leitet diese Auskünfte an die zuständige Behörde des Mitgliedstaats, in dem der wirtschaftliche Eigentümer ansässig ist, weiter. 119 ANLAGE: JAHRESBERICHT DER EMITTENTIN ZUM 30. NOVEMBER 2007 (in englischer Sprache) MORGAN STANLEY B.V. Annual Report and Accounts 30 November 2007 F-1 DIRECTORS' REPORT The Directors present their report and accounts for Morgan Stanley B.V. (the “Company”) for the year ended 30 November 2007. RESULTS AND DIVIDENDS The profit for the year, after tax, was €2,197,000 (2006: €775,000 profit). During the year, no dividends were paid (2006: €nil). PRINCIPAL ACTIVITY AND BUSINESS REVIEW The principal activity of the Company is the issuance of financial instruments and the hedging of the obligations arising pursuant to such issuances. The Company’s ultimate parent undertaking and controlling entity is Morgan Stanley, which, together with the Company and Morgan Stanley’s other subsidiary undertakings, form the Morgan Stanley Group (the "Group"). The income statement for the year is set out on page 2. The profit for the year rose by €1,422,000 over the prior year. The Company’s operating profit has increased by €1,887,000. This was primarily driven by fees earned from increased issuances of financial instruments to other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings following increased activity over prior year. The balance sheet on page 3 of the financial statements shows that the Company’s net assets at the end of the year were €5,368,000 an increase of 69.3% from the prior year. This was primarily driven by increased fees earned from issuances of financial instruments to other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings following increased activity over prior year not yet received and presented within receivables. The Directors have voluntarily opted for the financial statements to be prepared under International Financial Reporting Standards (‘IFRS’) as adopted by the European Union effective 1 December 2006. An explanation of how the transition to IFRS has affected the reported financial position, financial performance and cash flows of the Company is provided in Note 14. There have been no significant events after the balance sheet date. The Group manages its key performance indicators on a global basis. For this reason, the Company's Directors believe that providing performance indicators for the Company itself would not enhance an understanding of the development, performance or position of the business of the Company. Detailed information regarding the financial risk management of the Company is set out in note 10 to the accounts. FUTURE OUTLOOK There have not been any significant changes in the Company's principal activity in the year under review and no significant change in the Company's principal business is expected. DIRECTORS The following Directors held office throughout the year: G.C.De Boer C.E.C. Hood TMF Management B.V. J.A. Solan AUDITORS Deloitte Accountants B.V. have expressed their willingness to continue in office as auditors of the Company and a resolution to re-appoint them will be proposed at the forthcoming annual general meeting. By order of the Board on 1 February 2008. Directors G.C.De Boer C.E.C. Hood TMF Management B.V. J.A. Solan F-2 INCOME STATEMENT Year ended 30 November 2007 Note Net gains on financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss Interest income Other operating income 4 Other operating expense 5 OPERATING PROFIT BEFORE INCOME TAX Income tax expense PROFIT FOR THE YEAR 6 2007 €'000 2006 €'000 - - 397 176 2,573 908 (8) (9) 2,962 1,075 (765) (300) 2,197 775 All operations were continuing in the current and prior year. The notes on page 6 to 16 form an integral part of the accounts. F-3 BALANCE SHEET 30 November 2007 (Including Proposed Appropriation of Results) 2007 €'000 2006 €'000 12 14 13 31,229 - 13 46,356 1,736 7 10,104,646 3,890,053 236 1,454 10,182,479 3,893,257 13 (119,030) - 13 - (33) 7 (10,058,081) (3,890,053) (10,177,111) (3,890,086) (18) (18) (5,350) (3,153) (5,368) (3,171) (10,182,479) (3,893,257) Note ASSETS Loans and receivables: Cash at bank Trade receivables Other receivables Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss Current tax TOTAL ASSETS LIABILITIES AND EQUITY Financial liabilities at amortised cost: Trade payables Other payables Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss TOTAL LIABILITIES EQUITY ATTRIBUTABLE TO SHAREHOLDERS 8 Share capital Retained earnings TOTAL EQUITY TOTAL LIABILITIES AND EQUITY These accounts were approved by the Board and authorised for issue on 1 February 2008 Signed on behalf of the Board on 1 February 2008. Directors G.C.De Boer C.E.C. Hood TMF Management B.V. J.A. Solan The notes on pages 6 to 16 form an integral part of the accounts. F-4 STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY Year ended 30 November 2007 At 1 December 2005 Profit for the year Balance at 30 November 2006 At 1 December 2006 Profit for the year Balance at 30 November 2007 Share Capital €'000 Retained Earnings €'000 Total €'000 18 2,378 2,396 - 775 775 18 3,153 3,171 18 3,153 3,171 - 2,197 2,197 18 5,350 5,368 F-5 CASH FLOW STATEMENT Year ended 30 November 2007 2007 €'000 2006 €'000 2,962 1,075 (75,847) (1,160) (6,229,258) (3,250,780) (5) (1) (6,305,110) (3,251,941) 118,997 (272) 6,182,693 3,250,780 6,301,690 3,250,508 (458) (358) 982 358 (524) - 458 358 - - Currency translation differences on FX currency cash balances (2) (1) CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT THE BEGINNING OF THE YEAR 14 15 CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT THE END OF THE YEAR 12 14 OPERATING ACTIVITIES Profit for the year Change in operating assets Net increase in loans and receivables Net increase in financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss Net increase in current tax Change in operating liabilities Net increase /(decrease) in financial liabilities at amortised cost Net increase in financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss Cash used in operating activities Income tax received Income tax paid NET CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVIES F-6 NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS Year ended 30 November 2007 1. CORPORATE INFORMATION The Company is incorporated and domiciled in The Netherlands, at the following address: Locatellikade 1, Parnassustoren, 1076 AZ, Amsterdam, The Netherlands. The Company is engaged in the issuance of financial instruments and the hedging of obligations pursuant to such issuances. 2. BASIS OF PREPARATION Statement of compliance The Company has prepared its annual financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (‘IFRSs’) as adopted by the European Union. The primary financial statements in this document are presented in accordance with International Accounting Standard (‘IAS’) 1 ‘Presentation of Financial Statements’. This is the Company’s first set of financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS and IFRS 1 ‘Firsttime Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards’ (‘IFRS 1’) has been applied. An explanation of how the transition to IFRS has affected the reported financial position, financial performance and cash flows of the Company is provided in Note 14. New Standards and interpretations adopted during the year IFRS 7 ‘Financial Instruments: Disclosures’ (‘IFRS 7’) was issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (‘IASB’) in August 2005 for application for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2007. The Company has chosen to early adopt IFRS 7 with effect from 1 December 2006, ahead of its effective date. The impact of the new Standard has been to expand the disclosures provided in these financial statements regarding the Company’s financial instruments. New Standards and Interpretations not yet adopted At the date of authorisation of these financial statements, the following Standards and Interpretations relevant to the Company’s operations were in issue by the IASB but not yet effective: Amendment to IAS 1 ‘Presentation of Financial Statements’ on capital disclosures. This was issued by the IASB in August 2005 for application in accounting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2007. The Standard will be adopted by the Company for the year ended 30 November 2008. IFRS 8 ‘Operating Segments’. This was issued by the IASB in November 2006 for application in accounting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2009. This Standard will be adopted by the Company for the year ended 30 November 2008. The Company expects that the adoption of these Standards will have no material impact on the financial statements. Basis of measurement The financial statements of the Company are prepared under the historical cost convention modified by the inclusion of financial instruments at fair value. Use of estimates The preparation of financial information requires the Company to make estimates and assumptions regarding the valuation of certain financial instruments and other matters that affect the financial statements and related disclosures. The Company believes that the estimates utilised in preparing the financial statements are prudent and reasonable. Actual results could differ materially from these estimates. F-7 3. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES a. Functional currency Items included in the financial statements are measured and presented in Euros, the currency of the primary economic environment in which the Company operates. All currency amounts in the annual report are rounded to the nearest thousand Euros. b. Foreign currencies Any monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than Euros are translated into Euros at the rates ruling at the balance sheet date. Transactions in currencies other than Euros are recorded at the rates ruling at the dates of the transactions. All translation differences are taken through the income statement. c. Recognition of income and expenses i) Net gains and losses on financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss Net gains and losses on financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss includes all related realised and unrealised fair value changes, interest income and expense and foreign exchange differences. ii) Interest Interest income and interest expense on financial assets and financial liabilities not at fair value is recognised in the income statement using the effective interest method. The effective interest method is a method of calculating the amortised cost of a financial asset or a financial liability (or group of financial assets or financial liabilities) and of allocating the interest income or interest expense over the expected life of the financial asset or financial liability. The effective interest rate is the rate that exactly discounts the estimated future cash payments and receipts through the expected life of the financial asset or liability (or, where appropriate, a shorter period) to the carrying amount of the financial asset or liability. The effective interest rate is established on initial recognition of the financial asset and liability and is not revised subsequently. The calculation of the effective interest rate includes all fees and commissions paid or received transaction costs, and discounts or premiums that are an integral part of the effective interest rate. Transaction costs are incremental costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition, issue or disposal or a financial asset or liability. iii) Fees and commissions Fees and commissions classified within other operating income include fees earned from issuances of financial instruments to other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings. These amounts are recognised as the related services are performed. d. Fair value of financial instruments Fair value is the amount for which an asset could be exchanged, or a liability settled, between knowledgeable, willing parties, in an arm’s length transaction. The price transparency of a particular product will determine the degree of judgment involved in determining the fair value of the financial instrument. Price transparency is affected by a wide range of factors, including, for example, the type of product, whether it is a new product and not yet established in the marketplace and the characteristics particular to the product. Products for which actively quoted prices or market data are available or for which fair value is derived from actively quoted prices or market data will generally have a higher degree of price transparency. By contrast, products that are thinly traded or not quoted will generally have little or no price transparency. A substantial percentage of the fair value of the Company’s financial instruments held at fair value is based on observable market prices, observable market data, or is derived from such prices or data. The availability of observable market prices and market data can vary from product to product. Where available, observable market prices and market data in a product (or a related product) may be used to derive a price without requiring significant judgment. F-8 3. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED) In certain markets, observable market prices or market data are not available for all products, and fair value is determined using valuation techniques appropriate for each particular product. These valuation techniques involve some degree of judgement. The transparency of market prices and/or market data will determine the degree of judgement involved in determining the fair value of the Company’s financial instruments. The fair values of many financial instruments, including over-the-counter (OTC) financial instruments, are derived primarily using valuation techniques, which may require multiple market data as inputs. The Company also uses valuation techniques to manage the risks introduced by OTC financial instruments. Depending on the product and the terms of the valuation technique the fair value of the OTC financial instrument can be modelled using a series of techniques, including closed-form analytic formulae such as the Black-Scholes option pricing model, simulation models or a combination thereof, applied consistently. In the case of more established financial instruments, the valuation techniques used by the Company are widely accepted by the financial services industry. Valuation techniques take into account the contract terms including the maturity, as well as market data such as interest rates, volatility and the creditworthiness of the counterparty. In the normal course of business, the fair value of a financial instrument on initial recognition is the transaction price (i.e. the fair value of the consideration given or received). In certain circumstances, however, the fair value will be based on other observable current market transactions in the same instrument, without modification or repacking, or on a valuation technique whose variables include only data from observable markets. When such evidence exists, the Company recognises a gain or loss on inception of the transaction. When unobservable market data has a significant impact on determining fair value at the inception of the transaction, the entire initial change in fair value, as at the transaction date, indicated by the valuation technique is not recognised immediately in the income statement. It is recognised instead when the market data becomes observable. e. Financial instruments designated at fair value The Company has designated financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss when either: • the financial assets or financial liabilities are managed, evaluated and reported internally on a fair value basis; • the designation at fair value eliminates or significantly reduces an accounting mismatch which would otherwise arise; or • the financial asset or financial liability contains an embedded derivative that significantly modifies the cash flows that would otherwise be required under the contract. Financial instruments designated at fair value are recorded on settlement date at fair value. From the date the transaction is entered into (trade date) until settlement date the Company recognises any unrealised fair value changes of the contract in ‘Net gains from financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss’. On settlement date the financial instrument is recognised or derecognised from the balance sheet at fair value of the consideration given or received, plus or minus the change in fair value of the contract since the trade date. Subsequent changes in fair value are reflected in the income statement in ‘Net gains from financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss’. f. Loans and Receivables Financial assets with fixed or determinable payments and fixed maturities that are not quoted in an active market are categorised as loans and receivables. These financial assets are initially recognised on trade date at fair value. Subsequent measurement is at amortised cost, using the effective interest rate method, less allowance for impairment. F-9 3. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED) g. Offsetting of financial assets and financial liabilities Where there is a current legally enforceable right to set off the recognised amounts and an intention to settle on a net basis or to realise the asset and the liability simultaneously, financial assets and financial liabilities are offset and the net amount is presented on the balance sheet. In the absence of such conditions, financial assets and financial liabilities are presented on a gross basis. h. Income Tax The tax expense represents the sum of the tax paid and currently payable. The tax currently payable is based on taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit differs from net profit as reported in the income statement because it excludes items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other years and it further excludes items that are never taxable or deductible. The Company’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date. 4. OTHER OPERATING INCOME Other operating income 2007 €'000 2006 €'000 2,573 908 Operating income relates to fees earned from issuances of financial instruments to other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings. 5. OTHER OPERATING EXPENSE 2007 €'000 2006 €'000 8 9 Audit Fees Audit of the annual accounts The Company employed no staff during the year. F-10 6. TAX EXPENSE Dutch corporation tax at 25.84% (2006: 29.76%) Current year Adjustments in respect of prior years Tax expense Reconciliation of effective tax rate Profit before income tax Income tax using the standard rate of corporation tax in the Netherlands of 25.84% (2006: 29.76%) Impact on tax of: Adjustments to the tax charge in respect of previous periods Total income tax expense in the income statement 7. 2007 €’000 2006 €’000 765 765 320 (20) 300 2007 €’000 2006 €’000 2,962 1,075 765 320 765 (20) 300 FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES DESIGNATED AT FAIR VALUE THROUGH PROFIT OR LOSS Financial instruments designated at fair value through profit and loss consist primarily of the following classes of assets and liabilities: Issued structured notes - These instruments contain an embedded derivative which significantly modifies the cash flows of the issuance. The return on the instrument is linked to an underlying that is not clearly and closely related to the debt host including, but not limited to, equity, credit or commodity-linked notes. Using the fair value option, the entire instrument is measured at fair value through profit or loss. Prepaid equity securities contracts - These contracts involve derivatives for which an initial payment is paid at inception. These financial instruments hedge the obligations arising pursuant to the issuance of the structured notes. Using the fair value option, the entire instrument is measured at fair value through profit or loss. 2007 Assets €'000 Prepaid equity securities contracts Issued notes 10,104,646 10,104,646 2006 Liabilities €'000 Assets €'000 Liabilities €'000 - 3,890,053 - (10,058,081) - (3,890,053) (10,058,081) 3,890,053 (3,890,053) F-11 7. FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES DESIGNATED AT FAIR VALUE THROUGH PROFIT OR LOSS (CONTINUED) Included within financial assets designated at fair value is an amount of €2,331,580,000 (2006 €110,842,000) and within financial liabilities designated at fair value is an amount of €2,331,580,000 (2006 €110,842,000) that is expected to be settled after more than twelve months. The carrying amount at 30 November 2007 and 30 November 2006 of financial liabilities designated at fair value is equal to the contractual value at maturity. The change in the fair value of financial liabilities designated at fair value attributable to changes in credit risk is a gain of €104,980,000 and the change in the fair value of financial assets designated at fair value attributable to changes in credit risk is a loss of €104,980,000. This represents a change of estimate from the prior period when the equivalent amount would have been €14,664,000 in respect of both financial assets and liabilities. Included within the income statement is a gain of €104,980,000 attributable to changes in own credit risk for financial liabilities designated at fair value and a loss of €104,980,000 attributable to counterparty credit for financial assets designated at fair value. The above change in the fair value of financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss and financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss that is attributable to changes in the credit risk is determined as the amount of change in its fair value that is not attributable to changes in market conditions that give rise to market risk. 8. EQUITY Ordinary Shares Authorised Issued and fully paid 2007 Number 2006 Number 900 900 2007 €’000 2006 €’000 18 18 At 30 November 2007 the authorised share capital comprised 900 ordinary shares (2006: 900) with a par value of €100 each, of these 180 ordinary shares (2006: 180) were issued and fully paid. 9. SEGMENTAL REPORTING The Company structures its business segments primarily based upon the nature of the financial products and services provided to the Company’s internal management structure. The Company has only one business segment as described in the Directors’ Report and operates in one geographic market, Europe. The balance sheet and income statement reflect the financial position and results of this segment. F-12 10. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT Risk Management Procedures The principal activity of the Company continues to be the issuance of financial instruments and the economic hedging of the obligations arising pursuant to such issuances. It is the policy and objective of the Company not to be exposed to market risk. On issuance of each financial instrument, the Company enters into economic hedges of its obligations by purchasing financial instruments from another Morgan Stanley Group entity. Credit risk Credit risk refers to the risk of loss arising from borrower or counterparty default. The Morgan Stanley Group manages credit risk exposure on a global basis, but in consideration of each individual legal entity, including those of the Company. The credit risk management policies and procedures of the Morgan Stanley Group include ensuring transparency of material credit risks, ensuring compliance with established limits, approving material extensions of credit, and escalating risk concentrations to appropriate senior management. Credit risk management policies and procedures for the Company are consistent with those of the Morgan Stanley Group and include escalation to appropriate key management personnel of the Company. The maximum exposure to credit risk of the Company at the reporting date is the carrying amount of the financial assets held in the balance sheet. As the Company enters into all of its financial asset transactions with Morgan Stanley Group entities, the Company's credit risk related to this concentration is mitigated as both the Company and Morgan Stanley Group entities are wholly owned indirect subsidiaries of the same Group parent company, Morgan Stanley. Liquidity risk Liquidity is the risk that the entity may encounter difficulty in realising financial assets or otherwise raising funds to meet commitments associated with financial instruments. Morgan Stanley Group’s senior management establishes the overall liquidity and funding policies of the Morgan Stanley Group and the liquidity risk management policies and procedures conducted within the Company are consistent with those of the Morgan Stanley Group. The Morgan Stanley Group’s liquidity and funding risk management policies are designed to mitigate the potential risk that entities within the Morgan Stanley Group, including those of the Company, may be unable to access adequate financing to service their financial liabilities when they become payable without material, adverse franchise or business impact. The key objective of the liquidity and funding risk management framework is to support the successful execution of both the Company’s and the Morgan Stanley Group’s business strategies while ensuring ongoing and sufficient liquidity through the business cycle and during periods of financial difficulty. The Company hedges all of its fair value financial liability transactions with Group companies. The Company's liquidity risk related to this concentration is mitigated as both the Company and its Morgan Stanley Group companies are wholly owned subsidiaries of the same group parent company, Morgan Stanley. F-13 10. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (CONTINUED) In the following contractual maturity analysis, derivative contracts are disclosed as on demand; financial liabilities designated at fair value are disclosed according to their earliest contractual maturity. All such amounts are presented at their fair value. All other amounts represent the undiscounted cash flows payable by the Company arising from its financial liabilities to contractual maturities as at 30 November 2007. Repayments that are subject to notice are treated as if notice were given immediately and are classified as on demand. This presentation is considered by the Company to appropriately reflect the liquidity risk arising from those financial liabilities, presented in a way that is consistent with how the liquidity risk on these financial liabilities is managed by the Company. In less than one In more than year one year but not more than two years €'000 €'000 More than two years but less than five years More than five years Total €'000 €'000 €'000 2007 Financial liabilities Financial liabilities at amortised cost: Trade payables Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss Total financial liabilities 2006 Financial liabilities Financial liabilities at amortised cost: - Other payables Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss Total financial liabilities 119,030 - - - 119,030 7,726,501 21,267 2,070,542 239,771 10,058,081 7,845,531 21,267 2,070,542 239,771 10,177,111 33 - - - 33 3,779,211 54,027 41,719 15,096 3,890,053 3,779,244 54,027 41,719 15,096 3,890,086 Market Risk a. Price risk The Structured notes primarily expose the Company to the risk of changes in market prices of the underlying securities. The Company’s price risk arising on the issuance of each financial instrument is economically hedged by the purchase of corresponding hedging contracts from other Group companies. b. Interest rate risk The Company’s interest rate risk arising on issuance of each financial instrument is economically hedged by the purchase of the corresponding hedging contracts from other Group companies. F-14 10. FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT (CONTINUED) c. Foreign currency risk If denominated in currencies other than Euros, the structured notes may expose the Company to the risk of changes in rates of exchange between the Euro and the other relevant currencies. The Company uses the hedging contracts that it purchases from other Group companies to hedge any foreign currency risk associated with the issuance of the structured notes, consistent with the Company’s risk management strategy. 11. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS VALUED USING UNOBSERVABLE MARKET DATA a. Sensitivity of fair values to changing significant assumptions to reasonably possible alternatives Fair values of financial instruments recognised in the financial statements may be determined in whole or in part using valuation techniques based on assumptions that are not supposed by prices from current market transactions or observable market data. For fair values that are recognised in the financial statements where valuation techniques use unobservable market inputs, changing one or more assumptions used in these valuation techniques to reasonably possible alternative assumptions has no material impact to the net assets of the Company. This is due to the fact that the Company issues notes to other Group undertakings and currently offsets the risks arising from these financial liabilities by entering into corresponding hedging contracts with other Group undertakings. b. Financial instruments valued using unobservable market data The Company does not recognise initially gains/losses arising from unobservable market inputs. Subsequently, gains or losses arising from the valuation of the financial instruments using valuation techniques with unobservable market inputs are recognised in the income statement. c. Fair value changes estimated using valuation techniques The total amount of the change in fair value estimated using a valuation technique has resulted in a recognition in the income statement of €nil for the year (2006: €nil). This is due to the fact that the Company issues notes to other Group undertakings and currently offsets the risks arising from these financial liabilities by entering into mirroring contracts with other Group undertakings. 12. FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS NOT MEASURED AT FAIR VALUE For all financial assets and financial liabilities not recognised at fair value, the carrying amount is considered to be a reasonable approximation of fair value due to the short term nature of these financial assets and liabilities. 13. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES Parent and ultimate controlling entity The ultimate parent undertaking and controlling entity and the smallest and largest group of which the Company is a member and for which group accounts are prepared is Morgan Stanley. Morgan Stanley is incorporated in Delaware, the United States of America and copies of its accounts can be obtained from 25 Cabot Square, Canary Wharf, London E14 4QA. F-15 13. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED) Key Management Compensation Key management personnel is defined as those persons having authority and responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of the Company. Key management personnel includes the Board of Directors plus key business unit management. Compensation paid to key management personnel in respect of their services rendered to the Company is: Short-term employee benefits Post-employment benefits Share-based payment Other long-term employee benefits Termination benefits Management fees 2007 €’000 2006 €’000 40 5 1 118 164 87 1 20 99 207 There were no other transactions with key management personnel in the year. Transactions with related parties The Morgan Stanley Group conducts business for clients globally through a combination of both functional and legal entity organisational structures. Accordingly, the Company is closely integrated with the operations of the Morgan Stanley Group and enters into transactions with other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings for the purposes of utilising financing, trading and risk management, and infrastructure services. The nature of these relationships along with information about the transactions and outstanding balances is given below. The Company has made no provision for bad and doubtful debts related to the amount of outstanding balances from related parties (2006: nil). Financing The Company receives financing from and provides financing to other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings in the following forms: General funding General funding is undated, unsecured, floating rate lending. Funding may be received or provided for specific transaction related financing requirements, or for general intra group financing purposes. The interest rates are established by the Morgan Stanley Group Treasury function for all entities within the Morgan Stanley group and approximate the market rate of interest that the Morgan Stanley Group incurs in financing its business. Details of the outstanding balances on these financing arrangements and interest receivable/payable during the year are shown in the table below: 2007 2006 Interest €’000 Balance €’000 Interest €’000 Balance €’000 Amounts due from other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings 248 46,356 176 1,736 Amounts due to other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings - - - 33 F-16 13. RELATED PARTY DISCLOSURES (CONTINUED) Trading and risk management The Company enters into purchases and sales of securities and derivative transactions with other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings to manage the market risks associated with such business. All its transactions are entered into on an arm’s length basis. These transactions may give rise to credit risk either for the Company, or to a related party towards the Company. The total amounts receivable and payable on securities transactions not yet settled and the fair value of derivatives contracts outstanding at the year end were as follows: Amounts due from other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings on unsettled securities and derivatives transactions Amounts due to other Morgan Stanley Group undertakings 2007 €’000 2006 €’000 31,229 - (119,030) - The management and execution of business strategies on a global basis results in many Morgan Stanley transactions impacting a number of Morgan Stanley Group entities. The Morgan Stanley Group operates a number of intra-group policies to ensure that, where possible, revenues and related costs are matched. For the year ended 30 November 2007, a net income of €2,573,000 (2006: €908,000) was recognised in the income statement arising from such policies. Infrastructure services The Company uses infrastructure services, including the provision of office facilities, operated by other Group undertakings at no charge. 14. TRANSITION TO IFRS As stated in note 2, these are the Company’s first financial statements prepared in accordance with IFRS. The transition to IFRS is accounted for in accordance with IFRS 1 ‘First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards’ (‘IFRS 1’), with 1 December 2006 as the date of transition. The transition from UK GAAP to IFRS has had no material effect on the income statement, balance sheet or cash flows of the Company, and has not affected the underlying economics of its business. At 30 November 2007, financial assets designated at fair value totalling €10,104,646,000 and financial liabilities designated at fair value totalling €10,058,081,000 were disclosed on the balance sheet. At 30 November 2006, the assets were disclosed as financial instruments with a value of €3,890,053,000 and the liabilities were disclosed as financial instruments with a value of €3,890,053,000. These have been reclassified to financial assets designated at fair value and financial liabilities designated at fair value. The financial instruments were held at fair value in the prior year and so the transition from UK GAAP to IFRS has had no material effect on the valuation of these instruments. Therefore the reconciliation of changes to equity at 30 November 2006 and 30 November 2007 and the reconciliation of profit or loss under UK GAAP and IFRS is not required. F-17 Auditors’ report The auditors’ report is recorded on the next page. Statutory rules concerning appropriation of the net result The Articles of Incorporation of the Company provide that the net result for the year is at the disposition of the Annual General Meeting of Shareholders. Appropriation of the net result for the period The balance sheet is presented after the proposed appropriation of the net result for the period ended 30 November 2007. The directors propose to add profit to the profit and loss account as part of the equity shareholders’ funds. Subsequent events No events have occurred since the balance sheet date, which would change the financial position of the Company and which would require adjustment of disclosure in the annual report now presented. F-18 To the shareholders of Error! Reference source not found.Morgan Stanley B.V. Amsterdam February 4, 2008 Auditor's report Report on the financial statements We have audited the accompanying financial statements for the year ended November 30, 2007 of Morgan Stanley B.V., Amsterdam, which comprise the balance sheet as at November 30, 2007, the profit and loss account, statement of changes in equity and cash flow statement for the year then ended and a summary of significant accounting policies and other explanatory notes. Management’s responsibility Management is responsible for the preparation and fair presentation of the financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union and with Part 9 of Book 2 of the Netherlands Civil Code, and for the preparation of the management board report in accordance with Part 9 of Book 2 of the Netherlands Civil Code. This responsibility includes: designing, implementing and maintaining internal control relevant to the preparation and fair presentation of the financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; selecting and applying appropriate accounting policies; and making accounting estimates that are reasonable in the circumstances. Auditor’s responsibility Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the financial statements based on our audit. We conducted our audit in accordance with Dutch law. This law requires that we comply with ethical requirements and plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance whether the financial statements are free from material misstatement. An audit involves performing procedures to obtain audit evidence about the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. The procedures selected depend on the auditor’s judgment, including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to fraud or error. In making those risk assessments, the auditor considers internal control relevant to the entity’s preparation and fair presentation of the financial statements in order to design audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the entity’s internal control. An audit also includes evaluating the appropriateness of accounting policies used and the reasonableness of accounting estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. F-19 We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our audit opinion. Opinion In our opinion, the financial statements give a true and fair view of the financial position of Morgan Stanley B.V. as at November 30, 2007, and of its result and its cash flows for the year then ended in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union and with Part 9 of Book 2 of the Netherlands Civil Code. Report on other legal and regulatory requirements Pursuant to the legal requirement under 2:393 sub 5 part e of the Netherlands Civil Code, we report, to the extent of our competence, that the directors’ report is consistent with the financial statements as required by 2:391 sub 4 of the Netherlands Civil Code. Deloitte Acccountants B.V. G.J.W. Ros F-20 ANLAGE: JAHRESBERICHT (FORM 10-K) DER GARANTIN ZUM 30. NOVEMBER 2007 (in englischer Sprache) G-1 G-2 Table of Contents UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION Washington, D.C. 20549 FORM 10−K Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 For the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007 Commission File Number 1−11758 (Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter) Delaware (State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization) 1585 Broadway New York, NY 10036 36−3145972 (212) 761−4000 (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) (Registrant’s telephone number, including area code) (Address of principal executive offices, including zip code) Title of each class Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: Common Stock, $0.01 par value Depositary Shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of Floating Rate Non−Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series A, $0.01 par value 6¼% Capital Securities of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust III (and Registrant’s guaranty with respect thereto) 6¼% Capital Securities of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust IV (and Registrant’s guaranty with respect thereto) 5¾% Capital Securities of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust V (and Registrant’s guaranty with respect thereto) 6.60% Capital Securities of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VI (and Registrant’s guaranty with respect thereto) 6.60% Capital Securities of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VII (and Registrant’s guaranty with respect thereto) 6.45% Capital Securities of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VIII (and Registrant’s guaranty with respect thereto) SPARQS® due March 20, 2008; SPARQS due April 20, 2008; SPARQS due May 20, 2008; SPARQS due June 20, 2008 (3 issuances); SPARQS due July 20, 2008; SPARQS due August 20, 2008; SPARQS due September 20, 2008; SPARQS due October 20, 2008; SPARQS due January 20, 2009 (2 issuances); SPARQS due February 20, 2009 Exchangeable Notes due December 30, 2008; Exchangeable Notes due December 30, 2010; Exchangeable Notes due June 30, 2011 Callable Index−Linked Notes due December 30, 2008 BRIDGESSM due August 30, 2008; BRIDGES due December 30, 2008; BRIDGES due February 28, 2009; BRIDGES due March 30, 2009; BRIDGES due June 30, 2009; BRIDGES due July 30, 2009; BRIDGES due August 30, 2009; BRIDGES due October 30, 2009; BRIDGES due December 30, 2009; BRIDGES due June 15, 2010 Capital Protected Notes due June 30, 2008; Capital Protected Notes due September 30, 2008; Capital Protected Notes due December 30, 2008; Capital Protected Notes due December 30, 2009; Capital Protected Notes due April 20, 2010; Capital Protected Notes due July 20, 2010 (2 issuances); Capital Protected Notes due August 30, 2010; Capital Protected Notes due October 30, 2010; Capital Protected Notes due January 30, 2011; Capital Protected Notes due February 20, 2011; Capital Protected Notes due March 30, 2011 (2 issuances); Capital Protected Notes due June 30, 2011; Capital Protected Notes due August 20, 2011; Capital Protected Notes due October 30, 2011 (2 issuances); Capital Protected Notes due December 30, 2011; Capital Protected Notes due September 30, 2012 Capital Protected Notes due September 1, 2010 HITSSM due February 20, 2008; HITS due March 20, 2008; HITS due April 20, 2008 MPSSM due December 30, 2008; MPS due December 30, 2009; MPS due February 1, 2010; MPS due June 15, 2010; MPS due December 30, 2010 (2 issuances); MPS due March 30, 2012 MPS due March 30, 2009 Stock Participation Notes due September 15, 2010; Stock Participation Notes due December 30, 2010 Bear Market PLUS due February 20, 2008; Bear Market PLUS due April 20, 2008; Bear Market PLUS due July 20, 2008 Outperformance PLUS due December 20, 2008 PLUSSM due March 20, 2008 (3 issuances); PLUS due April 30, 2008 (2 issuances); PLUS due May 20, 2008; PLUS due October 20, 2008; PLUS due December 20, 2008 (4 issuances); PLUS due January 20, 2009 (3 issuances); PLUS due February 20, 2009; PLUS due June 30, 2009 PLUS due June 20, 2008; PLUS due August 20, 2008; PLUS due November 20, 2008; PLUS due December 20, 2008; PLUS due January 20, 2009; PLUS due September 30, 2009 PROPELSSM due December 30, 2011 (3 issuances) Protected Absolute Return Barrier Notes due December 20, 2008; Protected Absolute Return Barrier Notes due July 20, 2008; Protected Absolute Return Barrier Notes due September 20, 2008; Protected Absolute Return Barrier Notes due October 20, 2008; Protected Absolute Return Barrier Notes due June 20, 2009 (2 issuances); Protected Absolute Return Barrier Notes due July 20, 2009 Strategic Total Return Securities due December 17, 2009; Strategic Total Return Securities due March 30, 2010; Strategic Total Return Securities due July 30, 2011(2 issuances); Strategic Total Return Securities due January 15, 2012 Strategic Total Return Securities due October 30, 2011 BOXESSM due October 30, 2031; BOXES due January 30, 2032 Name of exchange on which registered New York Stock Exchange New York Stock Exchange New York Stock Exchange New York Stock Exchange New York Stock Exchange New York Stock Exchange New York Stock Exchange New York Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange American Stock Exchange The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC American Stock Exchange Philadelphia Stock Exchange Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: Targeted Income Strategic Total Return Securities due October 30, 2011 The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC MPS SM due March 30, 2009 The NASDAQ Stock Market LLC Indicate by check mark if Registrant is a well−known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. YES ⌧ NO ¨ Indicate by check mark if Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act. YES ¨ NO ⌧ Indicate by check mark whether Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. YES ⌧ NO ¨ Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S−K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10−K or any amendment to this Form 10−K. ⌧ Indicate by check mark whether Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non−accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer” and “large accelerated filer” in Exchange Act Rule 12b−2. Large accelerated filer ⌧ Accelerated filer ¨ Non−accelerated filer ¨ Indicate by check mark whether Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b−2). YES ¨ NO ⌧ As of May 31, 2007, the aggregate market value of the common stock of Registrant held by non−affiliates of Registrant was approximately $88,843,773,992.03. This calculation does not reflect a determination that persons are affiliates for any other purposes. As of January 11, 2008, there were 1,104,587,663 shares of Registrant’s common stock, $0.01 par value, outstanding. Documents Incorporated By Reference: Portions of Registrant’s definitive proxy statement for its annual stockholders’ meeting to be held on April 8, 2008 are incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10−K. G-3 Table of Contents ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007 Table of Contents Part I Item 1. Item 1A. Item 1B. Item 2. Item 3. Item 4. Part II Item 5. Item 6. Item 7. Item 7A. Item 8. Page Business Overview Available Information Business Segments Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Asset Management Competition Regulation Executive Officers of Morgan Stanley Risk Factors Unresolved Staff Comments Properties Legal Proceedings Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders 1 1 1 2 2 5 6 7 8 12 13 20 21 22 24 Market for Registrant's Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities Selected Financial Data Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations Introduction Results of Operations Impact of Credit Market Events Other Matters Critical Accounting Policies Certain Factors Affecting Results of Operations Liquidity and Capital Resources Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk Financial Statements and Supplementary Data Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition Consolidated Statements of Income Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows i 25 28 30 30 31 51 56 60 66 67 83 100 100 101 103 104 105 G-4 Table of Contents Item 9. Item 9A. Item 9B. Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements Note 1. Introduction and Basis of Presentation Note 2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies Note 3. Fair Value Disclosures Note 4. Collateralized Transactions Note 5. Securitization Activities and Variable Interest Entities Note 6. Sales and Trading Activities Note 7. Consumer Loans Note 8. Other Investments Note 9. Investments in Unconsolidated Investees Note 10. Goodwill and Net Intangible Assets Note 11. Deposits Note 12. Commercial Paper and Other Short−Term Borrowings Note 13. Long−Term Borrowings Note 14. Capital Units Note 15. Commitments, Guarantees and Contingencies Note 16. Shareholders’ Equity Note 17. Earnings per Common Share Note 18. Employee Stock−Based Compensation Plans Note 19. Employee Benefit Plans Note 20. Income Taxes Note 21. Segment and Geographic Information Note 22. Discontinued Operations Note 23. Business and Other Acquisitions and Dispositions and Sale of Minority Interest Note 24. Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108 Note 25. Insurance Settlement Note 26. Lease Adjustment Note 27. Quarterly Results (unaudited) Note 28. Subsequent Event Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure Controls and Procedures Other Information ii Page 106 107 107 109 122 127 128 132 136 137 137 138 140 141 142 144 144 150 152 153 157 164 167 170 172 174 176 177 178 178 182 182 185 G-5 Table of Contents Page Part III Item 10. Item 11. Item 12. Item 13. Item 14. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance Executive Compensation Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence Principal Accountant Fees and Services 186 186 187 188 188 Part IV Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules 189 Signatures 190 Index to Financial Statements and Financial Statement Schedules S−1 Exhibit Index E−1 iii G-6 Table of Contents Forward−Looking Statements We have included or incorporated by reference into this report, and from time to time may make in our public filings, press releases or other public statements, certain statements, including (without limitation) those under “Legal Proceedings” in Part I, Item 3, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” in Part II, Item 7 and “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk” in Part II, Item 7A, that may constitute “forward−looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. In addition, our management may make forward−looking statements to analysts, investors, representatives of the media and others. These forward−looking statements are not historical facts and represent only Morgan Stanley’s beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and beyond our control. The nature of Morgan Stanley’s business makes predicting the future trends of our revenues, expenses and net income difficult. The risks and uncertainties involved in our businesses could affect the matters referred to in such statements and it is possible that our actual results may differ from the anticipated results indicated in these forward looking statements. Important factors that could cause actual results to differ from those in the forward−looking statements include (without limitation): • the credit ratings assigned to Morgan Stanley; • the effect of political and economic conditions and geopolitical events; • the effect of market conditions, including in the global equity and credit markets and with respect to corporate, commercial and residential lending; • the availability and cost of capital; • the level and volatility of equity prices, commodity prices and interest rates, currency values and other market indices; • the actions and initiatives of current and potential competitors; • the impact of current, pending and future legislation, regulation and regulatory and legal actions in the U.S. and worldwide; • our reputation; • investor sentiment; • the potential effects of technological changes; and • other risks and uncertainties detailed under “Competition” and “Regulation” in Part I, Item 1, “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A, and elsewhere throughout this report. Accordingly, you are cautioned not to place undue reliance on forward−looking statements, which speak only as of the date on which they are made. Morgan Stanley undertakes no obligation to update publicly or revise any forward−looking statements to reflect the impact of circumstances or events that arise after the dates they are made, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise except as required by applicable law. You should, however, consult further disclosures Morgan Stanley may make in future filings of its Annual Reports on Form 10−K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10−Q and Current Reports on Form 8−K and any amendments thereto or in future press releases or other public statements. iv G-7 Table of Contents Part I Item 1. Business. Overview. Morgan Stanley is a global financial services firm that, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides its products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. Morgan Stanley was originally incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware in 1981, and its predecessor companies date back to 1924. Morgan Stanley conducts its business from its headquarters in and around New York City, its regional offices and branches throughout the U.S. and its principal offices in London, Tokyo, Hong Kong and other world financial centers. At November 30, 2007, Morgan Stanley had 48,256 employees worldwide. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Morgan Stanley,” the “Company,” “we,” “us” and “our” mean Morgan Stanley and its consolidated subsidiaries. Financial information concerning Morgan Stanley, our business segments and geographic regions for each of the fiscal years ended November 30, 2007, November 30, 2006 and November 30, 2005 is included in the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto in “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” in Part II, Item 8. Available Information. Morgan Stanley files annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). You may read and copy any document we file with the SEC at the SEC’s public reference room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. Please call the SEC at 1−800−SEC−0330 for information on the public reference room. The SEC maintains an internet site that contains annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy and information statements and other information that issuers (including Morgan Stanley) file electronically with the SEC. Morgan Stanley’s electronic SEC filings are available to the public at the SEC’s internet site, www.sec.gov. Morgan Stanley’s internet site is www.morganstanley.com. You can access Morgan Stanley’s Investor Relations webpage at www.morganstanley.com/about/ir. Morgan Stanley makes available free of charge, on or through our Investor Relations webpage, its proxy statements, Annual Reports on Form 10−K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10−Q, Current Reports on Form 8−K and any amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), as soon as reasonably practicable after such material is electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. Morgan Stanley also makes available, through its Investor Relations webpage, via a link to the SEC’s internet site, statements of beneficial ownership of Morgan Stanley’s equity securities filed by its directors, officers, 10% or greater shareholders and others under Section 16 of the Exchange Act. Morgan Stanley has a Corporate Governance webpage. You can access information about Morgan Stanley’s corporate governance at www.morganstanley.com/about/company/governance. Morgan Stanley posts the following on its Corporate Governance webpage: • Composite Certificate of Incorporation; • Bylaws; • Charters for our Audit Committee, Compensation, Management Development and Succession Committee and Nominating and Governance Committee; • Corporate Governance Policies; • Policy Regarding Communication with the Board of Directors; 1 G-8 Table of Contents • Policy Regarding Director Candidates Recommended by Shareholders; • Policy Regarding Corporate Political Contributions; • Policy Regarding Shareholder Rights Plan; • Code of Ethics and Business Conduct; and • Integrity Hotline. Morgan Stanley’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct applies to all directors, officers and employees, including its Chief Executive Officer, its Chief Financial Officer and its Controller and Principal Accounting Officer. Morgan Stanley will post any amendments to the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct and any waivers that are required to be disclosed by the rules of either the SEC or the New York Stock Exchange, Inc. (“NYSE”) on its internet site. You can request a copy of these documents, excluding exhibits, at no cost, by contacting Investor Relations, 1585 Broadway, New York, NY 10036 (212−761−4000). The information on Morgan Stanley’s internet site is not incorporated by reference into this report. Business Segments. Morgan Stanley is a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of its business segments—Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group and Asset Management. A summary of the activities of each of the business segments follows. Institutional Securities includes capital raising; financial advisory services, including advice on mergers and acquisitions, restructurings, real estate and project finance; corporate lending; sales, trading, financing and market−making activities in equity and fixed income securities and related products, including foreign exchange and commodities; benchmark indices and risk management analytics; research; and investment activities. Global Wealth Management Group provides brokerage and investment advisory services covering various investment alternatives; financial and wealth planning services; annuity and other insurance products; credit and other lending products; cash management services; retirement services; and trust and fiduciary services. Asset Management provides global asset management products and services in equity, fixed income, alternative investments, which includes hedge funds and fund of funds, and merchant banking, which includes real estate, private equity and infrastructure, to institutional and retail clients through proprietary and third−party retail distribution channels, intermediaries and Morgan Stanley’s institutional distribution channel. Asset Management also engages in investment activities. On June 30, 2007, the Company completed the spin−off of Discover Financial Services (the “Discover Spin−off”). Institutional Securities. Morgan Stanley provides financial advisory and capital−raising services to a diverse group of corporate and other institutional clients globally, primarily through wholly owned subsidiaries that include Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated (“MS&Co.”), Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc, Morgan Stanley Japan Securities Co., Ltd. and Morgan Stanley Asia Limited. These and other subsidiaries also conduct sales and trading activities worldwide, as principal and agent, and provide related financing services on behalf of institutional investors. Investment Banking. Capital Raising. Morgan Stanley manages and participates in public offerings and private placements of debt, equity and other securities worldwide. Morgan Stanley is a leading underwriter of common stock, preferred stock and other equity−related securities, including convertible securities and American Depositary Receipts (“ADRs”). 2 G-9 Table of Contents Morgan Stanley is a leading underwriter of fixed income securities, including investment grade debt, non−investment grade instruments, mortgage−related and other asset−backed securities, tax−exempt securities and commercial paper and other short−term securities. Financial Advisory Services. Morgan Stanley provides corporate and other institutional clients globally with advisory services on key strategic matters, such as mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense strategies, joint ventures, privatizations, recapitalizations, spin−offs, corporate restructurings, shareholder relations, tender offers, exchange offers and leveraged buyouts. Morgan Stanley also provides advice concerning rights offerings, dividend policy, valuations, foreign exchange exposure, financial risk management strategies and financial planning. In addition, Morgan Stanley furnishes advice and services regarding project financings and provides advisory services in connection with the purchase, sale, leasing and financing of real estate. Corporate Lending. Morgan Stanley provides to selected corporate clients through subsidiaries (including Morgan Stanley Bank) loans or lending commitments, including bridge financing. These loans and commitments have varying terms, may be senior or subordinated and/or secured or unsecured, are generally contingent upon representations, warranties and contractual conditions applicable to the borrower and may be syndicated, hedged or traded by Morgan Stanley.* The borrowers may be rated investment grade or non−investment grade. Sales and Trading Activities.** Morgan Stanley conducts sales, trading, financing and market−making activities on securities and futures exchanges and in over−the−counter (“OTC”) markets around the world. Morgan Stanley’s Institutional Securities business includes Equity and Proprietary Trading; Interest Rates, Credit and Currencies; Commodities and Clients and Services. Equity and Proprietary Trading. Morgan Stanley acts as principal (including as a market maker) and agent in executing transactions globally in equity and equity−related products, including common stock, ADRs, global depositary receipts and exchange−traded funds. Morgan Stanley’s equity derivatives sales, trading and market−making activities cover equity−related products globally, including equity swaps, options, warrants and futures overlying individual securities, indices and baskets of securities and other equity−related products. Morgan Stanley also issues and makes a principal market in equity−linked products to institutional and individual investors, including principal−protected securities. Morgan Stanley has several dedicated trading groups which engage in proprietary trading and investing activities utilizing multiple strategies across various cash and derivative asset classes including, among others, equity securities, quantitative and program driven strategies, commodities, currencies, interest rates, emerging markets, bonds, loans, corporate credit, as well as mortgage−related and other asset−backed securities. Interest Rates, Credit and Currencies. Morgan Stanley trades, makes markets and takes long and short proprietary positions in fixed income securities and related products globally, including, among other products, investment and non−investment grade corporate debt, distressed debt, bank loans, U.S. and other sovereign securities, emerging market bonds and loans, convertible bonds, collateralized debt obligations and securities issued by structured investment vehicles, mortgage−related and other asset−backed securities and real estate loan products, municipal securities, preferred stock and commercial paper, money market and other short−term securities. Morgan Stanley is a primary dealer of U.S. government securities and a member of the selling groups * ** Revenues and expenses associated with the trading of syndicated loans are included in “Sales and Trading Activities.” The description set forth under “Sales and Trading Activities” reflects organizational changes implemented since December 2007. See also “Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7A for a description of Morgan Stanley’s trading risk management structure, policies and procedures. 3 G-10 Table of Contents that distribute various U.S. agency and other debt securities. Morgan Stanley is a primary dealer or market−maker of government securities in numerous European, Asian and emerging market countries. Morgan Stanley trades, makes markets and takes long and short proprietary positions in listed futures and OTC swaps, forwards, options and other derivatives referencing, among other things, interest rates, currencies, investment grade and non−investment grade corporate credits, loans, bonds, U.S. and other sovereign securities, emerging market bonds and loans, credit indexes, asset−backed security indexes, property indexes, mortgage−related and other asset−backed securities and real estate loan products. Morgan Stanley is a market−maker in foreign currencies. Most of Morgan Stanley’s foreign exchange business relates to major foreign currencies such as Yen, Euro, Sterling, Swiss francs and Canadian dollars. Morgan Stanley trades on a principal basis in the spot, forward, option and futures markets and takes proprietary positions in such currencies. Through the use of repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, Morgan Stanley acts as an intermediary between borrowers and lenders of short−term funds and provides funding for various inventory positions. Morgan Stanley also provides financing to customers for commercial and residential real estate loan products and other securitizable asset classes. Morgan Stanley advises on investment and liability strategies and assists corporations in their debt repurchases and tax planning. Morgan Stanley structures debt securities and derivatives with risk/return factors designed to suit client objectives, including using repackaged asset and other structured vehicles through which clients can restructure asset portfolios to provide liquidity or reconfigure risk profiles. Commodities. Morgan Stanley trades as principal and maintains long and short proprietary trading positions in the spot, forward and futures markets in several commodities, including metals (base and precious), agricultural products, crude oil, oil products, natural gas, electric power, emission credits, coal, freight, liquefied natural gas (“LNG”) and related products and indices. Morgan Stanley is a market−maker in exchange−traded options and futures and OTC options and swaps on commodities, and offers counterparties hedging programs relating to production, consumption, reserve/inventory management and structured transactions, including energy−contract securitizations. Morgan Stanley is an electricity power marketer in the U.S. and owns five electricity generating facilities in the U.S. and Europe. Morgan Stanley owns TransMontaigne Inc. and its subsidiaries, a group of companies operating in the refined petroleum products marketing and distribution business, and the Heidmar Group of companies, which provide international marine transportation and U.S. marine logistics services. Clients and Services. Morgan Stanley provides financing services, including prime brokerage, which offers, among other services, consolidated clearance, settlement, custody, financing and portfolio reporting services to clients trading multiple asset classes. Morgan Stanley also engages in principal securities lending with clients, institutional lenders and other broker−dealers. In addition, Morgan Stanley’s institutional distribution and sales activities are overseen and coordinated through Clients and Services. Other Activities. ® Benchmark Indices and Risk Management Analytics. As of November 30, 2007, Morgan Stanley’s majority−owned subsidiary, MSCI Inc. (“MSCI ”), ® calculates and distributes over 100,000 international and U.S. equity benchmark indices (including the MSCI World and EAFE Indices) covering 56 countries, and has a historical database spanning over 35 years that includes fundamental and valuation data on thousands of equity securities in developed and emerging market countries. MSCI also calculates and distributes over 200 hedge fund indices. MSCI’s subsidiary, Barra, Inc., is a leading provider of risk analytic tools and services to investors to help them 4 G-11 Table of Contents analyze, measure and manage portfolio and firm−wide investment risk. The initial public offering of shares of MSCI began trading on the New York Stock Exchange on November 15, 2007. After this offering, Morgan Stanley continues to own in excess of 80 percent of MSCI. Research. Morgan Stanley’s global research department (“Research”) consists of economists, strategists and industry analysts. Research engages in equity and fixed income research activities and produces reports and studies on the U.S. and global economy, financial markets, portfolio strategy, technical market analyses, individual companies and industry developments. Research examines worldwide trends covering numerous industries and individual companies, the majority of which are located outside of the U.S. Research provides analysis and forecasts relating to economic and monetary developments that affect matters such as interest rates, foreign currencies, securities, derivatives and economic trends. Research provides analytical support and publishes reports on asset−backed securities and the markets in which such securities are traded. Research reports and data are disseminated to investors through third party distributors, proprietary internet sites such as Client Link and Morgan Stanley’s sales forces. Investments. Morgan Stanley from time to time makes investments that represent business facilitation or principal investing activities. Business facilitation investments are strategic investments undertaken by Morgan Stanley to facilitate core business activities. Principal investing activities are capital commitments provided to public and private companies, funds and other entities generally for proprietary purposes to maximize total returns to Morgan Stanley. Morgan Stanley expects to make additional principal investments over time. These principal investment activities are conducted within the investment banking and sales and trading areas in Institutional Securities. Morgan Stanley sponsors and manages investment vehicles and separate accounts for clients seeking exposure to private equity, real estate−related and other alternative investments. Morgan Stanley may also invest in and provide capital to such investment vehicles. See also “Asset Management.” Operations and Information Technology. Morgan Stanley’s Operations and Information Technology departments provide the process and technology platform that supports Institutional Securities sales and trading activity, including post−execution trade processing and related internal controls over activity from trade entry through settlement and custody, such as asset servicing. This is done for proprietary and customer transactions in listed and OTC transactions in commodities, equity and fixed income securities, including both primary and secondary trading, as well as listed, OTC and structured derivatives in markets around the world. This activity is undertaken through Morgan Stanley’s own facilities, through membership in various clearing and settlement organizations, and through agreements with unaffiliated third parties. Global Wealth Management Group. Morgan Stanley’s Global Wealth Management Group provides comprehensive financial services to clients through a network of approximately 8,400 global representatives in approximately 500 locations globally, including over 450 U.S. locations at fiscal year end. As of November 30, 2007, Morgan Stanley had $758 billion in client assets. On April 1, 2007, Morgan Stanley merged its primary broker−dealer for Global Wealth Management Group, Morgan Stanley DW Inc., into MS&Co. Upon completion of the merger, MS&Co. became Morgan Stanley’s principal U.S. broker−dealer. Clients. Global Wealth Management Group professionals serve individual investors and small−to−medium size businesses and institutions with an emphasis on ultra high net worth, high net worth and affluent investors. In the U.S., products and services are delivered through three principal channels. Specialized private wealth management 5 G-12 Table of Contents investment representative teams located in dedicated offices provide sophisticated investment solutions and services for ultra high net worth individuals, families and foundations. Financial advisors located in branches across the U.S. provide solutions designed to accommodate individual investment objectives, risk tolerance and liquidity needs for ultra high net worth, high net worth and affluent investors. Call centers are available to meet the needs of emerging affluent clients. Outside the U.S., Morgan Stanley offers financial services to clients in Europe, the Middle East, Asia and Latin America. Products and Services. Morgan Stanley’s Global Wealth Management Group provides clients with a comprehensive array of financial solutions, including Morgan Stanley’s products and services, and products and services from third party providers, such as insurance companies and mutual fund families. Morgan Stanley offers brokerage and investment advisory services covering various investment alternatives, including equities, options, futures, foreign currencies, precious metals, fixed income securities, mutual funds, structured products, alternative investments, unit investment trusts, managed futures, separately managed accounts and mutual fund asset allocation programs. Morgan Stanley also offers financial and wealth planning services, including education savings programs, as well as annuity and other insurance products. In addition, Morgan Stanley offers several cash management services, including cash sweeps, debit cards and checkwriting, as well as lending products, including securities based lending and a mortgage referral program, which provides residential SM mortgages and home equity lines of credit originated through Morgan Stanley’s affiliated entities. Morgan Stanley’s BusinesScape program offers cash management and commercial credit solutions to qualified small and medium businesses in the U.S. Morgan Stanley provides individual and corporate retirement solutions, including IRAs and 401(k) plans and U.S. stock plan services to corporate executives and businesses. Morgan Stanley also offers trust and fiduciary services to individual and corporate clients. Morgan Stanley’s Global Wealth Management Group offers its clients a variety of ways to establish a relationship and conduct business, including ® brokerage accounts with transaction−based pricing and investment advisory accounts with asset−based fee pricing. The Active Assets Account offers clients brokerage and cash management services in one account. Clients can also choose a fee−based, separately managed account managed by affiliated or unaffiliated professional asset managers. Operations and Information Technology. Morgan Stanley’s Operations and Information Technology departments provide the process and technology platform that supports the activities of Morgan Stanley’s Global Wealth Management Group from trade capture through clearance, settlement and custody, including asset servicing as well as bank deposit and loan processing through Morgan Stanley’s affiliated banks. These activities are undertaken through Morgan Stanley’s own facilities, through memberships in various clearing and settlement organizations, and through agreements with unaffiliated third parties. Asset Management. Morgan Stanley Investment Management is one of the largest global asset management organizations of any full−service securities firm and offers individual and institutional clients a diverse array of equity, fixed income and alternative investments and merchant banking strategies. Morgan Stanley had $597 billion of assets under management or supervision as of November 30, 2007. Morgan Stanley’s asset management activities are principally conducted under the Morgan Stanley and Van Kampen brands. Portfolio managers located in the U.S., Europe, Japan, Singapore and India manage investment products ranging from money market funds to equity, taxable and tax−exempt fixed income funds and alternative investment and merchant banking products in developed and emerging markets. Morgan Stanley offers clients various investment styles, such as value, growth, core, fixed income and asset allocation; global investments; active and passive management; and diversified and concentrated portfolios. 6 G-13 Table of Contents Morgan Stanley offers a range of alternative investment and merchant banking products for institutional investors and high net worth individuals. Morgan Stanley’s alternative investments platform includes hedge funds, funds of hedge funds, funds of private equity funds and portable alpha overlays, including FrontPoint Partners LLC, a leading provider of absolute return strategies with approximately $8.5 billion in assets under management, and minority stakes in Lansdowne Partners and Avenue Capital Group. Morgan Stanley’s Merchant Banking Division, formed in 2007, includes Morgan Stanley’s real estate investing business, private equity funds and infrastructure investing group. Morgan Stanley typically acts as general partner of, and investment adviser to, its alternative investment and merchant banking funds and typically commits to invest a minority of the capital of such funds with subscribing investors contributing the majority. Institutional Investors. Morgan Stanley provides asset management products and services to institutional investors worldwide, including pension plans, corporations, private funds, non−profit organizations, foundations, endowments, governmental agencies, insurance companies and banks. Products and services are available to institutional investors primarily through separate accounts, U.S. mutual funds and other pooled vehicles. Morgan Stanley Investment Management also sub−advises funds for various unaffiliated financial institutions and intermediaries. A global sales force and a team dedicated to covering the investment consultant industry serve institutional investors. Individual Investors. Morgan Stanley offers open−end and alternative investment funds and separately managed accounts to individual investors through affiliated and unaffiliated broker−dealers, banks, insurance companies and financial planners. Closed−end funds managed by Morgan Stanley or Van Kampen are available to individual investors through affiliated and unaffiliated broker−dealers. A small number of unaffiliated broker−dealers account for a substantial portion of Van Kampen open−end fund sales. Morgan Stanley also sells Van Kampen funds through numerous retirement plan platforms. Internationally, Morgan Stanley distributes traditional investment products to individuals outside the U.S. through non−proprietary distributors, and alternative investment products are distributed through affiliated broker−dealers. Operations and Information Technology. Morgan Stanley’s Operations and Information Technology departments provide or oversee the process and technology platform required to support its asset management business. Support activities include transfer agency, mutual fund accounting and administration, transaction processing and certain fiduciary services, on behalf of institutional, retail and intermediary clients. These activities are undertaken through Morgan Stanley’s own facilities, through membership in various clearing and settlement organizations, and through agreements with unaffiliated third parties. Competition. All aspects of Morgan Stanley’s businesses are highly competitive and Morgan Stanley expects them to remain so. Morgan Stanley competes in the U.S. and globally for clients, market share and human talent in all aspects of its business segments. Morgan Stanley’s competitive position depends on its reputation and the quality of its products, services and advice. Morgan Stanley’s ability to sustain or improve its competitive position also depends substantially on its ability to continue to attract and retain qualified employees while managing compensation and other costs. Morgan Stanley competes with commercial banks, insurance companies, sponsors of mutual funds, hedge funds, energy companies and other companies offering financial services in the U.S., globally and through the internet. Institutional Securities and Global Wealth Management Group. Morgan Stanley’s competitive position depends on innovation, execution capability and relative pricing. Morgan Stanley competes directly in the U.S. and globally with other securities and financial services firms and broker−dealers, and with others on a regional or product basis. 7 G-14 Table of Contents Morgan Stanley’s ability to access capital at competitive rates (which is generally dependent on Morgan Stanley’s credit ratings) and to commit capital efficiently, particularly in its capital−intensive underwriting and sales, trading, financing and market−making activities, also affects its competitive position. Corporate clients continue to request that Morgan Stanley provide loans or lending commitments in connection with certain investment banking activities. Over time, certain sectors of the financial services industry have become more concentrated, as financial institutions involved in a broad range of financial services industries have been acquired by or merged into other firms. This convergence could result in Morgan Stanley’s competitors gaining greater capital and other resources, such as the ability to offer a broader range of products and services and geographic diversity. It is possible that competition may become even more intense as Morgan Stanley continues to compete with financial institutions that may be larger, or better capitalized, or may have a stronger local presence and longer operating history in certain areas. Many of these firms have greater capital than Morgan Stanley and have the ability to offer a wide range of products and services that may enhance their competitive position and could result in pricing pressure in our businesses. The complementary trends in the financial services industry of consolidation and globalization present, among other things, technological, risk management, regulatory and other infrastructure challenges that require effective resource allocation in order for Morgan Stanley to remain competitive. Morgan Stanley has experienced intense price competition in some of its businesses in recent years. In particular, the ability to execute securities trades electronically on exchanges and through other automated trading markets has increased the pressure on trading commissions. The trend toward direct access to automated, electronic stock markets will likely continue. It is possible that Morgan Stanley will experience competitive pressures in these and other areas in the future as some of its competitors may seek to obtain market share by reducing prices. Asset Management. Competition in the asset management industry is affected by several factors, including Morgan Stanley’s reputation, investment objectives, quality of investment professionals, performance of investment products relative to peers and an appropriate benchmark index, advertising and sales promotion efforts, fee levels, the effectiveness of and access to distribution channels, and the types and quality of products offered. Morgan Stanley’s alternative investment products, such as private equity funds, real estate and hedge funds, compete with similar products offered by both alternative and traditional asset managers. Regulation. Most aspects of Morgan Stanley’s business are subject to stringent regulation by U.S. federal and state regulatory agencies and securities exchanges and by non−U.S. government agencies or regulatory bodies and securities exchanges. Aspects of Morgan Stanley’s public disclosure, corporate governance principles, internal control environment and the roles of auditors and counsel are subject to the Sarbanes−Oxley Act of 2002 and related regulations and rules of the SEC and the NYSE. New laws or regulations or changes to existing laws and regulations (including changes in the interpretation or enforcement thereof) either in the U.S. or elsewhere could materially adversely affect Morgan Stanley’s financial condition or results of operations. As a global financial institution, to the extent that different regulatory regimes impose inconsistent or iterative requirements on the conduct of its business, Morgan Stanley faces complexity and additional costs in its compliance efforts. Consolidated Supervision and Revised Capital Standards. Effective December 1, 2005, Morgan Stanley became a consolidated supervised entity (“CSE”) as defined by the SEC. As such, Morgan Stanley is subject to group−wide supervision and examination by the SEC and to minimum capital requirements on a consolidated basis. Morgan Stanley’s European regulated entities implemented Basel II capital standards on January 1, 2008. Morgan Stanley continues to work with its regulators on the implementation of the CSE rules and Basel II capital standards. 8 G-15 Table of Contents Anti−Money Laundering. Morgan Stanley’s Anti−Money Laundering (“AML”) program is coordinated on an enterprise−wide basis. In the U.S., for example, the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (the “USA PATRIOT Act”) imposes significant obligations on financial institutions to detect and deter money laundering and terrorist financing activity, including requiring banks, broker−dealers and mutual funds to identify and verify customers that maintain accounts. The USA PATRIOT Act also mandates that certain types of financial institutions monitor and report suspicious activity to appropriate law enforcement or regulatory authorities. An institution subject to the USA PATRIOT Act also must designate an AML compliance officer, provide employees with training on money laundering prevention, and undergo an annual, independent audit to assess the effectiveness of its AML program. Outside the U.S., applicable laws and regulations similarly subject designated types of financial institutions to AML requirements. Morgan Stanley has implemented policies, procedures and internal controls that are designed to comply with these AML requirements. Protection of Client Information. Many aspects of Morgan Stanley’s business are subject to increasingly comprehensive legal requirements concerning the use and protection of certain client information, including those adopted pursuant to the Gramm−Leach−Bliley Act of 1999 and the Fair and Accurate Credit Transactions Act of 2003 in the U.S., the European Union Data Protection Directive in the EU and various laws in Asia, including the Japanese Personal Information (Protection) Law, the Hong Kong Personal Data (Protection) Ordinance and the Australian Privacy Act. Morgan Stanley has adopted measures in response to such requirements. Institutional Securities and Global Wealth Management Group. Broker−Dealer Regulation. MS&Co. is registered as a broker−dealer with the SEC and in all 50 states, the District of Columbia, Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin Islands, and is a member of self−regulatory organizations, including the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA”) and securities exchanges, including the NYSE. Broker−dealers are subject to laws and regulations covering all aspects of the securities business, including sales and trading practices, securities offerings, publication of research reports, use of customers’ funds and securities, capital structure, record−keeping and retention and the conduct of their directors, officers, representatives and other associated persons. Broker−dealers are also regulated by securities administrators in those states where they do business. Violations of the laws and regulations governing a broker−dealer’s actions could result in censures, fines, the issuance of cease−and−desist orders, revocation of licenses or registrations, the suspension or expulsion from the securities industry of such broker−dealer or its officers or employees, or other similar consequences by both federal and state securities administrators. Margin lending by broker−dealers is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board’s restrictions on lending in connection with customer and proprietary purchases and short sales of securities, as well as securities borrowing and lending activities. Broker−dealers are also required by the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. and NYSE rules to impose maintenance requirements on the value of securities contained in margin accounts. In many cases, Morgan Stanley’s broker−dealer subsidiaries’ margin policies are more stringent than these rules. Morgan Stanley conducts some of its government securities activities through Morgan Stanley Market Products Inc., a FINRA member registered as a government securities broker−dealer with the SEC and in certain states. The Department of Treasury has promulgated regulations concerning, among other things, capital adequacy, custody and use of government securities and transfers and control of government securities subject to repurchase transactions. The rules of the Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board, which are enforced by FINRA, govern the municipal securities activities of Morgan Stanley. As registered U.S. broker−dealers, certain subsidiaries of Morgan Stanley, including MS&Co., are subject to the SEC’s net capital rule and the net capital requirements of various securities exchanges. Many non−U.S. securities exchanges and regulatory authorities either have imposed or are proposing rules relating to capital requirements 9 G-16 Table of Contents applicable to Morgan Stanley’s non−U.S. broker−dealer subsidiaries. These rules, which specify minimum capital requirements, are generally designed to measure general financial integrity and liquidity and require that at least a minimum amount of net assets be kept in relatively liquid form. See also “Consolidated Supervision and Revised Capital Standards” above and Note 16 in “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements” in Part II, Item 8. Rules of FINRA and other self−regulatory organizations also impose limitations and requirements on the transfer of member organizations’ assets. Compliance with the capital requirements may limit Morgan Stanley’s operations requiring the intensive use of capital. Such requirements restrict Morgan Stanley’s ability to withdraw capital from its broker−dealer subsidiaries, which in turn may limit its ability to pay dividends, repay debt or redeem or purchase shares of its own outstanding stock. Any change in such rules or the imposition of new rules affecting the scope, coverage, calculation or amount of capital requirements, or a significant operating loss or any unusually large charge against capital, could adversely affect Morgan Stanley’s ability to pay dividends or to expand or maintain present business levels. In addition, such rules may require Morgan Stanley to make substantial capital infusions into one or more of its broker−dealer subsidiaries in order for such subsidiaries to comply with such rules, either in the form of cash or subordinated loans made in accordance with the requirements of the SEC’s net capital rule. Regulation of Certain Commodities Activities. The commodities activities in the Institutional Securities business segment are subject to extensive and evolving energy, commodities, environmental, health and safety, and other governmental laws and regulations in the U.S. and abroad. Intensified scrutiny of certain energy markets by U.S. federal, state and local authorities in the U.S. and abroad and the public has resulted in increased regulatory and legal enforcement and remedial proceedings involving energy companies, including those engaged in power generation and liquid hydrocarbons trading. The EU has increased its focus on the energy markets, which has resulted in increased regulation of companies participating in the energy markets, including those engaged in power generation and liquid hydrocarbons trading. Terminal facilities and other assets relating to Morgan Stanley’s commodities activities are also subject to environmental laws both in the U.S. and abroad. In addition, pipeline, transport and terminal operations are subject to state laws in connection with the cleanup of hazardous substances that may have been released at properties currently or previously owned or operated by us or locations to which we have sent wastes for disposal. Additional Regulation of U.S. Entities. As a registered futures commission merchant, MS&Co. is subject to the net capital requirements of, and its activities are regulated by, the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (the “CFTC”) and various commodity exchanges. Certain subsidiaries of Morgan Stanley are registered with the CFTC as commodity trading advisors and/or commodity pool operators. Morgan Stanley’s futures and options−on−futures businesses are also regulated by the National Futures Association (the “NFA”), a registered futures association, of which MS&Co. and certain of its affiliates are members. Violations of the rules of the CFTC, the NFA or the commodity exchanges could result in remedial actions including fines, registration restrictions or terminations, trading prohibitions or revocations of commodity exchange memberships. Morgan Stanley Bank, through which Morgan Stanley conducts certain financing and lending activities, is an industrial bank chartered under the laws of the State of Utah. It has deposits that are eligible for insurance by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) in accordance with FDIC rules and is subject to comprehensive regulation and periodic examination by the Utah Department of Financial Institutions and the FDIC. Morgan Stanley Bank is not considered a “bank” under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHCA”). Morgan Stanley Trust National Association, a wholly owned subsidiary, is a federally chartered national bank whose activities are limited to fiduciary activities, primarily personal trust services. It is subject to comprehensive regulation and periodic examination by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency. Morgan Stanley Trust National Association is not FDIC−insured and is not considered a “bank” for purposes of the BHCA. 10 G-17 Table of Contents Morgan Stanley Trust, a wholly owned subsidiary which conducts certain transfer agency, sub−accounting and other activities, is a federally chartered savings bank whose activities are subject to comprehensive regulation and periodic examination by the Office of Thrift Supervision (“OTS”). As a result of its ownership of Morgan Stanley Trust, Morgan Stanley is registered with the OTS as a unitary savings and loan holding company (“SLHC”) and subject to regulation and examination by the OTS as a SLHC. Subsidiaries of Morgan Stanley, including Morgan Stanley Trust, are registered transfer agents subject to regulation and examination by the SEC. Morgan Stanley Trust has deposits that are eligible for insurance by the FDIC. Non−U.S. Regulation. Morgan Stanley’s businesses are also regulated extensively by non−U.S. regulators, including governments, securities exchanges, commodity exchanges, self−regulatory organizations, central banks and regulatory bodies, especially in those jurisdictions in which Morgan Stanley maintains an office. As Morgan Stanley continues to expand its business internationally, including in Europe, Latin America, Asia and the Middle East, it will become subject to regulation in the jurisdictions in which it conducts business. Certain Morgan Stanley subsidiaries are regulated as broker−dealers under the laws of the jurisdictions in which they operate. Subsidiaries engaged in banking and trust activities outside the U.S. are regulated by various government agencies in the particular jurisdiction where they are chartered, incorporated and/or conduct their business activity. For instance, the Financial Services Authority and several U.K. securities and futures exchanges, including the London Stock Exchange and Euronext.liffe regulate the Company’s activities in the U.K.; the Deutsche Borse AG and the Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht (the Federal Financial Supervisory Authority) regulate its activities in the Federal Republic of Germany; the Swiss Federal Banking Commission regulates its activities in Switzerland; the Comisión Nacional del Mercado del Valores (C.N.M.V.) regulates its activities in Spain; the Financial Services Agency, the Bank of Japan, the Japanese Securities Dealers Association and several Japanese securities and futures exchanges, including the Tokyo Stock Exchange, the Osaka Securities Exchange and the Tokyo International Financial Futures Exchange, regulate its activities in Japan; the Hong Kong Securities and Futures Commission, the Hong Kong Exchanges and Clearing Limited regulate its operations in Hong Kong; and the Monetary Authority of Singapore and the Singapore Exchange Limited regulate its business in Singapore. Research. Both U.S. and non−U.S. regulators continue to focus on research conflicts of interest. Research−related regulations have been implemented in many jurisdictions and are proposed or under consideration in other jurisdictions. New and revised requirements resulting from these regulations and the global research settlement with U.S. Federal and state regulators (to which Morgan Stanley is a party) have necessitated the development or enhancement of corresponding policies and procedures. Asset Management. The majority of subsidiaries related to Morgan Stanley’s asset management activities and others, including MS&Co., are registered as investment advisers with the SEC, and, in certain states, some employees or representatives of subsidiaries are registered as investment adviser representatives. Many aspects of Morgan Stanley’s asset management activities are subject to federal and state laws and regulations primarily intended to benefit the investor or client. These laws and regulations generally grant supervisory agencies and bodies broad administrative powers, including the power to limit or restrict Morgan Stanley from carrying on its asset management activities in the event that it fails to comply with such laws and regulations. Sanctions that may be imposed for such failure include the suspension of individual employees, limitations on Morgan Stanley engaging in various asset management activities for specified periods of time, the revocation of registrations, other censures and fines. Morgan Stanley’s Asset Management business is also regulated outside the U.S. For example, the Financial Services Authority regulates Morgan Stanley’s business in the U.K.; the Financial Services Agency regulates Morgan Stanley’s business in Japan; the Securities and Exchange Board of India regulates Morgan Stanley’s business in India; and the Monetary Authority of Singapore regulates Morgan Stanley’s business in Singapore. 11 G-18 Table of Contents Executive Officers of Morgan Stanley. The executive officers of Morgan Stanley and their ages and titles as of January 28, 2008 are set forth below. Business experience for the past five years is provided in accordance with SEC rules. John J. Mack (63). Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer (since June 2005). Chairman of Pequot Capital Management (June 2005). Co−Chief Executive Officer of Credit Suisse Group (January 2003 to June 2004). President, Chief Executive Officer and Director of Credit Suisse First Boston (July 2001 to June 2004). President and Chief Operating Officer of Morgan Stanley (May 1997 to March 2001). Walid Chammah (53). Co−President (since December 2007). Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Morgan Stanley International (since July 2007). Head of Investment Banking (August 2005 to July 2007) and Head of Global Capital Markets (July 2002 to August 2005). James Gorman (49). Co−President (since December 2007). Co−Head of Strategic Planning (since October 2007) and President and Chief Operating Officer of the Global Wealth Management Group (since February 2006). Head of Corporate Acquisitions Strategy & Research at Merrill Lynch & Co., Inc. (“Merrill Lynch”) (July 2005 to August 2005) and President of the Global Private Client business at Merrill Lynch (December 2002 to July 2005). Colm Kelleher (50). Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer and Co−Head of Strategic Planning (since October 2007). Head of Global Capital Markets (February 2006 to October 2007). Co−Head of Fixed Income Europe (May 2004 to February 2006). Head of Fixed Income Sales Europe (December 2000 to May 2004). Gary G. Lynch (57). Executive Vice President and Chief Legal Officer (since October 2005). Global General Counsel (October 2001 to October 2005) of Credit Suisse First Boston. Executive Vice Chairman (July 2004 to October 2005) and Vice Chairman (December 2002 to July 2004) of Credit Suisse First Boston and member of the Executive Board (July 2004 to July 2005) of Credit Suisse Group. Partner at the law firm of Davis Polk & Wardwell (September 1989 to October 2001). Thomas R. Nides (46). Executive Vice President, Chief Administrative Officer and Secretary (since September 2005). Worldwide President and Chief Executive Officer of Burson−Marsteller (November 2004 to August 2005). Chief Administrative Officer of Credit Suisse First Boston (June 2001 to June 2004). 12 G-19 Table of Contents Item 1A. Risk Factors. Liquidity Risk. Liquidity and funding risk refers to the risk that Morgan Stanley will be unable to finance its operations due to a loss of access to the capital markets or difficulty in liquidating its assets. Liquidity and funding risk also encompasses the ability of Morgan Stanley to meet its financial obligations without experiencing significant business disruption or reputational damage that may threaten its viability as a going concern. For more information on how we monitor and manage liquidity and funding risk, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Part II, Item 7 below. Liquidity is essential to our businesses and we rely on external sources to finance a significant portion of our operations. Liquidity is essential to our businesses. Our liquidity could be substantially negatively affected by an inability to raise funding in the long−term or short−term debt capital markets or the equity capital markets or an inability to access the secured lending markets. Factors that we cannot control, such as disruption of the financial markets or negative views about the financial services industry generally, could impair our ability to raise funding. In addition, our ability to raise funding could be impaired if lenders develop a negative perception of our long−term or short−term financial prospects. Such negative perceptions could be developed if we incur large trading losses, we are downgraded or put on negative watch by the rating agencies, we suffer a decline in the level of our business activity, regulatory authorities take significant action against us, or we discover serious employee misconduct or illegal activity, among other reasons. If we are unable to raise funding using the methods described above, we would likely need to liquidate unencumbered assets, such as our investment and trading portfolios, to meet maturing liabilities. We may be unable to sell some of our assets, or we may have to sell assets at a discount from market value, either of which could adversely affect our results of operations. Our borrowing costs and access to the debt capital markets depend significantly on our credit ratings. The cost and availability of unsecured financing generally are dependent on our short−term and long−term credit ratings. Factors that are significant to the determination of our credit ratings or otherwise affect our ability to raise short−term and long−term financing include the level and volatility of our earnings; our relative competitive position in the markets in which we operate; our geographic and product diversification; our ability to retain key personnel; our risk profile; our risk management policies; our cash liquidity; our capital adequacy; our corporate lending credit risk; and legal and regulatory developments. A deterioration in any of these factors or combination of these factors may lead rating agencies to downgrade our credit ratings, thereby increasing our cost of obtaining unsecured funding. Our debt ratings also can have a significant impact on certain trading revenues, particularly in those businesses where longer term counterparty performance is critical, such as OTC derivative transactions, including credit derivatives and interest rate swaps. In connection with certain OTC trading agreements and certain other agreements associated with the Institutional Securities business segment, we may be required to provide additional collateral to certain counterparties in the event of a credit ratings downgrade. We are a holding company and depend on payments from our subsidiaries. We depend on dividends, distributions and other payments from our subsidiaries to fund dividend payments and to fund all payments on our obligations, including debt obligations. Regulatory and other legal restrictions may limit our ability to transfer funds freely, either to or from our subsidiaries. In particular, many of our subsidiaries, including our broker−dealer subsidiaries, are subject to laws and regulations that authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce the flow of funds to the parent holding company, or that prohibit such transfers altogether in certain circumstances. These laws and regulations may hinder our ability to access funds that we may need to make payments on our obligations. 13 G-20 Table of Contents If our liquidity and funding policies are not adequate, we may be unable to access sufficient financing. Our liquidity and funding policies have been designed to ensure that we maintain sufficient liquid financial resources to continue to conduct our business for an extended period in a stressed liquidity environment. If our liquidity and funding policies are not adequate or we do not adhere to the policies, we may be unable to access sufficient financing to service our financial obligations when they come due, which could have a material adverse franchise or business impact. Market Risk. Market risk refers to the risk that a change in the level of one or more market prices of commodities or securities, rates, indices, implied volatilities (the price volatility of the underlying instrument imputed from option prices), correlations or other market factors, such as liquidity, will result in losses for a position or portfolio. For more information on how we monitor and manage market risk, see “Market Risk” in Part II, Item 7A herein. Our results of operations may be materially affected by market fluctuations and by economic and other factors. The amount, duration and range of our market risk exposures have been increasing over the past several years, and may continue to do so. Our results of operations may be materially affected by market fluctuations due to economic and other factors. Results of operations in the past have been, and in the future may continue to be, materially affected by many factors of a global nature, including political, economic and market conditions; the availability and cost of capital; the liquidity of global markets; the level and volatility of equity prices, commodity prices and interest rates; currency values and other market indices; technological changes and events; the availability and cost of credit; inflation; natural disasters; acts of war or terrorism; investor sentiment and confidence in the financial markets; or a combination of these or other factors. In addition, legislative, legal and regulatory developments related to our businesses potentially could increase costs, thereby affecting results of operations. These factors also may have an impact on our ability to achieve our strategic objectives. The results of our Institutional Securities business segment, particularly results relating to our involvement in primary and secondary markets for all types of financial products, are subject to substantial fluctuations due to a variety of factors, such as those enumerated above that we cannot control or predict with great certainty. These fluctuations impact results by causing variations in new business flows and in the fair value of securities and other financial products. Fluctuations also occur due to the level of global market activity, which, among other things, affects the size, number and timing of investment banking client assignments and transactions and the realization of returns from our principal investments. During periods of unfavorable market or economic conditions, the level of individual investor participation in the global markets may also decrease, which would negatively impact the results of our Global Wealth Management Group business segment. In addition, fluctuations in global market activity could impact the flow of investment capital into or from assets under management or supervision and the way customers allocate capital among money market, equity, fixed income or other investment alternatives, which could negatively impact our Asset Management business segment. We may experience further writedowns of our financial instruments and other losses related to volatile and illiquid market conditions. The Company recorded $9.4 billion in mortgage−related writedowns in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007, including $7.8 billion relating to our U.S. subprime trading positions and $1.6 billion relating to other mortgage−related products, such as commercial mortgage−backed securities, ALT−A and other loans, conduit and non−performing loans and European non−conforming loans, and an impairment charge related to mortgage−related securities portfolios in our domestic subsidiary banks. We continue to have exposure to these markets and products and as market conditions continue to evolve the fair value of these mortgage−related instruments could further deteriorate. In addition, recent market volatility has made it extremely difficult to value certain of our 14 G-21 Table of Contents securities. Subsequent valuations, in light of factors then prevailing, may result in significant changes in the values of these securities in future periods. In addition, at the time of any sales and settlements of these securities, the price we ultimately realize will depend on the demand and liquidity in the market at that time and may be materially lower than their current fair value. Any of these factors could require us to take further writedowns in the value of our securities portfolio, which may have an adverse effect on our results of operations in future periods. The results for fiscal 2007 included other losses primarily related to the illiquid market conditions that existed during the second half of fiscal 2007. These included losses reflecting mark−to−market valuations associated with loans and loan commitments largely related to acquisition financing to non−investment grade companies. The Company’s leveraged finance business originates and distributes loans and commitments, and intends to distribute its current positions; however, this may take longer than in the past and is dependent on liquidity reentering the market and additional writedowns of these loans and commitments may occur. The valuation of these commitments could change in future periods depending on, among other things, the extent that they are renegotiated or repriced or the associated acquisition transaction does not occur. Other areas of our business which to date have not been adversely affected by the illiquidity in our mortgage and lending businesses could be adversely affected if the current conditions in the credit market spread to other sectors. Holding large and concentrated positions may expose us to losses. Concentration of risk may reduce revenues or result in losses in our market−making, proprietary trading, investing, block trading, underwriting and lending businesses in the event of unfavorable market movements. We commit substantial amounts of capital to these businesses, which often results in us taking large positions in the securities of, or make large loans to, a particular issuer or issuers in a particular industry, country or region. Moreover, the trend in all major capital markets is towards larger and more frequent commitments of capital in many of these activities, and we expect this trend to continue. Markets may experience periods of high volatility accompanied by reduced liquidity. Financial markets are susceptible to severe events evidenced by rapid depreciation in asset values accompanied by a reduction in asset liquidity, such as the asset price deterioration in the U.S. subprime residential mortgage market. Under these extreme conditions, hedging and other risk management strategies may not be as effective at mitigating trading losses as they would be under more normal market conditions. Moreover, under these conditions market participants are particularly exposed to trading strategies employed by many market participants simultaneously and on a large scale, such as crowded trades. Morgan Stanley’s risk management and monitoring processes seek to quantify and mitigate risk to more extreme market moves. Severe market events have historically been difficult to predict, however, and Morgan Stanley could realize significant losses if unprecedented extreme market events were to occur, as illustrated by recent results in our subprime mortgage−related proprietary trading. We may incur significant losses in the real estate sector. We finance and acquire principal positions in a number of real estate and real estate−related products for our own account, for investment vehicles managed by affiliates in which we also may have a significant investment, for separate accounts managed by affiliates and for major participants in the commercial and residential real estate markets, and originate loans secured by commercial and residential properties. We also securitize and trade in a wide range of commercial and residential real estate and real estate−related whole loans, mortgages and other real estate and commercial assets and products, including residential and commercial mortgage−backed securities. These businesses could be adversely affected by a downturn in the real estate sector. 15 G-22 Table of Contents Credit Risk. Credit risk refers to the risk of loss arising from borrower or counterparty default when a borrower, counterparty or obligor does not meet its obligations. For more information on how we monitor and manage credit risk, see “Credit Risk” in Part II, Item 7A herein. We are exposed to the risk that third parties that are indebted to us will not perform their obligations. We incur significant, “single−name” credit risk exposure through the Institutional Securities business segment. This risk may arise, for example, from entering into swap or other derivative contracts under which counterparties have long−term obligations to make payments to us and by extending credit to our clients through various credit arrangements. We incur “individual consumer” credit risk in the Global Wealth Management Group business segment through margin and non−purpose loans to individual investors, which are collateralized by securities. The amount, duration and range of our credit exposures have been increasing over the past several years, and may continue to do so. In recent years, we have significantly expanded our use of swaps and other derivatives and we may continue to do so. Corporate clients are increasingly seeking loans or lending commitments from us in connection with investment banking and other assignments. In addition, we have experienced, due to competitive factors, increased pressure to assume longer−term credit risk, to provide swaps and lending commitments to counterparties and borrowers with lower credit quality, to extend credit against less liquid collateral and to price derivatives instruments more aggressively based on the credit risks that we take. As a clearing member firm, we finance our customer positions and we could be held responsible for the defaults or misconduct of our customers. Although we regularly review our credit exposures, default risk may arise from events or circumstances that are difficult to detect or foresee. Defaults by another larger financial institution could adversely affect financial markets generally. The commercial soundness of many financial institutions may be closely interrelated as a result of credit, trading, clearing or other relationships between the institutions. As a result, concerns about, or a default or threatened default by, one institution could lead to significant market−wide liquidity problems, losses or defaults by other institutions. This is sometimes referred to as “systemic risk” and may adversely affect financial intermediaries, such as clearing agencies, clearing houses, banks, securities firms and exchanges, with which we interact on a daily basis, and therefore could adversely affect Morgan Stanley. Operational Risk. Operational risk refers to the risk of financial or other loss, or potential damage to a firm’s reputation, arising from inadequate or failed internal processes, people, resources, systems or from external events (e.g., external or internal fraud, legal and compliance risks, damage to physical assets, etc.). Morgan Stanley may incur operational risk across its full scope of business activities, including revenue−generating activities (e.g., sales and trading) and support functions (e.g., information technology and facilities management). As such, Morgan Stanley may incur operational risk in each of its businesses, as well as within the control groups. For more information on how we monitor and manage operational risk, see “Operational Risk” in Part II, Item 7A herein. We are subject to operational risk and an operational event could adversely affect our businesses. Our businesses are highly dependent on our ability to process, on a daily basis, a large number of transactions across numerous and diverse markets in many currencies. In general, the transactions we process are increasingly complex. We perform the functions required to operate our different businesses either by ourselves or through agreements with third parties. We rely on the ability of our employees, our internal systems and systems at technology centers operated by third parties to process a high volume of transactions. We also face the risk of operational failure or termination of any of the clearing agents, exchanges, clearing houses or other financial 16 G-23 Table of Contents intermediaries we use to facilitate our securities transactions. In the event of a breakdown or improper operation of our or third party’s systems or improper action by third parties or employees, we could suffer financial loss, an impairment to our liquidity, a disruption of our businesses, regulatory sanctions or damage to our reputation. Despite the business contingency plans we have in place, our ability to conduct business may be adversely affected by a disruption in the infrastructure that supports our business and the communities where we are located. This may include a disruption involving physical site access, terrorist activities, disease pandemics, electrical, communications or other services used by Morgan Stanley, its employees or third parties with whom we conduct business. Legal Risk. Legal risk refers to the risk of non−compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements and standards. Legal risk also includes contractual and commercial risk such as the risk that a counterparty’s performance obligations will be unenforceable. For more information on how we monitor and manage legal risk, see “Legal Risk” in Part II, Item 7A herein. The financial services industry faces substantial litigation and regulatory risks, and we may face damage to our reputation and legal liability. We have been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions, and other litigation, arising in connection with our activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the issuers that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or in financial distress. We are also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental and self−regulatory agencies regarding our business, including, among other things, accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief. The number of these investigations and proceedings has increased in recent years with regard to many firms in the financial services industry, including us. Like any large corporation, we are also subject to risk from potential employee misconduct, including non−compliance with policies and improper use or disclosure of confidential information. Substantial legal liability or significant regulatory action against us could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations or cause us significant reputational harm, which could seriously harm our business. For more information regarding legal proceedings in which we are involved see “Legal Proceedings” in Part I, Item 3 herein. We are subject to extensive regulation in the jurisdictions in which we conduct our businesses. We are subject to extensive regulation globally and face the risk of significant intervention by regulatory authorities in the jurisdictions in which we conduct our businesses. Among other things, we could be fined, prohibited from engaging in some of our business activities or subject to limitations or conditions on our business activities. Significant regulatory action against us could have material adverse financial effects, cause significant reputational harm to us, or harm our business prospects. New laws or regulations or changes in the enforcement of existing laws or regulations applicable to our clients may also adversely affect our business. For more information regarding the regulatory environment in which we operate, see “Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 herein. Our commodities activities subject us to extensive regulation, potential catastrophic events and environmental risks and regulation that may expose us to significant costs and liabilities. In connection with the commodities activities in our Institutional Securities business segment, we engage in the production, storage, transportation, marketing and trading of several commodities, including metals (base and precious), agricultural products, crude oil, oil products, natural gas, electric power, emission credits, coal, freight, 17 G-24 Table of Contents LNG and related products and indices. In addition, we own five electricity generating facilities in the U.S. and Europe; TransMontaigne Inc. and its subsidiaries, a group of companies operating in the refined petroleum products marketing and distribution business; and the Heidmar Group of companies, which provide international marine transportation and U.S. marine logistics services. As a result of these activities, we are subject to extensive and evolving energy, commodities, environmental, health and safety, and other governmental laws and regulations. For example, liability may be incurred without regard to fault under certain environmental laws and regulations for the remediation of contaminated areas. Our commodities business also exposes us to the risk of unforeseen and catastrophic events, including natural disasters, leaks, spills, explosions, release of toxic substances, fires, accidents on land and at sea, wars, and terrorist attacks that could result in personal injuries, loss of life, property damage, and suspension of operations. Although we have attempted to mitigate our pollution and other environmental risks by, among other measures, adopting appropriate policies and procedures for power plant operations, monitoring the quality of petroleum storage facilities and transport vessels and implementing emergency response programs, these actions may not prove adequate to address every contingency. In addition, insurance covering some of these risks may not be available, and the proceeds, if any, from insurance recovery may not be adequate to cover liabilities with respect to particular incidents. As a result, our financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected by these events. We also expect the other laws and regulations affecting our commodities business to increase in both scope and complexity. During the past several years, intensified scrutiny of certain energy markets by federal, state and local authorities in the U.S. and abroad and the public has resulted in increased regulatory and legal enforcement, litigation and remedial proceedings involving companies engaged in the activities in which we are engaged. For example, the EU has increased its focus on the energy markets which has resulted in increased regulation of companies participating in the energy markets, including those engaged in power generation and liquid hydrocarbons trading. We may incur substantial costs in complying with current or future laws and regulations and our overall businesses and reputation may be adversely affected by the current legal environment. In addition, failure to comply with these laws and regulations may result in substantial civil and criminal fines and penalties. Potential conflicts of interest are increasing and a failure to appropriately deal with conflicts of interest could adversely affect our businesses. Our reputation is one of our most important assets. As we have expanded the scope of our businesses and our client base, we increasingly have to address potential conflicts of interest, including those relating to our proprietary activities. For example, conflicts may arise between our position as a financial advisor in a merger transaction and a principal investment we hold in one of the parties to the transaction. In addition, hedge funds and private equity funds are an increasingly important portion of our client base, and also compete with us in a number of our businesses. We have procedures and controls that are designed to address various conflicts of interest. However, identifying and managing potential conflicts of interest can be complex and difficult and our reputation could be damaged if we fail, or appear to fail, to deal appropriately with conflicts of interest. In addition, the SEC and other federal and state regulators have increased their scrutiny of potential conflicts of interest. It is possible that potential or perceived conflicts could give rise to litigation or enforcement actions, which may lead to our clients being less willing to enter into transactions in which such a conflict may occur, which will adversely affect our businesses. Competitive Environment. We face strong competition from other financial services firms, which could lead to pricing pressures that could materially adversely affect our revenue and profitability. The financial services industry and all of our businesses are intensely competitive, and we expect them to remain so. We compete with commercial banks, insurance companies, sponsors of mutual funds, hedge funds, energy companies and other companies offering financial services in the U.S., globally and through the internet. We 18 G-25 Table of Contents compete on the basis of several factors, including transaction execution, capital or access to capital, products and services, innovation, reputation and price. Over time, certain sectors of the financial services industry have become considerably more concentrated, as financial institutions involved in a broad range of financial services have been acquired by or merged into other firms. This convergence could result in our competitors gaining greater capital and other resources, such as a broader range of products and services and geographic diversity. We may experience pricing pressures as a result of these factors and as some of our competitors seek to increase market share by reducing prices. For more information regarding the competitive environment in which we operate, see “Competition” in Part I, Item 1 herein. Our ability to retain and attract qualified employees is critical to the success of our business and the failure to do so may materially adversely affect our performance. Our people are our most important resource and competition for qualified employees is intense. In order to attract and retain qualified employees, we must compensate such employees at market levels. Typically, those levels have caused employee compensation to be our greatest expense as compensation is highly variable and changes with performance. If we are unable to continue to attract and retain qualified employees, or do so at rates necessary to maintain our competitive position, or if compensation costs required to attract and retain employees become more expensive, our performance, including our competitive position, could be materially adversely affected. Automated trading markets may adversely affect our business and may increase competition. We have experienced intense price competition in some of our businesses in recent years. In particular, the ability to execute securities trades electronically on exchanges and through other automated trading markets has increased the pressure on trading commissions. The trend toward direct access to automated, electronic stock markets will likely continue. It is possible that we will experience competitive pressures in these and other areas in the future as some of our competitors may seek to obtain market share by reducing prices. International Risk. We are subject to numerous political, economic, legal, operational, franchise and other risks as a result of our international operations which could adversely impact our businesses in many ways. We are subject to political, economic, legal, operational, franchise and other risks that are inherent in operating in many countries, including risks of possible nationalization, expropriation, price controls, capital controls, exchange controls and other restrictive governmental actions, as well as the outbreak of hostilities or political and governmental instability. In many countries, the laws and regulations applicable to the securities and financial services industries are uncertain and evolving, and it may be difficult for us to determine the exact requirements of local laws in every market. Our inability to remain in compliance with local laws in a particular market could have a significant and negative effect not only on our business in that market but also on our reputation generally. We are also subject to the enhanced risk that transactions we structure might not be legally enforceable in all cases. We have expanded, and continue to look at opportunities to expand, in the emerging markets. Various emerging market countries have experienced severe economic and financial disruptions, including significant devaluations of their currencies, capital and currency exchange controls, high rates of inflation and low or negative growth rates in their economies. Crime and corruption, as well as issues of security and personal safety, also exist in certain of these countries. These conditions could adversely impact our businesses and increase volatility in financial markets generally. The emergence of a pandemic or other widespread health emergency, or concerns over the possibility of such an emergency, could create economic and financial disruptions in emerging markets and other areas throughout the world, and could lead to operational difficulties (including travel limitations) that could impair our ability to manage our businesses around the world. 19 G-26 Table of Contents Acquisition Risk. We may be unable to fully capture the expected value from acquisitions, joint ventures and minority stakes. We expect to grow in part through acquisitions, joint ventures and minority stakes. To the extent we make acquisitions or enter into combinations or joint ventures, we face numerous risks and uncertainties combining or integrating the relevant businesses and systems, including the need to combine accounting and data processing systems and management controls and to integrate relationships with clients and business partners. In the case of joint ventures and minority stakes, we are subject to additional risks and uncertainties in that we may be dependent upon, and subject to liability, losses or reputational damage relating to, systems, controls and personnel that are not under our control. In addition, conflicts or disagreements between us and our joint venture partners may negatively impact the benefits to be achieved by the joint venture. There is no assurance that our recent acquisitions or any business we acquire in the future will be successfully integrated and result in all of the positive benefits anticipated. If we are not able to integrate successfully our past and future acquisitions, there is a risk that our results of operations may be materially and adversely affected. Risk Management. Our hedging strategies and other risk management techniques may not be fully effective in mitigating our risk exposure in all market environments or against all types of risk. We have devoted significant resources to develop our risk management policies and procedures and expect to continue to do so in the future. Nonetheless, our hedging strategies and other risk management techniques may not be fully effective in mitigating our risk exposure in all market environments or against all types of risk, including risks that are unidentified or unanticipated. Some of our methods of managing risk are based upon our use of observed historical market behavior. As a result, these methods may not predict future risk exposures, which could be significantly greater than the historical measures indicate (e.g., recent events in the U.S. subprime residential mortgage market). Management of operational, legal and regulatory risks requires, among other things, policies and procedures to record properly and verify a large number of transactions and events, and these policies and procedures may not be fully effective. For more information on how we monitor and manage market and certain other risks, see “Risk Management—Market Risk” in Part II, Item 7A herein. Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments. Morgan Stanley, like other well−known seasoned issuers, from time to time receives written comments from the staff of the SEC regarding its periodic or current reports under the Exchange Act. There are no comments that remain unresolved that Morgan Stanley received not less than 180 days before the end of its fiscal year to which this report relates that Morgan Stanley believes are material. 20 G-27 Table of Contents Item 2. Properties. Morgan Stanley has offices, operations and processing centers and warehouse facilities located throughout the U.S., and certain subsidiaries maintain offices and other facilities in international locations. Morgan Stanley’s properties that are not owned are leased on terms and for durations that are reflective of commercial standards in the communities where these properties are located. Morgan Stanley believes the facilities it owns or occupies are adequate for the purposes for which they are currently used and are well maintained. Our principal offices consist of the following properties: Location Owned/ Leased Approximate Square Footage as of November 30, 2007* Lease Expiration U.S. Locations 1585 Broadway New York, New York (Global Headquarters and Institutional Securities Headquarters) Owned N/A 894,390 square feet 522 Fifth Avenue New York, New York (Asset Management Headquarters) Owned N/A 581,242 square feet 2000 Westchester Avenue Purchase, New York (Global Wealth Management Group Headquarters) Owned N/A 590,303 square feet New York, New York (Several locations) Leased 2008 – 2018 One Pierrepont Plaza Brooklyn, New York Leased 2013 456,686 square feet Jersey City, New Jersey (Several locations) Leased 2008 – 2012 499,350 square feet N/A 450,150 square feet 2,238,726 square feet International Locations 25 Cabot Square, Canary Wharf (London Headquarters) Owned** Canary Wharf (Several locations) Leased 2013 – 2038 957,378 square feet 1 Austin Road Kowloon Station, West Kowloon (Hong Kong Headquarters) Leased 2019 356,630 square feet Sapporo’s Yebisu Garden Place, Ebisu, Shibuya−ku (Tokyo Headquarters) Leased Option to cancel in 2008, or at any time thereafter 396,314 square feet * ** The indicated total aggregate square footage leased does not include space occupied by Morgan Stanley securities branch offices. Morgan Stanley holds the freehold interest in the land and building. 21 G-28 Table of Contents Item 3. Legal Proceedings. In addition to the matters described below, in the normal course of business, Morgan Stanley has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the issuers that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or in financial distress. Morgan Stanley is also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental and self−regulatory agencies regarding Morgan Stanley’s business, including, among other matters, accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief. Morgan Stanley contests liability and/or the amount of damages as appropriate in each pending matter. In view of the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of such matters, particularly in cases where claimants seek substantial or indeterminate damages or where investigations and proceedings are in the early stages, Morgan Stanley cannot predict with certainty the loss or range of loss, if any, related to such matters, how or if such matters will be resolved, when they will ultimately be resolved, or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, might be. Subject to the foregoing, Morgan Stanley believes, based on current knowledge and after consultation with counsel, that the outcome of such pending matters will not have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition of Morgan Stanley, although the outcome of such matters could be material to Morgan Stanley’s operating results and cash flows for a particular future period, depending on, among other things, the level of Morgan Stanley’s revenues or income for such period. Coleman Litigation. In May 2003, Coleman (Parent) Holdings Inc. (“CPH”) filed a complaint against Morgan Stanley in the Circuit Court of the Fifteenth Judicial Circuit for Palm Beach County, Florida relating to the 1998 merger between The Coleman Company, Inc. and Sunbeam, Inc. (“Sunbeam”). The complaint, as amended, alleged that CPH was induced to agree to the transaction with Sunbeam based on certain financial misrepresentations, and it asserted claims against Morgan Stanley for aiding and abetting fraud, conspiracy and punitive damages. Shortly before trial, which commenced in April 2005, the trial court granted, in part, a motion for entry of a default judgment against Morgan Stanley and ordered that portions of CPH’s complaint, including those setting forth CPH’s primary allegations against Morgan Stanley, be read to the jury and deemed established for all purposes in the action. In May 2005, the jury returned a verdict in favor of CPH and awarded CPH $604 million in compensatory damages and $850 million in punitive damages. In June 2005, the trial court issued a final judgment in favor of CPH in the amount of $1,578 million, which included prejudgment interest and excluded certain payments received by CPH in settlement of related claims against others. In March 2007, the District Court of Appeal for the Fourth District of Florida (the “Court of Appeal”) issued an opinion reversing the trial court’s award for compensatory and punitive damages and remanding the matter to the trial court for entry of judgment for Morgan Stanley. In June 2007, the Court of Appeal’s opinion became final when the Court of Appeal issued an order denying CPH’s motions for rehearing, rehearing en banc and for certification of certain questions for review by the Florida Supreme Court (“the Supreme Court”). On December 12, 2007, the Supreme Court denied CPH’s request for review of the Court of Appeal’s decision, directing judgment in favor of Morgan Stanley. IPO Fee Litigation. Starting in late 1998, purported class actions, later captioned In re Public Offering Fee Antitrust Litigation (the “purchaser actions”) and In re Issuer Plaintiff Initial Public Offering Fee Antitrust Litigation (the “issuer actions”), were initiated in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York (the “SDNY”) against 22 G-29 Table of Contents Morgan Stanley and numerous other underwriters. The consolidated proceedings, one on behalf of purchasers and the other on behalf of issuers of certain shares in initial public offerings (“IPOs”), allege that defendants conspired to fix the underwriters’ spread at 7% in IPOs of U.S. companies in the $20 million to $80 million range in violation of Section 1 of the Sherman Act. The complaints seek treble damages and injunctive relief. Plaintiffs’ claims for damages in the purchaser actions have been dismissed, but the claims for injunctive relief remain and plaintiffs’ claims in the issuer actions for damages and injunctive relief remain. Plaintiffs moved for class certification in both actions, and defendants opposed that motion in May 2005. In October 2005, plaintiffs moved for summary judgment, which defendants opposed. In May 2006, plaintiffs filed a petition pursuant to Federal Rule of Civil Procedure 23(f) for leave to appeal the SDNY’s denial of class certification and in September 2007, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit (the “Second Circuit”) reversed the SDNY’s decision and remanded the case back to the district court for further consideration of class certification issues. On remand, plaintiffs filed a motion for class certification on October 17, 2007. IPO Allocation Matters. Beginning in March 2001, numerous purported class actions, now captioned In re Initial Public Offering Securities Litigation, were filed in the SDNY against certain issuers of IPO securities, certain individual officers of those issuers, Morgan Stanley and other underwriters of those IPOs, purportedly on behalf of purchasers of stock in the IPOs or the aftermarket. These complaints allege that defendants required customers who wanted allocations of “hot” IPO securities to pay undisclosed and excessive underwriters’ compensation in the form of increased brokerage commissions and to buy shares of securities offered in the IPOs after the IPOs were completed at escalating price levels higher than the IPO price (a practice plaintiffs refer to as “laddering”), and claim violations of the federal securities laws, including Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933 (the “Securities Act”) and Section 10(b) of the Exchange Act. Some of the complaints also allege that continuous “buy” recommendations by the defendants’ research analysts improperly increased or sustained the prices at which the securities traded after the IPOs. In February 2003, the underwriter defendants’ joint motion to dismiss was denied, except as to certain specified offerings. In December 2006, the Second Circuit reversed the SDNY’s grant of class certification, and ruled that these cases could not be certified for class treatment. In August 2007, plaintiffs filed second consolidated amended class action complaints, which purport to amend the allegations in light of the Second Circuit’s reversal of the SDNY’s decision approving the cases to proceed as class actions. Plaintiffs again seek certification of classes. In October 2007, numerous derivative actions, purportedly brought on behalf of certain issuers of IPO securities, were filed in the U.S. District Court for the Western District of Washington against Morgan Stanley and other underwriters of those IPOs. The actions seek to recover “short swing” profits allegedly generated in violation of Section 16(b) of the Exchange Act. Late Trading and Market Timing. Starting in July 2003, Morgan Stanley received subpoenas and requests for information from various regulatory and governmental agencies, including the SEC, the NYSE and various states, in connection with industry−wide investigations of broker−dealers and mutual fund complexes relating to possible late trading and market timing of mutual funds. In December 2007, Morgan Stanley settled all claims with the SEC concerning late trading and market timing of mutual funds in the retail system over the period from January 2002 to August 2003. Under the terms of the settlement, Morgan Stanley will, among other things, be censured and pay a monetary fine. Subprime−related Matters. Morgan Stanley is responding to subpoenas and requests for information from certain regulatory and governmental entities concerning the origination, purchase, securitization and servicing of subprime and non−subprime residential mortgages and related issues. Morgan Stanley has also been named as a defendant in various civil litigation matters related to the subprime and non−subprime residential mortgage business, including 23 G-30 Table of Contents purported class actions related to Morgan Stanley’s role as an underwriter of certain preferred stock offerings for New Century Financial Corp. and Countrywide Financial Corp. and certain offerings of mortgage pass through certificates for a subsidiary of Countrywide Financial Corp., and other related matters. A shareholder derivative lawsuit was filed in the SDNY during November 2007 asserting claims related in large part to losses caused by certain subprime−related trading positions and related matters, but no complaint has been served. In December 2007, several purported class action complaints were filed in SDNY asserting claims on behalf of participants in Morgan Stanley’s 401(k) plan and employee stock ownership plan against Morgan Stanley and other parties, including certain present and former directors and officers, under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974. The complaints relate in large part to subprime−related losses, and allege, among other things, that Morgan Stanley stock was not a prudent investment and that risks associated with Morgan Stanley stock and Morgan Stanley’s financial condition were not adequately disclosed. The following matters were terminated during the quarter ended November 30, 2007: Global Wealth Management Group Employment Matters. Wage and Hour Matters. Complaints raising allegations of unpaid overtime and unlawful wage deductions were filed against Morgan Stanley in New Jersey, New York, Connecticut, Texas, Florida, Illinois, California and Ohio seeking damages on behalf of certain current and former employees. In October 2006, Morgan Stanley reached agreement to resolve these claims on behalf of the individual claimants as well as other potential class members nationwide. In November 2006, for purposes of executing the settlement, a consolidated amended complaint captioned Steinberg, et al. v. Morgan Stanley was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of California (“SDC”). In December 2006, the Judicial Panel on Multi−District Litigation issued an order centralizing the various matters pending across the country in the SDC. Gender Matters. In June 2006, Morgan Stanley was named in two purported class actions alleging gender discrimination under state and federal law. On October 24, 2007, the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia granted final approval to the settlement reached in Joanne Augst−Johnson v. Morgan Stanley. The approved settlement resolved all of the class−wide and individual plaintiffs’ claims and included, among other things, a payment to the settlement fund and certain programmatic relief. All similar class wide claims raised in the second purported gender class action captioned Daisy Jaffe et al. v. Morgan Stanley were subsumed by the Augst−Johnson settlement. Item 4. Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders. There were no matters submitted to a vote of security holders during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year ended November 30, 2007. 24 G-31 Table of Contents Part II Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities. Morgan Stanley’s common stock trades on the NYSE under the symbol “MS.” At January 23, 2008, Morgan Stanley had approximately 94,469 holders of record; however, Morgan Stanley believes the number of beneficial owners of common stock exceeds this number. The table below sets forth, for each of the last eight fiscal quarters, the low and high sales prices per share of Morgan Stanley’s common stock as reported by Bloomberg Financial Markets and the amount of any cash dividends declared per share of Morgan Stanley’s common stock. Fiscal 2007: Fourth Quarter Third Quarter* Second Quarter First Quarter Fiscal 2006: Fourth Quarter Third Quarter Second Quarter First Quarter * Low Sale Price High Sale Price Dividends $ $ $ $ 47.56 54.90 70.30 73.04 $ $ $ $ 69.87 90.95 87.44 84.66 $ $ $ $ 0.27 0.27 0.27 0.27 $ $ $ $ 65.26 54.52 57.58 55.89 $ $ $ $ 80.00 69.50 66.00 62.15 $ $ $ $ 0.27 0.27 0.27 0.27 On June 30, 2007, Morgan Stanley completed the Discover Spin−off. Prior to the Discover Spin−off, the Low Sale Price and the High Sale Price for the Third Quarter were $82.73 and $90.95, respectively. 25 G-32 Table of Contents The table below sets forth the information with respect to purchases made by or on behalf of Morgan Stanley of its common stock during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year ended November 30, 2007. Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities (dollars in millions, except per share amounts) Period Month #1 (September 1, 2007—September 30, 2007) Share Repurchase Program (A) Employee Transactions (B) Month #2 (October 1, 2007—October 31, 2007) Share Repurchase Program (A) Employee Transactions (B) Month #3 (November 1, 2007—November 30, 2007) Share Repurchase Program (A) Employee Transactions (B) Total Share Repurchase Program (A) Employee Transactions (B) Approximate Dollar Value of Shares that May Yet Be Purchased Under the Plans or Programs Total Number of Shares Purchased Average Price Paid Per Share Total Number of Shares Purchased As Part of Publicly Announced Plans or Programs (C) — 2,348,230 N/A $ 62.89 — N/A $ 2,787 N/A 2,830,092 29,705 $ 63.32 $ 66.34 2,830,092 N/A $ 2,608 N/A 6,364,081 98,592 $ 52.93 $ 53.65 6,364,081 N/A $ 2,271 N/A 9,194,173 2,476,527 $ 56.13 $ 62.56 9,194,173 N/A $ 2,271 N/A (A) On December 19, 2006, Morgan Stanley announced that its Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of up to $6 billion of Morgan Stanley’s outstanding stock under a new share repurchase program (the “Share Repurchase Program”). The Share Repurchase Program is a program for capital management purposes that considers, among other things, business segment capital needs, as well as equity−based compensation and benefit plan requirements. The Share Repurchase Program has no set expiration or termination date. (B) Includes: (1) shares delivered or attested to in satisfaction of the exercise price and/or tax withholding obligations by holders of employee stock options (granted under employee stock compensation plans) who exercised options; (2) restricted shares withheld (under the terms of grants under employee stock compensation plans) to offset tax withholding obligations that occur upon vesting and release of restricted shares; and (3) shares withheld (under the terms of grants under employee stock compensation plans) to offset tax withholding obligations that occur upon the delivery of outstanding shares underlying restricted stock units. Morgan Stanley’s employee stock compensation plans provide that the value of the shares delivered or attested, or withheld, shall be valued using the fair market value of Morgan Stanley common stock on the date the relevant transaction occurs, using a valuation methodology established by Morgan Stanley. (C) Share purchases under publicly announced programs are made pursuant to open−market purchases, Rule 10b5−1 plans or privately negotiated transactions (including with employee benefit plans) as market conditions warrant and at prices Morgan Stanley deems appropriate. *** 26 G-33 Table of Contents Stock performance graph. The following graph compares the cumulative total shareholder return (rounded to the nearest whole dollar) of our common stock, the S&P 500 Stock Index (“S&P 500”) and the S&P 500 Diversified Financials Index (“S5DIVF”) for our last five fiscal years. The graph assumes a $100 investment at the closing price on November 30, 2002 and reinvestment of dividends on the respective dividend payment dates without commissions. Historical prices are adjusted to reflect the Discover Spin−off completed on June 30, 2007. This graph does not forecast future performance of our common stock. 27 G-34 Table of Contents Item 6. Selected Financial Data. MORGAN STANLEY SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA (dollars in millions, except share and per share data) 2007 2006 Fiscal Year 2005 2004 2003 $ 6,368 $ 4,755 $ 3,843 $ 3,341 $ 2,440 3,206 3,262 4,682 6,519 60,083 1,208 11,805 1,807 3,770 5,238 42,776 585 7,377 1,128 3,331 4,915 25,987 496 5,512 721 3,235 4,436 16,719 332 6,262 170 2,861 3,784 13,685 245 85,328 57,302 70,736 40,897 47,077 23,552 34,296 13,977 29,447 11,826 28,026 29,839 23,525 20,319 17,621 16,552 8,033 — 13,986 6,750 — 10,749 6,711 (251) 9,320 5,482 — 7,892 4,659 — 24,585 20,736 17,209 14,802 12,551 Income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees, income taxes, dividends on preferred securities subject to mandatory redemption and cumulative effect of accounting change, net Losses from unconsolidated investees Provision for income taxes Dividends on preferred securities subject to mandatory redemption 3,441 47 831 — 9,103 40 2,728 — 6,316 311 1,473 — 5,517 328 1,384 45 5,070 279 1,305 154 Income from continuing operations before cumulative effect of accounting change, net 2,563 6,335 4,532 3,760 3,332 Discontinued operations: Net gain from discontinued operations Provision for income taxes 1,024 378 1,666 529 559 201 1,129 403 696 241 646 — 1,137 — 358 49 726 — 455 — Net income $ 3,209 $ 7,472 $ 4,939 $ 4,486 $ 3,787 Preferred stock dividend requirements $ $ $ $ $ Earnings applicable to common shareholders(1) $ 3,141 Income Statement Data: Revenues: Investment banking Principal transactions: Trading Investments Commissions Asset management, distribution and administration fees Interest and dividends Other Total revenues Interest expense Net revenues Non−interest expenses: Compensation and benefits Other th September 11 related insurance recoveries, net Total non−interest expenses Net gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net 28 68 19 $ 7,453 — $ 4,939 — $ 4,486 — $ 3,787 G-35 Table of Contents 2007 Per Share Data: Earnings per basic common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per basic common share Earnings per diluted common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per diluted common share Book value per common share Dividends per common share Balance Sheet and Other Operating Data: Total assets Consumer loans, net Total capital(2) Long−term borrowings(2) Shareholders’ equity Return on average common shareholders’ equity Average common and equivalent shares(1) (1) (2) $ Fiscal Year 2005 2006 2.49 0.64 $ 6.25 1.13 — $ — 4.32 0.33 2004 2003 $ 3.48 0.67 0.05 $ — 3.10 0.42 — $ 3.13 $ 7.38 $ 4.70 $ 4.15 $ 3.52 $ 2.37 0.61 $ 5.99 1.08 $ 4.19 0.33 $ 3.40 0.66 $ 3.04 0.41 — — 0.05 — — $ 2.98 $ 7.07 $ 4.57 $ 4.06 $ 3.45 $ $ 28.56 1.08 $ $ 32.67 1.08 $ $ 27.59 1.08 $ $ 25.95 1.00 $ $ 22.93 0.92 $ 1,045,409 — 191,085 159,816 31,269 $ 1,121,192 22,915 162,134 126,770 35,364 $ 898,835 21,966 125,891 96,709 29,182 $ 747,578 19,166 110,793 82,587 28,206 $ 603,022 18,362 82,769 57,902 24,867 8.9% 1,001,878,651 23.5% 1,010,254,255 17.3% 1,049,896,047 16.8% 1,080,121,708 Amounts shown are used to calculate earnings per basic common share. These amounts exclude the current portion of long−term borrowings and include Capital Units and junior subordinated debt issued to capital trusts. 29 16.5% 1,076,754,740 G-36 Table of Contents Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations. Introduction. Morgan Stanley (the “Company”) is a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of its business segments—Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group and Asset Management. The Company, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. A summary of the activities of each of the segments follows. Institutional Securities includes capital raising; financial advisory services, including advice on mergers and acquisitions, restructurings, real estate and project finance; corporate lending; sales, trading, financing and market−making activities in equity and fixed income securities and related products, including foreign exchange and commodities; benchmark indices and risk management analytics; research; and investment activities. Global Wealth Management Group provides brokerage and investment advisory services covering various investment alternatives; financial and wealth planning services; annuity and other insurance products; credit and other lending products; cash management services; retirement services; and trust and fiduciary services. Asset Management provides global asset management products and services in equity, fixed income, alternative investments, which includes hedge funds and fund of funds, and merchant banking, which includes real estate, private equity and infrastructure, to institutional and retail clients through proprietary and third−party retail distribution channels, intermediaries and the Company’s institutional distribution channel. Asset Management also engages in investment activities. The Company’s results of operations for the 12 months ended November 30, 2007 (“fiscal 2007”), November 30, 2006 (“fiscal 2006”) and November 30, 2005 (“fiscal 2005”) are discussed below. Discontinued Operations. On June 30, 2007, the Company completed the spin−off (the “Discover Spin−off”) of Discover Financial Services (“DFS”) to its shareholders. DFS’ results are included within discontinued operations for all periods presented through the date of the Discover Spin−off. The results of Quilter Holdings Ltd. (“Quilter”), Global Wealth Management Group’s former mass affluent business in the U.K., are reported as discontinued operations for all periods presented through its sale on February 28, 2007. The results of the Company’s aircraft leasing business, which was sold on March 24, 2006, are also reported as discontinued operations through its date of sale. See Note 22 to the consolidated financial statements. 30 G-37 Table of Contents Results of Operations. Executive Summary. Financial Information. 2007 Fiscal Year 2006 2005 $16,149 6,625 5,493 (241) $21,110 5,512 3,453 (236) $15,497 5,047 3,219 (238) $28,026 $29,839 $23,525 $ 817 1,155 1,467 2 $ 7,721 508 851 23 $ 4,609 591 1,030 86 $ 3,441 $ 9,103 $ 6,316 Consolidated net income (dollars in millions) $ 3,209 $ 7,472 $ 4,939 Earnings applicable to common shareholders (dollars in millions)(2) $ 3,141 $ 7,453 $ 4,939 $ 2.49 0.64 — $ 6.25 1.13 — $ 4.32 0.33 0.05 $ 3.13 $ 7.38 $ 4.70 $ 2.37 0.61 — $ 5.99 1.08 — $ 4.19 0.33 0.05 $ 2.98 $ 7.07 $ 4.57 Net revenues (dollars in millions): Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Asset Management Intersegment Eliminations Consolidated net revenues Income before taxes (dollars in millions)(1): Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Asset Management Intersegment Eliminations Consolidated income before taxes Earnings per basic common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per basic common share Earnings per diluted common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per diluted common share Regional net revenues (dollars in millions)(3): Americas Europe, Middle East and Africa Asia Consolidated net revenues $12,150 10,008 5,868 $18,803 7,762 3,274 $15,375 5,711 2,439 $28,026 $29,839 $23,525 $ 28.56 $ 32.67 $ 27.59 $ $ $ Statistical Data. Book value per common share(4) Average common equity (dollars in billions)(5): Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Asset Management Unallocated capital Total from continuing operations Discontinued operations 23.9 1.7 3.5 2.9 32.0 3.2 Total $ 31 35.2 18.0 3.0 2.4 3.1 26.5 5.2 $ 31.7 14.6 3.4 1.8 2.9 22.7 5.8 $ 28.5 G-38 Table of Contents Statistical Data (Continued). 2007 Return on average common equity(5): Consolidated Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Asset Management Effective income tax rate from continuing operations Worldwide employees (excluding DFS employees of 13,186 in 2006 and 13,495 in 2005) Consolidated assets under management or supervision by asset class (dollars in billions): Equity Fixed income Money market Alternatives(6) 9% 4% 41% 26% 24.5% 48,256 $ Subtotal Unit trusts Other(7) Total assets under management or supervision(8) Share of minority interest assets(9) Total $ Institutional Securities (dollars in billions): Mergers and acquisitions completed transactions(10): Global market volume Market share Rank Mergers and acquisitions announced transactions(10): Global market volume Market share Rank Global equity and equity−related issues(10): Global market volume Market share Rank Global debt issues(10): Global market volume Market share Rank Global initial public offerings(10): Global market volume Market share Rank Pre−tax profit margin(11) 32 Fiscal Year 2006 355 127 108 109 2005 23% 30% 11% 21% 30.1% 43,124 $ 307 111 89 61 17% 24% 11% 36% 24.5% 39,723 $ 272 105 83 43 699 15 61 568 14 63 503 12 48 775 7 645 4 563 — 782 $ 649 $ 563 $1,280.6 35.4% 1 $ 730.5 25.4% 3 $ 522.7 24.3% 3 $1,339.4 31.8% 2 $ 973.9 28.9% 2 $ 726.0 29.5% 2 $ $ $ 64.7 7.4% 5 57.2 8.0% 4 45.9 8.7% 3 $ 361.2 5.4% 6 $ 409.9 5.8% 6 $ 347.2 5.7% 5 $ $ $ 24.1 7.8% 3 5% 22.6 8.4% 2 37% 14.7 8.9% 2 30% G-39 Table of Contents Statistical Data (Continued). Global Wealth Management Group: Global representatives Annualized net revenue per global representative (dollars in thousands)(12) Client assets by segment (dollars in billions): $10 million or more $1 million – $10 million Subtotal $1 million or more $100,000 – $1 million Less than $100,000 Client assets excluding corporate and other accounts Corporate and other accounts Total client assets Fee−based assets as a percentage of total client assets(13) Client assets per global representative (dollars in millions)(14) Bank deposits (dollars in billions)(15) Pre−tax profit margin(11) Asset Management: Assets under management or supervision (dollars in billions)(16) Percent of fund assets in top half of Lipper rankings(17) Pre−tax profit margin(11) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) (14) (15) (16) (17) 2007 Fiscal Year 2006 2005 8,429 $ 811 7,944 $ 651 9,434 $ 502 $ 247 275 $ 199 243 $ 156 215 522 179 23 442 177 27 371 177 32 724 34 646 30 580 29 $ 758 $ 676 $ 609 27% $ 90 $ 26.2 17% 29% $ 85 $ 13.3 9% $ $ $ 597 49% 27% $ 496 40% 25% $ 443 61% 32% 27% 65 1.7 12% Amounts represent income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees, income taxes and cumulative effect of accounting change, net. Earnings applicable to common shareholders are used to calculate earnings per share information. Fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 include a preferred stock dividend of $68 million and $19 million, respectively. Reflects the regional view of the Company’s consolidated net revenues, on a managed basis, based on the following methodology: Institutional Securities: investment banking—client location, equity capital markets—client location, debt capital markets—revenue recording location, sales and trading—trading desk location. Global Wealth Management Group: global representative location. Asset Management: client location, except for the merchant banking business, which is based on asset location. Book value per common share equals common shareholders’ equity of $30,169 million at November 30, 2007, $34,264 million at November 30, 2006 and $29,182 million at November 30, 2005, divided by common shares outstanding of 1,056 million at November 30, 2007, 1,049 million at November 30, 2006 and 1,058 million at November 30, 2005. The computation of average common equity for each business segment is based upon an economic capital model that estimates the amount of equity capital required to support the businesses and their risk−generating activities through the business cycle while simultaneously satisfying regulatory, rating agency and investor minimum requirements. The economic capital model will evolve over time in response to changes in the business and regulatory environment and to improvements in modeling techniques in order to reflect the capital required to support business activities. The effective tax rates used in the computation of segment return on average common equity were determined on a separate entity basis. Amounts reported for Alternatives reflect the Company’s invested equity in those funds and include a range of alternative investment products such as real estate funds, hedge funds, private equity funds, funds of hedge funds and funds of private equity funds. Amounts include assets under management or supervision associated with the Global Wealth Management Group business segment. Revenues and expenses associated with these assets are included in the Company’s Asset Management, Global Wealth Management Group and Institutional Securities business segments. Amounts represent Asset Management’s proportional share of assets managed by entities in which it owns a minority interest. Source: Thomson Financial, data as of January 8, 2008—The data for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 are for the periods from January 1 to December 31, 2007, January 1 to December 31, 2006 and January 1 to December 31, 2005, respectively, as Thomson Financial presents these data on a calendar−year basis. Percentages represent income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees, income taxes and cumulative effect of accounting change, net, as a percentage of net revenues. Annualized net revenue per global representative amounts equal Global Wealth Management Group’s net revenues divided by the quarterly average global representative headcount for the periods presented. The decline in fee−based assets as a percent of total client assets largely reflected the termination on October 1, 2007 of the Company’s fee−based (fee in lieu of commission) brokerage program pursuant to a court decision vacating a Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) rule that permitted fee−based brokerage. Client assets that were in the fee−based program primarily moved to commission−based brokerage accounts, or at the election of some clients, into other fee−based advisory programs, including Morgan Stanley Advisory, a new nondiscretionary account launched in August 2007. Client assets per global representative equal total period−end client assets divided by period−end global representative headcount. Bank deposits are held at certain of the Company’s Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”) insured depository institutions for the benefit of retail clients through their accounts. Amounts include Asset Management’s proportional share of assets managed by entities in which it owns a minority interest. Source: Lipper, one−year performance excluding money market funds as of November 30, 2007, November 30, 2006 and November 30, 2005, respectively. 33 G-40 Table of Contents Fiscal 2007 Performance. Company Results. The Company recorded net income of $3,209 million in fiscal 2007, a 57% decrease from $7,472 million in the prior year. Net revenues (total revenues less interest expense) declined 6% to $28,026 million in fiscal 2007. During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007, the Company recorded $9.4 billion in mortgage−related writedowns resulting from an unfavorable subprime mortgage−related trading strategy and the continued deterioration and lack of market liquidity for subprime and other mortgage−related instruments. Included in the $9.4 billion were writedowns of $7.8 billion related to U.S. subprime trading positions, principally super senior derivative positions in collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”). These derivative positions were entered into primarily by the Company’s proprietary trading group. The remaining writedowns of $1.6 billion related to other mortgage−related instruments, which included $1.2 billion relating to commercial mortgage−backed securities (“CMBS”), ALT−A (a residential mortgage loan categorization that falls between prime and subprime) and other loans, conduit and non−performing loans, European non−conforming loans and an impairment charge of $437 million related to mortgage−related securities portfolios in the Company’s domestic subsidiary banks. The results for fiscal 2007 also included losses of approximately $700 million that reflected mark−to−market valuations associated with loans and loan commitments largely related to acquisition financing to non−investment grade companies (see “Impact of Credit Market Events” herein). Non−interest expenses increased 19% to $24,585 million from the prior year primarily due to higher compensation costs. Diluted earnings per share were $2.98 compared with $7.07 a year ago. Compensation and benefits expense increased 18%, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation accruals due to higher net revenues in certain of the Company’s businesses. Diluted earnings per share from continuing operations were $2.37 compared with $5.99 last year. The return on average common equity in fiscal 2007 was 8.9% compared with 23.5% in the prior year. The return on average common equity from continuing operations for fiscal 2007 was 7.8% compared with 23.8% last year. Results for fiscal 2007 also included a gain of $168 million ($109 million after−tax) in discontinued operations related to the sale of Quilter on February 28, 2007. Results for fiscal 2006 included a loss of $125 million ($75 million after−tax) related to the sale of the Company’s aircraft leasing business (see Note 22 to the consolidated financial statements). In addition, pre−tax results for fiscal 2007 included the $360 million reversal of the Coleman litigation reserve (see “Other Matters—Coleman Litigation” herein). Results for fiscal 2006 included non−cash incremental compensation expenses of approximately $260 million for stock−based awards granted to retirement−eligible employees (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements). The Company’s effective income tax rate from continuing operations was 24.5% in fiscal 2007 compared with 30.1% in fiscal 2006. The decrease primarily reflected lower earnings that increased the effect of permanent differences. Fiscal 2006’s income tax provision included an income tax benefit of $242 million resulting from the resolution of a federal tax audit. Excluding the benefits from the federal tax audit, the Company’s effective income tax rate from continuing operations in fiscal 2006 would have been 32.8%. At fiscal year−end, the Company had 48,256 employees worldwide compared with 43,124 (excluding DFS employees) at the prior year−end. Subsequent to the 2007 fiscal year−end, in December 2007, the Company sold equity units (the “Equity Units”) to a wholly owned subsidiary of the China Investment Corporation Ltd. (“CIC”) for approximately $5,579 million (see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—China Investment Corporation Investment” herein). Institutional Securities. Institutional Securities recorded income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees and income taxes of $817 million, an 89% decrease from a year ago. Net revenues declined 24% to $16,149 million as record results in equity sales and trading, advisory and underwriting were more than offset by lower results in fixed income sales and trading. Non−interest expenses increased 15% to $15,332 million, reflecting higher compensation costs and non−compensation expenses. Non−compensation expenses increased 24% as higher costs associated with higher levels of business activity, business investment 34 G-41 Table of Contents and operating expenses associated with TransMontaigne Inc. (“TransMontaigne”), the Heidmar Group of companies (“Heidmar”) and Saxon Capital, Inc. (“Saxon”) were partially offset by the reversal of the Coleman Litigation reserve. Investment banking revenues rose 31% from last year to $5,538 million. Underwriting revenues rose 21% from last year to $2,997 million. Advisory fees from merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions were $2,541 million, an increase of 45% from fiscal 2006. Fixed income sales and trading revenues were $650 million, down 93% from a year ago. The decrease was driven by significant losses in credit products and lower results in commodities, partially offset by record results in interest rate and currency products. The decline in credit product revenues primarily reflected the mortgage−related writedowns (see “Impact of Credit Market Events” herein). Commodity revenues decreased primarily due to lower trading results from oil liquids, electricity and natural gas products. Fiscal 2006 also benefited from revenue recognized on structured transactions. Interest rate and currency product revenues benefited from stronger revenues in interest rate, emerging markets and foreign exchange products. Equity sales and trading revenues increased 38% to a record $8,658 million. Record international results contributed to record revenues from derivative products and prime brokerage and strong results in cash products. Sales and trading revenues also benefited in fiscal 2007 from the widening of the Company’s credit spreads on financial instruments that are accounted for at fair value. In fiscal 2007, other sales and trading losses of approximately $1,242 million reflected loans and loan commitments largely related to event−driven lending to non−investment grade companies and the impairment charge related to mortgage−related securities portfolios in the Company’s domestic subsidiary banks (see “Impact of Credit Market Events—Subsidiary Banks” herein). Principal transaction net investment revenues increased 35% to $1,459 million in fiscal 2007. Fiscal 2007’s results primarily related to realized and unrealized net gains associated with certain of the Company’s investments and higher revenues from the Company’s investments in passive limited partnership interests associated with the Company’s real estate funds. The increase also reflected higher revenues primarily related to the appreciation of investments related to certain employee deferred compensation plans. Global Wealth Management Group. Global Wealth Management Group recorded income from continuing operations before income taxes of $1,155 million, up 127% from the prior year. Net revenues were $6,625 million, a 20% increase over a year ago, primarily reflecting higher revenues from increased underwriting activity, higher asset management revenues reflecting growth in fee−based products and higher net interest revenue from growth in the bank deposit program. Total non−interest expenses were $5,470 million, a 9% increase from a year ago. Compensation and benefits expense increased 15%, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation accruals due to higher net revenues. Non−compensation costs decreased 2%, primarily reflecting lower charges for legal and regulatory matters and continued cost discipline across the business. Total client assets increased to $758 billion, up 12% from the prior fiscal year−end. In addition, client assets in fee−based accounts increased 3% from a year ago to $201 billion and decreased as a percentage of total client assets to 27% from last year’s 29%. The decline in fee−based assets as a percent of total client assets largely reflected the termination on October 1, 2007 of the Company’s fee−based (fee in lieu of commission) brokerage program pursuant to a court decision vacating an SEC rule that permitted fee−based brokerage. At fiscal year−end, the number of global representatives was 8,429, an increase of 485 from a year ago. Asset Management. Asset Management recorded income before income taxes of $1,467 million, a 72% increase from last year. Net revenues of $5,493 million increased 59% from the prior year, reflecting significantly higher investment revenues, primarily in the merchant banking business, which includes the real estate, private equity and infrastructure businesses. The increase primarily reflected higher revenues associated with the appreciation of investments related to employee deferred compensation and co−investment plans. The 35 G-42 Table of Contents increase was also due to higher asset management, distribution and administration fees primarily due to an increase in assets under management, a more favorable asset mix and higher performance fees due to growth in the alternatives business, including FrontPoint Partners (“FrontPoint”), which was acquired in December 2006. Principal transaction net investment gains for the year were $1,774 million compared with $669 million a year ago. Non−interest expenses increased 55% from the prior year to $4,026 million. Compensation and benefits expense increased, primarily due to expenses associated with certain deferred compensation plans, higher levels of business investment and higher incentive−based compensation accruals associated with increased net revenues. Non−compensation expenses increased primarily due to increased business activity, including activity from FrontPoint. Assets under management or supervision within Asset Management of $597 billion were up $101 billion, or 20%, from last year, primarily due to market appreciation and positive net customer inflows. Global Market and Economic Conditions in Fiscal 2007. In the U.S., the moderate pace of economic growth that occurred during the first half of fiscal 2007 slowed during the second half of fiscal 2007, primarily reflecting the significant and broad−based illiquidity in the residential real estate and credit markets. Concerns about the impact of subprime loans caused the subprime−related and broader credit markets to deteriorate considerably over the course of the third and fourth quarters of fiscal 2007, with increased volatility, significant spread widening and lower levels of liquidity and price transparency for certain products. The U.S. unemployment rate at the end of fiscal 2007 increased to 4.7% from 4.5% at the end of fiscal 2006. Conditions in the U.S. equity markets were also volatile, and major equity market indices rose during the first half of fiscal 2007 while declining during the second half of fiscal 2007, primarily as a result of mixed corporate earnings and the developments in the credit markets. The Federal Reserve Board (the “Fed”) left rates unchanged during the first half of the year. In the third quarter, the Fed lowered the discount rate by 0.50%, and in the fourth quarter, the Fed lowered both the benchmark interest rate and discount rate by an aggregate of 0.75%. The Fed acted in order to provide additional liquidity and stability to the financial markets and to contain the negative economic impact related to the residential real estate and credit markets. The Fed had not changed the benchmark interest rate since June 2006. In December 2007, the Fed lowered both the benchmark interest rate and the discount rate by 0.25% and the U.S. unemployment rate increased to 5.0%. In January, the Fed lowered both the benchmark interest rate and the discount rate by 0.75%. In Europe, economic growth continued to be strong, reflecting momentum in domestic demand and exports. Corporate business surveys indicated, however, that growth in Europe may be slowing. Major equity market indices in Europe increased during fiscal 2007, primarily due to strong corporate earnings, merger and acquisition activity and generally favorable economic conditions, which more than offset the difficult conditions in the credit markets in the second half of fiscal 2007. The European Central Bank raised the benchmark interest rate by an aggregate of 0.75% in fiscal 2007. The Bank of England raised the benchmark interest rate by an aggregate of 0.75% in fiscal 2007 but subsequently reduced the benchmark interest rate by 0.25% in December 2007. In Japan, moderate economic growth continued to be driven by exports and domestic demand. The level of unemployment also remained relatively low. Japanese equity market indices decreased during fiscal 2007 primarily due to tighter global credit conditions. The Bank of Japan raised the benchmark interest rate from 0.25% to 0.50% during fiscal 2007. Economies elsewhere in Asia expanded, particularly in China, which benefited from strength in exports, domestic demand for capital projects and continued globalization. In China, equity market indices rose during fiscal 2007. The People’s Bank of China raised the benchmark lending rate by an aggregate of 1.17% in fiscal 2007. Business Segments. The remainder of “Results of Operations” is presented on a business segment basis before discontinued operations. Substantially all of the Company’s operating revenues and operating expenses can be directly attributed to its business segments. Certain revenues and expenses have been allocated to each business segment, generally in proportion to its respective revenues or other relevant measures. 36 G-43 Table of Contents As a result of treating certain intersegment transactions as transactions with external parties, the Company includes an Intersegment Eliminations category to reconcile the segment results to the Company’s consolidated results. Income before taxes in Intersegment Eliminations represents the effect of timing differences associated with the revenue and expense recognition of commissions paid by Asset Management to Global Wealth Management Group associated with sales of certain products and the related compensation costs paid to Global Wealth Management Group’s global representatives. Income before income taxes recorded in Intersegment Eliminations was $2 million, $23 million and $86 million in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Included in the results of Intersegment Eliminations for fiscal 2007 is a $25 million advisory fee related to the Discover Spin−off that was eliminated in consolidation. In addition, the results in Institutional Securities for fiscal 2006 included a $30 million advisory fee related to the Company’s sale of the aircraft leasing business that was eliminated in consolidation. 37 G-44 Table of Contents INSTITUTIONAL SECURITIES INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION Revenues: Investment banking Principal transactions: Trading Investments Commissions Asset management, distribution and administration fees Interest and dividends Other Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 (dollars in millions) Fiscal 2005 $ 5,538 $ 4,228 $ 3,394 2,740 1,459 3,262 103 59,131 983 11,326 1,081 2,606 73 42,106 444 6,915 593 2,160 20 25,439 334 73,216 57,067 61,864 40,754 38,855 23,358 16,149 21,110 15,497 15,332 13,389 10,888 7,721 40 2,212 4,609 311 852 $ 5,469 $ 3,446 Total revenues Interest expense Net revenues Total non−interest expenses Income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees, income taxes and cumulative effect of accounting change, net Losses from unconsolidated investees Income tax (benefit) provision Income from continuing operations before cumulative effect of accounting change, net 817 47 (170) $ 940 Investment Banking. Investment banking revenues are derived from the underwriting of securities offerings and fees from advisory services. Investment banking revenues were as follows: Fiscal 2007 Advisory fees from merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions Equity underwriting revenues Fixed income underwriting revenues Total investment banking revenues Fiscal Fiscal 2006 2005 (dollars in millions) $2,541 1,570 1,427 $1,753 1,059 1,416 $1,395 905 1,094 $5,538 $4,228 $3,394 Investment banking revenues increased 31% in fiscal 2007 and reached record levels. The increase was due to higher revenues from merger, acquisition and restructuring activities and equity underwriting transactions. In fiscal 2006, investment banking revenues increased 25%, primarily reflecting higher revenues from merger, acquisition and restructuring activities and fixed income and equity underwriting transactions. In fiscal 2007, advisory fees from merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions increased 45% to a record $2,541 million. Advisory fees in fiscal 2007 reflected a strong volume of transaction activity, particularly during the first half of fiscal 2007. In fiscal 2006, advisory fees from merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions increased 26% to $1,753 million, primarily reflecting a strong volume of transaction activity. Equity underwriting revenues increased 48% to a record $1,570 million in fiscal 2007. Equity underwriting revenues increased 17% to $1,059 million in fiscal 2006. Both periods reflected higher global industry−wide equity and equity−related activity. Fiscal 2006 reflected a strong volume of initial public offerings. 38 G-45 Table of Contents Fixed income underwriting revenues increased 1% to $1,427 in fiscal 2007 and increased 29% to $1,416 million in fiscal 2006. Fiscal 2007 revenues reflected strong revenues from underwriting investment grade corporate products, as corporate issuers sought longer−term financings due to market turmoil in the fixed income credit markets. The increase in fiscal 2006 was primarily due to an increase in underwriting revenues from non−investment grade and investment grade products as the level of issuer refinancings rose due to record levels of maturing debt. Acquisition−related financing resulting from a strong market for merger and acquisition activity contributed to the increase in both fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006. At the end of fiscal 2007, the backlog of merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions and equity underwriting transactions remained relatively strong despite current market conditions. The backlog of fixed income underwriting transactions was lower for non−investment grade products while the backlog of fixed income underwriting transactions was higher for investment−grade products, as compared with the end of fiscal 2006. The backlog of merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions and equity and fixed income underwriting transactions is subject to the risk that transactions may not be completed due to challenging or unforeseen economic and market conditions, adverse developments regarding one of the parties to the transaction, a failure to obtain required regulatory approval or a decision on the part of the parties involved not to pursue a transaction. Sales and Trading Revenues. Sales and trading revenues are composed of principal transaction trading revenues, commissions and net interest revenues (expenses). In assessing the profitability of its sales and trading activities, the Company views principal trading, commissions and net interest revenues in the aggregate. In addition, decisions relating to principal transactions are based on an overall review of aggregate revenues and costs associated with each transaction or series of transactions. This review includes, among other things, an assessment of the potential gain or loss associated with a transaction, including any associated commissions, dividends, the interest income or expense associated with financing or hedging the Company’s positions, and other related expenses. The components of the Company’s sales and trading revenues are described below: Principal Transactions–Trading. Principal transaction trading revenues include revenues from customers’ purchases and sales of financial instruments in which the Company acts as principal and gains and losses on the Company’s positions. The Company also engages in proprietary trading activities for its own account. Commissions. Commission revenues primarily arise from agency transactions in listed and over−the−counter (“OTC”) equity securities and options. Net Interest. Interest and dividend revenues and interest expense are a function of the level and mix of total assets and liabilities, including financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, not yet purchased, reverse repurchase and repurchase agreements, trading strategies, customer activity in the Company’s prime brokerage business, and the prevailing level, term structure and volatility of interest rates. Reverse repurchase and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions may be entered into with different customers using the same underlying securities, thereby generating a spread between the interest revenue on the reverse repurchase agreements or securities borrowed transactions and the interest expense on the repurchase agreements or securities loaned transactions. Total sales and trading revenues decreased 47% in fiscal 2007 and increased 37% in fiscal 2006. The decrease in fiscal 2007 reflected lower fixed income revenues and other sales and trading losses, partially offset by higher equity sales and trading revenues. Sales and trading revenues were adversely affected by the difficult market conditions that existed during the second half of fiscal 2007. The credit markets deteriorated considerably over the course of the latter half of the year with increased volatility, significant spread widening, lower levels of liquidity and reduced price transparency. These factors affected the subprime mortgage markets, including the market for collateralized debt obligations, and other structured credit product markets, leveraged lending 39 G-46 Table of Contents markets and the effectiveness of hedging strategies. This credit environment adversely impacted the Company’s credit sales and trading and corporate lending activities. In addition, such conditions contributed to increased volatility and systematic risk reduction in the equity markets, which adversely affected the Company’s quantitative trading strategies. Sales and trading revenues included the following: Fiscal 2007(1) Equity Fixed income Other Total sales and trading revenues (1) Fiscal Fiscal 2006(1) 2005(1) (dollars in millions) $ 8,658 650 (1,242) $ 6,281 9,291 (288) $ 4,810 6,571 (225) $ 8,066 $15,284 $11,156 Amounts include Principal transactions−trading, Commissions and Net interest revenues. Equity and fixed income sales and trading revenues include certain funding costs that were not previously allocated to those businesses. Other sales and trading net revenues primarily include net losses from loans and closed pipeline commitments related to investment banking, corporate lending and other corporate activities. All prior−year amounts have been reclassified to conform to the current year’s presentation. Equity sales and trading revenues increased 38% to a record $8,658 million in fiscal 2007, benefiting from record international revenues. The increase was driven by record revenues from derivative products and prime brokerage and higher revenues from equity cash and financing products, partially offset by trading losses in quantitative strategies resulting from unfavorable positioning. Revenues from derivative products benefited from strong customer flows. Prime brokerage generated record revenues, reflecting continued growth in global client asset balances. Higher revenues from financing products were primarily due to higher commission revenues driven by strong market volumes. Equity sales and trading revenues also benefited from the widening of the Company’s credit spreads on financial instruments that are accounted for at fair value, including, but not limited to, those for which the fair value option was elected pursuant to the Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities” (“SFAS No. 159”) on December 1, 2006 (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements). Revenues increased by approximately $390 million due to the widening of the Company’s credit spreads during the year resulting from the decrease in the fair value of certain of the Company’s long−term and short−term borrowings, such as structured notes, for which the fair value option was elected. Equity sales and trading revenues increased 31% to a then record $6,281 million in fiscal 2006. The increase was broad based and included higher revenues from derivatives and equity cash products, financing products, prime brokerage and principal trading strategies. Derivative revenues increased due to strong customer flows, although volatility in the global equity markets continued to be generally low. Revenues from equity cash products reflected higher market volumes, particularly in Europe and Asia. Financing product revenues also benefited from increased client activity. Prime brokerage generated record revenues, reflecting continued growth in global client asset balances. Global equity markets generally trended higher and created favorable opportunities for principal trading strategies. Although commission revenues increased, revenues continued to be affected by intense competition, particularly in the U.S., and a continued shift toward electronic trading. Fixed income sales and trading revenues decreased 93% to $650 million in fiscal 2007. Fiscal 2007 results reflected significant losses in credit products and lower results in commodities, partially offset by record results in interest rate and currency products. Credit product revenues decreased $9.4 billion, primarily reflecting mortgage−related writedowns of $7.8 billion, reflecting the deterioration in value of U.S. subprime trading positions, principally super senior derivative positions in CDOs entered into primarily by the Company’s proprietary trading group. Spread widening, lower liquidity and higher volatility resulted in lower origination, securitization and trading results across most credit product groups and also adversely affected the performance 40 G-47 Table of Contents of the Company’s hedging strategies. The Company’s residential and commercial mortgage loan activities contributed to the significant decline in credit product revenues, reflecting the difficult market conditions referred to above, as well as continued concerns in the subprime mortgage loan sector. See “Impact of Credit Market Events” herein, detailing the Company’s direct U.S. subprime mortgage−related exposures at November 30, 2007. Interest rate and currency product revenues increased 63% in fiscal 2007, reflecting higher revenues from interest rate, emerging markets and foreign exchange products. Commodity revenues decreased 33%, primarily due to lower trading results from oil liquids, electricity and natural gas products and lower revenues recognized on structured transactions. Fixed income sales and trading revenues also benefited from the widening of the Company’s credit spreads on financial instruments that are accounted for at fair value, including, but not limited to, those for which the fair value option was elected (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements). The decrease in the fair value of certain of the Company’s long−term and short−term borrowings, such as structured notes, for which the fair value option was elected, which was attributable to the widening of the Company’s credit spreads during the year, increased revenues by approximately $450 million (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements). Fixed income sales and trading revenues also benefited from gains on interest rate derivatives. Fixed income sales and trading revenues increased 41% to a record $9,291 million in fiscal 2006. The increase was driven by record results from commodities, credit products, and interest rate and currency products. Commodities revenues increased 112% due to strong results from electricity, natural gas products and oil liquids. Credit product revenues increased 52%, primarily due to significantly improved corporate credit trading and strength in residential and commercial securitized products. Interest rate and currency products decreased 1%. Both commodity and interest rate and currency products benefited from revenues recognized on structured transactions as a result of increased observability of market value in accordance with Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) Issue No. 02−3, “Issues Involved in Accounting for Derivative Contracts Held for Trading Purposes and Contracts Involved in Energy Trading and Risk Management Activities” (“EITF Issue No. 02−3”). With the adoption of SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements” (“SFAS No. 157”) on December 1, 2006, the Company no longer applies the revenue recognition criteria of EITF Issue No. 02−3 (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements). In addition to the equity and fixed income sales and trading revenues discussed above, sales and trading revenues include the net revenues from the Company’s corporate lending activities. In fiscal 2007, other sales and trading losses of approximately $1.2 billion primarily reflected approximately $700 million of mark−to−market valuations associated with loans and commitments largely related to acquisition financing to non−investment grade companies and the impairment charge related to securities in the Company’s domestic subsidiary banks (see “Impact of Credit Market Events—Subsidiary Banks” herein). The losses included markdowns of leveraged loan commitments associated with acquisition financing transactions that were accepted by the borrower but not yet closed. These losses were primarily related to the illiquid market conditions that existed during third quarter of fiscal 2007. The valuation of these commitments could change in future periods depending on, among other things, the extent that they are renegotiated or repriced or if the associated acquisition transaction does not occur. In addition, the Company’s leveraged finance business originates and distributes loans and commitments and intends to distribute its current positions; however, this could take longer than in the past and is dependent on liquidity re−entering the market. Subsequent to November 30, 2007, there has been further widening in credit spreads for non−investment grade loans that, if sustained, will result in additional writedowns for these loans and commitments. The fair value measurement of loan commitments takes into account certain fee income that is attributable to the contingent commitment contract. For further information about the Company’s corporate lending activities, see Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Credit Risk.” In fiscal 2006, revenues from corporate lending activities decreased by approximately $50 million from fiscal 2005, reflecting the impact of mark−to−market valuations on a higher level of new loans made during the year. Principal Transactions−Investments. The Company’s investments generally are held for appreciation and to facilitate other business activities. It is not possible to determine when the Company will realize the value of such 41 G-48 Table of Contents investments since, among other factors, such investments generally are subject to significant sales restrictions. Moreover, estimates of the fair value of the investments may involve significant judgment and may fluctuate significantly over time in light of business, market, economic and financial conditions generally or in relation to specific transactions. Principal transaction net investment revenues aggregating $1,459 million were recognized in fiscal 2007 as compared with $1,081 million in fiscal 2006 and $593 million in fiscal 2005. The increase in fiscal 2007 was primarily related to realized and unrealized net gains associated with certain of the Company’s investments, including Grifols S.A. and Bovespa Holdings S.A., and higher revenues from the Company’s investments in passive limited partnership interests associated with the Company’s real estate funds. The increase in fiscal 2007 also reflected higher revenues primarily due to the appreciation of investments related to certain employee deferred compensation plans. The increase in fiscal 2006 was primarily related to net gains associated with the Company’s investments. Other. Other revenues consist primarily of revenues from providing benchmark indices and risk management analytics associated with MSCI Inc. (see Note 23 to the consolidated financial statements). Other revenues also include revenues related to the operation of pipelines, terminals and barges and the distribution of refined petroleum products associated with TransMontaigne, the marine transportation and logistics services associated with Heidmar, revenues associated with Saxon, a servicer and originator of residential mortgages (see Note 23 to the consolidated financial statements) and a commodities−related strategic investment. Other revenues increased 121% in fiscal 2007 and 33% in fiscal 2006. The increase in both fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 was primarily attributable to revenues related to the operation of pipelines, terminals and barges and the distribution of refined petroleum products associated with TransMontaigne and higher sales of benchmark indices and risk management analytic products. The increase in fiscal 2007 was also due to higher revenues associated with Saxon and from the sale of a commodities−related strategic investment. Non−Interest Expenses. Non−interest expenses increased 15% in fiscal 2007. Compensation and benefits expense increased 10%, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation accruals for certain businesses. The increase also reflected higher costs associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans, partially offset by Institutional Securities’ share ($190 million) of the incremental compensation expense related to equity awards to retirement−eligible employees in the first quarter of fiscal 2006 (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements). Excluding compensation and benefits expense, non−interest expenses increased 24%, reflecting increased levels of business activity and expenses associated with acquired businesses. Occupancy and equipment expense increased 33%, primarily due to higher rent and occupancy costs in Europe, Asia and the U.S. Brokerage, clearing and exchange fees increased 30%, primarily reflecting substantially increased equity and fixed income trading activity. Marketing and business development expense increased 27%, primarily due to a higher level of business activity. Professional services expense increased 6%, primarily due to higher legal and consulting costs related to increased business activity. Other expenses increased 50%, reflecting costs associated with TransMontaigne, Heidmar and Saxon, partially offset by lower net litigation accruals. Fiscal 2007 results included a reversal of the $360 million legal accrual related to the Company’s favorable outcome from the Coleman litigation. Fiscal 2006 included legal accruals related to the pending settlement of General American litigation, which was partially offset by a favorable outcome related to the LVMH litigation. Non−interest expenses increased 23% in fiscal 2006. Compensation and benefits expense increased 36%, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation costs resulting from higher net revenues. Fiscal 2006 also included Institutional Securities’ share ($190 million) of incremental compensation expense related to equity awards to retirement−eligible employees while fiscal 2005 included Institutional Securities’ share ($193 million) of the costs associated with senior management changes (see “Other Matters—Senior Management Compensation Charges” herein). Excluding compensation and benefits expense, non−interest expenses remained relatively unchanged. Occupancy and equipment expense decreased 6%, primarily due to a $71 million charge that was recorded in the first quarter of fiscal 2005 for the correction in the method of accounting for certain real 42 G-49 Table of Contents estate leases (see Note 26 to the consolidated financial statements). Brokerage, clearing and exchange fees increased 32%, primarily reflecting increased equity and fixed income trading activity. Professional services expense increased 18%, primarily due to higher legal and consulting costs, reflecting increased levels of business activity. Other expenses decreased 48% due to lower charges for legal and regulatory matters. Fiscal 2006 reflected a net reduction in legal accruals of approximately $40 million related to the IPO Allocation Matters litigation, the LVMH litigation and the settlement of the General American litigation. Other expenses in fiscal 2005 included legal accruals of $360 million related to the Coleman litigation and approximately $170 million related to the Parmalat settlement and the IPO Allocation Matters litigation. 43 G-50 Table of Contents GLOBAL WEALTH MANAGEMENT GROUP INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION Fiscal 2007 Revenues: Investment banking Principal transactions: Trading Investments Commissions Asset management, distribution and administration fees Interest and dividends Other Fiscal Fiscal 2006 2005 (dollars in millions) $ 625 $ 428 $ 320 598 29 1,433 3,067 1,221 163 487 57 1,168 2,757 1,004 130 467 2 1,196 2,601 650 143 7,136 511 6,031 519 5,379 332 6,625 5,512 5,047 Total non−interest expenses 5,470 5,004 4,456 Income from continuing operations before income taxes and cumulative effect of accounting change, net Provision for income taxes 1,155 459 508 167 591 199 $ 696 $ 341 $ 392 Total revenues Interest expense Net revenues Income from continuing operations before cumulative effect of accounting change, net Investment Banking. Global Wealth Management Group investment banking includes revenues from the distribution of equity and fixed income securities, including initial public offerings, secondary offerings, closed−end funds and unit trusts. Revenues also include fees earned from offerings underwritten by the Institutional Securities business segment. Investment banking revenues increased 46% and 34% in fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006, respectively. The increase in fiscal 2007 was driven by strong underwriting activity across equity, fixed income and unit trust products. The increase in fiscal 2006 was primarily due to higher revenues from equity−related offerings and unit trust products. Principal Transactions–Trading. Principal transactions include revenues from customers’ purchases and sales of financial instruments in which the Company acts as principal and gains and losses on the Company’s inventory positions held, primarily to facilitate customer transactions. Principal transaction trading revenues increased 23% in fiscal 2007 primarily due to higher revenues from derivative products, municipal and corporate fixed income securities and foreign exchange products. The increase was also due to higher revenues primarily associated with the appreciation of investments related to certain employee deferred compensation plans. In fiscal 2006, principal transaction trading revenues increased 4%, primarily reflecting higher revenue from foreign exchange products, equity linked notes and municipal fixed income securities, partially offset by lower revenues from corporate and government fixed income products and other securities. Principal Transactions–Investments. Principal transaction net investment revenues were $29 million in fiscal 2007 compared with $57 million in fiscal 2006 and $2 million in fiscal 2005. The results in fiscal 2007 reflected lower net gains from certain of the Company’s investments in exchanges and memberships. The results in fiscal 2006 were primarily related to realized and unrealized gains on the Company’s investments in Bolsas y Mercados Españoles and the New York Stock Exchange. Commissions. Commission revenues primarily arise from agency transactions in listed and OTC equity securities and sales of mutual funds, futures, insurance products and options. Commission revenues increased 44 G-51 Table of Contents 23% in fiscal 2007 and decreased 2% in fiscal 2006. The increase in fiscal 2007 reflected higher levels of client activity. The decrease in fiscal 2006 largely reflected lower revenues from equity products, which was related to lower agency activity with customers due, in part, to growth in other product areas, including investment banking and asset management. Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees. Asset management, distribution and administration fees include revenues from individual investors electing a fee−based pricing arrangement and fees for investment management, account services and administration. The Company also receives shareholder servicing fees and fees for services it provides in distributing certain open−ended mutual funds and other products. Mutual fund distribution fees are based on either the average daily fund net asset balances or average daily aggregate net fund sales and are affected by changes in the overall level and mix of assets under management or supervision. Asset management, distribution and administration fees increased 11% in fiscal 2007 and 6% in fiscal 2006. In both fiscal years, the increase was driven by higher client asset balances in fee−based accounts. Client assets in fee−based accounts rose 3% to $201 billion at November 30, 2007 and represented 27% of total client assets versus 29% at November 30, 2006. The decline in fee−based assets as a percent of total client assets largely reflected the termination on October 1, 2007 of the Company’s fee−based (fee in lieu of commission) brokerage program pursuant to a court decision vacating an SEC rule that permitted fee−based brokerage. Client assets that were in the fee−based program primarily moved to commission−based brokerage accounts, or, at the election of some clients, into other fee−based advisory programs, including Morgan Stanley Advisory, a new nondiscretionary account launched in August 2007. Client assets in fee−based accounts rose 18% to $195 billion at November 30, 2006 and increased as a percentage of total client assets to 29% of total client assets from 27% at November 30, 2005. Total client asset balances increased to $758 billion at November 30, 2007 from $676 billion at November 30, 2006 primarily due to higher client inflows and market appreciation. Client asset balances in households greater than $1 million increased to $522 billion at November 30, 2007 from $442 billion at November 30, 2006 and $371 billion at November 30, 2005. Net Interest. Interest and dividend revenues and interest expense are a function of the level and mix of total assets and liabilities, including customer bank deposits and margin loans and securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions. Net interest revenues increased 46% and 53% in fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006, respectively. The increase in both periods was primarily due to increased customer account balances in the bank deposit program that was launched in November 2005. Balances in the bank deposit program rose to $26.2 billion at November 30, 2007 from $13.3 billion at November 30, 2006. Other. Other revenues primarily include customer account service fees and other miscellaneous revenues. Other revenues increased 25% in fiscal 2007 and decreased 9% in fiscal 2006. In fiscal 2007, the increase primarily reflected higher service fees and higher other miscellaneous revenues. In fiscal 2006, the decrease primarily reflected lower service fees. Non−Interest Expenses. Non−interest expenses increased 9% in fiscal 2007, primarily reflecting an increase in compensation and benefits expense, partially offset by lower non−compensation expenses primarily due to lower charges for legal and regulatory matters and continued cost discipline across the business. Compensation and benefits expense increased 15%, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation accruals due to higher net revenues and investments in the business, partially offset by Global Wealth Management Group’s share ($50 million) of the incremental compensation expense related to equity awards to retirement−eligible employees in the first quarter of fiscal 2006 (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements). Excluding compensation and benefits expense, non−interest expenses decreased 2%. Occupancy and equipment expense increased 6% primarily due to leasehold improvements and higher rental costs. Information processing and communications expense decreased 8% primarily due to lower computing costs. Marketing and business development expense increased 39% primarily due to costs associated with the Company’s advertising campaign. Other expenses 45 G-52 Table of Contents decreased 20%, primarily resulting from a reduction in costs associated with legal and regulatory matters, which included an insurance reimbursement related to a litigation matter. Non−interest expenses increased 12% in fiscal 2006. Fiscal 2005 included a reduction in non−interest expenses related to Global Wealth Management Group’s share ($198 million) of the insurance settlement related to the events of September 11, 2001 (see Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements). Compensation and benefits expense increased 15%, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation costs. In addition, fiscal 2006 expenses included Global Wealth Management Group’s share ($50 million) of the incremental compensation expense related to equity awards to retirement−eligible employees, including new hires (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements), while fiscal 2005 included Global Wealth Management Group’s share ($48 million) of the costs associated with senior management changes (see “Other Matters—Senior Management Compensation Charges” herein). Excluding compensation and benefits expense and the insurance settlement, non−interest expenses decreased 4%. Occupancy and equipment expense decreased 6% primarily due to a $29 million charge for the correction in the method of accounting for certain real estate leases that was recorded in the first quarter of fiscal 2005 (see Note 26 to the consolidated financial statements). Professional services expense increased 15%, largely due to higher sub−advisory fees associated with growth in fee−based assets and higher costs for outside legal counsel. Other expenses decreased 20%, primarily resulting from lower costs associated with legal and regulatory matters. During fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, the Company recorded legal and regulatory expenses of approximately $105 million and $170 million, respectively, related to ongoing regulatory, employment and branch litigation matters. 46 G-53 Table of Contents ASSET MANAGEMENT INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 (dollars in millions) Fiscal 2005 $ 264 $ 138 $ 133 (129) 1,774 23 3,524 74 75 — 669 25 2,574 48 26 — 533 29 2,462 87 26 5,605 112 3,480 27 3,270 51 5,493 3,453 3,219 Total non−interest expenses 4,026 2,602 2,189 Income before income taxes and cumulative effect of accounting change, net Provision for income taxes 1,467 541 851 340 1,030 391 $ 926 $ 511 $ 639 Revenues: Investment banking Principal transactions: Trading Investments Commissions Asset management, distribution and administration fees Interest and dividends Other Total revenues Interest expense Net revenues Income before cumulative effect of accounting change, net Investment Banking. Asset Management generates investment banking revenues primarily from the acquisition of investments in real estate funds and the underwriting of unit trust products. Investment banking revenues increased 91% in fiscal 2007 and 4% in fiscal 2006. The increase in fiscal 2007 primarily reflected higher revenues from certain real estate products. The increase in fiscal 2006 primarily reflected higher revenues from real estate products and higher equity unit trust sales, partially offset by a lower volume of fixed income unit trust sales. Principal Transactions−Trading. In fiscal 2007, the Company recognized losses of $129 million related to structured investment vehicles. See “Impact of Credit Market Events—Structured Investment Vehicles” herein for further discussion. Principal Transactions−Investments. Asset Management principal transaction investment revenues consist primarily of gains and losses on the Company’s investments in alternative investment products. Principal transaction net investment gains aggregating $1,774 million were recognized in fiscal 2007 as compared with $669 million in fiscal 2006. The results in both fiscal years were primarily related to investments associated with the Company’s real estate products and private equity portfolio, including employee deferred compensation plans and co−investment plans. Real estate and private equity investments generally are held for appreciation. It is not possible to determine when the Company will realize the value of such investments since, among other factors, such investments generally are subject to significant sales restrictions. Moreover, estimates of the fair value of the investments involve significant judgment and may fluctuate significantly over time in light of business, market, economic and financial conditions generally or in relation to specific transactions. Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees. Asset Management, distribution and administration fees include revenues generated from the management and supervision of assets, performance− 47 G-54 Table of Contents based fees relating to certain funds, and separately managed accounts and fees relating to the distribution of certain open−ended mutual funds. Asset Management fees arise from investment management services the Company provides to investment vehicles pursuant to various contractual arrangements. The Company receives fees primarily based upon mutual fund daily average net assets or based on monthly or quarterly invested equity for other vehicles. Performance−based fees are earned on certain funds as a percentage of appreciation earned by those funds and, in certain cases, are based upon the achievement of performance criteria. These fees are normally earned annually and are recognized on a monthly or quarterly basis. Asset management, distribution and administration fees increased 37% in fiscal 2007 and 5% in fiscal 2006. The increase in fiscal 2007 was primarily due to higher fund management and administration fees resulting from an increase in assets and a more favorable asset mix. The increase was also due to higher performance fees from the alternatives business, including those associated with FrontPoint, which the Company acquired in December 2006 (see Note 23 to the consolidated financial statements). The increase in fiscal 2006 was due to higher fund management and administration fees, partially offset by lower distribution fees. The higher management and administration fees in fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 were associated with increases in average assets under management of 20% and 6%, respectively. Asset Management’s year−end and average assets under management or supervision were as follows: At November 30, Assets under management or supervision by distribution channel: Americas Retail Morgan Stanley brand Americas Retail Van Kampen brand Americas Intermediary(1) U.S. Institutional Non−U.S. Total long−term assets under management or supervision Institutional money markets/liquidity Retail money markets Total money markets Total assets under management or supervision Share of minority interest assets(2) Total Assets under management or supervision by asset class: Equity Fixed income Money market Alternatives(3) Subtotal Unit trusts Total assets under management or supervision Share of minority interest assets(2) Total (1) (2) (3) Average for 2007 Fiscal Fiscal 2006 2005 2007 2006 (dollars in billions) Fiscal 2005 $ 64 99 68 128 132 $ 63 94 58 100 93 $ 63 88 48 96 69 $ 64 99 65 116 111 $ 64 90 51 97 80 $ 64 84 45 97 64 491 408 364 455 382 354 68 31 49 35 33 46 57 33 39 40 33 49 99 84 79 90 79 82 590 7 492 4 443 — 545 6 461 — 436 — $597 $496 $443 $551 $461 $436 $265 102 99 109 $239 94 84 61 $218 91 79 43 $256 97 90 87 $228 91 79 50 $207 96 82 40 575 15 478 14 431 12 530 15 448 13 425 11 590 7 492 4 443 — 545 6 461 — 436 — $597 $496 $443 $551 $461 $436 Americas Intermediary channel primarily represents client flows through defined contribution, insurance and bank trust platforms. Amounts represent Asset Management’s proportional share of assets managed by entities in which it owns a minority interest. The alternatives asset class includes a range of investment products, such as real estate funds, hedge funds, private equity funds, funds of hedge funds and funds of private equity funds. 48 G-55 Table of Contents Activity in Asset Management’s assets under management or supervision during fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 were as follows: Fiscal Fiscal 2007 2006 (dollars in billions) Balance at beginning of period Net flows by distribution channel: Americas Retail Morgan Stanley brand Americas Retail Van Kampen brand Americas Intermediary(1) U.S. Institutional Non−U.S. $ 496 (4) — 4 3 22 (9) (2) 8 (13) 6 25 (10) 15 (5) 13 (12) 10 1 Market appreciation/other 56 58 Total net increase Acquisitions Net increase in share of minority interest assets(2) 91 7 3 49 — 4 $ 597 $ 496 Net inflows/(outflows) excluding money markets Money market net flows: Institutional Retail Total money market net flows Balance at end of period (1) (2) $ 443 Americas Intermediary channel primarily represents client flows through defined contribution, insurance and bank trust platforms. Amount represents Asset Management’s proportional share of assets managed by entities in which it owns a minority interest. Net inflows (excluding money markets) in fiscal 2007 were primarily associated with positive flows from non−U.S. clients. Money market net flows for fiscal 2007 were primarily associated with positive flows into institutional liquidity assets, partially offset by outflows from certain money market funds that were impacted by the growth of Global Wealth Management Group’s bank deposit program. Other. Other revenues increased 188% in fiscal 2007 primarily due to revenues associated with Lansdowne Partners (“Lansdowne”), a London−based investment manager, and Avenue Capital Group (“Avenue”), a New York−based investment manager, which the Company acquired minority stakes in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2006 (see Note 23 to the consolidated financial statements). Other revenues remained flat in fiscal 2006. Non−Interest Expenses. Non−interest expenses increased 55% in fiscal 2007, primarily reflecting an increase in compensation and benefits expense. Compensation and benefits expense increased 81% in fiscal 2007, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation accruals due to higher net revenues. The increase in fiscal 2007 was also due to expenses associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans, partially offset by Asset Management’s share ($20 million) of the incremental compensation expense related to equity awards to retirement−eligible employees that was recorded in the first quarter of fiscal 2006 (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements). Excluding compensation and benefits expense, non−interest expenses increased 24%. Occupancy and equipment expenses increased 29% primarily due to higher rental costs associated with business growth. Brokerage, clearing and exchange fees increased 10% primarily due to increased fee sharing, increased assets under management and higher commission expenses associated with the launching of new products. These increases were offset by a decrease in the deferred commission amortization. Information processing and communications expense increased 21% primarily due to higher licensing fees associated with the acquisition of FrontPoint. Professional services expense increased 47% primarily due to higher sub−advisory fees related to the acquisition of FrontPoint. Other expenses increased 47% primarily due to an insurance reimbursement received in fiscal 2006 related to certain legal matters and an increase in other miscellaneous expenses. 49 G-56 Table of Contents Non−interest expenses increased 19% in fiscal 2006. Fiscal 2005 included a reduction in non−interest expenses from Asset Management’s share ($43 million) of the insurance settlement related to the events of September 11, 2001 (see Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements). Compensation and benefits expense increased 37% in fiscal 2006, primarily reflecting higher incentive−based compensation costs as well as the impact of new hires. In addition, fiscal 2006 included Asset Management’s share ($20 million) of the incremental compensation expense related to equity awards to retirement−eligible employees (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements), while fiscal 2005 included Asset Management’s share ($41 million) of the costs associated with senior management changes (see “Other Matters—Senior Management Compensation Charges” herein). Excluding compensation and benefits expense and the insurance settlement, non−interest expenses were unchanged. Brokerage, clearing and exchange fees decreased 14%, primarily reflecting lower amortization expense associated with certain open−ended funds. The decrease in amortization expense reflected a lower level of deferred costs in recent periods due to a decrease in sales of certain open−ended funds. Marketing and business development expense increased 11% primarily due to higher advertising and marketing costs. 50 G-57 Table of Contents Impact of Credit Market Events. Overview. The Company recorded $9.4 billion in mortgage−related writedowns in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007 resulting from an unfavorable subprime mortgage−related trading strategy and the continued deterioration and lack of market liquidity for subprime and other mortgage−related instruments. Included in the $9.4 billion were writedowns of $7.8 billion related to U.S. subprime trading positions, principally super senior derivative positions in CDOs. These derivative positions were entered into primarily by the Company’s proprietary trading group (see “U.S. ABS CDO Exposures”). As the credit markets in general, and the mortgage markets in particular, declined dramatically in the fourth quarter, increases in the implied cumulative losses in the subprime mortgage market, coupled with the illiquid nature of the Company’s trading positions, led to a significant deterioration in value in its subprime−related trading positions. A summary of the Company’s U.S. subprime trading positions, writedowns and remaining net exposures is further detailed in the table on page 53 and is discussed in “U.S. Subprime Mortgage−Related Exposures” herein. The $9.4 billion of fourth quarter writedowns also included an impairment charge of $437 million related to mortgage−related securities portfolios in the Company’s domestic subsidiary banks (see “Subsidiary Banks” herein) and $1.2 billion related to CMBS, ALT−A (a residential mortgage loan categorization that falls between prime and subprime) and other loans, conduit and non−performing loans and European non−conforming loans. The Company continues to have exposure to these markets and instruments, and, as market conditions continue to evolve, the fair value of these other mortgage−related instruments could further deteriorate. The valuation methodology used for these instruments incorporated a variety of inputs, including prices observed from the execution of a limited number of trades in the marketplace; ABX and similar indices that track the performance of a series of credit default swaps based on subprime mortgages; and other market information, including data on remittances received and updated cumulative loss data on the underlying mortgages. For a further discussion of the Company’s risk management policies and procedures see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7A. For further discussion regarding the Company’s involvement with other U.S. subprime−related activities, see “Special Purpose Entities and Variable Interest Entities” and “Other Exposures to Subprime Lenders.” The results for fiscal 2007 also included losses of approximately $700 million primarily recorded in the third quarter of fiscal 2007 that reflected mark−to−market valuations associated with loans and loan commitments largely related to acquisition financing to non−investment grade companies. The losses included markdowns of leveraged loan commitments associated with acquisition financing transactions that were accepted by the borrower but not yet closed. These losses were primarily related to the illiquid market conditions that existed during the second half of fiscal 2007. The valuation of these commitments could change in future periods depending on, among other things, the extent that they are renegotiated or repriced or the associated acquisition transaction does not occur. In addition, the Company’s leveraged finance business originates and distributes loans and commitments, and intends to distribute its current positions; however, this could take longer than in the past and is dependent on liquidity re−entering the market. Subsequent to November 30, 2007, there has been further widening in credit spreads for non−investment grade loans that, if sustained, will result in additional writedowns for these loans and commitments. For further information about the Company’s corporate lending activities, see Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Credit Risk.” The Company also recognized losses of $129 million in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007 related to structured investment vehicles (see “Structured Investment Vehicles” herein). U.S. Subprime Mortgage−Related Exposures. The Company’s U.S. subprime mortgage−related trading positions consist of those related to U.S. ABS CDOs and other mortgage−related exposures arising from investments in subprime loans, from asset−backed securities 51 G-58 Table of Contents that, in whole or in part, are backed by subprime mortgage loans, and from derivatives referencing subprime mortgages or subprime mortgage−backed securities. Subprime mortgages are loans secured by real property made to a borrower (or borrowers) with a diminished or impaired credit rating or with a limited credit history. A borrower’s credit history is reflected in his credit report and routinely converted into a numerical credit score often referred to as a Fair Isaac Corporation (or “FICO”) score. Generally, a loan made to a borrower with a low FICO score or other credit score has historically been considered as subprime. Loans to borrowers with higher FICO scores may be subprime if the loan exhibits other high−risk factors. Such risk factors may include loans where: (a) the loan has a high loan−to−value ratio or combined loan−to−value ratios; (b) the borrower has reduced or limited income documentation; (c) the borrower has a high debt−to−income ratio; (d) the occupancy type for the loan is other than the borrower’s primary residence. There are many other risk factors, including borrowers who have purchased multiple properties or have taken previous equity withdrawal (cash out) refinancings within the last 12 to 24 month period, non−arm’s length purchase transactions and unsupported or high−risk collateral properties, among others. Subprime mortgage−related securities are those securities that derive a significant portion of their value from subprime loans. U.S. ABS CDO Exposures. The Company purchases interests in and enters into derivatives with ABS CDOs. CDOs provide credit risk exposure to a portfolio of asset−backed securities (“cash CDOs”) or a reference portfolio of securities (“synthetic CDOs”). The underlying or reference portfolios consist primarily of residential mortgage−backed securities. The CDOs to which the Company has exposure are primarily structured and underwritten by third parties, although the Company also structures and underwrites CDOs, for which it receives structuring and/or distribution fees, and does from time to time retain interests in such CDOs. The Company’s primary exposure to ABS CDOs is to synthetic CDOs that hold or are referenced to collateral with ratings of BBB+, BBB or BBB− (“mezzanine CDOs”). The majority of the Company’s writedowns in the fourth quarter related to super senior credit default swaps referencing such mezzanine CDOs that were entered into primarily by the Company’s proprietary trading group. Under these credit default swap arrangements, the Company can be required to make payments in the event that securities in the referenced portfolios default or experience other credit events such as rating agency downgrades. (The characterization of these credit default swaps as “super senior” derives from their seniority in the capital structure of the synthetic CDO.) The Company also has exposure to ABS CDOs via other types of credit default swaps, direct investments in CDO securities, and retained interests in CDOs that the Company has underwritten. In determining the fair value of the Company’s ABS CDO−related instruments the Company took into consideration prices observed from the execution of a limited number of transactions and data for relevant benchmark instruments in synthetic subprime markets. Despite the fact that actual defaults on swap obligations have not yet been realized, the fair value of such positions has experienced significant declines, as a result of a deterioration of value in the benchmark instruments as well as market developments. These losses, as well as the Company’s net CDO exposures, are quantified in the U.S. subprime−related exposures table below. Other U.S. Subprime Mortgage−Related Exposures. The Company also has exposure to the U.S. subprime mortgage market via investments in subprime mortgage loans and ABS that are backed in whole or in part by subprime mortgage loans and via derivatives referencing subprime mortgages or subprime mortgage−backed securities. With respect to whole loans, the Company purchases pools of mortgage loans from third−party originators and also originates mortgage loans through its retail, wholesale and conduit channels and typically disposes of such loans by securitizing them. The Company typically retains certain lower−rated securities of such securitizations, often referred to as residual tranche securities. The Company’s other subprime mortgage−related trading exposures are quantified in the table below. The Company’s interests in U.S. subprime−related exposures are carried at fair value with changes recognized in earnings. 52 G-59 Table of Contents The following table provides a summary of the Company’s direct U.S. subprime trading exposures (excluding amounts related to mortgage−related securities portfolios in the Company’s domestic subsidiary banks (see “Subsidiary Banks” herein)) as of and for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007. The Company utilizes various methods of evaluating risk in its trading and other portfolios, including monitoring Net Exposure. Net Exposure is defined as potential loss to the Company over a period of time in an event of 100% default of the referenced loan, assuming zero recovery. The value of these positions remains subject to mark−to−market volatility. Positive net exposure amounts indicate potential loss (long position) in a default scenario. Negative net exposure amounts indicate potential gain (short position) in a default scenario. Net Exposure does not take into consideration the risk of counterparty default. See “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Credit Risk” in Part II, Item 7A for a further description of how credit risk is monitored. Actual losses could exceed the amount of Net Exposure. Statement of Financial Condition 11/30/07(1) November 30, 2007 Profit and Profit and (Loss) (Loss) Three 12 Months Months Ended Ended (dollars in billions) Net Exposure 11/30/07 Super Senior Derivative Exposure: Mezzanine CDO squared(3) $ (8.7) (0.1) $ (7.1) (0.1) $ (9.3) (0.1) $ 3.9 0.1 Total ABS CDO super senior derivative exposure $ (8.8) $ (7.2) $ (9.4) $ 4.0 Other CDO Exposure: ABS CDO CDS ABS CDO bonds $ 2.7 1.1 $ $ 2.3 (0.8) $ (1.5) 1.1 Total other CDO exposure $ 3.8 Subtotal ABS CDO−related exposure(2) $ (5.0) $ (6.4) $ (7.9) $ 3.6 $ 0.6 — 2.7 7.8 $ (0.1) — (2.9) 1.6 $ (0.2) 0.1 (3.8) 5.0 $ 0.6 — 2.7 (5.1) Subtotal U.S. subprime mortgage−related exposure $ 11.1 $ (1.4) $ 1.1 $ (1.8) Total U.S. subprime trading exposure $ 6.1 $ (7.8) $ (6.8) $ 1.8 U.S. Subprime Mortgage−Related Exposure: Loans Total rate−of−return swaps ABS bonds ABS CDS (1) (2) (3) 1.3 (0.5) 0.8 1.5 (0.4) Statement of financial condition amounts are presented on a net asset/liability basis and do not take into account any netting of cash collateral against these positions. In addition, these amounts reflect counterparty netting to the extent that there are positions with the same counterparty that are subprime−related; they do not reflect any counterparty netting to the extent that there are positions with the same counterparty that are not subprime related. The $6.1 billion is reflected in the Company’s consolidated statement of financial condition as follows: Financial instruments owned of $15.3 billion and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased of $9.2 billion. In determining the fair value of the Company’s ABS super senior CDO−related exposures the Company took into consideration prices observed from the execution of a limited number of transactions and data for relevant benchmark instruments in synthetic subprime markets. Deterioration of value in the benchmark instruments as well as market developments have led to significant declines in the estimates of fair value. These declines reflected increased implied losses across this portfolio. These implied loss levels are consistent with losses in the range between 13% – 20% implied by the ABX indices. These cumulative loss levels, at a severity rate of 50%, imply defaults in the range of 43% – 50% for 2005 and 2006 outstanding mortgages. Refers to CDOs where the collateral is comprised entirely of another CDO security. 53 G-60 Table of Contents Subsidiary Banks. The securities portfolios of Morgan Stanley Bank (Utah) and Morgan Stanley Trust FSB (collectively, the “subsidiary banks”) include certain subprime−related securities. The portfolios contain no subprime whole loans, subprime residuals or CDOs. At November 30, 2007, the securities portfolios totaled $9.9 billion consisting primarily of AAA−rated ABS and residential mortgage−backed securities. Of the total amount, $5.5 billion were subprime mortgage−related securities. The securities in the subsidiary domestic banks’ portfolios were previously classified as securities available for sale in accordance with SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities” (“SFAS No. 115”). In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007, the Company determined that it no longer intends to hold these securities until the fair value of the securities recovers to a level that exceeds their initial cost. Accordingly, the Company recorded an other−than−temporary impairment charge of $437 million in Principal transactions−trading revenues in the consolidated statement of income on its portfolio of securities available for sale in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007 and reclassified the portfolios to Financial instruments owned in the consolidated statement of financial condition effective November 30, 2007. Special Purpose Entities and Variable Interest Entities. The Company’s involvement with special purpose entities (“SPEs”) and variable interest entities (“VIEs”) is discussed in Note 5 to the consolidated financial statements and “Critical Accounting Policies—Special Purpose Entities” herein. In relation to subprime loans and subprime−backed securities, the Company’s involvement with SPEs/VIEs consists primarily of the following: • Engaging in securitization activities related to subprime loans and subprime−backed securities; • Acting as an underwriter of beneficial interests issued by securitization vehicles; • Transferring whole loans into SPEs/VIEs; • Holding one or more classes of securities issued by such securitization vehicles (including residual tranche securities) and possibly entering into derivative agreements with such securitization vehicles; • Purchasing and selling (in both a market−making and a proprietary−trading capacity) subprime−backed securities issued by SPEs/VIEs, whether such vehicles are sponsored by the Company or not; • Entering into derivative transactions with SPEs/VIEs (not sponsored by the Company) that hold subprime−related assets; • Providing warehouse financing to CDOs and collateralized loan obligations (“CLOs”); • Entering into derivative agreements with non−SPE/VIEs, whose value is derived from securities issued by SPEs/VIEs; • Servicing assets held by SPEs/VIEs or holding servicing rights related to assets held by SPEs/VIEs that are serviced by others under subservicing arrangements; • Serving as an asset manager to various investment funds that may invest in securities that are backed, in whole or in part, by subprime loans. Other Exposures to Subprime Lenders. The Company provides warehouse financing to entities collateralized by residential mortgage loans. Under these lines of credit arrangements, the Company requires those entities to provide collateral in excess of the monies advanced. The Company values the collateral on a regular basis to ensure that the value of the collateral exceeds the value of the monies advanced in accordance with the collateral agreements. The Company does not carry amounts lent under such arrangements at fair value but instead carries such amounts at amortized cost. In 54 G-61 Table of Contents addition, the Company does not fair value its commitments under such arrangements. The Company evaluates its exposure and any potential impairment under such arrangements, whether funded or committed, in accordance with SFAS No. 5, “Accounting for Contingencies” (“SFAS No. 5”). In addition, the Company had entered into derivative and lending arrangements with a third−party−sponsored commercial paper conduit that provides warehouse financing to subprime lenders, where such derivative and lending arrangements are linked to the performance of the conduit’s loans to the subprime lenders. At November 30, 2007, exposure related to these arrangements was approximately $300 million. These arrangements were satisfactorily settled and terminated in December 2007. The Company had no further subprime−related commitments to the third−party−sponsored commercial paper conduit as of November 30, 2007. The Company does not sponsor any commercial paper conduits. Structured Investment Vehicles. Structured investment vehicles (“SIVs”) are unconsolidated entities that issue various capital notes and debt instruments to fund the purchase of assets. While the Company does not sponsor or serve as asset manager to any unconsolidated SIVs, the Company does serve as investment advisor to certain unconsolidated money market funds (“the Funds”) that have investments in securities issued by SIVs. In 2007, widespread illiquidity in the commercial paper market led to market value declines and rating agency downgrades of many securities issued by SIVs, some of which were held by the Funds. As a result, the Company purchased approximately $900 million of such securities from the Funds during the year at amortized cost, which resulted in losses to the Company of $129 million. The carrying value of the purchased securities still held by the Company as of November 30, 2007 was $543 million. Such positions are reflected at fair value, and presented in Financial instruments owned—Corporate and other debt in the consolidated statement of financial condition. Subsequent to November 30, 2007, the Company purchased approximately $160 million of additional securities from the Funds and recorded losses of approximately $40 million on these securities. The Company was not obligated to purchase any of these securities and has no obligation to purchase any additional securities from the Funds in the future. The Funds continue to have investment in securities issued by SIVs, with an aggregate face value of $8.2 billion as of November 30, 2007 ($5.4 billion as of January 18, 2008.) These securities have been issued by SIVs that are predominately bank−sponsored, and meet the requirements and investment criteria to continue to be held by the Funds. Monoline Insurers. Monoline insurers (“Monolines”) provide credit enhancement to capital markets transactions. The current credit environment severely affected the capacity of such financial guarantors. The Company’s exposure to Monolines is limited to bonds that are insured by Monolines and as counterparties to derivative contracts. The aggregate direct exposure to Monolines at November 30, 2007 was $3.7 billion primarily including ABS bonds of $1.5 billion in the Subsidiary Banks’ portfolio (see “Subsidiary Banks”) that are collateralized by first and second lien subprime mortgages enhanced by financial guarantees, $1.3 billion in insurance municipal bond securities and $800 million in net counterparty exposure. 55 G-62 Table of Contents Other Matters. The following matters are discussed in the Company’s notes to the consolidated financial statements. For further information on these matters, please see the applicable note: Note Accounting Developments: Limited Partnerships Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments Accounting for Servicing of Financial Assets Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes Fair Value Measurements Employee Benefit Plans Fair Value Option Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Contracts Investment Company Accounting Dividends on Share−Based Payment Awards Business Combinations Noncontrolling Interests Tax Matters Discontinued Operations Business and Other Acquisitions and Dispositions and Sale of Minority Interest Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108 Insurance Settlement Lease Adjustment Stock−Based Compensation. The Company early adopted SFAS No. 123R, “Share−Based Payment” (“SFAS No. 123R”) using the modified prospective approach as of December 1, 2004. For further information on SFAS No. 123R, see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements. Additionally, based on interpretive guidance related to SFAS No. 123R in the first quarter of fiscal 2006, the Company changed its accounting policy for expensing the cost of anticipated fiscal 2006 year−end equity awards that were granted to retirement−eligible employees in the first quarter of fiscal 2007. Effective December 1, 2005, the Company accrues the estimated cost of these awards over the course of the current fiscal year rather than expensing the awards on the date of grant. As a result, fiscal 2006 stock−based compensation expense primarily included the following costs: • amortization of fiscal 2003 year−end awards; • amortization of fiscal 2004 year−end awards; • amortization of fiscal 2005 year−end awards to non−retirement eligible employees; • the full cost of fiscal 2005 year−end awards to retirement eligible employees (made in December 2005); and • the full cost of fiscal 2006 year−end awards to retirement eligible employees (made in December 2006). Fiscal 2007 stock−based compensation expense primarily included the following costs: • amortization of fiscal 2004 year−end awards; • amortization of fiscal 2005 year−end awards to non−retirement eligible employees; • amortization of fiscal 2006 year−end awards to non−retirement eligible employees; and • the full cost of fiscal 2007 year−end awards to retirement eligible employees (made in December 2007). 56 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 20 22 23 24 25 26 G-63 Table of Contents Fiscal 2003 and fiscal 2004 year−end awards are generally amortized over three and four years, while fiscal 2005 and fiscal 2006 year−end awards are generally amortized over two and three years. Senior Management Compensation Charges. Compensation and benefits expense in fiscal 2005 included charges for certain members of senior management related to severance and new hires, which increased non−interest expenses by approximately $282 million. These compensation charges were allocated to the Company’s business segments as follows: Institutional Securities ($193 million), Global Wealth Management Group ($48 million) and Asset Management ($41 million). Coleman Litigation. In May 2003, Coleman (Parent) Holdings Inc. (“CPH”) filed a complaint against Morgan Stanley in the Circuit Court of the Fifteenth Judicial Circuit for Palm Beach County, Florida relating to the 1998 merger between The Coleman Company, Inc. and Sunbeam, Inc. In June 2005, the trial court issued a final judgment in favor of CPH in the amount of $1,578 million, which included prejudgment interest and excluded certain payments received by CPH in settlement of related claims against others. In June 2005, Morgan Stanley filed a notice of appeal with the District Court of Appeal for the Fourth District of Florida (the “Court of Appeal”) and posted a supersedeas bond, which automatically stayed execution of the judgment pending appeal. In March 2007, the Court of Appeal issued an opinion reversing the trial court’s award for compensatory and punitive damages and remanding the matter to the trial court for entry of judgment for Morgan Stanley. In June 2007, the Court of Appeal’s opinion became final when the Court of Appeal issued an order denying CPH’s motions for rehearing, rehearing en banc and for certification of certain questions for review by the Florida Supreme Court (the “Supreme Court”). In June 2007, the trial court issued an order cancelling the supersedeas bond that Morgan Stanley had posted. In July 2007, CPH filed a petition with the Supreme Court asking that court to review the Court of Appeal’s decision (“Petition for Review”). On December 12, 2007, the Supreme Court issued an order denying CPH’s Petition for Review. The Company believes, after consultation with outside counsel, that the Supreme Court’s decision to deny the Petition for Review has effectively ended CPH’s civil claim against the Company. Effective November 30, 2007, the Company reversed the $360 million reserve previously established for the Coleman litigation under SFAS No. 5. Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans. Contributions. The Company made contributions of $131 million and $84 million (excluding $30 million in fiscal 2006 relating to DFS and Quilter) to its U.S. and non−U.S. defined benefit pension plans in fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006, respectively. These contributions were funded with cash from operations. The Company determines the amount of its pension contributions to its funded plans by considering several factors including the level of plan assets relative to plan liabilities, expected plan liquidity needs and expected future contribution requirements. The Company’s policy is to fund at least the amounts sufficient to meet minimum funding requirements under applicable employee benefit and tax regulations (for example in the U.S., the minimum required contribution under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, or “ERISA”). At November 30, 2007, there were no minimum required ERISA contributions for the Company’s U.S. pension plan that is qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code (the “U.S. Qualified Plan”). Liabilities for benefits payable under certain postretirement and unfunded supplementary plans are accrued by the Company and are funded when paid to the beneficiaries. Expense. In accordance with U.S. GAAP, the Company recognizes the compensation cost of an employee’s pension benefits (including prior−service cost) over the employee’s estimated service period. This process involves making certain estimates and assumptions, including the discount rate and the expected long−term rate of return on plan assets. 57 G-64 Table of Contents The assumed discount rate, which is intended to reflect the rates at which pension benefits could be effectively settled, is used to measure the projected and accumulated benefit obligations and to calculate the service cost and interest cost. For fiscal 2007, the assumed discount rate for all U.S. plans was selected by the Company, in consultation with its independent actuaries, using a pension discount yield curve based on the characteristics of the U.S. Qualified Plan liabilities. The pension discount yield curve represents spot discount yields based on duration implicit in a representative broad based Aa corporate bond universe of high−quality fixed income investments. It includes only bonds of reasonable issue size and excludes certain types of bonds, such as callable bonds. As of November 30, 2007, the Company’s U.S. Qualified Plan represented 82% of the total liabilities of its U.S. pension and postretirement plans combined. The assumed discount rate for the defined benefit portion of its U.K. pension plan was selected by the Company using a pension discount yield curve based on the characteristics of the U.K. defined benefit pension liabilities. As of November 30, 2007, the defined benefit portion of the Company’s U.K. pension plan represented 59% of the total liabilities of its non−U.S. pension plans combined. For all other non−U.S. pension plans, the Company set the assumed discount rates based on the nature of liabilities, local economic environments and available bond indices. The expected long−term rate of return on assets represents the Company’s best estimate of the long−term return on plan assets and generally was estimated by adjusting the previous year’s rate by the difference in the weighted average return of the underlying long−term expected returns on the different asset classes, based on the target asset allocations, taking into consideration estimated expenses and the benefits of diversification and rebalancing the portfolio. This rate is expected to remain the same from one year to the next unless there is a significant change in the target asset allocation, the fees and expenses paid by the plan or market conditions. As of November 30, 2007, the Company’s U.S. Qualified Plan represented 90% of the total assets of its U.S. and non−U.S. pension plans combined. The Company, in consultation with its independent investment consultants and actuaries, determined the expected long−term rate of return on its U.S. Qualified Plan assets would remain at 6.75% for fiscal 2007 (see Note 19 to the consolidated financial statements). There was no significant change in the fees paid by the plan or the underlying market outlook since September 2006. To better align the duration of plan assets with the duration of plan liabilities, in May 2007, the U.S. Qualified Plan’s target asset allocation policy was changed from 45%/55% equity/fixed income to 30%/70% equity/fixed income. The effects of this change will be reflected in fiscal 2008, and the impact is not expected to be material to the Company’s consolidated results of operations. The preliminary expected long−term rate of return on U.S. Qualified Plan assets is 6.50% for fiscal 2008. The Company’s expected long−term rate of return on assets for its U.S. Qualified Plan was based on the following target asset allocation: Target Investment Mix Expected Annual Return(1) Domestic equity: Large capitalization Small capitalization 12% 3% 8.1% 8.4% International equity 15% 8.4% Fixed income: Long−term government/corporate 70% 5.4% (1) These returns do not include the impact of diversification on the overall expected portfolio return. Each year, the Company compares its initial estimate of the expected long−term rate of return on assets for the U.S. Qualified Plan (and adjusts, if necessary) with a portfolio return calculator model (the “Portfolio Model”) that produces a range of expected returns for the portfolio. Return assumptions used are forward−looking gross returns that are not developed solely by an examination of historical returns. The Portfolio Model begins with the current U.S. Treasury yield curve, recognizing that expected returns on bonds are heavily influenced by the current level of yields. Corporate bond spreads and equity risk premiums, based on current market conditions, are 58 G-65 Table of Contents then added to develop the return expectations for each asset class. The resulting expected portfolio investment is then adjusted downward to reflect an assumed load for expenses, which include investment and transaction fees that typically are paid from plan assets, added to the cost basis or subtracted from sale proceeds, as well as administrative expenses paid from plan assets. The Company uses the expected long−term rate of return on plan assets to compute the expected return on assets component of pension expense. For the U.S. Qualified Plan, expected returns are computed based on a market−related value of assets. The market−related value of assets is a smoothed actuarial value of assets equal to a moving average of market values in which investment income is recognized over a five−year period. The market−related value of assets must be no greater than 120% and no less than 80% of the market value of assets. Investment income equal to the expected return on the plan’s assets as calculated for the prior year’s expense is recognized immediately. Any difference between the actual investment income (on a market−value basis) and the expected return is recognized over a five−year period in accordance with SFAS No. 87, “Employers’ Accounting for Pensions” (“SFAS No. 87”). Other assumptions, including mortality rates, long−term salary growth and employee turnover rates, are set by the Company in consultation with its independent actuaries. These assumptions are tested every year by monitoring gains and losses, performing assumption studies as needed, and monitoring Company objectives and actuarial trends. These assumptions are adjusted whenever necessary. The Company amortizes (as a component of pension expense) unrecognized net gains and losses over the average future service of active participants (5 to 20 years depending upon the plan) to the extent that the gain/loss exceeds 10% of the greater of the projected benefit obligation or the market−related value of plan assets. The loss amortization component for the U.S. and the non−U.S. pension plans was $41 million for fiscal 2007 (28% of pension expense) and $51 million for fiscal 2006 (32% of pension expense). Impact of SFAS No. 158. In September 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued SFAS No. 158, “Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R)” (“SFAS No. 158”). Among other items, SFAS No. 158 required recognition of the overfunded or underfunded status of the Company’s defined benefit and postretirement plans as an asset or liability in the consolidated financial statements for the fiscal year ending November 30, 2007. The Company recorded an after−tax charge of $208 million ($347 million pre−tax) to Shareholders’ equity upon the adoption of this requirement. SFAS No. 158 also requires the measurement of defined benefit and postretirement plan assets and obligations as of the end of the fiscal year. SFAS No. 158’s requirement to use the fiscal year−end date as the measurement date is effective for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2008. The Company expects to early adopt a fiscal year−end measurement date for its fiscal year ending November 30, 2008 and currently expects to record an after−tax charge of approximately $15 million to Shareholders’ equity upon adoption. 59 G-66 Table of Contents Critical Accounting Policies. The Company’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP, which requires the Company to make estimates and assumptions (see Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements). The Company believes that of its accounting policies (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements), the following may involve a higher degree of judgment and complexity. Fair Value. Financial Instruments Measured at Fair Value. A significant number of the Company’s financial instruments are carried at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings each period. The Company makes estimates regarding valuation of assets and liabilities measured at fair value in preparing the consolidated financial statements. These assets and liabilities include: • Financial instruments owned and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased; • Securities received as collateral and Obligation to return securities received as collateral; • Certain Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings, primarily structured notes; • Certain Deposits; • Other secured financings; and • Certain Long−term borrowings, primarily structured debt. Fair Value Measurement—Definition and Hierarchy. The Company adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 157, effective December 1, 2006. SFAS No. 157 defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (i.e., the “exit price”) in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. In determining fair value, the Company uses various valuation approaches, including market, income and/or cost approaches. SFAS No. 157 establishes a hierarchy for inputs used in measuring fair value that maximizes the use of observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs by requiring that the observable inputs be used when available. Observable inputs are inputs that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from sources independent of the Company. Unobservable inputs are inputs that reflect the Company’s assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels based on the reliability of inputs as follows: • Level 1—Valuations based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the Company has the ability to access. Valuation adjustments and block discounts are not applied to Level 1 instruments. Since valuations are based on quoted prices that are readily and regularly available in an active market, valuation of these products does not entail a significant degree of judgment. Assets and liabilities utilizing Level 1 inputs include exchange−traded equity securities and listed derivatives that are actively traded, most U.S. Government securities and certain other sovereign government obligations. • Level 2—Valuations based on quoted prices in markets that are not active or for which all significant inputs are observable, directly or indirectly. Assets and liabilities utilizing Level 2 inputs include: exchange−traded equity securities and listed derivatives that are not actively traded; most OTC derivatives; restricted stock; corporate and municipal bonds; certain corporate loans and loan commitments; certain high−yield debt; certain residential and commercial mortgage loans; certain mortgage−backed securities (“MBS”), asset−backed securities (“ABS”), and CDO securities; retained interests in certain securitization transactions; structured notes; physical commodities; and mortgage servicing rights. 60 G-67 Table of Contents • Level 3—Valuations based on inputs that are unobservable and significant to the overall fair value measurement. Assets and liabilities utilizing Level 3 inputs include: certain corporate loans and loan commitments; certain commercial whole loans; certain mortgage loans; certain high−yield debt; distressed debt (i.e., securities of issuers encountering financial difficulties, including bankruptcy or insolvency); certain MBS, ABS and CDO securities; retained interests in certain securitization transactions; investments in real estate funds; private equity investments; and complex over−the−counter derivatives (including certain foreign currency options; long−dated commodity options and swaps; certain mortgage−related credit default swaps; derivative interests in mortgage−related CDOs; and basket credit default swaps). The availability of observable inputs can vary from product to product and is affected by a wide variety of factors, including, for example, the type of product, whether the product is new and not yet established in the marketplace, and other characteristics particular to the transaction. To the extent that valuation is based on models or inputs that are less observable or unobservable in the market, the determination of fair value requires more judgment. Accordingly, the degree of judgment exercised by the Company in determining fair value is greatest for instruments categorized in Level 3. In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, for disclosure purposes the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls is determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. Fair value is a market−based measure considered from the perspective of a market participant who holds the asset or owes the liability rather than an entity−specific measure. Therefore, even when market assumptions are not readily available, the Company’s own assumptions are set to reflect those that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability at the measurement date. The Company uses prices and inputs that are current as of the measurement date, including during periods of market dislocation. In periods of market dislocation, the observability of prices and inputs may be reduced for many instruments. This condition could cause an instrument to be reclassified from Level 1 to Level 2 or Level 2 to Level 3. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about the Company’s financial assets and liabilities that are accounted for at fair value. Valuation Techniques. Many cash and OTC contracts have bid and ask prices that can be observed in the marketplace. Bid prices reflect the highest price that the Company and others are willing to pay for an asset. Ask prices represent the lowest price that the Company and others are willing to accept for an asset. For financial instruments whose inputs are based on bid−ask prices, the Company does not require that fair value always be a predetermined point in the bid−ask range. The Company’s policy is to allow for mid−market pricing and adjusting to the point within the bid−ask range that meets the Company’s best estimate of fair value. For offsetting positions in the same financial instrument, the same price within the bid−ask spread is used to measure both the long and short positions. Fair value for many cash and OTC contracts is derived using pricing models. Pricing models take into account the contract terms (including maturity) as well as multiple inputs, including, where applicable, commodity prices, equity prices, interest rate yield curves, credit curves, creditworthiness of the counterparty, option volatility and currency rates. In accordance with SFAS No. 157, the impact of the Company’s own credit spreads are also considered when measuring the fair value of liabilities, including OTC derivative contracts. Where appropriate, valuation adjustments are made to account for various factors, including bid−ask spreads, credit quality and market liquidity. These adjustments are applied on a consistent basis and are based upon observable inputs where available. OTC Derivative Contracts. OTC derivative contracts include forward, swap and option contracts related to interest rates, foreign currencies, credit standing of reference entities, equity prices or commodity prices. Depending on the product and the terms of the transaction, the fair value of OTC derivative products can be modeled using a series of techniques, including closed−form analytic formulae, such as the Black−Scholes option− 61 G-68 Table of Contents pricing model, and simulation models or a combination thereof. Many pricing models do not entail material subjectivity because the methodologies employed do not necessitate significant judgment, and the pricing inputs are observed from actively quoted markets, as is the case for generic interest rate swap and option contracts. In the case of more established derivative products, the pricing models used by the Company are widely accepted by the financial services industry. A substantial majority of OTC derivative products valued by the Company using pricing models fall into this category and are categorized within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Other derivative products, typically the newest and most complex products, will require more judgment in the implementation of the valuation technique applied due to the complexity of the valuation assumptions and the reduced observability of inputs. This includes certain credit default swaps where direct trading activity or quotes are unobservable. Derivative interests in mortgage−related CDOs, for which observability of external price data is extremely limited, are valued based on an evaluation of the market for similar positions as indicated by secondary and primary market activity in the cash CDO and synthetic CDO market. Each position is evaluated independently taking into consideration the underlying collateral performance and pricing, behavior of the tranche under various cumulative loss and prepayment scenarios, deal structures (e.g., non−amortizing reference obligations, call features) and liquidity. While these factors may be supported by historical and actual external observations, the determination of their value as it relates to specific positions nevertheless requires significant judgment. Mortgage−related credit default swaps are valued based on data from comparable credit instruments in the cash market and trades in comparable swaps as benchmarks, as prices and spreads for the specific credits subject to valuation tend to be of limited observability. For basket credit default swaps and CDO−squared positions, the correlation between reference credits is often a significant input into the pricing model, in addition to several other more observable inputs such as credit spread, interest and recovery rates. As the correlation input is unobservable for each specific swap, it is benchmarked to standardized proxy baskets for which external data are available. These instruments involve significant unobservable inputs and are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company trades various derivative structures with commodity underlyings. Depending on the type of structure, the model inputs generally include interest rate yield curves, commodity underlier spread curves, volatility of the underlying commodities and, in some cases, the correlation between these inputs. The fair value of these products is estimated using executed trades and broker and consensus data to provide values for the aforementioned inputs. Where these inputs are unobservable, relationships to observable commodities and data points, based on historic and/or implied observations, are employed as a technique to estimate the model input values. Commodity derivatives are generally categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy; in instances where significant inputs are unobservable, they are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Prior to the adoption of SFAS No. 157, the Company followed the provisions of EITF Issue No. 02−3. Under EITF Issue No. 02−3, recognition of day one profit at inception of an OTC derivative contract was prohibited unless the fair value of the contact was based on a valuation technique incorporating observable market data. With the adoption of SFAS No. 157, the Company is no longer applying the revenue recognition criteria of EITF Issue No. 02−3. Other Sovereign Government Obligations. The fair value of foreign sovereign government obligations is generally based on quoted prices in active markets. When quoted prices are not available, fair value is determined based on a valuation model that has as inputs interest rate yield curves, cross−currency basis index spreads, and country credit spreads for structures similar to the bond in terms of issuer, maturity and seniority. These bonds are generally categorized in Levels 1 or 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Municipal Bonds. The fair value of municipal bonds is estimated using recently executed transactions, market price quotations and pricing models that factor in, where applicable, interest rates, bond or credit default swap spreads and volatility. These bonds are generally categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Corporate Bonds. The fair value of corporate bonds is estimated using recently executed transactions, market price quotations (where observable), bond spreads or credit default swap spreads. The spread data used are for 62 G-69 Table of Contents the same maturity as the bond. If the spread data do not reference the issuer, then data that reference a comparable issuer is used. When observable price quotations are not available, fair value is determined based on cash flow models with yield curves, bond or single name credit default swap spreads and recovery rates based on collateral values as key inputs. Corporate bonds are generally categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy; in instances where significant inputs are unobservable, they are categorized in Level 3 of the hierarchy. Corporate Loans and Loan Commitments. The fair value of corporate loans is estimated using recently executed transactions, market price quotations (where observable) and market observable credit default swap levels along with proprietary valuation models and default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable. The fair value of contingent corporate loan commitments is estimated by using executed transactions on comparable loans and the anticipated market price based on pricing indications from syndicate banks and customers. The valuation of these commitments also takes into account certain fee income. While certain corporate loans, closed loan commitments and revolving loans are Level 2 instruments, certain other corporate loans and contingent corporate loan commitments are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Mortgage Loans. The valuation of mortgage loans depends upon the exit market for the loan. Loans not intended for securitization are valued based on the analysis of the underlying collateral performance, capital structure and market spreads for comparable positions as prices and/or spreads for specific credits tend to be unobservable. Where comparables do not exist, such loans are valued based on origination price and collateral performance (credit events) since origination. These loans are classified in Levels 2 or 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company also holds certain loan products and mortgage products with the intent to securitize them. When structuring of the related securitization is substantially complete, such that the value likely to be realized in a current transaction is consistent with the price that a securitization entity will pay to acquire these products, the Company marks them to the expected securitized value. Factors affecting the value of loan and mortgage products intended to be securitized include, but are not limited to, loan type, underlying property type and geographic location, loan interest rate, loan to value ratios, debt service coverage ratio, updated cumulative loan loss data, prepayment rates, yields, investor demand, any significant market volatility since the last securitization, and credit enhancement. While these valuation factors may be supported by historical and actual external observations, the determination of their value as it relates to specific positions may require significant judgment. These instruments are classified in Levels 2 or 3 of the fair value hierarchy. U.S. Agency Securities. U.S. agency securities include To−be−announced (“TBA”) securities and mortgage pass−through certificates. TBA securities are liquid and have quoted market prices. Fair value of mortgage pass−through certificates is determined via a simulation model, which considers different rate scenarios and historical activity to calculate a spread to the comparable TBA security. U.S. agency securities are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Commercial Mortgage−Backed Securities and Asset−Backed Securities (“ABS”). CMBS and ABS may be valued based on external price/spread data. When position−specific external price data are not observable, the valuation is based on prices of comparable bonds. Included in this category are certain interest−only securities, which, in the absence of market prices, are valued as a function of observable whole bond prices and cash flow values of principal−only bonds using current market assumptions at the measurement date. CMBS and ABS are categorized in Level 3 if external prices are unobservable; otherwise they are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Retained Interests in Securitization Transactions. The Company engages in securitization activities related to various types of loans and bonds. The Company may retain interests in securitized financial assets as one or more tranches of the securitization. To determine fair values, observable inputs are used if available. Observable inputs, however, may not be available for certain retained interests so the Company estimates fair value based on the present value of expected future cash flows using its best estimates of the key assumptions, including forecasted credit losses, prepayment rates, forward yield curves and discount rates commensurate with the risks 63 G-70 Table of Contents involved. When there are no significant unobservable inputs, retained interests are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. When unobservable inputs are significant to the fair value measurement, albeit generally supportable by historical and actual benchmark data, retained interests are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Investments in Private Equity and Real Estate. The Company’s investments in private equity and real estate take the form of direct private equity investments and investment in private equity and real estate funds. The transaction price is used as the best estimate of fair value at inception. When evidence supports a change to the carrying value from the transaction price, adjustments are made to reflect expected exit values. Ongoing reviews by Company management are based on an assessment of each underlying investment, incorporating valuations that consider the evaluation of financing and sale transactions with third parties, expected cash flows and market−based information, including comparable company transactions, performance multiples and changes in market outlook, among other factors. These nonpublic investments are included in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy because they trade infrequently, and, therefore, the fair value is unobservable. Physical Commodities. The Company trades various physical commodities, including crude oil and refined products, metals and agricultural products. Fair value for physical commodities is determined using observable inputs, including broker quotations and published indices. Physical commodities are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Deposits. The fair value of certificates of deposit is estimated using third−party quotations. These deposits are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Structured Notes. The Company issues structured notes that have coupons or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities. Fair value of structured notes is estimated using valuation models described in this section for the derivative and debt features of the notes. These models incorporate observable inputs, including prices that the notes are linked to, interest rate yield curves, option volatility and currency rates. The impact of the Company’s own credit spreads also is included based on the Company’s observed secondary bond market spreads. Most structured notes are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Reclasses from Level 2 to Level 3. During the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007, the Company reclassified approximately $7.0 billion of funded assets and $279 million of net derivative contracts from Level 2 to Level 3 because certain significant inputs for the fair value measurement became unobservable. These reclasses were primarily related to the continued market and liquidity deterioration in the mortgage markets. The most material transfers to Level 3 were in commercial whole loans, residuals from residential securitizations, interest−only commercial mortgage and agency bonds as well as commercial and residential credit default swaps. Fair Value Control Processes. The Company employs control processes to validate the fair value of its financial instruments, including those derived from pricing models. These control processes are designed to assure that the values used for financial reporting are based on observable inputs wherever possible. In the event that observable inputs are not available, the control processes are designed to assure that the valuation approach utilized is appropriate and consistently applied and that the assumptions are reasonable. These control processes include reviews of the pricing model’s theoretical soundness and appropriateness by Company personnel with relevant expertise who are independent from the trading desks. Additionally, groups independent from the trading divisions within the Financial Control, Market Risk and Credit Risk Departments participate in the review and validation of the fair values generated from pricing models, as appropriate. Where a pricing model is used to determine fair value, recently executed comparable transactions and other observable market data are considered for purposes of validating assumptions underlying the model. Consistent with market practice, the Company has individually negotiated agreements with certain counterparties to exchange collateral (“margining”) based on the level of fair values of the derivative contracts they have executed. Through this margining process, one party or both parties to a derivative contract provides the other party with information about the fair value of the derivative contract to calculate the amount of collateral required. This sharing of fair value information provides additional support of the Company’s recorded fair value 64 G-71 Table of Contents for the relevant OTC derivative products. For certain OTC derivative products, the Company, along with other market participants, contributes derivative pricing information to aggregation services that synthesize the data and make it accessible to subscribers. This information is then used to evaluate the fair value of these OTC derivative products. Legal, Regulatory and Tax Contingencies. In the normal course of business, the Company has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the issuers that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or in financial distress. The Company is also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental and self−regulatory agencies regarding the Company’s business, including, among other matters, accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief. Reserves for litigation and regulatory proceedings are generally determined on a case−by−case basis and represent an estimate of probable losses after considering, among other factors, the progress of each case, prior experience and the experience of others in similar cases, and the opinions and views of internal and external legal counsel. Given the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of such matters, particularly in cases where claimants seek substantial or indeterminate damages or where investigations and proceedings are in the early stages, the Company cannot predict with certainty the loss or range of loss, if any, related to such matters, how such matters will be resolved, when they will ultimately be resolved or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, might be. The Company is subject to the income and indirect tax laws of the U.S., its states and municipalities and those of the foreign jurisdictions in which the Company has significant business operations. These tax laws are complex and subject to different interpretations by the taxpayer and the relevant governmental taxing authorities. The Company must make judgments and interpretations about the application of these inherently complex tax laws when determining the provision for income taxes and the expense for indirect taxes and must also make estimates about when in the future certain items affect taxable income in the various tax jurisdictions. Disputes over interpretations of the tax laws may be settled with the taxing authority upon examination or audit. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood of assessments in each of the taxing jurisdictions resulting from current and subsequent years’ examinations, and tax reserves are established as appropriate. The Company establishes reserves for potential losses that may arise out of litigation, regulatory proceedings and tax audits to the extent that such losses are probable and can be estimated in accordance with SFAS No. 5. Once established, reserves are adjusted when there is more information available or when an event occurs requiring a change. Significant judgment is required in making these estimates, and the actual cost of a legal claim, tax assessment or regulatory fine/penalty may ultimately be materially different from the recorded reserves, if any. See Notes 2, 15 and 20 to the consolidated financial statements for additional information on legal proceedings and tax examinations. Special Purpose Entities. The Company enters into a variety of transactions with special purpose entities, primarily in connection with securitization activities. The Company engages in securitization activities related to commercial and residential mortgage loans, U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations, corporate bonds and loans, municipal bonds 65 G-72 Table of Contents and other types of financial instruments. In most cases, these SPEs are deemed to be variable interest entities. Unless a VIE is determined to be a qualifying special purpose entity (“QSPE”), the Company is required under accounting guidance to perform an analysis of each VIE at the date upon which the Company becomes involved with it to determine whether the Company is the primary beneficiary of the VIE, in which case the Company must consolidate the VIE. QSPEs are not consolidated. In accordance with accounting guidance, the Company reassesses whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE upon the occurrence of certain reconsideration events. If the Company’s initial assessment results in a determination that it is not the primary beneficiary of a VIE, then the Company reassesses this determination upon the occurrence of: • Changes to the VIE’s governing documents or contractual arrangements in a manner that reallocates the obligation to absorb the expected losses or the right to receive the expected residual returns of the VIE between the current primary beneficiary and the other variable interest holders, including the Company. • Acquisition by the Company of additional variable interests in the VIE. If the Company’s initial assessment results in a determination that it is the primary beneficiary, then the Company reassesses this determination upon the occurrence of: • Changes to the VIE’s governing documents or contractual arrangements in a manner that reallocates the obligation to absorb the expected losses or the right to receive the expected residual returns of the VIE between the current primary beneficiary and the other variable interest holders, including the Company. • A sale or disposition by the Company of all or part of its variable interests in the VIE to unrelated parties. • The issuance of new variable interests by the VIE to parties unrelated to the Company. The determination of whether an SPE meets the accounting requirements of a QSPE requires significant judgment, particularly in evaluating whether the permitted activities of the SPE are significantly limited and in determining whether derivatives held by the SPE are passive and nonexcessive. In addition, the analysis involved in determining whether an entity is a VIE, and in determining the primary beneficiary of a VIE, requires significant judgment (see Note 5 to the consolidated financial statements). Certain Factors Affecting Results of Operations. The Company’s results of operations may be materially affected by market fluctuations and by economic factors. In addition, results of operations in the past have been, and in the future may continue to be, materially affected by many factors of a global nature, including political, economic and market conditions; the availability and cost of capital; the level and volatility of equity prices, commodity prices and interest rates; currency values and other market indices; technological changes and events; the availability and cost of credit; inflation; and investor sentiment and confidence in the financial markets. In addition, there continues to be a heightened level of legislative, legal and regulatory developments related to the financial services industry that potentially could increase costs, thereby affecting future results of operations. Such factors also may have an impact on the Company’s ability to achieve its strategic objectives on a global basis. For a further discussion of these and other important factors that could affect the Company’s business, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A. 66 G-73 Table of Contents Liquidity and Capital Resources. The Company’s senior management establishes the overall liquidity and capital policies of the Company. Through various risk and control committees, the Company’s senior management reviews business performance relative to these policies, monitors the availability of alternative sources of financing, and oversees the liquidity and interest rate and currency sensitivity of the Company’s asset and liability position. These committees, along with the Company’s Treasury Department and other control groups, also assist in evaluating, monitoring and controlling the impact that the Company’s business activities have on its consolidated balance sheet, liquidity and capital structure, thereby helping to ensure that its business activities are integrated with the Company’s liquidity and capital policies. For a description of the Company’s other principal risks and how they are monitored and managed, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7A. The Company’s liquidity and funding risk management policies are designed to mitigate the potential risk that the Company may be unable to access adequate financing to service its financial obligations when they come due without material, adverse franchise or business impact. The key objectives of the liquidity and funding risk management framework are to support the successful execution of the Company’s business strategies while ensuring ongoing and sufficient liquidity through the business cycle and during periods of financial distress. The principal elements of the Company’s liquidity management framework are the Contingency Funding Plan, the Liquidity Reserve and the Cash Capital Policy. Comprehensive financing guidelines (collateralized funding, long−term funding strategy, surplus capacity, diversification, staggered maturities and committed credit facilities) support the Company’s target liquidity profile. The Balance Sheet. The Company monitors and evaluates the composition and size of its balance sheet. Given the nature of the Company’s market−making and customer financing activities, the size of the balance sheet fluctuates from time to time. A substantial portion of the Company’s total assets consists of highly liquid marketable securities and short−term receivables arising principally from its Institutional Securities sales and trading activities. The highly liquid nature of these assets provides the Company with flexibility in financing and managing its business. The Company’s total assets decreased to $1,045,409 million at November 30, 2007 from $1,121,192 million at November 30, 2006. The decrease was primarily due to decreases in securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell and the completion of the Discover Spin−off (see Note 22 to the consolidated financial statements), partially offset by an increase in cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations and securities received as collateral. Within the sales and trading related assets and liabilities, there are transactions attributable to securities financing activities. Securities financing assets and liabilities as of November 30, 2007 were $587 billion and $559 billion, respectively. Securities financing transactions include repurchase and resale agreements, securities borrowed and loaned transactions, securities received as collateral and obligation to return securities received, customer receivables/payables and related segregated customer cash. Securities financing assets and liabilities include matched book transactions with minimal market, credit and/or liquidity risk. These matched book transactions are to accommodate customers, as well as to obtain securities for the settlement and finance of inventory positions. The customer receivable/payable portion of the securities financing transactions includes customer margin loans, collateralized by customer owned securities, and customer cash, which is segregated in order to satisfy regulatory requirements. The Company’s exposure on these transactions is limited by collateral maintenance policies, which in turn limits the Company’s credit exposure to customers. Included within securities financing assets was $82 billion that, in accordance with SFAS No. 140, “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities (“SFAS No. 140”) represented equal and offsetting assets and liabilities for fully collateralized non−cash loan transactions. Balance sheet leverage ratios are one indicator of capital adequacy when viewed in the context of a company’s overall liquidity and capital policies. The Company views the adjusted leverage ratio as a more relevant measure 67 G-74 Table of Contents of financial risk when comparing financial services firms and evaluating leverage trends. The Company has adopted a definition of adjusted assets that excludes certain self−funded assets considered to have minimal market, credit and/or liquidity risk. These low−risk assets generally are attributable to the Company’s matched book and securities lending businesses. Adjusted assets are calculated by reducing gross assets by aggregate resale agreements and securities borrowed less non−derivative short positions and assets recorded under certain provisions of SFAS No. 140 and FASB Interpretation No. 46 (revised December 2003) “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities (“FIN 46R”). Gross assets are also reduced by the full amount of cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements. The adjusted leverage ratio reflects the deduction from shareholders’ equity of the amount of equity used to support goodwill and intangible assets (as the Company does not view this amount of equity as available to support its risk capital needs). In addition, the Company views junior subordinated debt issued to capital trusts as a component of its capital base given the inherent characteristics of the securities. These characteristics include the long−dated nature (e.g., some have final maturity at issuance of 30 years extendible at the Company’s option by a further 19 years; others have a 60−year final maturity at issuance), the Company’s ability to defer coupon interest for up to 20 consecutive quarters and the subordinated nature of the obligations in the capital structure. The Company also receives rating agency equity credit for these securities. Excluding the $82 billion of assets and liabilities recorded in accordance with SFAS No. 140 would reduce the leverage ratio from 32.6x to 30.0x. The following table sets forth the Company’s total assets, adjusted assets and leverage ratios as of November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 and for the average month−end balances during fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006: Balance at Average Month−End Balance November 30, November 30, 2007 2006 Fiscal 2007(1) Fiscal 2006(2) (dollars in millions, except ratio data) Total assets Less: Securities purchased under agreements to resell Securities borrowed Add: Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased Less: Derivative contracts sold, not yet purchased $ 1,045,409 (126,887) (239,994) 134,341 (71,604) Subtotal Less: Cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements(3) Assets recorded under certain provisions of SFAS No. 140 and FIN 46R Goodwill and net intangible assets(4) $ 1,121,192 (175,787) (299,631) 183,119 (57,491) $ 1,202,065 (176,973) (279,729) 172,075 (59,869) $ 1,022,269 (183,490) (274,807) 157,678 (47,176) 741,265 771,402 857,569 674,474 (61,608) (110,001) (4,071) (29,565) (100,236) (3,443) (41,357) (132,141) (3,924) (41,644) (82,992) (2,894) Adjusted assets $ 565,585 $ 638,158 $ 680,147 $ 546,944 Common equity Preferred equity $ 30,169 1,100 $ 34,264 1,100 $ 35,235 1,100 $ 31,740 423 Shareholders’ equity Junior subordinated debt issued to capital trusts 31,269 4,876 35,364 4,884 36,335 4,878 32,163 3,875 Subtotal Less: Goodwill and net intangible assets(4) 36,145 (4,071) 40,248 (3,443) 41,213 (3,924) 36,038 (2,894) Tangible shareholders’ equity $ 32,074 $ 36,805 $ 37,289 $ 33,144 Leverage ratio(5) 32.6x 30.5x 32.2x 30.8x Adjusted leverage ratio(6) 17.6x 17.3x 18.2x 16.5x 68 G-75 Table of Contents (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) Average balances for fiscal 2007 were calculated based upon month−end balances from November 2006 through November 2007. Average common equity was adjusted for the Discover Spin−off. The results for the Company and for the Institutional Securities business segment for the first two quarters of fiscal 2006 were adjusted (see Note 24 to the consolidated financial statements). In the second quarter of fiscal 2007, the adjusted assets calculation was revised in order to reduce gross assets by the full amount of cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements. All prior periods have been restated to conform with the current presentation. Effective December 1, 2006, mortgage servicing rights have been included in net intangible assets. Amounts as of November 30, 2006 have been reclassified to conform with the current presentation. Leverage ratio equals total assets divided by tangible shareholders’ equity. Adjusted leverage ratio equals adjusted assets divided by tangible shareholders’ equity. Activity in Fiscal 2007. The Company’s total capital consists of shareholders’ equity, long−term borrowings (debt obligations scheduled to mature in more than 12 months) and junior subordinated debt issued to capital trusts. At November 30, 2007, total capital was $191,085 million, an increase of $28,951 million from November 30, 2006. The Company redeemed all $66 million of its outstanding Capital Units on February 28, 2007. During the 12 months ended November 30, 2007, the Company issued senior notes with a carrying value aggregating $76.1 billion, including non−U.S. dollar currency notes aggregating $35.2 billion. In connection with the note issuances, the Company has entered into certain transactions to obtain floating interest rates based primarily on short−term London Interbank Offered Rates (“LIBOR”) trading levels. At November 30, 2007, the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the Company’s Senior Indebtedness (as defined in the Company’s senior debt indentures) was approximately $207 billion (including guaranteed obligations of the indebtedness of subsidiaries). The weighted average maturity of the Company’s long−term borrowings, based upon stated maturity dates, was approximately 5.5 years at November 30, 2007. Subsequent to fiscal year−end and through December 31, 2007, the Company’s long−term borrowings (net of repayments) increased by approximately $10 billion. In addition, in December 2007, the Company sold Equity Units to a wholly owned subsidiary of CIC for approximately $5,579 million. See “China Investment Corporation Investment” herein. 69 G-76 Table of Contents China Investment Corporation Investment. In December 2007, the Company sold Equity Units which include contracts to purchase Company common stock (see “Stock Purchase Contracts” herein) to a wholly owned subsidiary of CIC for approximately $5,579 million. CIC’s ownership in the Company’s common stock, including the maximum number of shares of common stock to be received by CIC upon settlement of the stock purchase contracts, will be 9.9% or less of the Company’s total shares outstanding based on the total shares outstanding on November 30, 2007. CIC will be a passive financial investor and will have no special rights of ownership nor a role in the management of the Company. A substantial portion of the investment proceeds will be treated as Tier 1 capital for regulatory capital purposes. Each stock purchase contract mandatorily settles in Company common stock at prices between $48.0700 and $57.6840. The maximum number of shares to be issued upon settlement of the stock purchase contracts included in the Equity Units is approximately 116,063,000. The stock purchase contracts settle for Company common stock on August 17, 2010, subject to adjustment. Each Equity Unit will pay a fixed annual payment rate of 9% payable quarterly. As described below, the Equity Units consist of interests in trust preferred securities issued by Morgan Stanley Capital Trust A (“Series A Trust”), Morgan Stanley Capital Trust B (“Series B Trust”) or Morgan Stanley Capital Trust C (“Series C Trust”) (each a “Morgan Stanley Trust” and, collectively, the “Trusts”) and stock purchase contracts issued by the Company. The only assets held by the Series A Trust, Series B Trust and Series C Trust are junior subordinated debentures issued by the Company. Equity Units. Each Equity Unit has a stated amount of $1,000 per unit consisting of: (i) an undivided beneficial ownership interest in a trust preferred security of Series A Trust, Series B Trust or Series C Trust with an initial liquidation amount of $1,000; and (ii) a stock purchase contract relating to the common stock, par value of $0.01 per share, of the Company. Junior Subordinated Debentures Issued to Support Trust Common and Trust Preferred Securities. In the first quarter of fiscal 2008, the Company issued junior subordinated debt securities due no later than February 17, 2042 for a total of $5,579,173,000 in exchange for $5,579,143,000 in aggregate proceeds from the sale of the trust preferred securities by the Trusts and $30,000 in trust common securities issued equally by the Trusts. The Company elected to fair value the junior subordinated debentures pursuant to SFAS No. 159. The common and trust preferred securities of the Trusts, totaling approximately $5,579 million, represent undivided beneficial ownership interests in the assets of the Trusts, have no stated maturity and must be redeemed upon the redemption or maturity of the corresponding series of junior subordinated debt securities—the sole assets of the respective Trusts. The Series A Trust, Series B Trust and Series C Trust will make quarterly distributions on the trust common and trust preferred securities at an annual rate of 6%. The trust common securities, which are held by the Company, represent an interest in the Trusts and are recorded as an equity method investment in the Company’s consolidated statement of financial condition. The Trusts are VIEs in accordance with FIN 46R and the Company does not consolidate its interests in the Trusts as it is not the primary beneficiary of any of the Trusts. The Company has directly guaranteed the repayment of the trust preferred securities to the holders thereof to the extent that there are funds available in the Trusts. If the Company does not make payments on the junior subordinated debentures owned by a Morgan Stanley Trust, such Morgan Stanley Trust will not be able to pay any amounts payable in respect of the trust preferred securities issued by it and will not have funds legally available for that purpose. In that event, holders of such series of trust preferred securities would not be able to 70 G-77 Table of Contents rely upon the guarantee for payment of those amounts. The guarantee will remain in place until the redemption price of all of the trust preferred securities is paid, the amounts payable with respect to the trust preferred securities upon liquidation of the Morgan Stanley Trusts are paid or the junior subordinated debentures are distributed to the holders of all the trust preferred securities. The trust preferred securities held by the Equity Unit holders are pledged to the Company to collateralize the obligations of the Equity Unit holders under the related stock purchase contracts. The Equity Unit holders may substitute certain zero−coupon treasury securities in place of the trust preferred securities as collateral under the stock purchase contracts. Stock Purchase Contracts. Each stock purchase contract requires the holder to purchase, and the Company to sell, on the stock purchase date a number of newly issued or treasury shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.01 per share, equal to the settlement rate. The settlement rate at the respective stock purchase date will be calculated based on the arithmetic average of the volume−weighted average prices of the common stock during a specified 20−day period ending three days immediately preceding the applicable stock purchase date (“applicable market value”). If the applicable market value of the Company’s common stock is less than the threshold appreciation price of $57.6840 but greater than $48.0700, the reference price, the settlement rate will be a number of shares of the Company’s common stock equal to $1,000 divided by the applicable market value. If the applicable market value is less than or equal to the reference price, the settlement rate will be the number of shares of the Company’s common stock equal to $1,000 divided by the reference price. If the applicable market value is greater than or equal to the threshold appreciation price, the settlement rate will be the number of shares of the Company’s common stock equal to $1,000 divided by the threshold appreciation price. Accordingly, upon settlement in the aggregate, the Company will receive proceeds of approximately $5,579 million and issue up to approximately 116,063,000 shares of its common stock. The stock purchase contract may be settled early at the option of the holder at any time prior to the second business day immediately preceding the beginning of the first remarketing period. However, upon early settlement, the holder will receive the minimum settlement rate, subject to adjustment. The initial quarterly distributions on the Series A, Series B and Series C trust preferred securities of 6%, combined with the contract adjustment payments on the stock purchase contracts of 3%, result in the 9% yield on the Equity Units. If the Company defers any of the contract adjustment payments on the stock purchase contracts, then it will accrue additional amounts on the deferred amounts at the annual rate of 9% until paid, to the extent permitted by law. The present value of the future contract adjustment payments due under the stock purchase contracts was approximately $400 million and was recorded in Other liabilities and accrued expenses with a corresponding decrease recorded in Shareholders’ equity in the Company’s consolidated statement of financial condition in the first quarter of fiscal 2008. The other liability balance related to the stock purchase contracts will accrete over the term of the stock purchase contract using the effective yield method with a corresponding charge to Interest expense. When the contract adjustment payments are made under the stock purchase contracts, they will reduce the other liability balance. Calculation of Impact on Average Diluted Common Shares Outstanding Prior to Settlement of Stock Purchase Contract. Prior to the issuance of common stock upon settlement of the stock purchase contract, the impact of the Equity Units will be reflected in the Company’s earnings per diluted common share using the treasury stock method, as defined by SFAS No. 128, “Earnings Per Share.” Under the treasury stock method, the number of shares of common stock included in the calculation of earnings per diluted common share will be calculated as the excess, if any, of the number of shares expected to be issued upon settlement of the stock purchase contract based on the 71 G-78 Table of Contents average market price for the last 20 days of the reporting period, less the number of shares that could be purchased by the Company with the proceeds to be received upon settlement of the contract at the average closing price for the reporting period. Dilution of net income per share will occur (i) in reporting periods when the average closing price of common shares is over $57.6840 per share or (ii) in reporting periods when the average closing price of common shares for a reporting period is between $48.0700 and $57.6840 and is greater than the average market price for the last 20 days ending three days prior to the end of such reporting period. Upon settlement of the Stock Purchase Contract, the amount of common shares issued in settlement of the contract will be included in the basic and diluted earnings per share calculation of weighted average common shares outstanding for the reporting period. Economic Capital. The Company’s economic capital model estimates the amount of equity capital required to support the businesses and their risk−generating activities through the business cycle while simultaneously satisfying regulatory, rating agency and investor minimum requirements. The economic capital model will evolve over time in response to changes in the business and regulatory environment and to incorporate improvements in modeling techniques in order to reflect the capital required to support business activities. Economic capital requirements are allocated to each business segment and are sub−allocated to product lines as appropriate. Each business segment is capitalized as if each were an independent operating entity. This process is intended to align equity capital with the risks in each business, provide business managers with tools for measuring and managing risk and associated cost of required capital, and allow senior management to evaluate risk−adjusted returns (such as return on equity and shareholder value added) to facilitate resource allocation decisions. The Company’s methodology is based on a going−concern approach that assigns equity to each business based on regulatory capital usage plus additional capital for stress losses, including principal investment risk. Regulatory capital, including additional capital assigned for certain goodwill, intangible assets and net deferred tax assets, is a minimum requirement to ensure the Company’s access to funding and credibility in the market. The Company believes it must be able to sustain stress losses and maintain capital substantially above regulatory minimums while supporting ongoing business activities. The difference between the Company’s consolidated book equity and aggregate equity requirements denotes the Company’s unallocated capital position, which is not currently reflected in business segment performance metrics. The Company assesses stress loss capital across various dimensions of market, credit, business and operational risks. Market risk scenarios capture systematic, idiosyncratic and random market risk through the use of internal market stress data. Credit risk is included in the form of idiosyncratic counterparty default events. Business risk incorporates earnings volatility due to variability in revenue flows, with estimates on the mix of fixed versus variable expenses at various points in the business cycle. Operational stress losses primarily reflect legal risk across the Company. Beginning in fiscal 2007, economic capital requirements are met by regulatory Tier 1 equity (including common shareholders’ equity, certain preferred stock, eligible hybrid capital instruments and deductions of certain goodwill, intangible assets and net deferred tax assets), subject to regulatory limits. 72 G-79 Table of Contents The following table presents the Company’s allocated average Tier 1 equity (“economic capital”) for fiscal 2007 and average common equity for fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006: Fiscal Year Ended 2007 Average Average Common Tier 1 Equity Equity (dollars in billions) Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Asset Management Unallocated capital $ 24.6 1.5 2.7 2.9 Total from continuing operations Discontinued operations $ 31.7 2.7 Total $ 34.4 23.9 1.7 3.5 2.9 2006 Average Common Equity $ 32.0 3.2 $ 35.2 18.0 3.0 2.4 3.1 26.5 5.2 $ 31.7 The increase in capital allocated to Institutional Securities from the prior−year period reflects the increased market and credit risk profile as well as capital required for new acquisitions and investments. The Company expects to continue deploying capital, provided market opportunities continue to warrant such investments. The decrease in the economic capital allocated to the Global Wealth Management Group was due to the Company’s reassessment of the amount of capital required to support the market risks and credit risks in this business segment. The incremental equity capital allocated to Asset Management primarily represents capital required for acquisitions and investments in asset management products. The Company’s unallocated economic capital was $(2.7) billion at November 30, 2007 due to the loss recorded in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007 and increased capital assigned to the Institutional Securities business segment. In December 2007, the Company entered into an agreement with CIC as a long−term financial investor and issued new capital of approximately $5,579 million through Equity Units. These Equity Units will help to further bolster the Company’s capital position and enhance growth opportunities globally while also building on the Company’s deep historic ties and market leadership in China (see “China Investment Corporation Investment” herein). The Company continues to believe that it is adequately capitalized. The Company generally uses available unallocated capital for organic growth, additional acquisitions, and other capital needs including repurchases of common stock while maintaining adequate internal capital ratios. During fiscal 2007, the Company’s shareholders’ equity has been affected by the adoption of SFAS No. 158 (see Note 19 to the consolidated financial statements), SFAS No. 157 and SFAS No. 159 (see Notes 2 and 3 to the consolidated financial statements), and the Discover Spin−off (see Note 22 to the consolidated financial statements). Equity Capital Management Policies. The Company’s senior management views equity capital as an important source of financial strength and, therefore, pursues a strategy of ensuring that the Company’s equity capital base adequately reflects and provides protection from the economic risks inherent in its businesses. Capital is required for, among other things, the Company’s inventories, underwritings, principal investments, bridge loans and other financings, investments in fixed assets and for future uses. Capital for future uses will be included within unallocated capital until required by the business segments. The Company also considers return on common equity to be an important measure of its performance, in the context of both the particular business environment in which the Company is operating and its peer group’s results. In this regard, the Company actively manages its consolidated equity capital position based upon, among other things, business opportunities, capital availability and rates of return together with internal capital policies, regulatory requirements and rating agency guidelines 73 G-80 Table of Contents and, therefore, in the future may expand or contract its equity capital base to address the changing needs of its businesses. The Company attempts to maintain total equity, on a consolidated basis, at least equal to the sum of its operating subsidiaries’ equity. At November 30, 2007, the Company’s equity capital (which includes shareholders’ equity and junior subordinated debt issued to capital trusts) was $36,145 million, a decrease of $4,103 million from November 30, 2006, primarily due to the Discover Spin−off. The Company returns internally generated equity capital that is in excess of the needs of its businesses to its shareholders through common stock repurchases and dividends. During fiscal 2007, the Company purchased approximately $3.8 billion of its common stock (approximately 52 million shares) through open market purchases at an average cost of $72.65 (see also “Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities” in Part II, Item 5). In December 2006, the Company announced that its Board of Directors had authorized the repurchase of up to $6 billion of the Company’s outstanding common stock. This share repurchase authorization replaced the Company’s previous repurchase authorizations with one repurchase program for capital management purposes that will consider, among other things, business segment capital needs, as well as equity−based compensation and benefit plan requirements. As of November 30, 2007, the Company had approximately $2.3 billion remaining under its current share repurchase authorization. The Board of Directors determines the declaration and payment of dividends on a quarterly basis. In December 2007, the Company announced that its Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend per common share of $0.27. The Company also announced that its Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $379.66 per share of Series A Floating Rate Non−Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by depositary shares, each representing 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.37966). Liquidity Management Policies. The primary goal of the Company’s liquidity management and financing activities is to ensure adequate funding over a wide range of market environments. Given the highly liquid nature of the Company’s balance sheet, funding requirements are largely fulfilled through the use of collateralized financing. The Company has centralized management of credit−sensitive unsecured funding sources in the Treasury Department. The Company maintains a liquidity management framework in order to meet target liquidity requirements and withstand a contraction in credit availability. The framework components include the Contingency Funding Plan (“CFP”), Liquidity Reserve and Cash Capital. Contingency Funding Plan. The Company maintains a CFP to manage a potential prolonged liquidity contraction over a one−year time period and to provide the ability to conduct business in an orderly manner. The CFP is produced on a parent, bank subsidiary and non−bank subsidiary level. The CFP sets forth a course of action to ensure effective management of a liquidity event. Liquidity risk exposures are regularly evaluated and reported to the Firm Risk Committee and appropriate business segment risk committees. The Company’s CFP model incorporates a wide range of potential cash outflows during a liquidity stress event, including, but not limited to, the following: (i) repayment of all unsecured debt maturing within one year; (ii) maturity roll−off of outstanding letters of credit with no further issuance and replacement with cash collateral; (iii) return of unsecured securities borrowed and any cash raised against these securities; (iv) additional collateral that would be required by counterparties in the event of a ratings downgrade; (v) higher haircuts on or lower availability of secured funding; (vi) client cash withdrawals; (vii) drawdowns on unfunded commitments provided to third parties; and (viii) discretionary unsecured debt buybacks. 74 G-81 Table of Contents The Company’s CFP is developed at the legal entity level in order to capture specific cash requirements and availability for the parent company and each of its major operating subsidiaries. The CFP assumes that the parent company does not have access to cash that may be trapped at subsidiaries due to regulatory, legal or tax constraints. In addition, the CFP assumes that the parent company does not draw down on its committed credit facilities. Liquidity Reserve. The Company seeks to maintain a target liquidity reserve that is sized to cover daily funding needs and to meet strategic liquidity targets as outlined in the CFP. This liquidity reserve is held in the form of cash deposits with banks and a pool of unencumbered securities. The Company manages the pool of unencumbered securities, against which funding can be raised, on a global basis, and securities for the pool are chosen accordingly. The U.S. and non−U.S. components, held in the form of a reverse repurchase agreement at the parent company, consists of U.S. and European government bonds and other high−quality collateral. The Company believes that diversifying the form in which its liquidity reserve (cash and securities) is maintained enhances its ability to quickly and efficiently source funding in a stressed environment. The Company’s funding requirements and target liquidity reserve may vary based on changes in the level and composition of its balance sheet, timing of specific transactions, client financing activity, market conditions and seasonal factors. The table below summarizes the Company’s liquidity reserves on a parent, bank subsidiary and non−bank subsidiary level. The liquidity held on the bank and non−bank subsidiary level is generally not available to the parent. Liquidity Reserve Parent Bank subsidiaries Non−bank subsidiaries Total Average Balance For the Fiscal Year Ended November 30, 2007 At November 30, 2007 For the Quarter Ended November 30, 2007 (dollars in billions) $ 62 22 34 $ 64 22 34 $ 49 16 20 $ 118 $ 120 $ 85 Cash Capital. The Company maintains a cash capital model that measures long−term funding sources against requirements. Sources of cash capital include the parent company’s equity and the non−current portion of certain long−term borrowings. Uses of cash capital include the following: (i) illiquid assets such as buildings, equipment, goodwill, net intangible assets, exchange memberships, deferred tax assets and principal investments; (ii) a portion of securities inventory that is not expected to be financed on a secured basis in a credit−stressed environment (i.e., stressed haircuts); and (iii) expected drawdowns on unfunded commitments. The Company seeks to maintain a surplus cash capital position. The Company’s equity capital of $36,145 million (including junior subordinated debt issued to capital trusts of $4,876 million) and long−term borrowings (debt obligations scheduled to mature in more than 12 months) of $154,940 million comprised the Company’s total capital of $191,085 million as of November 30, 2007, which substantially exceeded cash capital requirements. Committed Credit Facilities. The maintenance of committed credit facilities serves to further diversify the Company’s funding sources. The Company values committed credit as a secondary component of its liquidity management framework. The committed credit facilities include a diversification of lenders to the Company covering geographic regions, including North America, Europe and Asia. The Company maintains a senior revolving credit agreement with a group of banks to support general liquidity needs, including the issuance of commercial paper, which consists of three separate tranches: a U.S. dollar 75 G-82 Table of Contents tranche; a Japanese yen tranche; and a multicurrency tranche available in both euro and British pound, all of which exist with the Company as the sole borrower. Under this combined facility (the “Credit Facility”), the banks are committed to provide up to $7.6 billion under the U.S. dollar tranche, 80 billion Japanese yen under the Japanese yen tranche and $3.25 billion under the multicurrency tranche. The Credit Facility expires on April 16, 2008 and includes a term−out feature that allows the Company, at its option, to extend borrowings under the Credit Facility for an additional one year beyond the expiration date. At November 30, 2007, the Company had a $13.8 billion consolidated stockholders’ equity surplus as compared with the Credit Facility’s covenant requirement. The Company anticipates that it may utilize the Credit Facility for short−term funding from time to time. The Company does not believe that any of the covenant requirements in its Credit Facility will impair its ability to obtain funding under the Credit Facility, pay its current level of dividends or obtain loan arrangements, letters of credit and other financial guarantees or other financial accommodations. At November 30, 2007, no borrowings were outstanding under the Credit Facility. The Company also maintains a committed bilateral credit facility to support general liquidity needs. This facility is expected to be drawn from time to time to cover short−term funding needs. Capital Covenants. In October 2006 and April 2007, the Company executed a replacement capital covenant in connection with offerings by Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VII and Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VIII (the “Capital Securities”). Under the terms of the replacement capital covenant, the Company has agreed, for the benefit of certain specified holders of debt, to limitations on its ability to redeem or repurchase any of the Capital Securities for specified periods of time. For a complete description of the Capital Securities and the terms of the replacement capital covenant, see the Company’s Current Reports on Form 8−K dated October 12, 2006 and April 26, 2007. Funding Management Policies. The Company funds its balance sheet on a global basis through diverse sources. These sources include the Company’s equity capital; long−term debt; repurchase agreements; U.S., Canadian, European, Japanese and Australian commercial paper; asset−backed securitizations; letters of credit; unsecured bond borrowings; securities lending; buy/sell agreements; municipal reinvestments; promissory notes; master notes; and committed and uncommitted lines of credit. Repurchase agreement transactions, securities lending and a portion of the Company’s bank borrowings are made on a collateralized basis and, therefore, provide a more stable source of funding than short−term unsecured borrowings. The Company has active financing programs for both standard and structured products in the U.S., European and Asian markets, targeting global investors and currencies such as the U.S. dollar, euro, British pound, Australian dollar and Japanese yen. The Company’s bank subsidiaries solicit deposits from consumers, purchase Federal Funds, issue short−term institutional certificates of deposits and issue bank notes. Interest bearing deposits are classified by type as savings, brokered and other time deposits. Savings deposits consist primarily of money market deposit accounts sold nationally and savings deposits obtained from individual securities clients. Brokered deposits consist primarily of certificates of deposit issued by the Company’s bank subsidiaries. Other time deposits include individual and institutional certificates of deposit. The Company’s funding management policies are designed to provide for financings that are executed in a manner that reduces the risk of disruption to the Company’s operations that would result from an interruption in the availability of the Company’s funding sources. The Company pursues a strategy of diversification of funding sources (by product, by investor and by region) and attempts to ensure that the tenor of the Company’s liabilities equals or exceeds the expected holding period of the assets being financed. Maturities of financings are designed 76 G-83 Table of Contents to manage exposure to refinancing risk in any one period. The Company maintains a surplus of unused short−term funding sources at all times to withstand any unforeseen contraction in credit capacity. In addition, the Company attempts to maintain cash and unhypothecated marketable securities equal to at least 110% of its outstanding short−term unsecured borrowings. The Company also maintains committed credit facilities (described above) to support its ongoing borrowing programs. Secured Financing. A substantial portion of the Company’s total assets consists of highly liquid marketable securities and short−term receivables arising principally from its Institutional Securities sales and trading activities. The highly liquid nature of these assets provides the Company with flexibility in financing these assets with stable collateralized borrowings. The Company’s goal is to encourage funding through collateralized borrowings in order to achieve an optimal mix of secured and unsecured financing. The Institutional Securities business emphasizes the use of collateralized short−term borrowings to limit the growth of short−term unsecured funding, which is more typically subject to disruption during periods of financial stress. As part of this effort, the Institutional Securities business segment continually seeks to expand its global secured borrowing capacity. In addition, the Company, through several of its subsidiaries, maintains funded and unfunded committed credit facilities to support various businesses, including the collateralized commercial and residential mortgage whole loan, derivative contracts, warehouse lending, emerging market loan, structured product, corporate loan, investment banking and prime brokerage businesses. Unsecured Financing. The Company views long−term debt as a stable source of funding for core inventories and illiquid assets. In general, securities inventories not financed by secured funding sources and the majority of current assets are financed with a combination of short−term funding, floating rate long−term debt or fixed rate long−term debt swapped to a floating rate. The Company uses derivative products (primarily interest rate, currency and equity swaps) to assist in asset and liability management, reduce borrowing costs and hedge interest rate risk (see Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements). The Company issues long−term debt in excess of the amount necessary to meet the needs of its securities inventory and less liquid assets as determined by its Cash Capital Policy. In addition to these needs, long−term debt funding is employed to enhance the Company’s liquidity position by reducing reliance on short−term credit sensitive instruments (e.g., commercial paper and other unsecured short−term borrowings). Availability and cost of financing to the Company can vary depending on market conditions, the volume of certain trading and lending activities, the Company’s credit ratings and the overall availability of credit. The Company has a portfolio approach for managing the unsecured debt issued by the parent company. This approach gives the Company flexibility to manage the unsecured debt portfolio across maturities, currencies, investors and regions, taking into account market capacity and pricing. Down−lending to subsidiaries is managed to ensure that intercompany borrowings mature before those of the parent company. Liquidity and funding policies recognize potential constraints on the Company’s ability to transfer funds between regulated entities and the parent company. During fiscal 2007, the Company’s long−term financing strategy was driven, in part, by its continued focus on improving its balance sheet strength (evaluated through enhanced capital and liquidity positions), a significant factor in the maintenance of strong credit ratings. As a result, for fiscal 2007, a principal amount of $53 billion of unsecured debt was issued (of which $22 billion of equity−linked and credit−linked notes were not considered to be a component of the Company’s cash capital). Financing transactions were structured to ensure staggered maturities, thereby mitigating refinancing risk, and a diversified investor base was targeted through sales to domestic as well as international institutional and retail clients. Unsecured debt issuance activity resulted in a net increase in the long−term debt component of the cash capital portfolio of approximately $30 billion. 77 G-84 Table of Contents Credit Ratings. The Company’s reliance on external sources to finance a significant portion of its day−to−day operations makes access to global sources of financing important. The cost and availability of unsecured financing generally are dependent on the Company’s short−term and long−term credit ratings. Factors that are significant to the determination of the Company’s credit ratings or that otherwise affect its ability to raise short−term and long−term financing include the Company’s level and volatility of earnings, relative positions in the markets in which it operates, geographic and product diversification, retention of key personnel, risk profile, risk management policies, cash liquidity, capital structure, corporate lending credit risk, and legal and regulatory developments. A deterioration in any of the previously mentioned factors or combination of these factors may lead rating agencies to downgrade the credit ratings of the Company, thereby increasing the cost to the Company in obtaining unsecured funding. In addition, the Company’s debt ratings can have a significant impact on certain trading revenues, particularly in those businesses where longer term counterparty performance is critical, such as OTC derivative transactions, including credit derivatives and interest rate swaps. In connection with certain OTC trading agreements and certain other agreements associated with the Institutional Securities business, the Company may be required to provide additional collateral to certain counterparties in the event of a credit ratings downgrade. At November 30, 2007, the amount of additional collateral that would be required in the event of a one−notch downgrade of the Company’s senior debt credit rating was approximately $746 million. Of this amount, $677 million relates to bilateral arrangements between the Company and other parties where upon the downgrade of one party, the downgraded party must deliver incremental collateral to the other. These bilateral downgrade arrangements are a risk management tool used extensively by the Company as credit exposures are reduced if counterparties are downgraded. As of January 22, 2008, the Company’s credit ratings were as follows: Dominion Bond Rating Service Limited Fitch Ratings(1) Moody’s Investors Service(2) Rating and Investment Information, Inc.(3) Standard & Poor’s(4) (1) (2) (3) (4) Commercial Paper Senior Debt R−1 (middle) F1+ P−1 a−1+ A−1+ AA (low) AA− Aa3 AA AA− On December 19, 2006, Fitch Ratings changed the outlook on the Company’s senior debt ratings from Stable to Negative. On November 8, 2007, Moody’s Investors Service changed the outlook on the Company’s senior debt ratings from Stable to Negative. On December 20, 2007, Rating and Investment Information, Inc. changed the outlook on the Company’s senior debt from Stable to Negative. On July 30, 2007, Standard & Poor’s upgraded the Company’s commercial paper rating from A−1 to A−1+ and upgraded the Company’s senior debt rating from A+ to AA−. On November 8, 2007, Standard & Poor’s changed the outlook on the Company’s commercial paper and senior debt ratings from Stable to Negative. On December 19, 2007, Standard & Poor’s placed the Company’s commercial paper and senior debt ratings on CreditWatch with Negative implications. Off−Balance Sheet Arrangements with Unconsolidated Entities. The Company enters into various arrangements with unconsolidated entities, including variable interest entities, primarily in connection with its Institutional Securities businesses. Institutional Securities Activities. The Company utilizes SPEs primarily in connection with securitization activities. The Company engages in securitization activities related to commercial and residential mortgage loans, U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations, corporate bonds and loans, municipal bonds and other types of financial assets. The Company may retain interests in the securitized financial assets as one or more tranches of the securitization. These retained interests are included in the consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value. Any changes in the fair value of such retained interests are recognized in the consolidated 78 G-85 Table of Contents statements of income. Retained interests in securitized financial assets were approximately $5.3 billion at November 30, 2007, the majority of which were related to residential mortgage loan, commercial mortgage loan and U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligation securitization transactions. For further information about the Company’s securitization activities, see Notes 2 and 5 to the consolidated financial statements as well as “Impact of Credit Market Events” herein. The Company has entered into liquidity facilities with SPEs and other counterparties, whereby the Company is required to make certain payments if losses or defaults occur. The Company often may have recourse to the underlying assets held by the SPEs in the event payments are required under such liquidity facilities (see Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements). Guarantees. FASB Interpretation No. 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others” (“FIN 45”), requires the Company to disclose information about its obligations under certain guarantee arrangements. FIN 45 defines guarantees as contracts and indemnification agreements that contingently require a guarantor to make payments to the guaranteed party based on changes in an underlying measure (such as an interest or foreign exchange rate, a security or commodity price, an index, or the occurrence or non−occurrence of a specified event) related to an asset, liability or equity security of a guaranteed party. FIN 45 also defines guarantees as contracts that contingently require the guarantor to make payments to the guaranteed party based on another entity’s failure to perform under an agreement as well as indirect guarantees of the indebtedness of others. The table below summarizes certain information regarding derivative contracts, financial guarantees to third parties, market value guarantees and liquidity facilities at November 30, 2007: Maximum Potential Payout/Notional Type of Guarantee Notional amount of derivative contracts Standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees(1) Market value guarantees Liquidity facilities (1) Less than 1 Years to Maturity 1−3 3−5 Over 5 (dollars in millions) Total Carrying Amount $ 999,552 $ 1,004,069 $ 2,546,374 $ 2,570,385 $ 7,120,380 $ 131,678 5,133 97 18,043 1,824 106 1,026 1,107 — 444 6,712 655 1,652 14,776 858 21,165 802 44 — Collateral/ Recourse $ 59 2,396 145 20,281 Approximately $14 billion of standby letters of credit are also reflected in the “Commitments and Contractual Obligations” table below in the investment grade and non−investment grade primary and secondary lending commitments and in the letters of credit issued by subsidiaries that are guaranteed by the Company. In the ordinary course of business, the Company guarantees the debt and/or certain trading obligations (including obligations associated with derivatives, foreign exchange contracts and the settlement of physical commodities) of certain subsidiaries. These guarantees generally are entity or product specific and are required by investors or trading counterparties. The activities of the subsidiaries covered by these guarantees (including any related debt or trading obligations) are included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. See Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements for information on trust preferred securities, indemnities, exchange/clearinghouse member guarantees, general partner guarantees, securitized asset guarantees and other guarantees. 79 G-86 Table of Contents Commitments and Contractual Obligations. The Company’s commitments associated with outstanding letters of credit, other financial guarantees, investment activities, and corporate lending and financing arrangements as of November 30, 2007 are summarized below by period of expiration. Since commitments associated with letters of credit, other financial guarantees, and lending and financing arrangements may expire unused, the amounts shown do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements: Years to Maturity Less than 1 Letters of credit and other financial guarantees(1) Letters of credit issued by subsidiaries that are guaranteed by the Company Investment activities(2) Investment grade primary lending commitments(3)(4) Non−investment grade primary lending commitments(3)(4) Investment grade secondary lending commitments(4)(5) Non−investment grade secondary lending commitments(4)(5) Commitments for secured lending transactions(6) Commercial and residential mortgage−related commitments(7) Other commitments(8) Total (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) 1−3 $10,790 197 318 19,656 789 — 81 3,824 5,680 964 $ 4 1,186 238 5,791 1,072 — 27 4,095 — 19 $42,299 $12,432 3−5 Over 5 (dollars in millions) $ 4 194 108 23,323 3,931 — 151 1,073 — 5 $28,789 $ Total — 3,674 647 1,421 14,220 1,406 2,090 2,628 — — $ 10,798 5,251 1,311 50,191 20,012 1,406 2,349 11,620 5,680 988 $26,086 $109,606 This amount primarily represents the Company’s outstanding letters of credit and other financial guarantees issued by third−party banks to certain of the Company’s counterparties. The Company is contingently liable for these letters of credit and other financial guarantees, which are primarily used to satisfy various collateral and margin requirements. This amount represents commitments associated with the Company’s real estate, private equity and principal investment activities, which include alternative products. The Company’s investment grade and non−investment grade primary lending commitments are made in connection with corporate lending and other business activities. Credit ratings for commitments are determined by the Company’s Institutional Credit Department using methodologies generally consistent with those employed by external rating agencies. Obligor credit ratings of BB+ or lower are considered non−investment grade. The Company records these commitments at fair value within Financial instruments owned and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased in the consolidated statement of financial condition (see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements). This amount represents commitments associated with the Company’s Institutional Securities sales and trading activities. This amount represents lending commitments extended by the Company to companies that are secured by real estate assets of the borrower. Loans made under these arrangements typically are at variable rates and generally provide for over−collateralization based upon the creditworthiness of the borrower. This amount also includes commitments to asset−backed commercial paper conduits of $1,246 million, which have maturities of less than four years. These amounts represent the Company’s forward purchase contracts involving mortgage loans, residential mortgage loan commitments to individuals and residential home equity lines of credit. This amount includes commercial loan commitments to small businesses and commitments related to securities−based lending activities in connection with the Company’s Global Wealth Management Group business. At November 30, 2007, the Company had commitments to enter into reverse repurchase and repurchase agreements of approximately $107 billion and $26 billion, respectively. 80 G-87 Table of Contents In the normal course of business, the Company enters into various contractual obligations that may require future cash payments. Contractual obligations at November 30, 2007 include long−term borrowings, operating leases and purchase obligations. The Company’s future cash payments associated with its contractual obligations as of November 30, 2007 are summarized below: Payments Due in: Long−term borrowings(1) Operating leases – office facilities(2) Operating leases – equipment(2) Purchase obligations(3) Total (1) (2) (3) Fiscal 2008 Fiscal 2009−2010 Fiscal 2011−2012 Thereafter (dollars in millions) $30,808 549 650 268 $ 43,081 907 569 107 $ 39,701 676 210 8 $ 77,034 2,732 123 — $190,624 4,864 1,552 383 $32,275 $ 44,664 $ 40,595 $ 79,889 $197,423 Total See Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements. See Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements. Purchase obligations for goods and services include payments for, among other things, consulting, outsourcing, advertising, sponsorship, and computer and telecommunications maintenance agreements. Purchase obligations at November 30, 2007 reflect the minimum contractual obligation under legally enforceable contracts with contract terms that are both fixed and determinable. These amounts exclude obligations for goods and services that already have been incurred and are reflected on the Company’s consolidated statement of financial condition. Regulatory Requirements. On April 1, 2007, the Company merged Morgan Stanley DW Inc. (“MSDWI”) into Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated (“MS&Co”). Upon completion of the merger, the surviving entity, MS&Co., became the Company’s principal U.S. broker−dealer. MS&Co. is a registered broker−dealer and registered futures commission merchant and, accordingly, is subject to the minimum net capital requirements of the SEC, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission. MS&Co. has consistently operated in excess of these requirements. MS&Co.’s net capital totaled $6,673 million at November 30, 2007, which exceeded the amount required by $4,950 million. Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (“MSIP”), a London−based broker−dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Financial Services Authority, and Morgan Stanley Japan Securities Co., Ltd. (“MSJS”), a Tokyo−based broker−dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Financial Services Agency. MSIP and MSJS consistently operated in excess of their respective regulatory capital requirements. Under regulatory capital requirements adopted by the FDIC and other bank regulatory agencies, FDIC−insured financial institutions must maintain (a) 3% to 4% of Tier 1 capital, as defined, to average assets (“leverage ratio”), (b) 4% of Tier 1 capital, as defined, to risk−weighted assets (“Tier 1 risk−weighted capital ratio”) and (c) 8% of total capital, as defined, to risk−weighted assets (“total risk−weighted capital ratio”). At November 30, 2007, the leverage ratio, Tier 1 risk−weighted capital ratio and total risk−weighted capital ratio of each of the Company’s FDIC−insured financial institutions exceeded these regulatory minimums. Certain other U.S. and non−U.S. subsidiaries are subject to various securities, commodities and banking regulations, and capital adequacy requirements promulgated by the regulatory and exchange authorities of the countries in which they operate. These subsidiaries have consistently operated in excess of their local capital adequacy requirements. Morgan Stanley Derivative Products Inc. (“MSDP”) and Cournot Financial Products LLC (“Cournot”), which are triple−A rated derivative products subsidiaries, maintain certain operating restrictions that have been reviewed by various rating agencies. Both entities are operated such that creditors of the Company should not expect to have 81 G-88 Table of Contents any claims on either the assets of Cournot or the assets of MSDP, unless and until the obligations of such entity to its own creditors are satisfied in full. Creditors of Cournot or MSDP, respectively, should not expect to have any claims on the assets of the Company or any of its affiliates, other than the respective assets of Cournot or MSDP. The Company is a consolidated supervised entity (“CSE”) as defined by the SEC. As such, the Company is subject to group−wide supervision and examination by the SEC and to minimum capital requirements on a consolidated basis. During fiscal 2007, the Company was in compliance with CSE capital requirements. MS&Co. is required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of Rule 15c3−1. MS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. As of November 30, 2007, MS&Co. had tentative net capital in excess of the minimum and the notification requirements. Effects of Inflation and Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates. The Company’s assets to a large extent are liquid in nature and, therefore, are not significantly affected by inflation, although inflation may result in increases in the Company’s expenses, which may not be readily recoverable in the price of services offered. To the extent inflation results in rising interest rates and has other adverse effects upon the securities markets and upon the value of financial instruments, it may adversely affect the Company’s financial position and profitability. A significant portion of the Company’s business is conducted in currencies other than the U.S. dollar, and changes in foreign exchange rates relative to the U.S. dollar can therefore affect the value of non−U.S. dollar net assets, revenues and expenses. Potential exposures as a result of these fluctuations in currencies are closely monitored, and, where cost−justified, strategies are adopted that are designed to reduce the impact of these fluctuations on the Company’s financial performance. These strategies may include the financing of non−U.S. dollar assets with direct or swap−based borrowings in the same currency and the use of currency forward contracts or the spot market in various hedging transactions related to net assets, revenues, expenses or cash flows. 82 G-89 Table of Contents Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk. Risk Management. Risk Management Policy and Control Structure. Risk is an inherent part of the Company’s business and activities. The Company’s ability to properly and effectively identify, assess, monitor and manage each of the various types of risk involved in its activities is critical to its soundness and profitability. The Company’s broad−based portfolio of business activities helps reduce the impact that volatility in any particular area or related areas may have on its net revenues as a whole. The Company seeks to identify, assess, monitor and manage, in accordance with defined policies and procedures, the following principal risks involved in the Company’s business activities: market, credit, operational, legal, and liquidity and funding risk. Liquidity and funding risk is discussed in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Part II, Item 7. The Company’s currency exposure relating to its net monetary investments in non−U.S. dollar functional currency subsidiaries is discussed in Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements. The cornerstone of the Company’s risk management philosophy is protection of the Company’s franchise, reputation and financial standing. The Company’s risk management philosophy is based on the following principles: comprehensiveness, independence, accountability, defined risk tolerance and transparency. Given the importance of effective risk management to the Company’s reputation, senior management requires thorough and frequent communication and appropriate escalation of risk matters. Risk management at the Company requires independent Company−level oversight, accountability of the Company’s business segments, constant communication, judgment, and knowledge of specialized products and markets. The Company’s senior management takes an active role in the identification, assessment and management of various risks at both the Company and business segment level. In recognition of the increasingly varied and complex nature of the global financial services business, the Company’s risk management philosophy, with its attendant policies, procedures and methodologies, is evolutionary in nature and subject to ongoing review and modification. The nature of the Company’s risks, coupled with this risk management philosophy, informs the Company’s risk governance structure. The Company’s risk governance structure includes the Firm Risk Committee, the Capital Structure and Strategic Transactions Committee, the Chief Risk Officer, the Internal Audit Department, independent control groups, and various other risk control managers, committees and groups located within and across business segments. The Firm Risk Committee, composed of the Company’s most senior officers, oversees the Company’s risk management structure. The Firm Risk Committee’s responsibilities include oversight of the Company’s risk management principles, procedures and limits, and the monitoring of material financial, operational and franchise risks. The Firm Risk Committee is overseen by the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors (the “Audit Committee”). The Capital Structure and Strategic Transactions Committee (the “Capital Committee”) reviews strategic transactions for the Company and significant changes to the Company’s capital structure. The Capital Committee’s responsibilities include reviewing measures of capital and evaluating capital resources relative to the Company’s risk profile and strategy. The Chief Risk Officer, a member of the Firm Risk Committee, oversees compliance with Company risk limits; approves certain excessions of Company risk limits; reviews material market, credit and operational risks; and reviews results of risk management processes with the Audit Committee. The Internal Audit Department provides independent risk and control assessment and reports to the Audit Committee and administratively to the Chief Legal Officer. The Internal Audit Department examines the Company’s operational and control environment and conducts audits designed to cover all major risk categories. 83 G-90 Table of Contents The Market Risk, Credit Risk, Operational Risk, Financial Control, Treasury, and Legal and Compliance Departments (collectively, the “Company Control Groups”), which are all independent of the Company’s business units, assist senior management and the Firm Risk Committee in monitoring and controlling the Company’s risk through a number of control processes. The Company is committed to employing qualified personnel with appropriate expertise in each of its various administrative and business areas to implement effectively the Company’s risk management and monitoring systems and processes. Each business segment has a risk committee that is responsible for ensuring that the business segment, as applicable, adheres to established limits for market, credit, operational and other risks; implements risk measurement, monitoring, and management policies and procedures that are consistent with the risk framework established by the Firm Risk Committee; and reviews, on a periodic basis, its aggregate risk exposures, risk exception experience, and the efficacy of its risk identification, measurement, monitoring and management policies and procedures, and related controls. Each of the Company’s business segments also has designated operations officers, committees and groups, including operations and information technology groups (collectively, “Segment Control Groups” and, together with the Company Control Groups, the “Control Groups”) to manage and monitor specific risks and report to the business segment risk committee. The Control Groups work together to review the risk monitoring and risk management policies and procedures relating to, among other things, the business segment’s market, credit and operational risk profile, sales practices, reputation, legal enforceability, and operational and technological risks. Participation by the senior officers of the Control Groups helps ensure that risk policies and procedures, exceptions to risk limits, new products and business ventures, and transactions with risk elements undergo a thorough review. The following is a discussion of the Company’s risk management policies and procedures for its principal risks (other than funding and liquidity risk). The discussion focuses on the Company’s securities activities (primarily its institutional trading activities) and corporate lending and related activities. The Company believes that these activities generate a substantial portion of its principal risks. This discussion and the estimated amounts of the Company’s market risk exposure generated by the Company’s statistical analyses are forward−looking statements. However, the analyses used to assess such risks are not predictions of future events, and actual results may vary significantly from such analyses due to events in the markets in which the Company operates and certain other factors described below. Market Risk. Market risk refers to the risk that a change in the level of one or more market prices, rates, indices, implied volatilities (the price volatility of the underlying instrument imputed from option prices), correlations or other market factors, such as market liquidity, will result in losses for a position or portfolio. Generally, the Company incurs market risk as a result of trading and client facilitation activities, principally within the Institutional Securities business where the substantial majority of the Company’s Value−at−Risk (“VaR”) for market risk exposures is generated. In addition, the Company incurs trading−related market risk within the Global Wealth Management Group. Asset Management incurs non−trading market risk primarily from capital investments in funds and investments in private equity vehicles. Sound market risk management is an integral part of the Company’s culture. The various business units and trading desks are responsible for ensuring that market risk exposures are well−managed and prudent. The Control Groups help ensure that these risks are measured and closely monitored and are made transparent to senior management. The Market Risk Department is responsible for ensuring transparency of material market risks, monitoring compliance with established limits, and escalating risk concentrations to appropriate senior management. To execute these responsibilities, the Market Risk Department monitors the Company’s risk against limits on aggregate risk exposures, performs a variety of risk analyses, routinely reports risk summaries, and maintains the Company’s VaR system. A variety of limits is designed to control price and market liquidity 84 G-91 Table of Contents risk. Market risk is monitored through various measures: statistically (using VaR and related analytical measures); by measures of position sensitivity; and through routine stress testing and scenario analyses conducted by the Market Risk Department in collaboration with the business units. The material risks identified by these processes are summarized in reports produced by the Market Risk Department that are circulated to and discussed with senior management. Subprime and Related Risks. During 2007, asset−backed products referencing subprime consumer mortgages experienced a significant increase in expected default rates, resulting in a dramatic reduction in asset prices and market liquidity. Although other markets have also experienced periods of significant illiquidity in the past, the combined magnitude and velocity of price depreciation, as well as the continuing nature of the event, place it among the most significant market shocks ever realized. While such events may recur in the future, the timing and magnitude of recurrence are difficult to predict. Events of this magnitude are outside of the loss estimates forecast by VaR models and are more commonly measured by alternative risk measures such as stress tests and scenario analyses. However, the market moves associated with the subprime events of 2007 were significantly greater than those included in the Company’s stress tests and scenario analyses at that time. The Company has since enhanced its stress test and scenario analyses to better incorporate the levels of price volatility realized during the second half of fiscal 2007. Stress tests and scenario analyses represent estimates of future significant events. Actual market moves may continue to be more dramatic than the estimates included in the Company’s VaR, stress tests and scenario analyses. Limitations to VaR models are discussed further in “VaR Methodology, Assumptions and Limitations” below. Sales and Trading and Related Activities. Primary Market Risk Exposures and Market Risk Management. During fiscal 2007, the Company had exposures to a wide range of interest rates, equity prices, foreign exchange rates and commodity prices—and the associated implied volatilities and spreads—related to the global markets in which it conducts its trading activities. The Company is exposed to interest rate and credit spread risk as a result of its market−making activities and proprietary trading in interest rate sensitive financial instruments (e.g., risk arising from changes in the level or implied volatility of interest rates, the timing of mortgage prepayments, the shape of the yield curve and credit spreads). The activities from which those exposures arise and the markets in which the Company is active include, but are not limited to, the following: emerging market corporate and government debt, non−investment grade and distressed corporate debt, investment grade corporate debt and asset−backed debt (including mortgage−related securities). The Company is exposed to equity price and implied volatility risk as a result of making markets in equity securities and derivatives and maintaining proprietary positions (including positions in non−public entities). Positions in non−public entities may include, but are not limited to, exposures to private equity, venture capital, private partnerships, real estate funds and other funds. Such positions are less liquid, have longer investment horizons and are more difficult to hedge than listed equities. The Company is exposed to foreign exchange rate and implied volatility risk as a result of making markets in foreign currencies and foreign currency derivatives, from maintaining foreign exchange positions and from holding non U.S. dollar−denominated financial instruments. The Company is exposed to commodity price and implied volatility risk as a result of market−making activities and maintaining positions in physical commodities (such as crude and refined oil products, natural gas, electricity, and precious and base metals) and related derivatives. Commodity exposures are subject to periods of high price volatility as a result of changes in supply and demand. These changes can be caused by weather conditions; physical production, transportation and storage issues; or geopolitical and other events that affect the available supply and level of demand for these commodities. 85 G-92 Table of Contents The Company manages its trading positions by employing a variety of risk mitigation strategies. These strategies include diversification of risk exposures and hedging. Hedging activities consist of the purchase or sale of positions in related securities and financial instruments, including a variety of derivative products (e.g., futures, forwards, swaps and options). Hedging activities may not always provide effective mitigation against trading losses due to differences in the terms, specific characteristics or other basis risks that may exist between the hedge instrument and the risk exposure that is being hedged. The Company manages the market risk associated with its trading activities on a Company−wide basis, on a worldwide trading division level and on an individual product basis. The Company manages and monitors its market risk exposures in such a way as to maintain a portfolio that the Company believes is well−diversified in the aggregate with respect to market risk factors and that reflects the Company’s aggregate risk tolerance as established by the Company’s senior management. Aggregate market risk limits have been approved for the Company and for its major trading divisions worldwide (equity and fixed income, which includes interest rate products, credit products, foreign exchange and commodities). Additional market risk limits are assigned to trading desks and, as appropriate, products and regions. Trading division risk managers, desk risk managers, traders and the Market Risk Department monitor market risk measures against limits in accordance with policies set by senior management. The Market Risk Department independently reviews the Company’s trading portfolios on a regular basis from a market risk perspective utilizing VaR and other quantitative and qualitative risk measures and analyses. The Company’s trading businesses and the Market Risk Department also use, as appropriate, measures such as sensitivity to changes in interest rates, prices, implied volatilities and time decay to monitor and report market risk exposures. Net exposure, defined as the potential loss to the Company over a period of time in the event of default of a referenced asset, assuming zero recovery, is one key risk measure the Company employs to standardize the aggregation of market risk exposures across cash and derivative products. Stress testing, which measures the impact on the value of existing portfolios of specified changes in market factors for certain products, is performed periodically and is reviewed by trading division risk managers, desk risk managers and the Market Risk Department. The Market Risk Department also conducts scenario analyses, which estimate the Company’s revenue sensitivity to a set of specific, predefined market and geopolitical events. Value−at−Risk (VaR). The Company uses the statistical technique known as VaR as one of the tools used to measure, monitor and review the market risk exposures of its trading portfolios. The Market Risk Department calculates and distributes daily VaR−based risk measures to various levels of management. VaR Methodology, Assumptions and Limitations. The Company estimates VaR using a model based on historical simulation for major market risk factors and Monte Carlo simulation for name−specific risk in certain equity and fixed income exposures. Historical simulation involves constructing a distribution of hypothetical daily changes in the value of trading portfolios based on two sets of inputs: historical observation of daily changes in key market indices or other market factors (“market risk factors”); and information on the sensitivity of the portfolio values to these market risk factor changes. The Company’s VaR model uses approximately four years of historical data to characterize potential changes in market risk factors. The Company’s 95%/one−day VaR corresponds to the unrealized loss in portfolio value that, based on historically observed market risk factor movements, would have been exceeded with a frequency of 5%, or five times in every 100 trading days, if the portfolio were held constant for one day. The Company’s VaR model generally takes into account linear and non−linear exposures to price risk, interest rate risk and credit spread risk and linear exposures to implied volatility risks. Market risks that are incorporated in the VaR model include equity and commodity prices, interest rates, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates and associated implied volatilities. The VaR model also captures certain correlation risks associated with portfolio credit derivatives, as well as certain basis risks between corporate debt and related credit derivatives. As a supplement to the use of historical simulation for major market risk factors, the Company’s VaR model uses 86 G-93 Table of Contents Monte Carlo simulation to capture name−specific risk in equities and credit products (i.e., corporate bonds, loans, and credit derivatives). The Company’s VaR models evolve over time in response to changes in the composition of trading portfolios and to improvements in modeling techniques and systems capabilities. The Company is committed to continuous review and enhancement of VaR methodologies and assumptions in order to capture evolving risks associated with changes in market structure and dynamics. As part of regular process improvement, additional systematic and name−specific risk factors may be added to improve the VaR model’s ability to more accurately estimate risks to specific asset classes or industry sectors. In response to increased levels of market volatility realized during the second half of fiscal 2007, the Company has reviewed the appropriateness of the implementation of its VaR models and has made certain changes to more accurately capture risks generated by certain fixed income products. These changes include additional historical time series that provide broader product coverage of subprime consumer mortgage products as well as updated mappings of risk exposures to historical price time series. Among their benefits, VaR models permit estimation of a portfolio’s aggregate market risk exposure, incorporating a range of varied market risks; reflect risk reduction due to portfolio diversification or hedging activities; and can cover a wide range of portfolio assets. However, VaR risk measures should be interpreted carefully in light of the methodology’s limitations, which include the following: past changes in market risk factors may not always yield accurate predictions of the distributions and correlations of future market movements; changes in portfolio value in response to market movements (especially for complex derivative portfolios) may differ from the responses calculated by a VaR model; VaR using a one−day time horizon does not fully capture the market risk of positions that cannot be liquidated or hedged within one day; the historical market risk factor data used for VaR estimation may provide only limited insight into losses that could be incurred under market conditions that are unusual relative to the historical period used in estimating the VaR; and published VaR results reflect past trading positions while future risk depends on future positions. VaR is most appropriate as a risk measure for trading positions in liquid financial markets and will understate the risk associated with severe events, such as periods of extreme illiquidity. The Company is aware of these and other limitations and, therefore, uses VaR as only one component in its risk management oversight process. As explained above, this process also incorporates stress testing and scenario analyses and extensive risk monitoring, analysis, and control at the trading desk, division and Company levels. VaR for Fiscal 2007. The table below presents the Company’s Aggregate (Trading and Non−trading), Trading and Non−trading VaR for each of the Company’s primary market risk exposures at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, incorporating substantially all financial instruments generating market risk that are managed by the Company’s trading businesses. This measure of VaR incorporates most of the Company’s trading−related market risks. However, a small proportion of trading positions generating market risk is not included in VaR, and the modeling of the risk characteristics of some positions relies upon approximations that, under certain circumstances, could produce significantly different VaR results from those produced using more precise measures. For example, risks associated with residential mortgage−backed securities have been approximated as it is difficult to capture precisely the relevant microeconomic factors that affect mortgage prices within a VaR context. Aggregate Trading and Non−trading VaR also incorporates (a) the interest rate risk generated by funding liabilities related to institutional trading positions, (b) public company equity positions recorded as investments by the Company and (c) corporate loan exposures that are awaiting distribution to the market. Investments made by the Company that are not publicly traded are not reflected in the VaR results reported below. Aggregate Trading and Non−trading VaR also excludes certain funding liabilities primarily related to fixed and other non−trading assets as well as the credit spread risk generated by the Company’s funding liabilities. As of November 30, 2007, the notional amount of funding liabilities related to non−trading assets (including premises, equipment and software, goodwill, deferred tax assets and intangible assets) was approximately $7.8 billion, with a duration of approximately 10 years. The credit spread risk sensitivity generated by the Company’s funding 87 G-94 Table of Contents liabilitiesth(i.e., those funding both trading and non−trading assets) corresponded to an increase in value of approximately $78 million for each +1 basis point (or 1/100 of a percentage point) widening in the Company’s credit spread level as of November 30, 2007. Since the VaR statistics reported below are estimates based on historical position and market data, VaR should not be viewed as predictive of the Company’s future revenues or financial performance or of its ability to monitor and manage risk. There can be no assurance that the Company’s actual losses on a particular day will not exceed the VaR amounts indicated below or that such losses will not occur more than five times in 100 trading days. VaR does not predict the magnitude of losses which, should they occur, may be significantly greater than the VaR amount. The table below presents 95%/one−day VaR for each of the Company’s primary risk exposures and on an aggregate basis at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006. Aggregate (Trading and Non−trading) 95%/One−Day VaR at November 30, 2007 2006 Table 1: 95% Total VaR Primary Market Risk Category Interest rate and credit spread Equity price Foreign exchange rate Commodity price $ Subtotal Less diversification benefit(1) Total VaR (1) 52 40 24 34 $ 150 67 $ 41 58 9 31 $ 139 50 83 $ 89 Trading Non−trading 95%/One−Day VaR at November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) 95%/One−Day VaR at November 30, 2007 2006 45 39 25 34 $ 143 65 $ 78 38 55 9 31 $ 133 48 $ 85 33 4 1 — $ 13 5 — — 38 5 $ 33 18 3 $ 15 Diversification benefit equals the difference between Total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This benefit arises because the simulated one−day losses for each of the four primary market risk categories occur on different days; similar diversification benefits also are taken into account within each category. The Company’s Aggregate VaR at November 30, 2007 was $83 million compared with $89 million at November 30, 2006. The decrease in Aggregate VaR and Trading VaR at year−end was driven primarily by a decrease in equity exposures toward the end of the fiscal year. The Company’s Trading VaR at November 30, 2007 was $78 million compared with $85 million at November 30, 2006. The decrease in Trading VaR at year−end was driven primarily by a decrease in equity price VaR, partially mitigated by increases in foreign exchange rate VaR and interest rate and credit spread VaR. The increase in foreign exchange rate VaR was driven by increased exposure to foreign currencies. The increase in interest rate and credit spread VaR was driven primarily by two factors. First, at November 30, 2007 the Company reclassified the investment portfolio of its bank subsidiaries from securities available for sale to Financial instruments owned in the consolidated statement of financial condition. (The total notional amount of reclassified assets at November 30, 2007 was $8.1 billion, consisting entirely of ABS and residential mortgage−backed securities). Second, during fiscal 2007, the U.S. subprime market experienced a significant increase in price volatility. This increase in volatility drove an increase in VaR with respect to the Company’s exposure to securities that reference subprime mortgage pools and related financial instruments, whose change in value is modeled as a function of the underlying securities. Non−trading VaR at November 30, 2007 increased to $33 million from $15 million at November 30, 2006 primarily due to an increase in interest rate and credit spread non−trading VaR resulting from an increase in non−trading loan assets. 88 G-95 Table of Contents The Company views average Trading VaR over the fiscal year as more representative of trends in the business than VaR at any single point in time. Table 2 below, which presents the high, low and average 95%/one−day Trading VaR during fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006, represents substantially all of the Company’s trading activities. Certain market risks included in the year−end Aggregate VaR discussed above are excluded from these measures (e.g., equity price risk in public company equity positions recorded as principal investments by the Company and certain funding liabilities related to trading positions). Average Trading VaR for fiscal 2007 increased to $87 million from $60 million in fiscal 2006, driven by increases across all four primary market risk categories. Average Total VaR for fiscal 2007 increased to $92 million from $67 million in fiscal 2006, which was also driven by increases across all four primary market risk categories. The increase in interest rate and credit spread VaR was predominately driven by increased volatility in securitized product and corporate credit markets, which resulted in a higher VaR despite a reduction in risk exposures during the fiscal year. The increase in equity price VaR was primarily driven by increased equity exposures. The increase in foreign exchange rate VaR was driven by increased exposure to foreign currencies. The increase in commodity price VaR was predominately driven by increased exposure to electricity and natural gas products. Daily 95%/One−Day VaR Daily 95%/One−Day VaR for Fiscal 2007 for Fiscal 2006 High Low Average High Low Average (dollars in millions) Table 2: 95% High/Low/Average Trading VaR Primary Market Risk Category Interest rate and credit spread Equity price Foreign exchange rate Commodity price Trading VaR Non−trading VaR Total VaR $ 88 61 33 48 108 61 $ 123 $ 34 29 10 28 69 11 $ 70 $ $ 46 43 18 37 87 22 92 $ $ 48 55 23 43 85 37 91 $ 29 21 5 23 49 10 $ 54 $ 35 28 9 30 60 22 67 $ VaR Statistics under Varying Assumptions. VaR statistics are not readily comparable across firms because of differences in the breadth of products included in each firm’s VaR model, in the statistical assumptions made when simulating changes in market factors, and in the methods used to approximate portfolio revaluations under the simulated market conditions. These differences can result in materially different VaR estimates for similar portfolios. As a result, VaR statistics are more reliable and relevant when used as indicators of trends in risk taking within a firm rather than as a basis for inferring differences in risk taking across firms. Table 3 below presents the VaR statistics that would result if the Company were to adopt alternative parameters for its calculations, such as the reported confidence level (95% versus 99%) for the VaR statistic or a shorter historical time series (four years versus one year) for market data upon which it bases its simulations: Table 3: Average 95% and 99% Trading VaR with Four−Year/One−Year Historical Time Series Primary Market Risk Category Interest rate and credit spread Equity price Foreign exchange rate Commodity price Trading VaR Average 95%/One−Day VaR Average 99%/One−Day VaR for Fiscal 2007 for Fiscal 2007 Four−Year One−Year Four−Year One−Year Factor History Factor History Factor History Factor History (dollars in millions) $ 46 43 18 37 87 $ $ $ 46 49 18 37 90 $ $ 74 65 26 57 127 $ $ 72 81 28 52 132 In addition, if the Company were to report Trading VaR (using a four−year historical time series) with respect to a 10−day holding period, the Company’s 95% and 99% Average Trading VaR for fiscal 2007 would have been $274 million and $402 million, respectively. 89 G-96 Table of Contents Distribution of VaR Statistics and Net Revenues for Fiscal 2007. As shown in Table 2 above, the Company’s average 95%/one−day Trading VaR for fiscal 2007 was $87 million. The histogram below presents the distribution of the Company’s daily 95%/one−day Trading VaR for fiscal 2007. The most frequently occurring value was between $86 million and $89 million, while for approximately 90% of trading days during the fiscal year, VaR ranged between $71 million and $98 million. One method of evaluating the reasonableness of the Company’s VaR model as a measure of the Company’s potential volatility of net revenue is to compare the VaR with actual trading revenue. Assuming no intra−day trading, for a 95%/one−day VaR, the expected number of times that trading losses should exceed VaR during the fiscal year is 13, and, in general, if trading losses were to exceed VaR more than 21 times in a year, the accuracy of the VaR model could be questioned. Accordingly, the Company evaluates the reasonableness of its VaR model by comparing the potential declines in portfolio values generated by the model with actual trading results. For days where losses exceed the 95% or 99% VaR statistic, the Company examines the drivers of trading losses to evaluate the VaR model’s accuracy relative to realized trading results. The Company incurred daily trading losses in excess of the 95%/one−day Trading VaR on 15 days during fiscal 2007. These losses were incurred during a period of exceptionally high volatility across equity, corporate credit and securitized product markets. Since the Company bases its VaR calculations on four years of equally weighted historical data, clustering of VaR exceptions should occur during periods of exceptionally high market turbulence. An examination of the 15 outliers incurred during the fiscal year revealed that these losses occurred on days when markets experienced unusually high price volatility. Over the longer term, trading losses are expected to exceed VaR an average of three times per quarter at the 95% confidence level. The Company bases its VaR calculations on the long−term (or unconditional) distribution and, therefore, evaluates its risk from a longer term perspective, which avoids understating risk during periods of relatively lower volatility in the market. 90 G-97 Table of Contents The histogram below shows the distribution of daily net trading revenue during fiscal 2007 for the Company’s trading businesses (including net interest and non−agency commissions but excluding certain non−trading revenues such as primary, fee−based and prime brokerage revenue credited to the trading businesses). During fiscal 2007, the Company experienced net trading losses on 34 days. These loss days were driven predominately by increased market volatility realized during the second half of the fiscal year. Credit Risk. Credit risk refers to the risk of loss arising from borrower or counterparty default when a borrower, counterparty or obligor does not meet its financial obligations. The Company is exposed to two distinct types of credit risk in its businesses. The Company incurs significant, “single−name” credit risk exposure through the Institutional Securities business and to a lesser extent through its commercial lending activity in its Global Wealth Management Group. This type of risk requires credit analysis of specific counterparties, both initially and on an ongoing basis. The Company also incurs “individual consumer” credit risk in the Global Wealth Management Group business through margin and non−purpose loans to individual investors, which are collateralized by securities. The Company has structured its credit risk management framework to reflect that each of these businesses generates unique credit risks that are appropriately managed discretely. The Institutional Credit Department (“Institutional Credit”) evaluates and monitors credit risk exposure for the Institutional Securities business. Institutional Credit is responsible for ensuring transparency of material credit risks, ensuring compliance with established limits, approving material extensions of credit, and escalating risk concentrations to appropriate senior management. Credit risk exposure in the Global Wealth Management Group business segment is managed through various credit risk committees, whose membership includes Institutional Credit. The Global Wealth Management Group Risk Management Department is responsible for monitoring, measuring and analyzing credit risk exposures, including margin loans and credit sensitive, higher risk transactions. 91 G-98 Table of Contents Institutional Securities Activities. Corporate Lending. In connection with certain of its Institutional Securities business activities, the Company provides loans or lending commitments (including bridge financing) to selected clients. Such loans and commitments can generally be classified as either “event−driven” or “relationship−driven.” “Event−driven” loans and commitments refer to activities associated with a particular event or transaction, such as to support client merger, acquisition or recapitalization transactions. The commitments associated with these “event−driven” activities may not be indicative of the Company’s actual funding requirements since funding is contingent upon a proposed transaction being completed. In addition, the borrower may not fully utilize the commitment or the Company’s portion of the commitment may be reduced through the syndication process. The borrower’s ability to draw on the commitment is also subject to certain terms and conditions, among other factors. The borrowers of “event−driven” lending transactions may be investment grade or non−investment grade. The Company risk manages its exposures in connection with “event−driven” transactions through various means, including syndication, distribution and/or hedging. “Relationship−driven” loans and commitments are generally made to expand business relationships with select clients. The commitments associated with “relationship−driven” activities may not be indicative of the Company’s actual funding requirements, as the commitment may expire unused or the borrower may not fully utilize the commitment. The borrowers of “relationship−driven” lending transactions may be investment grade or non−investment grade. The Company may hedge its exposures in connection with “relationship−driven” transactions. Securitized Products. The Company also extends loans and lending commitments to clients that are secured by assets of the borrower and generally provide for over−collateralization, including commercial real estate, loans secured by loan pools, corporate and operating company loans, and secured lines of revolving credit. Credit risk with respect to these loans and lending commitments arises from the failure of a borrower to perform according to the terms of the loan agreement and a decline in collateral value. Other. In addition to the activities performed by Institutional Credit, there are credit risks managed by various business areas within Institutional Securities. For example, certain businesses with heightened settlement risk monitor compliance with established settlement risk limits. Certain risk management activities as they pertain to establishing appropriate collateral amounts for the Company’s prime brokerage and securitized product businesses are primarily monitored within those areas in that they determine the appropriate collateral level for each strategy or position. In addition, a collateral management group monitors collateral levels against requirements and oversees the administration of the collateral function. Derivative Contracts. In the normal course of business, the Company enters into a variety of derivative contracts related to financial instruments and commodities. The Company uses these instruments for trading and investment purposes, as well as for asset and liability management. These instruments generally represent future commitments to swap interest payment streams, exchange currencies, or purchase or sell commodities and other financial instruments on specific terms at specified future dates. Many of these products have maturities that do not extend beyond one year, although swaps, options and equity warrants typically have longer maturities. The Company incurs credit risk as a dealer in OTC derivatives. Credit risk with respect to derivative instruments arises from the failure of a counterparty to perform according to the terms of the contract. The Company’s exposure to credit risk at any point in time is represented by the fair value of the derivative contracts reported as assets. The fair value of derivatives represents the amount at which the derivative could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing parties, other than in a forced or liquidation sale, and is further described in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements. Future changes in interest rates, foreign currency exchange rates, or the fair values of the financial instruments, commodities, or indices underlying these contracts ultimately may result in cash settlements exceeding fair value amounts recognized in the consolidated statements of financial condition. 92 G-99 Table of Contents Analyzing Credit Risk. Credit risk management takes place at the transaction, counterparty and portfolio levels. In order to help protect the Company from losses resulting from these activities, Institutional Credit analyzes all material lending and derivative transactions and ensures that the creditworthiness of the Company’s counterparties and borrowers is reviewed regularly and that credit exposure is actively monitored and managed. Institutional Credit assigns obligor credit ratings to the Company’s counterparties and borrowers. These credit ratings are intended to assess a counterparty’s probability of default and are derived using methodologies generally consistent with those employed by external rating agencies. Credit ratings of “BB+” or below are considered non−investment grade. Additionally, for lending transactions, Institutional Credit evaluates the relative position of the Company’s particular obligation in the borrower’s capital structure and relative recovery prospects, as well as collateral (if applicable) and other structural elements of the particular transaction. The Company has credit guidelines that limit potential credit exposure to any one borrower or counterparty and to aggregates of borrowers or counterparties. Institutional Credit administers these limits and monitors and reports credit exposure relative to limits. Risk Mitigation. The Company may seek to mitigate credit risk from its lending and derivatives transactions in multiple ways. At the transaction level, the Company seeks to mitigate risk through management of key risk elements such as size, tenor, seniority and collateral. The Company actively hedges its lending and derivatives exposure through various financial instruments which may include single name, portfolio and structured credit derivatives. Additionally, the Company may sell, assign or sub−participate funded loans and lending commitments to other financial institutions in the primary and secondary loan market. In connection with its derivatives trading activities, the Company may enter into master netting agreements and collateral arrangements with counterparties. These agreements may provide the Company with the ability to offset a counterparty’s rights and obligations, request additional collateral when necessary or liquidate the collateral in the event of counterparty default. Credit Exposure−Corporate Lending. The following table presents information about the Company’s corporate loans and commitments as of November 30, 2007. The “total corporate lending exposure” column includes both lending commitments and funded loans. Funded loans represent loans that have been drawn by the borrower and that were outstanding as of November 30, 2007. Lending commitments represent legally binding obligations to provide funding to clients as of November 30, 2007 for both “relationship−driven” and “event−driven” transactions. As discussed above, these loans and commitments have varying terms, may be senior or subordinated, may be secured or unsecured, are generally contingent upon representations, warranties and contractual conditions applicable to the borrower, and may be syndicated, traded or hedged by the Company. 93 G-100 Table of Contents At November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, the aggregate amount of investment grade loans was $13.0 billion and $6.4 billion, respectively, and the aggregate amount of non−investment grade loans was $10.9 billion and $3.4 billion, respectively. At November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, the aggregate amount of lending commitments outstanding was $70.2 billion and $53.5 billion, respectively. In connection with these business activities (which include corporate funded loans and lending commitments), the Company had hedges with a notional amount of $37.6 billion and $26.5 billion at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, respectively. The table below shows the Company’s credit exposure from its corporate lending positions and commitments as of November 30, 2007. Since commitments associated with these business activities may expire unused, they do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements: Corporate Lending Commitments and Funded Loans Years to Maturity Credit Rating(1) Less than 1 AAA AA A BBB $ Investment grade Non−investment grade Total (1) (2) (3) 1−3 701 8,016 7,695 10,010 $ 3−5 Total Corporate Lending Exposure(2)(3) Over 5 (dollars in millions) Corporate Funded Loans Total Corporate Lending Commitments $ $ $ 462 457 3,451 3,954 $ 1,253 3,615 8,617 13,058 — 369 419 1,124 $ 26,422 8,324 26,543 1,912 63,201 13,010 50,191 2,862 2,387 4,777 20,883 30,909 10,897 20,012 $ 29,284 $ 10,711 $ 31,320 $ 22,795 94,110 $ 23,907 $ 2,416 12,457 20,182 28,146 380 1,941 3,120 7,569 $ 2,036 10,516 17,062 20,577 70,203 Obligor credit ratings are determined by Institutional Credit using methodologies generally consistent with those employed by external rating agencies. Total corporate lending exposure includes both lending commitments and funded loans. Amounts exclude approximately $38 billion of notional amount of hedges. Total corporate lending exposure includes “event−driven” funded loans of $10.8 billion and “event−driven” lending commitments of $24.5 billion. Included in the $24.5 billion of “event−driven” loan commitments were $12.2 billion of commitments to non−investment grade borrowers that were accepted by the borrower but not yet closed. 94 G-101 Table of Contents Credit Exposure−Derivatives. The table below presents a summary by counterparty credit rating and remaining contract maturity of the fair value of OTC derivatives in a gain position at November 30, 2007. Fair value represents the risk reduction arising from master netting agreements, where applicable, and, in the final column, net of collateral received (principally cash and U.S. government and agency securities): OTC Derivative Products—Financial Instruments Owned(1) Years to Maturity Credit Rating(2) Less than 1 AAA AA A BBB Non−investment grade Unrated(4) $ Total (1) (2) (3) (4) Cross−Maturity and Cash Collateral Netting(3) Over 5 (dollars in millions) Net Exposure Post−Cash Collateral Net Exposure Post− Collateral 1−3 3−5 1,625 11,560 4,196 3,245 6,299 2,005 $ 1,572 9,686 3,212 3,444 3,954 664 $ 2,142 6,649 3,675 2,879 2,753 190 $ 8,219 23,231 8,234 2,566 3,016 691 $ (4,057) (29,925) (8,454) (3,484) (5,007) (368) $ 9,501 21,201 10,863 8,650 11,015 3,182 $ 9,287 18,011 10,203 6,387 6,505 710 $ 28,930 $ 22,532 $ 18,288 $ 45,957 $ (51,295) $ 64,412 $ 51,103 Fair values shown present the Company’s exposure to counterparties related to the Company’s OTC derivative products. The table does not include the effect of any related hedges utilized by the Company. The table also excludes fair values corresponding to other credit exposures, such as those arising from the Company’s lending activities. Obligor credit ratings are determined by Institutional Credit using methodologies generally consistent with those employed by external rating agencies. Amounts represent the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within such maturity category, where appropriate. Cash collateral received is netted on a counterparty basis, provided legal right of offset exists. In lieu of making an individual assessment of the creditworthiness of unrated companies, the Company makes a determination that the collateral held with respect to such obligations is sufficient to cover a substantial portion of its exposure. The following tables summarize the fair values of the Company’s OTC derivative products recorded in Financial instruments owned and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased by product category and maturity at November 30, 2007, including on a net basis, where applicable, reflecting the fair value of related non−cash collateral for financial instruments owned: OTC Derivative Products—Financial Instruments Owned Years to Maturity Product Type Interest rate and currency swaps, interest rate options, credit derivatives and other fixed income securities contracts Foreign exchange forward contracts and options Equity securities contracts (including equity swaps, warrants and options) Commodity forwards, options and swaps Total (1) Less than 1 Cross−Maturity and Cash Collateral Netting(1) Over 5 (dollars in millions) 1−3 3−5 5,236 10,449 $ 10,704 1,133 $ 11,752 142 $ 42,911 67 6,875 6,370 3,157 7,538 872 5,522 764 2,215 $ 28,930 $ 22,532 $ 18,288 $ 45,957 $ $ (37,028) (4,043) Net Exposure Post−Cash Collateral Net Exposure Post− Collateral $ $ (3,493) (6,731) $ (51,295) 33,575 7,748 8,175 14,914 $ 64,412 29,877 6,327 2,832 12,067 $ 51,103 Amounts represent the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity and product categories. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within the maturity category, where appropriate. Cash collateral received is netted on a counterparty basis, provided legal right of offset exists. 95 G-102 Table of Contents OTC Derivative Products—Financial Instruments Sold, Not Yet Purchased(1) Years to Maturity Product Type Less than 1 Interest rate and currency swaps, interest rate options, credit derivatives and other fixed income securities contracts Foreign exchange forward contracts and options Equity securities contracts (including equity swaps, warrants and options) Commodity forwards, options and swaps $ Total (1) (2) 1−3 3−5 Over 5 (dollars in millions) Cross−Maturity and Cash Collateral Netting(2) Total 6,573 10,868 6,375 7,762 $ 8,749 1,043 4,952 7,821 $ 11,154 117 2,129 2,273 $ 29,487 380 1,746 1,743 $ (37,138) (3,038) (3,453) (5,946) $ 18,825 9,370 11,749 13,653 $ 31,578 $ 22,565 $ 15,673 $ 33,356 $ (49,575) $ 53,597 Since these amounts are liabilities of the Company, they do not result in credit exposures. Amounts represent the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity and product categories. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within the maturity category, where appropriate. Cash collateral paid is netted on a counterparty basis, provided legal right of offset exists. The Company’s derivatives (both listed and OTC) at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 are summarized in the table below, showing the fair value of the related assets and liabilities by product: At November 30, 2007 At November 30, 2006 Assets Liabilities Assets Liabilities (dollars in millions) Product Type Interest rate and currency swaps, interest rate options, credit derivatives and other fixed income securities contracts Foreign exchange forward contracts and options Equity securities contracts (including equity swaps, warrants and options) Commodity forwards, options and swaps Total $33,804 7,755 19,913 15,531 $ 19,515 9,372 27,887 14,830 $19,444 7,325 16,705 11,969 $ 15,688 7,725 23,155 10,923 $77,003 $ 71,604 $55,443 $ 57,491 Each category of derivative products in the above tables includes a variety of instruments, which can differ substantially in their characteristics. Instruments in each category can be denominated in U.S. dollars or in one or more non−U.S. currencies. The Company determines the fair values recorded in the above tables using various pricing models. For a discussion of fair value as it affects the consolidated financial statements, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Critical Accounting Policies” in Part I, Item 2 and Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements. Country Exposure. The Company monitors its credit exposure to individual countries. Credit exposure to a country arises from the Company’s primary lending activities and derivatives activities in a country. At November 30, 2007, based on the domicile of the counterparty, approximately 7% of the Company’s credit exposure (for credit exposure arising from corporate loans and lending commitments as discussed above and current exposure arising from the Company’s OTC derivatives contracts) was to emerging markets, and no one emerging market country accounted for more than 2% of the Company’s credit exposure. The Company defines emerging markets to include generally all countries that are not members of the Organization for Economic Co−operation and Development and includes as well the Czech Republic, Hungary, Korea, Mexico, Poland, the Slovak Republic and Turkey but excludes countries rated AA and Aa2 or above by Standard & Poor’s and Moody’s Investors Service, respectively. 96 G-103 Table of Contents Industry Exposure. The Company also monitors its credit exposure to individual industries. At November 30, 2007, the Company’s material credit exposure (for credit exposure arising from corporate loans and lending commitments as discussed above and current exposure arising from the Company’s OTC derivatives contracts) was to entities engaged in the following industries: utilities, financial institutions, consumer−related entities, banks, telecommunications, sovereign and energy−related entities. Global Wealth Management Group Activities. Margin Lending. Customer margin accounts, the primary source of retail credit exposure, are collateralized in accordance with internal and regulatory guidelines. The Company monitors required margin levels and established credit limits daily and, pursuant to such guidelines, requires customers to deposit additional collateral, or reduce positions, when necessary. Factors considered in the review of margin loans are the amount of the loan, the intended purpose, the degree of leverage being employed in the account, and overall evaluation of the portfolio to ensure proper diversification or, in the case of concentrated positions, possible hedging strategies. Additionally, transactions relating to concentrated or restricted positions require a review of any legal impediments to liquidation of the underlying collateral. Underlying collateral for margin loans is reviewed with respect to the liquidity of the proposed collateral positions, valuation of securities, historic trading range, volatility analysis and an evaluation of industry concentrations. At November 30, 2007, there were approximately $7.3 billion of customer margin loans outstanding. Non−purpose Securities−Based Lending: Non−purpose securities−based lending allows clients to borrow money against the value of qualifying securities for any suitable purpose other than purchasing, trading, or carrying marketable securities or refinancing margin debt. The Company establishes approved lines and advance rates against qualifying securities and monitors limits daily and, pursuant to such guidelines, requires customers to deposit additional collateral, or reduce debt positions, when necessary. Factors considered in the review of non−purpose securities−based lending are amount of the loan, the degree of concentrated or restricted positions, and the overall evaluation of the portfolio to ensure proper diversification or, in the case of concentrated positions, possible hedging strategies. Underlying collateral for non−purpose securities−based loans is reviewed with respect to the liquidity of the proposed collateral positions, historic trading range, volatility analysis and an evaluation of industry concentrations. Commercial Lending. Global Wealth Management Group provides structured credit facilities to high net worth individuals and their small and medium−size domestic businesses through Morgan Stanley Commercial Financial Services, Inc. (“CFS”). CFS’ suite of products includes working capital lines of credit, revolving lines of credit, standby letters of credit, term loans and commercial real estate mortgages. Clients are required to submit a credit application and financial statements to CFS’ centralized credit processing platform. CFS’ underwriting professionals recommend a lending structure following an analysis of the borrower, the guarantor, the collateral, cash flow, liquidity, leverage and credit history. For standard transactions, credit requests are approved via signature of independent credit officers, and where transactions are of size and higher complexity, approval is secured through a formal loan committee chaired by independent credit professionals. The facility is risk rated and upon credit approval is moved to the general portfolio where it is monitored periodically through account management, covenants compliance certificates, and spot and cycle audits. Consumer Lending Activities. With respect to first mortgages and second mortgages within the Company’s Institutional Securities business segment, including home equity lines of credit (“mortgage lending”), a loan evaluation process is adopted within a framework of credit underwriting policies and collateral valuation. The Company’s underwriting policy is designed to ensure that all borrowers pass an assessment of capacity and willingness to pay, which includes an analysis of applicable industry standard credit scoring models (e.g., FICO scores), debt ratios and reserves of the borrower. Loan−to−collateral value ratios are determined based on independent third−party property appraisal/valuations, and security lien position is established through title/ownership reports. As part of the mortgage 97 G-104 Table of Contents lending business strategy, almost all loans are sold in the secondary market through securitizations and whole loan sales, while almost all servicing rights are retained. These sales and securitizations pass the risk of credit loss onto the purchaser/investor. Operational Risk. Operational risk refers to the risk of financial or other loss, or potential damage to a firm’s reputation, resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people, systems or from external events (e.g., external or internal fraud, legal and compliance risks, damage to physical assets, etc.). The Company may incur operational risk across the full scope of its business activities, including revenue generating activities (e.g., sales and trading) and support functions (e.g., information technology and facilities management). Legal and compliance risk is included in the scope of operational risk and is discussed below under “Legal Risk.” The goal of the Company’s operational risk management framework is to establish firm−wide operational risk standards related to risk measurement, monitoring and management. Operational risk policies are designed to reduce the likelihood and/or impact of operational incidents as well as to mitigate legal, regulatory and reputational risks. As a foundation for the Basel II Advanced Measurement Approach, an enhanced risk−based capital model has been developed for the calculation of capital related to operational risk. This model encompasses both quantitative and qualitative elements, including internal and external operational incidents, metrics, risk and control self−assessments and scenario analysis. The Company will seek to obtain approval from the SEC to implement the Advanced Measurement Approach for Operational Risk Capital requirements in 2008. The Company’s Operational Risk Manager (“ORM”) oversees, monitors, measures, analyzes and reports on operational risk across the Company. The ORM is independent of the business segments and is supported by the Firm−wide Operational Risk Department (“ORD”). The ORM is also responsible for facilitating, designing, implementing and monitoring the Firm−wide operational risk program. The ORD works with the business segments and Control Groups to help ensure a transparent, consistent and comprehensive framework for managing operational risk within each area and across the Company, globally. Primary responsibility for the management of operational risk is with the business segments, the Control Groups, and the business managers therein. The business managers, generally, maintain processes and controls designed to identify, assess, manage, mitigate and report operational risk. As new products and business activities are developed and processes are designed and modified, operational risks are considered. Each business segment has a designated operational risk coordinator. In addition, business segment risk committees review operational risk matters and/or reports on a regular basis. Each Control Group also has a designated operational risk coordinator, or equivalent, and a forum for discussing operational risk matters and/or reports with senior management. Oversight of business segment operational risk is provided by business segment risk committees, a Firm−wide operational risk committee and, ultimately, senior management through the Firm Risk Committee. Business Continuity Management is an ongoing program of analysis and planning that ensures a recovery strategy and required resources for the resumption of critical business functions following a disaster or other business interruption. Disaster recovery plans are in place for critical facilities and resources on a Company−wide basis, and redundancies are built into the systems as deemed appropriate. The key components of the Company’s disaster recovery plans include: crisis management; business segment recovery plans; applications/data recovery; work area recovery; and other elements addressing management, analysis, training and testing. The Company maintains an information security program that coordinates the management of information security risks and satisfies regulatory requirements. Information security procedures are designed to protect the Company’s information assets against unauthorized disclosure, modification or misuse. These procedures cover a broad range of areas, including: application system entitlement; data protection; internet and intranet access, communications and usage; and mobile and portable information usage. The Company has also established policies, procedures and technologies to protect its computer and other assets from unauthorized access. 98 G-105 Table of Contents The Company utilizes the services of external vendors in connection with the Company’s ongoing operations. These may include, for example, outsourced processing and support functions and consulting and other professional services. The Company manages its exposures to the quality of these services through a variety of means, including service level and other contractual agreements, service and quality reviews, and ongoing monitoring of the vendors’ performance. It is anticipated that the use of these services will continue and possibly increase in the future. Legal Risk. Legal risk includes the risk of non−compliance with applicable legal and regulatory requirements and standards. Legal risk also includes contractual and commercial risk such as the risk that a counterparty’s performance obligations will be unenforceable. The Company is generally subject to extensive regulation in the different jurisdictions in which it conducts its business (see “Business—Regulation” in Part I, Item 1). The Company has established procedures based on legal and regulatory requirements on a worldwide basis that are designed to foster compliance with applicable statutory and regulatory requirements. The Company, principally through the Legal and Compliance Division, also has established procedures that are designed to require that the Company’s policies relating to conduct, ethics and business practices are followed globally. In connection with its businesses, the Company has and continuously develops various procedures addressing issues such as regulatory capital requirements, sales and trading practices, new products, potential conflicts of interest, structured transactions, use and safekeeping of customer funds and securities, credit granting, money laundering, privacy and recordkeeping. In addition, the Company has established procedures to mitigate the risk that a counterparty’s performance obligations will be unenforceable, including consideration of counterparty legal authority and capacity, adequacy of legal documentation, the permissibility of a transaction under applicable law and whether applicable bankruptcy or insolvency laws limit or alter contractual remedies. The legal and regulatory focus on the financial services industry presents a continuing business challenge for the Company. 99 G-106 Table of Contents Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data. REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Morgan Stanley: We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition of Morgan Stanley and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of November 30, 2007 and 2006, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, cash flows and changes in shareholders’ equity for each of the three years in the period ended November 30, 2007. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Morgan Stanley and subsidiaries as of November 30, 2007 and 2006, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended November 30, 2007, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. As discussed in Note 2 and Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements, in fiscal 2005, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123(R), “Share−Based Payment”, and effective December 1, 2005, Morgan Stanley changed its accounting policy for recognition of equity awards granted to retirement−eligible employees. As discussed in Note 24 to the consolidated financial statements, effective August 31, 2006, Morgan Stanley elected application of Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108, “Considering the Effects of Prior Year Misstatements when Quantifying Misstatements in Current Year Financial Statements”. As discussed in Note 2 and Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements, effective December 1, 2006, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 157, “Fair Value Measurement” and Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities—Including an amendment of FASB Statement No. 115”. Also, as discussed in Note 2 and Note 19 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company adopted Statement Financial Accounting Standards No. 158, “Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R)”. We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of November 30, 2007, based on the criteria established in “Internal Control—Integrated Framework” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated January 28, 2008, expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. /s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP New York, New York January 28, 2008 100 G-107 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition (dollars in millions, except share data) Assets Cash and cash equivalents Cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements (including securities at fair value of $31,354 in 2007 and $8,648 in 2006) Financial instruments owned, at fair value (approximately $131 billion in 2007 and $125 billion in 2006 were pledged to various parties): U.S. government and agency securities Other sovereign government obligations Corporate and other debt Corporate equities Derivative contracts Investments Physical commodities Total financial instruments owned Securities received as collateral, at fair value Collateralized agreements: Securities purchased under agreements to resell Securities borrowed Receivables: Consumer loans (net of allowances of $831 in 2006) Customers Brokers, dealers and clearing organizations Other loans Fees, interest and other Other investments Premises, equipment and software costs, at cost (net of accumulated depreciation of $3,449 in 2007 and $3,645 in 2006) Goodwill Intangible assets (net of accumulated amortization of $175 in 2007 and $109 in 2006) (includes $428 at fair value in 2007) Other assets Total assets See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 101 November 30, 2007 November 30, 2006 $ $ 25,598 20,606 61,608 29,565 23,887 21,606 147,724 87,377 77,003 14,270 3,096 39,352 27,305 158,864 86,058 55,443 4,725 3,031 374,963 82,229 374,778 64,588 126,887 239,994 175,787 299,631 — 76,352 16,011 11,629 8,320 4,524 22,915 82,923 7,633 11,908 8,937 3,232 4,372 3,024 4,086 2,792 1,047 8,851 651 11,160 $ 1,045,409 $ 1,121,192 G-108 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition—(Continued) (dollars in millions, except share data) Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings (includes $3,068 at fair value in 2007) Deposits (includes $3,769 at fair value in 2007) Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased, at fair value: U.S. government and agency securities Other sovereign government obligations Corporate and other debt Corporate equities Derivative contracts Physical commodities Total financial instruments sold, not yet purchased Obligation to return securities received as collateral, at fair value Collateralized financings: Securities sold under agreements to repurchase Securities loaned Other secured financings, at fair value Payables: Customers Brokers, dealers and clearing organizations Interest and dividends Other liabilities and accrued expenses Long−term borrowings (includes $38,392 at fair value in 2007) Capital Units November 30, 2007 November 30, 2006 $ $ 34,495 31,179 8,221 15,627 7,592 30,899 71,604 398 26,168 28,961 10,336 59,399 57,491 764 134,341 82,229 183,119 64,588 162,840 110,423 27,772 267,566 150,257 45,556 203,453 10,454 1,724 24,606 190,624 134,907 7,635 4,746 24,975 144,978 1,014,140 1,085,762 — Commitments and contingencies Shareholders’ equity: Preferred stock Common stock, $0.01 par value; Shares authorized: 3,500,000,000 in 2007 and 2006; Shares issued: 1,211,701,552 in 2007 and 2006; Shares outstanding: 1,056,289,659 in 2007 and 1,048,877,006 in 2006 Paid−in capital Retained earnings Employee stock trust Accumulated other comprehensive loss Common stock held in treasury, at cost, $0.01 par value; 155,411,893 shares in 2007 and 162,824,546 shares in 2006 Common stock issued to employee trust Total shareholders’ equity Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 102 29,092 28,343 66 1,100 1,100 12 1,902 38,045 5,569 (199) 12 2,213 41,422 4,315 (35) (9,591) (5,569) (9,348) (4,315) 31,269 35,364 $ 1,045,409 $ 1,121,192 G-109 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY Consolidated Statements of Income (dollars in millions, except share and per share data) Fiscal Year 2006 2007 Revenues: Investment banking Principal transactions: Trading Investments Commissions Asset management, distribution and administration fees Interest and dividends Other $ 6,368 $ 4,755 2005 $ 3,843 3,206 3,262 4,682 6,519 60,083 1,208 11,805 1,807 3,770 5,238 42,776 585 7,377 1,128 3,331 4,915 25,987 496 85,328 57,302 70,736 40,897 47,077 23,552 28,026 29,839 23,525 Non−interest expenses: Compensation and benefits Occupancy and equipment Brokerage, clearing and exchange fees Information processing and communications Marketing and business development Professional services Other September 11 th related insurance recoveries, net 16,552 1,130 1,656 1,193 813 2,112 1,129 — 13,986 912 1,305 1,089 643 1,889 912 — 10,749 957 1,069 1,056 576 1,622 1,431 (251) Total non−interest expenses 24,585 20,736 17,209 3,441 47 831 9,103 40 2,728 6,316 311 1,473 2,563 6,335 4,532 1,024 378 1,666 529 559 201 646 — 1,137 — 358 49 Total revenues Interest expense Net revenues Income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees, income taxes and cumulative effect of accounting change, net Losses from unconsolidated investees Provision for income taxes Income from continuing operations before cumulative effect of accounting change, net Discontinued operations: Net gain from discontinued operations Provision for income taxes Net gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Net income $ 3,209 $ 7,472 $ 4,939 Preferred stock dividend requirements $ 68 $ 19 $ — Earnings applicable to common shareholders $ 3,141 $ 7,453 $ 4,939 $ 2.49 0.64 — $ 6.25 1.13 — $ 4.32 0.33 0.05 $ 3.13 $ 7.38 $ 4.70 $ 2.37 0.61 — $ 5.99 1.08 — $ 4.19 0.33 0.05 $ 2.98 $ 7.07 $ 4.57 Earnings per basic common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per basic common share Earnings per diluted common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per diluted common share Average common shares outstanding: Basic Diluted 1,001,878,651 1,010,254,255 1,049,896,047 1,054,240,169 1,054,796,062 1,079,936,315 See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 103 G-110 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (dollars in millions) 2007 Fiscal Year 2006 2005 Net income Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax: Foreign currency translation adjustments(1) Net change in cash flow hedges(2) Minimum pension liability adjustment(3) $3,209 $7,472 $4,939 Comprehensive income $3,253 (1) (2) (3) 65 19 (40) 104 53 (2) $7,627 Amounts are net of provision for (benefit from) income taxes of $35 million, $56 million and $(48) million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Amounts are net of provision for (benefit from) income taxes of $10 million, $29 million and $(38) million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Amounts are net of provision for (benefit from) income taxes of $(16) million, $(5) million and $11 million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 104 (89) (70) 25 $4,805 G-111 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (dollars in millions) 2007 CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES Net income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used for operating activities: Losses from unconsolidated investees Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Deferred income taxes Compensation payable in common stock and options Depreciation and amortization Provision for consumer loan losses Lease adjustment Insurance settlement Gain on sale of Quilter Holdings Ltd. Aircraft−related charges Other−than−temporary impairment charge Changes in assets and liabilities: Cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements Financial instruments owned, net of financial instruments sold, not yet purchased Securities borrowed Securities loaned Receivables and other assets Payables and other liabilities Securities purchased under agreements to resell Securities sold under agreements to repurchase $ 3,209 47 — (2,046) 1,941 475 478 — (38) (168) — 437 Fiscal Year 2006 2005 $ 7,472 $ 4,939 40 — 111 1,923 876 756 — — — 125 — 311 (49) (999) 820 815 878 109 (251) — 509 — (32,040) (30,573) 59,637 (39,834) 1,786 71,057 48,900 (105,361) 10,592 (78,370) (55,390) 29,803 (41,929) 33,971 (1,075) 30,292 (3,388) (24,521) (35,892) 23,308 (1,598) (815) (51,204) 55,676 Net cash used for operating activities (22,093) (60,803) (31,352) CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES Net (payments for) proceeds from: Office facilities and aircraft under operating leases Business acquisitions, net of cash acquired Sale of Quilter Holdings Ltd. Net principal disbursed on consumer loans Sales of consumer loans Sale of interest in POSIT Insurance settlement Purchases of securities available for sale Sales of securities available for sale (1,469) (1,169) 476 (4,776) 5,301 — — (14,073) 4,272 993 (2,706) — (12,164) 11,532 — — — — (540) (323) — (14,093) 10,525 90 220 — — Net cash used for investing activities (11,438) (2,345) (4,121) 8,274 265 (859) (24,231) 23,099 281 (2,422) — 546 22,022 9,647 144 (5,183) — 1,044 16,487 4,886 355 — 927 74,540 1,097 643 47,849 — 327 35,768 (33,120) (66) (3,753) (5,615) (1,219) (20,643) — (3,376) — (1,167) (16,735) — (3,693) — (1,180) Net cash provided by financing activities 38,523 54,340 32,076 Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents, at beginning of period 4,992 20,606 (8,808) 29,414 (3,397) 32,811 CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES Net proceeds from (payments for): Short−term borrowings MSCI Inc. initial public offering Derivatives financing activities Other secured financings Deposits Tax benefits associated with stock−based awards Net proceeds from: Issuance of preferred stock Issuance of common stock Issuance of long−term borrowings Payments for: Repayments of long−term borrowings Redemption of Capital Units Repurchases of common stock Cash distribution in connection with the Discover Spin−off Cash dividends Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period $ 25,598 SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION Cash payments for interest were $59,955 million, $39,667 million and $23,415 million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Cash payments for income taxes were $3,404 million, $3,115 million and $1,536 million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 105 $ 20,606 $ 29,414 G-112 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity (dollars in millions) BALANCE AT NOVEMBER 30, 2004 Net income Dividends Issuance of common stock Repurchases of common stock Compensation payable in common stock and options Tax benefits associated with stock−based awards Employee tax withholdings and other Net change in cash flow hedges Minimum pension liability adjustment Foreign currency translation adjustments Preferred Stock Common Stock Paid−in Capital Retained Earnings $ $ 12 — — — — — — — — — — $ 2,088 — — (780) — 669 317 95 — — — $ 31,426 4,939 (1,180) — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — Common Stock Held in Treasury at Cost Common Stock Issued to Employee Trust (56) — — — — — — — (70) 25 (89) $ (6,614) — — 1,107 (3,693) 1,437 — (451) — — — $ Employee Stock Trust Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) $ $ 3,824 — — — — (764) — — — — — Total (2,474) — — — — (586) — — — — — $28,206 4,939 (1,180) 327 (3,693) 756 317 (356) (70) 25 (89) BALANCE AT NOVEMBER 30, 2005 Adjustment to opening shareholders’ equity Net income Dividends Issuance of preferred stock Issuance of common stock Repurchases of common stock Compensation payable in common stock and options Tax benefits associated with stock−based awards Employee tax withholdings and other Net change in cash flow hedges Minimum pension liability adjustment Foreign currency translation adjustments — — — — 1,100 — — — — — — — — 12 — — — — — — — — — — — — 2,389 34 — — — (1,949) — 1,486 72 181 — — — 35,185 (68) 7,472 (1,167) — — — — — — — — — 3,060 — — — — — — 1,255 — — — — — (190) — — — — — — — — — 53 (2) 104 (8,214) — — — — 2,592 (3,376) 5 — (355) — — — (3,060) — — — — — — (1,255) — — — — — 29,182 (34) 7,472 (1,167) 1,100 643 (3,376) 1,491 72 (174) 53 (2) 104 BALANCE AT NOVEMBER 30, 2006 Fair value adjustment Net income Dividends Issuance of common stock Repurchases of common stock Compensation payable in common stock and options Tax benefits associated with stock−based awards Employee tax withholdings and other Net change in cash flow hedges Minimum pension liability adjustment SFAS No. 158 pension adjustment Foreign currency translation adjustments MSCI Inc. initial public offering Discover Spin−off 1,100 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 12 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 2,213 — — — (1,555) — 1,710 280 (15) — — — — 239 (970) 41,422 186 3,209 (1,219) — — 5 — — — — — — — (5,558) 4,315 — — — — — 1,254 — — — — — — — — (35) — — — — — — — — 19 (40) (208) 65 — — (9,348) — — — 2,482 (3,753) 376 — (318) — — — — — 970 (4,315) — — — — — (1,254) — — — — — — — — 35,364 186 3,209 (1,219) 927 (3,753) 2,091 280 (333) 19 (40) (208) 65 239 (5,558) (199) $ (9,591) BALANCE AT NOVEMBER 30, 2007 $ 1,100 $ 12 $ 1,902 $ 38,045 $ 5,569 See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. 106 $ $ (5,569) $31,269 G-113 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Introduction and Basis of Presentation. The Company. Morgan Stanley (the “Company”) is a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of its business segments—Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group and Asset Management. A summary of the activities of each of the Company’s business segments is as follows: Institutional Securities includes capital raising; financial advisory services, including advice on mergers and acquisitions, restructurings, real estate and project finance; corporate lending; sales, trading, financing and market−making activities in equity and fixed income securities and related products, including foreign exchange and commodities; benchmark indices and risk management analytics; research; and investment activities. Global Wealth Management Group provides brokerage and investment advisory services covering various investment alternatives; financial and wealth planning services; annuity and other insurance products; credit and other lending products; cash management services; retirement services; and trust and fiduciary services. Asset Management provides global asset management products and services in equity, fixed income, alternative investments, which includes hedge funds and fund of funds, and merchant banking, which includes real estate, private equity and infrastructure, to institutional and retail clients through proprietary and third−party retail distribution channels, intermediaries and the Company’s institutional distribution channel. Asset Management also engages in investment activities. Discontinued Operations. Discover. On June 30, 2007, the Company completed the spin−off (the “Discover Spin−off”) of its business segment Discover Financial Services (“DFS”). The results of DFS prior to the Discover Spin−off are reported as discontinued operations for all periods presented. Quilter Holdings Ltd. The results of Quilter Holdings Ltd. (“Quilter”) are reported as discontinued operations for all periods presented through its sale on February 28, 2007. The results of Quilter were formerly included in the Global Wealth Management Group business segment. Aircraft Leasing. The results of the Company’s aircraft leasing business are reported as discontinued operations for all periods presented through its sale on March 24, 2006. The results of the Company’s aircraft leasing business were formerly included in the Institutional Securities business segment. See Note 22 for additional information on discontinued operations. Basis of Financial Information. The consolidated financial statements for the 12 months ended November 30, 2007 (“fiscal 2007”), November 30, 2006 (“fiscal 2006”) and November 30, 2005 (“fiscal 2005”) are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S., which require the Company to make estimates and assumptions regarding the valuations of certain financial instruments, the outcome of litigation, tax and other matters that affect the consolidated financial statements and related disclosures. The Company believes that the estimates utilized in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are prudent and reasonable. Actual results could differ materially from these estimates. The Company, in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108, “Considering the Effects of Prior Year Misstatements when Quantifying Misstatements in Current Year Financial Statements” (“SAB 108”), adjusted its opening retained earnings for fiscal 2006 and financial results for the first two quarters of fiscal 2006 to reflect a 107 G-114 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) change in its hedge accounting for certain securities under Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 133, “Accounting for Derivatives Instruments and Hedging Activities,” as amended (“SFAS No. 133”). The same periods also reflect the adjustments of two compensation and benefit accruals. See Note 24 for additional information on SAB 108. All material intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated. Consolidation. The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company, its wholly owned subsidiaries, other entities in which the Company has a controlling financial interest and certain variable interest entities (“VIE”). For entities where (1) the total equity investment at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance its activities independently and (2) the equity holders bear the economic residual risks of the entity and have the right to make decisions about the entity’s activities, the Company consolidates those entities it controls through a majority voting interest or otherwise. For entities that do not meet these criteria, commonly known as variable interest entities, the Company consolidates those entities where the Company is deemed to be the primary beneficiary when it absorbs a majority of the expected losses or a majority of the expected residual returns, or both, of such entities. Notwithstanding the above, certain securitization vehicles, commonly known as qualifying special purpose entities, are generally not consolidated by the Company if they meet certain criteria regarding the types of assets and derivatives they may hold, the types of sales they may engage in and the range of discretion they may exercise in connection with the assets they hold. For investments in entities in which the Company does not have a controlling financial interest but has significant influence over operating and financial decisions, the Company generally applies the equity method of accounting, except in instances where the Company has elected to fair value certain eligible investments (see Note 3). Equity and partnership interests held by entities qualifying for accounting purposes as investment companies are carried at fair value. The Company’s U.S. and international subsidiaries include Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated (“MS&Co.”), Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (“MSIP”), Morgan Stanley Japan Securities Co., Ltd. (“MSJS”) and Morgan Stanley Investment Advisors Inc. On April 1, 2007, the Company merged Morgan Stanley DW Inc. (“MSDWI”) into MS&Co. Upon completion of the merger, the surviving entity, MS&Co., became the Company’s principal U.S. broker−dealer. Income Statement Presentation. The Company, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. In connection with the delivery of the various products and services to clients, the Company manages its revenues and related expenses in the aggregate. As such, when assessing the performance of its businesses, the Company considers its principal trading, investment banking, commissions, and interest and dividend income, along with the associated interest expense, as one integrated activity for each of the Company’s separate businesses. The Company’s cost infrastructure supporting its businesses varies by activity. In some cases, these costs are directly attributable to one line of business, and, in other cases, such costs relate to multiple businesses. As such, when assessing the performance of its businesses, the Company does not consider these costs separately but rather assesses performance in the aggregate along with the related revenues. 108 G-115 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Therefore, the Company’s pricing structure considers various items, including the level of expenses incurred directly and indirectly to support the cost infrastructure, the risk it incurs in connection with a transaction, the overall client relationship and the availability in the market for the particular product and/or service. Accordingly, the Company does not manage or capture the costs associated with the products or services sold or its general and administrative costs by revenue line, in total or by product. 2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies. Revenue Recognition. Investment Banking. Underwriting revenues and fees from mergers, acquisitions and advisory assignments are recorded when services for the transactions are determined to be completed, generally as set forth under the terms of the engagement. Transaction−related expenses, primarily consisting of legal, travel and other costs directly associated with the transaction, are deferred and recognized in the same period as the related investment banking transaction revenue. Underwriting revenues are presented net of related expenses. Non−reimbursed expenses associated with advisory transactions are recorded within Non−interest expenses. Commissions. The Company generates commissions from executing and clearing customer transactions on stock, options and futures markets. Commission revenues are recorded in the accounts on trade date. Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees. Asset management, distribution and administration fees are recognized over the relevant contract period, generally quarterly or annually. In certain management fee arrangements, the Company is entitled to receive performance−based fees (also referred to as incentive fees) when the return on assets under management exceeds certain benchmark returns or other performance targets. In such arrangements, performance fee revenue is accrued (or reversed) quarterly based on measuring account/fund performance to date versus the performance benchmark stated in the investment management agreement. Financial Instruments and Fair Value. A significant portion of the Company’s financial instruments is carried at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings each period. A description of the Company’s policies regarding fair value measurement and its application to these financial instruments follows. Financial Instruments Measured at Fair Value. All of the instruments within Financial instruments owned and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased, are measured at fair value, either through the fair value option election (discussed below) or as required by other accounting pronouncements. These instruments primarily represent the Company’s trading and investment activities and include both cash and derivative products. In addition, Securities received as collateral and Obligation to return securities received as collateral are measured at fair value as required by other accounting pronouncements. Additionally, certain Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings (primarily structured notes), certain Deposits, Other secured financings and certain Long−term borrowings (primarily structured debt) are measured at fair value through the fair value option election. Gains and losses on all of these instruments carried at fair value are reflected in Principal transactions—trading revenues or Principal transactions—investment revenues in the consolidated statements of income. Interest income and expense and dividend income are recorded within the consolidated statements of income depending on the nature of the instrument and related market conventions. When interest and dividends are included as a component of the instruments’ fair value, interest and dividends are included within Principal transactions—trading revenues. Otherwise, they are included within Interest and dividend income or Interest expense. Fair Value Option. The Company adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities” (“SFAS No. 159”), effective December 1, 2006. SFAS No. 159 provides entities the option to measure certain financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value with changes 109 G-116 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) in fair value recognized in earnings each period. SFAS No. 159 permits the fair value option election on an instrument−by−instrument basis at initial recognition of an asset or liability or upon an event that gives rise to a new basis of accounting for that instrument. The Company applies the fair value option for certain eligible instruments, including certain loans and loan commitments, certain equity method investments, certain structured notes, certain certificates of deposits and other secured financings. See “Accounting Developments” herein for additional information regarding the Company’s adoption of SFAS No. 159. Fair Value Measurement—Definition and Hierarchy. The Company adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements” (“SFAS No. 157”), effective December 1, 2006. See “Accounting Developments” herein for additional information regarding the Company’s adoption of SFAS No. 157. Under this standard, fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (i.e., the “exit price”) in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. In determining fair value, the Company uses various valuation approaches, including market, income and/or cost approaches. SFAS No. 157 establishes a hierarchy for inputs used in measuring fair value that maximizes the use of observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs by requiring that the most observable inputs be used when available. Observable inputs are inputs that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from sources independent of the Company. Unobservable inputs are inputs that reflect the Company’s assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels based on the reliability of inputs as follows: • Level 1—Valuations based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the Company has the ability to access. Valuation adjustments and block discounts are not applied to Level 1 instruments. Since valuations are based on quoted prices that are readily and regularly available in an active market, valuation of these products does not entail a significant degree of judgment. Assets and liabilities utilizing Level 1 inputs include exchange−traded equity securities and listed derivatives that are actively traded, most U.S. Government securities and certain other sovereign government obligations. • Level 2—Valuations based on quoted prices in markets that are not active or for which all significant inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly. Assets and liabilities utilizing Level 2 inputs include: exchange−traded equity securities and listed derivatives that are not actively traded; most over−the−counter (“OTC”) derivatives; restricted stock; corporate and municipal bonds; certain corporate loans and loan commitments; certain high−yield debt; certain residential and commercial mortgage loans; certain mortgage−backed securities (“MBS”), asset−backed securities (“ABS”), and collateralized debt obligation (“CDO”) securities; retained interests in certain securitization transactions; structured notes; physical commodities; and mortgage servicing rights. • Level 3—Valuations based on inputs that are unobservable and significant to the overall fair value measurement. Assets and liabilities utilizing Level 3 inputs include: certain corporate loans and loan commitments; certain commercial whole loans; certain mortgage loans; certain high−yield debt, distressed debt (i.e., securities of issuers encountering financial difficulties, including bankruptcy or insolvency); certain MBS, ABS and CDO securities; retained interests in certain securitization transactions; investments in real estate funds; private equity investments; and complex over−the−counter derivatives (including certain foreign currency options; long−dated commodity options and swaps; certain mortgage−related credit default swaps; derivative interests in mortgage−related CDOs; and basket credit default swaps). 110 G-117 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The availability of observable inputs can vary from product to product and is affected by a wide variety of factors, including, for example, the type of product, whether the product is new and not yet established in the marketplace, and other characteristics particular to the transaction. To the extent that valuation is based on models or inputs that are less observable or unobservable in the market, the determination of fair value requires more judgment. Accordingly, the degree of judgment exercised by the Company in determining fair value is greatest for instruments categorized in Level 3. In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy. In such cases, for disclosure purposes the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the fair value measurement in its entirety falls is determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. Fair value is a market−based measure considered from the perspective of a market participant who holds the asset or owes the liability rather than an entity−specific measure. Therefore, even when market assumptions are not readily available, the Company’s own assumptions are set to reflect those that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability at the measurement date. The Company uses prices and inputs that are current as of the measurement date, including during periods of market dislocation. In periods of market dislocation, the observability of prices and inputs may be reduced for many instruments. This condition could cause an instrument to be reclassified from Level 1 to Level 2 or Level 2 to Level 3 (see Note 3). Valuation Techniques. Many cash and OTC contracts have bid and ask prices that can be observed in the marketplace. Bid prices reflect the highest price that the Company and others are willing to pay for an asset. Ask prices represent the lowest price that the Company and others are willing to accept for an asset. For financial instruments whose inputs are based on bid−ask prices, the Company does not require that fair value always be a predetermined point in the bid−ask range. The Company’s policy is to allow for mid−market pricing and adjusting to the point within the bid−ask range that meets the Company’s best estimate of fair value. For offsetting positions in the same financial instrument, the same price within the bid−ask spread is used to measure both the long and short positions. Fair value for many cash and OTC contracts is derived using pricing models. Pricing models take into account the contract terms (including maturity) as well as multiple inputs, including, where applicable, commodity prices, equity prices, interest rate yield curves, credit curves, creditworthiness of the counterparty, option volatility and currency rates. In accordance with SFAS No. 157, the impact of the Company’s own credit spreads are also considered when measuring the fair value of liabilities, including OTC derivative contracts. Where appropriate, valuation adjustments are made to account for various factors, including bid−ask spreads, credit quality and market liquidity. These adjustments are applied on a consistent basis and are based upon observable inputs where available. OTC Derivative Contracts. OTC derivative contracts include forward, swap and option contracts related to interest rates, foreign currencies, credit standing of reference entities, equity prices or commodity prices. Depending on the product and the terms of the transaction, the fair value of OTC derivative products can be modeled using a series of techniques, including closed−form analytic formulae, such as the Black−Scholes option−pricing model, and simulation models or a combination thereof. Many pricing models do not entail material subjectivity because the methodologies employed do not necessitate significant judgment, and the pricing inputs are observed from actively quoted markets, as is the case for generic interest rate swap and option contracts. In the case of more established derivative products, the pricing models used by the Company are widely accepted by the financial services industry. A substantial majority of OTC derivative products valued by the Company using pricing models fall into this category and are categorized within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Other derivative products, typically the newest and most complex products, will require more judgment in the implementation of the valuation technique applied due to the complexity of the valuation assumptions and the reduced 111 G-118 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) observability of inputs. This includes certain credit default swaps where direct trading activity or quotes are unobservable. Derivative interests in mortgage−related CDOs, for which observability of external price data is extremely limited, are valued based on an evaluation of the market for similar positions as indicated by primary and secondary market activity in the cash CDO and synthetic CDO market. Each position is evaluated independently taking into consideration the underlying collateral performance and pricing, behavior of the tranche under various cumulative loss and prepayment scenarios, deal structures (e.g., non−amortizing reference obligations, call features) and liquidity. While these factors may be supported by historical and actual external observations, the determination of their value as it relates to specific positions nevertheless requires significant judgment. Mortgage−related credit default swaps are valued based on data from comparable credit instruments in the cash market and trades in comparable swaps as benchmarks, as prices and spreads for the specific credits subject to valuation tend to be of limited observability. For basket credit default swaps and CDO−squared positions, the correlation between reference credits is often a significant input into the pricing model, in addition to several other more observable inputs such as credit spread, interest and recovery rates. As the correlation input is unobservable for each specific swap, it is benchmarked to standardized proxy baskets for which external data are available. These instruments involve significant unobservable inputs and are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company trades various derivative structures with commodity underlyings. Depending on the type of structure, the model inputs generally include interest rate yield curves, commodity underlier spread curves, volatility of the underlying commodities and, in some cases, the correlation between these inputs. The fair value of these products is estimated using executed trades and broker and consensus data to provide values for the aforementioned inputs. Where these inputs are unobservable, relationships to observable commodities and data points, based on historic and/or implied observations, are employed as a technique to estimate the model input values. Commodity derivatives are generally categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy; in instances where significant inputs are unobservable, they are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Other Sovereign Government Obligations. The fair value of foreign sovereign government obligations is generally based on quoted prices in active markets. When quoted prices are not available, fair value is determined based on a valuation model that has as inputs interest rate yield curves, cross−currency basis index spreads, and country credit spreads for structures similar to the bond in terms of issuer, maturity and seniority. These bonds are generally categorized in Levels 1 or 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Municipal Bonds. The fair value of municipal bonds is estimated using recently executed transactions, market price quotations and pricing models that factor in, where applicable, interest rates, bond or credit default swap spreads and volatility. These bonds are generally categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Corporate Bonds. The fair value of corporate bonds is estimated using recently executed transactions, market price quotations (where observable), bond spreads or credit default swap spreads. The spread data used are for the same maturity as the bond. If the spread data do not reference the issuer, then data that reference a comparable issuer is used. When observable price quotations are not available, fair value is determined based on cash flow models with yield curves, bond or single name credit default swap spreads and recovery rates based on collateral values as key inputs. Corporate bonds are generally categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy; in instances where significant inputs are unobservable, they are categorized in Level 3 of the hierarchy. Corporate Loans and Loan Commitments. The fair value of corporate loans is estimated using recently executed transactions, market price quotations (where observable) and market observable credit default swap levels along with proprietary valuation models and default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable. The fair value of contingent corporate loan commitments is estimated by using executed transactions on comparable loans and the anticipated market price based on pricing indications from syndicate banks and customers. The valuation of these commitments also takes into account certain fee income. 112 G-119 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) While certain corporate loans, closed loan commitments and revolving loans are Level 2 instruments, certain other corporate loans and contingent corporate loan commitments are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Mortgage Loans. The valuation of mortgage loans depends upon the exit market for the loan. Loans not intended for securitization are valued based on the analysis of the underlying collateral performance, capital structure and market spreads for comparable positions as prices and/or spreads for specific credits tend to be unobservable. Where comparables do not exist, such loans are valued based on origination price and collateral performance (credit events) since origination. These loans are classified in Levels 2 or 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The Company also holds certain loan products and mortgage products with the intent to securitize them. When structuring of the related securitization is substantially complete, such that the value likely to be realized in a current transaction is consistent with the price that a securitization entity will pay to acquire these products, the Company marks them to the expected securitized value. Factors affecting the value of loan and mortgage products intended to be securitized include, but are not limited to, loan type, underlying property type and geographic location, loan interest rate, loan to value ratios, debt service coverage ratio, updated cumulative loan loss data, prepayment rates, yields, investor demand, any significant market volatility since the last securitization, and credit enhancement. While these valuation factors may be supported by historical and actual external observations, the determination of their value as it relates to specific positions may require significant judgment. These instruments are classified in Levels 2 or 3 of the fair value hierarchy. U.S. Agency Securities. U.S. agency securities include To−be−announced (“TBA”) securities and mortgage pass−through certificates. TBA securities are liquid and have quoted market prices. Fair value of mortgage pass−through certificates is determined via a simulation model, which considers different rate scenarios and historical activity to calculate a spread to the comparable TBA security. U.S. agency securities are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Commercial Mortgage−Backed Securities (“CMBS”) and Asset−Backed Securities (“ABS”). CMBS and ABS may be valued based on external price/spread data. When position−specific external price data are not observable, the valuation is based on prices of comparable bonds. Included in this category are certain interest−only securities, which, in the absence of market prices, are valued as a function of observable whole bond prices and cash flow values of principal−only bonds using current market assumptions at the measurement date. CMBS and ABS are categorized in Level 3 if external prices are unobservable; otherwise they are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Retained Interests in Securitization Transactions. The Company engages in securitization activities related to various types of loans and bonds. The Company may retain interests in securitized financial assets as one or more tranches of the securitization. To determine fair values, observable inputs are used if available. Observable inputs, however, may not be available for certain retained interests so the Company estimates fair value based on the present value of expected future cash flows using its best estimates of the key assumptions, including forecasted credit losses, prepayment rates, forward yield curves and discount rates commensurate with the risks involved. When there are no significant unobservable inputs, retained interests are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. When unobservable inputs are significant to the fair value measurement, albeit generally supportable by historical and actual benchmark data, retained interests are categorized in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Investments in Private Equity and Real Estate. The Company’s investments in private equity and real estate take the form of direct private equity investments and investment in private equity and real estate funds. The transaction price is used as the best estimate of fair value at inception. When evidence supports a change to the 113 G-120 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) carrying value from the transaction price, adjustments are made to reflect expected exit values. Ongoing reviews by Company management are based on an assessment of each underlying investment, incorporating valuations that consider the evaluation of financing and sale transactions with third parties, expected cash flows and market−based information, including comparable company transactions, performance multiples and changes in market outlook, among other factors. These nonpublic investments are included in Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy because they trade infrequently, and, therefore, the fair value is unobservable. Physical Commodities. The Company trades various physical commodities, including crude oil and refined products, metals and agricultural products. Fair value for physical commodities is determined using observable inputs, including broker quotations and published indices. Physical commodities are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Deposits. The fair value of certificates of deposit is estimated using third−party quotations. These deposits are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Structured Notes. The Company issues structured notes that have coupons or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities. Fair value of structured notes is estimated using valuation models described in this section for the derivative and debt features of the notes. These models incorporate observable inputs, including prices that the notes are linked to, interest rate yield curves, option volatility and currency rates. The impact of the Company’s own credit spreads also is included based on the Company’s observed secondary bond market spreads. Most structured notes are categorized in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Fair Value Measurement—Other. Prior to the adoption of SFAS No. 157, the Company followed the provisions of Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) Issue No. 02−3, “Issues Involved in Accounting for Derivative Contracts Held for Trading Purposes and Contracts Involved in Energy Trading and Risk Management Activities” (“EITF Issue No. 02−3”). Under EITF Issue No. 02−3, recognition of day one profit at inception of an OTC derivative contract was prohibited unless the fair value of the contract was based on a valuation technique incorporating observable market data. With the adoption of SFAS No. 157, the Company is no longer applying the revenue recognition criteria of EITF Issue No. 02−3. The fair value of OTC financial instruments, including derivative contracts related to financial instruments and commodities, is presented in the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition on a net−by−counterparty basis, when appropriate. Additionally, the Company nets fair value of cash collateral paid or received against its derivatives inventory under credit support annexes, which the Company views as conditional contracts, pursuant to legally enforceable master netting agreements. Hedge Accounting. The Company applies hedge accounting for hedges involving various derivative financial instruments and non−U.S. dollar−denominated debt used to hedge interest rate, foreign exchange and credit risk arising from assets and liabilities not held at fair value. These derivative financial instruments are included within Financial instruments owned—Derivative contracts or Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased—Derivative contracts in the consolidated statements of financial condition. The Company’s hedges are designated and qualify for accounting purposes as one of the following types of hedges: hedges of changes in fair value of assets and liabilities due to the risk being hedged (fair value hedges), hedges of the variability of future cash flows from floating rate assets and liabilities due to the risk being hedged (cash flow hedges) and hedges of net investments in foreign operations whose functional currency is different from the reporting currency of the parent company (net investment hedges). 114 G-121 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) For all hedges where hedge accounting is being applied, effectiveness testing and other procedures to ensure the ongoing validity of the hedges are performed at least monthly. The impact of hedge ineffectiveness on the consolidated statements of income, primarily related to fair value hedges, was a gain of $132 million during fiscal 2007. The amount excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness was immaterial. If a derivative is de−designated as a hedge, it is thereafter accounted for as a financial instrument used for trading. Fair Value Hedges—Interest Rate Risk. In the first quarter of fiscal 2007, the Company began using regression analysis to perform an ongoing prospective and retrospective assessment of the effectiveness of these hedging relationships (i.e., the Company applied the “long−haul” method of hedge accounting). A hedging relationship is deemed effective if the fair values of the hedging instrument (derivative) and the hedged item (debt liability) change inversely within a range of 80% to 125%. Previously, the Company’s designated fair value hedges consisted primarily of interest rate swaps designated as fair value hedges of changes in the benchmark interest rate of fixed rate borrowings, including both certificates of deposit and senior long−term borrowings. For these hedges, the Company ensured that the terms of the hedging instruments and hedged items matched and that other accounting criteria were met so that the hedges were assumed to have no ineffectiveness (i.e., the Company applied the “shortcut” method of hedge accounting). The Company also used interest rate swaps as fair value hedges of the benchmark interest rate risk of host contracts of equity−linked notes that contained embedded derivatives. For these hedging relationships, regression analysis was used for the prospective and retrospective assessments of hedge effectiveness. For qualifying fair value hedges of benchmark interest rates, the changes in the fair value of the derivative and the changes in the fair value of the hedged liability provide offset of one another and, together with any resulting ineffectiveness, are recorded in Interest expense. When a derivative is de−designated as a hedge, any basis adjustment remaining on the hedged liability is amortized to Interest expense over the remaining life of the liability using the effective interest method. Fair Value Hedges—Credit Risk. Until the fourth quarter of 2007, the Company had designated a portion of a credit derivative embedded in a non−recourse structured note liability as a fair value hedge of the credit risk arising from a loan receivable to which the structured note liability was specifically linked. Regression analysis was used to perform prospective and retrospective assessments of hedge effectiveness for this hedge relationship. The changes in the fair value of the derivative and the changes in the fair value of the hedged item provided offset of one another and, together with any resulting ineffectiveness, were recorded in Principal transactions—trading revenues. This hedge was terminated in the fourth quarter of 2007 upon derecognition of both the hedging instrument and the hedged item. Cash Flow Hedges. Before the sale of the aircraft leasing business (see Note 22), the Company applied hedge accounting to interest rate swaps used to hedge variable rate long−term borrowings associated with this business. Changes in the fair value of the swaps were recorded in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) in Shareholders’ equity, net of tax effects, and then reclassified to Interest expense as interest on the hedged borrowings was recognized. In connection with the sale of the aircraft leasing business, the Company de−designated the interest rate swaps associated with this business effective August 31, 2005 and no longer accounts for them as cash flow hedges. Amounts in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) related to those interest rate swaps continue to be reclassified to Interest expense since the related borrowings remain outstanding. The Company estimates that approximately $22 million of the unrealized loss recognized in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) as of November 30, 2007 will be reclassified into earnings within the next 12 months. 115 G-122 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Net Investment Hedges. The Company utilizes forward foreign exchange contracts and non−U.S. dollar−denominated debt to manage the currency exposure relating to its net investments in non−U.S. dollar functional currency operations. No hedge ineffectiveness is recognized in earnings since the notional amounts of the hedging instruments equal the portion of the investments being hedged, and, where forward contracts are used, the currencies being exchanged are the functional currencies of the parent and investee; where debt instruments are used as hedges, they are denominated in the functional currency of the investee. The gain or loss from revaluing hedges of net investments in foreign operations at the spot rate is deferred and reported within Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) in Shareholders’ equity, net of tax effects. The forward points on the hedging instruments are recorded in Interest and dividend revenues or expense. Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows. For purposes of these statements, cash and cash equivalents consist of cash and highly liquid investments not held for resale with maturities, when purchased, of three months or less. In connection with business acquisitions, the Company assumed liabilities of $7,704 million, $1,377 million and $58 million in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. In connection with the Discover Spin−off, net assets of approximately $5,558 million were distributed to shareholders (see Note 22). At November 30, 2007, $8,086 million of securities were transferred from Securities available for sale to Financial instruments owned (see Note 8). Securitization Activities. The Company engages in securitization activities related to commercial and residential mortgage loans, corporate bonds and loans, U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations and other types of financial assets (see Note 5). Generally, such transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when the Company has relinquished control over the transferred assets. The gain or loss on sale of such financial assets depends, in part, on the previous carrying amount of the assets involved in the transfer allocated between the assets sold and the retained interests based upon their respective fair values at the date of sale. Transfers that are not accounted for as sales are accounted for as secured borrowings. Premises, Equipment and Software Costs. Premises and equipment consist of buildings, leasehold improvements, furniture, fixtures, computer and communications equipment, power plants, tugs, barges, terminals, pipelines and software (externally purchased and developed for internal use). Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation and amortization are provided by the straight−line method over the estimated useful life of the asset. Estimated useful lives are generally as follows: buildings—39 years; furniture and fixtures—7 years, computer and communications equipment—3 to 8 years; power plants—15 years; tugs and barges—15 years; and terminals and pipelines—3 to 25 years. Estimated useful lives for software costs are generally 3 to 5 years. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the estimated useful life of the asset or, where applicable, the remaining term of the lease, but generally not exceeding: 25 years for building structural improvements and 15 years for other improvements. Certain costs incurred in connection with internal−use software projects are capitalized and amortized over the expected useful life of the asset, generally 3 to 5 years. Income Taxes. Income tax expense is provided for using the asset and liability method, under which deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based upon the temporary differences between the financial statement and income tax bases of assets and liabilities using currently enacted tax rates. 116 G-123 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Earnings per Common Share. Basic earnings per common share (“EPS”) is computed by dividing income available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Diluted EPS reflects the assumed conversion of all dilutive securities. Stock−Based Compensation. The Company early adopted SFAS No. 123R, “Share−Based Payment” (“SFAS No. 123R”), using the modified prospective approach as of December 1, 2004. SFAS No. 123R revised the fair value−based method of accounting for share−based payment liabilities, forfeitures and modifications of stock−based awards and clarified guidance in several areas, including measuring fair value, classifying an award as equity or as a liability and attributing compensation cost to service periods. Upon adoption, the Company recognized an $80 million gain ($49 million after−tax) as a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle in the first quarter of fiscal 2005 resulting from the requirement to estimate forfeitures at the date of grant instead of recognizing them as incurred. The cumulative effect gain increased both basic and diluted earnings per share in fiscal 2005 by $0.05. SFAS No. 123R requires measurement of compensation cost for equity−based awards at fair value and recognition of compensation cost over the service period, net of estimated forfeitures. The Company determines the fair value of restricted stock units based on the number of units granted and the grant date fair value of the Company’s common stock, measured as the volume−weighted average price on the date of grant. The fair value of stock options is determined using the Black−Scholes valuation model and the single grant life method. Under the single grant life method, option awards with graded vesting are valued using a single weighted−average expected option life. Compensation expense for all stock−based payment awards is recognized using the graded vesting attribution method. The Employee Stock Purchase Plan (the “ESPP”) allows employees to purchase shares of the Company’s common stock at a 15% discount from market value. The Company expenses the 15% discount associated with the ESPP. For stock−based awards issued prior to the adoption of SFAS No. 123R, the Company’s accounting policy for awards granted to retirement−eligible employees is to recognize compensation cost over the service period specified in the award terms. The Company accelerates any unrecognized compensation cost for such awards if and when a retirement−eligible employee leaves the Company. For fiscal 2005 year−end stock−based compensation awards that were granted to retirement−eligible employees in December 2005, the Company recognized the compensation cost for such awards at the date of grant instead of over the service period specified in the award terms. As a result, the Company recorded non−cash incremental compensation expenses of approximately $260 million in fiscal 2006 for stock−based awards granted to retirement−eligible employees as part of the fiscal 2005 year−end award process and for awards granted to retirement−eligible employees, including new hires, in fiscal 2006. These incremental expenses were included within Compensation and benefits expense and reduced income before taxes within the Institutional Securities ($190 million), Global Wealth Management Group ($50 million) and Asset Management ($20 million) business segments. Additionally, based on interpretive guidance related to SFAS No. 123R in the first quarter of fiscal 2006, the Company changed its accounting policy for expensing the cost of anticipated fiscal 2006 year−end equity awards that are granted to retirement−eligible employees in the first quarter of the following year. Effective December 1, 2005, the Company accrues the estimated cost of these awards over the course of the current fiscal year. As such, the Company accrued the estimated cost of fiscal 2007 year−end awards granted to retirement−eligible employees over the 2007 fiscal year rather than expensing the awards on the date of grant (which occurred in December 2007). The Company believes that this method of recognition for retirement−eligible employees is preferable because it better reflects the period over which the compensation is earned. 117 G-124 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) If the Company had accrued the estimated cost of equity awards granted to retirement−eligible employees over the course of the fiscal year ended November 30, 2005 rather than expensing such awards at the grant date in December 2005, net income would have decreased during fiscal 2005. The approximate resulting pro forma net income would have been $4,684 million rather than the reported amount of $4,939 million. The approximate resulting impact on earnings per share for fiscal 2005 would have been a reduction in the reported amounts of earnings per basic share from $4.70 to $4.46 and earnings per diluted share from $4.57 to $4.34. Translation of Foreign Currencies. Assets and liabilities of operations having non−U.S. dollar functional currencies are translated at year−end rates of exchange, and income statement accounts are translated at weighted average rates of exchange for the year. Gains or losses resulting from translating foreign currency financial statements, net of hedge gains or losses and related tax effects, are reflected in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), a separate component of Shareholders’ equity. Gains or losses resulting from remeasurement of foreign currency transactions are included in net income. Goodwill and Intangible Assets. Goodwill and indefinite−lived assets are not amortized and are reviewed annually (or more frequently under certain conditions) for impairment. Other intangible assets are amortized over their useful lives. Investments in Unconsolidated Investees. The Company invests in unconsolidated investees that own synthetic fuel production plants and in certain structured transactions not integral to the operations of the Company. The Company accounts for these investments under the equity method. The Company’s share of the (losses) generated by these investments is recorded within (Losses) gains from unconsolidated investees, and the applicable tax credits and the tax benefits associated with these operating losses are recorded within the Provision for income taxes. Deferred Compensation Arrangements. The Company maintains trusts, commonly referred to as rabbi trusts, in connection with certain deferred compensation plans. Assets of rabbi trusts are consolidated, and the value of the Company’s stock held in rabbi trusts is classified in Shareholders’ equity and generally accounted for in a manner similar to treasury stock. The Company has included its obligations under certain deferred compensation plans in Employee stock trust. Shares that the Company has issued to its rabbi trusts are recorded in Common stock issued to employee trust. Both Employee stock trust and Common stock issued to employee trust are components of Shareholders’ equity. The Company recognizes the original amount of deferred compensation (fair value of the deferred stock award at the date of grant—see Note 18) as the basis for recognition in Employee stock trust and Common stock issued to employee trust. Changes in the fair value of amounts owed to employees are not recognized as the Company’s deferred compensation plans do not permit diversification and must be settled by the delivery of a fixed number of shares of the Company’s common stock. Accounting Developments. Limited Partnerships. In June 2005, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) ratified the consensus reached in EITF Issue No. 04−5, “Determining Whether a General Partner, or the General Partners as a Group, Controls a Limited Partnership or Similar Entity When the Limited Partners Have Certain Rights” (“EITF Issue No. 04−5”). Under the provisions of EITF Issue No. 04−5, a general partner in a limited partnership is presumed to control that limited partnership and, therefore, should include the limited partnership in its consolidated financial statements, regardless of the amount or extent of the general partner’s interest unless a simple majority of the limited partners can vote to dissolve or liquidate the partnership or otherwise remove the general partner without having to show cause or the limited partners have substantive participating rights that can overcome the presumption of control by the general partner. EITF Issue No. 04−5 was effective immediately for all newly formed limited partnerships and existing limited partnerships for which the partnership agreements 118 G-125 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) have been modified. For all other existing limited partnerships for which the partnership agreements have not been modified, the Company adopted EITF Issue No. 04−5 on December 1, 2006. The adoption of EITF Issue No. 04−5 on December 1, 2006 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments. In February 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 155, “Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments” (“SFAS No. 155”), which amends SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivatives Instruments and Hedging Activities,” as amended (“SFAS No. 133”), and SFAS No. 140, “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities” (“SFAS No. 140”), and permits hybrid financial instruments that contain an embedded derivative that would otherwise require bifurcation to irrevocably be accounted for at fair value, with changes in fair value recognized in the statement of income. The fair value election may be applied on an instrument−by−instrument basis. SFAS No. 155 also eliminates a restriction on the passive derivative instruments that a qualifying special purpose entity may hold. The Company adopted SFAS No. 155 on December 1, 2006. Since SFAS No. 159 incorporates accounting and disclosure requirements that are similar to SFAS No. 155, the Company decided to apply SFAS No. 159, rather than SFAS No. 155, to its fair value elections for hybrid financial instruments. Accounting for Servicing of Financial Assets. In March 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 156, “Accounting for Servicing of Financial Assets” (“SFAS No. 156”), which requires all separately recognized servicing assets and servicing liabilities to be initially measured at fair value, if practicable. The standard permits an entity to subsequently measure each class of servicing assets or servicing liabilities at fair value and report changes in fair value in the statement of income in the period in which the changes occur. The Company adopted SFAS No. 156 on December 1, 2006 and elected to fair value mortgage servicing rights (“MSRs”) held as of the date of adoption. This election did not have a material impact on the Company’s opening balance of Retained earnings as of December 1, 2006. The Company also elected to fair value MSRs acquired after December 1, 2006. Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes. In July 2006, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation No. 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes, an interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109” (“FIN 48”). FIN 48 clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in a company’s financial statements and prescribes a recognition threshold and measurement attribute for the financial statement recognition and measurement of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in an income tax return. FIN 48 also provides guidance on derecognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, disclosure and transition. The adoption of FIN 48 on December 1, 2007 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Fair Value Measurements. In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 157, which defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value and enhances disclosures requirements for fair value measurements. In addition, SFAS No. 157 disallows the use of block discounts when measuring financial instruments that trade with quoted prices in an active market. It also nullifies select guidance provided by EITF Issue No. 02−3, which prohibited the recognition of trading gains or losses at the inception of a derivative contract, unless the fair value of such derivative is based on a valuation technique that incorporates observable market data. SFAS No. 157 also requires the Company to consider its own credit spreads when measuring the fair value of liabilities, including derivatives. Effective December 1, 2006, the Company elected early adoption of SFAS No. 157. In accordance with the provisions of SFAS No. 157 related to block discounts and EITF Issue No. 02−3, the Company recorded a cumulative effect adjustment of approximately $84 million after−tax as an increase to the opening balance of Retained earnings as of December 1, 2006, which was primarily associated with EITF Issue No. 02−3. The impact of considering the Company’s own credit spreads when measuring the fair value of liabilities, including derivatives, did not have a material impact on fair value measurements at the date of adoption. With the adoption of SFAS No. 157, the Company no longer applies the revenue recognition criteria of EITF Issue No. 02−3. 119 G-126 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Employee Benefit Plans. In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 158, “Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R)” (“SFAS No. 158”). Among other items, SFAS No. 158 required recognition of the overfunded or underfunded status of the Company’s defined benefit and postretirement plans as an asset or liability in the consolidated financial statements for the fiscal year ending November 30, 2007. The Company recorded an after−tax charge of $208 million to Shareholders’ equity upon the adoption of this requirement. SFAS No. 158 also requires the measurement of defined benefit and postretirement plan assets and obligations as of the end of the fiscal year. SFAS No. 158’s requirement to use the fiscal year−end date as the measurement date is effective for fiscal years ending after December 15, 2008. The Company expects to early adopt a fiscal year−end measurement date for its fiscal year ending November 30, 2008 and currently expects to record an after−tax charge of approximately $15 million to Shareholders’ equity upon adoption. Fair Value Option. In February 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 159, which provides entities the option to measure certain financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in earnings each period. SFAS No. 159 permits the fair value option election on an instrument−by−instrument basis at initial recognition of an asset or liability or upon an event that gives rise to a new basis of accounting for that instrument. Effective December 1, 2006, the Company elected early adoption of SFAS No. 159 for certain eligible instruments, including certain equity method investments, certain loans and loan commitments, certain certificates of deposits and certain structured notes. Such instruments included loans and other financial instruments held by subsidiaries that are not registered broker−dealers as defined in the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (“AICPA”) Audit and Accounting Guide, Brokers and Dealers in Securities, or that are not held by investment companies as defined in the AICPA Audit and Accounting Guide, Investment Companies. A substantial portion of these positions, as well as the financial instruments included within Other secured financings, had been accounted for by the Company at fair value prior to the adoption of SFAS No. 159. Financial instruments under the fair value option election are primarily reflected within Financial instruments owned and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased in the consolidated statement of financial condition. As a result of the adoption of SFAS No. 159, the Company recorded a cumulative effect adjustment of approximately $102 million after−tax as an increase to the opening balance of Retained earnings as of December 1, 2006. Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Contracts. In April 2007, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (“FSP”) No. FIN 39−1, “Amendment of FASB Interpretation No. 39”, (“FSP FIN 39−1”). FSP FIN 39−1 amends certain provisions of FIN 39, “Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Contracts,” and permits companies to offset fair value amounts recognized for cash collateral receivables or payables against fair value amounts recognized for net derivative positions executed with the same counterparty under the same master netting arrangement. FSP FIN 39−1 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, with early application permitted. The adoption of FSP FIN 39−1 on December 1, 2007 did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Investment Company Accounting. In June 2007, the AICPA issued Statement of Position (“SOP”) 07–1, “Clarification of the Scope of the Audit and Accounting Guide Investment Companies and Accounting by Parent Companies and Equity Method Investors for Investments in Investment Companies” (“SOP 07−1”). SOP 07−1 provides guidance for determining whether an entity is within the scope of the AICPA “Audit and Accounting Guide Investment Companies” (the “Guide”). SOP 07−1 addresses whether the specialized industry accounting principles of the Guide should be retained by a parent company in consolidation. In addition, SOP 07−1 includes certain disclosure requirements for parent companies and equity method investors in investment companies that retain investment company accounting in the parent company’s consolidated financial statements or the financial statements of an equity method investor. SOP 07−1, as originally issued, was to be effective for the Company as 120 G-127 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) of December 1, 2008. In May 2007, the FASB issued FSP FIN 46R−7, “Application of FIN 46R to Investment Companies,” (“FSP FIN 46R−7”) which amends FASB Interpretation No. 46 (revised December 2003), “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities (“FIN 46R”) to make permanent the temporary deferral of the application of FIN 46R to entities within the scope of the revised audit guide under SOP 07−1. FSP FIN 46R−7 is effective upon adoption of SOP 07−1. The Company is currently evaluating the potential impact of adopting SOP 07−1 and FSP FIN 46R−7. In November 2007, the FASB issued a proposed FSP SOP 07−1−a to delay indefinitely the effective date of SOP 07−1. Dividends on Share−Based Payment Awards. In June 2007, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 06−11, “Accounting for Income Tax Benefits of Dividends on Share−Based Payment Awards” (“EITF Issue No. 06−11”). EITF Issue No. 06−11 requires that the tax benefit related to dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units that are expected to vest be recorded as an increase to additional paid−in capital. The Company currently accounts for this tax benefit as a reduction to its income tax provision. EITF Issue No. 06−11 is to be applied prospectively for tax benefits on dividends declared in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2007. The Company is currently evaluating the potential impact of adopting EITF Issue No. 06−11. Business Combinations. In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 141(R), “Business Combinations” (“SFAS No. 141(R)”). SFAS 141(R) requires the acquiring entity in a business combination to recognize the full fair value of assets acquired and liabilities assumed in the transaction (whether a full or partial acquisition); establishes the acquisition−date fair value as the measurement objective for all assets acquired and liabilities assumed; requires expensing of most transaction and restructuring costs; and requires the acquirer to disclose to investors and other users all of the information needed to evaluate and understand the nature and financial effect of the business combination. SFAS No. 141(R) applies to all transactions or other events in which the Company obtains control of one or more businesses, including those sometimes referred to as “true mergers” or “mergers of equals” and combinations achieved without the transfer of consideration, for example, by contract alone or through the lapse of minority veto rights. SFAS No. 141(R) applies prospectively to business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after December 1, 2009. Noncontrolling Interests. In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 160, “Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements—an amendment of Accounting Research Bulletin No. 51” (“SFAS No. 160”). SFAS No. 160 requires reporting entities to present noncontrolling (minority) interests as equity (as opposed to as a liability or mezzanine equity) and provides guidance on the accounting for transactions between an entity and noncontrolling interests. SFAS No. 160 applies prospectively as of December 1, 2009, except for the presentation and disclosure requirements which will be applied retrospectively for all periods presented. 121 G-128 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 3. Fair Value Disclosures. Fair Value Measurements. The Company’s assets and liabilities recorded at fair value have been categorized based upon a fair value hierarchy in accordance with SFAS No. 157. See Note 2 for a discussion of the Company’s policies regarding this hierarchy. The following fair value hierarchy tables present information about the Company’s assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of November 30, 2007: Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis as of November 30, 2007 Assets Cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements Financial instruments owned: U.S. government and agency securities Other sovereign government obligations Corporate and other debt Corporate equities Derivative contracts(1) Investments Physical commodities Quoted Prices in Active Markets for Identical Assets (Level 1) Significant Other Observable Inputs (Level 2) $ $ Total financial instruments owned Securities received as collateral Intangible assets(2) Liabilities Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings Deposits Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased: U.S. government and agency securities Other sovereign government obligations Corporate and other debt Corporate equities Derivative contracts(1) Physical commodities $ 31,354 — Significant Unobservable Inputs (Level 3) (dollars in millions) $ — Counterparty and Cash Collateral Netting Balance as of November 30, 2007 $ $ — 31,354 11,038 15,834 223 82,592 4,526 953 — 12,189 5,743 110,443 3,549 90,654 249 3,096 660 29 37,058 1,236 21,601 13,068 — — — — — (39,778) — — 23,887 21,606 147,724 87,377 77,003 14,270 3,096 115,166 68,031 — 225,923 14,191 428 73,652 7 — (39,778) — — 374,963 82,229 428 — — $ 3,068 3,769 $ — — $ — — $ 3,068 3,769 8,208 9,633 16 29,948 7,031 — 13 5,994 6,454 935 86,968 398 — — 1,122 16 15,663 — — — — — (38,058) — 8,221 15,627 7,592 30,899 71,604 398 Total financial instruments sold, not yet purchased 54,836 100,762 16,801 (38,058) 134,341 Obligation to return securities received as collateral Other secured financings Long−term borrowings 68,031 — — 14,191 25,451 37,994 7 2,321 398 (1) (2) — — — 82,229 27,772 38,392 Amounts represent the impact of counterparty netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included within that level. Amount represents MSRs accounted for at fair value (see Note 5). 122 G-129 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table presents additional information about Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis. Level 3 instruments may be hedged with instruments classified in Level 1 and Level 2. As a result, the realized and unrealized gains and losses for assets and liabilities within the Level 3 category presented in the tables below do not reflect the related realized or unrealized gains and losses on hedging instruments that have been classified by the Company within the Level 1 and/or Level 2 categories. Additionally, both observable and unobservable inputs may be used to determine the fair value of positions that the Company has classified within the Level 3 category. As a result, the unrealized gains and losses for assets and liabilities within the Level 3 category presented in the tables below may include changes in fair value that were attributable to both observable (e.g., changes in market interest rates) and unobservable (e.g., changes in unobservable long−dated volatilities) inputs. Changes in Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis for the Fiscal Year Ended November 30, 2007 Total Realized and Unrealized Gains or (Losses) Included in Income Assets Financial instruments owned: U.S. government and agency securities Other sovereign government obligations Corporate and other debt(1) Corporate equities Net derivative contracts(1)(2) Investments(3) Securities received as collateral Other assets(4) Liabilities Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased: Corporate and other debt(1) Corporate equities Obligation to return securities received as collateral Other secured financings Long−term borrowings (1) Beginning Balance Principal Transactions: Trading Principal Transactions: Investments $ $ $ 2 162 33,941 1,040 30 3,879 40 2,154 $ 185 9 40 4,724 464 134 — 10 (5,999) 62 4,152 — — — $ (1,242) (58) — — — — (114) — — — Purchases, Sales, Other Settlements and Issuances, net Net Transfers In and/or (Out) of Level 3 Ending Balance $ $ $ $ Other Revenues (dollars in millions) $ — — — — 2,538 — — $ Total Realized and Unrealized Gains or (Losses) — — — — — — — 32 $ 134 10 (5,999) 62 4,152 2,538 — 32 — — $ (1,242) (58) — — — — — (114) 524 (143) 3,664 (260) 913 6,651 (33) (2,186) $ (439) (55) (33) (2,403) (185) $ — 660 — 5,452 394 843 — — — 29 37,058 1,236 5,938 13,068 7 — 134 4 $ 1,122 16 — — 5 7 2,321 398 The net gains from Net derivative contracts and the net losses from Corporate and other debt resulted from market movements primarily associated with credit products and various credit linked instruments, respectively. The net gains in Level 3 Net derivative contracts were primarily driven by certain credit default swaps and other instruments associated with the Company’s credit products and securitized products activities. The net losses in Level 3 Corporate and other debt were primarily driven by certain asset−backed securities, including residential and commercial mortgage loans, and by corporate loans and loan commitments. 123 G-130 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) These results are only a component of the overall trading strategies of these businesses and do not take into consideration any related financial instruments that have been classified by the Company within the Level 1 and/or Level 2 categories. For example, the Company recorded offsetting net losses in Level 2 Net derivative contracts, which were primarily associated with the Company’s credit products and securitized products activities. (2) (3) (4) The Company reclassified certain Corporate and other debt and Net derivative contracts from Level 2 to Level 3 because certain significant inputs for the fair value measurement became unobservable. These reclassifications included transfers in the fourth quarter primarily related to the continued market and liquidity deterioration in the mortgage markets. The most material transfers into Level 3 were in commercial whole loans, residuals from residential securitizations, and interest−only commercial mortgage and agency bonds as well as commercial and residential credit default swaps. Amounts represent Financial instruments owned—derivative contracts net of Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased—derivative contracts. The net gains from Financial instruments owned—investments were primarily related to investments associated with the Company’s real estate products and private equity portfolio. These assets were disposed of in connection with the Discover Spin−off. The following table presents the amounts of unrealized gains or (losses) for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007 relating to those assets and liabilities for which the Company utilized significant Level 3 inputs to determine fair value and that were still held by the Company at November 30, 2007: Fiscal 2007 Unrealized Gains (Losses) for Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Still Held at November 30, 2007 Fiscal Year Ended November 30, 2007 Principal Principal Transactions: Transactions: Trading Investments (dollars in millions) Assets Financial instruments owned: U.S. government and agency securities Other sovereign government obligations Corporate and other debt Corporate equities Investments Net derivative contracts Liabilities Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased: Corporate and other debt Corporate equities Long−term borrowings 124 $ 49 2 (4,528) 515 — (3,294) $ — — — — 1,492 — $ (455) (27) (116) $ — — — G-131 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Fair Value Option. The following table presents information about the eligible instruments for which the Company elected the fair value option and for which a transition adjustment was recorded as of December 1, 2006: Transition Adjustment to Retained Earnings Gain/(Loss) (dollars in millions) Carrying Value of Instrument at December 1, 2006 Financial instruments owned: Corporate lending(1) Mortgage lending(2) Investments(3) Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings(4) Deposits(5) Long−term borrowings(4) $ 8,587 1,258 1,305 946 3,143 14,354 $ Pre−tax cumulative effect of adoption of the fair value option Deferred taxes 16 7 13 (1) 1 130 Carrying Value of Instrument at December 1, 2006 (after Adoption of SFAS No. 159) $ 8,603 1,265 1,318 947 3,142 14,224 166 64 Cumulative effect of adoption of the fair value option $ 102 The transition adjustments were primarily related to the following: (1) Loans and loan commitments made in connection with Institutional Securities’ corporate lending activities. The fair value option was elected for these positions as they are generally risk managed on a fair value basis. (2) Certain mortgage lending products which are risk managed by the Institutional Securities business segment on a fair value basis. The Company did not elect the fair value option for other eligible mortgage lending products that were managed by the Discover business segment prior to the Discover Spin−off. (3) Certain investments that had been previously accounted for under the equity method, as well as certain interests in clearinghouses. The fair value option was elected only for positions that are risk managed on a fair value basis. (4) Structured notes and other hybrid long−term debt instruments. The fair value option was elected for these positions as they are risk managed on a fair value basis. The fair value option was elected for all such instruments issued after December 1, 2006 and a portion of the portfolio of instruments outstanding as of December 1, 2006. The fair value option was not elected for the remaining portion of the portfolio that existed as of December 1, 2006 due to cost−benefit considerations, including the operational effort involved. (5) Brokered and callable certificates of deposit issued by certain of the Company’s bank subsidiaries. The fair value option was elected for these positions as they are risk−managed on a fair value basis. The Company did not elect the fair value option for other eligible instruments within Deposits that were managed by the Discover business segment prior to the Discover Spin−off. The following table presents gains and (losses) due to changes in fair value for items measured at fair value pursuant to the fair value option election for fiscal year ended November 30, 2007: Principal Transactions: Trading Fiscal year ended November 30, 2007 Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings Deposits Long−term borrowings (1) $ (326) (5) (481) Net Interest Revenue (dollars in millions) $ (5) — (366) Losses Included in the Year Ended November 30, 2007(1) $ (331) (5) (847) In addition to these amounts, as discussed in Note 2, all of the instruments within Financial instruments owned or Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased are measured at fair value, either through the election of SFAS No. 159 or as required by other accounting pronouncements. Changes in the fair value of these instruments are recorded in Principal transactions—trading and Principal transactions—investment revenues. 125 G-132 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) As of November 30, 2007, the aggregate contractual principal amount of loans for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the fair value of such loans by approximately $28,880 million. The aggregate fair value of loans that were 90 or more days past due as of November 30, 2007 was $6,588 million. The aggregate contractual principal amount of such loans 90 or more days past due exceeded their fair value by approximately $23,501 million. This difference in amount primarily emanates from the Company’s distressed debt trading business, which purchases distressed debt at amounts well below par. For the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007, changes in the fair value of loans for which the fair value option was elected that were attributable to changes in instrument−specific credit spreads were losses of $2,258 million. Instrument−specific credit losses were determined by excluding the non−credit components of gains and losses, such as those due to changes in interest rates. For the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007, the estimated changes in the fair value of the Company’s short−term and long−term borrowings, including structured notes, for which the fair value option was elected that were attributable to changes in instrument−specific credit spreads were gains of approximately $840 million. This gain was attributable to the widening of the Company’s credit spreads and was determined based upon observations of the Company’s secondary bond market spreads. As of November 30, 2007, the aggregate contractual principal amount of long−term debt instruments for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the fair value of such instruments by approximately $1,572 million. The estimated change in the fair value of other liabilities for which the fair value option was elected that was attributable to changes in instrument−specific credit spreads was a loss of approximately $291 million in the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007. This loss was primarily related to leveraged loan contingent commitments and was attributable to the illiquid market conditions that existed late in the year. It was generally determined based on the differential between estimated expected client yields at November 30, 2007 and contractual yields. Financial Instruments Not Measured at Fair Value. Some of the Company’s financial instruments are not measured at fair value on a recurring basis but nevertheless are recorded at amounts that approximate fair value due to their liquid or short−term nature. Such financial assets and financial liabilities include: Cash and cash equivalents, the cash component of Cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements, Securities purchased under agreements to resell, Securities borrowed, Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, Securities loaned, Receivables—customers, Receivables—brokers, dealers and clearing organizations, Payables—customers, Payables—brokers, dealers and clearing organizations, certain Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings, and certain Deposits. The Company’s long−term borrowings are recorded at historical amounts unless elected under the SFAS No. 159 fair value election or designated as a hedged item in a fair value hedge under SFAS No. 133. The fair value of the Company’s long−term borrowings was estimated using either quoted market prices or discounted cash flow analyses based on the Company’s current borrowing rates for similar types of borrowing arrangements. At November 30, 2007, the carrying value of the Company’s long−term borrowings was approximately $3.3 billion higher than fair value. At November 30, 2006, the carrying value of the Company’s long−term borrowings was approximately $1.8 billion less than fair value. 126 G-133 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 4. Collateralized Transactions. Securities purchased under agreements to resell (“reverse repurchase agreements”) and Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”), principally government and agency securities, are carried at the amounts at which the securities subsequently will be resold or reacquired as specified in the respective agreements; such amounts include accrued interest. Reverse repurchase agreements and repurchase agreements are presented on a net−by−counterparty basis, when appropriate. The Company’s policy is to take possession of securities purchased under agreements to resell. Securities borrowed and Securities loaned are carried at the amounts of cash collateral advanced and received in connection with the transactions. Other secured financings include the liabilities related to transfers of financial assets that are accounted for as financings rather than sales, consolidated variable interest entities where the Company is deemed to be the primary beneficiary and certain equity−referenced securities and loans where in all instances these liabilities are payable solely from the cash flows of the related assets accounted for as Financial instruments owned. The Company pledges its financial instruments owned to collateralize repurchase agreements and other securities financings. Pledged securities that can be sold or repledged by the secured party are identified as Financial instruments owned (pledged to various parties) in the consolidated statements of financial condition. The carrying value and classification of securities owned by the Company that have been loaned or pledged to counterparties where those counterparties do not have the right to sell or repledge the collateral were as follows: At At November 30, November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Financial instruments owned: U.S. government and agency securities Other sovereign government obligations Corporate and other debt Corporate equities Total $ 7,134 333 32,530 1,133 $ 12,111 893 44,237 6,662 $ 41,130 $ 63,903 The Company enters into reverse repurchase agreements, repurchase agreements, securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions to, among other things, acquire securities to cover short positions and settle other securities obligations, to accommodate customers’ needs and to finance the Company’s inventory positions. The Company also engages in securities financing transactions for customers through margin lending. Under these agreements and transactions, the Company either receives or provides collateral, including U.S. government and agency securities, other sovereign government obligations, corporate and other debt, and corporate equities. The Company receives collateral in the form of securities in connection with reverse repurchase agreements, securities borrowed and derivative transactions, and customer margin loans. In many cases, the Company is permitted to sell or repledge these securities held as collateral and use the securities to secure repurchase agreements, to enter into securities lending and derivative transactions or for delivery to counterparties to cover short positions. At November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, the fair value of securities received as collateral where the Company is permitted to sell or repledge the securities was $948 billion and $942 billion, respectively, and the fair value of the portion that had been sold or repledged was $708 billion and $780 billion, respectively. The Company additionally receives securities as collateral in connection with certain securities for securities transactions in which the Company is the lender. In instances where the Company is permitted to sell or repledge these securities, the Company reports the fair value of the collateral received and the related obligation to return the collateral in the consolidated statement of financial condition. At November 30, 2007 and November 30, 127 G-134 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 2006, $82 billion and $65 billion, respectively, were reported as Securities received as collateral and an Obligation to return securities received as collateral in the consolidated statements of financial condition. Collateral received in connection with these transactions that was subsequently repledged was approximately $72 billion and $45 billion at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, respectively. The Company manages credit exposure arising from reverse repurchase agreements, repurchase agreements, securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions by, in appropriate circumstances, entering into master netting agreements and collateral arrangements with counterparties that provide the Company, in the event of a customer default, the right to liquidate collateral and the right to offset a counterparty’s rights and obligations. The Company also monitors the fair value of the underlying securities as compared with the related receivable or payable, including accrued interest, and, as necessary, requests additional collateral to ensure such transactions are adequately collateralized. Where deemed appropriate, the Company’s agreements with third parties specify its rights to request additional collateral. Customer receivables generated from margin lending activity are collateralized by customer−owned securities held by the Company. For these transactions, adherence to the Company’s collateral policies significantly limits the Company’s credit exposure in the event of customer default. The Company may request additional margin collateral from customers, if appropriate, and, if necessary, may sell securities that have not been paid for or purchase securities sold but not delivered from customers. 5. Securitization Activities and Variable Interest Entities. Securitization Activities. The Company engages in securitization activities related to commercial and residential mortgage loans, U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations, corporate bonds and loans, municipal bonds and other types of financial assets. Special purpose entities (“SPEs”), also known as variable interest entities (“VIEs”) are typically used in such securitization transactions. Transferred assets are carried at fair value prior to securitization, and any changes in fair value are recognized in the consolidated statements of income. The Company may act as underwriter of the beneficial interests issued by securitization vehicles. Underwriting net revenues are recognized in connection with these transactions. The Company may retain interests in the securitized financial assets as one or more tranches of the securitization. These retained interests are included in the consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value. Any changes in the fair value of such retained interests are recognized in the consolidated statements of income. Retained interests in securitized financial assets were approximately $5.3 billion at November 30, 2007, the majority of which were related to residential mortgage loan, commercial mortgage loan and U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligation securitization transactions. Net gains at the time of securitization were not material in fiscal 2007. 128 G-135 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table presents information on the Company’s residential mortgage loan, commercial mortgage loan and U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligation securitization transactions. Key economic assumptions and the sensitivity of the current fair value of the retained interests to immediate 10% and 20% adverse changes in those assumptions at November 30, 2007 were as follows (dollars in millions): Residential Mortgage Loans Investment grade retained interests Non−investment grade retained interests Total retained interests (carrying amount/fair value) Weighted average life (in months) Range Weighted average discount rate (per annum) Range Impact on fair value of 10% adverse change Impact on fair value of 20% adverse change Weighted average credit losses (rate per annum) Range Impact on fair value of 10% adverse change Impact on fair value of 20% adverse change Weighted average prepayment speed assumption (“PSA”)(1)(2) Range Impact on fair value of 10% adverse change Impact on fair value of 20% adverse change (1) (2) U.S. Agency Collateralized Mortgage Obligations Commercial Mortgage Loans $ 2,048 1,167 $ 678 406 $ 826 — $ 3,215 $ 1,084 $ 826 49 1−322 12.55% 1.12−74.10% $ (114) $ (218) 4.52% 0.00−12.00% $ (215) $ (371) 1,173 188−2,250PSA $ (118) $ (194) 57 0.5−139 8.48% 3.00−16.83% $ (14) $ (28) 3.24% 0.00−13.69% $ (5) $ (10) — — $ — $ — 51 1−271 6.04% 0.75−18.12% $ (16) $ (31) 0.00% 0.00−0.00% $ — $ — 301 167−718PSA $ (7) $ (19) Amounts for residential mortgage loans exclude positive valuation effects from immediate 10% and 20% changes. Commercial mortgage loans typically contain provisions that either prohibit or economically penalize the borrower from prepaying the loan for a specified period of time. The weighted average assumptions and parameters used initially to value retained interests in relation to securitizations that were still held by the Company as of November 30, 2007 were as follows: Residential Mortgage Loans Weighted average life (in months) Weighted average discount rate (rate per annum) Weighted average credit losses (rate per annum) Weighted average prepayment speed assumptions 45 9.51% 2.23% 1,842 Commercial Mortgage Loans 64 6.87% 1.54% — U.S. Agency Collateralized Mortgage Obligations 72 5.79% — 258 The tables above do not include the offsetting benefit of any financial instruments that the Company may utilize to hedge risks inherent in its retained interests. In addition, the sensitivity analysis is hypothetical and should be used with caution. Changes in fair value based on a 10% or 20% variation in an assumption generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in the assumption to the change in fair value may not be linear. Also, the effect of a variation in a particular assumption on the fair value of the retained interests is calculated independent of changes in any other assumption; in practice, changes in one factor may result in changes in another, which might magnify or counteract the sensitivities. In addition, the sensitivity analysis does not consider any corrective action that the Company may take to mitigate the impact of any adverse changes in the key assumptions. 129 G-136 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) During fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, the Company received proceeds from new securitization transactions of $64 billion, $68 billion and $65 billion, respectively, and cash flows from retained interests in securitization transactions of $6.0 billion, $6.0 billion and $7.1 billion, respectively. Mortgage Servicing Rights. The Company may retain servicing rights to certain mortgage loans that are sold through its securitization activities. These transactions create an asset referred to as MSRs, which are included within Intangible assets in the consolidated statements of financial condition. The following table presents information about the Company’s MSRs, which relate to its mortgage loan business activities (dollars in millions): Fiscal 2007 Fair value as of the beginning of the period Additions: Purchases of servicing assets(1) Servicing assets that result from transfers of financial assets $ 93 306 549 Total additions Subtractions: Sales/disposals Changes in fair value(2) 855 (372) (148) Fair value as of the end of the period $ 428 Amount of contractually specified(2): Servicing fees Late fees Ancillary fees $ 170 26 1 $ 197 (1) (2) Amount includes MSRs obtained in connection with the Company’s acquisition of Saxon Capital, Inc. (see Note 23). These amounts are recorded within Other revenues in the Company’s consolidated statements of income. Fiscal 2007 Assumptions Used in Measuring Fair Value: Weighted average discount rate Weighted average prepayment speed assumption 18.11% 713PSA The Company generally utilizes information provided by third parties in order to determine the fair value of its MSRs. The valuation of MSRs consist of projecting servicing cash flows and discounting such cash flows using an appropriate risk−adjusted discount rate. These valuations require estimation of various assumptions, including future servicing fees, credit losses and other related costs, discount rates and mortgage prepayment speeds. The Company also compares the estimated fair values of the MSRs from the valuations with observable trades of similar instruments or portfolios. Due to subsequent changes in economic and market conditions, the actual rates of prepayments, credit losses and the value of collateral may differ significantly from the Company’s original estimates. Such differences could be material. If actual prepayment rates and credit losses were higher than those assumed, the value of the Company’s MSRs could be adversely affected. The Company may hedge a portion of its MSRs through the use of financial instruments, including certain derivative contracts. Variable Interest Entities. FASB Interpretation No. 46, as revised (“FIN 46R”), “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities,” applies to certain entities in which equity investors do not have the characteristics of a 130 G-137 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) controlling financial interest or do not have sufficient equity at risk for the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support from other parties. The primary beneficiary of a VIE is the party that absorbs a majority of the entity’s expected losses, receives a majority of its expected residual returns or both, as a result of holding variable interests. The Company consolidates entities in which it is the primary beneficiary. For those entities deemed to be qualifying special purpose entities (as defined in SFAS No. 140), the Company does not consolidate the entity. See Note 1 regarding the characteristics of qualifying special purpose entities. The Company is involved with various entities in the normal course of business that may be deemed to be VIEs. The Company’s variable interests in VIEs include debt and equity interests, commitments, guarantees and derivative instruments. The Company’s involvement with VIEs arises primarily from: • Purchased, sold and retained interests in connection with market making and securitization activities. • Guarantees issued and residual interests retained in connection with municipal bond securitizations. • Loans and investments made to VIEs that hold debt, equity, real estate or other assets. • Derivatives entered into with variable interest entities. • Structuring of credit linked notes or other asset−repackaged notes designed to meet the investment objectives of clients. • Other structured transactions designed to provide enhanced, tax−efficient yields to the Company or its clients. The following table sets forth the Company’s total assets and maximum exposure to loss associated with VIEs that the Company consolidated at November 30, 2007. The Company accounts for the assets held by the entities as Financial instruments owned and the liabilities of the entities as Other secured financings in the consolidated statement of financial condition (dollars in millions): As of November 30, 2007 Maximum Exposure to Loss in Consolidated VIEs(1) Mortgage and asset−backed securitizations Municipal bond trusts Credit and real estate(2) Commodities financing Other structured transactions VIE Assets That the Company Consolidates Debt and Equity Interests Derivatives Commitments and Guarantees $ 5,916 828 5,130 1,170 9,403 $ 1,746 1 2,515 — 8,868 $ $ — 827 — — 9 $ 1,750 828 5,835 328 8,877 22,447 $13,130 $ $ 836 $17,618 $ (1) (2) 4 — 3,320 328 — 3,652 Total The Company’s maximum exposure to loss often differs from the carrying value of the VIE’s assets. The maximum exposure to loss is dependent on the nature of the Company’s variable interest in the VIEs and is limited to the notional amounts of certain liquidity facilities, other credit support, total return swaps, written put options, and the fair value of certain other derivatives and investments the Company has made in the VIEs. Where notional amounts are utilized in quantifying maximum exposure related to derivatives, such amounts do not reflect writedowns already recorded by the Company. The Company’s maximum exposure to loss does not include the offsetting benefit of any financial instruments that the Company may utilize to hedge these risks associated with the Company’s variable interests. The Company’s maximum exposure to loss associated with Credit and real estate VIEs exceeds the consolidated assets of these entities. This is due to the inclusion in this category of certain VIEs that typically hold a limited amount of non−derivative security positions and instead obtain market exposure through the use of derivatives. Given the use of such derivatives, the risk of loss associated with such entities typically exceeds the carrying value of their assets. The Company’s maximum exposure to loss associated with such consolidated variable interest entities is generally limited to the notional amount of the Company’s derivatives entered into with the VIE and the fair value of any non−derivative security positions held by the Company. 131 G-138 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table sets forth the Company’s total assets and maximum exposure to loss associated with non−consolidated VIEs in which the Company had significant variable interests at November 30, 2007 (dollars in millions): Mortgage and asset−backed securitizations Credit and real estate Other structured transactions VIE Assets That the Company Does not Consolidate As of November 30, 2007 Maximum Exposure to Loss in Non−consolidated VIEs (1) Commitments Debt and and Equity Guarantees Total Interests Derivatives $ $ 7,234 20,265 10,218 $ 37,717 (1) 155 12,987 1,967 $ 125 200 — $ — 68 474 $ 280 13,255 2,441 $ 15,109 $ 325 $ 542 $ 15,976 The Company’s maximum exposure to loss often differs from the carrying value of the VIE’s assets. The maximum exposure to loss is dependent on the nature of the Company’s variable interest in the VIEs and is limited to the notional amounts of certain liquidity facilities, other credit support, total return swaps, written put options, and the fair value of certain other derivatives and investments the Company has made in the VIEs. Where notional amounts are utilized in quantifying maximum exposure related to derivatives, such amounts do not reflect writedowns already recorded by the Company. The Company’s maximum exposure to loss does not include the offsetting benefit of any financial instruments that the Company may utilize to hedge these risks associated with the Company’s variable interests. At November 30, 2006, in connection with its Institutional Securities business, the aggregate size of VIEs for which the Company was the primary beneficiary of the entities was approximately $20.4 billion, which is the carrying amount of the consolidated assets recorded as Financial instruments owned that are collateral for the entities’ obligations. At November 30, 2006, also in connection with its Institutional Securities business, the aggregate size of the entities for which the Company holds significant variable interests was approximately $34.7 billion. 6. Sales and Trading Activities. The Company’s institutional sales and trading activities are conducted through the integrated management of its client−driven and proprietary transactions along with the hedging and financing of these positions. Sales and trading activities include revenues from customer purchases and sales of financial instruments in which the Company acts as principal and gains and losses on the Company’s positions. The Company also engages in proprietary trading activities for its own account. Revenues from sales and trading activities are reflected in Principal transactions—trading, Commissions, Interest and dividends, and Interest expense in the consolidated statement of income. The Company’s trading portfolios are managed with a view toward the risk and profitability of the portfolios. The following discussions of risk management, market risk, credit risk, concentration risk and customer activities relate to the Company’s sales and trading activities. Risk Management. The cornerstone of the Company’s risk management philosophy is protection of the Company’s franchise, reputation and financial standing. The Company’s risk management philosophy is based on the following principles: comprehensiveness, independence, accountability, defined risk tolerance and transparency. Given the importance of effective risk management to the Company’s reputation, senior management requires thorough and frequent communication and appropriate escalation of risk matters. 132 G-139 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Risk management at the Company requires independent Company−level oversight, accountability of the Company’s business segments, constant communication, judgment, and knowledge of specialized products and markets. The Company’s senior management takes an active role in the identification, assessment and management of various risks at both the Company and business segment level. In recognition of the increasingly varied and complex nature of the global financial services business, the Company’s risk management philosophy, with its attendant policies, procedures and methodologies, is evolutionary in nature and subject to ongoing review and modification. The nature of the Company’s risks, coupled with this risk management philosophy, informs the Company’s risk governance structure. The Company’s risk governance structure includes the Firm Risk Committee, the Capital Structure and Strategic Transactions Committee, the Chief Risk Officer, the Internal Audit Department, independent control groups, and various risk control managers, committees and groups located within and across the business segments. The Firm Risk Committee, composed of the Company’s most senior officers, oversees the Company’s risk management structure. The Firm Risk Committee’s responsibilities include oversight of the Company’s risk management principles, procedures and limits, and the monitoring of material financial, operational and franchise risks. The Firm Risk Committee is overseen by the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors (the “Audit Committee”). The Capital Structure and Strategic Transactions Committee (the “Capital Committee”) reviews strategic transactions for the Company and significant changes to the Company’s capital structure. The Capital Committee’s responsibilities include reviewing measures of capital and evaluating capital resources relative to the Company’s risk profile and strategy. The Chief Risk Officer, a member of the Firm Risk Committee, oversees compliance with Company risk limits; approves certain excessions of Company risk limits; reviews material market, credit and operational risks; and reviews results of risk management processes with the Audit Committee. The Internal Audit Department provides independent risk and control assessment and reports to the Audit Committee and administratively to the Chief Legal Officer. The Internal Audit Department periodically examines the Company’s operational and control environment and conducts audits designed to cover all major risk categories. The Market Risk, Credit Risk, Operational Risk, Financial Control, Treasury, and Legal and Compliance Departments (collectively, the “Company Control Groups”), which are all independent of the Company’s business units, assist senior management and the Firm Risk Committee in monitoring and controlling the Company’s risk through a number of control processes. The Company is committed to employing qualified personnel with appropriate expertise in each of its various administrative and business areas to implement effectively the Company’s risk management and monitoring systems and processes. Each business segment has a risk committee that is responsible for ensuring that the business segment, as applicable, adheres to established limits for market, credit, operational and other risks; implements risk measurement, monitoring, and management policies and procedures that are consistent with the risk framework established by the Firm Risk Committee; and reviews, on a periodic basis, its aggregate risk exposures, risk exception experience, and the efficacy of its risk identification, measurement, monitoring and management policies and procedures, and related controls. Each of the Company’s business segments also has designated operations officers, committees and groups, including operations and information technology groups (collectively, “Segment Control Groups” and, together 133 G-140 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) with the Company Control Groups, the “Control Groups”) to manage and monitor specific risks and report to the business segment risk committee. The Control Groups work together to review the risk monitoring and risk management policies and procedures relating to, among other things, the business segment’s market, credit and operational risk profile, sales practices, reputation, legal enforceability, and operational and technological risks. Participation by the senior officers of the Control Groups helps ensure that risk policies and procedures, exceptions to risk limits, new products and business ventures, and transactions with risk elements undergo a thorough review. Market Risk. Market risk refers to the risk that a change in the level of one or more market prices, rates, indices, implied volatilities (the price volatility of the underlying instrument imputed from option prices), correlations or other market factors, such as liquidity, will result in losses for a position or portfolio. The Company manages the market risk associated with its trading activities on a Company−wide basis, on a worldwide trading division level and on an individual product basis. Aggregate market risk limits have been approved for the Company and for its major trading divisions worldwide (equity and fixed income, which includes interest rate products, credit products, foreign exchange and commodities). Additional market risk limits are assigned to trading desks and, as appropriate, products and regions. Trading division risk managers, desk risk managers, traders and the Market Risk Department monitor market risk measures against limits in accordance with policies set by senior management. The Market Risk Department independently reviews the Company’s trading portfolios on a regular basis from a market risk perspective utilizing Value−at−Risk and other quantitative and qualitative risk measures and analyses. The Company’s trading businesses and the Market Risk Department also use, as appropriate, measures such as sensitivity to changes in interest rates, prices, implied volatilities and time decay to monitor and report market risk exposures. Stress testing, which measures the impact on the value of existing portfolios of specified changes in market factors for certain products, is performed periodically and is reviewed by trading division risk managers, desk risk managers and the Market Risk Department. The Market Risk Department also conducts scenario analyses, which estimate the Company’s revenue sensitivity to a set of specific, predefined market and geopolitical events. Credit Risk. Credit risk refers to the risk of loss arising from borrower or counterparty default when a borrower, counterparty or obligor does not meet its financial obligations. The Company incurs significant, “single name” credit risk exposure through the Institutional Securities business. This type of risk requires credit analysis of specific counterparties, both initially and on an ongoing basis. The Institutional Credit Department (“Institutional Credit”) manages credit risk exposure for the Institutional Securities business. Institutional Credit is responsible for ensuring transparency of material credit risks, ensuring compliance with established limits, approving material extensions of credit, and escalating risk concentrations to appropriate senior management. Concentration Risk. The Company is subject to concentration risk by holding large positions in certain types of securities, loans or commitments to purchase securities of a single issuer, including sovereign governments and other entities, issuers located in a particular country or geographic area, public and private issuers involving developing countries, or issuers engaged in a particular industry. Financial instruments owned by the Company include U.S. government and agency securities and securities issued by other sovereign governments (principally Japan, United Kingdom, Germany and Brazil), which, in the aggregate, represented approximately 4% of the Company’s total assets at November 30, 2007. In addition, substantially all of the collateral held by the Company for resale agreements or bonds borrowed, which together represented approximately 19% of the Company’s total assets at November 30, 2007, consist of securities issued by the U.S. government, federal agencies or other 134 G-141 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) sovereign government obligations. Positions taken and commitments made by the Company, including positions taken and underwriting and financing commitments made in connection with its private equity, principal investment and lending activities, often involve substantial amounts and significant exposure to individual issuers and businesses, including non−investment grade issuers. In addition, the Company may originate or purchase certain residential and commercial mortgage loans that could contain certain terms and features that may result in additional credit risk as compared with more traditional types of mortgages. Such terms and features may include loans made to borrowers subject to payment increases or loans with high loan−to−value ratios. The Company seeks to limit concentration risk through the use of the systems and procedures described in the preceding discussions of risk management, market risk and credit risk. Customer Activities. The Company’s customer activities involve the execution, settlement and financing of various securities and commodities transactions on behalf of customers. Customer securities activities are transacted on either a cash or margin basis. Customer commodities activities, which include the execution of customer transactions in commodity futures transactions (including options on futures), are transacted on a margin basis. The Company’s customer activities may expose it to off−balance sheet credit risk. The Company may have to purchase or sell financial instruments at prevailing market prices in the event of the failure of a customer to settle a trade on its original terms or in the event cash and securities in customer margin accounts are not sufficient to fully cover customer losses. The Company seeks to control the risks associated with customer activities by requiring customers to maintain margin collateral in compliance with various regulations and Company policies. Derivative Contracts. The amounts in the following table represent the fair value of exchange traded and OTC options and other contracts (including interest rate, foreign exchange, and other forward contracts and swaps). Derivatives included are held for trading and investment, as well as for asset and liability management. Derivatives are disclosed net of offsetting positions in situations where netting is appropriate. The asset amounts are not reported net of non−cash collateral, which the Company obtains with respect to certain of these transactions to reduce its exposure to credit losses. Credit risk with respect to derivative instruments arises from the failure of a counterparty to perform according to the terms of the contract. The Company’s exposure to credit risk at any point in time is represented by the fair value of the contracts reported as assets. The Company monitors the creditworthiness of counterparties to these transactions on an ongoing basis and requests additional collateral when deemed necessary. The Company’s derivatives (both listed and OTC), net of cash collateral, at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 are summarized in the table below, showing the fair value of the related assets and liabilities by product: At November 30, 2007 At November 30, 2006 Assets Liabilities Assets Liabilities (dollars in millions) Product Type Interest rate and currency swaps, interest rate options, credit derivatives and other fixed income securities contracts Foreign exchange forward contracts and options Equity securities contracts (including equity swaps, warrants and options) Commodity forwards, options and swaps Total 135 $33,804 7,755 19,913 15,531 $ 19,515 9,372 27,887 14,830 $19,444 7,325 16,705 11,969 $ 15,688 7,725 23,155 10,923 $77,003 $ 71,604 $55,443 $ 57,491 G-142 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 7. Consumer Loans. Consumer loans, which primarily related to general purpose credit card and consumer installment loans of DFS, were as follows: At November 30, 2006 (dollars in millions) General purpose credit card and consumer installment Less: Allowance for consumer loan losses $ Consumer loans, net $ 23,746 831 22,915 Activity in the allowance for consumer loan losses was as follows: Fiscal Fiscal 2006 2005 (dollars in millions) Balance at beginning of period Additions: Provision for consumer loan losses(1) Purchase of consumer loans(2) Deductions: Charge−offs Recoveries(1) $ $ 943 756 55 Net charge−offs Translation adjustments and other Balance at end of period (1) (2) 838 $ 878 — (1,001) 174 (1,145) 167 (827) 9 (978) (5) 831 $ 838 Amounts included in discontinued operations. Amounts relate to the Company’s acquisition of Goldfish (see Note 23) and other acquisitions. At November 30, 2006, $5,570 million of the Company’s consumer loans had minimum contractual maturities of less than one year. Because of the uncertainty regarding consumer loan repayment patterns, which historically had been higher than contractually required minimum payments, this amount may not have necessarily been indicative of the Company’s actual consumer loan repayments. The Company received net proceeds from consumer loan sales of $5,301 million in fiscal 2007 through the date of the Discover Spin−off. The Company received net proceeds from consumer loan sales of $11,532 million and $10,525 million in fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. The Company’s U.S. consumer loan portfolio as of November 30, 2006, including securitized loans, was geographically diverse, with a distribution approximating that of the population of the U.S. At November 30, 2006, $2.3 billion of the Company’s consumer loans were classified as held for sale. On June 30, 2007, the Company completed the Discover Spin−off (see Note 22 for further information). Credit Card Securitization Activities. The Company’s retained interests in Discover’s credit card asset securitizations included undivided seller’s interests, accrued interest receivable on securitized credit card 136 G-143 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) receivables, cash collateral accounts, servicing rights, rights to any excess cash flows (“Residual Interests”) remaining after payments to investors in the securitization trusts of their contractual rate of return and reimbursement of credit losses, and other retained interests. The undivided seller’s interests less an applicable allowance for loan losses were recorded in Consumer loans. The Company’s undivided seller’s interests rank pari passu with investors’ interests in the securitization trusts, and the remaining retained interests were subordinate to investors’ interests. Accrued interest receivable and certain other subordinated retained interests were recorded in Other assets at amounts that approximated fair value. The Company received annual servicing fees of 2% of the investor principal balance outstanding. The Company did not recognize servicing assets or servicing liabilities for servicing rights as the servicing contracts provided just adequate compensation, as defined in SFAS No. 140 to the Company for performing the servicing. Residual Interests and cash collateral accounts were recorded in Other assets and reflected at fair value. The retained interests were subject to credit, payment and interest rate risks on the transferred credit card assets. The investors and the securitization trusts had no recourse to the Company’s other assets for failure of cardmembers to pay when due. The uncollected balances of securitized general purpose credit card loans were $26.7 billion at November 30, 2006. The Company no longer has retained interests in Discover’s credit card asset securitizations after the completion of the Discover Spin−off on June 30, 2007. 8. Other Investments. Other investments of $4,524 million and $3,232 million as of November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, respectively, primarily include investments in unconsolidated investees that are accounted for under the equity method of accounting (see Note 9). Beginning in the second quarter of fiscal 2007, the Company purchased certain debt securities that were classified as “securities available for sale” in accordance with SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities” (“SFAS No. 115”). During fiscal 2007, $4.3 billion of securities available for sale were sold for a loss of $74 million. In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007, the Company determined that it no longer intends to hold the remaining securities in this portfolio until the fair value of the securities recover to a level that exceeds their initial cost. Accordingly, the Company recorded an other−than−temporary impairment charge of $437 million in Principal transactions−trading revenues in the consolidated statement of income on these securities in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007 and reclassified $8.1 billion to Financial instruments owned in the consolidated statement of financial condition effective November 30, 2007. This other−than−temporary impairment charge represented all unrealized losses for these securities. 9. Investments in Unconsolidated Investees. The Company invests in unconsolidated investees that own synthetic fuel production plants and in certain structured transactions not integral to the operations of the Company. The Company accounts for these investments under the equity method of accounting. Losses from these investments were $47 million, $40 million and $311 million in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Synthetic Fuel Production Plants. The Company’s share of the operating losses generated by these investments is recorded within (Losses) gains from unconsolidated investees, and the tax credits and the tax benefits associated with these operating losses are recorded within the Provision for income taxes. 137 G-144 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The table below provides information regarding the losses from unconsolidated investees, tax credits and tax benefits on the losses: Fiscal Year 2007 2006 2005 (dollars in millions) Losses from unconsolidated investees Tax credits Tax benefits on losses $140 113 55 $225 156 89 $311 336 124 Synthetic fuels tax credits were granted under Section 45K of the Internal Revenue Code. Synthetic fuels tax credits were available in full only when the price of oil was less than a base price specified by the tax code, as adjusted for inflation (“Base Price”). The Base Price for each calendar year is determined by the Secretary of the Treasury by April 1 of the following year. If the annual average price of a barrel of oil in 2007 exceeds the applicable Base Price, the synthetic fuels tax credits generated by the Company’s synthetic fuel facilities will be phased out, on a ratable basis, over the phase−out range. Synthetic fuels tax credits realized in prior years are not affected by this limitation. Based on fiscal year to date and futures prices at November 30, 2007, the Company estimates that there will be a partial phase−out of tax credits earned in fiscal 2007. The impact of this anticipated partial phase−out is included within (Losses) gains from unconsolidated investees and the Provision for income taxes for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007. Under current tax law, the Section 45K synthetic fuels tax credits expired on December 31, 2007. The Company had entered into derivative contracts designed to reduce its exposure to rising oil prices and the potential phase−out of the synthetic fuels tax credits. Changes in fair value relative to these derivative contracts are included within Principal transactions—trading revenues. Structured Transactions. Gains from unconsolidated investees associated with investments in certain structured investments were $93 million in fiscal 2007 and $185 million in fiscal 2006. 10. Goodwill and Net Intangible Assets. The Company completed its annual goodwill impairment testing, in accordance with SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” (“SFAS No. 142”), as of December 1, 2006 and December 1, 2005. During the quarter ended August 31, 2007, the Company changed the date of its annual goodwill impairment testing to June 1 in order to move the impairment testing outside of the Company’s normal year−end reporting process to a date when resources are less constrained. The Company believes that the resulting change in accounting principle related to the annual testing date will not delay, accelerate or avoid an impairment charge. Goodwill impairment tests performed as of June 1, 2007 and December 1, 2006 and December 1, 2005 concluded that no impairment charges were required as of those dates. The Company determined that the change in accounting principle related to the annual testing date is preferable under the circumstances and does not result in adjustments to the Company’s financial statements when applied retrospectively. Additionally, due to the deterioration in the Company’s subprime−related activities, the Company performed an interim impairment test of goodwill subsequent to its annual testing date of June 1, which did not result in an impairment. 138 G-145 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Changes in the carrying amount of the Company’s goodwill and intangible assets for fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 were as follows: Goodwill: Balance as of November 30, 2005 Foreign currency translation adjustments Goodwill acquired during the year(1) Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group $ $ Balance as of November 30, 2006 Foreign currency translation adjustments Goodwill acquired during the year(2) Goodwill disposed of during the year(3) Balance as of November 30, 2007 Intangible assets: Balance as of November 30, 2005 Intangible assets acquired during the year and other(1)(4) Foreign currency translation adjustments Amortization expense(5) 701 — 862 (8) $ $ Balance as of November 30, 2006 Intangible assets acquired during the year(2) Intangible assets disposed of during the year(3) Amortization expense(5) Balance as of November 30, 2007 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) 444 — 257 1,555 227 253 — (33) 814 $ 589 18 3 (313) 966 — 2 Discover $ 968 — 207 (3) 256 31 247 534 2 — (536) Total $2,206 80 506 2,792 20 1,072 (860) $ 297 $ 1,172 $ — $3,024 $ — — — — $ — $ — (1) 67 130 16 (12) $ 294 387 16 (46) 3 242 (3) (9) 201 5 (200) (6) 651 720 (252) (72) 447 473 (49) (57) $ 540 49 — Asset Management (dollars in millions) 4 — — — — $ — $ 233 $ — $1,047 Institutional Securities activity primarily represents goodwill and intangible assets acquired in connection with the Company’s acquisition of TransMontaigne Inc., Heidmar Group and Morgan Stanley Bank International (China) Limited (formerly Nan Tung Bank Ltd. Zhuhai). Discover activity represents goodwill and intangible assets acquired in connection with the Company’s acquisition of Goldfish and other acquisitions (see Note 23). Institutional Securities activity primarily represents goodwill and intangible assets acquired in connection with the Company’s joint venture with JM Financial and the Company’s acquisitions of Saxon Capital, Inc. and CityMortgage Bank. Asset Management activity primarily represents goodwill and intangible assets acquired in connection with the Company’s acquisition of FrontPoint Partners (see Note 23). Global Wealth Management Group activity primarily represents goodwill disposed of in connection with the Company’s sale of Quilter. Discover activity represents goodwill and intangible assets disposed of in connection with the Discover Spin−off (see Note 22). Effective December 1, 2006, mortgage servicing rights have been included in net intangible assets. During fiscal 2006 amounts were reclassified to conform with the current presentation. See Note 5 for further information on the Company’s mortgage servicing rights. Amortization expense for Discover is included in discontinued operations. 139 G-146 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Amortizable intangible assets were as follows: At November 30, 2007 At November 30, 2006 Gross Carrying Accumulated Gross Carrying Accumulated Amount Amortization Amount Amortization (dollars in millions) Amortizable intangible assets: Trademarks Technology−related Customer relationships Management contracts Other Total amortizable intangible assets $ 129 151 140 220 154 $ 22 75 22 8 48 $ 193 153 214 — 107 $ 15 55 25 — 14 $ 794 $ 175 $ 667 $ 109 Amortization expense associated with intangible assets is estimated to be approximately $49 million per year over the next five fiscal years. 11. Deposits. Deposits were as follows: At At November 30, November 30, 2006 2007 (dollars in millions) Demand, passbook and money market accounts Consumer certificate accounts(1) $100,000 minimum certificate accounts $ 27,186 3,993 — $ 14,872 4,076 9,395 Total $ 31,179 $ 28,343 (1) Certain consumer certificate accounts are carried at fair value under the fair value option (see Note 3). The weighted average interest rates of interest−bearing deposits outstanding during fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 were 3.6% and 4.4%, respectively. At November 30, 2007, interest−bearing deposits maturing over the next five years were as follows: Fiscal Year (dollars in millions) 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 $ 140 30,992 — 10 76 10 G-147 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 12. Commercial Paper and Other Short−Term Borrowings. The table below summarizes certain information regarding commercial paper and other short−term borrowings for fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006: At November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Commercial paper: Balance at year−end $22,596 $22,433 Average amount outstanding $25,362 $23,962 Weighted average interest rate on year−end balance 4.8% 4.6% Other short−term borrowings(1)(2): Balance at year−end $11,899 $ 6,659 Average amount outstanding $ 8,947 $ 7,773 (1) (2) These borrowings included bank loans, Federal Funds and bank notes. Certain structured short−term borrowings are carried at fair value under the fair value option. See Note 3 for additional information. The Company maintains a senior revolving credit agreement with a group of banks to support general liquidity needs, including the issuance of commercial paper, which consists of three separate tranches: a U.S. dollar tranche; a Japanese yen tranche; and a multicurrency tranche available in both euro and British pound, all of which exist with the Company as the sole borrower. Under this combined facility (the “Credit Facility”), the banks are committed to provide up to $7.6 billion under the U.S. dollar tranche, 80 billion Japanese yen under the Japanese yen tranche and $3.25 billion under the multicurrency tranche. The Credit Facility expires on April 16, 2008 and includes a term−out feature that allows the Company, at its option, to extend borrowings under the Credit Facility for an additional one year beyond the expiration date. At November 30, 2007, the Company had a $13.8 billion consolidated stockholders’ equity surplus as compared with the Credit Facility’s covenant requirement. The Company anticipates that it may utilize the Credit Facility for short−term funding from time to time. The Company does not believe that any of the covenant requirements in its Credit Facility will impair the ability to obtain funding under the Credit Facility, pay its current level of dividends, or obtain loan arrangements, letters of credit and other financial guarantees or other financial accommodations. At November 30, 2007, no borrowings were outstanding under the Credit Facility. The Company also maintains a committed bilateral credit facility to support general liquidity needs. This facility is expected to be drawn from time to time to cover short−term funding needs. In addition, the Company, through several of its subsidiaries, maintains several funded committed credit facilities to support various businesses, including the collateralized commercial and residential mortgage whole loan, derivative contracts, warehouse lending, emerging market loan, structured product, corporate loan, investment banking and prime brokerage businesses. 141 G-148 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 13. Long−Term Borrowings. Maturities and Terms. Long−term borrowings at fiscal year−end consisted of the following: U.S. Dollar Due in fiscal 2007 Due in fiscal 2008 Due in fiscal 2009 Due in fiscal 2010 Due in fiscal 2011 Due in fiscal 2012 Thereafter Total Weighted average coupon at fiscal year−end (1) (2) (3) (4) $ Non−U.S. Dollar(1) Fixed Rate Floating Rate(2) Index Linked(3) — 1,592 1,993 3,709 5,786 6,958 24,337 $ $ $44,375 5.6% — 17,679 11,717 5,499 1,795 2,600 6,001 $45,291 — 5,305 2,923 3,204 1,119 1,658 3,227 $ 17,436 5.2% n/a $ At November 30, Fixed Floating Rate Rate(2) (dollars in millions) Index Linked(3) — 1,339 3,134 2,309 1,930 5,118 14,467 $ $28,297 4.3% $ — 4,136 1,041 1,538 728 6,262 17,024 $30,729 4.8% — 757 2,735 3,279 1,696 4,051 11,978 $ 24,496 n/a 2007 Total(4) $ 2006 Total(4) — 30,808 23,543 19,538 13,054 26,647 77,034 $ 18,274 33,758 11,907 11,597 11,123 13,660 44,659 $190,624 $144,978 5.0% 5.0% Weighted average coupon was calculated utilizing non−U.S. dollar interest rates. U.S. dollar contractual floating rate borrowings bear interest based on a variety of money market indices, including London Interbank Offered Rates (“LIBOR”) and Federal Funds rates. Non−U.S. dollar contractual floating rate borrowings bear interest based primarily on Euribor floating rates. Amounts include borrowings that are equity−linked, credit−linked, commodity−linked or linked to some other index. Amounts include an increase of approximately $164 million at November 30, 2007 and a decrease of approximately $326 million at November 30, 2006 to the carrying amount of certain of the Company’s long−term borrowings associated with fair value hedges under SFAS No. 133. The Company’s long−term borrowings included the following components: At November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Senior debt Subordinated debt Junior subordinated debentures Total $ 181,733 4,015 4,876 $ 136,213 3,881 4,884 $ 190,624 $ 144,978 Senior debt securities often are denominated in various non−U.S. dollar currencies and may be structured to provide a return that is equity−linked, credit−linked, commodity−linked or linked to some other index (e.g., the consumer price index). Senior debt also may be structured to be callable by the Company or extendible at the option of holders of the senior debt securities. Debt containing provisions that effectively allow the holders to put or extend the notes aggregated $6,736 million at November 30, 2007 and $16,016 million at November 30, 2006. Subordinated debt and junior subordinated debentures typically are issued to meet the capital requirements of the Company or its regulated subsidiaries and primarily are U.S. dollar denominated. Senior Debt—Structured Borrowings. The Company’s index−linked, equity−linked or credit−linked borrowings include various structured instruments whose payments and redemption values are linked to the performance of a specific index (e.g., Standard & Poor’s 500), a basket of stocks, a specific equity security, a credit exposure or basket of credit exposures. To minimize the exposure resulting from movements in the underlying index, equity, 142 G-149 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) credit or other position, the Company has entered into various swap contracts and purchased options that effectively convert the borrowing costs into floating rates based upon LIBOR. These instruments are included in the preceding table at their redemption values based on the performance of the underlying indices, baskets of stocks, or specific equity securities, credit or other position or index. The Company accounts for these structured borrowings containing embedded derivatives which, prior to the adoption of SFAS No. 159, were bifurcated from the hybrid notes and accounted for at fair value. Effective December 1, 2006, the Company applied the fair value election in certain cases to these hybrid notes. The swaps and purchased options used to economically hedge the embedded features are derivatives, and also are carried at fair value. Changes in fair value related to the notes and economic hedges are reported in Principal transactions trading revenues. Subordinated Debt and Junior Subordinated Debentures. Included in the Company’s long−term borrowings are subordinated notes (including the Series F notes issued by MS&Co. discussed below) of $4,015 million having a contractual weighted average coupon of 4.77% at November 30, 2007 and $3,881 million having a weighted average coupon of 4.77% at November 30, 2006. Junior subordinated debentures outstanding by the Company were $4,876 million at November 30, 2007 and $4,884 million at November 30, 2006 having a contractual weighted average coupon of 6.37% at November 30, 2007 and 6.51% at November 30, 2006. Maturities of the subordinated and junior subordinated notes range from fiscal 2011 to fiscal 2046. Maturities of certain junior subordinated debentures can be extended to 2067 at the Company’s option. At November 30, 2007, MS&Co. had a $25 million 7.82% fixed rate subordinated Series F note outstanding. The note matures in fiscal 2016. The terms of the note contain restrictive covenants that require, among other things, MS&Co. to maintain specified levels of Consolidated Tangible Net Worth and Net Capital, each as defined therein. As of November 30, 2007, MS&Co. was in compliance with these restrictive covenants. Asset and Liability Management. In general, securities inventories not financed by secured funding sources and the majority of current assets are financed with a combination of short−term funding, floating rate long−term debt or fixed rate long−term debt swapped to a floating rate. Fixed assets are financed with fixed rate long−term debt. The Company uses interest rate swaps to more closely match these borrowings to the duration, holding period and interest rate characteristics of the assets being funded and to manage interest rate risk. These swaps effectively convert certain of the Company’s fixed rate borrowings into floating rate obligations. In addition, for non−U.S. dollar currency borrowings that are not used to fund assets in the same currency, the Company has entered into currency swaps that effectively convert the borrowings into U.S. dollar obligations. The Company’s use of swaps for asset and liability management affected its effective average borrowing rate as follows: Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 Weighted average coupon of long−term borrowings at fiscal year−end(1) 5.0% 5.0% 4.6% Effective average borrowing rate for long−term borrowings after swaps at fiscal year−end(1) 5.1% 5.0% 4.1% (1) Included in the weighted average and effective average calculations are non−U.S. dollar interest rates. Subsequent to fiscal year−end and through December 31, 2007, the Company’s long−term borrowings (net of repayments) increased by approximately $10 billion. In addition, the Company sold Equity Units to a wholly−owned subsidiary of China Investment Corporation Ltd. (“CIC”) for approximately $5,579 million. 143 G-150 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 14. Capital Units. The Company had Capital Units outstanding that were issued by the Company and Morgan Stanley Finance plc (“MSF”), a U.K. subsidiary. A Capital Unit consisted of (a) a Subordinated Debenture of MSF guaranteed by the Company and maturing in 2017 and (b) a related Purchase Contract issued by the Company, which may have been accelerated by the Company, requiring the holder to purchase one Depositary Share representing shares of the Company’s Cumulative Preferred Stock. The aggregate amount of Capital Units outstanding was $66 million at November 30, 2006. The Company redeemed all $66 million of the outstanding Capital Units on February 28, 2007. 15. Commitments, Guarantees and Contingencies. Commitments. The Company’s commitments as of November 30, 2007 are summarized below by period of expiration. Since commitments may expire unused, the amounts shown do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements: Years to Maturity Less than 1 Letters of credit and other financial guarantees(1) Letters of credit issued by subsidiaries that are guaranteed by the Company Investment activities(2) Investment grade primary lending commitments(3)(4) Non−investment grade primary lending commitments(3)(4) Investment grade secondary lending commitments(4)(5) Non−investment grade secondary lending commitments(4)(5) Commitments for secured lending transactions(6) Commercial and residential mortgage−related commitments(7) Other commitments(8) Total (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) 1−3 $10,790 197 318 19,656 789 — 81 3,824 5,680 964 $ 4 1,186 238 5,791 1,072 — 27 4,095 — 19 $42,299 $12,432 3−5 Over 5 (dollars in millions) $ 4 194 108 23,323 3,931 — 151 1,073 — 5 $28,789 $ Total — 3,674 647 1,421 14,220 1,406 2,090 2,628 — — $ 10,798 5,251 1,311 50,191 20,012 1,406 2,349 11,620 5,680 988 $26,086 $109,606 This amount primarily represents the Company’s outstanding letters of credit and other financial guarantees issued by third−party banks to certain of the Company’s counterparties. The Company is contingently liable for these letters of credit and other financial guarantees, which are primarily used to satisfy various collateral and margin requirements. This amount represents commitments associated with the Company’s real estate, private equity and principal investment activities, which include alternative products. The Company’s investment grade and non−investment grade primary lending commitments are made in connection with corporate lending and other business activities. Credit ratings for commitments are determined by the Company’s Institutional Credit Department using methodologies generally consistent with those employed by external rating agencies. Obligor credit ratings of BB+ or lower are considered non−investment grade. The Company records these commitments at fair value within Financial instruments owned and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased in the consolidated statement of financial condition (see Note 3). This amount represents commitments associated with the Company’s Institutional Securities sales and trading activities. 144 G-151 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) (6) (7) (8) This amount represents lending commitments extended by the Company to companies that are secured by real estate assets of the borrower. Loans made under these arrangements typically are at variable rates and generally provide for over−collateralization based upon the creditworthiness of the borrower. This amount also includes commitments to asset−backed commercial paper conduits of $1,246 million, which have maturities of less than four years. These amounts represent the Company’s forward purchase contracts involving mortgage loans, residential mortgage loan commitments to individuals and residential home equity lines of credit. This amount includes commercial loan commitments to small businesses and commitments related to securities−based lending activities in connection with the Company’s Global Wealth Management Group business. At November 30, 2007, the Company had commitments to enter into reverse repurchase and repurchase agreements of approximately $107 billion and $26 billion, respectively. Premises and Equipment. The Company has non−cancelable operating leases covering premises and equipment. At November 30, 2007, future minimum rental commitments under such leases (net of subleases, principally on office rentals) were as follows (dollars in millions): Fiscal Year 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 Thereafter $ 549 504 403 348 328 2,732 The total of minimum rentals to be received in the future under non−cancelable subleases as of November 30, 2007 was $96 million. Occupancy lease agreements, in addition to base rentals, generally provide for rent and operating expense escalations resulting from increased assessments for real estate taxes and other charges. Total rent expense, net of sublease rental income, was $604 million, $470 million and $571 million in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. The net rent expense for fiscal 2005 included $105 million related to the lease adjustment charge recorded in the first quarter of fiscal 2005 (see Note 26). In connection with its commodities business, the Company enters into operating leases for both crude oil and refined products storage and for vessel charters. These operating leases are integral parts of the Company’s commodities risk management business. At November 30, 2007, future minimum rental commitments under such leases were as follows (dollars in millions): Fiscal Year 2008 2009 2010 2011 2012 Thereafter $650 357 212 117 93 123 Guarantees. The Company has certain obligations under certain guarantee arrangements, including contracts and indemnification agreements that contingently require a guarantor to make payments to the guaranteed party based 145 G-152 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) on changes in an underlying measure (such as an interest or foreign exchange rate, security or commodity price, an index or the occurrence or non−occurrence of a specified event) related to an asset, liability or equity security of a guaranteed party. Also included as guarantees are contracts that contingently require the guarantor to make payments to the guaranteed party based on another entity’s failure to perform under an agreement, as well as indirect guarantees of the indebtedness of others. The Company’s use of guarantees is described below by type of guarantee: Derivative Contracts. Certain derivative contracts meet the accounting definition of a guarantee, including certain written options, contingent forward contracts and credit default swaps. Although the Company’s derivative arrangements do not specifically identify whether the derivative counterparty retains the underlying asset, liability or equity security, the Company has disclosed information regarding all derivative contracts that could meet the accounting definition of a guarantee. The maximum potential payout for certain derivative contracts, such as written interest rate caps and written foreign currency options, cannot be estimated, as increases in interest or foreign exchange rates in the future could possibly be unlimited. Therefore, in order to provide information regarding the maximum potential amount of future payments that the Company could be required to make under certain derivative contracts, the notional amount of the contracts has been disclosed. The Company records all derivative contracts at fair value. For this reason, the Company does not monitor its risk exposure to such derivative contracts based on derivative notional amounts; rather, the Company manages its risk exposure on a fair value basis. Aggregate market risk limits have been established, and market risk measures are routinely monitored against these limits. The Company also manages its exposure to these derivative contracts through a variety of risk mitigation strategies, including, but not limited to, entering into offsetting economic hedge positions. The Company believes that the notional amounts of the derivative contracts generally overstate its exposure. Standby Letters of Credit and other Financial Guarantees. In connection with its corporate lending business and other corporate activities, the Company provides standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees to counterparties. Such arrangements represent obligations to make payments to third parties if the counterparty fails to fulfill its obligation under a borrowing arrangement or other contractual obligation. Market Value Guarantees. Market value guarantees are issued to guarantee return of principal invested to fund investors associated with certain European equity funds and to guarantee timely payment of a specified return to investors in certain affordable housing tax credit funds. The guarantees associated with certain European equity funds are designed to provide for any shortfall between the market value of the underlying fund assets and invested principal and a stipulated return amount. The guarantees provided to investors in certain affordable housing tax credit funds are designed to return an investor’s contribution to a fund and the investor’s share of tax losses and tax credits expected to be generated by a fund. Liquidity Facilities. The Company has entered into liquidity facilities with SPEs and other counterparties, whereby the Company is required to make certain payments if losses or defaults occur. Primarily, the Company acts as liquidity provider to municipal bond securitization SPEs and for standalone municipal bonds in which the holders of beneficial interests issued by these SPEs or the holders of the individual bonds have the right to tender their interests for purchase by the Company on specified dates at a specified price. The Company often may have recourse to the underlying assets held by the SPEs in the event payments are required under such liquidity facilities as well as make−whole or recourse provisions with the trust sponsors. 146 G-153 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The table below summarizes certain information regarding these guarantees at November 30, 2007: Maximum Potential Payout/Notional Type of Guarantee Notional amount of derivative contracts Standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees(1) Market value guarantees Liquidity facilities (1) Less than 1 Years to Maturity 1−3 3−5 Over 5 (dollars in millions) Total Carrying Amount $ 999,552 $ 1,004,069 $ 2,546,374 $ 2,570,385 $ 7,120,380 $ 131,678 5,133 97 18,043 1,824 106 1,026 1,107 — 444 6,712 655 1,652 14,776 858 21,165 802 44 — Collateral/ Recourse $ 59 2,396 145 20,281 Approximately $14 billion of standby letters of credit are also reflected in the “Commitments” table above in the investment grade and non−investment grade primary and secondary lending commitments and in the letters of credit issued by subsidiaries that are guaranteed by the Company. Trust Preferred Securities. The Company has established Morgan Stanley Trusts for the limited purpose of issuing trust preferred securities to third parties and lending the proceeds to the Company in exchange for junior subordinated debentures. The Company has directly guaranteed the repayment of the trust preferred securities to the holders thereof to the extent that the Company has made payments to a Morgan Stanley Trust on the junior subordinated debentures. In the event that the Company does not make payments to a Morgan Stanley Trust, holders of such series of trust preferred securities would not be able to rely upon the guarantee for payment of those amounts. The Company has not recorded any liability in the consolidated financial statements for these guarantees and believes that the occurrence of any events (i.e., nonperformance on the part of the paying agent) that would trigger payments under these contracts is remote. See Note 13 for details on the Company’s junior subordinated debentures. Indemnities. In the normal course of its business, the Company provides standard indemnities to counterparties for certain contingent exposures and taxes, including U.S. and foreign withholding taxes, on interest and other payments made on derivatives, securities and stock lending transactions, certain annuity products and other financial arrangements. These indemnity payments could be required based on a change in the tax laws or change in interpretation of applicable tax rulings or a change in factual circumstances. Certain contracts contain provisions that enable the Company to terminate the agreement upon the occurrence of such events. The maximum potential amount of future payments that the Company could be required to make under these indemnifications cannot be estimated. The Company has not recorded any contingent liability in the consolidated financial statements for these indemnifications and believes that the occurrence of any events that would trigger payments under these contracts is remote. Exchange/Clearinghouse Member Guarantees. The Company is a member of various U.S. and non−U.S. exchanges and clearinghouses that trade and clear securities and/or futures contracts. Associated with its membership, the Company may be required to pay a proportionate share of the financial obligations of another member who may default on its obligations to the exchange or the clearinghouse. While the rules governing different exchange or clearinghouse memberships vary, in general the Company’s guarantee obligations would arise only if the exchange or clearinghouse had previously exhausted its resources. In addition, any such guarantee obligation would be apportioned among the other non−defaulting members of the exchange or clearinghouse. Any potential contingent liability under these membership agreements cannot be estimated. The Company has not recorded any contingent liability in the consolidated financial statements for these agreements and believes that any potential requirement to make payments under these agreements is remote. 147 G-154 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) General Partner Guarantees. As a general partner in certain private equity and real estate partnerships, the Company receives distributions from the partnerships according to the provisions of the partnership agreements. The Company may, from time to time, be required to return all or a portion of such distributions to the limited partners in the event the limited partners do not achieve a certain return as specified in various partnership agreements, subject to certain limitations. The maximum potential amount of future payments that the Company could be required to make under these provisions at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 was $472 million and $320 million, respectively. As of November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, the Company’s accrued liability for distributions that the Company has determined is probable it will be required to refund based on the applicable refund criteria specified in the various partnership agreements was $20 million and $25 million, respectively. Securitized Asset Guarantees. As part of the Company’s Institutional Securities securitization activities, the Company provides representations and warranties that certain securitized assets conform to specified guidelines. The Company may be required to repurchase such assets or indemnify the purchaser against losses if the assets do not meet certain conforming guidelines. Due diligence is performed by the Company to ensure that asset guideline qualifications are met, and, to the extent the Company has acquired such assets to be securitized from other parties, the Company seeks to obtain its own representations and warranties regarding the assets. The maximum potential amount of future payments the Company could be required to make would be equal to the current outstanding balances of all assets subject to such securitization activities. Also, in connection with originations of residential mortgage ® loans under the Company’s FlexSource program, the Company may permit borrowers to pledge marketable securities as collateral instead of requiring cash down payments for the purchase of the underlying residential property. Upon sale of the residential mortgage loans, the Company may provide a surety bond that reimburses the purchasers for shortfalls in the borrowers’ securities accounts up to certain limits if the collateral maintained in the securities accounts (along with the associated real estate collateral) is insufficient to cover losses that purchasers experience as a result of defaults by borrowers on the underlying residential mortgage loans. The Company requires the borrowers to meet daily collateral calls to ensure the marketable securities pledged in lieu of a cash down payment are sufficient. At November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, the maximum potential amount of future payments the Company may be required to make under its surety bond was $122 million and $121 million, respectively. The Company has not recorded any contingent liability in the consolidated financial statements for these representations and warranties and reimbursement agreements and believes that the probability of any payments under these arrangements is remote. Other. The Company may, from time to time, in its role as investment banking advisor be required to provide guarantees in connection with certain European merger and acquisition transactions. If required by the regulating authorities, the Company provides a guarantee that the acquirer in the merger and acquisition transaction has or will have sufficient funds to complete the transaction and would then be required to make the acquisition payments in the event the acquirer’s funds are insufficient at the completion date of the transaction. These arrangements generally cover the time frame from the transaction offer date to its closing date and, therefore, are generally short term in nature. The maximum potential amount of future payments that the Company could be required to make cannot be estimated. The Company believes the likelihood of any payment by the Company under these arrangements is remote given the level of the Company’s due diligence associated with its role as investment banking advisor. In the ordinary course of business, the Company guarantees the debt and/or certain trading obligations (including obligations associated with derivatives, foreign exchange contracts and the settlement of physical commodities) of certain subsidiaries. These guarantees generally are entity or product specific and are required by investors or trading counterparties. The activities of the subsidiaries covered by these guarantees (including any related debt or trading obligations) are included in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. 148 G-155 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Contingencies. Legal. In the normal course of business, the Company has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the issuers that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or in financial distress. The Company is also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental and self−regulatory agencies regarding the Company’s business, including, among other matters, accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief. The Company contests liability and/or the amount of damages as appropriate in each pending matter. In view of the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of such matters, particularly in cases where claimants seek substantial or indeterminate damages or where investigations and proceedings are in the early stages, the Company cannot predict with certainty the loss or range of loss, if any, related to such matters, how or if such matters will be resolved, when they will ultimately be resolved, or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, might be. Subject to the foregoing, the Company believes, based on current knowledge and after consultation with counsel, that the outcome of such pending matters will not have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition of the Company, although the outcome of such matters could be material to the Company’s operating results and cash flows for a particular future period, depending on, among other things, the level of the Company’s revenues or income for such period. Legal reserves have been established in accordance with SFAS No. 5, “Accounting for Contingencies” (“SFAS No. 5”). Once established, reserves are adjusted when there is more information available or when an event occurs requiring a change. Coleman Litigation. In May 2003, Coleman (Parent) Holdings Inc. (“CPH”) filed a complaint against Morgan Stanley in the Circuit Court of the Fifteenth Judicial Circuit for Palm Beach County, Florida relating to the 1998 merger between The Coleman Company, Inc. and Sunbeam, Inc. In June 2005, the trial court issued a final judgment in favor of CPH in the amount of $1,578 million, which included prejudgment interest and excluded certain payments received by CPH in settlement of related claims against others. In June 2005, Morgan Stanley filed a notice of appeal with the District Court of Appeal for the Fourth District of Florida (the “Court of Appeal”) and posted a supersedeas bond, which automatically stayed execution of the judgment pending appeal. In March 2007, the Court of Appeal issued an opinion reversing the trial court’s award for compensatory and punitive damages and remanding the matter to the trial court for entry of judgment for Morgan Stanley. In June 2007, the Court of Appeal’s opinion became final when the Court of Appeal issued an order denying CPH’s motions for rehearing, rehearing en banc and for certification of certain questions for review by the Florida Supreme Court (the “Supreme Court”). In June 2007, the trial court issued an order cancelling the supersedeas bond that Morgan Stanley had posted. In July 2007, CPH filed a petition with the Supreme Court asking that court to review the Court of Appeal’s decision (“Petition for Review”). On December 12, 2007, the Supreme Court issued an order denying CPH’s Petition for Review. The Company believes, after consultation with outside counsel, that the Supreme Court’s decision to deny the Petition for Review has effectively ended CPH’s civil claim against the Company. Effective November 30, 2007, the Company reversed the $360 million reserve previously established for the Coleman litigation under SFAS No. 5. 149 G-156 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 16. Shareholders’ Equity. Common Stock. Changes in shares of common stock outstanding for fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 were as follows (share data in millions): Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Shares outstanding at beginning of period Net impact of stock option exercises and other share issuances Treasury stock purchases 1,049 59 (52) 1,058 43 (52) Shares outstanding at end of period 1,056 1,049 Treasury Shares. During fiscal 2007, the Company purchased $3.8 billion of its common stock through open market purchases at an average cost of $72.65 per share. During fiscal 2006, the Company purchased $3.4 billion of its common stock through open market purchases at an average cost of $65.43 per share. In December 2006, the Company announced that its Board of Directors had authorized the repurchase of up to $6 billion of the Company’s outstanding common stock. This share repurchase authorization considers, among other things, business segment capital needs, as well as equity−based compensation and benefit plan requirements. As of November 30, 2007, the Company had approximately $2.3 billion remaining under its current share repurchase authorization. Rabbi Trusts. The Company has established rabbi trusts (the “Rabbi Trusts”) to provide common stock voting rights to certain employees who hold outstanding restricted stock units. The number of shares of common stock outstanding in the Rabbi Trusts was approximately 107 million at November 30, 2007 and approximately 81 million at November 30, 2006. The assets of the Rabbi Trusts are consolidated with those of the Company, and the value of the Company’s stock held in the Rabbi Trusts is classified in Shareholders’ equity and generally accounted for in a manner similar to treasury stock. Preferred Stock. In July 2006, the Company issued 44,000,000 Depositary Shares, in an aggregate of $1,100 million. Each Depositary Share represents 1/1,000th of a Share of Floating Rate Non−Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series A, $0.01 par value (“Series A Preferred Stock”). The Series A Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Company’s option, in whole or in part, on or after July 15, 2011 at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $25 per Depositary Share). The Series A Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Company’s common stock upon liquidation. Subsequent to fiscal year−end, the Company declared a quarterly dividend of $379.66 per share of Series A Preferred Stock that was paid on January 15, 2008 to preferred shareholders of record on December 31, 2007. Regulatory Requirements. On April 1, 2007, the Company merged MSDWI into MS&Co. Upon completion of the merger, the surviving entity, MS&Co., became the Company’s principal U.S. broker−dealer. MS&Co. is a registered broker−dealer and registered futures commission merchant and, accordingly, is subject to the minimum net capital requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”), the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority and the Commodity Futures Trading Commission. MS&Co. has consistently operated in excess of these requirements. MS&Co.’s net capital totaled $6,673 million at November 30, 2007, which exceeded the amount required by $4,950 million. MSIP, a London−based broker−dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Financial Services Authority, and MSJS, a Tokyo−based broker−dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Financial Services Agency. MSIP and MSJS consistently operated in excess of their respective regulatory capital requirements. 150 G-157 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Under regulatory capital requirements adopted by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”) and other bank regulatory agencies, FDIC−insured financial institutions must maintain (a) 3% to 4% of Tier 1 capital, as defined, to average assets (“leverage ratio”), (b) 4% of Tier 1 capital, as defined, to risk−weighted assets (“Tier 1 risk−weighted capital ratio”) and (c) 8% of total capital, as defined, to risk−weighted assets (“total risk−weighted capital ratio”). At November 30, 2007, the leverage ratio, Tier 1 risk−weighted capital ratio and total risk−weighted capital ratio of each of the Company’s FDIC−insured financial institutions exceeded these regulatory minimums. Certain other U.S. and non−U.S. subsidiaries are subject to various securities, commodities and banking regulations, and capital adequacy requirements promulgated by the regulatory and exchange authorities of the countries in which they operate. These subsidiaries have consistently operated in excess of their local capital adequacy requirements. Morgan Stanley Derivative Products Inc. (“MSDP”) and Cournot Financial Products LLC (“Cournot”), which are triple−A rated derivative products subsidiaries, maintain certain operating restrictions that have been reviewed by various rating agencies. Both entities are operated such that creditors of the Company should not expect to have any claims on either the assets of Cournot or the assets of MSDP, unless and until the obligations of such entity to its own creditors are satisfied in full. Creditors of Cournot or MSDP, respectively, should not expect to have any claims on the assets of the Company or any of its affiliates, other than the respective assets of Cournot or MSDP. The Company is a consolidated supervised entity (“CSE”) as defined by the SEC. As such, the Company is subject to group−wide supervision and examination by the SEC and to minimum capital requirements on a consolidated basis. As of November 2007, the Company was in compliance with the CSE capital requirements. MS&Co. is required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of Rule 15c3−1. MS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. As of November 30, 2007, MS&Co. had tentative net capital in excess of the minimum and the notification requirements. The regulatory capital requirements referred to above, and certain covenants contained in various agreements governing indebtedness of the Company, may restrict the Company’s ability to withdraw capital from its subsidiaries. At November 30, 2007, approximately $14.2 billion of net assets of consolidated subsidiaries may be restricted as to the payment of cash dividends and advances to the Company. Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss). As of November 30, 2007, the components of the Company’s Accumulated other comprehensive loss are as follows: At At November 30, November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Foreign currency translation adjustments, net of tax Net change in cash flow hedges, net of tax Minimum pension liability adjustment, net of tax SFAS No. 158 pension adjustment, net of tax $ 114 (58) (47) (208) $ 49 (77) (7) — Accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax $ (199) $ (35) Cumulative Foreign Currency Translation Adjustments. Cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments include gains or losses resulting from translating foreign currency financial statements from their respective 151 G-158 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) functional currencies to U.S. dollars, net of hedge gains or losses and related tax effects. The Company uses foreign currency contracts and designates certain non−U.S. dollar currency debt as hedges to manage the currency exposure relating to its net monetary investments in non−U.S. dollar functional currency subsidiaries. Increases or decreases in the value of the Company’s net foreign investments generally are tax deferred for U.S. purposes, but the related hedge gains and losses are taxable currently. The Company attempts to protect its net book value from the effects of fluctuations in currency exchange rates on its net monetary investments in non−U.S. dollar subsidiaries by selling the appropriate non−U.S. dollar currency in the forward market. However, under some circumstances, the Company may elect not to hedge its net monetary investments in certain foreign operations due to market conditions, including the availability of various currency contracts at acceptable costs. Information relating to the hedging of the Company’s net monetary investments in non−U.S. dollar functional currency subsidiaries and their effects on cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments is summarized below: At November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Net monetary investments in non−U.S. dollar functional currency subsidiaries Cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments resulting from net investments in subsidiaries with a non−U.S. dollar functional currency Cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments resulting from realized or unrealized losses on hedges, net of tax Total cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments, net of tax 17. $ 9,534 $6,195 $ 1,290 $ 741 (1,176) $ 114 (692) $ 49 Earnings per Common Share. Basic EPS is computed by dividing income available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Diluted EPS reflects the assumed conversion of all dilutive securities. The following table presents the calculation of basic and diluted EPS (in millions, except for per share data): Basic EPS: Income from continuing operations before cumulative effect of accounting change, net Gain on discontinued operations, net Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Preferred stock dividend requirements Net income applicable to common shareholders Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 $ 2,563 646 — (68) $ 6,335 1,137 — (19) $ 4,532 358 49 — $ 3,141 $ 7,453 $ 4,939 Weighted average common shares outstanding 1,002 Earnings per basic common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per basic common share 152 1,010 1,050 $ 2.49 0.64 — $ 6.25 1.13 — $ 4.32 0.33 0.05 $ 3.13 $ 7.38 $ 4.70 G-159 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Diluted EPS: Net income applicable to common shareholders Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 $ $ $ Weighted average common shares outstanding Effect of dilutive securities: Stock options and restricted stock units Weighted average common shares outstanding and common stock equivalents Earnings per diluted common share: Income from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations Cumulative effect of accounting change, net Earnings per diluted common share 3,141 7,453 4,939 1,002 1,010 1,050 52 45 30 1,054 1,055 1,080 $ 2.37 0.61 — $ 5.99 1.08 — $ 4.19 0.33 0.05 $ 2.98 $ 7.07 $ 4.57 The following securities were considered antidilutive and, therefore, were excluded from the computation of diluted EPS: Fiscal Fiscal Fiscal 2007 2006 2005 (shares in millions) Number of antidilutive securities (including stock options and restricted stock units) outstanding at end of period 18. 19 38 93 Employee Stock−Based Compensation Plans. As of December 1, 2004, the Company early adopted SFAS No. 123R using the modified prospective method. SFAS No. 123R requires measurement of compensation cost for equity−based awards at fair value and recognition of compensation cost over the service period, net of estimated forfeitures. The components of the Company’s stock−based compensation expense (net of cancellations and a cumulative effect of a change in accounting principle in fiscal 2005 associated with the adoption of SFAS No. 123R) are presented below: Fiscal 2007(1) Deferred stock Stock options Employee Stock Purchase Plan Total (1) Fiscal 2006(1) (dollars in millions) Fiscal 2005 $ 1,592 241 9 $ 1,763 152 8 $ 589 143 8 $ 1,842 $ 1,923 $ 740 Amounts for fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 include $345 million and $457 million, respectively, of accrued stock−based compensation expense primarily related to fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 year−end equity awards granted in December 2007 and December 2006, respectively, to employees who are retirement−eligible under the plan terms. The table above excludes stock−based compensation expense included in discontinued operations, which was approximately $17 million, $32 million and $16 million, for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. 153 G-160 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The tax benefit for stock−based compensation expense related to deferred stock and stock options was $722 million, $737 million and $255 million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. The tax benefit for stock−based compensation expense included in discontinued operations in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 was approximately $6 million, $11 million and $5 million, respectively. At November 30, 2007, the Company had approximately $1,376 million of compensation cost related to unvested stock−based awards not yet recognized (excluding fiscal 2007 year−end awards granted in December 2007 to nonretirement−eligible employees, which will begin to be amortized in fiscal 2008). The unrecognized compensation cost relating to unvested stock−based awards expected to vest will primarily be recognized over the next two years. In connection with awards under its equity−based compensation and benefit plans, the Company is authorized to issue shares of its common stock held in treasury or newly issued shares. At November 30, 2007, approximately 166 million shares were available for future grant under these plans. The Company generally uses treasury shares to deliver shares to employees and has an ongoing repurchase authorization that includes repurchases in connection with awards granted under its equity−based compensation plans. As a result of the Discover Spin−off effective June 30, 2007, all outstanding options to purchase the Company’s common stock held by employees of Discover were canceled and replaced with options to purchase Discover common stock. Outstanding options to purchase Morgan Stanley common stock held by directors and employees who remained with the Company after the Discover Spin−off were adjusted to preserve the intrinsic value of the award immediately prior to the spin−off using an adjustment ratio based on the Morgan Stanley closing market stock price immediately prior to the spin−off date and the beginning market stock price at the date of the spin−off. Additional compensation cost recognized as a result of this modification was not material. Similarly, restricted stock units awarded pursuant to equity incentive plans and held by employees of Discover were canceled and replaced with restricted units of Discover stock. Outstanding deferred shares held by Morgan Stanley directors and employees who remained with the Company after the Discover Spin−off were adjusted by multiplying the number of shares by an adjustment ratio in order to account for the impact of the spin−off on the value of the Company’s shares at the time the spin−off was completed. No additional compensation cost was recognized as a result of this modification. Cash paid to the holders of deferred shares in lieu of fractional shares was not material. Deferred Stock Awards. The Company has made deferred stock awards pursuant to several equity−based compensation plans. The plans provide for the deferral of a portion of certain key employees’ discretionary compensation with awards made in the form of restricted common stock or in the right to receive unrestricted shares of common stock in the future (“restricted stock units”). Awards under these plans are generally subject to vesting over time contingent upon continued employment and to restrictions on sale, transfer or assignment until the end of a specified period, generally two to five years from date of grant. All or a portion of an award may be canceled if employment is terminated before the end of the relevant restriction period. All or a portion of a vested award also may be canceled in certain limited situations, including termination for cause during the relevant restriction period. Recipients of deferred stock awards generally receive dividend equivalents that are not subject to vesting and have voting rights. 154 G-161 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table sets forth activity relating to the Company’s vested and unvested restricted stock units (share data in millions): Fiscal 2007(1) (1) (2) (3) Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 Restricted stock units at beginning of year Granted Conversions to common stock Canceled(2) 95 31 (12) (6) 60 38 (12) (5) 78 4 (18) (4) Restricted stock units at end of year(3) 108 81 60 For fiscal 2007, the number of restricted stock units was adjusted to reflect the impact of the Discover Spin−off. Amount includes approximately 1 million awards held by Discover employees that were canceled as a result of the Discover Spin−off. Approximately 104 million awards were vested or expected to vest at the end of fiscal 2007. The weighted average price of restricted stock units at the beginning and end of fiscal 2007 was $45.59 (as adjusted to reflect the impact of the Discover Spin−off) and $51.95, respectively. During fiscal 2007, the weighted average price for granted, converted and canceled restricted stock units was $66.68, $40.22 and $52.24, respectively (adjusted to reflect the impact of the Discover Spin−off). The weighted average price for restricted stock units granted during fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 was $57.86 and $53.10, respectively (unadjusted for the Discover Spin−off). The total fair value of restricted stock units converted to common stock during fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 was $817 million, $768 million and $986 million, respectively. The following table sets forth activity relating to the Company’s unvested restricted stock units (share data in millions): Fiscal 2007 Number of Shares(1) Unvested restricted stock units at beginning of period Granted Vested Canceled(2) Unvested restricted stock units at end of period(3) (1) (2) (3) Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value(1) 60 31 (27) (5) $ 46.55 66.68 51.33 54.21 59 $ 54.29 The number of shares and weighted average grant date fair value have been adjusted to reflect the impact of the Discover Spin−off based on the adjustment ratio discussed above. Amount includes approximately 1 million awards held by Discover employees that were canceled due to the Discover Spin−off. Unvested restricted stock units represent awards where recipients have yet to satisfy either the explicit vesting terms or retirement−eligible requirements. Approximately 56 million unvested restricted stock units, with a weighted average grant date fair value of $53.81, were expected to vest at the end of fiscal 2007. 155 G-162 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Stock Option Awards. The Company has granted stock option awards pursuant to several equity−based compensation plans. The plans provide for the deferral of a portion of certain key employees’ discretionary compensation with awards made in the form of stock options generally having an exercise price not less than the fair value of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant. Such stock option awards generally become exercisable over a three−year period and expire 10 years from the date of grant, subject to accelerated expiration upon termination of employment. Stock option awards have vesting, restriction and cancellation provisions that are generally similar to those in deferred stock awards. The weighted average fair values of the Company’s options granted during fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 were $18.55 (as adjusted to reflect the impact of the Discover Spin−off), $14.15 and $12.77 (unadjusted for the Discover Spin−off), respectively, utilizing the following weighted average assumptions: Fiscal 2007 Risk−free interest rate Expected option life in years Expected stock price volatility Expected dividend yield Fiscal 2006 4.4% 6.0 23.8% 1.4% Fiscal 2005 4.8% 3.3 28.6% 1.7% 3.7% 3.1 34.3% 2.0% The Company’s expected option life has been determined based upon historical experience. Beginning on December 1, 2006, the expected stock price volatility assumption was determined using the implied volatility of exchange−traded options, consistent with the guidance in Staff Accounting Bulletin (“SAB”) No. 107, “Share−Based Payment” (“SAB 107”). Prior to December 1, 2006, the expected stock price volatility was determined based upon the Company’s historical stock price data over a time period similar to the expected option life. The Company believes that implied volatility is more reflective of market conditions and a better indicator of expected volatility than historical volatility or a combined method of determining volatility. The following table sets forth activity relating to the Company’s stock options (share data in millions): Fiscal 2007 Weighted Average Exercise Price(1) Number of Options(1) Fiscal 2006 Weighted Average Exercise Price Number of Options Fiscal 2005 Weighted Average Exercise Price Number of Options Options outstanding at beginning of period Granted Exercised Canceled(2) 128.6 18.9 (24.7) (4.7) $ 44.15 66.90 39.86 55.19 125.8 2.1 (14.5) (4.0) $ 51.01 64.05 44.60 57.41 152.2 0.9 (19.5) (7.8) $ 47.09 54.73 18.13 57.01 Options outstanding at end of period(3) 118.1 $ 48.22 109.4 $ 51.88 125.8 $ 51.01 96.7 $ 45.22 92.6 $ 51.65 95.4 $ 50.10 Options exercisable at end of period (1) (2) (3) For fiscal 2007, the number and weighted average exercise price have been adjusted to reflect the impact of the Discover Spin−off based on the adjustment ratio discussed above. Includes approximately 2 million awards held by DFS employees that were canceled due to the Discover Spin−off. 116.8 million awards, with a weighted average exercise price of $48.01, were vested or expected to vest at the end of fiscal 2007. The total intrinsic value of stock options exercised during fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 was $707 million, $326 million and $722 million, respectively. 156 G-163 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) As of November 30, 2007, the intrinsic value of in−the−money exercisable stock options was $826 million. The following table presents information relating to the Company’s stock options outstanding at November 30, 2007 (number of options outstanding data in millions): Options Outstanding Range of Exercise Prices $22.00 – $29.99 $30.00 – $39.99 $40.00 – $49.99 $50.00 – $59.99 $60.00 – $69.99 $70.00 – $79.99 $80.00 – $91.99 Total (1) Number Outstanding 5.3 23.6 44.3 24.9 18.9 0.7 0.4 Weighted Average Exercise Price(1) $ 22.91 34.20 47.14 53.66 66.56 72.89 87.45 118.1 Options Exercisable Average Remaining Life (Years) Number Exercisable 0.1 3.5 5.1 2.7 8.1 3.2 1.6 5.3 23.6 39.3 24.8 2.7 0.6 0.4 Weighted Average Exercise Price(1) $ Average Remaining Life (Years) 22.91 34.20 47.32 53.66 65.57 73.12 87.45 0.1 3.5 5.0 2.7 2.5 1.9 1.6 96.7 The weighted average exercise price has been adjusted to reflect the impact of the Discover Spin−off based on the adjustment ratio discussed above. In November 2007, in connection with its initial public offering, MSCI Inc., a majority−owned subsidiary of Morgan Stanley, made a founders’ grant in the form of restricted stock units (representing shares of MSCI Inc. common stock) and options to purchase MSCI Inc. common stock (such awards are not reflected in the above disclosures). The aggregate value of the founders’ grant was $68 million of restricted stock units and options, subject to two− to four−year vesting periods. 19. Employee Benefit Plans. The Company sponsors various pension plans for the majority of its U.S. and non−U.S. employees. The Company provides certain other postretirement benefits, primarily health care and life insurance, to eligible U.S. employees. The Company also provides certain postemployment benefits other than pension and postretirement benefits to certain former employees or inactive employees prior to retirement. The Company’s defined benefit pension, postretirement and postemployment plans are accounted for in accordance with SFAS Nos. 87, 88, 106 and 112. The Company adopted the provision of SFAS No. 158 to recognize the overfunded or underfunded status of the Company’s defined benefit and postretirement plans as an asset or liability in the consolidated statement of financial condition at November 30, 2007. Accordingly, the Company recorded a charge of $347 million ($208 million after−tax) to Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), a component of Shareholders’ equity (see Note 2). Prior to its adoption of SFAS No. 158, but after taking into account the effects of the Discover Spin−off, the Company recognized a final net minimum pension liability of $68 million ($47 million after−tax) at November 30, 2007 and $13 million ($7 million after−tax with recognition of a $1 million intangible asset) at November 30, 2006 for defined benefit pension plans whose accumulated benefit obligations exceeded plan assets. 157 G-164 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table illustrates the incremental effect of the application of SFAS No. 158: Before Application of SFAS No. 158 Other assets Other liabilities and accrued expenses Net deferred tax assets Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) Total shareholders’ equity $ 9,153 24,561 5,454 9 31,477 SFAS No. 158 Adjustments (dollars in millions) $ (302) 45 139 (208) (208) After Application of SFAS No. 158 $ 8,851 24,606 5,593 (199) 31,269 The Accumulated other comprehensive loss of $415 million pre−tax was composed of $(74) million in prior−year service credits and $489 million in net actuarial losses. The estimated net loss for the defined benefit pension plans that will be amortized from Accumulated other comprehensive loss into net periodic benefit cost over fiscal 2008 is approximately $32 million. The estimated prior−service credit that will be amortized from Accumulated other comprehensive loss into net periodic benefit cost over fiscal 2008 is approximately $(8) million for defined benefit pension plans and $(2) million for postretirement plans. Pension and Other Postretirement Plans. Substantially all of the U.S. employees of the Company hired before July 1, 2007 and its U.S. affiliates are covered by a non−contributory, defined benefit pension plan that is qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code (the “Qualified Plan”). Unfunded supplementary plans (the “Supplemental Plans”) cover certain executives. In addition, certain of the Company’s non−U.S. subsidiaries also have pension plans covering substantially all of their employees. These pension plans generally provide pension benefits that are based on each employee’s years of credited service and on compensation levels specified in the plans. The Company’s policy is to fund at least the amounts sufficient to meet minimum funding requirements under applicable employee benefit and tax regulations. Liabilities for benefits payable under its Supplemental Plans are accrued by the Company and are funded when paid to the beneficiaries. The Company’s U.S. Qualified Plan was closed to new participants effective July 1, 2007. In lieu of a defined benefit pension plan, eligible employees who were first hired, rehired or transferred to a U.S. benefits eligible position will receive a retirement contribution into their 401(k) plan. The amount of the retirement contribution is included in the Company’s 401(k) cost and will be equal to between 2% to 5% of eligible pay based on years of service as of December 31. The Company also has unfunded postretirement benefit plans that provide medical and life insurance for eligible U.S. retirees and their dependents. The Company uses a measurement date of September 30 to calculate obligations under its pension and postretirement plans. The Company expects to early adopt a fiscal year−end measurement date for the fiscal year ending November 30, 2008. In connection with the Discover Spin−off, the Company transferred assets and liabilities relating to certain current and former DFS employees to a new defined benefit pension plan established by DFS. The Company remeasured the assets and projected benefit obligation of the separated pension plans as of December 31, 2006. The impact of the remeasurement results on continuing operations for fiscal 2007 was not material. 158 G-165 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following tables present information for the Company’s pension and postretirement plans on an aggregate basis: Net Periodic Benefit Expense. The following table presents the components of the net periodic benefit expense: Fiscal 2007 Pension Fiscal 2006 Service cost, benefits earned during the year Interest cost on projected benefit obligation Expected return on plan assets Net amortization—prior−service cost Net amortization—actuarial loss Special termination benefits $ 109 125 (124) (8) 41 2 $ Net periodic benefit expense $ 145 $ 159 Fiscal 2005 Fiscal 2007 (dollars in millions) 111 119 (116) (7) 51 2 $ 160 $ 101 110 (107) (8) 41 — $ 137 $ 7 8 Postretirement Fiscal 2006 $ — (1) — — 14 $ Fiscal 2005 8 10 — (2) 2 — $ 18 $ 7 9 — (1) 2 — 17 G-166 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Benefit Obligations and Funded Status. The following table provides a reconciliation of the changes in the benefit obligation and fair value of plan assets for fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006 as well as a summary of the funded status at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006: Pension Reconciliation of benefit obligation: Benefit obligation at beginning of year Service cost(1) Interest cost(2) Plan amendments Actuarial (gain) loss Benefits paid Plan settlements Special termination benefits Transfers/divestitures(3) Other, including foreign currency exchange rate changes Benefit obligation at end of year Reconciliation of fair value of plan assets: Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year Actual return on plan assets Employer contributions Benefits paid Plan settlements Transfers/divestitures(3) Other, including foreign currency exchange rate changes Fair value of plan assets at end of year Net amount recognized Amounts recognized in the consolidated statements of financial condition consist of: Assets Liabilities Intangible asset Accumulated other comprehensive income Net amount recognized (2) (3) Postretirement Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 (dollars in millions) $ 2,563 109 125 (9) (46) (102) (1) 2 (400) 22 $ 2,524 133 139 2 (88) (169) (21) 2 — 41 $ 168 7 8 (4) 14 (8) — — (23) — $ 196 10 11 — (40) (9) — — — — $ 2,263 $ 2,563 $ 162 $ 168 $ 2,312 161 131 (102) (1) (405) 17 $ 2,217 144 114 (169) (21) — 27 $ — — $ — — 2,113 $ 2,312 $ — $ — $ Funded status: Unfunded status Amount contributed to plan after measurement date Unrecognized prior−service cost Unrecognized loss (1) Fiscal 2007 8 (8) — — — 9 (9) — — — $ (150) 24 — — $ (251) 4 (113) 708 $ (162) — — — $ (168) — (6) 9 $ (126) $ 348 $ (162) $ (165) $ 162 (288) — — $ 598 (263) 1 12 $ — (162) — — $ — (165) — — $ (126) $ 348 $ (162) $ (165) The pension amount related to the Discover Spin−off and the sale of Quilter was $22 million during fiscal 2006. The postretirement amount related to the Discover Spin−off was $2 million during fiscal 2006. These amounts are included in discontinued operations (see Note 22). The pension amount related to the Discover Spin−off and the sale of Quilter was $20 million during fiscal 2006. The postretirement amount related to DFS was $1 million during fiscal 2006. These amounts are included in discontinued operations (see Note 22). Transfers and divestitures primarily relate to the impact of the Discover Spin−off and non−U.S. subsidiary plans. The accumulated benefit obligation for all defined benefit pension plans was $2,147 million and $2,385 million at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, respectively. 160 G-167 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table contains information for pension plans with projected benefit obligations in excess of the fair value of plan assets as of fiscal year−end: November 30, November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Projected benefit obligation Fair value of plan assets $ 511 216 $ 338 36 The following table contains information for pension plans with accumulated benefit obligations in excess of the fair value of plan assets as of fiscal year−end: November 30, November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Accumulated benefit obligation Fair value of plan assets $ 474 216 $ 287 36 Assumptions. The following table presents the weighted average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at fiscal year−end: Pension Fiscal 2007 Discount rate Rate of future compensation increases Postretirement Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2006 6.17% 5.08 5.79% 4.40 6.34% n/a 5.97% n/a The following table presents the weighted average assumptions used to determine net periodic benefit costs for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005: Fiscal 2007 Discount rate Expected long−term rate of return on plan assets Rate of future compensation increases Pension Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 5.79% 5.60% 5.90% 6.65 4.40 6.65 4.35 6.95 4.45 Fiscal 2007 Postretirement Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 5.97% 5.75% 6.05% n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a The expected long−term rate of return on assets represents the Company’s best estimate of the long−term return on plan assets and generally was estimated by computing a weighted average return of the underlying long−term expected returns on the different asset classes, based on the target asset allocations. For plans where there is no established target asset allocation, actual asset allocations were used. The expected long−term return on assets is a long−term assumption that generally is expected to remain the same from one year to the next unless there is a significant change in the target asset allocation, the fees and expenses paid by the plan or market conditions. 161 G-168 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table presents assumed health care cost trend rates used to determine the postretirement benefit obligations at fiscal year−end: November 30, 2007 Health care cost trend rate assumed for next year: Medical Prescription Rate to which the cost trend rate is assumed to decline (ultimate trend rate) Year that the rate reaches the ultimate trend rate November 30, 2006 8.33−8.61% 11.11% 5.00% 2012 9.00−9.33% 12.33% 5.00% 2012 Assumed health care cost trend rates can have a significant effect on the amounts reported for the Company’s postretirement benefit plans. A one−percentage point change in assumed health care cost trend rates would have the following effects: One−Percentage One−Percentage Point Increase Point (Decrease) (dollars in millions) Effect on total postretirement service and interest cost Effect on postretirement benefit obligation $ 3 26 $ (2) (21) The Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 (the “Act”) was enacted in December 2003. For 2008, Morgan Stanley elected not to apply for the Medicare Retiree Drug Subsidy or take any other action related to the Act since Medicare prescription drug coverage was deemed to have no material effect on the Company’s retiree medical program. No impact of the Act has been reflected in the Company’s results. U.S. Qualified Plan Assets. The U.S. Qualified Plan assets represent 90% of the Company’s total pension plan assets. The weighted average asset allocations for the U.S. Qualified Plan at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 and the targeted asset allocation for fiscal 2008 by asset class were as follows: Fiscal 2008 Targeted Equity securities Fixed income securities Other—primarily cash Total November 30, 2007 November 30, 2006 30% 70 — 31% 68 1 44% 51 5 100% 100% 100% U.S. Qualified Pension Plan Asset Allocation. The Company, in consultation with its independent investment consultants and actuaries, determined the asset allocation targets for its U.S. Qualified Plan based on its assessment of business and financial conditions, demographic and actuarial data, funding characteristics and related risk factors. Other relevant factors, including industry practices and long−term historical and prospective capital market returns, were considered as well. The expected long−term rate of return on U.S. Qualified Plan assets is 6.75% for fiscal 2007. The U.S. Qualified Plan return objectives provide long−term measures for monitoring the investment performance against growth in the pension obligations. The overall allocation is expected to help protect the plan’s funded status while generating sufficiently stable real returns (net of inflation) to help cover current and future benefit payments. Total U.S. Qualified Plan portfolio performance is assessed by comparing actual returns with relevant benchmarks, such as the S&P 500 Index, the Russell 2000 Index, the MSCI EAFE Index and, in the case of the fixed income portfolio, the U.S. Qualified Plan’s liability profile. 162 G-169 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Both the equity and fixed income portions of the asset allocation use a combination of active and passive investment strategies and different investment styles. The fixed income asset allocation consists of longer duration fixed income securities in order to help reduce plan exposure to interest rate variation and to better correlate assets with obligations. The longer duration fixed income allocation is expected to help maintain the stability of plan contributions over the long run. The asset mix of the Company’s U.S. Qualified Plan is reviewed by the Morgan Stanley Retirement Plan Investment Committee on a regular basis. When asset class exposure reaches a minimum or maximum level, an asset allocation review process is initiated, and the portfolio is automatically rebalanced back to target allocation levels unless the Investment Committee determines otherwise. Under the current Investment Committee policy, no more than 10% of the U.S. Qualified Plan assets can be allocated to non−traditional “alternative” asset classes and only to the extent that those alternatives provide attractive diversification benefits, absolute return enhancement and/or other potential benefit to the plan. Allocations to alternative asset classes will be made based upon an evaluation of particular attributes and relevant considerations of each asset class. Derivative instruments are permitted in the U.S. Qualified Plan’s portfolio only to the extent that they comply with all of the plan’s policy guidelines and are consistent with the plan’s risk and return objectives. In addition, any investment in derivatives must meet the following conditions: • Derivatives may be used only if the vehicle is deemed by the investment manager to be more attractive than a similar direct investment in the underlying cash market or if the vehicle is being used to manage risk of the portfolio. • Derivatives may not be used in a speculative manner or to leverage the portfolio under any circumstances. • Derivatives may not be used as short−term trading vehicles. The investment philosophy of the U.S. Qualified Plan is that investment activity is undertaken for long−term investment rather than short−term trading. • Derivatives may only be used in the management of the U.S. Qualified Plan’s portfolio when their possible effects can be quantified, shown to enhance the risk−return profile of the portfolio, and reported in a meaningful and understandable manner. As a fundamental operating principle, any restrictions on the underlying assets apply to a respective derivative product. This includes percentage allocations and credit quality. Derivatives will be used solely for the purpose of enhancing investment in the underlying assets and not to circumvent portfolio restrictions. Cash Flows. The Company expects to contribute approximately $115 million to its pension and postretirement benefit plans (U.S. and non−U.S.) in fiscal 2008 based upon their current funded status and expected asset return assumptions for fiscal 2008, as applicable. Expected benefit payments associated with the Company’s pension and postretirement benefit plans for the next five fiscal years and in aggregate for the five fiscal years thereafter are as follows: Fiscal 2008 Fiscal 2009 Fiscal 2010 Fiscal 2011 Fiscal 2012 Fiscal 2013−2017 163 Pension Postretirement (dollars in millions) $ 109 109 108 109 119 654 $ 8 8 8 9 9 47 G-170 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Morgan Stanley 401(k) and Profit Sharing Awards. Eligible U.S. employees receive 401(k) matching contributions that are invested in the Company’s common stock. The retirement contribution granted in lieu of a defined benefit pension plan is included in the Company’s 401(k) expense. The Company also provides discretionary profit sharing to certain Non−U.S. employees. The pre−tax expense associated with the 401(k) match and profit sharing for fiscal 2007 was $128 million and $117 million for both fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005. The impact of the Discover Spin−off and Quilter disposal on pre−tax 401(k) match and profit sharing expense in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 was approximately $8 million, $15 million and $15 million, respectively. The impact was reflected in discontinued operations (see Note 22). Defined Contribution Pension Plans. The Company maintains separate defined contribution pension plans that cover substantially all employees of certain non−U.S. subsidiaries. Under such plans, benefits are determined based on a fixed rate of base salary with certain vesting requirements. In fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, the Company’s expense related to these plans was $115 million, $87 million and $71 million, respectively. Other Postemployment Benefits. Postemployment benefits include, but are not limited to, salary continuation, severance benefits, disability−related benefits, and continuation of health care and life insurance coverage provided to former employees or inactive employees after employment but before retirement. The postemployment benefit obligations were not material as of November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006. 20. Income Taxes. The provision for (benefit from) income taxes from continuing operations consisted of: Fiscal 2007 Current: U.S. federal U.S. state and local Non−U.S. $ 302 147 2,428 Fiscal 2006 (dollars in millions) $ 2,877 Deferred: U.S. federal U.S. state and local Non−U.S. 1,084 254 1,279 Fiscal 2005 $ 2,617 1,252 198 1,022 2,472 (1,861) (69) (116) 126 (20) 5 (873) (68) (58) (2,046) 111 (999) Provision for income taxes from continuing operations $ 831 $ 2,728 $ 1,473 Provision for income taxes from discontinued operations $ 378 $ 529 $ 201 164 G-171 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following table reconciles the provision for (benefit from) income taxes to the U.S. federal statutory income tax rate: Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 U.S. federal statutory income tax rate U.S. state and local income taxes, net of U.S. federal income tax benefits Lower tax rates applicable to non−U.S. earnings Domestic tax credits Tax exempt income Other 35.0% 1.5 (2.0) (6.0) (3.3) (0.7) 35.0% 1.6 (2.4) (2.3) (0.9) (0.9) 35.0% 1.4 (5.5) (6.4) (0.8) 0.8 Effective income tax rate(1) 24.5% 30.1% 24.5% (1) The fiscal 2006 effective tax rate includes the impact of a $242 million income tax benefit, or $0.23 per diluted share, related to the resolution of the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) examination of years 1994−1998. The fiscal 2005 effective tax rate includes the impact of a $309 million income tax benefit resulting from repatriation of foreign earnings under the provisions of the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004. As of November 30, 2007, the Company had approximately $5.8 billion of earnings attributable to foreign subsidiaries for which no provisions have been recorded for income tax that could occur upon repatriation. Except to the extent such earnings can be repatriated tax efficiently, they are permanently invested abroad. It is not practicable to determine the amount of income taxes payable in the event all such foreign earnings are repatriated. The American Jobs Creation Act, adopted on October 22, 2004, provided for a special one−time tax deduction, or dividend received deduction, of 85% of qualifying foreign earnings that are repatriated in either a company’s last tax year that began before the enactment date or the first tax year that begins during the one−year period beginning on the enactment date. In the fourth quarter of fiscal 2005, the Company recorded an income tax benefit of $309 million, or $0.29 per diluted share, resulting from the Company’s repatriation of approximately $4.0 billion of qualifying foreign earnings under the provisions of the American Jobs Creation Act. The $309 million tax benefit resulted from the reversal of net deferred tax liabilities previously provided under SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes” (“SFAS No. 109”), net of additional taxes associated with these qualifying earnings. 165 G-172 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities and are measured using the enacted tax rates and laws that will be in effect when such differences are expected to reverse. Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 were as follows: November 30, November 30, 2007 2006 (dollars in millions) Deferred tax assets: Employee compensation and benefit plans Loan loss allowance Valuation and liability allowances Deferred expenses Tax credit and loss carryforward Other $ $ 2,965 321 553 26 — 806 Total deferred tax assets Valuation allowance(1) 7,905 19 4,671 — Deferred tax assets after valuation allowance 7,886 4,671 787 52 283 1,171 20 91 368 1,076 2,293 1,555 Deferred tax liabilities: Valuation of inventory, investments and receivables Prepaid commissions Fixed assets Other Total deferred tax liabilities Net deferred tax assets (1) 4,789 — 498 38 1,729 851 $ 5,593 $ 3,116 The valuation allowance reduces the benefit of certain state net operating loss carryforwards to the amount that will more likely than not be realized. During fiscal 2007, the valuation allowance was increased by $19 million related to the ability to utilize state net operating losses. The Company had federal and state net operating loss carryforwards for which a deferred tax asset of $724 million and zero was recorded as of November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, respectively. These carryforwards are subject to annual limitations and will expire in 2027. The Company had tax credit carryforwards for which a related deferred tax asset of $1,005 million and zero was recorded as of November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006, respectively. These carryforwards are subject to annual limitations on utilization and will expire in 2017. The Company believes that the realization of the recognized net deferred tax asset of $5,593 million (after valuation allowance) is more likely than not based on expectations as to future taxable income in the jurisdictions in which it operates. The Company recorded income tax benefits to Paid−in capital of $280 million, $72 million and $317 million related to employee stock compensation transactions in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Such benefits were credited to Paid−in capital. 166 G-173 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Cash paid for income taxes was $3,404 million, $3,115 million and $1,536 million in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. The Company has requested a refund of $1,200 million for estimated taxes paid during fiscal 2007. Income Tax Examinations. The Company is under continuous examination by the IRS and other tax authorities in certain countries, such as Japan and the U.K., and states in which the Company has significant business operations, such as New York. The tax years under examination vary by jurisdiction; for example, the current IRS examination covers 1999−2005. The Company regularly assesses the likelihood of additional assessments in each of the taxing jurisdictions resulting from these and subsequent years’ examinations. The Company has established tax reserves that the Company believes are adequate in relation to the potential for additional assessments. Once established, the Company adjusts tax reserves only when more information is available or when an event occurs necessitating a change to the reserves. The Company believes that the resolution of tax matters will not have a material effect on the consolidated financial condition of the Company, although a resolution could have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated statement of income for a particular future period and on the Company’s effective income tax rate for any period in which such resolution occurs. 21. Segment and Geographic Information. The Company structures its segments primarily based upon the nature of the financial products and services provided to customers and the Company’s management organization. The Company provides a wide range of financial products and services to its customers in each of its business segments: Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group and Asset Management. For further discussion of the Company’s business segments, see Note 1. Revenues and expenses directly associated with each respective segment are included in determining their operating results. Other revenues and expenses that are not directly attributable to a particular segment are allocated based upon the Company’s allocation methodologies, generally based on each segment’s respective net revenues, non−interest expenses or other relevant measures. As a result of treating certain intersegment transactions as transactions with external parties, the Company includes an Intersegment Eliminations category to reconcile the business segment results to the Company’s consolidated results. Income before taxes in Intersegment Eliminations primarily represents the effect of timing differences associated with the revenue and expense recognition of commissions paid by Asset Management to the Global Wealth Management Group associated with sales of certain products and the related compensation costs paid to the Global Wealth Management Group’s global representatives. 167 G-174 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Selected financial information for the Company’s segments is presented below: Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Net revenues excluding net interest Net interest $ 14,085 2,064 $ 5,915 710 $ 5,531 (38) $ (286) 45 $25,245 2,781 Net revenues $ 16,149 $ 6,625 $ 5,493 $ (241) $28,026 817 47 (170) $ 1,155 — 459 $ 1,467 — 541 $ 940 $ 696 $ 926 $ Fiscal 2007 Income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees and income taxes Losses from unconsolidated investees Income tax (benefit) provision $ Asset Management (dollars in millions) Intersegment Eliminations(1) 2 Total 1 $ 3,441 47 831 1 $ 2,563 — Income from continuing operations(2) $ Fiscal 2006(3) Institutional Securities(2) Global Wealth Management Group Net revenues excluding net interest Net interest $ 19,758 1,352 $ 5,027 485 $ 3,432 21 $ (257) 21 $27,960 1,879 Net revenues $ 21,110 $ 5,512 $ 3,453 $ (236) $29,839 $ 7,721 40 2,212 $ 508 — 167 $ 851 — 340 $ 23 — 9 $ 9,103 40 2,728 Income from continuing operations(2) $ 5,469 $ 341 $ 511 $ 14 $ 6,335 Fiscal 2005(3) Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Net revenues excluding net interest Net interest $ 13,416 2,081 $ 4,729 318 $ 3,183 36 $ (238) — $21,090 2,435 Net revenues $ 15,497 $ 5,047 $ 3,219 $ (238) $23,525 Income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees, income taxes and cumulative effect of accounting change, net Losses from unconsolidated investees Provision for income taxes $ 4,609 311 852 $ 591 — 199 $ 1,030 — 391 $ 86 — 31 $ 6,316 311 1,473 $ 3,446 $ 392 $ 639 $ 55 $ 4,532 Income from continuing operations before losses from unconsolidated investees and income taxes Losses from unconsolidated investees Provision for income taxes Income from continuing operations before cumulative effect of accounting change, net(2)(4) 168 Asset Management (dollars in millions) Asset Management (dollars in millions) Intersegment Eliminations(1) Intersegment Eliminations Total Total G-175 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group Fiscal 2007 Interest and dividends Interest expense $ 59,131 57,067 $ 1,221 511 $ 74 112 $ (343) (388) $60,083 57,302 Net interest $ 2,064 $ 710 $ (38) $ 45 $ 2,781 Fiscal 2006(3) Interest and dividends Interest expense $ 42,106 40,754 $ 1,004 519 $ 48 27 $ (382) (403) $42,776 40,897 Net interest $ 1,352 $ 485 $ 21 $ 21 $ 1,879 Fiscal 2005(3) Interest and dividends Interest expense $ 25,439 23,358 $ 650 332 $ 87 51 $ (189) (189) $25,987 23,552 Net interest $ 2,081 $ 318 $ 36 $ — $ 2,435 Net Interest Asset Management (dollars in millions) Intersegment Eliminations(1) Total Total Assets(5) Institutional Securities Global Wealth Management Group At November 30, 2007 $ 1,005,452 $ 27,518 $ 12,439 At November 30, 2006(3) $ 1,063,985 $ 21,232 $ 6,908 $ 29,067 $ 1,121,192 At November 30, 2005(3) $ 848,555 $ 19,290 $ 4,046 $ 26,944 $ 898,835 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) Asset Management (dollars in millions) Discover $ — Total $ 1,045,409 The results of the Institutional Securities business segment for fiscal 2007 included a $25 million advisory fee related to the Discover Spin−off that was eliminated in consolidation. The results of the Institutional Securities business segment for fiscal 2006 included a $30 million advisory fee related to the Company’s sale of the aircraft leasing business that was eliminated in consolidation. See Note 22 for a discussion of discontinued operations. Certain reclassifications have been made to prior−period amounts to conform to the current year’s presentation. See Note 2 for a discussion of the cumulative effect of accounting change, net. Corporate assets have been fully allocated to the Company’s business segments. The Company operates in both U.S. and non−U.S. markets. The Company’s non−U.S. business activities are principally conducted through European and Asian locations. The following table presents selected income statement information and the total assets of the Company’s operations by geographic area. The net revenues and total assets disclosed in the following table reflect the regional view of the Company’s consolidated net revenues and total assets, on a managed basis, based on the following methodology: • Institutional Securities: investment banking—client location, equity capital markets—client location, debt capital markets—revenue recording location, sales & trading—trading desk location. • Global Wealth Management Group: global representative coverage location. • Asset Management: client location, except for merchant banking business, which is based on asset location. 169 G-176 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Net Revenues Americas Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006(1) Fiscal 2005(1) $ 12,150 18,803 15,375 Total Assets At November 30, 2007 At November 30, 2006(1) At November 30, 2005(1) (1) 22. Americas Europe, Middle East and Africa $ 705,728 708,129 613,361 $ 269,753 347,379 240,467 Europe, Middle East and Africa Asia (dollars in millions) $10,008 7,762 5,711 $5,868 3,274 2,439 Asia Eliminations (dollars in millions) $ 83,328 83,315 66,527 $ (13,400) (17,631) (21,520) Total $28,026 29,839 23,525 Total $ 1,045,409 1,121,192 898,835 Certain reclassifications have been made to prior−year amounts to conform to the current year’s presentation. Discontinued Operations. Fiscal 2007. Discover. On June 30, 2007, the Company completed the Discover Spin−off. The Company distributed all of the outstanding shares of DFS common stock, par value $0.01 per share, to the Company’s stockholders of record as of June 18, 2007. The Company’s stockholders received one share of DFS common stock for every two shares of the Company’s common stock. Stockholders received cash in lieu of fractional shares for amounts less than one full DFS share. The Company received a tax ruling from the IRS that, based on customary representations and qualifications, the distribution was tax−free to the Company’s stockholders for U.S. federal income tax purposes. The Discover Spin−off allows the Company to focus its efforts on more closely aligned firm−wide strategic priorities within its Institutional Securities, Global Wealth Management Group and Asset Management business segments. The results of DFS prior to the Discover Spin−off are included within discontinued operations for all periods presented. 170 G-177 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The following is a summary of the assets and liabilities associated with DFS as of November 30, 2006 (dollars in millions): Assets Cash and cash equivalents Financial instruments owned—U.S. government and agency securities Financial instruments owned—Derivative contracts Consumer loans Fees, interest and other Office facilities and other equipment, at cost, net Goodwill and net intangible assets Other assets $ Total 869 65 33 22,915 166 661 735 3,623 $ 29,067 Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings Deposits Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased—Derivative contracts Interest and dividends payables Other liabilities and accrued expenses Long−term borrowings $ 3,100 13,277 28 129 6,508 250 Total 23,292 Net assets $ 5,775 The net assets that were distributed to shareholders on the date of the Discover Spin−off were $5,558 million, which was recorded as a reduction to the Company’s retained earnings. Net revenues included in discontinued operations related to DFS were $2,392 million, $4,290 million and $3,452 million in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. The results of discontinued operations include interest expense that was allocated based upon borrowings that were specifically attributable to DFS’ operations through intercompany transactions existing prior to the Discover Spin−off. For fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, the amount of interest expense reclassified to discontinued operations was approximately $159 million, $247 million and $145 million, respectively. Quilter. On February 28, 2007, the Company sold Quilter, its standalone U.K. mass affluent business, which was formerly included within the Global Wealth Management Group business segment. The results of Quilter are included within discontinued operations for all periods presented. The results for discontinued operations in fiscal 2007 also included a pre−tax gain of $168 million ($109 million after−tax) on disposition. Fiscal 2006 and Fiscal 2005. Aircraft Leasing. On August 17, 2005, the Company announced that its Board of Directors had approved management’s recommendation to sell the Company’s non−core aircraft leasing business. In connection with this action, the aircraft leasing business was classified as “held for sale” and reported as discontinued operations in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. In addition, in the third quarter of fiscal 2005, the Company recognized a charge of approximately $1.7 billion ($1.0 billion after−tax) to reflect the writedown of the aircraft 171 G-178 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) leasing business to its estimated fair value of approximately $2.0 billion. In determining the charge that was recorded in the third quarter of fiscal 2005, the Company estimated the value to be realized in selling the aircraft leasing business as a whole. The estimated value of the business was based on the appraised values of the aircraft portfolio, an evaluation of then current market conditions, recent transactions involving the sales of similar aircraft leasing businesses, a detailed assessment of the portfolio and additional valuation analyses. On January 30, 2006, the Company announced that it had signed a definitive agreement under which it would sell its aircraft leasing business to Terra Firma, a European private equity group, for approximately $2.5 billion in cash and the assumption of liabilities. Based on the terms of the agreement and in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long−Lived Assets” (“SFAS No. 144”), the Company revised its estimate of the fair value (less selling costs) of the aircraft leasing business and, as a result, in the fourth quarter, reduced the pre−tax charge recorded in the third quarter of fiscal 2005 by approximately $1.1 billion. Full year results for fiscal 2005 reflected a charge of $509 million ($316 million after−tax). The sale was completed on March 24, 2006. The results for discontinued operations in fiscal 2006 included a loss of $125 million ($75 million after−tax) related to the impact of the finalization of the sales proceeds and balance sheet adjustments related to the closing. Gross revenues from the aircraft leasing business included in discontinued operations was $137 million and $417 million in fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Summarized financial information for the Company’s discontinued operations for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005: The table below provides information regarding amounts included within discontinued operations (dollars in millions): Pre−tax gain (loss) on discontinued operations DFS Quilter Aircraft leasing 23. 2007 Fiscal Year 2006 2005 $ 850 174 — $1,681 27 (42) $1,025 20 (486) $1,024 $1,666 $ 559 Business and Other Acquisitions and Dispositions and Sale of Minority Interest. Subsequent to Fiscal 2007. Morgan Stanley Wealth Management S.V., S.A.U. On January 28, 2008, the Company announced that it had reached an agreement to sell Morgan Stanley Wealth Management S.V., S.A.U. (“MSWM”), its Spanish onshore mass affluent wealth management business. The transaction is expected to close during the first half of fiscal 2008 subject to customary closing conditions, including regulatory approvals. The results of MSWM have been included within the Global Wealth Management Group business segment. Fiscal 2007. MSCI. On July 31, 2007, the Company announced that it would sell a minority interest in its subsidiary, MSCI Inc. (“MSCI”) in an initial public offering (“IPO”). MSCI is a provider of investment decision support tools to investment institutions worldwide. MSCI is included within the Institutional Securities business segment. In November 2007, MSCI completed its IPO of 16.1 million shares and received net proceeds of approximately $265 million, net of underwriting discounts, commissions and offering expenses. As the IPO was part of a 172 G-179 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) broader corporate reorganization, contemplated by the Company at the IPO date, the increase in the carrying amount of the Company’s investment in MSCI was recorded in Paid−in capital in the Company’s consolidated statement of financial condition and the Company’s consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity at November 30, 2007. Subsequent to the IPO, the Company maintains approximately 81% ownership of MSCI and consolidates MSCI for financial reporting purposes. JM Financial. In October 2007, the Company dissolved its India joint ventures with JM Financial. The Company purchased the joint venture’s institutional equities sales, trading and research platform by acquiring JM Financial’s 49% interest and sold the Company’s 49% interest in the joint venture’s investment banking, fixed income and retail operation to JM Financial. CityMortgage Bank. On December 21, 2006, the Company acquired CityMortgage Bank (“CityMortgage”), a Moscow−based mortgage bank that specializes in originating, servicing and securitizing residential mortgage loans in the Russian Federation. Since the acquisition date, the results of CityMortgage have been included within the Institutional Securities business segment. Olco Petroleum Group Inc. On December 15, 2006, the Company acquired a 60% equity stake in Olco Petroleum Group Inc. (“Olco”), a petroleum products marketer and distributor based in eastern Canada. Since the acquisition date, the results of Olco have been included within the Institutional Securities business segment. Saxon Capital, Inc. On December 4, 2006, the Company acquired Saxon Capital, Inc. (“Saxon”), a servicer and originator of residential mortgages. Since the acquisition date, the results of Saxon have been included within the Institutional Securities business segment. FrontPoint Partners. On December 4, 2006, the Company acquired FrontPoint Partners (“FrontPoint”), a provider of absolute return investment strategies. Since the acquisition date, the results of FrontPoint have been included within the Asset Management business segment. Fiscal 2006. Goldfish. On February 17, 2006, the Company acquired the Goldfish credit card business in the U.K. As a result of the Discover Spin−off, the results of Goldfish have been included within discontinued operations (see Note 22). The acquisition price was $1,676 million, which was paid in cash in February 2006. The Company recorded goodwill and other intangible assets of approximately $370 million in connection with the acquisition. The following table summarizes the fair values of the assets acquired and the liabilities assumed at the date of the acquisition: At February 17, 2006 (dollars in millions) Consumer loans Goodwill Amortizable intangible assets Other assets $ Total assets acquired Total liabilities assumed 1,316 247 123 20 1,706 30 Net assets acquired $ 1,676 The $123 million of acquired amortizable intangible assets includes customer relationships of $54 million (15−year estimated useful life) and trademarks of $69 million (25−year estimated useful life). 173 G-180 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Lansdowne Partners. On November 1, 2006, the Company acquired a 19% stake in Lansdowne Partners (“Lansdowne”), a London−based investment manager. The investment in Lansdowne is accounted for under the equity method of accounting within the Asset Management business segment. Avenue Capital Group. On October 30, 2006, the Company formed a strategic alliance with Avenue Capital Group (“Avenue”), a New York−based investment manager with approximately $12 billion in assets under management. The Company acquired a minority interest in Avenue. The investment in Avenue is accounted for under the equity method of accounting within the Asset Management business segment. Morgan Stanley Bank International (China) Limited. On September 29, 2006, the Company acquired Morgan Stanley Bank International (China) Limited (“China Bank”) (formerly Nan Tung Bank Ltd. Zhuhai), a bank in the People’s Republic of China. The acquisition enabled the Company to strengthen its platform in China. Since the acquisition date, the results of China Bank have been included within the Institutional Securities business segment. TransMontaigne Inc. On September 1, 2006, the Company acquired TransMontaigne Inc. and its subsidiaries (“TransMontaigne”), a group of companies operating in the refined petroleum products marketing and distribution business. The acquisition enabled the Company to expand its supply and distribution of oil and refined oil products across a broader range of clients and regions across the U.S., as well as increase its oil storage capacity across the U.S. Since the acquisition date, the results of TransMontaigne and its subsidiaries have been included within the Institutional Securities business segment. Heidmar Group. On September 1, 2006, the Company acquired the Heidmar Group of companies that provides international shipping and U.S. marine logistics services. The acquisition enabled the Company to expand its physical freight business across multiple vessel classes and geographies and provided an opportunity to expand into international shipping and services. Since the acquisition date, the results of the Heidmar Group of companies have been included within the Institutional Securities business segment. Office Building. On June 19, 2006, the Company purchased a majority interest in a joint venture that indirectly owned title to 522 Fifth Avenue, a 23−floor office building in New York City (the “Building”), for approximately $420 million. On July 10, 2007, the Company purchased the balance of the interest in the joint venture for approximately $37 million. The pro forma impact of each of the above business acquisitions individually and in the aggregate was not material to the consolidated financial statements. 24. Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108. In September 2006, the SEC released SAB 108. SAB 108 permits the Company to adjust for the cumulative effect of errors relating to prior years in the carrying amount of assets and liabilities as of the beginning of the 2006 fiscal year, with an offsetting adjustment to the opening balance of retained earnings in the year of adoption. SAB 108 also requires the adjustment of any prior quarterly financial statements within the fiscal year of adoption for the effects of such errors on the quarters when the information is next presented. Such adjustments do not require previously filed reports with the SEC to be amended. Effective August 31, 2006, the Company elected early application of SAB 108. In accordance with SAB 108, the Company adjusted its opening retained earnings for fiscal 2006 and its financial results for the first two quarters of fiscal 2006 for the items described below. The Company considers these adjustments to be immaterial to prior annual periods. 174 G-181 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) Trust Preferred Securities. The Company adjusted its opening retained earnings for fiscal 2006 and its financial results for the first two quarters of fiscal 2006 to reflect a change in its hedge accounting under SFAS No. 133. The change is being made following a clarification by the SEC of its interpretation of SFAS No. 133 related to the accounting for fair value hedges of fixed−rate trust preferred securities. Since January 2005, the Company entered into various interest rate swaps to hedge the interest rate risk inherent in its trust preferred securities. The terms of the interest rate swaps and the corresponding trust preferred securities mirrored one another, and the Company determined in the past that the changes in the fair value of the swaps and hedged instruments were the same. The Company applied the commonly used “short−cut method” in accounting for these fair value hedges and, therefore, did not reflect any gains or losses during the relevant periods. Based upon the SEC’s clarification of SFAS No. 133, the Company determined that since it has the ability at its election to defer interest payments on its trust preferred securities, these swaps did not qualify for the short−cut method. These swaps performed as expected as effective economic hedges of interest rate risk. The Company ended hedging of the interest rate risk on these trust preferred securities effective August 2006 and adjusted its financial results as if hedge accounting was never applied. The Company currently manages the interest rate risk on these securities as part of its overall asset liability management. Compensation and Benefits. The Company also adjusted its opening retained earnings for fiscal 2006 and its financial results for the first two quarters of fiscal 2006 for two compensation and benefits accruals. Such accruals are related to (i) the overaccrual of certain payroll taxes in certain non−U.S. locations, primarily in the U.K., which arose in fiscal 2000 through fiscal 2006 and (ii) an adjustment to the amortization expense associated with stock−based compensation awards, which arose in fiscal 2003 and fiscal 2004. Impact of Adjustments. The impact of each of the items noted above on fiscal 2006 opening Shareholders’ equity and Retained earnings and on Net income for the first and second quarters of fiscal 2006 is presented below (dollars in millions): Cumulative effect on Shareholders’ equity as of December 1, 2005 Cumulative effect on Retained earnings as of December 1, 2005 Effect on: Net income for the three months ended February 28, 2006 Net income for the three months ended May 31, 2006 Net income for the six months ended May 31, 2006 175 Non−U.S. Payroll Taxes Amortization of Stock− Based Compensation Awards Total (84) (84) $ $ 38 38 $ $ 12 (22) $ (34) $ (68) (1) (116) (117) $ $ $ 14 — 14 $ $ $ — — — $ 13 $(116) $(103) Trust Preferred Securities $ $ $ $ $ G-182 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) The aggregate impact of these adjustments is summarized below (dollars in millions, except per share data): As of and for the Three Months Ended February 28, 2006 Previously Reported Adjustment Other assets Other liabilities Long−term borrowings Shareholders’ equity Principal transactions trading revenue Compensation and benefits expense Interest expense Net income Diluted EPS $ 15,988 $ 14,984 $ 121,395 $ 30,124 $ 3,073 $ 4,032 $ 9,216 $ 1,561 $ 1.47 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ As of and for the Three Months Ended May 31, 2006 Previously Reported Adjustment Other assets Other liabilities Long−term borrowings Shareholders’ equity Principal transactions trading revenue Compensation and benefits expense Interest expense Net income Diluted EPS $ 17,651 $ 18,159 $ 127,985 $ 32,255 $ 3,729 $ 3,587 $ 9,735 $ 1,957 $ 1.86 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ For the Six Months Ended May 31, 2006 Previously Reported Adjustment Principal transactions trading revenue Compensation and benefits expense Interest expense Net income Diluted EPS $ 6,802 $ 7,619 $ 18,951 $ 3,518 $ 3.33 $ $ $ $ $ 25. 12 (98) 131 (21) 13 (22) 15 13 0.01 12 (162) 311 (137) (170) — 9 (116) (0.11) (157) (22) 24 (103) (0.10) As Adjusted $ 16,000 $ 14,886 $ 121,526 $ 30,103 $ 3,086 $ 4,010 $ 9,231 $ 1,574 $ 1.48 As Adjusted $ 17,663 $ 17,997 $ 128,296 $ 32,118 $ 3,559 $ 3,587 $ 9,744 $ 1,841 $ 1.75 As Adjusted $ 6,645 $ 7,597 $ 18,975 $ 3,415 $ 3.23 Insurance Settlement. On September 11, 2001, the U.S. experienced terrorist attacks targeted against New York City and Washington, D.C. The attacks in New York resulted in the destruction of the World Trade Center complex, where approximately 3,700 of the Company’s employees were located, and the temporary closing of the debt and equity financial markets in the U.S. Through the implementation of its business recovery plans, the Company relocated its displaced employees to other facilities. In the first quarter of fiscal 2005, the Company settled its claim with its insurance carriers related to the events of September 11, 2001. The Company recorded a pre−tax gain of $251 million as the insurance recovery was in excess of previously recognized costs related to the terrorist attacks (primarily write−offs of leasehold improvements and destroyed technology and telecommunications equipment in the World Trade Center complex, employee relocation and certain other employee−related expenditures). The pre−tax gain was recorded as a reduction to non−interest expenses and is included within the Global Wealth Management Group ($198 million), Asset Management ($43 million) and Institutional Securities ($10 million) business segments. The insurance settlement was allocated to the respective segments in accordance with the relative damages sustained by each segment. 176 G-183 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 26. Lease Adjustment. Prior to the first quarter of fiscal 2005, the Company did not record the effects of scheduled rent increases and rent−free periods for certain real estate leases on a straight−line basis. In addition, the Company had been accounting for certain tenant improvement allowances as reductions to the related leasehold improvements instead of recording funds received as deferred rent and amortizing them as reductions to lease expense over the lease term. In the first quarter of fiscal 2005, the Company changed its method of accounting for these rent escalation clauses, rent−free periods and tenant improvement allowances to properly reflect lease expense over the lease term on a straight−line basis. The impact of this correction resulted in the Company recording $105 million of additional rent expense in the first quarter of fiscal 2005. The impact of this change was included within non−interest expenses and reduced income before taxes within the Institutional Securities ($71 million), Global Wealth Management Group ($29 million) and Asset Management ($5 million) business segments. The impact of this correction was not material to the pre−tax income of each of the segments or to the Company. 177 G-184 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) 27. Quarterly Results (unaudited). First Total revenues Interest expense $23,192 13,198 2007 Fiscal Quarter 2006 Fiscal Quarter Second Third Fourth(1) First(2) Second(2) Third (dollars in millions, except per share data) $26,195 $21,230 $ 14,711 $16,644 $ 17,257 $18,613 15,671 13,272 15,161 9,231 9,744 11,549 Net revenues 9,994 10,524 7,958 Total non−interest expenses 6,538 7,000 5,693 Income (losses) from continuing operations before (losses) gains from unconsolidated investees and income taxes (Losses) gains from unconsolidated investees Provision for (benefit from) income taxes 3,456 (26) 1,116 3,524 (20) 1,141 2,314 2,363 Income (losses) from continuing operations Discontinued operations(3): Gain from discontinued operations Provision for income taxes (450) Fourth $18,222 10,373 7,413 7,513 7,064 7,849 5,354 5,503 5,212 4,820 5,201 2,265 (19) 772 (5,804) 18 (2,198) 1,910 (19) 603 2,301 24 848 2,244 20 676 2,648 (65) 601 1,474 (3,588) 1,288 1,477 1,588 1,982 564 (206) 349 (130) 111 (42) — — 453 (167) 583 (219) 399 (136) 231 (7) 358 219 69 — 286 364 263 224 Net income $ 2,672 $ 2,582 $ 1,543 $ $ 1,851 $ 2,206 Preferred stock dividend requirements $ $ $ 17 $ $ $ Earnings applicable to common shareholders $ 2,655 $ 2,565 $ 1,526 $ (3,605) Earnings per basic common share(4): Income (losses) from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations $ 2.28 0.35 $ 2.35 0.22 $ 1.45 0.07 $ Earnings per basic common share $ 2.63 $ 2.57 $ 1.52 Earnings per diluted common share(4): Income (losses) from continuing operations Gain on discontinued operations $ 2.17 0.34 $ 2.24 0.21 $ $ 2.51 $ 2.45 $ Gain on discontinued operations Earnings per diluted common share Dividends to common shareholders Book value (1) (2) (3) (4) 28. 17 $ 0.27 $ 34.71 17 $ 0.27 $ 36.52 (3,588) $ 1,574 $ 1,841 $ $ — $ 1,574 $ 1,841 (3.61) — $ 1.26 0.28 $ $ (3.61) $ 1.54 1.38 0.06 $ (3.61) — $ 1.44 $ (3.61) $ $ 0.27 $ 32.14 $ $ 0.27 28.56 17 — — 19 $ 1,851 $ 2,187 1.46 0.36 $ 1.57 0.26 $ 1.97 0.22 $ 1.82 $ 1.83 $ 2.19 1.21 0.27 $ 1.40 0.35 $ 1.50 0.25 $ 1.87 0.21 1.48 $ 1.75 $ 1.75 $ 2.08 $ 0.27 $ 28.12 $ $ 0.27 29.97 $ 0.27 $ 31.24 $ 0.27 $ 32.67 Results for the Company in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007 included $9.4 billion in mortgage−related writedowns. Results for the Company for the first two quarters of fiscal 2006 were adjusted (see Note 24). See Note 22 for a discussion of discontinued operations. Summation of the quarters’ earnings per common share may not equal the annual amounts due to the averaging effect of the number of shares and share equivalents throughout the year. Subsequent Event. China Investment Corporation Investment. In December 2007, the Company sold Equity Units which include contracts to purchase Company common stock (see “Stock Purchase Contracts” herein) to a wholly owned subsidiary of the CIC for approximately $5,579 million. CIC’s ownership in the Company’s common stock, including the maximum number of shares of common stock to be received by CIC upon settlement of the stock purchase contracts, will be 9.9% or less of the Company’s total shares outstanding based on the total shares outstanding on November 30, 2007. CIC will be a 178 G-185 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) passive financial investor and will have no special rights of ownership nor a role in the management of the Company. A substantial portion of the investment proceeds will be treated as Tier 1 capital for regulatory capital purposes. Each stock purchase contract mandatorily settles in Company common stock at prices between $48.0700 and $57.6840. The maximum number of shares to be issued upon settlement of the stock purchase contracts included in the Equity Units is approximately 116,063,000. The stock purchase contracts settle for Company common stock on August 17, 2010, subject to adjustment. Each Equity Unit will pay a fixed annual payment rate of 9% payable quarterly. As described below, the Equity Units consist of interests in trust preferred securities issued by Morgan Stanley Capital Trust A (“Series A Trust”), Morgan Stanley Capital Trust B (“Series B Trust”) or Morgan Stanley Capital Trust C (“Series C Trust”) (each a “Morgan Stanley Trust” and, collectively, the “Trusts”) and stock purchase contracts issued by the Company. The only assets held by the Series A Trust, Series B Trust and Series C Trust are junior subordinated debentures issued by the Company. Equity Units. Each Equity Unit has a stated amount of $1,000 per unit consisting of: (i) an undivided beneficial ownership interest in a trust preferred security of Series A Trust, Series B Trust or Series C Trust with an initial liquidation amount of $1,000; and (ii) a stock purchase contract relating to the common stock, par value of $0.01 per share, of the Company. Junior Subordinated Debentures Issued to Support Trust Common and Trust Preferred Securities. In the first quarter of fiscal 2008, the Company issued junior subordinated debt securities due no later than February 17, 2042 for a total of $5,579,173,000 in exchange for $5,579,143,000 in aggregate proceeds from the sale of the trust preferred securities by the Trusts and $30,000 in trust common securities issued equally by the Trusts. The Company elected to fair value the junior subordinated debentures pursuant to SFAS No. 159. The common and trust preferred securities of the Trusts, totaling approximately $5,579 million, represent undivided beneficial ownership interests in the assets of the Trusts, have no stated maturity and must be redeemed upon the redemption or maturity of the corresponding series of junior subordinated debt securities—the sole assets of the respective Trusts. The Series A Trust, Series B Trust and Series C Trust will make quarterly distributions on the trust common and trust preferred securities at an annual rate of 6%. The trust common securities, which are held by the Company, represent an interest in the Trusts and are recorded as an equity method investment in the Company’s consolidated statement of financial condition. The Trusts are VIEs in accordance with FIN 46R and the Company does not consolidate its interests in the Trusts as it is not the primary beneficiary of any of the Trusts. The Company has directly guaranteed the repayment of the trust preferred securities to the holders thereof to the extent that there are funds available in the Trusts. If the Company does not make payments on the junior subordinated debentures owned by a Morgan Stanley Trust, such Morgan Stanley Trust will not be able to pay any amounts payable in respect of the trust preferred securities issued by it and will not have funds legally available for that purpose. In that event, holders of such series of trust preferred securities would not be able to rely upon the guarantee for payment of those amounts. The guarantee will remain in place until the redemption price of all of the trust preferred securities is paid, the amounts payable with respect to the trust preferred 179 G-186 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) securities upon liquidation of the Morgan Stanley Trusts are paid or the junior subordinated debentures are distributed to the holders of all the trust preferred securities. The trust preferred securities held by the Equity Unit holders are pledged to the Company to collateralize the obligations of the Equity Unit holders under the related stock purchase contracts. The Equity Unit holders may substitute certain zero−coupon treasury securities in place of the trust preferred securities as collateral under the stock purchase contracts. Stock Purchase Contracts. Each stock purchase contract requires the holder to purchase, and the Company to sell, on the stock purchase date a number of newly issued or treasury shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.01 per share, equal to the settlement rate. The settlement rate at the respective stock purchase date will be calculated based on the arithmetic average of the volume−weighted average prices of the common stock during a specified 20−day period ending three days immediately preceding the applicable stock purchase date (“applicable market value”). If the applicable market value of the Company’s common stock is less than the threshold appreciation price of $57.6840 but greater than $48.0700, the reference price, the settlement rate will be a number of shares of the Company’s common stock equal to $1,000 divided by the applicable market value. If the applicable market value is less than or equal to the reference price, the settlement rate will be the number of shares of the Company’s common stock equal to $1,000 divided by the reference price. If the applicable market value is greater than or equal to the threshold appreciation price, the settlement rate will be the number of shares of the Company’s common stock equal to $1,000 divided by the threshold appreciation price. Accordingly, upon settlement in the aggregate, the Company will receive proceeds of approximately $5,579 million and issue up to approximately 116,063,000 shares of its common stock. The stock purchase contract may be settled early at the option of the holder at any time prior to the second business day immediately preceding the beginning of the first remarketing period. However, upon early settlement, the holder will receive the minimum settlement rate, subject to adjustment. The initial quarterly distributions on the Series A, Series B and Series C trust preferred securities of 6%, combined with the contract adjustment payments on the stock purchase contracts of 3%, result in the 9% yield on the Equity Units. If the Company defers any of the contract adjustment payments on the stock purchase contracts, then it will accrue additional amounts on the deferred amounts at the annual rate of 9% until paid, to the extent permitted by law. The present value of the future contract adjustment payments due under the stock purchase contracts was approximately $400 million and was recorded in Other liabilities and accrued expenses with a corresponding decrease recorded in Shareholders’ equity in the Company’s consolidated statement of financial condition in the first quarter of fiscal 2008. The other liability balance related to the stock purchase contracts will accrete over the term of the stock purchase contract using the effective yield method with a corresponding charge to Interest expense. When the contract adjustment payments are made under the stock purchase contracts, they will reduce the other liability balance. Calculation of Impact on Average Diluted Common Shares Outstanding Prior to Settlement of Stock Purchase Contract. Prior to the issuance of common stock upon settlement of the stock purchase contract, the impact of the Equity Units will be reflected in the Company’s earnings per diluted common share using the treasury stock method, as defined by SFAS No. 128, “Earnings Per Share.” Under the treasury stock method, the number of shares of common stock included in the calculation of earnings per diluted common share will be calculated as the excess, if any, of the number of shares expected to be issued upon settlement of the stock purchase contract based on the 180 G-187 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued) average market price for the last 20 days of the reporting period, less the number of shares that could be purchased by the Company with the proceeds to be received upon settlement of the contract at the average closing price for the reporting period. Dilution of net income per share will occur (i) in reporting periods when the average closing price of common shares is over $57.6840 per share or (ii) in reporting periods when the average closing price of common shares for a reporting period is between $48.0700 and $57.6840 and is greater than the average market price for the last 20 days ending three days prior to the end of such reporting period. Upon settlement of the Stock Purchase Contract, the amount of common shares issued in settlement of the contract will be included in the basic and diluted earnings per share calculation of weighted average common shares outstanding for the reporting period. 181 G-188 Table of Contents Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure. None. Item 9A. Controls and Procedures. Conclusion Regarding the Effectiveness of Disclosure Controls and Procedures. Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer, we conducted an evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures, as such term is defined under Exchange Act Rule 13a−15(e). Based on this evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and our Chief Financial Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this annual report. Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Morgan Stanley’s internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that: • Pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of Morgan Stanley; • Provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of Morgan Stanley’s management and directors; and • Provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Management assessed the effectiveness of Morgan Stanley’s internal control over financial reporting as of November 30, 2007. In making this assessment, management used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control−Integrated Framework. Based on management’s assessment and those criteria, management believes that Morgan Stanley maintained effective internal control over financial reporting as of November 30, 2007. Morgan Stanley’s independent registered public accounting firm has audited and issued a report on Morgan Stanley’s internal control over financial reporting, which appears below. 182 G-189 Table of Contents Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Morgan Stanley: We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Morgan Stanley and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of November 30, 2007, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company’s principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company’s board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of November 30, 2007, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated statement of financial condition of the Company as of November 30, 2007 and the related consolidated statement of income, comprehensive income, cash flows and changes in shareholders’ equity for the year ended November 30, 2007 and our report dated January 28, 2008 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements and includes an explanatory paragraph, in fiscal 2007, concerning the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 157, “Fair Value Measurement” and Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities—Including an amendment of FASB Statement No. 115” and, an explanatory paragraph, in fiscal 183 G-190 Table of Contents 2007, concerning the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards, No. 158, “Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R).” /s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP New York, New York January 28, 2008 184 G-191 Table of Contents Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. No change in Morgan Stanley’s internal control over financial reporting (as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a−15(f)) occurred during the fiscal quarter ended November 30, 2007 that materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, Morgan Stanley’s internal control over financial reporting. Item 9B. Other Information. Not applicable. 185 G-192 Table of Contents Part III Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance. Information relating to Morgan Stanley’s directors and nominees under the following captions in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein. • “Item 1—Election of Directors” • “Item 1—Election of Directors—Board Meetings and Committees” Information relating to Morgan Stanley’s executive officers is contained in Part I, Item 1 of this report under “Executive Officers of Morgan Stanley.” Morgan Stanley’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct applies to all directors, officers and employees, including its Chief Executive Officer, its Chief Financial Officer and its Controller and Principal Accounting Officer. You can find our Code of Ethics and Business Conduct on our internet site, www.morganstanley.com. We will post any amendments to the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct, and any waivers that are required to be disclosed by the rules of either the SEC or the NYSE, on our internet site. Because Morgan Stanley’s common stock is listed on the NYSE, its Chief Executive Officer made his annual certification to the NYSE on May 4, 2007 stating that he was not aware of any violation by Morgan Stanley of the NYSE’s corporate governance listing standards. In addition, Morgan Stanley has filed, as exhibits to this Annual Report on Form 10−K, the certifications of its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer required under Section 302 of the Sarbanes−Oxley Act of 2002 to be filed with the SEC regarding the quality of Morgan Stanley’s public disclosure. Item 11. Executive Compensation. Information relating to director and executive officer compensation under the following captions in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein. • “Item 1—Election of Directors—Director Compensation” • “Executive Compensation” 186 G-193 Table of Contents Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters. Equity Compensation Plan Information. The following table provides information about stock options outstanding and shares of common stock available for future awards under all of Morgan Stanley’s equity compensation plans as of November 30, 2007. Morgan Stanley has not made any grants of common stock outside of its equity compensation plans. Plan Category Equity compensation plans approved by security holders Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders Total (1) (2) (3) (a) (b) Number of securities to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options, warrants and rights Weighted−average exercise price of outstanding options, warrants and rights 118,130,600 $ — 48.2201 — 118,130,600 $ 48.2201 (c) Number of securities remaining available for future issuance under equity compensation plans (excluding securities reflected in column (a))(1) 149,206,247(2) 4,993,329(3) 154,199,576 This column does not include 11,694,388 shares available under the 401(k) Plan. Includes the following: • 42,582,283 shares available under the Employee Stock Purchase Plan (ESPP). Pursuant to this plan, which is qualified under Section 423 of the Internal Revenue Code, eligible employees may purchase shares of common stock at a discount to market price through regular payroll deduction. • 100,000,000 shares available under the 2007 Equity Incentive Compensation Plan (EICP). Awards may consist of stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units to be settled by the delivery of shares of common stock (or the value thereof), other awards that are valued by reference to or otherwise based on the fair market value of common stock, and other equity−based or equity−related awards approved by the Compensation, Management Development and Succession Committee. • 5,621,592 shares available under the Employee Equity Accumulation Plan (EEAP). Awards may consist of stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units to be settled by the delivery of shares of common stock (or the value thereof), other awards that are valued by reference to or otherwise based on the fair market value of common stock, and other equity−based or equity−related awards approved by the Compensation, Management Development and Succession Committee. • 415,716 shares available under the Tax Deferred Equity Participation Plan (TDEPP). Awards consist of restricted stock units which are settled by the delivery of shares of common stock. • 586,656 shares available under the Directors’ Equity Capital Accumulation Plan (DECAP). This plan provides for periodic awards of shares of common stock and stock units to non−employee directors and also allows non−employee directors to defer the fees they earn from services as a director in the form of stock units. 22,957 shares available under the Branch Manager Compensation Plan (BMCP) and 4,970,372 shares available under the Financial Advisor and Investment Representative Compensation Plan (FAIRCP). The material features of these plans are described below. The material features of Morgan Stanley’s equity compensation plans that have not been approved by shareholders under SEC rules (BMCP and FAIRCP) are described below. The following descriptions do not purport to be complete and are qualified in their entirety by reference to the plan documents. All plans through which awards may currently be granted are included as exhibits to this report. BMCP. Branch managers are eligible to receive awards under BMCP. Awards under BMCP may consist of cash awards, restricted stock and restricted stock units to be settled by the delivery of shares of common stock. 187 G-194 Table of Contents FAIRCP. Financial advisors and investment representatives are eligible to receive awards under FAIRCP. Awards under FAIRCP may consist of cash awards, restricted stock and restricted stock units to be settled by the delivery of shares of common stock. *** Other information relating to security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management is set forth under the caption “Beneficial Ownership of Company Common Stock” in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement and such information is incorporated by reference herein. Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence. Information regarding certain relationships and related transactions under the following caption in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein. • “Other Matters—Certain Transactions” Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services. Information regarding principal accountant fees and services under the following caption in Morgan Stanley’s Proxy Statement is incorporated by reference herein. • “Item 2—Ratification of Appointment of Morgan Stanley’s Independent Auditor” (excluding the information under the subheading “Audit Committee Report”) 188 G-195 Table of Contents Part IV Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules. Documents filed as part of this report. • The financial statements required to be filed hereunder are listed on page S−1. • The financial statement schedules required to be filed hereunder are listed on page S−1. • An exhibit index has been filed as part of this report beginning on page E−1 and is incorporated herein by reference. 189 G-196 Table of Contents Signatures Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, on January 28, 2008. MORGAN STANLEY (REGISTRANT) By: /S/ JOHN J. MACK (John J. Mack) Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer Power of Attorney We, the undersigned, hereby severally constitute Colm Kelleher, Gary G. Lynch, and Martin M. Cohen, and each of them singly, our true and lawful attorneys with full power to them and each of them to sign for us, and in our names in the capacities indicated below, any and all amendments to the Annual Report on Form 10−K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission, hereby ratifying and confirming our signatures as they may be signed by our said attorneys to any and all amendments to said Annual Report on Form 10−K. Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities indicated on the 28th day of January, 2008. Signature Title JOHN J. MACK (John J. Mack) Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer) /s/ COLM KELLEHER (Colm Kelleher) Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer) /s/ PAUL C. WIRTH (Paul C. Wirth) Controller and Principal Accounting Officer (Principal Accounting Officer) /s/ ROY J. BOSTOCK (Roy J. Bostock) Director /s/ ERSKINE B. BOWLES (Erskine B. Bowles) Director /s/ HOWARD J. DAVIES (Howard J. Davies) Director /s/ C. ROBERT KIDDER (C. Robert Kidder) Director DONALD T. NICOLAISEN (Donald T. Nicolaisen) Director /s/ /s/ 190 G-197 Table of Contents Signature Title /s/ /s/ CHARLES H. NOSKI (Charles H. Noski) Director /s/ HUTHAM S. OLAYAN (Hutham S. Olayan) Director CHARLES E. PHILLIPS, JR. (Charles E. Phillips, Jr.) Director O. GRIFFITH SEXTON (O. Griffith Sexton) Director LAURA D’ANDREA TYSON (Laura D’Andrea Tyson) Director KLAUS ZUMWINKEL (Klaus Zumwinkel) Director /s/ /s/ /s/ 191 G-198 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES ITEMS (15)(a)(1) AND (15)(a)(2) Page Financial Statements Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 Consolidated Statements of Income for Fiscal 2007, Fiscal 2006 and Fiscal 2005 Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for Fiscal 2007, Fiscal 2006 and Fiscal 2005 Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for Fiscal 2007, Fiscal 2006 and Fiscal 2005 Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for Fiscal 2007, Fiscal 2006 and Fiscal 2005 Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 100 101 103 104 105 106 107 Financial Statement Schedules Schedule I—Condensed Financial Information of Morgan Stanley (Parent Company Only) at November 30, 2007 and November 30, 2006 and for each of the three fiscal years in the period ended November 30, 2007 S−1 S−2 − S−6 G-199 Table of Contents SCHEDULE I MORGAN STANLEY (Parent Company Only) Condensed Statements of Financial Condition (dollars in millions, except share data) Assets: Cash and cash equivalents Financial instruments owned Securities purchased under agreement to resell with affiliate Advances to subsidiaries Investment in subsidiaries, at equity Other assets Total assets Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity: Commercial paper and other short−term borrowings Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased Payables to subsidiaries Other liabilities and accrued expenses Long−term borrowings November 30, 2007 November 30, 2006 $ 10,224 8,551 54,137 156,446 34,946 4,149 $ 6,879 14,823 40,353 145,550 36,966 4,629 $ 268,453 $ 249,200 $ 20,615 253 32,523 1,037 182,756 $ 14,255 9,359 48,105 2,969 139,148 Commitments and contingencies Shareholders’ equity: Preferred stock Common stock, $0.01 par value; Shares authorized: 3,500,000,000 in 2007 and 2006; Shares issued: 1,211,701,522 in 2007 and 2006; Shares outstanding: 1,056,289,659 in 2007 and 1,048,877,006 in 2006 Paid−in capital Retained earnings Employee stock trust Accumulated other comprehensive loss Common stock held in treasury, at cost, $0.01 par value; 155,411,893 shares in 2007 and 162,824,546 shares in 2006 Common stock issued to employee trust Total shareholders’ equity Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity $ See Notes to Condensed Financial Statements. S−2 237,184 213,836 1,100 1,100 12 1,902 38,045 5,569 (199) 12 2,213 41,422 4,315 (35) (9,591) (5,569) (9,348) (4,315) 31,269 35,364 268,453 $ 249,200 G-200 Table of Contents SCHEDULE I MORGAN STANLEY (Parent Company Only) Condensed Statements of Income and Comprehensive Income (dollars in millions) Revenues: Interest and dividends Principal transactions Other Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 $ 9,211 613 (2) $ 6,036 (156) 3 $3,698 159 6 9,822 5,883 3,863 9,834 427 6,744 146 3,126 106 10,261 6,890 3,232 Total revenues Expenses: Interest expense Non−interest expenses Total expenses (Loss) income before income tax benefit (provision) and equity in earnings of subsidiaries Income tax benefit (provision) (439) 173 (1,007) 296 (Loss) income before equity in earnings of subsidiaries Equity in earnings of subsidiaries, net of tax (including a cumulative effect of accounting change of $49 in fiscal 2005) (266) (711) Net income 631 (143) 488 3,475 8,183 4,451 $ 3,209 $ 7,472 $4,939 Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax: Foreign currency translation adjustment Net change in cash flow hedges Minimum pension liability adjustment 65 19 (40) 104 53 (2) (89) (70) 25 Comprehensive income $ 3,253 $ 7,627 $4,805 Net income $ 3,209 $ 7,472 $4,939 Preferred stock dividend requirements $ $ $ — Earnings applicable to common shareholders $ 3,141 See Notes to Condensed Financial Statements. S−3 68 19 $ 7,453 $4,939 G-201 Table of Contents SCHEDULE I MORGAN STANLEY (Parent Company Only) Condensed Statements of Cash Flows (dollars in millions) Cash flows from operating activities: Net income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Cumulative effect of accounting change of subsidiaries Compensation payable in common stock and stock options Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net of dividends Change in assets and liabilities: Financial instruments owned, net of financial instruments sold, not yet purchased Other assets Other liabilities and accrued expenses Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Advances to and investments in subsidiaries Securities purchased under agreement to resell with affiliate Net cash used for investing activities Fiscal 2007 Fiscal 2006 Fiscal 2005 $ 3,209 $ 7,472 $ 4,939 — 1,941 3,500 — 1,955 (6,345) (49) 836 1,269 (2,625) 6,346 (23,855) (1,857) 7,091 10,064 554 (4,123) 1,255 (11,484) 18,380 4,681 (12,376) (13,784) (32,837) (16,055) 1,044 (14,297) (26,160) (48,892) (13,253) 6,360 265 281 (3,375) — 144 (11,179) — 355 Cash flows from financing activities: Net proceeds from (payments for) short−term borrowings MSCI Inc. initial public offering Tax benefits associated with stock−based awards Net proceeds from: Issuance of preferred stock Issuance of common stock Issuance of long−term borrowings Payments for: Repurchases of common stock Repayments of long−term borrowings Cash dividends — 927 60,651 1,097 643 44,009 — 327 31,304 (3,753) (22,523) (1,219) (3,376) (14,363) (1,167) (3,693) (14,579) (1,180) Net cash provided by financing activities 40,989 23,612 1,355 3,345 6,879 (6,900) 13,779 (7,217) 20,996 Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents, at beginning of period Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period $ 10,224 $ 6,879 SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION Cash payments for interest were $8,590 million, $6,230 million and $2,928 million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Cash payments for income taxes were $847 million, $1,517 million and $867 million for fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. See Notes to Condensed Financial Statements. S−4 $ 13,779 G-202 Table of Contents MORGAN STANLEY (Parent Company Only) NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 1. Introduction and Basis of Presentation. Basis of Financial Information. The accompanying condensed financial statements (the “Parent Company Financial Statements”), including the notes thereto, should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements of Morgan Stanley (the “Company”) and the notes thereto found on pages 101 to 181 in this Form 10−K. The Parent Company Financial Statements for the 12 months ended November 30, 2007 (“fiscal 2007”), November 30, 2006 (“fiscal 2006”) and November 30, 2005 (“fiscal 2005”) are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S., which require the Company to make estimates and assumptions regarding valuations of certain financial instruments, the potential outcome of litigation and other matters that affect the Parent Company Financial Statements and related disclosures. The Company believes that the estimates utilized in the preparation of the Parent Company Financial Statements are prudent and reasonable. Actual results could differ materially from these estimates. 2. Transactions with Subsidiaries. The Company has transactions with its consolidated subsidiaries determined on an agreed−upon basis and has guaranteed certain unsecured lines of credit and contractual obligations of certain of its consolidated subsidiaries. The Company received cash dividends from its consolidated subsidiaries totaling $6,975 million, $1,838 million and $5,720 million in fiscal 2007, fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. 3. Guarantees. In the normal course of its business, the Company guarantees certain of its subsidiaries’ obligations under derivative and other financial arrangements. The Company records all derivative contracts and Financial instruments owned and Financial instruments sold, not yet purchased at fair value on its consolidated statements of financial condition. For a discussion of the Company’s risk management activities, see Note 6 to the Company’s consolidated financial statements. The Company also, in the normal course of its business, provides standard indemnities to counterparties on behalf of its subsidiaries for taxes, including U.S. and foreign withholding taxes, on interest and other payments made on derivatives, securities and stock lending transactions and certain annuity products. These indemnity payments could be required based on a change in the tax laws or change in interpretation of applicable tax rulings. Certain contracts contain provisions that enable the Company to terminate the agreement upon the occurrence of such events. The maximum potential amount of future payments that the Company could be required to make under these indemnifications cannot be estimated. The Company has not recorded any contingent liability in the condensed financial statements for these indemnifications and believes that the occurrence of any events that would trigger payments under these contracts is remote. The Company has issued guarantees on behalf of its subsidiaries to various U.S. and non−U.S. exchanges and clearinghouses that trade and clear securities and/or futures contracts. Under these guarantee arrangements, the Company may be required to pay the financial obligations of its subsidiaries related to business transacted on or with the exchanges and clearinghouses in the event of a subsidiary’s default on its obligations to the exchange or the clearinghouse. The Company has not recorded any contingent liability in the condensed financial statements for these arrangements and believes that any potential requirements to make payments under these arrangements is remote. S−5 G-203 Table of Contents The Company guarantees certain debt instruments and warrants issued by subsidiaries. The debt instruments totaled $11.8 billion and the warrants totaled $0.1 billion at November 30, 2007. In connection with subsidiary lease obligations, the Company has issued guarantees to various lessors. At November 30, 2007, the Company had $2.2 billion outstanding under subsidiary lease obligations, primarily in the United Kingdom. 4. Commitments and Contingencies. For a discussion of the Company’s commitments and contingencies, see Note 15 to the Company’s consolidated financial statements. S−6 G-204 Table of Contents REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Morgan Stanley: We have audited the consolidated financial statements of Morgan Stanley and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of November 30, 2007 and 2006, and for each of the three years in the period ended November 30, 2007 and the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of November 30, 2007, and have issued our reports thereon dated January 28, 2008 (such report on the consolidated financial statements expresses an unqualified opinion and includes an explanatory paragraph, in fiscal 2005, concerning the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123(R), “Share−Based Payment” (“SFAS No. 123(R)”) and, effective December 1, 2005, the change in accounting policy for recognition of equity awards granted to retirement−eligible employees and, an explanatory paragraph, in fiscal 2006, concerning the application of Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 108 “Considering the Effects of Prior Year Misstatements when Quantifying Misstatements in the Current Year Financial Statements” (“SAB No. 108”) and, an explanatory paragraph, in fiscal 2007, concerning the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 157, “Fair Value Measurement” (“SFAS No. 157”) and Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities–Including an amendment of FASB Statement No. 115” (“SFAS No. 159”) and, an explanatory paragraph, in fiscal 2007, concerning the adoption of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 158, “Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans, an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R)”); such consolidated financial statements and reports are included in this 2007 Annual Report on Form 10−K. Our audits also included Schedule I listed in the Index to Financial Statements and Financial Statement Schedules. This financial statement schedule is the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion based on our audits. In our opinion, such financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein. In fiscal 2005, the Company adopted SFAS No. 123(R). In fiscal 2006, the Company changed its accounting policy for recognition of equity awards granted to retirement eligible employees and the Company elected application of SAB No. 108. In fiscal 2007, the Company adopted SFAS No. 157, SFAS No. 158 and SFAS No. 159. /s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP New York, New York January 28, 2008 S−7 G-205 Table of Contents SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION Washington, D.C. 20549 EXHIBITS TO FORM 10−K For the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007 Commission File No. 1−11758 G-206 Table of Contents Exhibit Index Certain of the following exhibits, as indicated parenthetically, were previously filed as exhibits to registration statements filed by Morgan Stanley or its predecessor companies under the Securities Act or to reports or registration statements filed by Morgan Stanley or its predecessor companies under the Exchange Act, respectively, and are hereby incorporated by reference to such statements or reports. Morgan Stanley’s Exchange Act file number is 1 1−11758. The Exchange Act file number of Morgan Stanley Group Inc., a predecessor company (“MSG”), was 1−9085. Exhibit No. 3.1 3.2 3.3 4.1 4.2 4.3* 4.4 4.5* 4.6 4.7 4.8 4.9 (1) Description Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Morgan Stanley, as amended to date (Exhibit 3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2007). Certificate of Elimination of the 8.03% Cumulative Preferred Stock dated as of March 23, 2007 (Exhibit 3 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated March 23, 2007). By−Laws of Morgan Stanley, as amended to date (Exhibit 3 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated June 19, 2007). Indenture dated as of February 24, 1993 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−3 (No. 33−57202)). Amended and Restated Senior Indenture dated as of May 1, 1999 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4−e to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−3/A (No. 333−75289)). Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of October 8, 2007 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York as trustee (Supplemental to Amended and Restated Senior Indenture dated as of May 1, 1999). Senior Indenture dated as of November 1, 2004 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4−f to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−3/A (No. 333−117752)). First Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of September 4, 2007 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Supplemental to Senior Indenture dated as of November 1, 2004). Second Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of January 4, 2008 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley Current Report on Form 8−K dated January 4, 2008). Amended and Restated Subordinated Indenture dated as of May 1, 1999 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4−f to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−3/A (No. 333−75289)). Subordinated Indenture dated as of October 1, 2004 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4−g to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−3/A (No. 333−117752)). Junior Subordinated Indenture dated as of March 1, 1998 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 1998). For purposes of this Exhibit Index, references to “The Bank of New York” mean in some instances the entity successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. or J.P. Morgan Trust Company, National Association; references to “JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.” mean the entity formerly known as The Chase Manhattan Bank, in some instances as the successor to Chemical Bank; references to “J.P. Morgan Trust Company, N.A.” mean the entity formerly known as Bank One Trust Company, N.A., as successor to The First National Bank of Chicago. E−1 G-207 Table of Contents Exhibit No. 4.10 4.11 4.12 4.13 4.14 4.15 4.16 4.17 4.18 4.19 4.20 4.21 10.1 Description Junior Subordinated Indenture dated as of October 1, 2004 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4−ww to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−3/A (No. 333−117752)). Junior Subordinated Indenture dated as of October 12, 2006 between Morgan Stanley and The Bank of New York, as trustee (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated October 12, 2006). Certificate representing the Series A Preferred Stock (Exhibit 4.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2006). Deposit Agreement dated as of July 6, 2006 among Morgan Stanley, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and the holders from time to time of the depositary receipts described therein (Exhibit 4.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2006). Depositary Receipt for Depositary Shares, representing Floating Rate Non−Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series A (included in Exhibit 4.13 hereto). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust III dated as of February 27, 2003 among Morgan Stanley, as depositor, The Bank of New York, as property trustee, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware trustee, and the administrators named therein (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2003). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust IV dated as of April 21, 2003 among Morgan Stanley, as depositor, The Bank of New York, as property trustee, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee and the administrators named therein (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2003). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust V dated as of July 16, 2003 among Morgan Stanley, as depositor, The Bank of New York, as property trustee, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware trustee and the administrators named therein (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2003). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VI dated as of January 26, 2006 among Morgan Stanley, as depositor, The Bank of New York, as property trustee, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware trustee and the administrators named therein (Exhibit 4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2006). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VII dated as of October 12, 2006 among Morgan Stanley, as depositor, The Bank of New York, as property trustee, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware trustee and the administrators named therein (Exhibit 4.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated October 12, 2006). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VIII dated as of April 26, 2007 among Morgan Stanley, as depositor, The Bank of New York, as property trustee, The Bank of New York (Delaware), as Delaware trustee and the administrators named therein (Exhibit 4.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated April 26, 2007). Instruments defining the Rights of Security Holders, Including Indentures—Except as set forth in Exhibits 4.1 through 4.20 above, the instruments defining the rights of holders of long−term debt securities of Morgan Stanley and its subsidiaries are omitted pursuant to Section (b)(4)(iii) of Item 601 of Regulation S−K. Morgan Stanley hereby agrees to furnish copies of these instruments to the SEC upon request. Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated as of November 30, 2000 between Morgan Stanley and State Street Bank and Trust Company (Exhibit T to Amendment No. 5 to the Schedule 13D dated as of November 30, 2000 filed by certain senior officers of Morgan Stanley) as amended by Amendment No. 1 dated as of November 30, 2000 between Morgan Stanley and State Street Bank and Trust Company, effective January 1, 2002 (Exhibit 10.10 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2001), Amendment No. 2 dated as of November 30, 2000 between Morgan Stanley and State E−2 G-208 Table of Contents Exhibit No. 10.2 10.3 10.4† 10.5† 10.6†* 10.7† 10.8† 10.9†* 10.10† Description Street Bank and Trust Company, effective January 1, 2003 (Exhibit 10.12 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002), Amendment No. 3 dated as of November 30, 2000 between Morgan Stanley and State Street Bank and Trust Company, effective September 15, 2003 (Exhibit 10.11 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2003), Amendment No. 4 dated as of March 21, 2006 between Morgan Stanley and State Street Bank and Trust Company (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2006) and Amendment No. 5 dated as of June 25, 2007 between Morgan Stanley and State Street Bank and Trust Company (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2007). Separation and Distribution Agreement dated as of June 29, 2007 by and between Morgan Stanley and Discover Financial Services (Exhibit 10 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated June 29, 2007). Securities Purchase Agreement dated as of December 19, 2007 between Morgan Stanley and Best Investment Corporation, a wholly owned subsidiary of China Investment Corporation (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated December 19, 2007). Omnibus Equity Incentive Plan (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−8 (No. 33−63024)). Morgan Stanley 401(k) Plan (f/k/a the Morgan Stanley DPSP/START Plan) amended and restated effective as of October 1, 2002 (Exhibit 10.17 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.18 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002), Amendment (Exhibit 10.18 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2003), Amendment (Exhibit 10.19 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2003), Amendment (Exhibit 10 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2004), Amendment (Exhibit 10.16 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2004), Amendment (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2005), Amendment (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2005), Amendment (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2005), Amendment (Exhibit 10.8 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2005), Amendment (Exhibit 10 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2007) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2007). Amendment to Morgan Stanley 401(k) Plan, dated as of November 20, 2007. 1993 Stock Plan for Non−Employee Directors (Exhibit 4.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−8 (No. 33−63024)) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.37 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1993) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.4 to Morgan Stanley Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2007). 1994 Omnibus Equity Plan as amended and restated (Exhibit 10.23 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2003) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.11 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006). Tax Deferred Equity Participation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007. Directors’ Equity Capital Accumulation Plan as amended through March 19, 2007 (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2007). E−3 G-209 Table of Contents Exhibit No. 10.11† 10.12†* 10.13† 10.14† 10.15† 10.16† 10.17†* 10.18† 10.19†* 10.20† 10.21† 10.22†* 10.23† Description Select Employees’ Capital Accumulation Program (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 29, 2004). Employees’ Equity Accumulation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007. Employee Stock Purchase Plan amended as of November 27, 2006 (Exhibit 10.16 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2007). Form of Agreement under the Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated Owners’ and Select Earners’ Plan (Exhibit 10.1 to MSG’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 1993). Form of Agreement under the Officers’ and Select Earners’ Plan (Exhibit 10.2 to MSG’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 1993). Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated Excess Benefit Plan (Exhibit 10.31 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 1998) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.32 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2000), Amendment (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2002), Amendment (Exhibit 10.32 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002), Amendment (Exhibit 10.34 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2003), Amendment (Exhibit 10.33 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2004) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.20 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2005). Amendment to Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated Excess Benefit Plan, dated as of November 20, 2007. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (Exhibit 10.32 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 1998) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.37 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 1999), Amendment (Exhibit 10.35 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2000), Amendment (Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2002), Amendment (Exhibit 10.37 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2002), Amendment (Exhibit 10.40 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2003) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.22 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2005). Amendment to Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, dated as of November 20, 2007. 1988 Equity Incentive Compensation Plan as amended (Exhibit 10.12 to MSG’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for fiscal year ended January 31, 1993) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.22 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006). 1995 Equity Incentive Compensation Plan (Annex A to MSG’s Proxy Statement for its 1996 Annual Meeting of Stockholders) as amended by Amendment (Exhibit 10.39 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2000), Amendment (Exhibit 10.5 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2005), Amendment (Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2006) and Amendment (Exhibit 10.24 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006). Amendment to 1995 Equity Incentive Compensation Plan, dated as of November 26, 2007. Form of Equity Incentive Compensation Plan Award Certificate (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2004). E−4 G-210 Table of Contents Exhibit No. 10.24† 10.25† 10.26† 10.27† 10.28† 10.29† 10.30† 10.31† 10.32† 10.33†* 10.34†* 10.35† 10.36† 10.37† 10.38† 10.39†* 10.40† 10.41†* Description Form of Equity Incentive Compensation Plan Award Certificate (Exhibit 10.10 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended August 31, 2005). Form of Chief Executive Officer Equity Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Award of Stock Units under the EICP (Exhibit 10.2 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated December 12, 2005). Form of Chief Executive Officer Equity Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Award of Stock Units and Stock Options (Exhibit 10.28 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006). Form of Management Committee Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Award of Stock Units under the EICP (Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated December 12, 2005). Form of Management Committee Equity Award Certificate for Discretionary Retention Award of Stock Units and Stock Options (Exhibit 10.30 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2006). 1988 Capital Accumulation Plan as amended (Exhibit 10.13 to MSG’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 1993). Form of Deferred Compensation Agreement under the Pre−Tax Incentive Program (Exhibit 10.12 to MSG’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 1994). Form of Deferred Compensation Agreement under the Pre−Tax Incentive Program 2 (Exhibit 10.12 to MSG’s Annual Report for the fiscal year ended November 30, 1996). Key Employee Private Equity Recognition Plan (Exhibit 10.43 to Morgan Stanley’s Annual Report on Form 10−K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2000). Morgan Stanley Branch Manager Compensation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007. Morgan Stanley Financial Advisor and Investment Representative Compensation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007. Morgan Stanley UK Share Ownership Plan (Exhibit 4.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Registration Statement on Form S−8 (No. 333−146954)). Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated as of September 20, 2005 between Morgan Stanley and Mr. John J. Mack (Exhibit 10 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated September 19, 2005) as amended by Amendment dated December 13, 2005 (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated December 12, 2005) and Amendment dated February 14, 2006 (Exhibit 10.4 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended February 28, 2006). Form of Restrictive Covenant Agreement (Exhibit 10 to Morgan Stanley’s Current Report on Form 8−K dated November 22, 2005). Morgan Stanley Performance Formula and Provisions (Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2006). 2007 Equity Incentive Compensation Plan as amended and restated as of November 26, 2007. Morgan Stanley 2007 Notional Leveraged Co−Investment Plan (Exhibit 10.1 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2007). Governmental Service Amendment to Outstanding Stock Option and Stock Unit Awards (replacing and superseding in its entirety Exhibit 10.3 to Morgan Stanley’s Quarterly Report on Form 10−Q for the quarter ended May 31, 2007). E−5 G-211 Table of Contents Exhibit No. 11 12* 21* 23.1* 24 31.1** 31.2** 32.1** 32.2** * ** † Description Statement Re: Computation of Earnings Per Common Share (The calculation of per share earnings is in Part II, Item 8, Note 10 to the Consolidated Financial Statements (Earnings per Share) and is omitted in accordance with Section (b)(11) of Item 601 of Regulation S−K). Statement Re: Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends. Subsidiaries of Morgan Stanley. Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP. Powers of Attorney (included on signature page). Rule 13a−14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer. Rule 13a−14(a) Certification of Chief Financial Officer. Section 1350 Certification of Chief Executive Officer. Section 1350 Certification of Chief Financial Officer. Filed herewith. Furnished herewith. Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement required to be filed as an exhibit to this Form 10−K pursuant to Item 15(b). E−6 G-212 Table of Contents G-213 Exhibit 4.3 FOURTH SUPPLEMENTAL SENIOR INDENTURE BETWEEN MORGAN STANLEY (formerly known as MORGAN STANLEY DEAN WITTER & CO.) AND THE BANK OF NEW YORK as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly known as The Chase Manhattan Bank), Trustee Dated as of October 8, 2007 SUPPLEMENTAL TO AMENDED AND RESTATED SENIOR INDENTURE DATED AS OF MAY 1, 1999, AS SUPPLEMENTED BY A FIRST SUPPLEMENTAL SENIOR INDENTURE DATED AS OF SEPTEMBER 15, 2000, A SECOND SUPPLEMENTAL SENIOR INDENTURE DATED AS OF OCTOBER 8, 2002 AND A THIRD SUPPLEMENTAL SENIOR INDENTURE DATED AS OF AUGUST 29, 2003. G-214 THIS FOURTH SUPPLEMENTAL SENIOR INDENTURE dated as of October 8, 2007 between MORGAN STANLEY (formerly known as Morgan Stanley Dean Witter & Co.), a Delaware corporation (the “Issuer”), and THE BANK OF NEW YORK as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly known as The Chase Manhattan Bank), as trustee (the “Trustee”), WITNESSETH: WHEREAS, the Issuer and the Trustee are parties to that certain Amended and Restated Senior Indenture dated as of May 1,1999, as supplemented by a First Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of September 15, 2000, a Second Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of October 8, 2002 and a Third Supplemental Senior Indenture dated as of August 29, 2003 (as so supplemented, the “Indenture”); WHEREAS, the Issuer established and on July 22, 2004 issued its Medium−Term Notes, Series C, Senior Variable Rate Renewable Notes with an initial maturity date of August 15, 2005 and a final maturity date of August 13, 2010 (the “Notes”); WHEREAS, Section 8.01 of the Indenture provides that, without the consent of the Holders of any Securities, the Issuer, when authorized by a resolution of its Board of Directors, and the Trustee may enter into indentures supplemental to the Indenture, subject to the conditions set forth therein, for the purpose of, among other things, making any provisions as the Issuer may deem necessary or desirable, provided that no such action shall adversely affect the interests of the Holders of the Securities; WHEREAS, the Issuer desires to modify certain provisions of the Notes to increase the spread that will be used when calculating the interest payable with respect to the Notes on Interest Reset Dates from and including September 15, 2007; WHEREAS, the entry into this Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture by the parties hereto is in all respects authorized by the provisions of the Indenture; and WHEREAS, all things necessary to make this Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture a valid indenture and agreement according to its terms have been done; NOW, THEREFORE: In consideration of the premises and the purchases of the Securities by the holders thereof, the Issuer and the Trustee mutually covenant and agree for the equal and proportionate benefit of the respective holders from time to time of the Notes as follows: 2 G-215 ARTICLE 1 Section 1.01. Amendment of the Notes. (i) The definition of Spread (Plus or Minus) within the Notes is hereby amended by deleting the existing definition in its entirety and inserting in lieu thereof the following: SPREAD (PLUS OR MINUS): Plus 0.000% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from the Original Issue Date to and including August 14, 2005; plus 0.030% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including August 15, 2005 to and including August 14, 2006; plus 0.060% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including August 15, 2006 to and including August 14, 2007; plus 0.080% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including August 15, 2007 to and including September 14, 2007; plus 0.125% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including September 15, 2007 to and including August 14, 2008; plus 0.150% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including August 15, 2008 to and including August 14, 2009; plus 0.180% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including August 15, 2009 to but excluding August 13, 2010. 3 G-216 SECTION 1.02. Exchange of the Notes. The Trustee is authorized to exchange the original certificates dated July 22, 2004 evidencing the Notes for the duly executed and authenticated certificates evidencing the amended terms of the Notes. Upon such exchange, the Trustee shall promptly cancel and dispose of such original Notes in accordance with Section 2.10 of the Indenture. Failure to exchange such original Notes for such amended Notes in accordance with this Section will not impair the validity of or otherwise affect the Notes, as amended. ARTICLE 2 Miscellaneous Provisions Section 2.01. Further Assurances. The Issuer will, upon request by the Trustee, execute and deliver such further instruments and do such further acts as may reasonably be necessary or proper to carry out more effectively the purposes of this Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture. Section 2.02. Other Terms of Indenture. Except insofar as herein otherwise expressly provided, all provisions, terms and conditions of the Indenture are in all respects ratified and confirmed and shall remain in full force and effect. Section 2.03. Terms Defined. All terms defined elsewhere in the Indenture shall have the same meanings when used herein. Section 2.04. Governing Law. This Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture shall be deemed to be a contract under the laws of the State of New York, and for all purposes shall be construed in accordance with the laws of such State, except as may otherwise be required by mandatory provisions of law. Section 2.05. Counterparts. This Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an original; but such counterparts shall together constitute but one and the same instrument. Section 2.06. Responsibility of the Trustee. The recitals contained herein shall be taken as the statements of the Issuer, and the Trustee assumes no responsibility for the correctness of the same. The Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or sufficiency of this Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture. 4 G-217 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Fourth Supplemental Senior Indenture to be duly executed, and their respective corporate seals to be hereunto affixed and attested, all as of October 8, 2007. MORGAN STANLEY (formerly known as Morgan Stanley Dean Witter & Co.) By: /s/ Jai Sooklal Name: Jai Sooklal Title: Assistant Treasurer Attest: By: /s/ W. Gary Beeson Name: W. Gary Beeson Title: Assistant Secretary THE BANK OF NEW YORK, as TRUSTEE By: /s/ Francine Kincaid Name: Francine Kincaid Title: Vice President Attest: By: /s/ Geovanni Barris Name: Geovanni Barris Title: Vice President 5 G-218 STATE OF NEW YORK COUNTY OF NEW YORK ) ) ss.: ) th On this 8 day of October 2007 before me personally came Jai Sooklal to me personally known, who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say that he resides at Chatham, N.J.; that he is the Assistant Treasurer of Morgan Stanley, one of the corporations described in and which executed the above instrument; and that signed his name thereto by authority of the Board of Directors of said corporation. [NOTARIAL SEAL] /s/ Michael M. O’Brien Notary Public MICHAEL M. O’BRIEN Notary Public, State of New York No. 31−5003142 Qualified in New York County Commission Expires Oct 19, 2010 G-219 STATE OF NEW YORK COUNTY OF NEW YORK ) ) ss.: ) th On this 8 day of October 2007 before me personally came Francine Kincaid to me personally known, who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say that she resides at Deer Park, N.Y.; that she is a Vice President of The Bank of New York, one of the corporations described in and which executed the above instrument; and that signed her name thereto by authority of the Board of Directors of said corporation. [NOTARIAL SEAL] /s/ Carlos R. Luciano Notary Public 2 G-220 Exhibit 4.5 FIRST SUPPLEMENTAL SENIOR INDENTURE BETWEEN MORGAN STANLEY AND THE BANK OF NEW YORK as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly known as JPMorgan Chase Bank), Trustee Dated as of September 4, 2007 SUPPLEMENTAL TO SENIOR INDENTURE DATED NOVEMBER 1, 2004. G-221 THIS FIRST SUPPLEMENTAL SENIOR INDENTURE dated as of September 4, 2007 between MORGAN STANLEY, a Delaware corporation (the “Issuer”), and THE BANK OF NEW YORK as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly known as JPMorgan Chase Bank), as trustee (the “Trustee”), WITNESSETH: WHEREAS, the Issuer and the Trustee are parties to that certain Senior Indenture dated as of November 1, 2004 (the “Indenture”); WHEREAS, the Issuer established and on January 12, 2005 issued its Medium−Term Notes, Series F, Senior Variable Rate Renewable Notes with an initial maturity date of February 3, 2006 and a final maturity date of February 3, 2011 (the “Original Notes”) and on February 3, 2005 issued additional notes with the same terms (the “Reopening Notes” and together with the Original Notes, the “Notes”); WHEREAS, Section 8.01 of the Indenture provides that, without the consent of the Holders of any Securities, the Issuer, when authorized by a resolution of its Board of Directors, and the Trustee may enter into indentures supplemental to the Indenture for the purpose of, among other things, making any provisions as the Issuer may deem necessary or desirable, subject to the conditions set forth therein; provided that no such action shall adversely affect the interests of the Holders of the Securities; WHEREAS, the Issuer desires to modify certain provisions of the Notes to increase the spread that will be used when calculating the interest payable with respect to the Notes on Interest Reset Dates from and including September 3, 2007; WHEREAS, the entry into this First Supplemental Senior Indenture by the parties hereto is in all respects authorized by the provisions of the Indenture; and WHEREAS, all things necessary to make this First Supplemental Senior Indenture a valid indenture and agreement according to its terms have been done; NOW, THEREFORE: In consideration of the premises and the purchases of the Securities by the holders thereof, the Issuer and the Trustee mutually covenant and agree for the equal and proportionate benefit of the respective holders from time to time of the Notes as follows: 2 G-222 ARTICLE 1 Section 1.01. Amendment of the Notes. (i) The definition of Spread (Plus or Minus) within the Notes is hereby amended by deleting the existing definition in its entirety and inserting in lieu thereof the following: SPREAD (PLUS OR MINUS): Minus 0.01% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from the Original Issue Date to and including February 2, 2006; plus 0.02% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including February 3, 2006 to and including February 2, 2007; plus 0.04% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including February 3, 2007 to and including September 2, 2007; plus 0.125% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including September 3, 2007 to and including February 2, 2008; plus 0.15% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including February 3, 2008 to and including February 2, 2009; plus 0.18% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including February 3, 2009 to and including February 2, 2010; plus 0.18% per annum for the Interest Reset Dates occurring from and including February 3, 2010 to but excluding February 3, 2011 3 G-223 SECTION 1.02. Exchange of the Notes. The Trustee is authorized to exchange the original certificates dated January 12, 2005 evidencing the Original Notes and the original certificates dated February 3, 2005 evidencing the Reopening Notes for the duly executed and authenticated certificates evidencing the amended terms of the Notes. Upon such exchange, the Trustee shall promptly cancel and dispose of such original Notes in accordance with Section 2.10 of the Indenture. Failure to exchange such original Notes for such amended Notes in accordance with this Section will not impair the validity of or otherwise affect the Notes, as amended. ARTICLE 2 Miscellaneous Provisions Section 2.01. Further Assurances. The Issuer will, upon request by the Trustee, execute and deliver such further instruments and do such further acts as may reasonably be necessary or proper to carry out more effectively the purposes of this First Supplemental Senior Indenture. Section 2.02. Other Terms of Indenture. Except insofar as herein otherwise expressly provided, all provisions, terms and conditions of the Indenture are in all respects ratified and confirmed and shall remain in full force and effect. Section 2.03. Terms Defined. All terms defined elsewhere in the Indenture shall have the same meanings when used herein. Section 2.04. Governing Law. This First Supplemental Senior Indenture shall be deemed to be a contract under the laws of the State of New York, and for all purposes shall be construed in accordance with the laws of such State, except as may otherwise be required by mandatory provisions of law. Section 2.05. Counterparts. This First Supplemental Senior Indenture may be executed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an original; but such counterparts shall together constitute but one and the same instrument. Section 2.06. Responsibility of the Trustee. The recitals contained herein shall be taken as the statements of the Issuer, and the Trustee assumes no responsibility for the correctness of the same. The Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or sufficiency of this First Supplemental Senior Indenture. 4 G-224 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this First Supplemental Senior Indenture to be duly executed, and their respective corporate seals to be hereunto affixed and attested, all as of September 4, 2007. MORGAN STANLEY By: /s/ Jai Sooklal Name: Jai Sooklal Title: Assistant Treasurer Attest: By: /s/ Gary Beeson Name: Gary Beeson Title: Assistant Secretary THE BANK OF NEW YORK TRUSTEE, By: /s/ Geovanni Barris Name: Geovanni Barris Title: Vice President Attest: By: /s/ Jeremy Finkelstein Name: Jeremy Finkelstein Title: Vice President 5 G-225 STATE OF NEW YORK COUNTY OF NEW YORK ) ) ss.: ) th On this 4 day of September 2007 before me personally came Jai Sooklal to me personally known, who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say that he resides at Chatham, N.J.; that he is the Assistant Treasurer of Morgan Stanley, one of the corporations described in and which executed the above instrument; and that signed his name thereto by authority of the Board of Directors of said corporation. [NOTARIAL SEAL] /s/ Michael M. O’Brien Notary Public G-226 STATE OF NEW YORK COUNTY OF NEW YORK ) ) ss.: ) th On this 4 day of September 2007 before me personally came Geovanni Barris to me personally known, who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say that he resides at New York, N.Y.; that he is a Vice President of The Bank of New York, one of the corporations described in and which executed the above instrument; and that signed his name thereto by authority of the Board of Directors of said corporation. [NOTARIAL SEAL] /s/ Carlos R. Luciano Notary Public 2 G-227 Exhibit 10.6 AMENDMENT TO 401(k) PLAN Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated (the “Corporation”) hereby amends the Morgan Stanley 401(k) Plan (the “401(k) Plan”) as follows: 1. Effective April 1, 2007, Section 2, Definitions, is amended by adding a new definition as follows: ““Broker−Dealer Merger” means the merger of Morgan Stanley DW Inc. with and into Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated as of April 1, 2007.” 2. Effective November 13, 2007, the definition of “Elective Deferrals” in Section 2 of the 401(k) Plan shall be amended by adding the following sentence at the end thereof: “Elective Deferrals shall also include any Roth Elective Deferrals made pursuant to Section 5(l).” 3. Effective April 1, 2007, Section 2, Definitions is amended by adding the following to the end of the definition of “Eligible IIG Employee”: “Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, to the extent an Eligible Employee is an Eligible IIG Employee due to employment by Morgan Stanley DW Inc. or a subsidiary thereof prior to the Broker−Dealer Merger, such Eligible Employee shall not cease to be treated as an Eligible IIG Employee, nor become treated as an Eligible MS Employee, after the effective date of the Broker−Dealer Merger solely as a result of such merger.” 4. Effective November 13, 2007, the first sentence of the definition of “Matched Contributions” in Section 2 of the 401(k) Plan shall be amended to read as follows: ““Matched Contributions” means Pre−Tax Contributions, Roth Elective Deferrals and After−Tax Adjustment Contributions.” 5. Effective April 1, 2007, Section 2, Definitions, is amended by adding the following to the end of paragraph (a) of “Securities E